Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Dodge
Model
Neon
Engine and year
L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 8
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 14
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Locations
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The system relay is used for the operation of the Anti Lock Brake (ABS) system. Power for the
relay is supplied on the B57 circuit from cavity 57 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB).
Ground for the relay is on the Z1 circuit. This ground is spliced in with the pump motor and
terminates at the left headlamp ground.
When the system is operating normally power for the contact side of the relay is supplied from the
CAB on the B57 circuit. It passes through the relay to the Z1 ground and terminates at the left
headlamp ground. If a problem is detected in the system, the contact side of the relay switches
from the Z1 to the F12 circuit. This causes the ABS warning lamp in the instrument cluster to
illuminate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay > Page 21
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relays
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
SYSTEM RELAY
The main purpose of the system relay is to put the Antilock Brake System (ABS) into a stand-by
mode for ABS operation. The System Relay is energized by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
shortly after the ignition switch is turned on.
When Energized - by the CAB, the System Relay turns off the ABS warning lamp and provides 12
volts to the CAB. This voltage can then be used by the CAB to energize the Decay Solenoids
during ABS braking. When energized, the System Relay also provides the Pump/Motor Relay coil
with 12 volts. The ground path to the Pump/Motor Relay is completed by the CAB during ABS
braking.
When De-energized - the ABS warning lamp is illuminated, voltage to the Decay Solenoids is cut
off, and the Pump/Motor Relay is prevented from energizing. Typically, the System Relay is
de-energized by the CAB when a fault is detected that requires turning ABS off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Description
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
PURPOSE
Pump/Motor power is supplied by the Pump/Motor Relay. The pump motor relay is also part of the
relay box mounted to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). If pump/motor relay replacement is
required, it is also only serviced by the replacement of the relay box assembly.
FUNCTION
Voltage for the 12 volt side of the relay coil is provided by the System Relay. The ground path
through the relay coil is completed by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) during Antilock Brake
System (ABS) braking. The relay contacts are closed when the relay is energized. This provides 12
volts to the pump/motor as needed during ABS braking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 26
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Anti Lock Brake (ABS) pump motor relay controls when the pump motor runs. Power for the
coil side of the relay is supplied from cavity 47 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) on the B47
circuit. This circuit also supplies voltage for the contact side of the system relay The ground side of
the coil is controlled by the B116 circuit. Circuit B116 connects to cavity 16 of the CAB connector.
Circuit B120 from cavity 20 of the CAB connector powers the ABS pump motor. This circuit is also
used as an input to the CAB for pump motor monitoring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
Controller Antilock Brake
The CAB is mounted under the instrument panel behind the drivers side kick panel of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 30
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
Controller Antilock Brake
PURPOSE
The Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) is a microprocessor based device which monitors the Antilock
Brake System (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when in an ABS stop. The CAB is
mounted under the instrument panel on the drivers side kick panel. The CAB uses a 60 way
electrical connector on the vehicle wiring harness. The power source for the CAB is through the
ignition switch in the Run or On position.
NOTE: The CAB is not on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) bus.
THE PRIMARY FUNCTIONS OF THE CAB
- Detect wheel locking tendencies.
- Control fluid modulation to the brakes while in ABS mode.
- Monitor the system for proper operation.
- Provide communication to the DRB scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
The CAB Continuously Monitors - the speed of each wheel through the signals generated at the
Wheel Speed Sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the CAB commands the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) to modulate brake fluid
pressure in some or all of the hydraulic circuits. The CAB continues to control pressure in individual
hydraulic circuits until a locking tendency is no longer present.
The ABS System Is Constantly Monitored - by the CAB for proper operation. If the CAB detects a
fault, it will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp and disable the ABS braking system. The normal
Non ABS braking system will remain operational.
The CAB Contains A Self-diagnostic Program - which will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp
when a ABS system fault is detected.
Faults Are Then Stored - in a diagnostic program memory. There are multiple fault messages
which may be stored in the CAB and displayed through the DRB. These fault messages will remain
in the CAB memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The fault messages can be cleared
by using the DRB diagnostics tester, or they will be automatically cleared from the memory after
the vehicle is driven approximately 3500 miles.
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE INPUTS
^ Four wheel speed sensors. ^ Stop lamp switch. ^ Ignition switch. ^ System relay voltage. ^
Ground. ^ Pump/Motor Relay Monitor ^ Diagnostics Communications
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE OUTPUTS
^ 4 Decay Solenoids ^ ABS warning lamp. ^ System relay actuation. ^ Diagnostic communication. ^
Pump motor relay actuation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 31
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Controller Antilock Brake
REMOVE
1. Turn vehicle ignition off.
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
2. Disconnect the wiring harness 60 way connector from the Controller Antilock Brake Module
(CAB). Verify that the vehicle ignition is off before
removing the 60 way connector.
CAB Bracket To Kick Panel Mounting
3. Remove the 2 controller bracket to drivers side cowl mounting nuts. 4. Remove the CAB from
the vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Install CAB and mounting bracket on mounting studs located on passenger side kick panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 32
2. Install the 2 CAB bracket mounting nuts and securely tighten. 3. Install the 60-way wiring
harness connector by hand into the 60-way CAB connector, as far as possible. Then use the CAB
connector retaining
bolt to fully seat wiring harness connector into the CAB.
4. Torque the 60-way connector retaining bolt to 4 Nm (38 inch lbs.). 5. If a new CAB is being has
been installed, it must be initialized prior to the vehicle being driven. The CAB is initialized using
the DRB Scan Tool
and the initializing procedure described upon selecting Bendix ABX-4 Diagnostics. New controllers
are programmed to flash the ABS warning lamp until initialized by the installing technician.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 >
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 >
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 42
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 >
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 43
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 >
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 44
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 >
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 45
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 >
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 >
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 50
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 >
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 51
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 >
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 52
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 >
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 53
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98
> Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98
> Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 59
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98
> Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 60
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 66
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 67
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 68
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 69
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 74
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 75
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 76
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 77
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 82
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 83
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 84
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 85
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 90
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 91
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 97
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 98
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 99
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 100
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 105
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 106
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 112
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 113
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 114
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions > Page 115
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 120
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 121
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 122
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 123
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 128
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 129
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 130
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 131
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 132
Solid State Fan Relay: Locations
Fig.31 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 133
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The power distribution center (PDC) is located next to the battery in the engine compartment. The
PDC contains the starter relay, radiator fan relay, A/C compressor clutch relay, auto shutdown
relay, fuel pump relay and several fuses. For the location of the relay within the PDC, refer to the
PDC cover for location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 134
Solid State Relay
Solid State Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
137
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
138
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
139
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
140
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
141
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
142
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
143
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
144
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
145
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
146
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
147
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
148
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
149
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
150
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
151
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
152
Radiator Fan Relay Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
153
Solid State Fan Relay: Electrical Diagrams
Dual Cooling Fans
A/C & Heater System -- Sheet 8w-42-4
Chrysler Does not provide a wiring diagram for dual fans on 95-98 model year Neons. This diagram
is for the 99 model year and is presented for reference only.
Single Cooling Fan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
154
A/C And Heat Part 1 of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
155
A/C And Heat Part 2 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
156
A/C And Heat Part 3 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
157
A/C And Heat Part 4 Of 4
The OE does not show a wiring diagram showing the dual fan option specifically until 1999 but the
dual fan option is mentioned. Additionally, the Radiator Fan Control is shown as a portion of the
A/C circuit and as a portion of the PCM circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Solid State Fan Relay <-->
[Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 158
Solid State Fan Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Solid State Relay
The relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 166
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge
Protection Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Description and Operation
Halo Lamp/Time Delay Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time delay relay is used to allow a time-ON function for the ignition switch halo lamp. Power for
the relay is received on the M1 circuit from the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC). This is the Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse and HOT at all times.
When a door is OPENED, or the headlamp switch is moved to the dome lamp position, a ground
path is provided for the relay on the M23 circuit. This energizes the relay, CLOSING the contacts.
When the relay contacts are CLOSED, power is provided through the relay to the M50 circuit.
The M50 circuit supplies current to the ignition switch lamp in the steering column. Ground for the
lamp is provided on the Z3 circuit. This circuit splices with the glove box lamp, the ash receiver
lamp, and the PRNDL lamp. The Z3 circuit terminates at the instrument panel left center support.
Circuit M23 is also spliced with the Remote Key-less Entry (RKE) module and the time out relay
located in the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
DRL Module
The Daytime Running Lamp module is attached to a support brace on the underside of the
instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 174
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION - CANADA
On vehicles built for sale in Canada, the head- lamps operate, at reduced intensity, when the
ignition switch is in the RUN position and the parking brake switch is OPEN.
In the Power Distribution Center (PDC), a bus bar connected to battery voltage feeds circuit A1. In
the RUN position, the ignition switch connects circuit A1 to circuit A21. A 30 Amp fuse in the PDC,
protects circuits A1 and A21.
Circuit A21 connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. The bus bar in the fuse block feeds circuit G5
through a 5 Amp fuse in cavity 11. Circuit G5 is powered only when the ignition switch is in the
RUN position.
Circuit G9 connects to the DRL module. The G9 circuit splices to the brake warning switch, park
brake switch and instrument cluster brake warning bulb.
Circuit L20 from the headlamp and dimmer switch supplies battery voltage to the DRL module at all
times. Circuit A3 from the PDC feeds circuit L20. A 40 Amp fuse in the PDC protects the A3 circuit.
From the DRL module, circuit L4 powers the LOW beams of the left and right headlamps. The DRL
controls the power to circuit L4. Circuit L4 connects to cavity 10 of the DRL module.
Circuit L3 feeds the high beams of the headlamps. When the operator flashes the headlamps with
the stalk of the multi-function switch, the DRL senses voltage on circuit L3. When it senses voltage
on circuit L3, the DRL module stops supplying power to the low beams on circuit L4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 175
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
- If the park brake switch is CLOSED, the DRL will not turn on the headlamps. The DRL senses if
the park brake switch is CLOSED on circuit G9.
- Circuit Z1 provides ground for the headlamps.
- Circuit L20 of the headlamp switch connector has a jumper that feeds the DRL module.
- Check for a blown fuse in circuits A1 or G5.
- The headlamp switch has a 24 Amp circuit breaker that feeds circuit L20.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Relay Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Control Module
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. From behind bumper fascia, remove bolt holding
outboard end of module to fender. 3. Loosen bolts holding inboard end of module to radiator
closure panel. 4. Remove bolt holding grille to headlamp module.
Headlamp Module
5. Remove bolts holding top of module to upper cross member. 6. Disengage wire connector from
headlamp and parking lamp sockets. 7. Separate headlamp module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 186
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 187
Horn Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 188
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 189
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay. 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity between ground and circuit 65 of horn
relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay. b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and refer to Horn
Test.
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
5. Check relay for 70 to 75 Ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 190
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Power Distribution Center cover and locate the horn relay.
Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Interior Lighting Relay: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time out relay is located in the fuse block and is used to control the ground path for various
interior lamps. It will also turn the lamps OFF after a specified period of time, and works with the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system for illuminated entry.
Circuit M2 connects to the relay and supplied a ground path through the door ajar switches.
Circuit M1 is used to supply battery voltage to the relay. This circuit is produced by a 10 Amp fuse
located in cavity 13 of the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
Circuit M32 is connected from the relay to the various interior lamps and RKE module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Specifications
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
PCM 60-Way Connector Torque = 4 Nm (35 in lb) PCM Mounting Screws = 4 Nm (35 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 199
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 202
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 203
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 204
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 205
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 206
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 207
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 208
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 209
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 210
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 211
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 212
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 213
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 214
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 215
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 216
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 217
Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 218
Powertrain Control Module: Service Precautions
- Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is off. Failure to do so could
damage the module.
- When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end)
of the connector.
- Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause it to fail
because of corrosion.
- Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
- Operation of any type, including idling, should be avoided if engine misfiring occurs. Under this
condition, the exhaust system operates at abnormally high temperature, which may cause damage
to the catalyst or under-body parts of the vehicle.
- Alteration or deterioration of ignition or fuel system, or any type of operating condition which
results in engine misfiring must be corrected to avoid overheating the catalytic converter.
- Proper maintenance and tune-up, according to manufacturer's specifications, should be made to
correct abnormal conditions as soon as possible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 from the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies battery voltage to cavity 46 of the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). A 20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuit A14.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 221
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation PCM Operation
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor (Fig. 2).
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
PCM Inputs: Air Conditioning Controls
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor
- Ignition Switch (A21)
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oxygen Sensors
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receiver
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Transmission Park/Neutral Switch (Automatic Transmission)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
PCM Outputs:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 222
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Air Conditioning WOT Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp
- Data Link Connector
- Duty Cycle EVAP Canister Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor
- Ignition Coils
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp
- Radiator Fan Relay
- Speed Control Solenoids
- Tachometer
- Torque Convertor Clutch Solenoid
Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts: Fuel Injector Pulse Width
- Idle Speed
- Ignition Spark Advance
- Ignition Coil Dwell
- EVAP Canister Purge Operation.
The PCM Regulates: Cooling Fan
- Air Conditioning
- Speed Control System
- Generator Charge Rate -- by Adjusting The Generator Field
The PCM Also Performs Diagnostics
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on: Battery Voltage
- Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Content (Oxygen Sensor)
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on: Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on: Air Conditioning Sense
- Battery Temperature
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Engine Run Time
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
- Vehicle Distance (Speed)
ASD and Fuel Pump Relay Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 223
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are mounted externally, but turned on and off by
the PCM.
Crankshaft Position (Engine Speed) Signal The crankshaft position sensor signal is sent to the
PCM. If the PCM does not receive the signal within approximately one second of engine cranking,
it deactivates the ASD relay and fuel pump relay When these relays deactivate, power is shut off
from the fuel injectors, ignition coils, heating element in the oxygen sensors and the fuel pump.
PCM Regulated Output Supply Voltages The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes
battery voltage to a regulated 8 volts direct current to power: Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
The PCM also provides a 5 volt direct current supply for: Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
- Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 224
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Powertrain Control Module The speed control electronic control circuitry is integrated into the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The PCM is located in the engine compartment. The PCM
speed control functions are monitored by the On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). All OBD-sensed
systems are monitored by the PCM. Each monitored circuit is assigned a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC). The PCM will store a DTC in electronic memory for any failure it detects. The PCM cannot
be repaired and must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Powertrain Control Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit A14 connects to a bus bar in the PDC that the battery feeds. Circuit A14 powers the
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay and fuel pump relay The A14 circuit also splices to the data link
connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 227
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
NOTE: The PCM attaches to the inner fender panel next to the washer fluid bottle on the driver
side (Fig. 100).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Disconnect positive cable from battery. 3. Remove
washer bottle neck. 4. Squeeze tabs on Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling PDC up to
remove it from bracket.
- Lay PDC aside to gain access to PCM bracket screws.
5. Remove screws attaching PCM to body. 3. Lift PCM up and disconnect the 2 40-way connector
7. Remove PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the 2 40-way connector to PCM. 2. Install PCM. Tighten mounting screws to 4 Nm (35 in
lb) torque. 3. Install PDC by pushing down into brackets. 4. Install washer bottle neck. 5. Connect
positive cable to battery. 6. Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 231
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 234
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 235
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 236
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 239
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 240
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
246
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The inside top of the PDC
cover has a label showing relay and fuse location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
247
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector >
Page 250
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector >
Page 251
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump
Relay Operation
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Operation
NAME OF CODE:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
WHEN MONITORED:
With the ignition key ON and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
SET CONDITION:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). One side of
the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "RUN"
position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the
powertrain control module (PCM). The PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either
the RUN or CRANK position and engine RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM
will remove the fuel pump relay control circuit ground.
POSSIBLE CAUSES:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump
Relay Operation > Page 254
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit Trouble Code
Name of Code:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key on and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the PDC. One side of the relay control coil is
supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "run position". The circuit is
completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the powertrain control module. The
PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either the run or crank position and engine
RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM will remove the fuel pump relay control
circuit ground.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 255
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump relay.
Terminal 85 -- The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A -- When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87 When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should not show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one
end of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the
jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 256
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
NOTE: Other testing for this system or component is done at the system level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 260
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 263
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 264
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 265
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 268
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 269
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 279
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 280
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 281
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 282
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 283
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 284
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 285
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 286
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 287
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 288
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 289
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 290
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 291
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 292
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 293
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 299
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 300
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 301
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 302
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 303
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 304
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 305
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 306
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 307
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 308
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 309
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 310
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 311
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 312
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 313
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 314
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 315
Connector Pin-Outs Component Index
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 316
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Electrical Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "OFF". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion.
Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 317
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Airbag Control Module Location
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) contains the safing sensor and energy reserve capacitor. The
safing sensor is located inside the ACM. The module is mounted on the tunnel/floor pan between
the gear shift lever and the park brake lever. The safing sensor provides confirmation of a crash,
but does not discriminate severity. The ACM monitors the system to determine the system
readiness. The ACM contains on-board diagnostics, and will illuminate the AIRBAG warning lamp
in the cluster when a fault occurs. The warning equipment is tested for 6 to 8 Seconds every time
the vehicle is started.
Driver And Passenger Airbag Module
WARNING: NEVER DISASSEMBLE THE DRIVER OR PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE, THERE
ARE NO SERVICEABLE PARTS WITH IN THE MODULES.
Driver Airbag
The Driver Airbag Module located on the steering wheel is the most visible part of the system. The
airbag module contains a housing to which the cushion, inflator and cover are attached to.
The driver side inflator assembly is mounted from the back of the module housing. When supplied
with the proper electrical signal the inflator assembly will produce a gas and discharge it directly
into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted to the front of the Driver Airbag Module and forms a
decorative cover in the center of the steering wheel. The Driver Airbag Module is mounted directly
to the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 318
Passengers Airbag
The Passenger Airbag Module is located beneath the decorative cover of the instrument panel,
facing the passenger seat.
The passenger inflator assembly is within the module housing. The module is mounted to the
instrument panel retainer and support structure. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the
inflator will produce a gas and discharge it directly into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted into
the instrument panel over the airbag module and forms a decorative cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 319
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: -
THE ACM CONTAINS A SAFING SENSOR WHICH ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY THE
AIRBAGS. TO AVOID ACCIDENTAL DEPLOYMENT, NEVER CONNECT THE ACM
ELECTRICALLY TO THE SYSTEM WHILE VEHICLE BATTERY IS CONNECTED.
- DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE BEFORE
BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
- ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING ANY
AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
CAUTION: Failure to follow the parking brake service procedures can result in damage to the
parking brake mechanism.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Manual transaxle only, remove shifter knob
fastener and remove shifter knob.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
3. Remove screws attaching rear of center console assembly to console bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 320
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
4. Remove the two screws located in cup holders, attaching front of center console assembly to
console bracket. 5. Raise park brake hand lever assembly as high as it will go for required
clearance to remove center console. 6. Remove center console assembly from vehicle.
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS REQUIRED,
THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE RELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
7. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
8. Grasp park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward. Continue pulling on cable until a
3/16 in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and
sector gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off
park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 321
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
9. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer.
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
10. Remove wiring harness electrical connector for brake warning light from park brake lever.
Park Brake Lever Attachment To Console Bracket
11. Remove the two nuts attaching park brake lever to console bracket. Remove park brake lever
mechanism from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 322
Airbag Control Module
12. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module.
ACM Connector
13. Disconnect ACM 23-PIN connector. 14. Remove Airbag Control Module.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector locking tab is engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED SCREWS ONLY
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
11 to 14 N.m (105 to 125 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: The park brake lever can be in any position when releasing the auto adjuster. To ease
installation of center console, it is advisable to pull park brake lever handle all the way up before
removing lockout pin.
3. Place park brake lever on console bracket. Install and securely tighten the 2 attaching nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 323
Park Brake Cables Properly Installed In Equalizer
Rear Park Brake Cable Installation On Equalizer
4. Install both rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever output cable. 5. Ensure that
park brake cable is correctly installed and aligned with cable track on park brake lever. 6. Pull park
brake lever handle all the way up.
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever Assembly
7. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin and quickly remove it from the park brake lever
mechanism, This will allow the park brake lever
mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 324
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
8. Connect electrical connector for brake warning lamp onto terminal on park brake lever assembly.
9. Cycle park brake lever once to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever its
released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle. They should rotate freely without dragging.
10. Raise park brake lever to its fully engaged position. This is necessary to allow installation of the
center console. 11. Install center console assembly.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 325
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
12. Install the four center console assembly attaching screws. 13. Replace shifter knob and
fastener. 14. Do not connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 331
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 332
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 333
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 334
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: CHECK TO ENSURE THAT THE TRANSMISSION IS IN THE PARK
POSITION/NEUTRAL WITH THE PARKING BRAKE APPLIED
Relay Test
The starter relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine compartment.
Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location. Remove the starter relay from the PDC
as described to perform the following tests:
1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30, and
no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 Ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 3. Connect a battery B+ lead to terminals 86 and a
ground lead to terminal 85 to energize the relay The relay should click. Also test for continuity
between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A and 30. If OK, refer to
Relay Circuit Test procedure. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to battery voltage and should be hot at
all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the PDC fuse as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position, but is not used for this application. Go to Step
3.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. This terminal supplies battery
voltage to the starter solenoid field coils. There should be continuity between the cavity for relay
terminal 87 and the starter solenoid terminal at all times. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the starter solenoid as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. It is energized when
the ignition switch is held in the Start position.
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the clutch pedal must be fully depressed for this test.
Check for battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86 with the ignition switch in the Start
position, and no voltage when the ignition switch is released to the On position. If OK, go to Step 5.
If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an open or short circuit to the ignition switch
and repair, if required. If the circuit to the ignition switch is OK, see the Ignition Switch Test
procedure. If not OK with a manual transmission, check the circuit between the relay and the clutch
pedal position switch for an open or a short. If the circuit is OK, see the Clutch Pedal Position
Switch/Brake pedal Switch/Sensor Test procedure.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. On vehicles with an
automatic transmission, it is grounded through
the park/neutral position switch only when the gearshift selector lever is in the Park or Neutral
positions. On vehicles with a manual transmission, it is grounded at all times. Check for continuity
to ground at the cavity for relay terminal 85. If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an
open or short circuit to the park/neutral position switch and repair, if required. If the circuit is OK,
see the Park/Neutral Position Switch/Neutral Safety Switch Test procedure. If not OK with a
manual transmission, repair the circuit to ground as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Left Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the door lock switch is moved to the LOCK position,
voltage is supplied on the P35 circuit to the bus bar located inside the right door switch, lock side.
Battery voltage is passed through the switch to the P33 circuit to the door motors. Grounding is
provided through the P34 circuit for all door motors back to the right door switch. The ground is
passed through the bus bar internal to the switch, UNLOCK side, to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit
connects to the left front switch to a bus bar, internal to the switch, and then to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit connects to its grounding point.
Left Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position, voltage is
supplied on the P36 circuit to the right door switch, unlock side. The battery voltage is passed
through the switch internal bus bar to the P34 circuit.
The P34 circuit then connects to the door motors on the unlock side. Grounding for the UNLOCK
function is provided by the P33 circuit.
The P33 circuit connects back to the right door switch, LOCK side, and passes through the internal
bus bar to the P35 circuit. The P35 circuit connects back to the left door switch, and passes
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to it's grounding point.
Right Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the switch is moved to the LOCK position, voltage is
supplied to the P33 circuit, and then to the door lock motors. The ground path is provided on the
P34 circuit back to the right door switch. The ground is passed through the switch internal bus bar
to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit connects to the left door switch and through to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit then connects to the grounding point at the left center instrument panel support.
Right Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position voltage
is supplied to the P34 circuit from the switch to the door UNLOCK side of the motors. The
grounding path is through the LOCK side of the motors, circuit P33, back to the switch. The ground
continues through the internal bus bar of the switch on circuit P35 to the left door switch. At the left
door switch, the ground passes through that switches internal bus bar to the Z8 grounding point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 345
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Door Lock Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the Door Lock Switch
Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct in the Lock and Unlock switch positions. If these
results are not obtained, replace the switch.
Wiring The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through
the body harness to switch. 1. Remove left side switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate
multiple terminal block on wiring harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a
ground terminal. Touch other test light lead to Red Wire terminal.
a. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional. b. If test light
does not come on, check fuse 3 in the fuse block or for a open circuit.
4. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 346
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove front door trim. 2. Disconnect wire connector. 3. Remove attaching screws. 4. Remove
the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Mirror Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power mirror switch has a right and left position. Moving the switch to either of these positions
changes the voltage path internal to the switch (i.e.. changes polarity at the motors).
When the switch is moved to the left position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P93 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a left door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P95 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door minor RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
When the switch is moved to the right position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P92 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a right door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P94 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door mirror RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 350
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Mirror Switch Test
Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position. 2. Disconnect wiring harness at switch
connector. 3. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown
in the Mirror Switch Test and RHD Power Fold Away Mirror
Switch Test.
4. If test results are not obtained as shown, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 351
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove switch mounting screws from back side of trim panel and
remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 356
Brake Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair
GENERAL INFORMATION
The master cylinder or brake fluid reservoir does not have to be removed from vehicle for
replacement of the brake fluid level sensor.
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
1. Remove wiring harness connector from brake fluid reservoir level sensor.
Brake Fluid Level Switch Retaining Tabs
2. Compress retaining tabs on end of brake fluid level switch.
Removing/Installing Fluid Reservoir Level Switch
3. While compressing retaining tabs, grasp opposite end of brake fluid level switch and pull it out of
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir. 4. Correctly align the replacement level switch with its
mounting hole in the brake fluid reservoir. Push switch into fluid reservoir until retaining tabs
are fully expanded on opposite side of fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 357
5. Install the wiring harness connector onto the brake fluid level switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Braking Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit L50 is an input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB). The L50 connects to cavity 13 of the
CAB connector. Circuit L50 is spliced in with the stop lamps and is used to provide the CAB with
information on when the brakes are being applied.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions
Wheel Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-10-99I
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: October, 1999
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1993-1997 Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 ABS Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96026
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revisions to the ABS test procedures for wheel speed sensors
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 365
39
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 366
43
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 367
45
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 368
47
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 369
51
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 370
55
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 371
57
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 372
59
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 373
63
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 374
67
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 375
69
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 376
71
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 377
173
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 378
177
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 379
179
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 380
181
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 381
187
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 382
191
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 383
193
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 384
195
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 385
201
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 386
205
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 387
207
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 388
209
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 389
256
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 390
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Rear
Clearance Minimum Clearance 0.014 in 0.016 in
Maximum Clearance 0.047 in 0.047 in
Runout 0.006 in 0.006 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 391
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service Precautions
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
There are four wheel speed sensors, one at each wheel. The sensors use a tone wheel to
determine wheel speed. Input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) is done on the following
circuits. All of these circuits are a twisted pair. B8 and B9 for the left front wheel (cavity 8 and cavity
9). B6 and B7 for the right front wheel (cavity 6 and cavity 7). B3 and B4 for the left rear wheel
(cavity 3 and cavity 4). B1 and B2 for the right rear wheel (cavity 1 and cavity 2).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 394
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensors and Tone Wheels
Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Drum Brakes
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Rear Disc Brakes
One Wheel Speed Sensor (WSS) is located at each wheel and sends a small AC signal to the
Controller Antilock Brake (CAB). This signal is generated by magnetic induction created when a
toothed sensor ring (tone wheel) passes the stationary magnetic Wheel Speed Sensor. The CAB
converts the AC signal generated at each wheel into a digital signal. If a wheel locking tendency is
detected by the CAB, it will then modulate hydraulic pressure via the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
to prevent the wheel(s) from locking.
The front Wheel Speed Sensor is attached to a boss in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is part
of the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear drum brake
applications is mounted to the rear brake support plate and the rear tone wheel is an integral part
of the rear wheel hub and bearing assembly. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear disc brake
applications is mounted to the rear disc brake adapter and the rear tone wheel is also an integral
part of the rearwheel hub and bearing assembly. The speed sensor air gap on both applications is
NOT adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 395
The four Wheel Speed Sensors are serviced individually. The front Tone Wheels are serviced as
an assembly with the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Tone Wheels are serviced as an
assembly with the rear hub and bearing assembly.
Correct ABS system operation is dependent on accurate wheel speed signals. The vehicle's
wheels and tires must all be the same size and type to generate accurate signals. Variations in
wheel and tire size can produce inaccurate wheel speed signals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 396
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CAREFUL INSPECTION
Carefully inspect tone wheel at the suspected faulty wheel speed sensor for missing, chipped or
broken teeth, this can cause erratic speed sensor signals. Tone wheels should show no evidence
of contact with the wheel speed sensors. If contact was made, determine cause and correct before
replacing the wheel speed sensor.
Excessive Runout - of the tonewheel can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Refer to
Tone-wheel Runout under Specification. Replace drive shaft assembly or rear hub/bearing
assembly if tonewheel runout exceeds the specification.
Inspect For Looseness - on their mounting surfaces. Tone wheels are pressed onto their mounting
surfaces and should not rotate independently from the mounting surface. Check the wheel speed
sensor head alignment to the tone wheel. Also check the gap between the speed sensor head and
the tone wheel to ensure it is at specification. See: Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Speed Sensor Cable To Wiring Herness Connection
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Attaching Bolt
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 399
4. Remove wheel speed sensor head to steering knuckle attaching bolt. 5. Carefully, remove
sensor head from steering knuckle. If the sensor has seized, due to corrosion, DO NOT USE
PLIERS ON SENSOR HEAD. Use
a hammer and a punch and tap edge of sensor ear, rocking the sensor side to side until free.
6. Remove the speed sensor cable assembly grommets from the retaining bracket. Remove speed
sensor cable routing clip from the frame of the
vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector to the vehicle wiring harness. 2. Install the
speed sensor cable assembly grommets into the retaining bracket. Install speed sensor cable
routing clip onto the frame of the vehicle. 3. Install wheel speed sensor to steering knuckle
attaching screw. Torque the attaching screw to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 4. Install the wheel and tire
assembly on vehicle. 5. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS
systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 400
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Speed Sensor Connection To Vehicle Wiring Harness
Speed Sensor Head Mounting And Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body. 4. Remove the
speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting bracket. Then
remove the speed sensor cable from the
routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
5. Remove bolt attaching the rear wheel speed sensor to the disc brake adapter. The remove bolt
attaching speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear
strut assembly.
6. Remove speed sensor head from the disc brake adapter. If the speed sensor head has seized in
the adapter, DO NOT USE PLIERS ON SENSOR
HEAD.
INSTALL
1. Install wheel speed sensor head into disc brake adapter. 2. Install wheel speed sensor attaching
bolt. Tighten the attaching bolt to a torque of 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 3. Install the brake flex hose and
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut bracket. 4. Install wheel speed sensor
cable into the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube. 5. Plug speed
sensor cable connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install clip attaching speed sensor cable
connector to vehicle body. 6. Install the tire and wheel assembly on vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the base and ABS systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 406
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 407
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 408
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Lamps and Indicators Cooling System/Temperature Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing > Page 411
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 412
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
There are two separate switch pods that operate the speed control system. The
steering-wheel/mounted switches use multiplexed circuits to provide inputs to the PCM for ON,
OFF RESUME/ACCELERATE, SET/COAST and CANCEL modes. Refer to the owner's manual for
more information on speed control switch functions and setting procedures.
When speed control is selected by depressing the ON switch, the PCM allows a set speed to be
stored in RAM for speed control. To store a set speed, depress the COAST/SET switch while the
vehicle is moving at a speed between 30 and 85 mph. In order for the speed control to engage, the
brakes cannot be applied, nor can the gear selector be indicating the transmission is in Park or
Neutral.
The speed control can be disengaged manually by: Stepping on the brake pedal
- Depressing the OFF switch
- Depressing the CANCEL switch.
The speed control can be disengaged also by any of the following conditions: An indication of Park or Neutral
- The VSS signal increases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the co-efficient of friction
between the road surface and tires is extremely low)
- An rpm increase without a VSS signal increase (indicates that the clutch has been disengaged)
- Excessive engine rpm (indicates that the transmission may be in a low gear)
- The VSS signal decreases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the vehicle may have
decelerated at an extremely high rate)
- If the actual speed is not within 20 mph of the set speed
The previous disengagement conditions are programmed for added safety.
Once the speed control has been disengaged, depressing the RES/ACCEL switch restores the
vehicle to the target speed that was stored in the PCM's RAM.
NOTE: Depressing the OFF switch will erase the set speed stored in the PCM's RAM.
If, while the speed control is engaged, the driver wishes to increase vehicle speed, the PCM is
programmed for an acceleration feature. With the RES/ ACCEL switch held closed, the vehicle
accelerates slowly to the desired speed. The new target speed is stored in the RAM when the
RES/ACCEL switch is released. The PCM also has a "tap-up" feature in which vehicle speed
increases at a rate of approximately 2 mph for each momentary switch activation of the
RES/ACCEL switch.
The PCM also provides a means to decelerate without disengaging speed control. To decelerate
from an existing recorded target speed, depress and hold the SET/COAST switch until the desired
speed is reached. Then release the switch. The ON and OFF switches operates two components:
the PCM's ON/OFF input, and the battery voltage to the brake switch, which powers the speed
control servo.
The individual switches cannot be repaired. If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 417
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection
The speed control switches mounted on the steering wheel contain five switches and four resistors.
The PCM sends 5 Volts through pin 41 to the speed control switches. The input on pin 41 is
responsible for identifying the following: Resume/Accelerate, Set/ Coast, On, Off and Cancel. This
is accomplished by multiplexing. Multiplexing allows the PCM to identify more than one signal from
a single wire. To accomplish this, the speed control switch uses resistors that cause different
voltage signals at pin 41.
The 5-Volt signal at pin 41 has no path to ground when no buttons are depressed, allowing the
PCM to recognize the open circuit. When the ON, OFF switch contacts are closed, the 5 Volt signal
is pulled through a 15400 ohm resistor to ground providing a voltage of 4.14 to 4.73 Volts at pin 41.
Once the PCM recognizes the ON signal, the PCM provides a battery voltage signal to the speed
control servo through pin 5 of the 80-way connector.
When the SET/COAST switch is depressed, a momentary contact closes a path to ground through
a 2,940 ohm resistor. This causes a voltage of approximately 1.99 to 3.20 Volts at pin 41, indicating
that the SET/COAST switch has been depressed. When the RES/ACCEL switch is depressed, a
momentary contact closes to ground through a 6,650 ohm resistor. The 5-volt signal then passes
through a higher resistance than that of the SET/COAST switch, causing the voltage to be
approximately 3.30 to 4.14 Volts. When the OFF switch is depressed, the contacts close directly to
ground, causing the 5-Volt signal to drop to 0 Volts. When the CANCEL is pressed the contact
closes to ground through a 920 ohm resister, causing voltage at pin 41 of 0.61 to 1.94 Volts.
Ohmmeter Check Of Switch
Speed Control Switch
1. Remove the ON, OFF speed control switch assembly and disconnect the two-way connector. 2.
Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the other Pin. The meter
should read no continuity. Press the OFF button,
the ohmmeter should read 0 to 0.5 ohms. Press the ON button, the ohmmeter should read 15,245
to 15,555 ohms. If the resistance does not fall within these values replace switch.
3. Remove the RESUME/SET/CANCEL speed control switch assembly and disconnect the
two-way connector. 4. Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the
other Pin. The meter should read no continuity Press the SET button,
the ohmmeter should read 2,910 to 2,970 ohms. Press the RESUME button, the ohmmeter should
read 6,580 to 6,720 ohms. Press the CANCEL button, the ohmmeter should read 900 to 920 ohms.
If the resistance values do not fall within these specification replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor Switch: Testing and Inspection
Heater A/C Blower Switch Test
1. Remove Heater A/C control module.
Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Blower Switch Test. 3. If the switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace Heater A/C Control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7
check the lamps, replace if necessary.
Heater Blower Switch Test
1. Remove heater control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 422
Heater Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Heater Blower Test. 3. If switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace heater control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7 check the
lamps, replace if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 423
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
The switch is not serviced, replace heater A/C control. Refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning/Control Assembly/service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Locations
Evaporator Probe Location
The evaporator probe is located in the Evaporator Case unit housing and placed in the evaporator
fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 429
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 430
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 431
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 432
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 433
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 434
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 435
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 436
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 437
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 438
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 439
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 440
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 441
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 442
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 443
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
444
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR PROBE
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the unit housing and placed in the evaporator fins. the probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature rises above freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator temperature
rises above freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a capillary tube. The
tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C unit housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
445
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area and vehicle must be between 16° C (60° F) and 32° C (90° F) when
testing the switch.
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC.
Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there
is no power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
- Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent.
7. If the clutch does not begin to cycle off between 2° C to 7° C (35° F to 45° F), verify that the
evaporator probe is fully installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and reset outlet temperature. If the evaporator
probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
446
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the
vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Evaporator Probe Location
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator blower module. 3. Note in which of the three pilot
holes the evaporator probe is located. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick and make a new hole. Make the hole 1/4 inch above or below the original
hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into evaporator
probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
The high pressure cut out switch is located in the compressor manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 451
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
HIGH PRESSURE CUT-OFF SWITCH
The High Pressure Cut-Off Switch turns off the compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240
kPa (470 psi).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 452
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: The refrigerant must be removed from the system before removing the high pressure
cut out switch.
REMOVAL
High Pressure Relief Valve
1. Disconnect wiring connector at the switch. 2. Remove internal snap ring. 3. Pull switch out of
manifold.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
The low pressure cut off switch is located on the expansion valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 456
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Low Pressure Cut Off Switch monitors the refrigerant gas pressure on the suction side of the
system.
OPERATION
It turns off voltage to the compressor clutch coil when refrigerant gas pressure drops to levels that
could damage the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 457
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area must not be below 21°C (70°F) to test the compressor clutch circuit.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the cycling clutch switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
low pressure cut off switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 458
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The low pressure cut out switch is a sealed factory calibrated unit. It must be replaced if defective.
WARNING: The refrigeration system must be completely recovered before proceeding with this
operation.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the boot like wire connector at the cut off switch.
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
2. Using a sender unit removal socket, remove the switch from the expansion valve.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Verity the 0-ring condition on the replacement switch.
For installation, reverse the above procedures. Evacuate and charge the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 468
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov >
96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov >
96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 474
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description > Page 479
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 482
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 483
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 484
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 485
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 486
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Backup Lamp Switch: Specifications
Mounting ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 491
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 494
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
NOTE: The back-up lamp switch is located on the top left front side of the transaxle case.
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist. 2. From bottom side of vehicle, remove wiring connector from switch. 3.
Unscrew switch from transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. To install, reverse removal procedure. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Confirm back-up lamps are functioning properly following installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service Precautions
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Switch Operation
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Switch Operation
The stop lamp switch controls operation of the vehicles stop lamps. Also, if the vehicle is equipped
with speed control, the stop lamp switch will deactivate speed control when the brake pedal is
depressed. The stop lamp switch controls operation of the right and left tail, stop and turn signal
lamp and Center High Mounted Stop Lamp CHMSL, by supplying battery current to these lamps.
The stop lamp switch controls the lamp operation by opening and closing the electrical circuit to the
stop lamps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Switch Operation > Page 500
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Vehicles equipped with the speed control option use a dual function stop lamp switch. The switch is
mounted in the same location as the conventional stop lamp switch, on the brake pedal mounting
bracket under the instrument panel. The PCM monitors the state of the dual function stop lamp
switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 501
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 21 Stop Lamp Switch
1. Remove the stop lamp switch, refer to Lighting and Horns/Brake Light Switch/Stop Switch
Removal/Installation. Disconnect connector from stop
lamp switch. Using an ohmmeter, switch continuity may be checked as follows:
2. With switch plunger released, there should be continuity between Pin 5 and Pin 6. 3. With switch
plunger depressed, there should be continuity:
- Between Pin 1 and Pin 2.
- Between Pin 3 and Pin 4.
4. If the above results are not obtained, the stop lamp switch is defective or out of adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 502
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
PROCEDURE
1. Remove stop lamp switch from its bracket by rotating it approximately 30° in a counter-clockwise
direction. 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch. 3. Hold stop lamp switch
firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of the stop lamp switch until
it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
4. Install the stop lamp switch into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake
pedal as far down as possible. Then while keeping
the brake pedal depressed, install the stop lamp switch into the bracket by aligning index key on
switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When switch is fully installed in the
square hole of the bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock the switch into the
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
5. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 6. Gently pull back on brake
pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger to ratchet backward to the
correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 503
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
REMOVE
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal while rotating stop lamp switch in a counter-clockwise
direction approximately 30°. 2. Pull the switch rearward and remove from its mounting bracket. 3.
Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch.
INSTALL
NOTE: Prior to installing stop lamp switch into bracket, the plunger must be moved to its fully
extended position using procedure in step Step 1.
1. Hold stop lamp switch firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of
the stop lamp switch until it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 3. Mount the stop lamp switch
into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake pedal as far down as possible.
Then install switch in
bracket by aligning index key on switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When
switch is fully installed in bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock switch into
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If too much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
4. Gently pull back on brake pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger
to ratchet backward to the correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 507
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 516
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov >
96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov >
96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 522
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires, connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of the switch to
battery voltage.
Fog Lamp Switch Test
Fog Lamp Switch Circuit
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in for fog lamp switch circuit. 4. Push
the fog lamp switch button. The test lamp and the LED indicator on the front of the switch should
illuminate. 5. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Front Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch and disconnect the connector at the center stack.
Front Fog Lamp Switch Circuit Diagram
2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin L7 to battery voltage, and connect Pin Z03 to ground. 3.
Push the fog lamp switch button. The LED indicator on the front of the switch should illuminate.
Check Pin L35 with a test lamp for battery
voltage.
4. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Rear Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of
the switch to battery voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 526
Rear Fog Lamp Switch Test
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in. 4. Push the fog lamp switch
button. The test lamp should illuminate, and the LED indicator on the front of the switch. 5. If either
the LED, or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the wire connector in the center stack, EUX left side and RHD right side. 2. Remove
the floor console and disconnect the two clips attaching the wire harness from the underside of the
floor console. 3. Remove the switch bezel from the floor console.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 529
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 530
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Rear Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove the assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable and isolate it or remove fuse 12 prior to removing the switch,
or wires may short to ground. 2. Open the glove box and push the glove box sides inward allowing
the door bumpers to clear and the box to tip forward. 3. Reach inside the opening and squeeze the
lamp/switch retainers until they are disengage. 4. Pull the switch/lamp rearward and remove it.
Replace the lamp. To replace the switch disconnect wire and replace the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 537
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
In OFF or Parking Lamp Position Circuit A3 originates in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and
supplies battery voltage for the headlamp switch. A 40 Amp fuse protects the A3 circuit. The
headlamp switch has an internal 24 Amp circuit breaker that connects circuit A3 to either the L2 or
L20 circuits, depending on switch position.
In the OFF and PARK positions the headlamp switch feeds the L20 circuit that connects to the
multi-function switch. Circuit L20 powers the high beam circuit when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function switch. when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the stalk, the multi-function switch connects the L20 circuit to the L3 circuit. The L3
circuit feeds the high beam of the headlamps.
In ON Position When the headlamp switch is in the ON position, it connects the A3 circuit from the
PDC to circuit L2. Circuit L2 connects to the multi-function switch and feeds the L4 circuit (for low
beam operation). The L4 circuit connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. Circuits L43 and L44
connect to the bus bar in fuse block and power the low beam headlamps. Circuit L43 supplies
voltage to the left headlamp. Circuit L44 supplies voltage to the right headlamp. Both the L43 and
L44 circuits have separate 10 Amp fuses located in fuse block. Fuse 17 protects circuit L43, and
fuse 18 protects circuit L44.
When the operator selects high beam operation with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function
switch, circuit L2 connects to the L3 circuit, Circuit L3 powers high beam operation.
On vehicles equipped with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) the L4 circuit is spliced to the RKE
module. The RKE module uses this circuit to flash the headlamps when the operator has activated
the PANIC mode with the key fob.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Leveling Switch
1. Remove the headlamp leveling switch from the instrument panel and disconnect the wire
harness connector from the switch. 2. If the L.E.D. is not illuminated, using a voltmeter, connect B+
lead to Pin 4 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the negative lead to Pin 3.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low beam position and ensure the instrument panel dimmer
switch is on day light driving position. If voltage is present, replace switch. If no voltage, connect
the ground lead to a good ground, if voltage, repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary, and if no
voltage.
3. Using a voltmeter, connect B+ lead to Pin 2 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the
negative lead to Pin 3. Turn ON the headlamp switch to
the low beam position. If battery voltage, go to Step 5. If not OK, go to Step 4.
4. Connect the ground lead to a good ground, if no voltage, refer to Wiring Diagrams and test
circuit back to headlamp switch. If battery voltage,
repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary
5. Turn headlamps OFF. Connect the wire harness connector to the headlamp leveling switch.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low. beam
position. Check voltage at Pin 5, while rotating the headlamp leveling switch knob through the four
positions. The voltage reading should change as the switch is rotated to each position. If the
voltage does not vary replace switch. If OK, test the headlamp leveling motors and/or circuit to the
motors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch > Page 543
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Switch Test
Headlamp Switch Test
1. Remove the headlamp switch. 2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals
of the switch as shown in the Headlamp Switch Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly
Headlamp Leveling Switch
2. Disengage the headlamp leveling switch bezel from instrument panel . 3. Pull the switch and
bezel rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export > Page 546
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlight Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the steering column cover and liner.
Headlamp Switch
2. Remove the three screws securing headlamp switch mounting plate to the instrument panel. 3.
Pull the headlamp switch and mounting plate rearward from the instrument panel opening. 4.
Disconnect both the nine way and the ground wiring connectors from the switch. 5. Remove the
switch knob by depressing the release button on the bottom on the switch and pulling out knob
from switch. 6. Snap headlamp switch bezel out of mounting plate to gain access to the mounting
plate retaining nut. 7. Remove the headlamp switch, mounting plate retaining nut and separate
switch from mounting plate.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
Horn Switch
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module. When
the Driver Airbag is pressed the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is carried
to the horn relay and the horn sounds. 1. The horn switch grounds to the airbag housing. 2. If horn
does not sound check for corrosion:
- Horn wire
- Horn switch ground connected to airbag metal housing
- Airbag to steering wheel
- Ensure horn wire is properly connected and insulator is in place on wire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 550
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center.
Power Distribution Center
2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power
distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch, should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4.
Test continuity at horn switch remove the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat
Belts/Air Bag Control Module/Replacement/Driver
Airbag Module.
Test Horn Switch Driver Airbag Module
5. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity. If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 551
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
The Horn Switch is part of the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/Air Bag
Control Module/Replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
> Page 557
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 560
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 561
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 566
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 569
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
570
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
571
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
572
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
573
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing > Page 576
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing > Page 577
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 580
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 581
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 585
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 586
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 587
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Lamps and Indicators Cooling System/Temperature Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 590
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 591
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 598
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 599
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 600
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 601
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 602
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Failure to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Failure to Start Test > Page 605
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement > Page 608
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit G4 provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) indicating fuel tank level. This
circuit connects to cavity 23 of the PCM connector.
The G4 circuit is also used for the fuel gauge located in the instrument cluster. For operation of fuel
gauge, See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Fuel Gauge/Description and
Operation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 613
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 616
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 617
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 618
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
619
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
620
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 624
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 625
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 626
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The intake air temperature sensor measures the temperature of the air as it enters the engine. The
sensor supplies one of the inputs the PCM uses to determine injector pulse-width.
CONSTRUCTION
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, located on the intake manifold, combines the MAP
and Intake Air Temperature (IAT) functions into one sensor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The intake air temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on
circuit K21. Circuit K21 connects to cavity 37 of the PCM connector.
From circuit K21 the intake air temperature sensor draws voltage from the PCM. The sensor is a
variable resistor As intake air temperature changes the resistance in the sensor changes causing a
change in current draw.
The PCM provides ground for the intake air temperature sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit
K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Helpful Information
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 629
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 630
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 634
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 635
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 636
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 639
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
640
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The MAP sensor puts out a low voltage signal (0.5 to 1.8 volts) at idle when the manifold vacuum is
high, and a higher voltage signal (3.9 to 4.8 volts) at open throttle when the manifold vacuum is
low.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications > Page 645
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 646
Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 647
IAT/Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 648
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
OPERATION
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sen son The MAP sensor function converts intake manifold
pressure into voltage. The PCM monitors the MAP sensor output voltage. As vacuum increases,
MAP sensor voltage decreases proportionately. Also, as vacuum decreases, MAP sensor voltage
increases proportionately.
During cranking, before the engine starts running, the PCM determines atmosphenc air pressure
from the MAP sensor voltage. While the engine operates, the PCM determines intake manifold
pressure from the MAP sensor voltage. Based on MAP sensor voltage and inputs from other
sensors, the PCM adjusts spark advance and the air/fuel mixture.
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (MAP/IAT) sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Manifold Absolute
Pressure (MAP) sensor. Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K1 delivers the MAP signal to the PCM. Circuit K1 connects to cavity 36 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the MAP sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 82 MAP Sensor Connector
CAUTION: When testing the MAP sensor, be sure that the harness wires are not damaged by the
test meter probes.
1. Test the MAP sensor output voltage at the MAP sensor connector between terminals 1 and 4
(Fig. 82). With the ignition switch ON and the engine
not running, output voltage should be 4 to 5 volts. The voltage should drop to 1.5 to 2.1 volts with a
hot, neutral idle speed condition. If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, go to step 3.
2. Test PCM terminal 36 for the same voltage described in the previous step to verify wire harness
condition. Repair as required. 3. Test the MAP sensor ground circuit at sensor connector terminal 1
and PCM terminal 43.
- If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, repair as required.
4. Test MAP sensor supply voltage between sensor connector terminals 3 and 1 with the key ON.
The voltage should be approximately 5 volts ±
0.5V). Five volts (± 0.5V) should also be at terminal 61 of the PCM. If OK, replace MAP sensor.
- If not OK, repair or replace the wire harness as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing > Page 651
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 652
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 653
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Upstream and Downstream
Heated Oxygen Sensors Torque = 28 Nm (20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up and Engine
Performance Checks/Firing Order/Specifications
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations > Page 659
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations > Page 660
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 661
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 662
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Engine, Cooling
and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up and Engine
Performance Checks/Firing Order/Specifications
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 663
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay. The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground path circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors.
The A142 circuit also splices to cavity 6 of the PCM. The input provided by circuit A142 at cavity 6
tells the PCM that the ASD relay energized.
Circuit K41 delivers the signal from the upstream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit K41
connects to cavity 30 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K141 delivers the signal from the down-stream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit
K141 connects to cavity 51 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides a ground for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensor signals
(circuit K41 and K141) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector
Circuit Z1 provides ground for the heater circuits in each sensor. Circuit Z1 terminates at the left
side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator, and
the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors. The PCM controls the ground circuit for
each of the components powered by circuit A142.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 666
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Test
NOTE: Use an ohmmeter to test the heating element of the oxygen sensors.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from each oxygen sensor.
- The white wires in the sensor connector are the power and ground circuits for the heater
elements.
2. Connect the ohmmeter test leads to terminals of the white wires in the heated oxygen sensor
connector.
- Replace the heated oxygen sensor if the resistance is not between 4 and 7 ohms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 19 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
NOTE: The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust pipe behind the catalytic
convertor (Fig. 19).
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig. 20 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent (Fig. 20).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream O2 Sensor > Page 669
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 18 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector. 3. Remove sensor using an oxygen
sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or equivalent (Fig. 18).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 670
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 675
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 676
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 677
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 678
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 683
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
684
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
685
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
686
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information > Page 689
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 690
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 691
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 695
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 696
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 2.2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 700
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 703
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 704
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 705
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 706
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 707
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 708
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 709
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 710
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 711
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 712
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 713
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 714
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 715
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 716
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 717
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 718
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> System Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed. Refer to the
Powertrain Management/Computer and Control Systems/Diagnostic Procedures for diagnosis and
testing of this component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> System Operation > Page 721
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor-PCM Input
Fig. 17 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Automatic Transmission
Fig. 18 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Manual Transmission
PURPOSE
The sensor input is used by the PCM to determine vehicle speed and distance traveled.
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor generates 8 pulses per sensor revolution. These signals, in conjunction
with a closed throttle signal from the throttle position sensor, indicate a closed throttle deceleration
to the PCM. Under deceleration conditions, the PCM adjusts the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor to
maintain a desired MAP value.
When the vehicle is stopped at idle, a closed throttle signal is received by the PCM (but a speed
sensor signal is not received). Under idle conditions, the PCM adjusts the IAC motor to maintain a
desired engine speed.
The vehicle speed sensor signal is also used to operate: Speedometer
- Speed control
- Daytime Running Lights (Canadian Vehicles only).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the Vehicle Speed Sensor
(VSS). The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit G7 from the VSS provides an input signal to the PCM. The G7 circuit connects to cavity 66
of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the VSS signal (circuit G7) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit G7 splices to the speedometer and odometer in the instrument cluster.
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 724
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 24 Vehicle Speed Sensor
Fig. 7 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Connector
Fig. 8 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Speedometer Pinion
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 725
NOTE: The vehicle speed sensor is located in the transmission extension housing (Fig. 24).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 2. Remove the sensor mounting bolt. 3. Lift the
sensor out of the transaxle extension housing. Ensure the 0-ring was removed with the sensor.
NOTE: The speed sensor gear meshes with a gear on the output shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. With 0-ring in place, install sensor and seat sensor by hand -- to ensure proper gear
engagement. 2. Install mounting bolt and torque bolt to 2.2 Nm (20 in lb). 3. Connect electrical
connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 731
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 732
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 733
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 734
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information > Page 737
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 738
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 739
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam
Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam
Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 745
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 748
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 749
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 750
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 751
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 752
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing > Page 755
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing > Page 756
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement > Page 759
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement > Page 760
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 767
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 768
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 769
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 770
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 771
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to
Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to
Start Test > Page 774
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor Replacement > Page 777
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 782
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 786
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 787
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 788
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page
791
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 792
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag - On/Off Switches
NUMBER: 08-025-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 23, 2001
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-037-99, DATED
NOVEMBER 12, 1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN
THE 1999 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-00004). ALL
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS,
PARTS, AND 2001 MODEL YEAR PROCEDURES.
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN DOES NOT APPLY TO DIAMLERCHRYSLER CANADA DEALERS.
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - **2001** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 - **2001** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - **2001** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - **2001** (DN) Durango
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
**2001** (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - **2001** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - **2001** (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
**2001** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 798
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
**2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe**
1997 - 2001** (TJ) Wrangler
1999 - **2001** (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - **2001** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
NOTE:
**SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR PACKAGES (AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL/PT/RS/TJ) REQUIRE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER (ORC) CONFIGURATION USING THE DRB III(R) AS
DETAILED IN EACH VEHICLE SPECIFIC PACKAGE.**
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated) and
a detailed instruction sheet. Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule,
consumers will be authorized for on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria.
Airbag on-off switches must not be installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA
authorization letter. For more information concerning the authorization process and/or the
authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. We encourage you
(dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so and has the
necessary NHTSA authorization.
NOTE:
FOR SOME 2000 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (AB/AN/AN84/DN/JA/NS) **AND SOME 2001
CARRYOVER APPLICATIONS (AB/BR/WJ/XJ)**, A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS
REQUIRED, P/N 05013528AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG
SWITCH KIT. THE NEW INSERT IS ORANGE, AND MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE
CUSTOMER IN PLACE OF THE YELLOW ONE, P/N 05013517AA, THAT WILL COME IN THE
AIRBAG KIT.
**FOR SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (WITH J1850 BUS,
AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL(PT/RS/TJ) A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS REQUIRED, P/N
05016025AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG SWITCH KIT. THE
NEW INSERT MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE CUSTOMER AFTER INSTALLATION.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 799
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 800
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 801
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 802
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 803
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have~
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available in the "Forms Folder" under "TSB/Recall" tab of MDS2 and printed on
your dealership letterhead. keep a copy for your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 804
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag System - ON-OFF Switch
Availibility
NO: 08-17-98 Rev. C
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-17-98 Rev. B DATED
SEPTEMBER 18, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL
MODELS HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS:
**1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan**
1995 - **1999** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
**1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon**
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 -**1999** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue**
1994 - **1999** (BR) Ram Pickup
**1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth**
1998 - **1999** (DN) Durango
**1995 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon**
1995 - **1999** (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **1999** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 -**1999** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - **1999** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/ Voyager
1995 - **1999** (PL) Neon
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
1997 - **1999** (TJ) Wrangler
1997 - **1999** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. Other applicable passenger vehicles will be announced as soon as the switches are
available. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated)
and a detailed instruction sheet.
Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule, consumers will be authorized for
on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria. Airbag on-off switches must not be
installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA authorization letter. For more information
concerning the authorization process and/or the authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
We encourage you (dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so
and has the necessary NHTSA authorization.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 805
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 806
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 808
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 809
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have.
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available on T.I.L. and printed on your dealership letterhead. Keep a copy for
your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 810
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The airbag control module (ACM) is an electronic module that monitors the airbag system for
proper operation, stores diagnostic trouble code (DTCs), controls the airbag warning lamp, and
contains the safing sensor and accelerometer that is responsible for airbag deployment. The ACM
is located on the floor pan between the gear shifter and the parking brake assembly. The ACM
provides diagnostic information (DTCs) to the technician through the DRB Ill via the CCD bus.
Some circuits are tested continuously; others are checked only under certain circumstances.
NOTE: The warning lamp is hardwired to the ACM and there are no external impact sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 818
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 821
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 822
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch pedal position switch functions as a safety interlock device. It prevents possible engine
cranking with the clutch engaged.
The clutch pedal position switch is wired in series between the starter relay coil and the ignition
switch.
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 826
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRICAL TEST
Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness from instrument panel wiring harness. Using an
ohmmeter, check for continuity between the two terminals in the connector on the switch harness.
There should be no continuity between the terminals when the switch is in its normal (fully
extended) position. When the switch is depressed more than 1.25 mm (0.050 inch), the ohmmeter
should show continuity (zero ohms).
If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch is defective, and must be replaced.
MECHANICAL TEST
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN NEUTRAL, turn the key to the start position. The vehicle
should not crank. If the vehicle cranks, the switch is defective (shorted out) and must be replaced.
If the vehicle does not crank proceed to the next step.
WARNING: Before performing this step, be sure that the area in front of the vehicle is clear of
obstructions and people. Vehicle may move when performing this test.
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN GEAR, turn the key to the start position and hold it there.
Slowly depress the clutch pedal and feel for any vehicle motion when the starter is energized. If
there is no motion the switch is working properly.
If motion is felt, check to see if the switch is making contact when the pedal is between 25 mm (1.0
inch) and 6 mm (0.25 inch) from the floor. If this condition is met, then the problem is either the
clutch or the self-adjusting cable. If this condition is not met, then the switch mounting tab on the
brake bracket is bent, and the brake bracket must be replaced.
If vehicle will not crank, even with clutch pedal pressed to the floor, refer to illustrated chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 827
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 828
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
NOTES:
^ The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
^ The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical harness to switch connector. 2. Depress wing tabs on switch and push
switch out of mounting bracket. Then slide wires through slot in bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide switch wires through slot in switch bracket. 2. Line up switch tab with slot in switch bracket
and push switch into position. Do not pull on the switch wires to seat switch into bracket, switch
damage may occur.
3. Attach switch wiring harness to vehicle wiring harness. 4. After installation, the switch must be
checked for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 833
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Neutral Safety Switch: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 837
Neutral Safety Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 838
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
> Page 845
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 846
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 847
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 848
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 854
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 855
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The rear window defogger switch is a control switch and timer relay integrated into a single panel
mounted assembly. Actuating the switch energizes the circuit which allows current to flow through
the grid lines. Upon initial actuation for approximately eight to ten minutes, or until either the switch
or ignition is turned off. An indicating lamp illuminates a lens inlaid in the control switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 860
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in- vehicle or bench tested. In vehicle testing is
accomplished in the following manner:
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Rear Window Defogger Switch-Export
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 3 and Pin 4.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 8 in fuse block and the 30 Amp maxi fuse in the
Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check wiring
circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch/relay module.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come on and remain on for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
6. To bench test relay:
a. Using a jumper wire connect a 12 volt batter supply, apply voltage to Pin 3 and 4. Ground Pin 2.
b. Follow the above procedures except Step 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Master Window Switch (Left Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q21 circuit. The Q21 circuit connects from the switch to the left front window motor.
Grounding is provided on circuit Q11 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q11 is
the feed and circuit Q21 is the ground.
Master Window Switch (Right Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q26 circuit. The Q26 circuit connects from the master switch to the right window switch. A
BUS bar internal to the right switch passes the voltage through the switch to circuit Q22. Circuit
Q22 connects from the switch to the right window motor. Grounding is provided on circuit Q12 from
the motor back to the right switch.
The ground is passed through the switch on a BUS bar to circuit Q16. Circuit Q16 then goes to the
master switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit attaches to
its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuits Q12
and Q16 are the feeds and circuits Q22 and Q26 are the grounds.
Right Window Switch Operation When the window switch is moved to the window DOWN position,
voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch to the Q22 circuit.
The Q22 circuit connects from the switch to the right front window motor. Grounding is provided on
circuit Q12 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Q16
circuit. The Q16 circuit connects from the right switch to the master switch. Ground is passed
through the master switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q12 is
the feed and circuit Q22 is the ground.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 40 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
- Check the 30 Amp circuit breaker located behind the fuse block.
- Check the ground at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 866
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch Test
Driver Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Passenger Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting, refer to the Window Switch Removal and Installation
procedures. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the test procedure, Driver Side or Passenger Side
Window Switch Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct. If the results are not obtained,
replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 867
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Switch Removal
1. Using a flat tool, insert tool in the slot on the bottom of the switch bezel. 2. Pry the bezel from the
door trim panel. 3. Disconnect wire connector from switch. 4. Remove switch by releasing the tabs
from bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch Test
To test the switch, first disconnect the switch wires from the body wiring in the steering column.
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch, as indicated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 872
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Upper Shroud Removal
1. Remove three screws holding steering column shroud and remove upper half of shroud. 2.
Remove mounting screw on switch and remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 882
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 883
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 889
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 890
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
NO: 02-04-97
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Front End Alignment Torque Specifications & Shock Adjustment Procedures On
Competition Package
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE SALES
CODE (ACR) SUSPENSION SALES CODE (SDK).
DISCUSSION:
The alignment on ACR equipped vehicles must be set to the preferred specifications provided in
the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) page 2-7. After each final
setting the nuts should then be torqued to 75 ft.lbs plus an additional 90 degree turn. It is important
that the proper torque be used to maintain the proper alignment. If the alignment is outside of
specifications, rapid and excessive tire wear will result.
Starting in 1997, Neon competition package (ACR) vehicles come equipped with adjustable strut
dampers on all four wheels. The struts are finely tuned to the ride and handling profile of the entire
suspension system. If the customer wishes to change the dampening force for special conditions
the dampening characteristics of the strut dampers are adjustable on the ACR equipped vehicles.
The knob for adjusting the strut can be found in a packet located in the glove compartment. The
adjustment procedures are as follows:
1. The top end of the adjusting rod has flats over which the adjusting knob will fit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment > Page 895
2. Install the knob over the top end of the front or rear damper and lock it into position by turning
counterclockwise slowly until the knob engages, (Illustration).
3. Turn the adjusting knob clockwise, if resistance is felt do not use force, as the damper is in an
unadjusted position. Reverse the adjustment slightly and try again. When the damper is in the full
clockwise position, this is the minimum (City Ride) position.
4. To adjust the dampening force, the adjusting knobs has to be turned in the direction of the arrow
for increased dampening and the opposite direction for decreased dampening.
NOTE:
BOTH THE LEFT AND RIGHT STRUT DAMPERS MUST BE ADJUSTED IDENTICALLY.
FAILURE TO DO SO COULD PRODUCE UNSTABLE HANDLING AND UNEVEN TIRE TREAD
WEAR.
5. The following is a description of the various settings and the adjustment procedure.
A. City Ride - To enjoy the most comfortable city ride, the struts should be left in the "minimum"
position as they are set from the assembly plant. To set to minimum the knob should be turned
completely clockwise.
B. Cross Country - The cross country setting will give the car a firmer handling characteristic, but
yet will still be very comfortable to drive. To set, turn the adjusting knob 1/2 turn counter clockwise
from the "minimum" position.
C. G.T./Aggressive Driving - This setting equates the car's handling to a cross-country grand
turismo car, offering increased cornering ability, improved road feel and precise directional stability
at higher speeds. To set turn the adjusting knob 1 turn counter clockwise from the "minimum"
position.
6. Remove the adjusting knob before closing the hood or trunk. The vehicle should not be driven
with the adjusting knob in place.
NOTE:
DURING INSPECTION/SERVICING A THIN FILM OF OIL AND DUST COLLECTION MAY BE
NOTICED ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE STRUT TUBE. THIS IS A NORMAL CONDITION WHICH
OCCURS DURING THE DAMPER INTERNAL SEAL "BREAK-IN" PERIOD AND DOES NOT
AFFECT THE PERFORMANCE OF THE STRUT AND DOES NOT INDICATE THE NEED FOR
STRUT REPLACEMENT. STRUT REPLACEMENT SHOULD ONLY OCCUR IF THE STRUT
LEAKAGE IS SUFFICIENT TO COVER THE ENTIRE STRUT DAMPER TUBE AND HAS
"DRIPPED" ONTO THE LOWER CONTROL ARM OR ONTO THE PAVEMENT DURING
OVERNIGHT PARKING.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-96D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision the front end alignment specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions >
Page 900
2-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
NO: 02-04-97
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Front End Alignment Torque Specifications & Shock Adjustment Procedures On
Competition Package
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE SALES
CODE (ACR) SUSPENSION SALES CODE (SDK).
DISCUSSION:
The alignment on ACR equipped vehicles must be set to the preferred specifications provided in
the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) page 2-7. After each final
setting the nuts should then be torqued to 75 ft.lbs plus an additional 90 degree turn. It is important
that the proper torque be used to maintain the proper alignment. If the alignment is outside of
specifications, rapid and excessive tire wear will result.
Starting in 1997, Neon competition package (ACR) vehicles come equipped with adjustable strut
dampers on all four wheels. The struts are finely tuned to the ride and handling profile of the entire
suspension system. If the customer wishes to change the dampening force for special conditions
the dampening characteristics of the strut dampers are adjustable on the ACR equipped vehicles.
The knob for adjusting the strut can be found in a packet located in the glove compartment. The
adjustment procedures are as follows:
1. The top end of the adjusting rod has flats over which the adjusting knob will fit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment > Page 906
2. Install the knob over the top end of the front or rear damper and lock it into position by turning
counterclockwise slowly until the knob engages, (Illustration).
3. Turn the adjusting knob clockwise, if resistance is felt do not use force, as the damper is in an
unadjusted position. Reverse the adjustment slightly and try again. When the damper is in the full
clockwise position, this is the minimum (City Ride) position.
4. To adjust the dampening force, the adjusting knobs has to be turned in the direction of the arrow
for increased dampening and the opposite direction for decreased dampening.
NOTE:
BOTH THE LEFT AND RIGHT STRUT DAMPERS MUST BE ADJUSTED IDENTICALLY.
FAILURE TO DO SO COULD PRODUCE UNSTABLE HANDLING AND UNEVEN TIRE TREAD
WEAR.
5. The following is a description of the various settings and the adjustment procedure.
A. City Ride - To enjoy the most comfortable city ride, the struts should be left in the "minimum"
position as they are set from the assembly plant. To set to minimum the knob should be turned
completely clockwise.
B. Cross Country - The cross country setting will give the car a firmer handling characteristic, but
yet will still be very comfortable to drive. To set, turn the adjusting knob 1/2 turn counter clockwise
from the "minimum" position.
C. G.T./Aggressive Driving - This setting equates the car's handling to a cross-country grand
turismo car, offering increased cornering ability, improved road feel and precise directional stability
at higher speeds. To set turn the adjusting knob 1 turn counter clockwise from the "minimum"
position.
6. Remove the adjusting knob before closing the hood or trunk. The vehicle should not be driven
with the adjusting knob in place.
NOTE:
DURING INSPECTION/SERVICING A THIN FILM OF OIL AND DUST COLLECTION MAY BE
NOTICED ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE STRUT TUBE. THIS IS A NORMAL CONDITION WHICH
OCCURS DURING THE DAMPER INTERNAL SEAL "BREAK-IN" PERIOD AND DOES NOT
AFFECT THE PERFORMANCE OF THE STRUT AND DOES NOT INDICATE THE NEED FOR
STRUT REPLACEMENT. STRUT REPLACEMENT SHOULD ONLY OCCUR IF THE STRUT
LEAKAGE IS SUFFICIENT TO COVER THE ENTIRE STRUT DAMPER TUBE AND HAS
"DRIPPED" ONTO THE LOWER CONTROL ARM OR ONTO THE PAVEMENT DURING
OVERNIGHT PARKING.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-96D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision the front end alignment specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions >
Page 911
2-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 912
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-09-99 Date: 990702
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 913
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 914
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part Technical Service Bulletin # 02-09-99 Date: 990702
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 915
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 916
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 917
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 918
Alignment: Specifications
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-96.
NOTE: All alignment specifications are taken at curb height.
FRONT:
Camber: Acceptable Range ................................................................................................................
........................................................................ -0.4° to +0.4° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 0.0° S/C ACR only [3] ...............................................................................................................
.......................................................................... -2.4° to +0.4°
Total Toe [1]: Acceptable Range .........................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.3° in to 0.1° out Preferred Setting ............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............ 0.1° in S/C ACR only [3] .........................................................................................................
................................................................... 0.30° In to 0.70° Out
Caster*: Acceptable Range .................................................................................................................
....................................................................... +1.8° to +3.8° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ +2.8°
* Side To Side Caster: Not To Exceed ................................................................................................
................................................................................................. 1.0° or less
REAR:
Camber: Acceptable Range ................................................................................................................
.................................................................... -0.75° to +0.25° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... -0.25° S/C ACR only [3] ...............................................................................................................
...................................................................... -1.00° to +0.25°
Total Toe [1] [2]: Acceptable Range ....................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 0.3° in to 0.1°out Preferred Setting .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 0.1° in S/C ACR only [3] ....................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.30° In to 0.50° Out
Thrust Angle ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................... -0.10° to +0.10°
[1]: Total toe is the arithmetic sum of the left and right wheel toe settings. Positive is toe-in,
negative is toe-out. Total toe must be equally split between each front wheel to ensure the steering
wheel is centered after setting toe. Left and right toe must be equal to within 0.02 degrees.
[2]: Toe-out when backed on to the alignment rack is toe in when driving.
[3]: The alignment specifications shown, are only for vehicles which are equipped with the ACR
(Competition Package) sales code. This specification is listed to show the adjustable range for the
Camber and Toe on the front and rear suspension of a vehicle with the Competition Package.
These alignment specifications are only to be used at the request of the vehicle owner and only
when the vehicle is going to be used in a competition event. The alignment is to be set back to the
preferred setting before the vehicle is returned to normal operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 919
Alignment: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify any suspension or steering components by heating or bending
of the component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 920
Alignment: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
Proper vehicle wheel alignment is the proper adjustment of all interrelated front and rear
suspension angles. These angles are what affects the handling and steering of the vehicle when it
is in motion. The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment will vary depending
on the type and manufacturer of the equipment being used. Instructions furnished by the
manufacturer of the equipment being used should always be followed to ensure accuracy of the
alignment, except alignment specifications recommended by Chrysler Corporation MUST ALWAYS
be used.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify any suspension or steering components by heating or bending
of the component.
ORDER OF ADJUSTMENTS
Wheel alignment adjustments should be made in the following sequence, to ensure that an
accurate alignment is performed.
1. Rear Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for both total toe and thrust angle. 2. Front
Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for total toe. 3. Toe is measured in degrees or inches
and is the distance that the front edges of the tires are closer (or farther apart) than the rear edges.
4. Thrust Angle is defined as the average of the Toe settings on each rear wheel. If this
measurement is out of specification, re-adjust rear wheel Toe
so that each wheel has 1/2 of the total Toe measurement. When re-adjusting, do not exceed the
total Toe specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 921
Alignment: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact damage, the steering
column to steering gear coupling must be inspected.
PRE-ALIGNMENT VEHICLE INSPECTION
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment factors, the following
inspection and necessary corrections must be made on those parts which influence the steering of
the vehicle. 1. Be sure the fuel tank is full when the wheel alignment specifications are checked
and or adjusted. A full tank of fuel weighs approximately 75
pounds, if the fuel tank is not full this reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the vehicle
and the alignment specifications.
2. Alignment specifications of a vehicle can be the most accurately checked and set when the
passenger compartment and trunk of the vehicle are
vacant with the exception of the spare tire. People, luggage, and any other appreciable weight will
adversely affect the checking and setting of the camber specification.
3. Check and if required, inflate all of the tires to the recommended air pressure. All tires must be of
the same size and in good condition and
have approximately the same tread wear. Note the type of tread wear on the tire, this will aid in
diagnosing problems.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for radial runout. 5. Before beginning the alignment
process, inspect all suspension component fasteners for looseness and/or loss of specified torque.
6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering linkage for looseness and any signs of wear
and or damage. 7. Inspect the tie rod ends for looseness and any signs of wear and or damage. 8.
Inspect the rubber bushings on all suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any
bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment Bolt Package Installation
1. If front and or rear camber readings obtained are not within the required specification range, a
Mopar (R) Service Kit is available to provide the
required adjustment. The kit contains new bolts and nuts for the strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle attachment. The bolts contained in the service kit, are slightly undersize allowing for
movement between the strut clevis bracket and steering knuckle. The movement allowed by the
undersize bolts will provide approximately 2 degrees of camber adjustment per side of vehicle. To
install new bolts in service kit follow the procedure below.
CAUTION: The Mopar (R) Service Kit for allowing adjustment of front and rear camber are different
for the front and rear of the vehicle. When using the service kits be sure that the front and rear strut
attaching bolts are always used in the right location on the vehicle.
2. Raise front and or rear of vehicle until tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle and rear knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated
and must not be turned during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering
knuckles.
3. Remove original upper bolt attaching the front or rear strut clevis bracket to the steering knuckle
or rear knuckle. 4. Loosen lower bolt attaching strut clevis bracket to steering knuckle or rear
knuckle ONLY enough to allow knuckle to move in clevis bracket. 5. Install bolt from service kit into
the upper strut clevis bracket to steering knuckle or rear knuckle mounting hole.
CAUTION: Only the nuts supplied in the service kits MUST be used with the service kit
replacement bolts. The original nuts will not properly secure the strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle or rear knuckle.
6. Install nut provided in service kit on the replacement bolt. 7. Tighten upper bolt and nut from
service kit until snug, but still allowing movement between strut clevis bracket and knuckle. 8.
Remove original lower bolt. Install bolt from service kit into the bottom hole of the strut clevis
bracket. Install nut and snug. 9. Lower vehicle until full weight of vehicle is supported by the
suspension and then jounce front and rear of vehicle an equal amount of times.
10. Adjust front and or rear camber to the preferred setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the
front or rear tire. When camber is correctly set
tighten upper and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce front and rear of vehicle an equal
amount of times and verify front and rear camber setting.
11. When vehicle is at correct camber setting torque both front strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an
additional 1/4 turn after required torque is met. Torque rear strut clevis bracket to rear knuckle
attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
12. If Toe readings obtained are not within the required specification range, adjust Toe to meet the
preferred specification setting. Toe is adjustable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 924
using the following Toe setting procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 925
Alignment: Service and Repair Checking Wheel Alignment Angles
GENERAL INFORMATION
Front and rear Caster and Camber settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is
designed, by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is called a Net Build vehicle
and results in no required adjustment of Caster and Camber after vehicle is built or when servicing
the suspension components. Thus Caster and Camber are not normally considered an adjustable
specification when performing an alignment on this vehicle. Though Caster and Camber are not
adjustable they must be checked to ensure they meet vehicle specifications.
If front and or rear camber is found not to meet the vehicle alignment specifications, it can be
adjusted using a Mopar (R) Service Kit developed to allow for camber adjustment. If a vehicle's
front or rear camber is found to be outside the specifications, the vehicles suspension components
should be inspected for any signs of damage on bending. This must be done before using the
Mopar (R) Service Kit for setting camber to meet required specification.
If a vehicles caster is not within manufacturers alignment specifications, check for damaged
suspension components or body parts. This type of damage can cause component locations to
move affecting vehicle alignment. No adjustment can be made for the Caster setting on this
vehicle.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicles Caster or Camber by heating, bending or any
other modification of the suspension components.
PROCEDURE
1. Correctly position vehicle on alignment rack and install all required equipment on vehicle, per the
alignment equipment manufacturers
specifications.
2. Center the steering wheel and lock in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: Prior to reading each alignment specification, jounce the front and rear of the vehicle an
equal number of times. Induce jounce (rear first then front) by grasping center of bumper and
jouncing each end of vehicle an equal number of times. Bumper should always be released when
vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Correctly jounce vehicle and read front and rear alignment settings and compare to vehicle
specifications for Camber, Caster and Toe. If front and
rear camber readings are within required specifications proceed to step Step 3 in the Front And
Rear Toe Setting procedure. If Camber readings are not within specifications refer to step Step 1 in
the camber adjustment bolt package installation procedure, for the front and rear Camber
adjustment procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 926
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Alignment
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact damage, the steering
column to steering gear coupling must be inspected.
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment factors, the following
inspection and necessary corrections must be made on those parts which influence the steering of
the vehicle. 1. Be sure the fuel tank is full when the wheel alignment specifications are checked
and or adjusted. A full tank of fuel weighs approximately 75
pounds, if the fuel tank is not full this reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the vehicle
and the alignment specifications.
2. Alignment specifications of a vehicle can be the most accurately checked and set when the
passenger compartment and trunk of the vehicle are
vacant with the exception of the spare tire. People, luggage, and any other appreciable weight will
adversely affect the checking and setting of the camber specification.
3. Check and if required, inflate all of the tires to the recommended air pressure. All tires must be of
the same size and in good condition and
have approximately the same tread wear. Note the type of tread wear on the tire, this will aid in
diagnosing problems.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for radial runout. 5. Before beginning the alignment
process, inspect all suspension component fasteners for looseness and/or loss of specified torque.
6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering linkage for looseness and any signs of wear
and or damage. 7. Inspect the tie rod ends for looseness and any signs of wear and or damage. 8.
Inspect the rubber bushings on all suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any
bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 927
Alignment: Service and Repair Front and Rear Toe Setting Procedure
1. Prepare vehicle as described in the Pre-Alignment Vehicle Inspection procedure. 2. Center
steering wheel and lock in place using a steering wheel clamp. 3. When performing the Toe setting
procedure, set rear wheel Toe to preferred specification first, then set front wheel Toe to the
preferred
specification.
4. Loosen nuts on attaching bolts, for the left and right rear lateral links to rear crossmember.
5. Rotate lateral link adjustment cams until the preferred rear Toe specification is obtained.
6. While holding Toe adjustment cams from turning, tighten left and right lateral links to rear
crossmember attaching bolt nuts. This will securely hold
adjustment cams in position. Then while holding lateral link attaching bolt and adjustment cam from
turning, torque nut of lateral link attaching bolt to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not twist front inner tie rod to steering gear rubber boots during front wheel Toe
adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 928
7. Loosen inner to outer tie rod end jam nuts. Grasp inner tie rods at serrations and rotate tie rods
to set the front wheel Toe to the preferred
specification.
8. Tighten tie rod locknuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 9. Adjust steering gear to tie rod boots at tie
rod.
10. Remove steering wheel clamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber Adjustment
Bolt Package Installation > Page 929
Alignment: Service and Repair Order of Adjustments
Wheel alignment adjustments should be made in the following sequence, to ensure that an
accurate alignment is performed.
1. Rear Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for both total toe and thrust angle. 2. Front
Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for total toe. 3. Toe is measured in degrees or inches
and is the distance that the front edges of the tires are closer (or farther apart) than the rear edges.
4. Thrust Angle is defined as the average of the Toe settings on each rear wheel. If this
measurement is out of specification, re-adjust rear wheel Toe
so that each wheel has 1/2 of the total Toe measurement. When re-adjusting, do not exceed the
total Toe specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Minimum Air Flow Idle Odometer <= 1,000 Miles ................................................................................
............................................................................................. 550 - 1,300 rpm Odometer >= 1,000
Miles ....................................................................................................................................................
......................... 600 - 1,300 rpm
Note: Idle speed range achieved through Minimum Air Flow Idle Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Page 938
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 31 PCV Vacuum Nipple
1. Turn ignition key off. 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold nipple (Fig. 31).
Cap the PCV vacuum nipple.
Fig. 32 Purge Hose
3. Disconnect purge hose from the nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 32).
Fig. 33 Orifice 6457 Attached To Purge Nipple
4. Use a piece of hose to attach Air Metering Orifice 6457 (0.125 in. orifice) or equivalent, to the
purge nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 33). 5. Ensure that all accessories are off. 6. Connect the
DRB or equivalent scan tool to the data link connector inside the passenger compartment. 7. Run
engine in Park or Neutral until the cooling fan has cycled on and off at least once (180°F). 8. Using
the DRB or equivalent scan tool, access Minimum Airflow Idle Speed. 9. The following will then
occur:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Page 939
- Idle air control motor will fully close
- Idle spark advance will become fixed
- PCM will go open loop enriched
- DRB or equivalent scan tool displays engine RPM
10. If idle RPM is within the range shown below, throttle body minimum airflow is set correctly.
Odometer Reading Idle RPM
Below 1,000 Miles 550 - 1,300 RPM
Above 1,000 Miles 600 - 1,300 RPM
11. If idle RPM is above specifications, use the DRB or equivalent scan tool to check idle air control
motor operation. If idle air control motor is OK,
replace throttle body. If idle air flow is below specification, shut off the engine and clean the throttle
body as follows: a. Remove the throttle body from engine.
WARNING: Clean throttle body in a well ventilated area. Wear rubber or butyl gloves, do not let
Mopar parts cleaner come in contact with eyes or skin. Avoid ingesting the cleaner. Wash
thoroughly after using cleaner.
b. While holding the throttle open, spray the entire throttle body bore and the manifold side of the
throttle plate with Mopar Parts Cleaner. Only
use Mopar Parts Cleaner to clean the throttle body.
c. Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom of throttle body bore and the edges and
manifold side of the throttle blade. The edges of the
throttle blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest to the throttle blade when is closed,
must be free of deposits.
d. Use compressed air to dry the throttle body. e. Inspect throttle body for foreign material. f.
Install throttle body on manifold.
g. Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow is still not within specifications, the problem is
not caused by the throttle body.
12. Shut off engine. 13. Remove Air Metering Orifice 6457 or equivalent. Install purge hose. 14.
Remove cap from PCV valve. Connect hose to PCV valve. 15. Remove DRB or equivalent scan
tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Fig. 104 Air Intake Duct
Fig. 105 Removal/Installation of Air Inlet Duct
NOTE: Neon vehicles do not use a heated air inlet system. The PCM adjusts fuel injector pulse
width and ignition timing to compensate for different ambient temperatures.
NOTE: The air cleaner attaches to a bracket on the rear of the cylinder head. An ambient air duct
supplies underhood air for the engine.
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake tube (Fig. 104) from air cleaner and intake manifold (Fig. 105).
Fig. 106 Removal/Installation Air Cleaner Front Housing and Element
2. Tighten clasps on top of air cleaner housing. Rotate front of housing forward then lift front away
from air cleaner housing (Fig 106). 3. Remove air cleaner element from front housing (Fig. 106).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 944
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element into front housing. 2. Rotate front of housing forward then lower into
place and locate tabs in slots.
- Fasten clasps on top of air cleaner housing.
- Install air intake duct at air cleaner and intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 949
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 960
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Plastic clips in various locations protect the cables from damage. When the cables are replaced the
clips must be used to prevent damage to the cables. The #1 cable must be routed under the PCV
hose and clipped to the #2 cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Ignition Cable: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 963
Ignition Cable: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Testing For Open Circuits, High Resistance and Loose Terminals
Use an ohmmeter to check cables for opens, loose terminals or high resistance as follows:
1. Remove cable from spark plug. 2. Remove cable from the coil tower. 3. Connect the ohmmeter
between the spark plug end terminal and the coil end terminal.
- Make sure ohmmeter probes are in good contact.
- Resistance should be within tolerance shown in the cable resistance chart.
- If resistance is not within tolerance, replace cable assembly. Test all spark plug cables in the
same manner.
- If no problems are found, SEE Ignition System/System Diagnosis/Testing For Spark At Coil.
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Testing For Punctures and Cracks
When testing cables for punctures and cracks with an oscilloscope and an inductive voltage probe,
follow the instructions of the equipment manufacturers.
CAUTION: Do not leave any one spark plug cable disconnected for more than 30 seconds during
test or possible heat damage to catalytic converter will occur.
If an oscilloscope and inductive probe are not available, cables can be tested as follows:
1. With the engine not running, connect one end of a test probe (i.e. a piece of wire with insulated
alligator clips on each end) to a good ground, other
end free for probing.
WARNING: The ignition system generates approximately 40,000 volts. Personal injury could result
from contact with this system.
2. With the engine running, move test probe along entire length of all cables (approximately 0 to 1/8
inch gap).
- If punctures or cracks are present there will be a noticeable spark jump from the faulty area to the
probe.
- Replace cracked, leaking or faulty cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Cleaning
Clean high tension cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning > Page 966
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Replacement
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: The cables insulate the spark plugs and cover the top of the spark plug tube (Fig. 3).
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
REMOVAL
1. Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Lightly grasp the top of the cable. 2. Rotate the insulator
1/2 turn and pull straight up in a steady motion. 3. To replace the cables, disconnect the cable from
the ignition coil.
INSTALLATION
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube.Then connect the other end to coil pack.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Electrode Gap ......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... (0.033-0.038 in) Torque ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm
(20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 970
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Plug Type ............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... RC9YC Thread Size ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
(14mm) 3/4 in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 971
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Resistor spark plugs are used in this engine.
Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes and fouled, cracked or broken
porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from the
engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended.
Faulty or fouled spark plugs may perform well at idle speed, but frequently fail at higher engine
speeds. Faulty plugs can be identified in a number of ways: poor fuel economy, power loss,
decrease in engine speed, hard starting and, in general, poor engine performance.
Spark plugs also malfunction because of carbon fouling, excessive electrode air gap, or a broken
insulator. SEE Powertrain Management/Ignition System/Testing and Inspection/Procedures, for
spark plug diagnosis.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 974
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 975
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 976
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 977
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 978
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Heavy Colored Deposits
DESCRIPTION:
Colored coatings heavily deposited on the portion of the plug projecting into the chamber and on
the side facing the intake valve.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Leaking Valve Seals (1 or 2 cylinders) - Check the valve seals. Replace if necessary. Clean, regap,
and reinstall
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Normal Operating Conditions
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
The few deposits present will be probably light tan or slightly gray in color with most grades of
commercial gasoline. There will not be evidence of electrode burning. Gap growth will not average
more than approximately 0.025 mm (0.001 in) per 1600 km (1000 miles) of operation for non
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 979
platinum spark plugs. Non-platinum spark plugs that have normal wear can usually be cleaned,
have the electrodes filed and regapped, and then reinstalled.
CAUTION: Never attempt to file the electrodes or use a wire brush for cleaning platinum spark
plugs. This would damage the platinum pads which would shorten spark plug life.
Some fuel refiners in several areas of the United States have introduced a manganese additive
(MMT) for unleaded fuel. During combustion, fuel with MMT may coat the entire tip of the spark
plug with a rust colored deposit. The rust color deposits can be misdiagnosed as being caused by
coolant in the combustion chamber. Spark plug performance may be affected by MMT deposits.
Oil or Ash Encrusted
OIL OR ASH ENCRUSTED
Oil Or Ash Encrusted
If one or more plugs are oil or ash encrusted, evaluate the engine for the cause of oil entering the
combustion chambers. Sometimes fuel additives can cause ash encrustation on an entire set of
spark plugs. Ash encrusted spark plugs can be cleaned and reused.
Premature Electrode Wear - Preignition Damage
PREIGNITION DAMAGE
Preignition Damage
Excessive combustion chamber temperature can cause preignition damage. First, the center
electrode dissolves and the ground electrode dissolves somewhat later. Insulators appear relatively
deposit free. Other possible causes include ignition timing over-advanced and incorrect spark plug
heat range.
Spark plugs are designed to operate within a specific temperature range, called spark plug heat
range. Variations in thickness and length of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 980
center electrode and porcelain insulator change how fast the plug can dissipate heat and determine
the plugs heat range.
Determine if the spark plugs are the correct type, as specified on the VECI label, or if other
operating conditions are causing engine overheating.
Red, Brown, Yellow or White Deposits - Fuel Additives
SCAVENGER DEPOSITS
Scavenger Deposits
Fuel scavenger deposits may be either white or yellow. They may appear to be harmful, but are a
normal condition caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. These additives are designed to
change the chemical nature of deposits and decrease spark plug misfire tendencies. Notice that
accumulation on the ground electrode and shell area may be heavy but the deposits are easily
removed using standard procedures. Spark plugs with scavenger deposits can be considered
normal in condition, cleaned and reused.
Shiny Yellow Glaze
COMBUSTION DEPOSITS
A shiny yellow glaze coating on the spark plug insulator is evidence of metallic by-products of fuel
combustion, caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. Avoid sudden acceleration with wide
open throttle after long periods of low speed driving. Spark plugs with combustion deposits can be
cleaned and reused.
Spark Plug Inspection
- Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes. Also check for fouled, cracked
or broken porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from
the engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended in the Maintenance
Schedules.
- Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned and reused if not otherwise defective -- SEE
Spark Plug Condition. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file. Adjust the gap between the electrodes to the specified dimension. The spark plug gap is 0.033
to0.038 in.
- Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion resulting
in a change in the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Wet Oily Deposits
FUEL FOULING
A spark plug that is coated with excessive wet fuel is called fuel fouled. This condition is normally
observed during hard start periods. Clean fuel fouled spark plugs with compressed air and reinstall
them in the engine.
White or Gray - Burned or Blistered Insulator
SPARK PLUG OVERHEATING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 981
Spark Plug Overheating
Overheating is indicated by a white or gray center electrode insulator that also appears blistered.
The increase in electrode gap will be considerably in excess of 0.001 in. per 1000 miles of
operation. This suggests that a plug with a cooler heat range rating should be used. Over
advanced ignition timing, detonation and cooling system malfunctions also can cause spark plug
overheating. Also check for lean air-fuel mixture. Check the torque value of the plugs to ensure
good plug-engine seat contact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 982
Spark Plug: Adjustments
Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Fig.2 Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Check the spark plug gap with a gap gauge. If the gap is not correct, adjust it by bending the
ground -- center electrode.
Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information (VECI) label, (under hood).
If label is gone, or not readable, verify system and use the following specification.
Plug Gap ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.033 to 0.038 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 983
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
CAUTION: Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of the spark plug insulator,
turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL
1. Remove the spark plug using a quality socket with a rubber or foam insert. 2. Inspect the spark
plug condition.
SPARK PLUG CLEANING
Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned using commercially available spark plug
cleaning equipment. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file before adjusting gap.
CAUTION: Never use a motorized wire wheel brush to clean the spark plugs. Metallic deposits will
remain on the spark plug insulator and will cause plug misfire.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap.
SPARK PLUG INSTALLATION
1. To avoid cross threading, start the spark plug into the cylinder head by hand. 2. Tighten spark
plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque. 3. Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of
the spark plug insulator covers the upper end of the spark plug tube. 4. Connect coil.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION PRESSURE (at 250 - 400 RPM):
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................ 1172 - 1551 kPa (170 - 225 psi) Minimum .............................................................
................................................................................................................................... 689 kPa (100
psi)
COMPRESSION PRESSURE DIFFERENCE OF ALL CYLINDER:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 25%
VACUUM:
Manifold ...............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 60 kPa (18 inches Hg)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 987
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
PROCEDURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Disconnect coil wire from distributor and secure to good ground to prevent a spark from starting
a fire (Conventional Ignition System). For
Direct Ignition System (DIS) disconnect the coil connector.
5 . Be sure throttle blade is fully open during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gage
adaptor into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Crank engine until maximum pressure is
reached on gage.
Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure.
7. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689
kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more
cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem
in the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a
guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the
cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
11. Clean or replace spark plugs as necessary and adjust gap. Tighten to specifications. 12. Test
resistance of spark plug cables. Perform secondary circuit inspection. 13. Test coil output voltage,
primary and secondary resistance. Replace parts as necessary. 14. Check fuel pump pressure at
idle and different RPM ranges. 15. The air filter elements should be replaced as specified. 16.
Inspect crankcase ventilation system. 17. Inspect and adjust accessory belt drives. 18. Road test
vehicle as a final test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates this engine is equipped with hydraulic lifters or lash adjusters and
therefore does not require adjustment.
See "Rocker Arm: Service and Repair" for further information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Service Replacement Interval Information Not Supplied by the Manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Camshaft or crankshaft should not be rotate after timing belt is removed. Damage to
valve components may occur. Always align timing marks before removing timing belt.
REMOVAL
1. Remove crankshaft damper bolt. 2. Remove engine mount bracket and timing belt cover
fasteners, remove cover. 3. Align camshaft timing marks. Loosen timing belt tensioner fasteners
and remove timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not loosen, tighten, or remove the tensioner pivot bolt.
INSTALLATION
1. When tensioner is removed from the engine it is necessary to compress the plunger into the
tensioner body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation > Page 996
2. Place the tensioner into a vise and slowly compress the plunger.
CAUTION: Index the tensioner in the vise the same way it is installed on the engine. This is to
ensure proper pin orientation when tensioner is installed on the engine.
3. When plunger is compressed into the tensioner body install a pin through the body and plunger
to retain plunger in place until tensioner is
installed.
4. Set crankshaft sprocket to Top Dead Center (TDC) by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on
the oil pump housing, then back off to 3 notches
before TDC.
5. Set camshafts timing marks together by aligning notches on sprockets.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation > Page 997
6. Rotate crankshaft 1/2 tooth counterclockwise from TDC.
7. Install timing belt in this direction. Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket,
idler pulley, camshaft sprockets and then around
the tensioner pulley.
8. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack. Install tensioner to Clock but do not
tighten fasteners. 9. Using a torque wrench on the tensioner pulley apply 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) of
torque to tensioner.
10. With torque being applied to the tensioner pulley move the tensioner up against the tensioner
pulley bracket and tighten fasteners to 31 Nm (275
inch lbs.).
11. Pull tensioner plunger pin. Pretension is correct when pin can be removed and installed freely.
12. Rotate crankshaft 2 revolutions and check the alignment of the timing marks. 13. Install front
half of timing cover. 14. Install engine mount bracket. 15. Install right engine mount. 16. Remove
jack from under engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation > Page 998
17. Install crankshaft damper using M12 1.75 x 150 mm bolt, washer, thrust bearing and nut from
Special Tool 6792. Install crankshaft damper bolt
and tighten to 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
18. Install accessory drive belts. 19. Raise vehicle on hoist and install right inner splash shield. 20.
After timing belt has been replaced, use a Diagnostic Readout Box (DRB), or equivalent select
adjustments and then relearn CMP/CKP, to relearn
camshaft and crankshaft timing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation > Page 999
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt
Removal and Installation > Page 1000
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets and Timing Procedure
With Cover Installed
1. Remove number one spark plug. 2. Using a dial indicator, set number one cylinder to Top Dead
Center (TDC) on the compression stroke.
3. Remove the timing belt access cover from the engine.
4. Check the timing marks on the camshaft sprockets, they should align with each other.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist > Page 1009
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist >
Page 1015
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1016
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1017
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
If the engine is equipped with power steering or air conditioning, it will have 2 drive belts. One belt
drives the generator, the other drives the Power Steering and Air Conditioning.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1018
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required, excessive wear, frayed
cords or severe glazing. Poly-V-Belt system with back drive pulley may develop minor cracks
across the ribbed side (due to reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and
acceptable. Cracks parallel are not.
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V-Belt and V-Belt
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment
Drive Belt: Adjustments A/C Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment >
Page 1021
Drive Belt: Adjustments Alternator Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment >
Page 1022
Drive Belt: Adjustments Power Steering Pump Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair A/C Belt
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C to remove and install belt
and/or adjust belt tension. 2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the
square D hole on the power steering pivot bracket. Adjust tension to
specification.
3. Tighten in order, first tighten locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Then pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt > Page
1025
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Alternator Belt
1. Loosen pivot bolt E then locking nut F and adjusting bolt G to remove and install belt and/or
adjust belt tension. 2. Tighten adjusting bolt G. Adjust belt tension to specification. 3. Tighten pivot
bolt E to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). Locking nut F to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt > Page
1026
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Belt
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C to remove and install belt
and/or adjust belt tension. 2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the
square D hole on the power steering pivot bracket. Adjust tension to
specification.
3. Tighten in order, first tighten locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Then pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1027
Belt Tension Gauge C-4162
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Fig. 104 Air Intake Duct
Fig. 105 Removal/Installation of Air Inlet Duct
NOTE: Neon vehicles do not use a heated air inlet system. The PCM adjusts fuel injector pulse
width and ignition timing to compensate for different ambient temperatures.
NOTE: The air cleaner attaches to a bracket on the rear of the cylinder head. An ambient air duct
supplies underhood air for the engine.
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake tube (Fig. 104) from air cleaner and intake manifold (Fig. 105).
Fig. 106 Removal/Installation Air Cleaner Front Housing and Element
2. Tighten clasps on top of air cleaner housing. Rotate front of housing forward then lift front away
from air cleaner housing (Fig 106). 3. Remove air cleaner element from front housing (Fig. 106).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 1033
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element into front housing. 2. Rotate front of housing forward then lower into
place and locate tabs in slots.
- Fasten clasps on top of air cleaner housing.
- Install air intake duct at air cleaner and intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Filter - A/T: Specifications
Mounting Screw ...................................................................................................................................
................................................... 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
Precautions > Page 1041
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Filter: Specifications
To Adapter ...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1045
Oil Filter: Description and Operation
All engines are equipped with a high quality full flow, disposable type oil filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1046
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When servicing the oil filter avoid deforming the filter, install tool band strap against the
seam at the base of the filter. The seam, joining the can to the base is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Turn counter clockwise to remove. 2. To install, lubricate new filter gasket. Check filter mounting
surface. The surface must be smooth, flat and free of debris or old pieces of rubber.
Screw filter on until gasket contacts base. Tighten to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Water Pump Inlet Tube <--> [Coolant Line/Hose] > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Water Pump Inlet Tube: Service and Repair
The inlet tube connects the water pump to the radiator and heater core. This tube is sealed by an
O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the block.
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use any sharp tools to remove hoses from inlet tube. This may cause the tube to
leak.
1. Drain cooling system. 2. Remove upper radiator hose to access the hose connections at the inlet
tube.
Figure 19
3. Remove lower radiator hose and heater hose from the inlet tube. 4. Remove the two fasteners
that hold the inlet tube to the block and one fastener that holds the intake manifold to inlet tube.
Figure 20
5. Rotate tube while removing the tube from the engine block.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube into the cylinder block. Replace O-ring
as necessary. 2. Lubricate O-ring with coolant and install inlet tube into the cylinder block opening.
3. Install two fasteners to the engine block and the one fastener to the intake manifold. Tighten
fasteners to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.). 4. Connect lower radiator hose and heater hose to inlet tube. 5.
Install upper radiator hose. 6. Fill cooling system. 7. Pressure system to 104 kPa (15 psi) to check
for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Heater Hose: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system. 2. Remove clamp at end of heater hose to be removed.
Heater Hose Quick Connect
3. ON Right Hand Drive (RHD) vehicles, heater hoses at the heater core connection have quick
connects. The quick connect consist of two pieces; a
quick connect and insert. The quick connect is removed by compressing the insert with a pliers,
and pulling the quick connect free of the insert/nipple. Carefully compressed insert pulling the quick
connect from connector nipple. The insert will remain on the connector nipple as the quick connect
is removed.
4. Remove the heater hose clamp from the heater hose at the block and remove hose.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The insert should be removed from the connector nipple and placed inside of the quick
connect before reassembly.
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation
DISCHARGE LINE
Discharge Line
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber 0-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
LIQUID LINE
Liquid/Suction Line
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the drier. It has no serviceable parts
except the rubber 0-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an
assembly.
SUCTION LINE
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/ drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber 0-rings on all other connections. There are no serviceable parts on the
suction line other than the rubber 0-rings and expansion valve gasket. If the line is found to be
leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1057
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
HANDLING TUBING AND FITTINGS
Kinks in the refrigerant tubing or sharp bends in the refrigerant hose lines will greatly reduce the
capacity of the entire system. High pressures are produced in the system when it is operating.
Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that all connections are pressure tight. Dirt and
moisture can enter the system when it is opened for repair or replacement of lines or components.
The refrigerant oil will absorb moisture readily out of the air. This moisture will convert to acids
within a closed system.
CAUTION: The system must be completely empty before opening any fitting or connection on the
refrigerant system. Open fittings with caution even after system has been emptied. If pressure is
noticed as a fitting is loosened, tighten fitting and evacuate system again.
BENDING FLEX HOSE
A good rule for the flexable hose lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times the
diameter of the hose. Sharper bends will reduce the flow of the refrigerant. The flexible hose lines
should be routed at least 3 inches away from exhaust manifolds. Inspect all flexible hose lines to
make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
CAUTION: The use of correct wrenches when making connections is very important. Improper
wrenches or the improper use of wrenches can damage the fittings.
INTERNAL DAMAGE
The internal parts of the A/C system will remain stable as long as moisture free refrigerant and
refrigerant oil is used. Abnormal amounts of dirt, moisture, or air can upset the chemical stability.
This may cause operational troubles or even serious damage if present in more than very small
quantities.
OPENING SYSTEM
When it is necessary to open the refrigeration system, have everything needed to service the
system ready. The system should not be left open any longer than necessary. Cap or Plug all lines
and fittings as soon as they are opened. This will prevent the entrance of dirt and moisture into the
system. All new lines and components should be capped or sealed until they are ready to be used.
CAUTION: All tools, including the refrigerant dispensing manifold, the manifold gauge set, and test
hoses should be kept dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Pressure and Return Line Tube Nuts
................................................................................................................................................... 31
Nm (275 inch lbs.) Pressure Hose Banjo Bolt .....................................................................................
.................................................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Routing Bracket ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
CAUTION: Care must be used when removing the power steering fluid supply hose from power
steering fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to remove hose from nipple on power
steering fluid reservoir, nipple can break off of the reservoir.
REMOVE
1. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering fluid supply hose to power steering fluid reservoir.
Then remove power steering fluid supply hose
from power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering fluid supply hose to the power steering pump.
Then remove power steering fluid supply hose from
power steering pump fitting.
3. Remove power steering fluid supply hose from engine.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering fluid supply hose back on engine making sure it is correctly routed.
CAUTION: Care must be used when installing power steering fluid supply hose on power steering
fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to install hose on nipple of power steering fluid
reservoir, nipple can be broken off the reservoir.
2. Install power steering fluid supply hose on power steering fluid reservoir fitting. Install hose
clamp on power steering fluid supply hose at power
steering fluid reservoir. Be sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on power
steering fluid reservoir.
3. Install power steering fluid supply hose on power steering pump fitting. Install hose clamp on
power steering fluid supply hose at power steering
pump fitting. Be sure hose clamp is installed on power steering fluid supply hose past upset bead
on power steering pump fitting.
4. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 5. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 6. Raise
front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 7. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and
left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 8. Add power steering fluid if
necessary. 9. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1063
10. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required. 11. If the fluid is extremely foamy,
allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 12. After hose is
installed, check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1064
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Pressure Hose
Removal
CAUTION: Cap all open ends of hoses, power steering pump fittings and steering gear ports to
prevent entry of foreign material into the components.
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Remove bolt attaching power steering hose routing bracket to front suspension crossmember.
3. Disconnect power steering pressure hose at power steering gear. Drain power steering fluid from
power steering pump and hose through open end of
hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1065
4. Remove power steering pressure hose from routing clip on generator shield. 5. Lower vehicle.
6. Remove bolt, attaching power steering pressure hose routing clip, to generator shield.
7. Loosen and remove Banjo bolt, and power steering pressure hose from pressure fitting on power
steering pump. 8. Power steering fluid pressure hose is removed from the vehicle from the top of
the engine compartment. 9. Discard all used O-rings located at ends of power steering pressure
hose and Banjo bolt.
Installation
1. Install power steering pressure hose in vehicle from top of engine compartment. 2. Using a lint
free towel, wipe clean all open power steering hose ends, and the power steering pump and
steering gear ports.
3. Install new O-ring on end of power steering pressure hose banjo fitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1066
4. Install a new O-ring on power steering pressure hose banjo fitting bolt. 5. Lubricate both O-rings
using fresh clean power steering fluid. 6. Install banjo bolt into the power steering pressure hose
banjo fitting.
7. Attach power steering pressure hose to outlet fitting on power steering pump. Do not tighten or
torque pressure fitting Banjo bolt at this time.
8. Correctly route power steering pressure hose avoiding tight bends or kinking of the hose. Install
power steering pressure hose to generator shield
routing clip attaching screw but do not tighten at this time.
9. Raise vehicle.
CAUTION: Hoses must remain away from exhaust system, vehicle components and unfriendly
surfaces causing possible damage to power steering hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1067
10. Route power steering pressure hose to pressure port on power steering gear. Install power
steering pressure hose, on steering gear and loosely
install tube nut into steering gear. Tighten and torque tube nut after routing bracket is installed,
correctly positioning hoses in vehicle.
11. Install the power steering pressure and return hose routing clip on hoses. Install bolt attaching
routing clip to front suspension crossmember.
Torque routing clip to front suspension crossmember attaching bolt to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
12. Torque power steering pressure hose to steering gear tube nut to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
13. Install power steering pressure hose in routing clip on generator shield. 14. Lower Vehicle. 15.
Position locating pin on power steering pressure hose banjo fitting so it is against power steering
pump mounting bracket. While holding locating
pin against power steering pump bracket, torque pump end Banjo bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
16. Securely tighten bolt attaching power steering pressure hose bracket to generator shield. 17.
Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 18. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 19.
Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 20. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel
right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 21. Add power steering
fluid if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1068
22. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 23. Stop the engine.
Check the fluid level and refill as required. 24. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to
stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 25. After hose is installed, check for leaks at
all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1069
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Return Hose
CAUTION: Cap all open ends of hoses, power steering pump fittings and steering gear ports to
prevent entry of foreign material into the components.
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Remove hose clamp, attaching return hose to steel tube at power steering gear. Let power
steering fluid, drain from return hose and power steering
fluid reservoir, until reservoir is empty.
3. Remove power steering return hose from routing clip on generator shield. 4. Lower vehicle.
5. Remove tube clip at generator shield attaching power steering fluid return hose to power
steering fluid pressure hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 1070
CAUTION: Care must be used when removing power steering fluid return hose from power
steering fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to remove hose from nipple on power
steering fluid reservoir, nipple can break off of the reservoir.
6. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering return hose to power steering fluid reservoir.
Then remove power steering return hose from power
steering fluid reservoir
7. Remove the power steering return hose from the vehicle. The power steering return hose is
removed from the top of the engine compartment.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering return hose on vehicle. Power steering return hose is installed from the top
of the vehicles engine compartment.
CAUTION: Care must be used when installing power steering fluid return hose on power steering
fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to install hose on nipple of power steering fluid
reservoir, nipple can be broken off the reservoir.
2. Install power steering return hose on power steering fluid reservoir fitting. Install hose clamp on
power steering return hose at power steering fluid
reservoir. Be sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on power steering fluid
reservoir.
3. Raise vehicle. 4. Clip power steering return hose and pressure hose together. 5. Install power
steering return hose on steel tube at power steering gear. Install hose clamp on power steering
return hose at power steering gear. Be
sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on steel tube at power gear.
6. Install power steering return hose on routing clip at generator shield. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Start
the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 9. Add fluid if necessary. Repeat
the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine.
10. Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 11. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering
wheel right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 12. Add power
steering fluid if necessary. 13. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to
lock. 14. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required. 15. If the fluid is extremely
foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 16. After hose is
installed, check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Radiator Hose > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Hose: Description and Operation
WARNING: IF VEHICLE HAS BEEN RUN RECENTLY, WAIT 15 MINUTES BEFORE WORKING
ON VEHICLE. RELIEVE PRESSURE BY PLACING A SHOP TOWEL OVER THE CAP AND
WITHOUT PUSHING DOWN ROTATE IT COUNTER-CLOCKWISE TO THE FIRST STOP.
ALLOW FLUIDS TO ESCAPE THROUGH THE OVERFLOW TUBE AND WHEN THE SYSTEM
STOPS PUSHING OUT COOLANT AND STEAM AND THE PRESSURE DROPS CONTINUE
SERVICE.
CAUTION:
- Constant tension hose clamps are used on most cooling system hoses. When removing or
installing, use only tools designed for servicing this type of clamp. Always wear safety glasses
when servicing constant tension clamps.
- A number or letter is stamped into the tongue of constant tension clamps. If replacement is
necessary, use only a original equipment clamp with matching number or letter.
HOSES
Radiator hoses should be routed without any kinks and indexed as designed. The use of molded
hoses is recommended. A hardened, cracked, swollen or restricted hose should be replaced. Do
not damage radiator inlet and outlet when loosening hoses.
CLAMPS
Spring type hose clamps are used in all applications. If replacement is necessary replace with the
original Mopar equipment spring type clamp. The hose clamps are removed by using Special Tool
6094, or equivalent constant tension clamp pliers to compress hose clamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Specification ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. DOT 3
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE J1703
NOTE: The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1078
Brake Fluid: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in
the brake system will result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1079
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION:
The hydraulic fluid used in automotive brake systems is hygroscopic. This means that the hydraulic
fluid tends to absorb moisture from the atmosphere over periods of time. As hydraulic brake fluid
absorbs moisture, it effects the function of the vehicles hydraulic brake system. For this reason, the
vehicle's hydraulic brake fluid should be drained and replaced using fresh clean hydraulic brake
fluid every two years. When replacing hydraulic brake fluid, use only Mopar brake fluid or an
equivalent from a sealed container. Brake fluid must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid. This
includes the master cylinder, proportioning valves, caliper seals, wheel cylinder seals, ABS
hydraulic control unit (HCU), and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1080
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
Master Cylinder Fluid Level
CAUTION:Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use
petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in the brake system will result.
Check master cylinder reservoir brake fluid level a minimum of twice a year. Master cylinder
reservoirs are marked with the words FULL AND MIN indicating proper range of the master
cylinder fluid level. If necessary, add specified brake fluid bringing level to the FULL mark on the
side of the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Clutch Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................ DOT3 Brake Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Engine - Coolant Recommendations
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Coolant Recommendations
NO: 07-03-97
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: May 9, 1997
SUBJECT: Engine Coolant Usage
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-05-93 DATED NOV. 26,
1993 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND MARKED IN THE 1993
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN BOOK (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-94000). THE COMPLETE
BULLETIN IS REVISED.
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Pickup/Ram Cab & Chassis/Ramcharger/
Power Ram/Power Ram Cab & Chassis
1989 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/LeBaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron Convertible
1989 - 1997 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1989 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati TC
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 1997 (BR) Ram Truck
1993 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1989 - 1992 (MJ) Comanche
1996 - 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1992 - 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
1997 (TJ) Wrangler
1989 - 1997 (XJ) Cherokee
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1993 - 1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
DISCUSSION:
Some owners have expressed interest in using engine coolants made with propylene glycol instead
of ethylene glycol due to its lower toxicity and resultant reduced hazards to children and animals.
Based on recent test data, most owners should not experience significant effects on cooling system
performance when using propylene glycol based coolant. The use of national brand propylene
glycol based engine coolant that meets the same Chrysler ethylene glycol specification of MS-7170
(or equivalent ASTM D5216) is acceptable for Chrysler built vehicles.
NOTE:
ANTIFREEZE SOLD FOR PROTECTING PLUMBING ETC. (RV ANTIFREEZE) IS NOT A
SUITABLE ENGINE COOLANT.
However, owners should be discouraged from changing their engine coolant prior to the regularly
scheduled maintenance period. Prematurely changing engine coolant unnecessarily adds to the
risk of environmental exposure.
Sufficient freeze protection for the region should be maintained. However, do not use more than a
55% solution (-35 F, -37 C). Use the chart that accompanies the propylene glycol coolant, since a
higher concentration is required to obtain the same freeze points as ethylene glycol coolant. If the
temperatures for your region fall below this, use ethylene glycol coolant.
Under severe driving conditions (towing a trailer in hot weather etc.) there may be a slight loss in
cooling performance. If this is noticed, the system should be changed back to ethylene glycol
coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Engine - Coolant Recommendations > Page 1088
The two types of coolant should not be mixed. The standard testers for measuring freeze protection
will not provide an accurate reading when this occurs. If the cooling system is changed to
propylene glycol, all the ethylene glycol coolant should be removed using an approved cooling
system flush procedure. The freeze protection of propylene glycol cannot be measured with a
standard cooling system hydrometer. A refractometer or hydrometer calibrated for propylene glycol
is the preferred test tool.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Cooling System Capacity ....................................................................................................................
............................................................. 7.0L (7.4 qts)
NOTE: Capacity includes heater and coolant reserve system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1091
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
GENERAL INFORMATION
Performance is measurable. For heat transfer pure water absorbs 1 btu for each degree of
temperature rise for each pound of water. This formula is altered when necessary additives to
control boiling, freezing, and corrosion are added as follows: Pure Water (1 btu) boils at 100°C (212°F) and freezes at 0°C (32°F).
- 100 Percent ethylene glycol (0.7 btu) can cause an engine to run hot, cause detonation, and will
freeze at -22°C (-8°F).
- 50/50 Ethylene Glycol and Distilled Water (0.82 btu) is the recommended combination that
provides a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F). The radiator, water pump, engine water jacket, radiator
pressure cap, thermostat, temperature gauge, coolant sensor and heater are all designed for 50/50
ethylene glycol.
- Where required, a 56 percent glycol and 44 percent water mixture will provide a freeze point of
-46°C ( -50°F ).
NOTE: Richer mixtures cannot be measured with field equipment and can lead to problems
associated with 100 percent glycol. If there is doubt that the coolant mixture is to rich for field
equipment to measure, put a sample in a clean container. Add exactly the same amount of water
and retest. If the coolant in the vehicle is 100% antifreeze, the diluted sample will read 50%. If the
coolant in the vehicle was 70% antifreeze and 30% water, the diluted sample will read as 35%, etc.
SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, intake manifolds, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze or their equivalent are recommended for best engine cooling without
corrosion. When mixed only to a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F) to -59°C (-50°F). If it looses color or
becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed solution.
CAUTION: Do not use well water, or suspected water supply in cooling system. A 50/50 ethylene
glycol and distilled water mix is recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Information
Coolant: Description and Operation General Information
GENERAL INFORMATION
The cooling system is designed around the coolant.
PICKING UP HEAT
The coolant must accept heat from engine metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust
valves.
GIVING OFF HEAT
Then carry this heat to the radiator where the tube/fin assemblies of these components can give off
the heat to the air.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Information > Page 1094
Coolant: Description and Operation Coolant Performance
GENERAL INFORMATION
Performance is measurable. For heat transfer pure water absorbs 1 btu for each degree of
temperature rise for each pound of water. This formula is altered when necessary additives to
control boiling, freezing, and corrosion are added as follows: Pure Water (1 btu) boils at 100°C (212°F) and freezes at 0°C (32°F).
- 100 Percent ethylene glycol (0.7 btu) can cause an engine to run hot, cause detonation, and will
freeze at -22°C (-8°F).
- 50/50 Ethylene Glycol and Distilled Water (0.82 btu) is the recommended combination that
provides a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F). The radiator, water pump, engine water jacket, radiator
pressure cap, thermostat, temperature gauge, coolant sensor and heater are all designed for 50/50
ethylene glycol.
- Where required, a 56 percent glycol and 44 percent water mixture will provide a freeze point of
-46°C ( -50°F ).
NOTE: Richer mixtures cannot be measured with field equipment and can lead to problems
associated with 100 percent glycol. If there is doubt that the coolant mixture is to rich for field
equipment to measure, put a sample in a clean container. Add exactly the same amount of water
and retest. If the coolant in the vehicle is 100% antifreeze, the diluted sample will read 50%. If the
coolant in the vehicle was 70% antifreeze and 30% water, the diluted sample will read as 35%, etc.
SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, intake manifolds, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze or their equivalent are recommended for best engine cooling without
corrosion. When mixed only to a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F) to -59°C (-50°F). If it looses color or
becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed solution.
CAUTION: Do not use well water, or suspected water supply in cooling system. A 50/50 ethylene
glycol and distilled water mix is recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1095
Coolant: Service and Repair
Refer to Cooling System, Service and Repair for applicable service procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1100
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1101
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1102
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF+4 Fluid Usage/Applications
NUMBER: 21-010-06
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: April 14, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-004-04, DATED MARCH
16, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1103
2007 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - 2007 (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to AW-4 transmissions, Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire
transmissions, MK/PM vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) and WG
vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a W5J400 or NAG1 transmission
(sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE NOTED ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4 can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4(R) is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1104
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Service Fill ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 3.7L (4.0 Qt) Overhaul with torque converter empty
..............................................................................................................................................................
8.1L (8.6 Qt) Overhaul with torque converter empty (fleet vehicles)
..................................................................................................................................... 8.7L (9.2 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1107
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type Type ............................................................................................................
....................................................... MOPAR ATF +4 Type 9602 or Equivalent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
............................................. 1.9-2.2L (4.0-4.6 Pints)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1112
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid
MOPAR type M.S. 9417 Manual Transaxle Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter Change ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.2L (4.5 Qt)
Capacity shown is without filter. When replacing filter, additional oil may be needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1117
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification
..............................................................................................................................................................
SJ ECII or SJ/CD ECII or Above Above -10°F (-23°C).........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 10W-30 Below 100°F
(38°C)...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 5W-30
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1118
Engine Oil: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use non-detergent or straight mineral oil when adding or changing crankcase
lubricant. Engine failure can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1119
Engine Oil: Description and Operation
CAUTION: Do not use non-detergent or straight mineral oil when adding or changing crankcase
lubricant. Engine failure can result.
API SERVICE GRADE CERTIFIED
Use an engine oil that is API Service Grade Certified or an oil that conforms to the API Service
Grade SH or SH/CD.
SAE VISCOSITY
An SAE viscosity grade is used to specify the viscosity of engine oil. SAE 30 specifies a single
viscosity engine oil. Engine oils also have multiple viscosities. These are specified with a dual SAE
viscosity grade which indicates the cold-to-hot temperature viscosity range. Select an engine oil
that is best suited to your particular temperature range and variation.
ENERGY CONSERVING OIL
An Energy Conserving type oil is recommended for gasoline engines. They are designated as
either ENERGY CONSERVING or ENERGY CONSERVING II.
CONTAINER IDENTIFICATION
Standard engine oil identification notations have been adopted to aid in the proper selection of
engine oil. The identifying notations are located on the label of engine oil plastic bottles and the top
of engine oil cans.
ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES
In some instances, such as infrequent operation, short trip driving, and during break-in after a
major overhaul, addition of special materials containing anti-rust and anti-scuff additives are
beneficial.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1120
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
The best time to check engine oil level is after it has sat overnight, or if the engine has been
running, allow the engine to be shut off for at least 5 minutes before checking oil level.
NOTE: Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil
level reading. Add only when the level is at or below the ADD mark.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1121
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
CHANGING ENGINE OIL
Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 1. Position the vehicle on a level surface
and turn engine off. 2. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. Refer. to Hoisting and Jacking
Recommendations. 3. Remove oil fill cap. 4. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain. 5.
Remove drain plug from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug threads for
stretching or other damage. Replace drain
plug and gasket if damaged.
6. Install drain plug in crankcase. 7. Lower vehicle and fill crankcase with specified type and
amount of engine oil. 8. Install oil fill cap. 9. Start engine and inspect for leaks.
10. Stop engine and inspect oil level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Fluid: Customer Interest Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures > Page 1130
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering
Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering
Fluid Usage > Page 1136
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering
Fluid Usage > Page 1137
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering
Fluid Usage > Page 1138
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise
in Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Steering System - Noise in Cold
Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise
in Cold Temperatures > Page 1143
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid
Usage
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid
Usage > Page 1149
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid
Usage > Page 1150
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid
Usage > Page 1151
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1152
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving parts. Do
not use automatic transmission fluid in the power steering system. Do not overfill the power
steering system.
Wipe reservoir filler cap free of dirt. Then check fluid level. The dipstick should indicate COLD
when fluid is at normal ambient temperature, approximately 21°C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F). In all pumps
add fluid as necessary, use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent. DO NOT USE
ANY TYPE OF AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1153
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving parts. Do
not use automatic transmission fluid in the power steering system. Do not overfill the power
steering system.
Wipe reservoir filler cap free of dirt. Then check fluid level. The dipstick should indicate COLD
when fluid is at normal ambient temperature, approximately 21°C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F). In all pumps
add fluid as necessary, use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent. DO NOT USE
ANY TYPE OF AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
R134a Capacity ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.78 kg (28 oz. or 1.57 lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1158
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydrofluorocarbon (HFC), ...................................................................................................................
............................................... R-134a liquefied gas
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Total System ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 200 ml 6.75 oz.
Condenser ...........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 30 ml 1.0 oz.
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 59 ml 2.0 oz. Filter-Drier ......................................................
................................................................................................................................................... 30 ml
1.0 oz.
A/C Lines .............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 44 ml 1.5 oz.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1163
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Synthetic-based, Polyalkylene Glycol ..................................................................................................
.......................................................................... ND-8
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1164
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
It is important to have the correct amount of oil in the A/C system to ensure proper lubrication of the
compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the compressor. Too much oil will reduce the
cooling capacity of the system and consequently result in higher discharge air temperatures.
NOTE: The oil used in the compressor is ND8 PAG R-134a refrigerant oil. Only refrigerant oil of the
same type should be used to service the system. Do not use any other oil. The oil container should
be kept tightly capped until it is ready for use. Tightly cap afterwards to prevent contamination from
dirt and moisture. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with. Special
effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free. Moisture in the oil is very
difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the compressor.
It will not be necessary to check oil level in the compressor or to add oil unless there has been an
oil loss. Oil loss at a leak point will be evident by the presence of a wet, shiny surface around the
leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake
System Bleeding Procedures
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures
GENERAL INFORMATION
The base brake system must be bled anytime air is permitted to enter the hydraulic system, due to
disconnection of brake lines, hoses or components. The Antilock Brake System (ABS), particularly
the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU), should only be bled when the HCU is. replaced or removed from
the vehicle, or if there is reason to believe the HCU has ingested air. Under most circumstances
that would require brake bleeding, only the base brake system needs to be bled. It is important to
note that excessive air in the brake system will cause a soft or spongy feeling brake pedal.
During Bleeding Operations - be sure that the brake fluid level remains close to the FULL level in
the reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add DOT 3 brake
fluid as required. The Bendix ABX-4 Brake System must be bled as two independent braking
systems. The non ABS portion of the brake system is to be bled the same as any non ABS system.
Refer to Brakes Service and Repair for the proper bleeding procedure to be used. This brake
system can be either pressure bled or manually bled. The ABS portion of brake system MUST be
bled separately. This bleeding procedure requires the use of the DRB scan tool and the bleeding
sequence procedure outlined below.
ABS BLEEDING PROCEDURE
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence MUST be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding. The ABS system can be bled using a Manual bleeding procedure
or standard Pressure Bleeding Equipment. If the brake system is to be bled using pressure
bleeding equipment, refer to Brakes Service and Repair.
1. Assemble and install all brake system components on vehicle making sure all hydraulic fluid
lines are installed and properly torqued.
ABS System Diagnostic Connector
2. Connect the DRB scan tool to the diagnostics connector. The diagnostics connector is located
under the steering column cover, directly below the steering column.
3. Using the DRB scan tool, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, remove them using the DRB scan tool.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE. BRAKE FLUID AT
HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure as
outlined in Brakes Service and Repair.
5. Using the DRB scan tool, go to the "Bleed ABS" routine. Apply the brake pedal firmly and initiate
the "Bleed ABS" cycle one time. Release the brake pedal.
6. Bleed the base brake system again, as in step Step 4 above.
7. Repeat steps Step 5 and Step 6 above until brake fluid flows clear and free of bubbles. Check
brake fluid level in reservoir periodically to prevent reservoir from running low on brake fluid.
8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure brake are operating correctly and that pedal is solid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake
System Bleeding Procedures > Page 1169
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure Bleeding (Preferred Procedure)
Air Trapped In Brake System
Method For Purging Air From Brake System
Bleeder Screw
CAUTION:
- Before removing the Master Cylinder cover, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder.
- Use bleeder tank Special Tool C-3496-B, or equivalent with required adapter for the master
cylinder reservoir to pressurize the hydraulic system for bleeding.
NOTE:
- For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Hydraulic Control Unit.
- Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding equipment.
PROCEDURE
When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines or valves far
upstream, as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake
System Bleeding Procedures > Page 1170
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out. The following wheel sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic
system should be used to ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
^ Left rear wheel
^ Right front wheel
^ Right rear wheel
^ Left front wheel
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw starting at the right rear wheel and feed the hose
into a clear jar containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
2. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain an steady stream of brake fluid.
3. After 4 to 8 ounces of fluid has been bled through the brake and an air-free flow is maintained in
the clear plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
4. Repeat the procedure at all the other remaining bleeder screws. Then check the pedal for travel.
If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, enough fluid has not passed through the
system to expel all the trapped air. Be sure to monitor the fluid level in the pressure bleeder. It must
stay at the proper level so air will not be allowed to reenter the brake system through the master
cylinder reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Air Bag Disarming > Page 1175
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations
Fuse: Locations
Fuse Locations
Fuse Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1184
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1185
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1186
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1187
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1188
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1189
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1190
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1191
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1192
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1193
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1194
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1195
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1196
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1197
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1198
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1199
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1200
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 2)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1201
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1202
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1203
Fuse Block (Part 3 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1204
Fuse Block (Part 4 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1205
Fuse Block (Part 5 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1206
Fuse Block (Part 6 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1207
Fuse Block (Part 7 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1208
Fuse Block (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1209
Fuse Block (Part 9 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1210
Fuse Block (Part 10 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1211
Fuse Block (Part 11 Of 11)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Service Engine Soon lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is in the ON position and prior
to starting the vehicle. The lamp will turn off after the vehicle is started.
If while the vehicle is running a problem is detected in the engine control system the lamp is
illuminated. This is accomplished by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) grounding the G3
circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Spare Tire: Description and Operation
The temporary spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be repaired
and reinstalled at the first opportunity, or replaced with a new. Do not exceed speeds of 50 MPH
when the temporary spare tire is in use on the vehicle. Refer to the Owner's Manual for complete
details.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Tire & Wheel - Runout
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Tire & Wheel - Runout
NO: 22-01-97
GROUP: Wheels & Tires
DATE: Jun. 13, 1997
SUBJECT: Tire & Wheel Runout
MODELS: 1994 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1994 - 1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1994 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Convertible
1994 - 1997 (AN) Dakota
1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1994 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 1997 (BR) Ram Pickup
1994 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
1995 - 1997 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1994 - 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1996 - 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
1994 - 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
1997 (TJ) Wrangler
1994 - 1997 (XJ) Cherokee
1994 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1994 - 1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
Radial runout is the vertical distance between the high and low points on the tire or wheel edge
measured at the center line of the tread.
Lateral runout is the horizontal movement of the tire or wheel measured near the shoulder of the
tire.
Runout of more than the preferred specification may cause the vehicle to shake. Refer to the
following specifications and appropriate Service Manual procedures.
PREFERRED TIRE & WHEEL RUNOUT
Usually runout can be reduced by relocating the wheel and tire on the wheels studs and/or rotating
the tire on the wheel (match mounting).
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1225
Wheels: Specifications
Lug Nuts ..............................................................................................................................................
................................. 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1226
Wheels: Description and Operation
Original equipment wheels are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the specified
maximum vehicle capacity.
All models use steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. Every wheel has raised sections
between the rim flanges and rim drop well called safety humps.
Initial inflation of the tires forces the bead over these raised sections. In case of air loss the raised
sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the vehicle can be brought to a safe stop.
Cast aluminum wheels require special balance weights to fit on the thicker flange of the rim and
special wheel clamps for the alignment equipment.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum wheels use wheel nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is necessary to
ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Vehicles that are equipped with bolt-on wheel covers use large nose wheel nuts. The wheel nuts
used on a vehicle equipped with bolt-on wheel covers are externally threaded so that the wheel
covers can be attached to the wheel nuts.
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup of corrosion on the wheel mounting surface.
WARNING: Installing wheels without good metal-to-metal contact could cause loosening of wheel
lug nuts. This could adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1227
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
Wheels must be replaced if they:
- Have excessive run out
- Are bent or dented
- Leak air
- Have damaged wheel lug/ nut holes
Wheel repairs employing hammering, heating, welding or repairing leaks are not allowed.
Original equipment replacement wheels should be used. When obtaining replacement wheels, they
should be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The physical dimensions (diameter, width, offset,
pilot hole and bolt circle) of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: Failure to use equivalent replacement wheels may adversely affect the safety and
handling of the vehicle. Replacement with used wheels is not recommended. The service history of
the rim may have included severe treatment or very high mileage. The rim could fail without
warning.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1228
Wheels: Service and Repair
Lug Nut Tightening Sequence
To install the wheel and tire assembly, first position it properly on the mounting surface using the
hub pilot as a guide. Then progressively tighten the lug nuts in the proper sequence to half of the
required torque. Finally tighten the lug nuts in the proper sequence to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft.
lbs.). Never use oil or grease on studs or nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
> Mechanical Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Mechanical Specifications
Front
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
................................................ 216 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Hub Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
> Mechanical Specifications > Page 1233
Wheel Bearing: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Wheel Bearing Grease NLGI GC rated automotive grease
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1234
Wheel Bearing: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front
The front wheel hub bearing used is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing.
The wheel bearing is serviced separately from the front steering knuckle and front hub assembly.
Installation and retention of the front wheel bearing into the steering knuckle, is by means of an
interference press fit using a retaining compound and a retaining snap ring. Installation of the front
hub into the front wheel bearing, must be done after wheel bearing and retaining snap ring is
installed in steering knuckle.
The unit 1 wheel bearing is serviced only as a complete assembly less the wheel hub. If the front
wheel bearing requires replacement, the hub must be removed from the original wheel bearing and
transferred to the replacement bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Front > Page 1237
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear
All vehicles are equipped with permanently lubricated and sealed for life rear wheel bearings.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units. However, if servicing
of a rear wheel bearing is required, refer to procedures in Testing and Inspection and Service and
Repair for the inspection and replacement of the rear wheel bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front
NOTE: The hub bearing is designed for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of periodic
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub
bearing.
With the wheel, disc brake caliper. and brake rotor removed, rotate the wheel hub. Any roughness
or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the hub bearing
exhibits any of these conditions during diagnosis, the hub bearing will require replacement, the
bearing is not serviceable.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the hub bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front > Page 1240
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear
The rear hub and bearing assembly is designed for the life of the vehicle and should require no
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for evaluation of bearing condition. With wheel
and brake drum removed, rotate flanged outer ring of hub. Excessive roughness, lateral play or
resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or bearing failure. If the rear wheel bearings exhibit
these conditions during inspection, the hub and bearing assembly should be replaced. Damaged
bearing seals and resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing replacement. Moderate
grease loss from bearing is considered normal and should not require replacement of the hub and
bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Removal
1. Remove the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Front Steering
Knuckle/Service and Repair
NOTE: The removal and installation of the steering knuckle hub bearing is to ONLY be done with
the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the hub bearing from the steering
knuckle MUST be done using an arbor press and the following procedure.
2. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on the steering knuckle and hub/bearing
assembly as shown to support steering knuckle
when pressing out hub.
3. Position steering knuckle and hub and bearing in an arbor press supported by Bearing Splitter,
Special Tool P334 as shown. 4. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on the small
end of the hub to drive hub out of bearing. Using arbor press remove hub from
bearing. The one bearing race will come out with hub when hub is removed from bearing.
5. Remove Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent from the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: Safety goggles and or face protection should always be worn when removing the snap
ring retaining the hub/bearing in the steering knuckle. When the snap ring is removed from the
steering knuckle it could fly out of the steering knuckle with great force possibly causing personal
injury.
6. Using a screw driver, remove the snap ring retaining the hub bearing in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1243
7. Place steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. Press blocks
must not obstruct hub bearing bore in steering knuckle so
bearing can be pressed out of knuckle. Place Bearing Driver, Special Tool MB-990799, or
equivalent on outer race of hub bearing. Press hub bearing completely out of the steering knuckle.
8. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on hub so it is between the flange of the
hub and the bearing race remaining on the hub.
Place hub, bearing race and the bearing splitter in an arbor press as shown. Place Driver, Special
Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on end of hub. Press the hub out of the bearing race.
Installation
1. Wipe bore of steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTIONS: Do not use any type of solvent on the hub bearing when cleaning it.
- The hub bearing must be wiped as clean as possible. Any remaining rust preventative on the
bearing can effect the bonding action of the adhesive to the bearing.
2. Clean the rust preventative from the replacement hub bearing using a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTION: When applying adhesive to bore of steering knuckle, do not allow adhesive to get into
the snap ring in bore or on the seal of the hub bearing
3. Apply Loctite Adhesive #640 or an equivalent, to the bore of the steering knuckle. The adhesive
is to be applied to the entire bore wall surface,
from the shoulder at the bottom to just below the snap ring groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1244
4. Place new hub bearing into bore of steering knuckle so it is square with the bore. Place steering
knuckle in arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
C-4698-2, or equivalent supporting steering knuckle. Place Diver, Special Tool 5052, or equivalent
on outer race of the hub bearing. Press hub bearing into steering knuckle until it is fully bottom in
bearing bore of steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When installing the retaining snap ring for the hub bearing care must be taken not to
damage seal on new hub bearing.
5. Install hub bearing retaining snap ring into snap ring groove in hub bearing bore of steering
knuckle. Be sure snap ring is fully seated in snap ring
groove.
6. Place steering knuckle with hub bearing installed in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
MB-990799, or equivalent supporting inner race of
the hub bearing. Place hub in nub bearing making sure it is square with bearing. Place Driver,
Special Tool 6522, or equivalent on front face of hub. Press the hub into the hub bearing until hub
is fully bottomed in hub bearing.
7. Install the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly on the vehicle. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Front Steering
Knuckle/Service and Repair
8. Install the wheel and tire on the vehicle. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Set the front wheel Toe to the required specification.
CAUTION: After the vehicle is aligned it can only be moved a short distance and then parked. Do
not move the vehicle any further until the adhesive has cured for a minimum of two hours. Driving
the vehicle before the adhesive is allowed to cure properly, will affect the retention of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1245
bearing in the bore of the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1246
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
3. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub And Bearing Dust Cap
4. Remove dust cap. from rear hub/bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1247
5. Remove hub/bearing assembly to rear spindle retaining nut. 6. Remove rear hub/bearing
assembly from rear spindle by pulling straight of spindle by hand.
INSTALL
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
1. Position hub/bearing assembly on rear spindle. 2. Install a new hub nut and tighten to a torque of
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). 3. Install dust cap; using a soft faced hammer. 4. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
5. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer To Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair.
6. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Cover: > 220396 > Oct > 96 > Wheel Covers - Noisy/Missing/Loose
Wheel Cover: Customer Interest Wheel Covers - Noisy/Missing/Loose
NO: 22-03-96
GROUP: Wheels
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Noisy, Loose Or Missing Bolt-on Wheel Covers
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Noisy, loose or missing wheel covers due to loose or missing wheel cover nuts.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect each wheel cover nut and determine if loose. If the plastic nut is over-torqued, it will result
in a jumped thread and become loose. If the plastic nut has jumped a thread torque nut to 55 in.
lbs. Inspect the nut, if the nut is loose remove and inspect for damage. If one or more of the 5 nuts
is damaged proceed to the repair procedure. If nut is now secure no further action is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04656777 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4W)
AR 04656376 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4Y)
AR 04656825 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4J)
AR 04656251 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4C)
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin provides the procedure for the wheel cover installation.
1. Place wheel cover on wheel and firmly push down on center cap so that it is flat against the
wheel.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER ATTACHING NUTS SHOULD NEVER BE INSTALLED BY DRIVING THE
NUT ONTO THE WHEEL NUT WITH A RUBBER MALLET OR BY USING AN IMPACT WRENCH.
PLEASE INSURE THAT THE NEW VEHICLE PREP TECHNICIAN IS AWARE OF THIS
INFORMATION.
2. Hand tighten the wheel cover nuts until they begin to "ratchet" and then let the cover spring
back.
3. Torque the wheel cover nuts sequentially to between 45 to 55 in. lbs.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER NUT HAS A BUILT IN SAFEGUARD THAT WILL ALLOW THE NUT TO
JUMP A THREAD IF OVER-TORQUED. IF THIS CONDITION OCCURS, IT THE NUT SHOULD
BE TIGHTENED TO JUST BEFORE THE "JUMP" FEATURE. THE "JUMP" FEATURE CAN BE
FELT AS A POP WHEN THE NUT IS TORQUED OVER 55 IN. LBS.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-93 0.2 Hrs.
Inspect and Torque Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-94 0.2 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Cover: > 220396 > Oct > 96 > Wheel Covers Noisy/Missing/Loose
Wheel Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheel Covers - Noisy/Missing/Loose
NO: 22-03-96
GROUP: Wheels
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Noisy, Loose Or Missing Bolt-on Wheel Covers
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Noisy, loose or missing wheel covers due to loose or missing wheel cover nuts.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect each wheel cover nut and determine if loose. If the plastic nut is over-torqued, it will result
in a jumped thread and become loose. If the plastic nut has jumped a thread torque nut to 55 in.
lbs. Inspect the nut, if the nut is loose remove and inspect for damage. If one or more of the 5 nuts
is damaged proceed to the repair procedure. If nut is now secure no further action is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04656777 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4W)
AR 04656376 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4Y)
AR 04656825 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4J)
AR 04656251 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4C)
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin provides the procedure for the wheel cover installation.
1. Place wheel cover on wheel and firmly push down on center cap so that it is flat against the
wheel.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER ATTACHING NUTS SHOULD NEVER BE INSTALLED BY DRIVING THE
NUT ONTO THE WHEEL NUT WITH A RUBBER MALLET OR BY USING AN IMPACT WRENCH.
PLEASE INSURE THAT THE NEW VEHICLE PREP TECHNICIAN IS AWARE OF THIS
INFORMATION.
2. Hand tighten the wheel cover nuts until they begin to "ratchet" and then let the cover spring
back.
3. Torque the wheel cover nuts sequentially to between 45 to 55 in. lbs.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER NUT HAS A BUILT IN SAFEGUARD THAT WILL ALLOW THE NUT TO
JUMP A THREAD IF OVER-TORQUED. IF THIS CONDITION OCCURS, IT THE NUT SHOULD
BE TIGHTENED TO JUST BEFORE THE "JUMP" FEATURE. THE "JUMP" FEATURE CAN BE
FELT AS A POP WHEN THE NUT IS TORQUED OVER 55 IN. LBS.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-93 0.2 Hrs.
Inspect and Torque Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-94 0.2 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1261
Wheel Cover: Description and Operation
A lock-on type wheel cover is used on certain models.
The wheel cover is locked to the wheel using the 5 nuts located in the wheel cover. The nuts in the
wheel cover, thread onto a special externally threaded wheel nut. This is the method used to retain
the wheel cover to the wheel.
The wheel cover retaining nut is retained in the wheel cover and will stay on the wheel cover when
unthreaded from the wheel nut. If required, the retaining nut for the lock-on wheel cover can be
removed from the wheel cover and replaced as a separate part of the lock-on wheel cover.
The lock-on wheel cover can not be removed from the wheel until all 5 of wheel cover retaining
nuts are unthreaded from the wheel nuts. Then the lock-on wheel cover can be removed by hand
from the wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Cover Replacement
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover Replacement
NOTE: When unthreading the wheel cover retaining nuts from the wheel nuts it is recommended
that a hand wrench be used and not an impact wrench. Use of an impact wrench could result in
damage to the lock-on wheel cover retaining nuts.
REMOVE
1. Unthread the 5 nuts attaching the wheel cover to the wheel nuts. 2. Grasp the wheel cover and
pull straight outward from the wheel. This will remove the wheel cover from the wheel.
Fig. 2
INSTALL
1. Align the valve notch in the wheel cover with the valve stem on the wheel. Align the wheel cover
retaining nuts with the externally threaded wheel
nuts.
2. By hand, start to thread all 5 of the wheel cover retaining nuts onto the externally threaded wheel
nuts.
NOTE: When tightening the wheel cover retaining nuts it is recommended that a hand wrench be
used and not an impact wrench. Use of an impact wrench could result in damage to the lock-on
wheel cover retaining nuts.
3. Tighten each of the wheel cover retaining nuts. If the retaining nut "jumps" a thread (slips), which
is an override feature of the retaining nut,
retighten the retaining nut to a point just prior to this occurring. To avoid rattling of the wheel cover
be sure all five retaining nuts are correctly tightened.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Cover Replacement > Page 1264
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover Retaining Nut Replacement
NOTE: If a retaining nut for the lock-on wheel is damaged, it can be replaced as a separate part of
the wheel cover. Use the following procedure for replacing a wheel cover retaining nut.
REMOVE
1. If required, remove the wheel cover from the wheel.
NOTE: The retaining nut flange can not be forced past the large retaining tab. When removing
retaining nut from wheel cover, the flange on the retaining nut must be forced past the 2 small
retaining tabs on wheel cover.
2. From the back side of the wheel cover, push outward and tilt the retaining nut sideways forcing
the flange on the retaining nut past the 2 small
retaining tabs in the retaining nut hole of the wheel cover.
3. When flange on retaining nut is past the 2 retaining tabs on the wheel cover, remove retaining
nut from wheel cover by pushing or pulling from
hole in wheel cover.
INSTALL
1. Install retaining nut in hole of wheel cover with retaining nut flange positioned under the large
retaining flange. 2. Push on hex of retaining nut forcing the retaining nut flange past the 2 small
retaining tabs in wheel cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During Low
Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During Low
Speed Stop > Page 1274
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop > Page 1280
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1281
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
183 Nm (135 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Wheel Tightening Sequence
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Tightening Sequence
Wheel Torque Sequence - Master
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Wheel Tightening Sequence > Page 1286
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Lug Nut Torque
Lug Nuts ..............................................................................................................................................
................................. 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.) Lug Nut Hex Size .............................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
19 mm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Wheel Tightening Sequence > Page 1287
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Stud Size
Stud Size .............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ M12 x 1.5 mm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1288
Wheel Fastener: Description and Operation
If wheel attaching studs need to be replaced in the hub and bearing assembly the studs CAN NOT
be hammered out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out of the bearing flange,
damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature bearing failure.
The hub and bearing assembly does not require removal from the steering knuckle or the rear
knuckle to replace the wheel attaching studs in the hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1289
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
CAUTION: If wheel attaching stud needs to be replaced in the hub and bearing assembly the studs
CAN NOT be hammered out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out of the
bearing flange, damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature bearing
failure.
NOTES:
- The following procedure and special tools shown MUST be used when replacing wheel attaching
studs.
- The hub and bearing assembly does not require removal from the steering knuckle to replace
wheel attaching studs in the hub and bearing assembly.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the front
wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. Remove front disc brake caliper to steering knuckle attaching bolts.
4. Remove disc brake caliper assembly from steering knuckle. Caliper is removed by first lifting
bottom of caliper away from steering knuckle, and
then removing top of caliper out from under steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1290
5. Support the brake caliper assembly using a wire hook, not by the hydraulic flex hose.
6. Remove the braking disc from the front hub.
7. Install a lug nut on wheel stud to be removed from hub and bearing assembly, so threads on
stud are even with end of lug nut. Rotate hub so stud
requiring removal is aligned with notch cast into front of steering knuckle. Install Remover, Special
Tool C-4150, or equivalent on hub and bearing assembly flange and wheel stud.
8. Tighten down on special tool, pushing wheel stud out of the hub and bearing assembly flange.
When shoulder of wheel stud is past flange remove
special tool from hub and bearing assembly. Remove lug nut from stud and remove wheel stud
from flange.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1291
INSTALL
1. Install replacement wheel stud into flange of hub and bearing assembly. Install washers and
wheel lug nut on stud, with flat side of lug nut against
washers.
2. Tighten the wheel lug nut, pulling the wheel stud into the flange of the hub and bearing
assembly. When the head of the stud is fully seated against
the bearing flange, remove lug nut and washers from wheel stud.
3. Install braking disk back on front hub.
4. Install disc brake caliper assembly on steering knuckle. Caliper is installed by first sliding top of
caliper under top abutment on steering knuckle.
Then installing bottom of caliper against bottom abutment of steering knuckle.
5. Install the disc brake caliper assembly to steering knuckle attaching bolts and torque to 31 Nm
(23 ft. lbs.). 6. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install front wheel lug nuts and torque to 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION PRESSURE (at 250 - 400 RPM):
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................ 1172 - 1551 kPa (170 - 225 psi) Minimum .............................................................
................................................................................................................................... 689 kPa (100
psi)
COMPRESSION PRESSURE DIFFERENCE OF ALL CYLINDER:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 25%
VACUUM:
Manifold ...............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 60 kPa (18 inches Hg)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1297
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
PROCEDURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Disconnect coil wire from distributor and secure to good ground to prevent a spark from starting
a fire (Conventional Ignition System). For
Direct Ignition System (DIS) disconnect the coil connector.
5 . Be sure throttle blade is fully open during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gage
adaptor into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Crank engine until maximum pressure is
reached on gage.
Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure.
7. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689
kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more
cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem
in the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a
guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the
cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
11. Clean or replace spark plugs as necessary and adjust gap. Tighten to specifications. 12. Test
resistance of spark plug cables. Perform secondary circuit inspection. 13. Test coil output voltage,
primary and secondary resistance. Replace parts as necessary. 14. Check fuel pump pressure at
idle and different RPM ranges. 15. The air filter elements should be replaced as specified. 16.
Inspect crankcase ventilation system. 17. Inspect and adjust accessory belt drives. 18. Road test
vehicle as a final test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications > Bearing Cap Bolt Torque
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications Bearing Cap Bolt Torque
Camshaft Bearing Cap ID
Camshaft Bearing Cap-Torque Sequence
1. Lubricate bearing journals and cam followers with clean oil and install the camshafts. Install right
and left camshaft bearing caps #2 thru #5 and
right #6. Tighten M6 fasteners to 12 N.m (105 in. lbs.) in sequence.
Camshaft Bearing Cap Sealing
2. Apply Mopar Gasket Maker to No.1 and No.6 bearing caps. Jnstall bearing caps and tighten M8
fasteners to 24 N.m (215 in. lbs.).
3. Bearing cap number 1, must be installed before the camshaft seals can be installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Specifications > Bearing Cap Bolt Torque > Page 1303
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications Engine Rebuild Specifications
Bearing Bore Diameter No.1-6
............................................................................................................................. 26.020 - 26.041
mm (1.024 - 1.025 inch) Diametrical Bearing Clearance
............................................................................................................................... 0.069 - 0.071 mm
(0.0027 - 0.003 inch) Max. Allowable
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.05 - 0.15 mm (0.002 - 0.006 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Sprocket Bolt .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1307
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Tools and Equipment
Camshaft Sprocket Remover/Installer C-4687
Camshaft Sprocket Remover/Installer Adapter C-4687-1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Bearing Cap Bolt Torque
Camshaft: Specifications Bearing Cap Bolt Torque
Camshaft Bearing Cap ID
Camshaft Bearing Cap-Torque Sequence
1. Lubricate bearing journals and cam followers with clean oil and install the camshafts. Install right
and left camshaft bearing caps #2 thru #5 and
right #6. Tighten M6 fasteners to 12 N.m (105 in. lbs.) in sequence.
Camshaft Bearing Cap Sealing
2. Apply Mopar Gasket Maker to No.1 and No.6 bearing caps. Jnstall bearing caps and tighten M8
fasteners to 24 N.m (215 in. lbs.).
3. Bearing cap number 1, must be installed before the camshaft seals can be installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Bearing Cap Bolt Torque > Page 1312
Camshaft: Specifications Rebuild Specifications
Bearing Bore Diameter
......................................................................................................................................... 26.020 26.041 mm (1.024 - 1.025 inch) Diametrical Bearing Clearance
............................................................................................................................. 0.069 - 0.071 mm
(0.0027 - 0.0030 inch) End Play ..........................................................................................................
.............................................................. 0.05 - 0.15 mm (0.002 - 0.006 inch) Bearing Journal
Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
25.951 - 25.970 mm (1.021 - 1.022 inch)
LIFT:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ 8.75 mm (0.344 inch) Exhaust ................................................................
............................................................................................................................ 8.00 mm (0.314
inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1313
Camshaft: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The nodular iron camshafts have six bearing journals and 2 cam lobes per cylinder.
END PLAY CONTROL
Flanges at the rear journals control camshaft end play.
CAM POSITION SENSOR
Provision for cam position sensor is located on the intake camshaft at the rear of cylinder head.
OIL SEAL
A hydrodynamic oil seal is used for oil control at the front of the camshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Camshaft: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover. 2. Remove timing belt, sprockets and covers.
3. Bearing caps are identified for location. Remove the outside bearing caps first.
4. Loosen the camshaft bearing cap attaching fasteners in sequence shown one camshaft at a
time.
CAUTION: Camshafts are not interchangeable. The intake cam number 6 thrust bearing face
spacing is wider.
5. Identify the camshafts before removing from the head. The camshafts are not interchangeable.
NOTE:
- Check Camshaft for binding in cylinder head. Inspect camshaft bearing journals for damage. If
camshafts are binding, also check the cylinder head bearing surface for damage, and check the
camshaft bearing oil feed holes in the cylinder head for clogging.
- Check the cam surface for abnormal wear and damage, replace if defective. A visible worn
groove in the roller follower or on the cam lobes is cause for replacement.
CAUTION: Ensure that NONE of the pistons are at top dead center when installing the camshafts.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate bearing journals and cam followers with clean oil and install the camshafts. Install right
and left camshaft bearing caps #2 thru #5 and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1316
right #6. Tighten M6 fasteners to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) in sequence shown.
2. Apply Mopar Gasket Maker, or equivalent to No. 1 and No. 6 bearing caps. Install bearing caps
and tighten M8 fasteners to 24 Nm (215 inch lbs.)
.
3. Bearing cap number 1, must be installed before the camshaft seals can be installed. 4. Install
timing belt, sprockets and covers. 5. Install cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1317
Camshaft: Service and Repair Checking End Play
END PLAY
1. Oil camshaft journals and install camshaft WITHOUT cam follower assemblies. Install rear cam
caps and tighten screws to specified torque. 2. Using a suitable tool, move camshaft as far
rearward as it will go. 3. Zero dial indicator. 4. Move camshaft as far forward as it will go. 5. End
play travel: 0.05 - 0.15 mm (0.002 - 0.06 inch).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
A tappet-like noise may be produced from several items. Check the following items.
1. Engine oil level too high or too low. This may cause aerated oil to enter the adjusters and cause
them to be spongy. 2. Insufficient running time after rebuilding cylinder head. Low speed running
up to 1 hour may be required. 3. During this time, turn engine off and let set for a few minutes
before restarting. Repeat this several times after engine has reached normal operating
temperature.
4. Low oil pressure. 5. The oil restrictor pressed into the vertical oil passage to the cylinder head is
plugged with debris. 6. Air ingested into oil due to broken or cracked oil pump pick up. 7. Worn
valve guides. 8. Rocker arm ears contacting valve spring retainer. 9. Rocker arm loose, adjuster
stuck or at maximum extension and still leaves lash in the system.
10. Faulty lash adjuster.
a. Check lash adjusters for sponginess while installed in cylinder head. Depress part of rocker arm
over adjuster. Normal adjusters should feel
very firm. Spongy adjusters can be bottomed out easily.
b. Remove suspected lash adjusters, and replace.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Cam Follower
<--> [Rocker Arm Assembly] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cam Follower: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve cover using. 2. Remove timing belt, sprockets and covers. 3. Remove camshaft.
4. Remove cam follower assemblies from cylinder head. Keep the cam followers in the order they
have been removed from the head for reassembly.
Mark hydraulic lash adjusters for reassembly in their original position. Lash adjusters are serviced
as a assembly.
NOTE: Inspect the cam follower assembly for wear or damage. Replace as necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hydraulic lash adjuster assembly making sure that adjusters are at least partially full of oil.
This is indicated by little or no plunger travel
when the lash adjuster is Lubricated with clean oil and install cam follower assemblies in their
original position on the hydraulic adjuster and valve stem.
2. Install the camshafts.
NOTE:
- A tappet like noise may be produced from several items.
- Hydraulic Lash adjusters are replaced as an assembly and are not repaired.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1328
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
Engine connecting rod bearing clearances can be determined by use of Plastigage or equivalent.
The following is the recommended procedure for the use of Plastigage:
1. Rotate the crankshaft until the connecting rod to be checked is at the bottom of its stroke. 2.
Remove oil film from surface to be checked. Plastigage is soluble in oil.
3. Place a piece of Plastigage across the entire width of the bearing shell in the bearing cap
approximately 6.35 mm (1/4 inch) off center and away
from the oil hole. In addition, suspect areas can be checked by placing plastigage in the suspect
area.
4. Before assembling the rod cap with Plastigage in place, the crankshaft must be rotated until the
connecting being checked starts moving toward the
top of the engine. Only then should the cap be assembled and torqued to specifications. Do not
rotate the crankshaft while assembling the cap or the Plastigage may be smeared, giving
inaccurate results.
5. Remove the bearing cap and compare the width of the flattened Plastigage with the scale
provided on the package. Locate the band closest to the
same width. This band indicates the amount of oil clearance. Differences in readings between the
ends indicate the amount of taper present. Record all readings taken. Refer to Specifications.
Plastigage generally is accompanied by two scales. One scale is in inches, the other is a metric
scale.
NOTE: Plastigage is available in a variety of clearance ranges. Use the most appropriate range for
the specifications you are checking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Connecting Rod Cap Bolts/Nuts
Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod Cap Bolts/Nuts
Connecting rod cap bolt
..................................................................................................................................... 27 Nm + 90°
turn (20 ft. lbs. + 90° turn)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Connecting Rod Cap Bolts/Nuts > Page 1333
Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod Specifications
Piston Pin Bore Diameter
...................................................................................................................................... 20.96 - 20.98
mm (0.8252 - 0.8260 inch) Large End Bore Diameter
................................................................................................................................. 50.991 - 51.005
mm (2.0075 - 2.0081 inch) Side Clearance .........................................................................................
...................................................................... 0.13 - 0.38 mm (0.005 - 0.015 inch) Total Weight
(Less Bearing) .....................................................................................................................................
........................... 543 grams (1.20 lbs.) Mounting Bolt ........................................................................
............................................................................................ 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Plus 1/4 Turn
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1334
Connecting Rod: Description and Operation
This engine DOES NOT have provision for a free wheeling valve train. Non free wheeling valve
train means, in the event of a broken timing belt Pistons will contact the Valves. All engines use
pressed-in piston pins to attach forged powdered metal connecting rods. The connecting rods are a
cracked cap design and are not repairable. Hex head cap screw are used to provide alignment and
durability in the assembly.
NOTE: Pistons And Connecting rods are serviced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a reliable ridge reamer before removing pistons from
cylinder block. Be sure to keep tops of pistons
covered during this operation. Mark piston with matching cylinder number.
2. Remove oil pan. Scribe the cylinder number on the side of the rod and cap for identification. 3.
Pistons will have a stamping in the approximate location shown. These stamps will be either a
directional arrow or a weight identification for the
assembly. L is for light and H is for heavy. These assemblies should all be the same weight class.
Service piston assemblies are marked with a S and can be used with either L or H production
assemblies. The weight designation stamps should face toward the timing belt side of the engine.
4. Pistons and connecting rods must be removed from top of cylinder block. Rotate crankshaft so
that each connecting rod is centered in cylinder
bore.
5. Remove connecting rod cap bolts Do not use old bolts if reinstalling connecting rod. Push each
piston and rod assembly out of cylinder bore.
NOTE: Be careful not to nick crankshaft journals.
6. After removal, install bearing cap on the mating rod. 7. Piston and Rods are serviced as an
assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing pistons and connecting rod assemblies into the bore, be sure that compression
ring gaps are staggered so that neither is in line
with oil ring rail gap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1337
2. Before installing the ring compressor, make sure the oil ring expander ends are butted and the
rail gaps located as shown.
3. Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil, slide the ring compressor, over the piston.
Be sure position of rings does not change during
this operation.
4. The weight stamp designation L or H will be in the front half of the piston should face toward the
front of the engine. 5. Rotate crankshaft so that the connecting rod journal is on the center of the
cylinder bore. Insert rod and piston assembly into cylinder bore and
guide rod over the crankshaft journal.
6. Tap the piston down in cylinder bore, using a hammer handle. At the same time, guide
connecting rod into position on connecting rod journal. 7. Install rod caps. Install New bolts and
tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft.lb.) Plus 1/4 turn.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1338
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Fitting Connecting Rod
1. Follow the procedure specified in Connecting Rod Bearing for Connecting Rod Bearing
Clearance. Refer to specifications.
CAUTION: Do not rotate crankshaft or the Plastigage may be smeared.
NOTE: The rod bearing bolts should not be reused.
2. Before installing the NEW bolts the threads should be oiled with clean engine oil. 3. Install each
bolt finger tight then alternately torque each bolt to assemble the cap properly. 4. Tighten the bolts
to 27 Nm PLUS 1/4 turn (20 ft. lbs. PLUS 1/4 turn) Do not use a torque wrench for last step. 5.
Using a feeler gauge, check connecting rod side clearance. Refer to connecting rod specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Description and Operation
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
A sintered iron timing belt sprocket is mounted on the crankshaft nose. This sprocket transmits
crankshaft movement, via timing belt to the camshaft sprocket providing timed valve actuation.
BOLT ACCESS PLUG
An Access plug is located in the right inner fender shield. Remove the plug and insert the proper
size socket, extension and ratchet, when crankshaft rotation is necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1342
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Tools and Equipment
Crankshaft Sprocket Remover 6793
Crankshaft Sprocket Installer 6792
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Rebuild Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications Rebuild Specifications
Main bearing journal diameter
.................................................................................................................. 51.9924 - 52.0076 mm
(2.0469 - 2.0475 inch) Main bearing journal out-of-roundness
...................................................................................................................................... 0.0035 mm
(0.0001 inch) Main bearing journal taper
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.0038 mm (0.0001 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Rebuild Specifications > Page 1347
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications Torque Specifications
M8 Bedplate Bolts ...............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) M11 Main Cap Bolts .........................................
....................................................................................................................................... 81 Nm (60 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1348
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Description and Operation
The crankshaft is supported in five main bearings. All upper bearing shells in the crankcase have
oil grooves. All lower bearing shells installed in the (bedplate) main bearing cap are plain.
Crankshaft end play is controlled by a flanged bearing on the number three main bearing journal.
NOTE: The upper and lower main Bearing shells are Not interchangeable: The lower shells have a
revised tab to prevent improper installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1349
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
PLASTIGAGE METHOD
Engine crankshaft bearing clearances can be determined by use of Plastigage or equivalent. The
following is the recommended procedure for the use of Plastigage:
NOTE: The total clearance of the main bearings can only be determined by removing the weight of
the crankshaft. This can be accomplished by either of two methods:
Preferred Method Shimming the bearings adjacent to the bearing to be checked in order to remove
the clearance between upper bearing shell and the crankshaft. This can be accomplished by
placing a minimum of 0.254 mm (0.010 inch) shim (e.g. cardboard, match-book cover, etc.)
between the bearing shell and the bearing cap on the adjacent bearings and tightening bolts to 14 20 Nm (10 - 15 ft. lbs.). The number of main bearing will vary from engine to engine. -
When checking #1 main bearing shim #2 main bearing.
- When checking #2 main bearing shim #1 & main bearing.
- When checking #3 main bearing shim #2 & 4 main bearing.
- When checking #4 main bearing shim #3 & 5 main bearing.
- When checking #5 main bearing shim #4 main bearing.
CAUTION: Remove all shims before reassembling engine.
Alternative Method The weight of the crankshaft can be supported by a jack under the
counterweight adjacent to the bearing being checked.
PLASTIGAGE PROCEDURE
1. Remove oil film from surface to be checked. Plastigage is soluble in oil.
2. Place a piece of Plastigage across the entire width of the bearing shell in the cap approximately
6.35 mm (1/4 inch) off center and away from the
oil holes. (In addition, suspected areas can be checked by placing the Plastigage in the suspected
area). Torque the bearing cap bolts of the bearing being checked to the proper specifications.
3. Remove the bearing cap and compare the width of the flattened Plastigage with the metric scale
provided on the package. Locate the band closest
to the same width. This band shows the amount of clearance in thousandths of a millimeter.
Differences in readings between the ends indicate the amount of taper present. Record all readings
taken. Plastigage generally is accompanied by two scales. One scale is in inches, the other is a
metric scale.
NOTE: Plastigage is available in a variety of clearance ranges. Use the most appropriate range for
the specifications you are checking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Out-of-Round (Max.): 0.0035 mm (0.0001 inch) Taper (Max.): 0.0038 mm (0.0001 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1353
Crankshaft: Description and Operation
CONSTRUCTION
A nodular cast iron crankshaft is used. The engine has 5 main bearings, with number 3 flanged to
control thrust. The 52 mm diameter main and 48 mm diameter crank pin journals (all) have
undercut fillet radiuses that are deep rolled for added strength. To optimize bearing loading 8
counterweights are used.
SEALING
Hydrodynamic seals provide end sealing, where the crankshaft exits the block. Anaerobic gasket
material is used for parting line sealing.
SPROCKET
A sintered iron timing belt sprocket is mounted on the crankshaft nose. This sprocket transmits
crankshaft movement, via timing belt to the camshaft sprocket providing timed valve actuation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove oil filter and adapter from bedplate. 2. Remove oil pan. 3. Remove crankshaft sprocket
and oil pump. 4. Remove all main bearing cap and bedplate bolts from the engine block. 5. Using a
mallet tap the bedplate loose from the engine block dowel pins.
CAUTION: Do not pry up on one side of the bedplate. Damage may occur to cylinder block and
bedplate alignment.
6. Bedplate should be removed evenly from the cylinder block dowel pins. 7. Lift out crankshaft
from cylinder block. Be sure not to damage the main bearings or journals when removing the
crankshaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the main bearing shells with the lubrication groove in the cylinder block. Install O-ring into
recess in the block. 2. Make certain oil holes in block line up with oil hole in bearings and bearing
tabs seat in the block tab slots.
CAUTION: Do Not get oil on the bedplate mating surface. It will affect the sealer ability to seal the
bedplate to cylinder block.
3. Oil the bearings and journals and install crankshaft and O-ring in cylinder block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1356
CAUTION: Use only the specified anaerobic sealer on the bedplate or damage may occur to the
engine.
4. Apply 1.5 - 2.0 mm (0.059 - 0.078 inch) bead of Mopar Torque Cure Gasket Maker to cylinder
block as shown. 5. Install lower main bearings into main bearing cap/bedplate. Make certain the
bearing tabs are seated into the bedplate slots. Install the main
bearing/bedplate into engine block.
6. Before installing the bolts the threads should be oiled with clean engine oil, wipe off any excess
oil.
7. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts 11, 17 and 20 finger tight. Tighten this bolts
down together until the bedplate contacts the
cylinder block. Torque bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
8. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts (1 thru 10) and torque each bolt to 81 Nm (60
ft. lbs.) in sequence shown. 9. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts (11 thru 20), with
baffle studs in positions 12, 13 and 16 and torque each bolt to 30 Nm (22 ft.
lbs.) in sequence shown.
10. After the main bearing bedplate is installed, check the crankshaft turning torque. The turning
torque should not exceed 5.6 Nm (50 inch lbs.). 11. Install oil pump and check crankshaft end play.
12. Install crankshaft sprocket. 13. Install oil filter adapter and filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1357
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Service Procedures
Crankshaft End Play Measurement
DIAL INDICATOR METHOD
1. Mount a dial indicator to front of engine, locating probe on nose of crankshaft. 2. Move
crankshaft all the way to the rear of it travel. 3. Zero the dial indicator. 4. Move crankshaft all the
way to the front ant read the dial indicator. Refer to specifications.
FEELER GAGE METHOD
1. Move crankshaft all the way to the rear of its travel using a lever inserted between a main
bearing cap and a crankshaft cheek, using care not to
damage any bearing surface. Do not loosen main bearing cap.
2. Use a feeler gauge between number three thrust bearing and machined crankshaft surface to
determine end play.
Journal Inspection
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1358
The crankshaft journals should be checked for excessive wear, taper and scoring. Limits of taper or
out-of-round on any crankshaft journals should be held to 0.025 mm (0.001 inch). Journal grinding
should not exceed 0.305 mm (0.012 inch) under the standard journal diameter. DO NOT grind
thrust faces of Number 3 main bearing. DO NOT nick crank pin or bearing fillets. After grinding,
remove rough edges from crankshaft oil holes and clean out all passages.
CAUTION: With the nodular cast iron crankshafts used it is important that the final paper or cloth
polish after any journal regrind be in the same direction as normal rotation in the engine.
Upper and lower Number 3 bearing halves are flanged to carry the crankshaft thrust loads and are
NOT interchangeable with any other bearing halves in the engine. All bearing cap bolts removed
during service procedures are to be cleaned and oiled before installation. Bearing shells are
available in standard and the following undersized: 0.016 mm (0.0006 inch), 0.032 mm (0.0012
inch), 0.250 mm (0.010 inch). Never install an undersize bearing that will reduce clearance below
specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Engine Block Heater: Description and Operation
The heater, operated by ordinary house current (110 Volt A.C.) through a power cord and
connector behind the radiator grille, provides easier engine starting and faster warm-up when
vehicle is operated in areas having extremely low temperatures. The heater is mounted in a core
hole (in place of a core hole plug) in the engine block, with the heating element immersed in
coolant.
NOTE: The power cord must be secured in its retainer clips, and not positioned so it could contact
linkages or exhaust manifolds and become damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1362
Engine Block Heater: Testing and Inspection
If unit does not operate, trouble can be in either the power cord or the heater element. Test power
cord for continuity with a 110-volt voltmeter or 110volt test light; test heater element continuity with
an ohmmeter or 12-volt test light.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1363
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain coolant from radiator and cylinder block. 2. Detach power cord plug from heater. 3. Loosen
screw in center of heater. Remove heater assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Thoroughly clean core hole and heater seat. 2. Insert heater assembly with element loop
positioned upward. 3. With heater seated, tighten center screw securely to assure a positive seal.
4. Fill cooling system with coolant to the proper level, vent air, and inspect for leaks. Pressurize
system with Radiator Pressure Tool before looking
for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Core Plug <-->
[Expansion/Freeze Plug] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Core Plug: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Using a blunt tool such as a drift or a screwdriver and a hammer, strike the bottom edge of the cup
plug. With the cup plug rotated, grasp firmly with pliers or other suitable tool and remove plug.
CAUTION: Do not drive cup plug into the casting as restricted cooling can result and cause serious
engine Problems.
INSTALLATION
Thoroughly clean inside of cup plug hole in cylinder block or head. Be sure to remove old sealer.
Lightly coat inside of cup plug hole with sealer. Make certain the new plug is cleaned of all oil or
grease. Using proper drive plug, drive plug into hole so that the sharp edge of the plug is at least
0.5 mm (0.020 inch) inside the lead in chamfer. It is in not necessary to wait for curing of the
sealant. The cooling system can be refilled and the vehicle placed in service immediately.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications Torque
Torque
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt 105 ft.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1370
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
NOTE: If a gap is found in the crankshaft damper, in the area where the Poly-V Generator belt
rides this is normal and is acceptable.
REMOVAL
1. Remove accessory drive belts.
2. Raise vehicle on a hoist and remove right inner splash shield.
3. Remove crankshaft damper bolt. Remove damper using the large side of Special Tool 1026 and
insert 6827-A. or equivalents.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1371
INSTALLATION
1. Install crankshaft damper using M12-1.75 x 150 mm bolt, washer, thrust bearing and nut from
Special Tool 6792, or equivalent. Install crankshaft
damper bolt and tighten to 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
2. Install accessory drive belts. 3. Raise vehicle on hoist and install right inner splash shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1372
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Tools and Equipment
Puller 1026
Crankshaft Damper Removal Insert 6827-A
Crankshaft Damper Installer 6792
Crankshaft Damper Installer C-4685-C
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Clearance ............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.018 - 0.050 mm (0.0007 - 0.0020inch) Weight ............................................................
......................................................................................................... 340 - 350 grams (11.99 - 12.34
ounces) Head Land Clearance
................................................................................................................................................ 0.740 0.803 mm (0.029 - 0.031 inch)
PISTON RING GROOVE DEPTH
No. 1 ....................................................................................................................................................
.................. 3.983 - 4.132 mm (0.157 - 0.163 inch) No. 2 ....................................................................
.................................................................................................. 4.456 - 4.605 mm (0.175 - 0.181
inch) No. 3 ...........................................................................................................................................
........................... 3.841 - 4.075 mm (0.151 - 0.150 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1376
Piston: Description and Operation
This engine DOES NOT have provision for a free wheeling valve train. Non free wheeling valve
train means, in the event of a broken timing belt Pistons will contact the Valves. All engines use
pressed-in piston pins to attach forged powdered metal connecting rods. The connecting rods are a
cracked cap design and are not repairable. Hex head cap screw are used to provide alignment and
durability in the assembly.
NOTE: Pistons And Connecting rods are serviced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Piston: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a reliable ridge reamer before removing pistons from
cylinder block. Be sure to keep tops of pistons
covered during this operation. Mark piston with matching cylinder number.
2. Remove oil pan. Scribe the cylinder number on the side of the rod and cap for identification. 3.
Pistons will have a stamping in the approximate location shown. These stamps will be either a
directional arrow or a weight identification for the
assembly. L is for light and H is for heavy. These assemblies should all be the same weight class.
Service piston assemblies are marked with a S and can be used with either L or H production
assemblies. The weight designation stamps should face toward the timing belt side of the engine.
4. Pistons and connecting rods must be removed from top of cylinder block. Rotate crankshaft so
that each connecting rod is centered in cylinder
bore.
5. Remove connecting rod cap bolts Do not use old bolts if reinstalling connecting rod. Push each
piston and rod assembly out of cylinder bore.
NOTE: Be careful not to nick crankshaft journals.
6. After removal, install bearing cap on the mating rod. 7. Piston and Rods are serviced as an
assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing pistons and connecting rod assemblies into the bore, be sure that compression
ring gaps are staggered so that neither is in line
with oil ring rail gap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1379
2. Before installing the ring compressor, make sure the oil ring expander ends are butted and the
rail gaps located as shown.
3. Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil, slide the ring compressor, over the piston.
Be sure position of rings does not change during
this operation.
4. The weight stamp designation L or H will be in the front half of the piston should face toward the
front of the engine. 5. Rotate crankshaft so that the connecting rod journal is on the center of the
cylinder bore. Insert rod and piston assembly into cylinder bore and
guide rod over the crankshaft journal.
6. Tap the piston down in cylinder bore, using a hammer handle. At the same time, guide
connecting rod into position on connecting rod journal. 7. Install rod caps. Install New bolts and
tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft.lb.) Plus 1/4 turn.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1380
Piston: Service and Repair Fitting Pistons
Piston and cylinder wall must be clean and dry. Piston diameter should be measured 90 degrees to
piston pin about 17.5 mm (11/16 inch) from the bottom of the skirt as shown. Cylinder bores should
be measured halfway down the cylinder bore and transverse to the engine crankshaft center line
shown. Correct piston to bore clearance must be established in order to assure quiet and
economical operation.
NOTE:
- Chrysler engines use pistons designed specifically for each engine model. Clearance and sizing
locations vary with respect to engine model.
- Pistons and cylinder bores should be measured at normal room temperature, 21°C (70°F).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Clearance in Piston
................................................................................................................................................ 0.008 0.020 mm (0.0003 - 0.0008 inch) In Rod (Interference)
............................................................................................................................................. 0.018 0.043 mm (0.0007 - 0.0017 inch) Diameter
............................................................................................................................................................
20.998 - 21.003 mm (0.8267 - 0.8269 inch) End Play .........................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... None
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
..................... 74.75 - 75.25 mm (2.943 - 2.963 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
END GAP:
Top Compression Ring
............................................................................................................................................. 0.23 0.52 mm (0.009 - 0.020 inch) 2nd Compression Ring
.............................................................................................................................................. 0.49 0.78 mm (0.019 - 0.031 inch) Oil Control Steel Rails
.............................................................................................................................................. 0.23 0.66 mm (0.009 - 0.026 inch)
SIDE GROOVE CLEARANCE:
Compression Rings
........................................................................................................................................... 0.025 0.065 mm (0.0010 - 0.0026 inch) Oil Ring Pack
.................................................................................................................................................... 0.004
- 0.178 mm (0.0002 - 0.0070 inch)
RING WIDTH:
Compression Rings
................................................................................................................................................... 1.17 1.19 mm (0.046 - 0.047 inch) Oil Ring Pack
.................................................................................................................................................... 2.854
- 3.008 mm (0.1124 - 0.1184 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1387
Piston Ring: Description and Operation
The piston rings include a molybdenum faced top ring for reliable compression sealing and a taper
faced intermediate ring for additional cylinder pressure control. Oil Control Ring Package consist of
2 steel rails and a expander spacer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. ID mark on face of upper and intermediate piston rings must point toward piston crown.
2. Using a suitable ring expander, remove upper and intermediate piston rings. 3. Remove the
upper oil ring side rail, lower oil ring side rail and then oil ring expander from piston. 4. Clean ring
grooves of any carbon deposits.
INSTALLATION
1. Install rings with manufacturers I.D. mark facing up, to the top of the piston.
CAUTION: Install piston rings in the following order: a. Oil ring expander. b. Upper oil ring side rail.
c. Lower oil ring side rail. d. No. 2 Intermediate piston ring. e. No. 1 Upper piston ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1390
f. Install the side rail by placing one end between the piston ring groove and the expander. Hold
end firmly and press down the portion to be installed until side rail is in position. Do not use a piston
ring expander.
2. Install upper side rail first and then the lower side rail. 3. Install No. 2 piston ring and then No. 1
piston ring.
4. Position piston ring end gaps as shown in. 5. Position oil ring expander gap at least 45° from the
side rail gaps but not on the piston pin center or on the thrust direction. Staggering ring gap is
important for oil control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1391
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Fitting Piston Rings
END GAP
Wipe cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down with piston to ensure it is square in bore. The
ring gap measurement must be made with the ring positioning at least 12 mm (0.50 inch) from
bottom of cylinder bore. Check gap with feeler gauge.
SIDE GROOVE CLEARANCE
Check piston ring to groove side clearance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates this engine is equipped with hydraulic lifters or lash adjusters and
therefore does not require adjustment.
See "Rocker Arm: Service and Repair" for further information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1399
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Cam Follower <-->
[Rocker Arm Assembly] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cam Follower: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve cover using. 2. Remove timing belt, sprockets and covers. 3. Remove camshaft.
4. Remove cam follower assemblies from cylinder head. Keep the cam followers in the order they
have been removed from the head for reassembly.
Mark hydraulic lash adjusters for reassembly in their original position. Lash adjusters are serviced
as a assembly.
NOTE: Inspect the cam follower assembly for wear or damage. Replace as necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hydraulic lash adjuster assembly making sure that adjusters are at least partially full of oil.
This is indicated by little or no plunger travel
when the lash adjuster is Lubricated with clean oil and install cam follower assemblies in their
original position on the hydraulic adjuster and valve stem.
2. Install the camshafts.
NOTE:
- A tappet like noise may be produced from several items.
- Hydraulic Lash adjusters are replaced as an assembly and are not repaired.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Cover: Specifications
Cylinder Head Cover Bolts 105 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1406
Valve Cover: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not allow oil or solvents to contact the timing belt as they can deteriorate the rubber
and cause tooth skipping.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1407
Valve Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove ignition coil pack.
2. Remove the cylinder head cover fasteners. 3. Remove cylinder head cover from cylinder head.
NOTE: Before installation, clean cylinder head and cover mating surfaces. Make certain the rails
are flat.
INSTALLATION
1. Install new cylinder head cover gaskets.
CAUTION: Do not allow oil or solvents to contact the timing belt as they can deteriorate the rubber
and cause tooth skipping.
2. Apply Mopar Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant at the camshaft cap corners and at the top
edges of the 1/2 round seal. 3. Install cylinder head cover assembly to head and tighten fasteners
in sequence shown. Using the 3 step torque method:
- Step 1 Tighten all fasteners to 4.5 Nm (40 inch lbs.)
- Step 2 Tighten all fasteners to 9.0 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Step 3 Tighten all fasteners to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.)
4. Install ignition coil pack. Tighten fasteners to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1411
Valve Guide: Description and Operation
Incorporates powder metal valve guides.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1412
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
1. Remove carbon and varnish deposits from inside of valve guides with a reliable guide cleaner.
2. Using a small hole gauge and a micrometer, measure valve guides in 3 places top, middle and
bottom. Refer to specifications. Replace guides if they
are not within specification.
3. Check valve guide height.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications
Valve Seat: Specifications
Angle ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 44 1/2 - 45°
Runout (Max.) ......................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.050 mm (0.002 inch) Width (Finish) Intake and Exhaust
.................................................................................................................................... 0.9 - 1.3 mm
(0.035 - 0.051 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1416
Valve Seat: Description and Operation
Incorporates powder metal seats.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1417
Valve Seat: Service and Repair
1. When refacing valve seats, it is important the correct size valve guide pilot be used for reseating
stones. A true and complete surface must be
obtained.
2. Measure the concentricity of valve seat and valve guide using a valve seat runout dial indicator.
Total runout should not exceed 0.051 mm (0.002
inch) (total indicator reading).
3. Inspect the valve seat with Prussian blue to determine where the valve contacts the seat. To do
this, coat valve seat LIGHTLY with Prussian blue
then set valve in place. Rotate the valve with light pressure. If the blue is transferred to the center
of valve face, contact is satisfactory. If the blue is transferred to top edge of the valve face, lower
valve seat with a 15 degrees stone. If the blue is transferred to the bottom edge of valve face raise
valve seat with a 65 degrees stone. - Intake valve seat diameter is 34.37 - 34.63 mm (1.353 - 1.363
inch) - Exhaust valve seat diameter is 29.37 - 29.63 mm (1.156 - 1.166 inch)
4. Valve seats which are worn or burned can be reworked, provided that correct angle and seat
width are maintained. The intake valve seat must be
serviced when the valve seat width is 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) or greater. The exhaust valve seat must
be serviced when the valve seat width is 2.5 mm (0.098 inch) or greater. Otherwise the cylinder
head must be replaced.
5. When seat is properly positioned the width of intake and exhaust seats should be 0.90 - 1.30
mm (0.035 - 0.051 inch).
6. Check valve tip to spring seat dimensions A after grinding the valve seats or faces. Grind valve
tip to 47.99 mm (1.889 inch) for exhaust valve and
48.04 mm (1.891 inch) for intake valve over spring seat when installed in the head. The valve tip
chamfer may need to be reground to prevent seal damage when the valve is installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Spring: > 18-18-99 > Aug > 99 > Engine
- MIL ON Misfire DTC's Stored
Valve Spring: Customer Interest Engine - MIL ON Misfire DTC's Stored
NUMBER: 18-18-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 13, 1999
SUBJECT: Multiple Cylinder Misfire Due to Carbon Deposits
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying PCM software and installing revised valve springs.
MODELS:
1997 - 1999 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC ENGINE BUILT
PRIOR TO NOVEMBER 3, 1998 (MDH 11O3XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Engine roughness/misfire usually only apparent on initial cold engine start. May be accompanied
by a MIL illumination for SINGLE or MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE DTC's.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and/or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB
III(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems
are functioning as designed. If non-misfire related DTC's are present, record them on the repair
order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If SINGLE or MULTIPLE
CYLINDER MISFIRE DTC's are present, follow all misfire diagnostics listed in the appropriate
Diagnostic Procedures Manual and verify TSB 18-47-98 has been completed before performing
this Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
16 04777555AB Valve Spring
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Replace all Valve springs as described on page 9-83 of the 1999 Neon service manual
(Publication No. 81-270-0125).
NOTE:
ALL VALVE SPRINGS MUST BE REPLACED ASA SET WHEN INSTALLING THE REVISED
SPRING. FOR REFERENCE, THE REVISED SPRING IS 49.3 MM (+/- 1 MM) IN LENGTH WITH
A SINGLE GREEN OR YELLOW STRIPE.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 09-95-20-93 3.8 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Spring: > 18-18-99 > Aug >
99 > Engine - MIL ON Misfire DTC's Stored
Valve Spring: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - MIL ON Misfire DTC's Stored
NUMBER: 18-18-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 13, 1999
SUBJECT: Multiple Cylinder Misfire Due to Carbon Deposits
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying PCM software and installing revised valve springs.
MODELS:
1997 - 1999 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC ENGINE BUILT
PRIOR TO NOVEMBER 3, 1998 (MDH 11O3XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Engine roughness/misfire usually only apparent on initial cold engine start. May be accompanied
by a MIL illumination for SINGLE or MULTIPLE CYLINDER MISFIRE DTC's.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and/or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB
III(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems
are functioning as designed. If non-misfire related DTC's are present, record them on the repair
order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If SINGLE or MULTIPLE
CYLINDER MISFIRE DTC's are present, follow all misfire diagnostics listed in the appropriate
Diagnostic Procedures Manual and verify TSB 18-47-98 has been completed before performing
this Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
16 04777555AB Valve Spring
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Replace all Valve springs as described on page 9-83 of the 1999 Neon service manual
(Publication No. 81-270-0125).
NOTE:
ALL VALVE SPRINGS MUST BE REPLACED ASA SET WHEN INSTALLING THE REVISED
SPRING. FOR REFERENCE, THE REVISED SPRING IS 49.3 MM (+/- 1 MM) IN LENGTH WITH
A SINGLE GREEN OR YELLOW STRIPE.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 09-95-20-93 3.8 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1431
Valve Spring: Specifications
Free Length .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 46 mm (1.811 inch) Spring Tension:
Valve Closed ...................................................................................................................................
246 - 270 N @ 38.0 mm (55 - 60 lbs. @ 1.496 inch) Valve Open
.................................................................................................................................... 549 - 611 N @
29.3 mm (123 - 137 lbs. @ 1.53 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Off
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Cylinder Head Off
REMOVAL
1. With cylinder head removed, compress valve springs using Special Tool MD 998735 or
equivalent. 2. Remove valve retaining locks, valve spring retainers, valve stem seals and valve
springs. 3. Before removing valves, remove any burrs from valve stem lock grooves to prevent
damage to the valve guides. Identify valves to insure
installation in original location.
INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert in cylinder head.
2. Install new valve stem seals on all valves using a valve stem seal tool. The valve stem seals
should be pushed firmly and squarely over valve guide.
CAUTION: If oversize valves are used, there is only one oversize valve available. The same stem
seal is used on both the standard and oversize valve.
3. Install valve springs and retainers. Compress valve springs only enough to install locks, taking
care not to misalign the direction of compression.
Nicked valve stems may result from misalignment of the valve spring compressor.
CAUTION: When depressing the valve spring retainers with valve spring compressor the locks can
become dislocated. Check to make sure both locks are in their correct location after removing tool.
4. Check the valve spring installed height B after refacing the valve and seat. Make sure
measurements are taken from top of spring seat to the
bottom surface of spring retainer. If height is greater than 38.75 mm (1.525 inch), install 7.620 mm
(0.030 inch) spacer under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back within specification.
5. Install cam followers and camshaft. 6. Checking dry lash. Dry lash is the amount of clearance
that exists between the base circle of an installed cam and the rocker arm roller when the
adjuster is drained of oil and completely collapsed.
NOTE: Specified dry lash is 1.17 mm (0.046 inch) for intake and 1.28 mm (0.050 inch) for exhaust.
After performing dry lash check, refill adjuster with oil and allow 10 minutes for adjuster or adjusters
to bleed down before rotating cam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Off > Page 1434
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Cylinder Head On
REMOVAL
1. Remove camshafts. 2. Rotate crankshaft until piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC) on
compression. 3. With air hose attached to adapter tool installed in spark plug hole, apply 90 - 120
psi air pressure.
4. Using Special Tool MD998772A with adapter 6779, or equivalents compress valve springs and
remove valve locks. 5. Remove valve spring.
6. Remove valve stem seal by using a valve stem seal tool.
INSTALLATION
1. Install valve seal/valve spring seat assembly. 2. Install valve spring and retainer. Using Special
Tool MD998772A, or equivalent compress valve springs only enough to install locks. Correct
alignment of tool is necessary to avoid nicking valve stems (air pressure required), piston at TDC.
3. Remove air hose and install spark plugs. 4. Install camshafts. 5. Install cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Off > Page 1435
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Inspection
1. Whenever valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve
springs should be tested Special Tool C-647, or equivalent.
NOTE: As an example, the compression length of the spring to be tested is 33.34 mm (1-5/16
inches). Turn tool table until surface is in line with the 33.34 mm (1-5/16 inch) mark on the threaded
stud and the zero mark on the front.
Place spring over stud on the table and lift compressing lever to set tone device. Pull on torque
wrench until ping is heard. Take reading on torque wrench at this instant. Multiply this reading by
two. This will give the spring load at test length. Fractional measurements are indicated on the
table for finer adjustments. Discard the springs that do not meet specifications. The Following
specifications apply to both intake and exhaust valve springs . - Valve Closed Nominal Force: 58
lbs. @ 38.0 mm (1.50 inch) - Valve Open Nominal Force: 130 lbs. @ 29.25 mm (1.17 inch)
2. Verify springs are not distorted with a steel square and surface plate, check springs from both
ends. If the spring is more than 1.5 mm (1/16 inch) out
of square, install a new spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1436
Valve Spring: Tools and Equipment
Valve Spring Compressor MD-998772-A
Spring Compressor Adapter 6779
Valve Spring Compressor C-3575-A
Valve Spring Tester C-647
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1440
Valve: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
Four valves per cylinder are actuated by roller cam followers which pivot on stationary hydraulic
lash adjusters.
VALVE SIZES
All valves have 6 mm diameter chrome plated valve stems. The valve sizes are 34.8 mm (1.370
inch) diameter intake valves and 30.5 mm (1.20 inch) diameter exhaust valves.
COMPONENTS
Viton rubber valve stem seals are integral with the spring seats. Valve springs, spring retainers,
and locks are conventional.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1441
Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Clean valves thoroughly and discard burned, warped and cracked valves. 2. Measure valve
stems for wear. Measure stem about 60 mm beneath the valve lock grooves. 3. If valve stems are
worn more than 0.05 mm (0.002 inch), replace valve.
NOTE: Clean all valve guides, valves and valve spring assemblies thoroughly with suitable
cleaning solution before reassembling.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Valve: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. With cylinder head removed, compress valve springs using Special Tool MD 998735 or
equivalent. 2. Remove valve retaining locks, valve spring retainers, valve stem seals and valve
springs. 3. Before removing valves, remove any burrs from valve stem lock grooves to prevent
damage to the valve guides. Identify valves to insure
installation in original location.
INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert in cylinder head.
2. Install new valve stem seals on all valves using a valve stem seal tool. The valve stem seals
should be pushed firmly and squarely over valve guide.
CAUTION: If oversize valves are used, there is only one oversize valve available. The same stem
seal is used on both the standard and oversize valve.
3. Install valve springs and retainers. Compress valve springs only enough to install locks, taking
care not to misalign the direction of compression.
Nicked valve stems may result from misalignment of the valve spring compressor.
CAUTION: When depressing the valve spring retainers with valve spring compressor the locks can
become dislocated. Check to make sure both locks are in their correct location after removing tool.
4. Check the valve spring installed height B after refacing the valve and seat. Make sure
measurements are taken from top of spring seat to the
bottom surface of spring retainer. If height is greater than 38.75 mm (1.525 inch), install 7.620 mm
(0.030 inch) spacer under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back within specification.
5. Install cam followers and camshaft. 6. Checking dry lash. Dry lash is the amount of clearance
that exists between the base circle of an installed cam and the rocker arm roller when the
adjuster is drained of oil and completely collapsed.
NOTE: Specified dry lash is 1.17 mm (0.046 inch) for intake and 1.28 mm (0.050 inch) for exhaust.
After performing dry lash check, refill adjuster with oil and allow 10 minutes for adjuster or adjusters
to bleed down before rotating cam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1444
Valve: Service and Repair Refacing Valves and Valve Seats
1. The intake and exhaust valve seats and valve face have a 45 and a 45 1/2 degree angles. 2.
Inspect the remaining margin after the valves are refaced. Intake valves with less than 1.2 mm
(3/64 inch) margin and Exhaust valves with less than
0.9 mm (1/32 inch) margin should be discarded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97
> Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Drive Belt: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97
> Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist > Page 1454
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: >
07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: >
07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist > Page 1460
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1461
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1462
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
If the engine is equipped with power steering or air conditioning, it will have 2 drive belts. One belt
drives the generator, the other drives the Power Steering and Air Conditioning.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1463
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required, excessive wear, frayed
cords or severe glazing. Poly-V-Belt system with back drive pulley may develop minor cracks
across the ribbed side (due to reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and
acceptable. Cracks parallel are not.
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V-Belt and V-Belt
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment
Drive Belt: Adjustments A/C Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment > Page 1466
Drive Belt: Adjustments Alternator Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Belt Adjustment > Page 1467
Drive Belt: Adjustments Power Steering Pump Belt Adjustment
PROPER BELT TENSION
Satisfactory performance of the belt driven accessories depends on belt condition and proper belt
tension. Refer to Accessory Drive Belt Inspection in this section. There are two belt tensioning
methods given in order of preference: Belt tension gauge method.
- Torque equivalent method.
NOTE: The belt tension gauge method usually requires the vehicle to be raised on a hoist and the
splash shield removed.
TORQUE EQUIVALENT METHOD
Adjustable accessory brackets provided with a 13 mm (1/2 inch) square hole for a torque wrench
can use an equivalent torque value for belt adjustment. Equivalent torque values for adjusting
these accessory drive belts are specified in above image.
BELT TENSION GAUGE METHOD
Use belt tensioning Special Tool Kit C-4162 for conventional belts and Poly-V-belts. Adjust the belt
tension for a New or Used belt as prescribed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair A/C Belt
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C to remove and install belt
and/or adjust belt tension. 2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the
square D hole on the power steering pivot bracket. Adjust tension to
specification.
3. Tighten in order, first tighten locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Then pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt > Page 1470
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Alternator Belt
1. Loosen pivot bolt E then locking nut F and adjusting bolt G to remove and install belt and/or
adjust belt tension. 2. Tighten adjusting bolt G. Adjust belt tension to specification. 3. Tighten pivot
bolt E to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). Locking nut F to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Belt > Page 1471
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Belt
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C to remove and install belt
and/or adjust belt tension. 2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the
square D hole on the power steering pivot bracket. Adjust tension to
specification.
3. Tighten in order, first tighten locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Then pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1472
Belt Tension Gauge C-4162
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Power Hop Damper <--> [Engine Torque Strut] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Hop Damper: Service and Repair
NOTE: Power hop damper is used on manual transmission vehicle only.
1. Remove the thru-bolt and nut from the front suspension crossmember. 2. Remove the damper
nut and grommets. Remove the damper. 3. Remove the power hop damper bracket, if necessary.
4. Reverse removal procedure for installation. Tighten all bolts and nuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Minimum Oil Pressure At Idle Engine Warm
............................................................................................................................................. 78 kPa
(11.4 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1481
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove oil pressure switch and install gauge assembly C-3292, or equivalent with adaptor. 2.
Run engine until thermostat opens.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not perform the 3000 RPM test in the next step.
3. Oil Pressure:
- Curb Idle 25 kPa (4 psi) minimum - 3000 RPM 170 - 550 kPa (25 - 80 psi).
4. If oil pressure is 0 at idle. Shut off engine, check for pressure relief valve stuck open, a clogged
oil pick-up screen or a damaged oil pick-up tube
O-ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Drain Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Drain Plug: Specifications
To Pan .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter Change ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.2L (4.5 Qt)
Capacity shown is without filter. When replacing filter, additional oil may be needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 1489
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification
..............................................................................................................................................................
SJ ECII or SJ/CD ECII or Above Above -10°F (-23°C).........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 10W-30 Below 100°F
(38°C)...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 5W-30
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1490
Engine Oil: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use non-detergent or straight mineral oil when adding or changing crankcase
lubricant. Engine failure can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1491
Engine Oil: Description and Operation
CAUTION: Do not use non-detergent or straight mineral oil when adding or changing crankcase
lubricant. Engine failure can result.
API SERVICE GRADE CERTIFIED
Use an engine oil that is API Service Grade Certified or an oil that conforms to the API Service
Grade SH or SH/CD.
SAE VISCOSITY
An SAE viscosity grade is used to specify the viscosity of engine oil. SAE 30 specifies a single
viscosity engine oil. Engine oils also have multiple viscosities. These are specified with a dual SAE
viscosity grade which indicates the cold-to-hot temperature viscosity range. Select an engine oil
that is best suited to your particular temperature range and variation.
ENERGY CONSERVING OIL
An Energy Conserving type oil is recommended for gasoline engines. They are designated as
either ENERGY CONSERVING or ENERGY CONSERVING II.
CONTAINER IDENTIFICATION
Standard engine oil identification notations have been adopted to aid in the proper selection of
engine oil. The identifying notations are located on the label of engine oil plastic bottles and the top
of engine oil cans.
ENGINE OIL ADDITIVES
In some instances, such as infrequent operation, short trip driving, and during break-in after a
major overhaul, addition of special materials containing anti-rust and anti-scuff additives are
beneficial.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1492
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
The best time to check engine oil level is after it has sat overnight, or if the engine has been
running, allow the engine to be shut off for at least 5 minutes before checking oil level.
NOTE: Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil
level reading. Add only when the level is at or below the ADD mark.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1493
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
CHANGING ENGINE OIL
Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 1. Position the vehicle on a level surface
and turn engine off. 2. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. Refer. to Hoisting and Jacking
Recommendations. 3. Remove oil fill cap. 4. Place a suitable drain pan under crankcase drain. 5.
Remove drain plug from crankcase and allow oil to drain into pan. Inspect drain plug threads for
stretching or other damage. Replace drain
plug and gasket if damaged.
6. Install drain plug in crankcase. 7. Lower vehicle and fill crankcase with specified type and
amount of engine oil. 8. Install oil fill cap. 9. Start engine and inspect for leaks.
10. Stop engine and inspect oil level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Filter: Specifications
To Adapter ...........................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1497
Oil Filter: Description and Operation
All engines are equipped with a high quality full flow, disposable type oil filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1498
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When servicing the oil filter avoid deforming the filter, install tool band strap against the
seam at the base of the filter. The seam, joining the can to the base is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Turn counter clockwise to remove. 2. To install, lubricate new filter gasket. Check filter mounting
surface. The surface must be smooth, flat and free of debris or old pieces of rubber.
Screw filter on until gasket contacts base. Tighten to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Filter Adapter: Specifications
Fastener ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 80 Nm (60 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1502
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Ensure O-ring is in the groove on adapter. Align roll pin into engine block and tighten assembly to
80 Nm (60 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1506
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine oil. 2. Remove transmission bending bracket. 3. Remove front engine mount and
bracket. 4. Remove transmission inspection cover. 5. If equipped with air conditioning remove oil
filter and adapter. 6. Remove oil pan. 7. Clean oil pan and all gasket surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant or equivalent at the oil pump to engine block
parting line. 2. Install a new oil pan gasket to pan. 3. Install pan and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105
inch lbs.). 4. Install oil filter and adapter. 5. Install transmission inspection cover. 6. Install front
engine mount and bracket. 7. Install transmission bending bracket. 8. Install proper Amount of oil.
- With oil filter 4.25 Liters (4.5 Qts.).
- Without oil filter 3.8 Liters (4.0 Qts.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The low oil pressure lamp is used to indicate to the operator that the engine oil pressure has
dropped below a predetermined pressure. Power for the lamp is provided on the G5 circuit which
also powers the other warning lamps.
When the oil pressure is low the normally OPEN oil pressure switch CLOSES completing a path to
ground on circuit G6. The oil pressure switch is case grounded to the engine block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
CAUTION: Disconnect the battery negative cable before servicing the instrument panel or
components. When power is required for test purposes, connect battery cable for test only.
Disconnect the battery negative cable afier test and before continuing service procedures.
The low oil pressure warning lamp will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a
safe oil pressure level.
Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine. If the wire
at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper wire,
ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check the
warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket in
the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test > Page 1512
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Warning Circuit
The low fuel warning lamp receives its-signal from the fuel gauge drive circuit. Due to production
variations, the point where the lamp illuminates, may vary from 1/16 to 3/16 mark on the fuel
gauge. There is a built in time delay before the lamp illuminates. This prevents the lamp from going
on and off under various road conditions.
1. Verify that the fuel gauge is operating properly 2. Check the low fuel warning lamp assembly. 3.
If the lamp still does not function under a low fuel condition replace the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Minimum Oil Pressure At Idle Engine Warm
............................................................................................................................................. 78 kPa
(11.4 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1517
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove oil pressure switch and install gauge assembly C-3292, or equivalent with adaptor. 2.
Run engine until thermostat opens.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not perform the 3000 RPM test in the next step.
3. Oil Pressure:
- Curb Idle 25 kPa (4 psi) minimum - 3000 RPM 170 - 550 kPa (25 - 80 psi).
4. If oil pressure is 0 at idle. Shut off engine, check for pressure relief valve stuck open, a clogged
oil pick-up screen or a damaged oil pick-up tube
O-ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Oil
Pressure Regulator Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Aluminum Engine - Gasket Surface Preparation
Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Aluminum Engine - Gasket Surface Preparation
NO: 09-09-97
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Gasket Surface Preparation On Aluminum Engine Components
MODELS: 1995
(AA) Acclaim/Spirit
1995 (AJ) Lebaron Convertible
1995 (AS) Caravan/Voyager/Town & Country
1995 - 1998 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - 1998 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker
1996 - 1998 (NS) Caravan/Voyager/Town & Country
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
DISCUSSION: Many aluminum engine components are being received by the material return
center with gouges, scratches, and out of flat conditions on the sealing surface. Caution must be
exercised when cleaning aluminum engine components. The use of solvents and plastic or wooden
scrapers are the only approved methods for removing gasket material.
NOTE:
DO NOT USE METAL SCRAPERS GRINDING DISCS OR ABRASIVES TO CLEAN ALUMINUM
ENGINE COMPONENTS. DAMAGE TO THE SEALING SURFACE WILL OCCUR.
Engine components received by the material return center will be evaluated for appropriate gasket
removal procedures. Components returned with obvious damage caused by improper gasket
removal procedures may be denied for warranty reimbursement.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Intake Manifold: Mechanical Specifications
Machining Specifications
TORQUE:
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................ 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.)
FLATNESS:
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................. 0.15 mm (0.006 inch) or less Wear Limit ..........................................................
............................................................................................................................... 0.2 mm (0.008
inch)
Intake Manifold Bolts/Nuts 250 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 1527
Intake Manifold: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Intake Manifold Vacuum (Min.) ............................................................................................................
.................................................... 60 kPa (18 in-Hg)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1528
Intake Manifold: Description and Operation
The intake manifold is a two piece aluminum casting, attached to the cylinder head with ten
fasteners. This long branch fan design enhances low and midspeed torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1529
Intake Manifold: Testing and Inspection
LEAKAGE DIAGNOSIS
An intake manifold air leak is characterized by lower than normal manifold vacuum. Also, one or
more cylinders may not be functioning.
WARNING: USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN THE ENGINE IS OPERATING. DO NOT STAND IN
A DIRECT LINE WITH THE FAN. DO NOT PUT YOUR HANDS NEAR THE PULLEYS, BELTS OR
THE FAN. DO NOT WEAR LOOSE CLOTHING.
1. Start the engine. 2. Spray a small stream of water (Spray Bottle) at the suspected leak area. 3. If
a change in RPM'S, the area of the suspected leak has been found. 4. Repair as required.
GENERAL INSPECTION
Check for: Damage and cracks of each section.
- Clogged water passages in end crossovers (if equipped).
- Check for cylinder head mounting surface distortion using a straightedge and thickness gauge.
CLEANING
Remove the gasket material from the manifold surfaces. Be careful not to gouge or scratch the
sealing surface.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cleaning and Inspection
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
- Inspect manifold for cracks or distortions. - Check for torn gasket at the mating surface of the
manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cleaning and Inspection > Page 1532
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair Intake Manifold Replacement
Removal
WARNING: RELEASE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE BEFORE SERVICING FUEL SYSTEM
COMPONENTS. SERVICE VEHICLES IN WELL VENTILATED AREAS AND AVOID IGNITION
SOURCES. NEVER SMOKE WHILE SERVICING THE VEHICLE.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap.
3. Remove fresh air inlet duct. Remove wing nut on intake.
4. Remove the protective cap from the fuel pressure test port on the fuel rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cleaning and Inspection > Page 1533
5. Place the open end of fuel pressure release hose, tool number C- 4799-1, into an approved
gasoline container. Connect the other end of hose to the
fuel pressure test port. Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container.
Fuel gauge C-4799-A contains hose C-4799-1, or equivalents.
6. Disconnect the fuel supply line-connect at fuel tube assembly. 7. Remove clean air inlet duct.
CAUTION: Wrap shop towels around hose to catch any gasoline spillage.
8. Disconnect the coolant temperature sensor. 9. Remove fuel rail assembly attaching screws and
remove fuel rail assembly from engine. Cover injector holes with suitable covering.
CAUTION: Do not set fuel injectors on their tips, damage may occur to the injectors
10. Remove accelerator, kickdown and speed control cables from throttle lever and bracket. 11.
Remove throttle body.
12. Disconnect Idle Air Control (IAC) motor and Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) wiring connectors.
13. Disconnect vacuum hoses from throttle body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cleaning and Inspection > Page 1534
14. Disconnect Manifold Absolute Pressure/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (TMAP) electrical
connector. Disconnect vapor and brake booster hoses.
15. Disconnect knock sensor electrical connector and disconnect wiring harness from tab located
OI1 the intake manifold. 16. Disconnect wiring from starter.
17. Remove EGR tube bolts at the valve and at the intake manifold. Remove tube from engine. 18.
Remove intake manifold fastener. Remove intake manifold.
Installation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cleaning and Inspection > Page 1535
NOTE: Before installing manifold. Clean all mating surfaces. Replace all gaskets, with new.
1. Install intake manifold onto cylinder head and tighten fasteners to 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) in
sequence shown. 2. Remove covering from fuel injector holes and insure the holes are clean.
Install fuel rail assembly to intake manifold. Tighten screws to 23 Nm (200
inch lbs.).
3. Connect PCV and brake booster hoses. 4. Inspect quick connect fittings for damage, replace if
necessary. Lube tube with clean 30w engine oil, Connect fuel supply hose to fuel rail assembly.
Check connection by pulling on connector to insure it locked into position.
5. Install throttle body. Tighten fastener to 22 Nm (200 inch lbs.). 6. Connect Manifold Absolute
Pressure/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (TMAP) wiring connector. 7. Connect knock sensor
connector and starter wires. Connect wiring harness to intake manifold tab. 8. Connect Idle Air
Control (IAC) motor and Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) wiring connectors. 9. Connect vacuum
hoses to throttle body.
10. Install accelerator, kickdown and speed control cables to their bracket and connect them to the
throttle lever. 11. Loose assemble the EGR tube onto valve and intake manifold finger tight.
Tighten tube fasteners at the EGR valve first to 11 Nm (95 inch lbs.) then,
tighten the intake manifold side fasteners to 11 Nm (95 inch lbs.).
12. Install clean air duct. 13. Install fresh air duct to air filter housing. Tighten clamp to 3 Nm (25
inch lbs.). 14. Connect negative battery cable. 15. With the Diagnostic Readout Box (DRB) scan
tool use Auto Shutdown (ASD) Fuel System Test to pressurize system to check for leaks.
CAUTION: When using the ASD Fuel System Test, the ASD relay will remain energized for 7
minutes or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, or Stop All Test is selected.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The low oil pressure lamp is used to indicate to the operator that the engine oil pressure has
dropped below a predetermined pressure. Power for the lamp is provided on the G5 circuit which
also powers the other warning lamps.
When the oil pressure is low the normally OPEN oil pressure switch CLOSES completing a path to
ground on circuit G6. The oil pressure switch is case grounded to the engine block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
CAUTION: Disconnect the battery negative cable before servicing the instrument panel or
components. When power is required for test purposes, connect battery cable for test only.
Disconnect the battery negative cable afier test and before continuing service procedures.
The low oil pressure warning lamp will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a
safe oil pressure level.
Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine. If the wire
at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper wire,
ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check the
warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket in
the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test > Page
1542
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Warning Circuit
The low fuel warning lamp receives its-signal from the fuel gauge drive circuit. Due to production
variations, the point where the lamp illuminates, may vary from 1/16 to 3/16 mark on the fuel
gauge. There is a built in time delay before the lamp illuminates. This prevents the lamp from going
on and off under various road conditions.
1. Verify that the fuel gauge is operating properly 2. Check the low fuel warning lamp assembly. 3.
If the lamp still does not function under a low fuel condition replace the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Front Cam Seal Retainer - New Design
Camshaft Oil Seal: Technical Service Bulletins Front Cam Seal Retainer - New Design
NUMBER: 09-008-00
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Jan. 12, 2001
SUBJECT: Front Cam Seal Retention
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installation of a new component to assist cam seal retention.
MODELS:
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS EQUIPPED WITH A 1.8 OR 2.0L SOHC ENGINE.
DISCUSSION: A new cam seal retainer has been released to retain the front cam seal on 1.8L or
2.0L SOHC engines. Whenever a cam seal is replaced, a retainer should be installed to provide
positive retention.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Upon engine re-assembly after front cam seal installation, install the retainer p/n 5016733AA
using the inner cover fasteners as shown in (Fig. 1)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Front Cam Seal Retainer - New Design > Page 1548
2. Torque the fasteners to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
3. Complete the re-assembly following the applicable service manual.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1549
Camshaft Oil Seal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove front timing belt cover and timing belt.
CAUTION: Before removing timing belt set crankshaft sprocket 3 notches before Top Dead Center
(TDC), this will prevent possible engine damage.
2. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tool C-4687 and adaptor C4687-1, or equivalents while
removing / installing bolts.
3. Remove camshaft seal using a pry bar. Be careful not to nick or damage the camshaft seal
surface or cylinder head seal retaining bore.
CAUTION: Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal bore.
4. Shaft seal lip surface must be free of varnish, dirt or nicks. Polish with 400 grit paper if
necessary.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1550
1. Install camshaft seal into cylinder head using Special Tool MD 998713, or equivalent until flush
with the head. 2. Install camshaft sprockets and tighten attaching bolts to 101 Nm (75 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1551
Camshaft Seal Installer MD-998713
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Rear Crankshaft Seal
<--> [Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Rear Crankshaft Seal: Description and Operation
Hydrodynamic seals provide end sealing, where the crankshaft exits the block. Anaerobic gasket
material is used for parting line sealing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Rear Crankshaft Seal
<--> [Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1555
Rear Crankshaft Seal: Testing and Inspection
Since it is sometimes difficult to determine the source of an oil leak in the rear seal area of the
engine, a more involved inspection is necessary. The following steps should be followed to help
pinpoint the source of the leak. If the leakage occurs at the crankshaft rear oil seal area:
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove torque converter or clutch housing cover
and inspect rear of block for evidence of oil. Use a black light to check for the oil leak. If a leak
is present in this area remove transmission for further inspection. a. Circular spray pattern
generally indicates seal leakage or crankshaft damage. b. Where leakage tends to run straight
down, possible causes are a porous block, oil galley cup plug, bedplate to cylinder block mating
surfaces
and seal bore. See proper repair procedures for these items.
4. If no leaks are detected, pressurized the crankcase.
CAUTION: Do not exceed 20.6 kPa (3 psi).
5. If the leak is not detected, very slowly turn the crankshaft and watch for leakage. If a leak is
detected between the crankshaft and seal while slowly
turning the crankshaft, it is possible the crankshaft seal surface is damaged. The seal area on the
crankshaft could have minor nicks or scratches that can be polished out with emery cloth.
CAUTION: Use extreme caution when crankshaft polishing is necessary to remove minor nicks and
scratches. The crankshaft seal flange is especially machined to complement the function of the
rear oil seal.
6. For bubbles that remain steady with shaft rotation, no further inspection can be done until
disassembled. 7. After the oil leak root cause and appropriate corrective action have been
identified. Replace rear main seal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Rear Crankshaft Seal
<--> [Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1556
Rear Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Insert a 3/16 flat bladed screwdriver between the dust lip and the metal case of the crankshaft
seal. Angle the screwdriver through the dust lip
against metal case of the seal. Pry out seal.
CAUTION: Do not permit the screwdriver blade to contact crankshaft seal surface. Contact of the
screwdriver blade against crankshaft edge (chamfer) is permitted.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If burr or scratch is present on the crankshaft edge (chamfer), cleanup with 400 grit
sand paper to prevent seal damage during installation of new seal.
NOTE: When installing seal, no lube on seal is needed.
1. Place Special Tool 6926-1, or equivalent on crankshaft. This is a pilot tool with a magnetic base.
2. Position seal over pilot tool. Make sure you can read the words THIS SIDE OUT on seal. Pilot
tool should remain on crankshaft during
installation of seal. Ensure that the lip of the seal is facing towards the crankcase during
installation.
CAUTION: If the seal is driven into the block past flush, this may cause an oil leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Rear Crankshaft Seal
<--> [Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1557
3. Drive the seal into the block using Special Tool 6926-2 and handle C-4171, or equivalents until
the tool bottoms out against the block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Rear Crankshaft Seal
<--> [Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1558
Rear Crankshaft Seal Guide and Installer 6926-1 and 6926-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Cylinder Head Gasket
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Multi Layer Steel Head Gasket - Installation Procedures
Technical Service Bulletin # 09-08-99 Date: 990917
Multi Layer Steel Head Gasket - Installation Procedures
NUMBER: 09-08-99
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Sep. 17, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-05-98, DATED NOV. 6,
1998, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1998
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-99003). ALL
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE PART NUMBER
REVISIONS AND MODEL ADDITIONS.
SUBJECT: Multi-Layer Steel (MLS) Head Gasket Installation Procedures
MODELS:
**1995 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995-2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED) OR 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION: Multi-Layer Steel (MLS) head gaskets have been developed and released for use
on the above models. The MLS gasket was released for production, as a running change, in the
1999 model year for all models except FJ.
This new gasket provides superior sealing characteristics, but will require extra care in their
installation where a composite gasket was previously in place. The following steps outline the
proper installation of this MLS gasket.
CAUTION:
ALUMINUM ENGINE COMPONENTS ARE SUSCEPTIBLE TO METAL TRANSFER AND
SURFACE DAMAGE WHEN OLD GASKET MATERIAL IS REMOVED FROM THEM. USE
EXTREME CARE WHEN CLEANING GASKET MATERIAL FROM ALUMINUM COMPONENTS.
THE MLS GASKET CANNOT PROPERLY SEAL IF GOUGING OF SURFACES, METAL
TRANSFER, OR COMPOSITE GASKET MATERIAL IS LEFT ON THE HEAD OR BLOCK
SURFACES.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Cylinder Head Gasket
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Multi Layer Steel Head Gasket - Installation Procedures > Page
1563
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 NPN Plastic/Wooden Scraper
AR(1) 07528 2" 3M Roloc Bristle Disc White (For Aluminum Surfaces)
AR(1) 07525 2" 3M Roloc Bristle Disc Yellow (For Aluminum/Cast Iron/Steel Surfaces)
1 05539 2" 3M Roloc Bristle Disc Arbor
1 NPN Drill Motor
POLICY: Information Only.
Repair Procedure
This bulletin outlines the proper procedures for preparing head/block surfaces for MLS gasket
installation.
1. Following service manual procedures, remove the head.
2. Remove as much of the loose composite gasket material with a plastic or wooden scraper.
NOTE:
PRIOR TO ADDITIONAL CLEANING, INSPECT THE COOLING PASSAGES OF THE HEAD.
REPLACEMENT MAY BE NECESSARY IF EXCESSIVE PITTING OR EROSION HAS TAKEN
PLACE THAT WILL COMPROMISE THE SEALING SURFACES AROUND THE COOLING
PASSAGES.
3. Cover coolant and oil passages to the best of your ability and apply solvent or a commercially
available gasket cleaner to the head/block surfaces. Allow the solvent to soften the remaining
composite gasket material.
4. Using a plastic or wooden scraper, scrape the composite gasket residue from the surfaces. If
necessary, apply additional solvent or gasket remover to ease removal.
5. If additional cleaning is needed, use a drill motor and 3M Roloc bristle disc p/n 07528 (white) to
carefully remove the remaining gasket material from the head and block surfaces.
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Cylinder Head Gasket
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Multi Layer Steel Head Gasket - Installation Procedures > Page
1564
IF DIFFICULT TO REMOVE RESIDUE IS LEFT, THE YELLOW ROLOC BRISTLE DISK 3M P/N
07525 CAN BE USED. USE EXTREME CARE WHEN POWER CLEANING ALUMINUM
SURFACES TO PREVENT METAL TRANSFER.
6. Inspect the sealing surfaces for any remaining composite gasket residue. Carefully remove any
remaining material.
7. The head and block must be checked for flatness. Follow service manual
procedures/specifications where applicable.
8. Spray both sides of the MLS gasket with a coat of MOPAR spray gasket sealant p/n 04318035.
9. Re-assemble the engine as outlined in the appropriate service manual. Pay particular attention
to head bolt torque and torqueing procedures. All head bolts should be oiled prior to assembly.
NOTE:
THE 2.0L DOHC TORQUE AND TORQUING PROCEDURE HAS CHANGED WITH THE
INSTALLATION OF A MLS GASKET. USE THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURES FOR THE 2.0L
DOHC ONLY.
2.OL DOHC TORQUE PROCEDURE WITH MLS GASKET INSTALLATION
NOTE:
THE 4 SHORT BOLTS ARE PLACED IN THE CORNERS.
A. Torque all center bolts to 34 Nm (25 Ft Lbs), Torque the 4 corner bolts to 27 Nm (20 Ft Lbs) see
Fig 1 for torque sequence.
B. Torque all center bolts to 68 Nm (50 Ft Lbs), Torque the 4 corner bolts to 47 Nm (35 Ft Lbs) see
Fig 1 for torque sequence.
C. Re-torque all center bolts to 68 Nm (50 Ft Lbs), Re-torque the 4 corner bolts to 47 Nm (35 Ft
Lbs) see Fig 1 for torque sequence.
D. Tighten all bolts in the specified sequence (Fig 1) an additional 90° (1/4 turn).
10. Make sure the cam sensor seal is replaced on all engine applications.
NOTE:
A NEW CAM SENSOR SEAL MUST BE INSTALLED DURING THE HEAD GASKET
REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE. OIL SEEPAGE FROM THIS SEAL CAN BE MISINTERPRETED
AS A HEAD GASKET LEAK.
11. Replace the engine oil and filter after performing these procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Cylinder Head Gasket
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Multi Layer Steel Head Gasket - Installation Procedures > Page
1565
Cylinder Head Gasket: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Front Crankshaft Seal: Description and Operation
Hydrodynamic seals provide end sealing, where the crankshaft exits the block. Anaerobic gasket
material is used for parting line sealing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1569
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Do Not Rotate the camshaft or crankshaft when timing belt is removed damage to the
engine may occur.
REMOVAL
1. Using Special Tool 1026 and Insert 6827-A, or equivalents remove crankshaft damper. 2.
Remove outer timing belt cover and timing belt.
3. Remove crankshaft sprocket using Special Tool 6793 and insert C- 4685-C2, or equivalents.
CAUTION: Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal bore.
4. Using Tool 6771, or equivalent to remove front crankshaft oil seal. Do not damage the seal
contact area on the crankshaft.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1570
1. Install new seal by using Tool 6780-1, or equivalent. 2. Place seal into opening with seal spring
towards the inside of engine. Install seal until flush with cover.
3. Install crankshaft sprocket. Using Special Tool 6792, or equivalent.
NOTE: Make sure the word "front" on the sprocket is facing you.
4. Install timing belt and covers.
5. Install crankshaft damper. Use thrust bearing/washer and 12M-1.75 x 150 mm bolt from Special
Tool 6792, or equivalent. Install crankshaft
damper bolt and tighten to 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1571
Front Crankshaft Seal: Tools and Equipment
Front Crankshaft Seal Remover 6771
Front Crankshaft Seal Installer 6780
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Valve Guide Seal: Description and Operation
Viton rubber valve stem seals are integral with spring seats.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Off
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Cylinder Head Off
REMOVAL
1. With cylinder head removed, compress valve springs using Special Tool MD 998735 or
equivalent. 2. Remove valve retaining locks, valve spring retainers, valve stem seals and valve
springs. 3. Before removing valves, remove any burrs from valve stem lock grooves to prevent
damage to the valve guides. Identify valves to insure
installation in original location.
INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert in cylinder head.
2. Install new valve stem seals on all valves using a valve stem seal tool. The valve stem seals
should be pushed firmly and squarely over valve guide.
CAUTION: If oversize valves are used, there is only one oversize valve available. The same stem
seal is used on both the standard and oversize valve.
3. Install valve springs and retainers. Compress valve springs only enough to install locks, taking
care not to misalign the direction of compression.
Nicked valve stems may result from misalignment of the valve spring compressor.
CAUTION: When depressing the valve spring retainers with valve spring compressor the locks can
become dislocated. Check to make sure both locks are in their correct location after removing tool.
4. Check the valve spring installed height B after refacing the valve and seat. Make sure
measurements are taken from top of spring seat to the
bottom surface of spring retainer. If height is greater than 38.75 mm (1.525 inch), install 7.620 mm
(0.030 inch) spacer under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back within specification.
5. Install cam followers and camshaft. 6. Checking dry lash. Dry lash is the amount of clearance
that exists between the base circle of an installed cam and the rocker arm roller when the
adjuster is drained of oil and completely collapsed.
NOTE: Specified dry lash is 1.17 mm (0.046 inch) for intake and 1.28 mm (0.050 inch) for exhaust.
After performing dry lash check, refill adjuster with oil and allow 10 minutes for adjuster or adjusters
to bleed down before rotating cam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cylinder Head Off > Page 1577
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Cylinder Head On
REMOVAL
1. Remove camshafts. 2. Rotate crankshaft until piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC) on
compression. 3. With air hose attached to adapter tool installed in spark plug hole, apply 90 - 120
psi air pressure.
4. Using Special Tool MD998772A with adapter 6779, or equivalents compress valve springs and
remove valve locks. 5. Remove valve spring.
6. Remove valve stem seal by using a valve stem seal tool.
INSTALLATION
1. Install valve seal/valve spring seat assembly. 2. Install valve spring and retainer. Using Special
Tool MD998772A, or equivalent compress valve springs only enough to install locks. Correct
alignment of tool is necessary to avoid nicking valve stems (air pressure required), piston at TDC.
3. Remove air hose and install spark plugs. 4. Install camshafts. 5. Install cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Sprocket Bolt .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1582
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Tools and Equipment
Camshaft Sprocket Remover/Installer C-4687
Camshaft Sprocket Remover/Installer Adapter C-4687-1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
A sintered iron timing belt sprocket is mounted on the crankshaft nose. This sprocket transmits
crankshaft movement, via timing belt to the camshaft sprocket providing timed valve actuation.
BOLT ACCESS PLUG
An Access plug is located in the right inner fender shield. Remove the plug and insert the proper
size socket, extension and ratchet, when crankshaft rotation is necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1586
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Tools and Equipment
Crankshaft Sprocket Remover 6793
Crankshaft Sprocket Installer 6792
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Service Replacement Interval Information Not Supplied by the Manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Camshaft or crankshaft should not be rotate after timing belt is removed. Damage to
valve components may occur. Always align timing marks before removing timing belt.
REMOVAL
1. Remove crankshaft damper bolt. 2. Remove engine mount bracket and timing belt cover
fasteners, remove cover. 3. Align camshaft timing marks. Loosen timing belt tensioner fasteners
and remove timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not loosen, tighten, or remove the tensioner pivot bolt.
INSTALLATION
1. When tensioner is removed from the engine it is necessary to compress the plunger into the
tensioner body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation > Page 1592
2. Place the tensioner into a vise and slowly compress the plunger.
CAUTION: Index the tensioner in the vise the same way it is installed on the engine. This is to
ensure proper pin orientation when tensioner is installed on the engine.
3. When plunger is compressed into the tensioner body install a pin through the body and plunger
to retain plunger in place until tensioner is
installed.
4. Set crankshaft sprocket to Top Dead Center (TDC) by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on
the oil pump housing, then back off to 3 notches
before TDC.
5. Set camshafts timing marks together by aligning notches on sprockets.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation > Page 1593
6. Rotate crankshaft 1/2 tooth counterclockwise from TDC.
7. Install timing belt in this direction. Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket,
idler pulley, camshaft sprockets and then around
the tensioner pulley.
8. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack. Install tensioner to Clock but do not
tighten fasteners. 9. Using a torque wrench on the tensioner pulley apply 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) of
torque to tensioner.
10. With torque being applied to the tensioner pulley move the tensioner up against the tensioner
pulley bracket and tighten fasteners to 31 Nm (275
inch lbs.).
11. Pull tensioner plunger pin. Pretension is correct when pin can be removed and installed freely.
12. Rotate crankshaft 2 revolutions and check the alignment of the timing marks. 13. Install front
half of timing cover. 14. Install engine mount bracket. 15. Install right engine mount. 16. Remove
jack from under engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation > Page 1594
17. Install crankshaft damper using M12 1.75 x 150 mm bolt, washer, thrust bearing and nut from
Special Tool 6792. Install crankshaft damper bolt
and tighten to 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
18. Install accessory drive belts. 19. Raise vehicle on hoist and install right inner splash shield. 20.
After timing belt has been replaced, use a Diagnostic Readout Box (DRB), or equivalent select
adjustments and then relearn CMP/CKP, to relearn
camshaft and crankshaft timing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation > Page 1595
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Timing Belt Removal and Installation > Page 1596
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets and Timing Procedure
With Cover Installed
1. Remove number one spark plug. 2. Using a dial indicator, set number one cylinder to Top Dead
Center (TDC) on the compression stroke.
3. Remove the timing belt access cover from the engine.
4. Check the timing marks on the camshaft sprockets, they should align with each other.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Assembly Mechanical Bolts .................................................................................................................
............................................... 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) Assembly Hydraulic Bolt ...................................
....................................................................................................................................... 31 Nm (23 ft.
lbs.) Tensioner-Hydraulic Bolts ............................................................................................................
............................................................ 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.) Tensioner ..................................................
........................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm
(250 inch lbs.) Backing Plate Bolts ......................................................................................................
............................................................................ 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) Pulley Bolt .................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Camshaft or crankshaft should not be rotated after timing belt is removed. Damage to
valve components may occur. Always align timing marks before removing timing belt.
REMOVAL
1. Remove accessory drive belts.
2. Raise vehicle on a hoist and remove right inner splash shield.
3. Remove crankshaft damper bolt. Remove damper using Special Tool 1026 and Insert 6827-A or
equivalent. 4. Lower vehicle and place a jack under engine 5. Remove right engine mount.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1603
6. Remove right engine mount bracket. 7. Remove timing belt cover fasteners, remove cover.
INSTALLATION
1. Install front timing cover. 2. Install engine mount bracket. 3. Install Right engine mount. 4.
Remove jack from under engine. 5. Install crankshaft vibration damper 6. Install accessory drive
belts. 7. Raise vehicle on hoist and install right inner splash shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Minimum Air Flow Idle Odometer <= 1,000 Miles ................................................................................
............................................................................................. 550 - 1,300 rpm Odometer >= 1,000
Miles ....................................................................................................................................................
......................... 600 - 1,300 rpm
Note: Idle speed range achieved through Minimum Air Flow Idle Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications > Page 1612
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 31 PCV Vacuum Nipple
1. Turn ignition key off. 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold nipple (Fig. 31).
Cap the PCV vacuum nipple.
Fig. 32 Purge Hose
3. Disconnect purge hose from the nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 32).
Fig. 33 Orifice 6457 Attached To Purge Nipple
4. Use a piece of hose to attach Air Metering Orifice 6457 (0.125 in. orifice) or equivalent, to the
purge nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 33). 5. Ensure that all accessories are off. 6. Connect the
DRB or equivalent scan tool to the data link connector inside the passenger compartment. 7. Run
engine in Park or Neutral until the cooling fan has cycled on and off at least once (180°F). 8. Using
the DRB or equivalent scan tool, access Minimum Airflow Idle Speed. 9. The following will then
occur:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications > Page 1613
- Idle air control motor will fully close
- Idle spark advance will become fixed
- PCM will go open loop enriched
- DRB or equivalent scan tool displays engine RPM
10. If idle RPM is within the range shown below, throttle body minimum airflow is set correctly.
Odometer Reading Idle RPM
Below 1,000 Miles 550 - 1,300 RPM
Above 1,000 Miles 600 - 1,300 RPM
11. If idle RPM is above specifications, use the DRB or equivalent scan tool to check idle air control
motor operation. If idle air control motor is OK,
replace throttle body. If idle air flow is below specification, shut off the engine and clean the throttle
body as follows: a. Remove the throttle body from engine.
WARNING: Clean throttle body in a well ventilated area. Wear rubber or butyl gloves, do not let
Mopar parts cleaner come in contact with eyes or skin. Avoid ingesting the cleaner. Wash
thoroughly after using cleaner.
b. While holding the throttle open, spray the entire throttle body bore and the manifold side of the
throttle plate with Mopar Parts Cleaner. Only
use Mopar Parts Cleaner to clean the throttle body.
c. Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom of throttle body bore and the edges and
manifold side of the throttle blade. The edges of the
throttle blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest to the throttle blade when is closed,
must be free of deposits.
d. Use compressed air to dry the throttle body. e. Inspect throttle body for foreign material. f.
Install throttle body on manifold.
g. Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow is still not within specifications, the problem is
not caused by the throttle body.
12. Shut off engine. 13. Remove Air Metering Orifice 6457 or equivalent. Install purge hose. 14.
Remove cap from PCV valve. Connect hose to PCV valve. 15. Remove DRB or equivalent scan
tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Fig. 104 Air Intake Duct
Fig. 105 Removal/Installation of Air Inlet Duct
NOTE: Neon vehicles do not use a heated air inlet system. The PCM adjusts fuel injector pulse
width and ignition timing to compensate for different ambient temperatures.
NOTE: The air cleaner attaches to a bracket on the rear of the cylinder head. An ambient air duct
supplies underhood air for the engine.
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake tube (Fig. 104) from air cleaner and intake manifold (Fig. 105).
Fig. 106 Removal/Installation Air Cleaner Front Housing and Element
2. Tighten clasps on top of air cleaner housing. Rotate front of housing forward then lift front away
from air cleaner housing (Fig 106). 3. Remove air cleaner element from front housing (Fig. 106).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1618
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element into front housing. 2. Rotate front of housing forward then lower into
place and locate tabs in slots.
- Fasten clasps on top of air cleaner housing.
- Install air intake duct at air cleaner and intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1623
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1634
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Plastic clips in various locations protect the cables from damage. When the cables are replaced the
clips must be used to prevent damage to the cables. The #1 cable must be routed under the PCV
hose and clipped to the #2 cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Ignition Cable: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1637
Ignition Cable: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Testing For Open Circuits, High Resistance and Loose Terminals
Use an ohmmeter to check cables for opens, loose terminals or high resistance as follows:
1. Remove cable from spark plug. 2. Remove cable from the coil tower. 3. Connect the ohmmeter
between the spark plug end terminal and the coil end terminal.
- Make sure ohmmeter probes are in good contact.
- Resistance should be within tolerance shown in the cable resistance chart.
- If resistance is not within tolerance, replace cable assembly. Test all spark plug cables in the
same manner.
- If no problems are found, SEE Ignition System/System Diagnosis/Testing For Spark At Coil.
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Testing For Punctures and Cracks
When testing cables for punctures and cracks with an oscilloscope and an inductive voltage probe,
follow the instructions of the equipment manufacturers.
CAUTION: Do not leave any one spark plug cable disconnected for more than 30 seconds during
test or possible heat damage to catalytic converter will occur.
If an oscilloscope and inductive probe are not available, cables can be tested as follows:
1. With the engine not running, connect one end of a test probe (i.e. a piece of wire with insulated
alligator clips on each end) to a good ground, other
end free for probing.
WARNING: The ignition system generates approximately 40,000 volts. Personal injury could result
from contact with this system.
2. With the engine running, move test probe along entire length of all cables (approximately 0 to 1/8
inch gap).
- If punctures or cracks are present there will be a noticeable spark jump from the faulty area to the
probe.
- Replace cracked, leaking or faulty cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Cleaning
Clean high tension cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning > Page 1640
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Replacement
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: The cables insulate the spark plugs and cover the top of the spark plug tube (Fig. 3).
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
REMOVAL
1. Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Lightly grasp the top of the cable. 2. Rotate the insulator
1/2 turn and pull straight up in a steady motion. 3. To replace the cables, disconnect the cable from
the ignition coil.
INSTALLATION
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube.Then connect the other end to coil pack.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Electrode Gap ......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... (0.033-0.038 in) Torque ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm
(20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1644
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Plug Type ............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... RC9YC Thread Size ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
(14mm) 3/4 in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1645
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Resistor spark plugs are used in this engine.
Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes and fouled, cracked or broken
porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from the
engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended.
Faulty or fouled spark plugs may perform well at idle speed, but frequently fail at higher engine
speeds. Faulty plugs can be identified in a number of ways: poor fuel economy, power loss,
decrease in engine speed, hard starting and, in general, poor engine performance.
Spark plugs also malfunction because of carbon fouling, excessive electrode air gap, or a broken
insulator. SEE Powertrain Management/Ignition System/Testing and Inspection/Procedures, for
spark plug diagnosis.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1648
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1649
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1650
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1651
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1652
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Heavy Colored Deposits
DESCRIPTION:
Colored coatings heavily deposited on the portion of the plug projecting into the chamber and on
the side facing the intake valve.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Leaking Valve Seals (1 or 2 cylinders) - Check the valve seals. Replace if necessary. Clean, regap,
and reinstall
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Normal Operating Conditions
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
The few deposits present will be probably light tan or slightly gray in color with most grades of
commercial gasoline. There will not be evidence of electrode burning. Gap growth will not average
more than approximately 0.025 mm (0.001 in) per 1600 km (1000 miles) of operation for non
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1653
platinum spark plugs. Non-platinum spark plugs that have normal wear can usually be cleaned,
have the electrodes filed and regapped, and then reinstalled.
CAUTION: Never attempt to file the electrodes or use a wire brush for cleaning platinum spark
plugs. This would damage the platinum pads which would shorten spark plug life.
Some fuel refiners in several areas of the United States have introduced a manganese additive
(MMT) for unleaded fuel. During combustion, fuel with MMT may coat the entire tip of the spark
plug with a rust colored deposit. The rust color deposits can be misdiagnosed as being caused by
coolant in the combustion chamber. Spark plug performance may be affected by MMT deposits.
Oil or Ash Encrusted
OIL OR ASH ENCRUSTED
Oil Or Ash Encrusted
If one or more plugs are oil or ash encrusted, evaluate the engine for the cause of oil entering the
combustion chambers. Sometimes fuel additives can cause ash encrustation on an entire set of
spark plugs. Ash encrusted spark plugs can be cleaned and reused.
Premature Electrode Wear - Preignition Damage
PREIGNITION DAMAGE
Preignition Damage
Excessive combustion chamber temperature can cause preignition damage. First, the center
electrode dissolves and the ground electrode dissolves somewhat later. Insulators appear relatively
deposit free. Other possible causes include ignition timing over-advanced and incorrect spark plug
heat range.
Spark plugs are designed to operate within a specific temperature range, called spark plug heat
range. Variations in thickness and length of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1654
center electrode and porcelain insulator change how fast the plug can dissipate heat and determine
the plugs heat range.
Determine if the spark plugs are the correct type, as specified on the VECI label, or if other
operating conditions are causing engine overheating.
Red, Brown, Yellow or White Deposits - Fuel Additives
SCAVENGER DEPOSITS
Scavenger Deposits
Fuel scavenger deposits may be either white or yellow. They may appear to be harmful, but are a
normal condition caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. These additives are designed to
change the chemical nature of deposits and decrease spark plug misfire tendencies. Notice that
accumulation on the ground electrode and shell area may be heavy but the deposits are easily
removed using standard procedures. Spark plugs with scavenger deposits can be considered
normal in condition, cleaned and reused.
Shiny Yellow Glaze
COMBUSTION DEPOSITS
A shiny yellow glaze coating on the spark plug insulator is evidence of metallic by-products of fuel
combustion, caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. Avoid sudden acceleration with wide
open throttle after long periods of low speed driving. Spark plugs with combustion deposits can be
cleaned and reused.
Spark Plug Inspection
- Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes. Also check for fouled, cracked
or broken porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from
the engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended in the Maintenance
Schedules.
- Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned and reused if not otherwise defective -- SEE
Spark Plug Condition. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file. Adjust the gap between the electrodes to the specified dimension. The spark plug gap is 0.033
to0.038 in.
- Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion resulting
in a change in the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Wet Oily Deposits
FUEL FOULING
A spark plug that is coated with excessive wet fuel is called fuel fouled. This condition is normally
observed during hard start periods. Clean fuel fouled spark plugs with compressed air and reinstall
them in the engine.
White or Gray - Burned or Blistered Insulator
SPARK PLUG OVERHEATING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 1655
Spark Plug Overheating
Overheating is indicated by a white or gray center electrode insulator that also appears blistered.
The increase in electrode gap will be considerably in excess of 0.001 in. per 1000 miles of
operation. This suggests that a plug with a cooler heat range rating should be used. Over
advanced ignition timing, detonation and cooling system malfunctions also can cause spark plug
overheating. Also check for lean air-fuel mixture. Check the torque value of the plugs to ensure
good plug-engine seat contact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1656
Spark Plug: Adjustments
Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Fig.2 Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Check the spark plug gap with a gap gauge. If the gap is not correct, adjust it by bending the
ground -- center electrode.
Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information (VECI) label, (under hood).
If label is gone, or not readable, verify system and use the following specification.
Plug Gap ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.033 to 0.038 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1657
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
CAUTION: Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of the spark plug insulator,
turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL
1. Remove the spark plug using a quality socket with a rubber or foam insert. 2. Inspect the spark
plug condition.
SPARK PLUG CLEANING
Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned using commercially available spark plug
cleaning equipment. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file before adjusting gap.
CAUTION: Never use a motorized wire wheel brush to clean the spark plugs. Metallic deposits will
remain on the spark plug insulator and will cause plug misfire.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap.
SPARK PLUG INSTALLATION
1. To avoid cross threading, start the spark plug into the cylinder head by hand. 2. Tighten spark
plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque. 3. Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of
the spark plug insulator covers the upper end of the spark plug tube. 4. Connect coil.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION PRESSURE (at 250 - 400 RPM):
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................ 1172 - 1551 kPa (170 - 225 psi) Minimum .............................................................
................................................................................................................................... 689 kPa (100
psi)
COMPRESSION PRESSURE DIFFERENCE OF ALL CYLINDER:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 25%
VACUUM:
Manifold ...............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 60 kPa (18 inches Hg)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 1661
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
PROCEDURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Disconnect coil wire from distributor and secure to good ground to prevent a spark from starting
a fire (Conventional Ignition System). For
Direct Ignition System (DIS) disconnect the coil connector.
5 . Be sure throttle blade is fully open during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gage
adaptor into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Crank engine until maximum pressure is
reached on gage.
Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure.
7. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689
kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more
cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem
in the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a
guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the
cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
11. Clean or replace spark plugs as necessary and adjust gap. Tighten to specifications. 12. Test
resistance of spark plug cables. Perform secondary circuit inspection. 13. Test coil output voltage,
primary and secondary resistance. Replace parts as necessary. 14. Check fuel pump pressure at
idle and different RPM ranges. 15. The air filter elements should be replaced as specified. 16.
Inspect crankcase ventilation system. 17. Inspect and adjust accessory belt drives. 18. Road test
vehicle as a final test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates this engine is equipped with hydraulic lifters or lash adjusters and
therefore does not require adjustment.
See "Rocker Arm: Service and Repair" for further information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) Inlet Tube To Engine Block ..............................
.................................................................................................................................. 12 Nm (105 inch
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1668
Water Pump: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The water has a diecast aluminum body and housing with a stamped steel impeller. The water
pump bolts directly to the block. Cylinder block to water pump sealing is provided by a rubber
O-ring. The water pump is driven by the timing belt. The water pump is the heart of the cooling
system , pumping the coolant through the engine block, cylinder head, heater core, and radiator.
NOTE: The water pump on all models can be replaced without discharging the air conditioning
system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1669
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
OPERATIONAL TEST
A quick flow test to tell whether or not the pump is working is to see if the heater warms properly. A
defective pump will not be able to circulate heated coolant through the long heater hose. Another
flow test to help determine pump operation, remove radiator cap.
CAUTION: DO NOT remove radiator cap if the cooling system is hot or under pressure.
FLOW TEST
1. Remove radiator cap. 2. Remove a small amount of coolant from the system, start the engine
and warm up until thermostat opens. With the thermostat open and coolant
level low you will see if the water pump is pumping coolant through the system.
REASONS FOR REPLACEMENT
Replace water pump body assembly if it has any of these defects: Cracks or damage on the body.
- Coolant leaks from the shaft seal, evident by coolant traces on the pump body.
- Loose or rough turning bearing.
- Impeller rubs either the pump body or the engine block.
- Impeller loose or damaged.
- Sprocket or sprocket flange loose or damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1670
Water Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Remove right inner splash shield. 2. Remove accessory drive belts and
power steering pump. 3. Drain cooling system. 4. Support engine from the bottom and remove right
engine mount. 5. Remove power steering pump bracket bolts and set pump and bracket assembly
aside. Power steering lines do not need to be disconnected. 6. Remove right engine mount
bracket. 7. Remove timing belt. 8. Remove inner timing belt cover.
9. Remove water pump attaching screws to engine.
INSTALLATION
1. Install O-ring in water pump body O-ring groove. Use small dabs of Mopar Silicone Rubber
Adhesive Sealant, or equivalent around the water
pump body to secure O-ring in place during installation.
CAUTION: Make sure O-ring is properly seated in water pump groove before tightening screws. An
improperly located O-ring may cause damage to the O-ring and cause a coolant leak.
2. Assemble pump body to block and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs). Pressurize cooling
system to 15 psi with pressure tester and check
water pump shaft seal and O-ring for leaks.
3. Rotate pump by hand to check for freedom of movement. 4. Install inner timing belt cover. 5.
Install timing belt. 6. Install right engine mount bracket and engine mount. 7. Fill cooling system. 8.
Install power steering pump and accessory drive belts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Coolant Recommendations
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Coolant Recommendations
NO: 07-03-97
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: May 9, 1997
SUBJECT: Engine Coolant Usage
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-05-93 DATED NOV. 26,
1993 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND MARKED IN THE 1993
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN BOOK (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-94000). THE COMPLETE
BULLETIN IS REVISED.
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Pickup/Ram Cab & Chassis/Ramcharger/
Power Ram/Power Ram Cab & Chassis
1989 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/LeBaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron Convertible
1989 - 1997 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1989 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati TC
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 1997 (BR) Ram Truck
1993 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1989 - 1992 (MJ) Comanche
1996 - 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1992 - 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
1997 (TJ) Wrangler
1989 - 1997 (XJ) Cherokee
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1993 - 1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
DISCUSSION:
Some owners have expressed interest in using engine coolants made with propylene glycol instead
of ethylene glycol due to its lower toxicity and resultant reduced hazards to children and animals.
Based on recent test data, most owners should not experience significant effects on cooling system
performance when using propylene glycol based coolant. The use of national brand propylene
glycol based engine coolant that meets the same Chrysler ethylene glycol specification of MS-7170
(or equivalent ASTM D5216) is acceptable for Chrysler built vehicles.
NOTE:
ANTIFREEZE SOLD FOR PROTECTING PLUMBING ETC. (RV ANTIFREEZE) IS NOT A
SUITABLE ENGINE COOLANT.
However, owners should be discouraged from changing their engine coolant prior to the regularly
scheduled maintenance period. Prematurely changing engine coolant unnecessarily adds to the
risk of environmental exposure.
Sufficient freeze protection for the region should be maintained. However, do not use more than a
55% solution (-35 F, -37 C). Use the chart that accompanies the propylene glycol coolant, since a
higher concentration is required to obtain the same freeze points as ethylene glycol coolant. If the
temperatures for your region fall below this, use ethylene glycol coolant.
Under severe driving conditions (towing a trailer in hot weather etc.) there may be a slight loss in
cooling performance. If this is noticed, the system should be changed back to ethylene glycol
coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Coolant Recommendations > Page 1676
The two types of coolant should not be mixed. The standard testers for measuring freeze protection
will not provide an accurate reading when this occurs. If the cooling system is changed to
propylene glycol, all the ethylene glycol coolant should be removed using an approved cooling
system flush procedure. The freeze protection of propylene glycol cannot be measured with a
standard cooling system hydrometer. A refractometer or hydrometer calibrated for propylene glycol
is the preferred test tool.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Cooling System Capacity ....................................................................................................................
............................................................. 7.0L (7.4 qts)
NOTE: Capacity includes heater and coolant reserve system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 1679
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
GENERAL INFORMATION
Performance is measurable. For heat transfer pure water absorbs 1 btu for each degree of
temperature rise for each pound of water. This formula is altered when necessary additives to
control boiling, freezing, and corrosion are added as follows: Pure Water (1 btu) boils at 100°C (212°F) and freezes at 0°C (32°F).
- 100 Percent ethylene glycol (0.7 btu) can cause an engine to run hot, cause detonation, and will
freeze at -22°C (-8°F).
- 50/50 Ethylene Glycol and Distilled Water (0.82 btu) is the recommended combination that
provides a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F). The radiator, water pump, engine water jacket, radiator
pressure cap, thermostat, temperature gauge, coolant sensor and heater are all designed for 50/50
ethylene glycol.
- Where required, a 56 percent glycol and 44 percent water mixture will provide a freeze point of
-46°C ( -50°F ).
NOTE: Richer mixtures cannot be measured with field equipment and can lead to problems
associated with 100 percent glycol. If there is doubt that the coolant mixture is to rich for field
equipment to measure, put a sample in a clean container. Add exactly the same amount of water
and retest. If the coolant in the vehicle is 100% antifreeze, the diluted sample will read 50%. If the
coolant in the vehicle was 70% antifreeze and 30% water, the diluted sample will read as 35%, etc.
SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, intake manifolds, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze or their equivalent are recommended for best engine cooling without
corrosion. When mixed only to a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F) to -59°C (-50°F). If it looses color or
becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed solution.
CAUTION: Do not use well water, or suspected water supply in cooling system. A 50/50 ethylene
glycol and distilled water mix is recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > General Information
Coolant: Description and Operation General Information
GENERAL INFORMATION
The cooling system is designed around the coolant.
PICKING UP HEAT
The coolant must accept heat from engine metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust
valves.
GIVING OFF HEAT
Then carry this heat to the radiator where the tube/fin assemblies of these components can give off
the heat to the air.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > General Information > Page 1682
Coolant: Description and Operation Coolant Performance
GENERAL INFORMATION
Performance is measurable. For heat transfer pure water absorbs 1 btu for each degree of
temperature rise for each pound of water. This formula is altered when necessary additives to
control boiling, freezing, and corrosion are added as follows: Pure Water (1 btu) boils at 100°C (212°F) and freezes at 0°C (32°F).
- 100 Percent ethylene glycol (0.7 btu) can cause an engine to run hot, cause detonation, and will
freeze at -22°C (-8°F).
- 50/50 Ethylene Glycol and Distilled Water (0.82 btu) is the recommended combination that
provides a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F). The radiator, water pump, engine water jacket, radiator
pressure cap, thermostat, temperature gauge, coolant sensor and heater are all designed for 50/50
ethylene glycol.
- Where required, a 56 percent glycol and 44 percent water mixture will provide a freeze point of
-46°C ( -50°F ).
NOTE: Richer mixtures cannot be measured with field equipment and can lead to problems
associated with 100 percent glycol. If there is doubt that the coolant mixture is to rich for field
equipment to measure, put a sample in a clean container. Add exactly the same amount of water
and retest. If the coolant in the vehicle is 100% antifreeze, the diluted sample will read 50%. If the
coolant in the vehicle was 70% antifreeze and 30% water, the diluted sample will read as 35%, etc.
SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, intake manifolds, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze or their equivalent are recommended for best engine cooling without
corrosion. When mixed only to a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F) to -59°C (-50°F). If it looses color or
becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed solution.
CAUTION: Do not use well water, or suspected water supply in cooling system. A 50/50 ethylene
glycol and distilled water mix is recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 1683
Coolant: Service and Repair
Refer to Cooling System, Service and Repair for applicable service procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump Inlet Tube <--> [Coolant
Line/Hose] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Water Pump Inlet Tube: Service and Repair
The inlet tube connects the water pump to the radiator and heater core. This tube is sealed by an
O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the block.
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use any sharp tools to remove hoses from inlet tube. This may cause the tube to
leak.
1. Drain cooling system. 2. Remove upper radiator hose to access the hose connections at the inlet
tube.
Figure 19
3. Remove lower radiator hose and heater hose from the inlet tube. 4. Remove the two fasteners
that hold the inlet tube to the block and one fastener that holds the intake manifold to inlet tube.
Figure 20
5. Rotate tube while removing the tube from the engine block.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube into the cylinder block. Replace O-ring
as necessary. 2. Lubricate O-ring with coolant and install inlet tube into the cylinder block opening.
3. Install two fasteners to the engine block and the one fastener to the intake manifold. Tighten
fasteners to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.). 4. Connect lower radiator hose and heater hose to inlet tube. 5.
Install upper radiator hose. 6. Fill cooling system. 7. Pressure system to 104 kPa (15 psi) to check
for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Specifications
Fan Motor to Shroud Retaining Screws (A/C Equipped) 3.8 Nm 34 In Lbs
Fan Motor to Shroud Retaining Screws (non A/C Equipped) 2.3 Nm 20 In Lbs
Fan Module (Shroud) to Radiator Fasteners 7.3 Nm 65 In Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1693
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1694
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1695
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1696
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1697
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1698
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1699
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1700
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1701
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1702
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1703
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1704
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1705
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1706
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1707
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1708
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Electrical Diagrams
Dual Cooling Fans
A/C & Heater System -- Sheet 8w-42-4
Chrysler Does not provide a wiring diagram for dual fans on 95-98 model year Neons. This diagram
is for the 99 model year and is presented for reference only.
Single Cooling Fan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1709
A/C And Heat Part 1 of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1710
A/C And Heat Part 2 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1711
A/C And Heat Part 3 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1712
A/C And Heat Part 4 Of 4
The OE does not show a wiring diagram showing the dual fan option specifically until 1999 but the
dual fan option is mentioned. Additionally, the Radiator Fan Control is shown as a portion of the
A/C circuit and as a portion of the PCM circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1713
Cooling Fan Modules
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
Cooling Fan Modules
Circuit Operation
The radiator fan system used in this vehicle uses a solid state relay that controls the speed of the
radiator fan.
Power for the relay is supplied on circuit A16 This circuit is HOT at all times and protected by a 30
Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
Ground for the coil side of the relay is controlled by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). When
the PCM determines the need for fan operation the PCM supplies the ground path for circuit K173.
This circuit connects to cavity 18 of the PCM connector.
From the relay, circuit C25 connects to the radiator fan motor(s). On vehicles equipped with the
manual transmission only one radiator fan is used. For vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission there are two radiator fans used.
Ground for the radiator fans is supplied on circuit Z1.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 1716
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation Cooling Fan Motor Description
The radiator fan system used in this vehicle uses a solid state relay (Pulse Width Module) that
controls the speed of the radiator fan.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the Pulse Width Module (PWM). The PCM provides a pulsed ground
for the PWM. Depending on the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage
to the fan motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to
the fan motor would be 3.6 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 1717
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation Radiator Fan Control
Cooling Fan Modules
Fan control is accomplished in two ways. The fan always runs when the compressor clutch is engaged.
- The fan is also turned on by the temperature of the coolant which is sensed by the coolant
temperature sensor. The coolant temperature sensor sends the message to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). The (PCM) turns on the fan through the Pulse Width Module (PWM). Switching
through the (PCM) provides fan control for the following conditions:
1. Fan will not run when cranking engine no matter what coolant temperature is. 2. Fan will run
when the A/C clutch is engaged and low pressure cutout switch is closed. 3. At vehicle speeds over
40 mph, fan will run only if coolant temperature reaches 230°F (110°C) and fan will turn off when
temperature drops to
220°F (104°C).
4. At vehicle speeds under 40 mph, fan will run when coolant temperature reaches 215°F (102°C)
and fan will turn off when temperature drops 200°
F (93°C).
5. To prevent steaming, the fan will run with engine at idle speed and only for three minutes, when
ambient temperature is below 60°F (16°C) and
coolant temperature is between 100-207°F (38-97°C).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1718
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Service and Repair
WARNING: Do not disassemble the fan motor from the support bracket.
NOTE: Electric fan motor is serviced as an assembly with the fan module.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect fan motor leads from module.
Servicing Fan Module
2. Remove fan module fasteners from radiator.
INSTALLATION
1. Install module to radiator. Torque shroud to radiator fasteners to 7.3 Nm (65 inch lbs.). 2.
Connect fan motor lead.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 >
May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 >
May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1727
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 >
May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1728
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 >
May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1729
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7692 >
May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1730
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 >
May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 >
May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1735
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 >
May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1736
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 >
May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1737
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 7691 >
May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1738
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest:
> 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest:
> 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1744
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest:
> 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1745
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1751
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1752
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1753
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1754
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1759
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1760
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1761
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1762
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1767
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1768
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1769
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1770
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats >
Page 1775
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats >
Page 1776
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1782
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1783
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1784
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1785
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1790
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1791
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1797
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1798
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1799
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out Revisions >
Page 1800
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1805
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1806
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1807
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1808
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1813
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1814
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1815
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1816
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1817
Solid State Fan Relay: Locations
Fig.31 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1818
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The power distribution center (PDC) is located next to the battery in the engine compartment. The
PDC contains the starter relay, radiator fan relay, A/C compressor clutch relay, auto shutdown
relay, fuel pump relay and several fuses. For the location of the relay within the PDC, refer to the
PDC cover for location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1819
Solid State Relay
Solid State Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1822
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1823
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1824
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1825
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1826
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1827
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1828
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1829
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1830
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1831
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1832
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1833
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1834
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1835
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1836
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1837
Radiator Fan Relay Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1838
Solid State Fan Relay: Electrical Diagrams
Dual Cooling Fans
A/C & Heater System -- Sheet 8w-42-4
Chrysler Does not provide a wiring diagram for dual fans on 95-98 model year Neons. This diagram
is for the 99 model year and is presented for reference only.
Single Cooling Fan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1839
A/C And Heat Part 1 of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1840
A/C And Heat Part 2 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1841
A/C And Heat Part 3 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1842
A/C And Heat Part 4 Of 4
The OE does not show a wiring diagram showing the dual fan option specifically until 1999 but the
dual fan option is mentioned. Additionally, the Radiator Fan Control is shown as a portion of the
A/C circuit and as a portion of the PCM circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Solid State Fan
Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1843
Solid State Fan Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fan Blade: Service and Repair
NOTE: There are no repairs to be made to the fan. If the fan is warped, cracked, or otherwise
damaged, it must be replaced with only the recommended part for adequate strength, performance
and safety.
REMOVAL
To remove fan from motor shaft, bench support the motor and motor shaft, while removing the fan
retaining clip, so that the shaft and motor will not be damaged by excessive force. Do not permit
the fan blades to touch the bench.
NOTE: Surface burr removal may be required to remove fan from motor shaft.
INSTALLATION
To install fan on motor shaft, slide the fan over shaft. Support motor and shaft as above while
installing fan retaining clip.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1851
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1852
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1853
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System/Temperature
Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing > Page 1856
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 1857
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Fan Shroud: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
Some fan shrouds are equipped with flapped doors to prevent the shroud from restricting air flow at
high speeds.
PURPOSE
All vehicles have fan shrouds to improve fan air flow efficiency. The shroud supports the electric
fan motor and fan.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Heater Hose: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system. 2. Remove clamp at end of heater hose to be removed.
Heater Hose Quick Connect
3. ON Right Hand Drive (RHD) vehicles, heater hoses at the heater core connection have quick
connects. The quick connect consist of two pieces; a
quick connect and insert. The quick connect is removed by compressing the insert with a pliers,
and pulling the quick connect free of the insert/nipple. Carefully compressed insert pulling the quick
connect from connector nipple. The insert will remain on the connector nipple as the quick connect
is removed.
4. Remove the heater hose clamp from the heater hose at the block and remove hose.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The insert should be removed from the connector nipple and placed inside of the quick
connect before reassembly.
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The temperature gauge is connected to the engine coolant temperature sensor on the G20 circuit.
The engine coolant temperature sensor for the gauge is a combination unit. One side of the unit is
used for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and the other side for the cluster. The sending unit
is case grounded to the engine.
The logic driven gauge moves in response to the measured resistance of the engine coolant
temperature sending unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1868
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
1. Disconnect the coolant temperature sensor. 2. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge
should be at its lowest position. Turn ignition switch OFF 3. Ground temperature gauge sending
unit connector Pin 3. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge should be at its highest
position. After
the seat belt lamp goes out, the cluster should chime for about Eight Seconds. a. If OK, check
temperature sending unit connector for proper connection. If connections are OK, replace the
sending unit. b. If not OK, and the high temperature chime sounds but the gauge shows cold,
replace the gauge assembly If gauge is still not working, replace
the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Radiator Drain Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Radiator Drain Plug: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Plastic tanks, while stronger then brass are subject to damage by impact, such as
wrenches.
REMOVAL
Turn the drain cock stem counterclockwise to unscrew the stem. When the stem is unscrewed to
the end of the threads, pull the stem from the radiator tank.
INSTALLATION
1. Push the draincock assembly body into the tank opening. 2. Tighten the draincock stem by
turning clockwise to 2.0 - 2.7 Nm (18 - 25 inch lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The cooling system is equipped with a pressure cap that releases pressure at some point within a
range of 97 - 124 kPa (14 - 18 psi). The system will operate at higher than atmospheric pressure,
which raises the coolant boiling point, allowing increased radiator cooling capacity.
VENT VALVE
There is a vent valve in the center of the cap that allows a small coolant flow to the Coolant
Recovery System (CRS) tank. If the valve is stuck shut, the radiator hoses will collapse on
cool-down. Clean the vent valve to ensure proper sealing when boiling point is reached.
GASKET
There is a gasket in the cap that seals to the top of the filler neck so that vacuum is maintained to
draw coolant back into the system from the coolant reserve system tank.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Radiator Cap: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Hold the cap in your hand, right side up. The vent valve at the bottom of the cap should open with a
slight pull. If the rubber gasket has swollen preventing the valve from opening, replace the cap. If
any light can be seen between vent valve and the rubber gasket, replace the cap. Use only a
replacement cap that has a spring to hold the vent shut.
NOTE: A replacement cap must be of the type designed for coolant reserve systems. This design
ensures system pressurization.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1878
Radiator Cap: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Radiator Cap - Pressure Testing
Dip the pressure cap in water; clean off any deposits on the vent valve or its seat, and apply the
cap to end of radiator pressure tester. Working the plunger, increase the pressure to 104 kPa (15
psi) on the gauge. If the pressure cap fails to hold pressure of at least 97 kPa (14 psi), replace the
cap.
CAUTION: The radiator pressure tester is very sensitive to small air leaks that will not cause
cooling system problems. A pressure cap that does not have a history of coolant loss should not be
replaced just because it leaks slowly when tested with this tool. Add water to the tool. Turn the tool
upside down, and recheck the pressure cap to confirm that the cap is faulty.
NOTE: If the pressure cap tests properly while positioned the on radiator pressure tester, but will
not hold pressure or vacuum when positioned on the filler neck, inspect the filler neck and cap top
gasket for irregularities that may prevent the cap from sealing properly.
Radiator Cap to Filler Neck Seal - Pressure Relief Check
The pressure cap upper gasket (seal) pressure relief can be checked by removing the overflow
hose at the radiator filler neck nipple. Attach the radiator pressure tester to the filler neck nipple,
and pump air into the system. The pressure cap upper gasket should relieve pressure at 69 - 124
kPa (10 - 18 psi) , and hold pressure at 55 kPa (8 psi) minimum.
WARNING: THE WARNING WORDS DO NOT OPEN HOT ON THE PRESSURE CAP IS A
SAFETY PRECAUTION. WHEN HOT, THE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1879
COOLING SYSTEM BUILDS UP PRESSURE. TO PREVENT SCALDING OR OTHER INJURY,
THE PRESSURE CAP SHOULD NOT BE REMOVED WHILE THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND/OR
UNDER PRESSURE.
There is no need to remove the pressure cap at any time except for the following purposes:
- Check and adjust coolant freeze point
- Refill system with new coolant
- Conducting service procedures
- Checking for leaks
WARNING: IF VEHICLE HAS BEEN RUN RECENTLY, WAIT 15 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING
CAP. PLACE A SHOP TOWEL OVER THE CAP, AND WITHOUT PUSHING DOWN, ROTATE IT
COUNTERCLOCKWISE TO THE FIRST STOP. ALLOW FLUIDS TO ESCAPE THROUGH THE
OVERFLOW TUBE. WHEN THE SYSTEM STOPS PUSHING COOLANT AND STEAM INTO THE
COOLANT RECOVERY SYSTEM (CRS) TANK AND PRESSURE DROPS, PUSH DOWN ON
THE CAP AND REMOVE IT COMPLETELY. SQUEEZING THE RADIATOR INLET HOSE WITH A
SHOP TOWEL (TO CHECK PRESSURE) BEFORE AND AFTER TURNING TO THE FIRST STOP
IS RECOMMENDED.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Hose > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Radiator Hose: Description and Operation
WARNING: IF VEHICLE HAS BEEN RUN RECENTLY, WAIT 15 MINUTES BEFORE WORKING
ON VEHICLE. RELIEVE PRESSURE BY PLACING A SHOP TOWEL OVER THE CAP AND
WITHOUT PUSHING DOWN ROTATE IT COUNTER-CLOCKWISE TO THE FIRST STOP.
ALLOW FLUIDS TO ESCAPE THROUGH THE OVERFLOW TUBE AND WHEN THE SYSTEM
STOPS PUSHING OUT COOLANT AND STEAM AND THE PRESSURE DROPS CONTINUE
SERVICE.
CAUTION:
- Constant tension hose clamps are used on most cooling system hoses. When removing or
installing, use only tools designed for servicing this type of clamp. Always wear safety glasses
when servicing constant tension clamps.
- A number or letter is stamped into the tongue of constant tension clamps. If replacement is
necessary, use only a original equipment clamp with matching number or letter.
HOSES
Radiator hoses should be routed without any kinks and indexed as designed. The use of molded
hoses is recommended. A hardened, cracked, swollen or restricted hose should be replaced. Do
not damage radiator inlet and outlet when loosening hoses.
CLAMPS
Spring type hose clamps are used in all applications. If replacement is necessary replace with the
original Mopar equipment spring type clamp. The hose clamps are removed by using Special Tool
6094, or equivalent constant tension clamp pliers to compress hose clamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1892
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1893
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1894
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1895
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1900
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1901
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1902
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1903
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1909
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 1910
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay
Pin-Out Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay
Pin-Out Revisions > Page 1916
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay
Pin-Out Revisions > Page 1917
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay
Pin-Out Revisions > Page 1918
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay
Pin-Out Revisions > Page 1919
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1924
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1925
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1926
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1927
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1932
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1933
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1934
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1935
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats > Page 1940
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats > Page 1941
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
Solid State Fan Relay: All Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-98D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L SFI Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the PL body radiator fan relay connector pin out
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1947
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1948
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1949
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1950
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats > Page 1955
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON
Continuously/Overheats > Page 1956
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1962
10
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1963
49
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1964
110
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 26-06-98D > Jun > 98 > Cooling System - Cooling Fan Relay Pin-Out
Revisions > Page 1965
111
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7692 Date: 980501
Recall- Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1970
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1971
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1972
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7692 > May > 98 > Recall- Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1973
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you don't get this done...
The State of California requires the completion of emission recall repairs prior to vehicle
registration renewal. In addition, the State requires that every vehicle must pass an emission test
(SMOG Check) every two years and before it is sold. Without the free service we are providing,
your vehicle may be more likely to fail this test and require that you make costly repairs.
Further, in order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty provisions, it is
recommended that you have your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could be
determined as lack of proper maintenance of your vehicle.
How the state knows that the recall has been performed...
State of California regulations require Chrysler to provide the Department of Motor Vehicles with a
record of all vehicles which have not had the recall service performed. If your vehicle is not on this
list the state will know that the recall has been completed.
Your dealer will provide you with a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form after the
recall service is completed. Be sure to save this form since the California Department of Motor
Vehicles may require that you supply it as proof of recall completion.
If you need help...
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll free,
at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired.
We are sorry for any inconvenience but trust you understand our interest in clean air and in your
continued satisfaction with our products. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
Technical Service Bulletin # 7691 Date: 980501
Recall - Radiator Fan Relay
No. 7691
May, 1998
To: All Dodge and Chrysler-Plymouth Dealers
Subject: Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692 -- Radiator Fan Relay
Models: 1997 and 1998 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca
Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
The radiator fan relay on about 45,000 of the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On Board Diagnostic (OBD) system. Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and California Air Resources
Board (GARB) emission regulations. To correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be
replaced and a jumper wire that contains a diode must be installed.
IMPORTANT:
This recall (# 7692) is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall
Enforcement Program. Involved vehicles must have the recall service completed before registration
renewal.
The servicing dealer must provide a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No.
81-016-1053) to each California vehicle owner upon completion of the Recall # 7692 service, for
use as proof in renewal of the vehicle registration.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer to
whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP at the time of notification
mailing for dealer inquiry as needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number is listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt, then type "ORD7691" (vehicles out of California) or ORD7692"
(vehicles in California).
Parts
IMPORTANT:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the notification were invoiced (or the current dealer at
the same street address), will receive enough Fan Relay Packages, PN CKF07690, to service
about 25% of those vehicles.
Each parts package contains the following components:
Quantity Description
1 Radiator Fan Relay
1 Wiring Jumper Assembly
2 Tie Straps
California Recall Completion Label Requirement
There is a California Air Resources Board requirement to affix a label to the vehicle to certify that
the emissions recall (# 7692) was completed. Dealers are requested to order the required
Authorized Modifications label, PN 04275086, as necessary to support scheduled repairs. Refer to
the Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1978
Procedure of this letter for application instructions.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record notification service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use the following labor operation number and time allowance:
Install jumper wire and replace fan relay
Labor Operation Number Time Allowance
07769182 0.3 hours
Add the cost of the parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual Recall Claim Processing Section for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action please contact your Zone
Service Office.
A. Install the Jumper Harness
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect the battery.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1979
3. Disconnect the left (driver side) black fan motor electrical connector by retracting the red latch
and depressing the thumb latch (Figure 1).
4. Disconnect the fan motor wiring harness connector from the fan support (if necessary).
5. Disconnect the two (2) push-in fasteners that secure the radiator fan section of the main
electrical harness to the lower radiator support.
6. Attach the push-in clip on the male connector of the provided jumper harness into the outboard
hole in the lower radiator support so that the connector faces toward the outboard (left) side of the
vehicle (Figure 2).
7. Attach the other jumper harness clip into the inboard hole in the lower radiator support (Figure
2).
8. Connect the main wiring harness radiator fan electrical connector to its mating connector on the
jumper harness. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
9. Connect the other end of the jumper harness to the fan motor harness. Slide the red latch to the
locked position.
10. Bundle the excess fan wiring and secure it to the main wiring harness with the two (2) provided
tie straps.
NOTE:
Make sure that the wiring does not interfere with any other components.
B. Replace the Radiator Fan Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1980
1. Locate the radiator fan relay on the left front inner frame rail just behind the radiator (Figure 3).
2. Disconnect the radiator fan relay wiring connector.
3. Remove and discard the radiator fan relay.
4. Install the new radiator fan relay. Tighten the fasteners to 45 in-lbs (5 N.m).
CAUTION:
Do not over torque screws. To ensure heat transfer and proper operation, the new radiator fan
relay must be installed using both of the screws.
5. Connect the radiator fan relay electrical connector. Slide the red latch to the locked position.
6. Lower the vehicle.
7. Connect the negative battery cable.
C. Install the Authorized Label
1. Type or print (with a ball point pen) the following information (Figure 4) on the Authorized
Modifications label (PN 4275086).
2. Peel the label from its backing and apply it near the Vehicle Emission Control Information Label
located in the engine compartment.
D. Complete Proof of Correction Form
1. Complete a Vehicle emission Recall Proof of Correction Form and supply it to the vehicle owner.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
DEALER SERVICE INSTRUCTIONS
Emissions Recalls # 7691 and # 7692-- Radiator Fan Relay
^ This service requirement applies only to 1997 and 1998 model year Dodge and Plymouth Neon
(PL) vehicles built at the Toluca Assembly Plant ("T" in the 11th VIN Position) through September
10, 1997 (MDH 0910XX) and:
^ Currently Located Out of California -- Recall # 7691
^ Currently Located In California -- Recall # 7692
^ The radiator fan relay on the above listed vehicles, may not turn on the radiator cooling fans. To
correct this condition, the radiator fan relay must be replaced and a jumper wire that contains a
diode must be installed.
^ Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall
notification. The Labor Operation Number for TSB 07-07-97 and 07-04-98 is being canceled.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Solid State Fan Relay: > 7691 > May > 98 > Recall - Radiator Fan Relay > Page 1981
^ For vehicles currently located in California involved in Recall # 7692: Be sure to provide a Vehicle
Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) to each owner upon completion
of the recall service, for owner use as proof during renewal of the vehicle registration.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in this notification were invoiced, will receive enough Fan
Relay Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
EMISSIONS RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S RADIATOR FAN RELAY AND INSTALL A
WIRING JUMPER HARNESS
Dear Dodge or Plymouth Neon Owner:
Chrysler has determined that some 1997 and 1998 Dodge and Plymouth Neon vehicles may be in
violation of Federal Emissions Regulations.
The problem is...
The radiator fan relay on your Neon (identified on the enclosed form), may not turn on the radiator
cooling fans. This may cause the engine to overheat. In addition, radiator fan relay operation is
monitored by the vehicles On-Board Diagnostic system (OBD). Failure of an OBD monitored
component violates U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Emission Regulations.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your vehicle free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will replace
the radiator fan relay and install a wiring jumper harness. The work will take about 1/2 hour to
complete. However, additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are
scheduled and processed.
What you must do...
^ Simply contact your dealer to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold the parts for
your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to your dealer.
If you need help...
^ If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-992-1997. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If you are
still unable to obtain the repair as described in this letter within a reasonable time, you may also
contact the Vehicle Programs and Compliance Division of the Environmental Protection Agency
(6405J), 401 M Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20460.
In order to ensure your full protection under the emission warranty made applicable to your vehicle
under Federal law, and your right to participate in future recalls, it is recommended that you have
your vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Failure to do so could legally be determined to be a lack
of proper maintenance of your vehicle. Further, without this repair your vehicle may fail a state or
local emission inspection test.
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but trust that you understand our interest in clean air and your
continuing satisfaction with our product. Thanks for your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1982
Solid State Fan Relay: Locations
Fig.31 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1983
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The power distribution center (PDC) is located next to the battery in the engine compartment. The
PDC contains the starter relay, radiator fan relay, A/C compressor clutch relay, auto shutdown
relay, fuel pump relay and several fuses. For the location of the relay within the PDC, refer to the
PDC cover for location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1984
Solid State Relay
Solid State Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1987
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1988
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1989
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1990
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1991
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1992
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1993
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1994
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1995
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1996
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1997
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1998
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1999
Solid State Fan Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2000
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2001
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2002
Radiator Fan Relay Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2003
Solid State Fan Relay: Electrical Diagrams
Dual Cooling Fans
A/C & Heater System -- Sheet 8w-42-4
Chrysler Does not provide a wiring diagram for dual fans on 95-98 model year Neons. This diagram
is for the 99 model year and is presented for reference only.
Single Cooling Fan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2004
A/C And Heat Part 1 of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2005
A/C And Heat Part 2 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2006
A/C And Heat Part 3 Of 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2007
A/C And Heat Part 4 Of 4
The OE does not show a wiring diagram showing the dual fan option specifically until 1999 but the
dual fan option is mentioned. Additionally, the Radiator Fan Control is shown as a portion of the
A/C circuit and as a portion of the PCM circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Solid State Fan Relay <--> [Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2008
Solid State Fan Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2014
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2015
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2016
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System/Temperature
Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2019
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2020
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The temperature gauge is connected to the engine coolant temperature sensor on the G20 circuit.
The engine coolant temperature sensor for the gauge is a combination unit. One side of the unit is
used for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and the other side for the cluster. The sending unit
is case grounded to the engine.
The logic driven gauge moves in response to the measured resistance of the engine coolant
temperature sending unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2024
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
1. Disconnect the coolant temperature sensor. 2. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge
should be at its lowest position. Turn ignition switch OFF 3. Ground temperature gauge sending
unit connector Pin 3. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge should be at its highest
position. After
the seat belt lamp goes out, the cluster should chime for about Eight Seconds. a. If OK, check
temperature sending unit connector for proper connection. If connections are OK, replace the
sending unit. b. If not OK, and the high temperature chime sounds but the gauge shows cold,
replace the gauge assembly If gauge is still not working, replace
the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Thermostat: Mechanical Specifications
Case Assembly Mounting Bolt
................................................................................................................................................... 17 20 Nm (12 - 14 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 2029
Thermostat: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Opening Temperature .........................................................................................................................
......................................................... 90.5° C (195° F) Full Opening Temperature .............................
............................................................................................................................................... 102° C
(216° F)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2030
Thermostat: Locations
The engine thermostat is located on the front of the engine (radiator side) in the thermostat
housing/engine outlet connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2031
Thermostat: Description and Operation
LOCATION
The engine thermostat is located on the front of the engine (radiator side) in the thermostat
housing/ engine outlet connector. The thermostat has an air bleed (vent) located in the flange and
a O-ring for sealing incorporate on it. There is a relief in the thermostat housing/outlet connector for
the O-ring.
DESIGN
The engine cooling thermostats are wax pellet driven, reverse poppet choke type. They are
designed to provide the fastest warm up possible by preventing leakage through them and to
guarantee a minimum engine operating temperature of 88 - 93°C (192 - 199°F). They also
automatically reach wide open so they do not restrict flow to the radiator as temperature of the
coolant rises in hot weather to around 104°C (220°F). Above this temperature the coolant
temperature is controlled by the radiator, fan, and ambient temperature, not the thermostat.
PURPOSE
Its primary purpose is to maintain engine temperature in a range that will provide satisfactory
engine performance and emission levels under all expected driving conditions. It also provides hot
water (coolant) for heater performance. It does this by transferring heat from engine metal and
automatic transmission oil cooler (if equipped) to coolant, moving this heated coolant to the heater
core and radiator, and then transferring this heat to the ambient air.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2032
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
GENERAL INFORMATION
The thermostat is operated by a wax filled container (Pellet) which is sealed so that when heated to
a predetermined temperature. The wax expands enough to overcome the closing spring and water
pump pressure, which forces the valve to open. Coolant leakage into the pellet will cause a
thermostat to fail open. Do not attempt to free up a thermostat with a screwdriver.
IMPROPER OPERATION
The thermostat that opens too soon type failure mode is included in the on-board diagnosis. The
check engine light will not be lit by an open too soon condition. If it has failed open, code 17 will be
set. Do not change a thermostat for lack of heater performance or temperature gage position,
unless code 17 is present. Thermostat failing shut is the normal long term mode of failure, and
normally, only on high mileage vehicles. The temperature gauge will indicate this.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2033
Thermostat: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain cooling system to the thermostat level or below. 2. Remove Coolant Recovery System
(CRS) hose and thermostat/engine outlet connector bolts. 3. Remove thermostat assembly, and
clean sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Place the new thermostat assembly into the engine outlet connector. Align air bleed with notch
on the cylinder head. 2. Install thermostat housing/outlet connector onto cylinder head and tighten
bolts to 12.5 Nm (110 inch lbs.). Connect the CRS hose. 3. Refill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications
Thermostat Housing: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) Inlet Tube To Engine Block ..............................
.................................................................................................................................. 12 Nm (105 inch
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2040
Water Pump: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The water has a diecast aluminum body and housing with a stamped steel impeller. The water
pump bolts directly to the block. Cylinder block to water pump sealing is provided by a rubber
O-ring. The water pump is driven by the timing belt. The water pump is the heart of the cooling
system , pumping the coolant through the engine block, cylinder head, heater core, and radiator.
NOTE: The water pump on all models can be replaced without discharging the air conditioning
system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2041
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
OPERATIONAL TEST
A quick flow test to tell whether or not the pump is working is to see if the heater warms properly. A
defective pump will not be able to circulate heated coolant through the long heater hose. Another
flow test to help determine pump operation, remove radiator cap.
CAUTION: DO NOT remove radiator cap if the cooling system is hot or under pressure.
FLOW TEST
1. Remove radiator cap. 2. Remove a small amount of coolant from the system, start the engine
and warm up until thermostat opens. With the thermostat open and coolant
level low you will see if the water pump is pumping coolant through the system.
REASONS FOR REPLACEMENT
Replace water pump body assembly if it has any of these defects: Cracks or damage on the body.
- Coolant leaks from the shaft seal, evident by coolant traces on the pump body.
- Loose or rough turning bearing.
- Impeller rubs either the pump body or the engine block.
- Impeller loose or damaged.
- Sprocket or sprocket flange loose or damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2042
Water Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Remove right inner splash shield. 2. Remove accessory drive belts and
power steering pump. 3. Drain cooling system. 4. Support engine from the bottom and remove right
engine mount. 5. Remove power steering pump bracket bolts and set pump and bracket assembly
aside. Power steering lines do not need to be disconnected. 6. Remove right engine mount
bracket. 7. Remove timing belt. 8. Remove inner timing belt cover.
9. Remove water pump attaching screws to engine.
INSTALLATION
1. Install O-ring in water pump body O-ring groove. Use small dabs of Mopar Silicone Rubber
Adhesive Sealant, or equivalent around the water
pump body to secure O-ring in place during installation.
CAUTION: Make sure O-ring is properly seated in water pump groove before tightening screws. An
improperly located O-ring may cause damage to the O-ring and cause a coolant leak.
2. Assemble pump body to block and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs). Pressurize cooling
system to 15 psi with pressure tester and check
water pump shaft seal and O-ring for leaks.
3. Rotate pump by hand to check for freedom of movement. 4. Install inner timing belt cover. 5.
Install timing belt. 6. Install right engine mount bracket and engine mount. 7. Fill cooling system. 8.
Install power steering pump and accessory drive belts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Catalyst Shield >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Catalyst Shield: Description and Operation
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts.
PURPOSE
The heat shield is needed to protect both the car and the environment from the high temperatures
developed in the vicinity of the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: Avoid application of rust prevention compounds or undercoating materials to exhaust
system floor pan heat shield on cars. Light over-spray near the edges is permitted. Application of
coating will greatly reduce the efficiency of the heat shields resulting in excessive floor pan
temperatures and objectionable fumes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Manifold To Exhaust Pipe ....................................................................................................................
.................................................... 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Manifold Flange (LEV) ......................................
................................................................................................................................. 28 Nm (250 inch
lbs.) Mounting Bolts .............................................................................................................................
....................................................... 23 Nm (200 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2051
Exhaust Manifold: Description and Operation
The exhaust manifold is made of nodular cast iron for strength and high temperatures. Exhaust
gasses exit through a machined, articulated joint connection to the exhaust pipe.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove air cleaner assembly and bracket.
2. Remove exhaust manifold heat shield. 3. Disconnect upstream heated oxygen sensor connector.
4. Remove exhaust pipe from manifold.
5. Remove 8 exhaust manifold retaining fasteners and remove exhaust manifold.
NOTE: Discard gasket and clean all gasket surfaces of manifolds and cylinder head.
INSTALLATION
1. Set exhaust manifold and gasket in place. Apply Loctite 271 or equivalent to fasteners and
tighten to 23 Nm (200 inch lbs.) starting at center and
progressing outward in both directions. Repeat this procedure until all fasteners are at specified
torque.
2. Install exhaust manifold heat shield. 3. Connect upstream heated oxygen sensor connector. 4.
Install air cleaner bracket and assembly. 5. Attach exhaust pipe and tighten fasteners to 28 Nm
(250 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2054
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
1. Discard gasket and clean all gasket from surfaces of manifolds and cylinder head. 2. Test
manifold gasket surfaces for flatness with straight edge. Surface must be flat within 0.15 mm per
300 mm (0.006 inch per foot) of manifold
length.
3. Inspect manifolds for cracks or distortion. Replace manifold if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Removal
1. Raise vehicle on hoist and apply penetrating oil to band clamp fastener of component being
removed.
NOTE: Do not use petroleum-based lubricants when removing/installing muffler or exhaust pipe
isolators as it may compromise the life of the part. A suitable substitute is a mixture of liquid dish
soap and water.
2. Loosen band clamp and remove support insulators at muffler. Remove muffler from exhaust
pipe. 3. Disconnect downstream heated oxygen sensor from the catalytic converter pipe.
4. Remove clamp at the catalytic converter to exhaust pipe slip joint. Separate at slip joint.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2059
5. When removing exhaust pipe, raise rear of vehicle to relieve body weight from rear suspension
to provide clearance between pipe and lateral arms.
6. Remove catalytic converter to exhaust manifold attaching bolts. 7. Clean ends of pipes and/or
muffler to assure mating of all parts. Discard broken or worn insulators, rusted clamps, supports
and attaching parts.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, you must use
original equipment parts, or equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2060
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Installation
NOTE: When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until components are aligned and
clearances are checked.
1. Assemble catalytic convertor to exhaust manifold ball joint connection. 2. Assemble exhaust pipe
to catalytic convertor and the support to the underbody 3. Install the muffler to exhaust pipe and the
supports to the underbody. 4. Working from the front of system; 5. Align and tighten the catalytic
convertor to exhaust manifold ball joint bolts.
6. Align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with underbody parts and
tighten clamps to specification. 7. Connect the downstream heated oxygen sensor.
8. A new style band clamp (Torca) will be used on this vehicles exhaust system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger > Component
Information > Specifications
Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Specifications
Fastener ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Service and Repair Removal
1. Raise vehicle on hoist and apply penetrating oil to band clamp fastener of component being
removed.
NOTE: Do not use petroleum-based lubricants when removing/installing muffler or exhaust pipe
isolators as it may compromise the life of the part. A suitable substitute is a mixture of liquid dish
soap and water.
2. Loosen band clamp and remove support insulators at muffler. Remove muffler from exhaust
pipe. 3. Clean ends of pipes and/or muffler to assure mating of all parts. Discard broken or worn
insulators, rusted clamps, supports and attaching parts.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, you must use
original equipment parts, or equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2066
Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Service and Repair Installation
NOTE: When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until components are aligned and
clearances are checked.
1. Install the muffler to exhaust pipe and the supports to the underbody. 2. Working from the front
of system align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with underbody parts
and tighten clamps to
specification.
3. A new style band clamp (Torca) will be used on this vehicles exhaust system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Specifications
Heat Shield: Specifications
Manifold Heat Shield ...........................................................................................................................
............................................... 23 Nm (200 inch lbs.) Body Shields ....................................................
....................................................................................................................................... 4 Nm (35
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2070
Heat Shield: Description and Operation
The heat shield is needed to protect both the car and the environment from the high temperatures
developed in the vicinity of the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: Avoid application of rust prevention compounds or undercoating materials to exhaust
system floor pan heat shield on cars if equipped. Light over-spray near the edges is permitted.
Application of coating will greatly reduce the efficiency of the heat shields resulting in excessive
floor pan temperatures and objectionable fumes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Muffler: Service and Repair Removal
1. Raise vehicle on hoist and apply penetrating oil to band clamp fastener of component being
removed.
NOTE: Do not use petroleum-based lubricants when removing/installing muffler or exhaust pipe
isolators as it may compromise the life of the part. A suitable substitute is a mixture of liquid dish
soap and water.
2. Loosen band clamp and remove support insulators at muffler. Remove muffler from exhaust
pipe. 3. When removing exhaust pipe, raise rear of vehicle to relieve body weight from rear
suspension to provide clearance between pipe and lateral arms. 4. Clean ends of pipes and/or
muffler to assure mating of all parts. Discard broken or worn insulators, rusted clamps, supports
and attaching parts.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, you must use
original equipment parts, or equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 2075
Muffler: Service and Repair Installation
NOTE: When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until components are aligned and
clearances are checked.
1. Install the muffler to exhaust pipe and the supports to the underbody. 2. Working from the front
of system; 3. Align and tighten the catalytic convertor to exhaust manifold ball joint bolts.
4. Align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with underbody parts and
tighten clamps to specification.
5. A new style band clamp (Torca) will be used on this vehicles exhaust system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Specifications
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
PCM 60-Way Connector Torque = 4 Nm (35 in lb) PCM Mounting Screws = 4 Nm (35 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2082
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2085
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2086
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2087
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2088
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2089
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2090
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2091
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2092
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2093
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2094
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2095
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2096
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2097
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2098
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2099
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2100
Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2101
Powertrain Control Module: Service Precautions
- Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is off. Failure to do so could
damage the module.
- When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end)
of the connector.
- Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause it to fail
because of corrosion.
- Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
- Operation of any type, including idling, should be avoided if engine misfiring occurs. Under this
condition, the exhaust system operates at abnormally high temperature, which may cause damage
to the catalyst or under-body parts of the vehicle.
- Alteration or deterioration of ignition or fuel system, or any type of operating condition which
results in engine misfiring must be corrected to avoid overheating the catalytic converter.
- Proper maintenance and tune-up, according to manufacturer's specifications, should be made to
correct abnormal conditions as soon as possible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 from the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies battery voltage to cavity 46 of the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). A 20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuit A14.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2104
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation PCM Operation
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor (Fig. 2).
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
PCM Inputs: Air Conditioning Controls
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor
- Ignition Switch (A21)
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oxygen Sensors
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receiver
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Transmission Park/Neutral Switch (Automatic Transmission)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
PCM Outputs:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2105
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Air Conditioning WOT Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp
- Data Link Connector
- Duty Cycle EVAP Canister Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor
- Ignition Coils
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp
- Radiator Fan Relay
- Speed Control Solenoids
- Tachometer
- Torque Convertor Clutch Solenoid
Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts: Fuel Injector Pulse Width
- Idle Speed
- Ignition Spark Advance
- Ignition Coil Dwell
- EVAP Canister Purge Operation.
The PCM Regulates: Cooling Fan
- Air Conditioning
- Speed Control System
- Generator Charge Rate -- by Adjusting The Generator Field
The PCM Also Performs Diagnostics
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on: Battery Voltage
- Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Content (Oxygen Sensor)
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on: Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on: Air Conditioning Sense
- Battery Temperature
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Engine Run Time
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
- Vehicle Distance (Speed)
ASD and Fuel Pump Relay Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2106
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are mounted externally, but turned on and off by
the PCM.
Crankshaft Position (Engine Speed) Signal The crankshaft position sensor signal is sent to the
PCM. If the PCM does not receive the signal within approximately one second of engine cranking,
it deactivates the ASD relay and fuel pump relay When these relays deactivate, power is shut off
from the fuel injectors, ignition coils, heating element in the oxygen sensors and the fuel pump.
PCM Regulated Output Supply Voltages The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes
battery voltage to a regulated 8 volts direct current to power: Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
The PCM also provides a 5 volt direct current supply for: Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
- Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2107
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Powertrain Control Module The speed control electronic control circuitry is integrated into the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The PCM is located in the engine compartment. The PCM
speed control functions are monitored by the On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). All OBD-sensed
systems are monitored by the PCM. Each monitored circuit is assigned a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC). The PCM will store a DTC in electronic memory for any failure it detects. The PCM cannot
be repaired and must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Powertrain Control Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit A14 connects to a bus bar in the PDC that the battery feeds. Circuit A14 powers the
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay and fuel pump relay The A14 circuit also splices to the data link
connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2110
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
NOTE: The PCM attaches to the inner fender panel next to the washer fluid bottle on the driver
side (Fig. 100).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Disconnect positive cable from battery. 3. Remove
washer bottle neck. 4. Squeeze tabs on Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling PDC up to
remove it from bracket.
- Lay PDC aside to gain access to PCM bracket screws.
5. Remove screws attaching PCM to body. 3. Lift PCM up and disconnect the 2 40-way connector
7. Remove PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the 2 40-way connector to PCM. 2. Install PCM. Tighten mounting screws to 4 Nm (35 in
lb) torque. 3. Install PDC by pushing down into brackets. 4. Install washer bottle neck. 5. Connect
positive cable to battery. 6. Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2114
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2117
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2118
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2119
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2122
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)]
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2123
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2129
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The inside top of the PDC
cover has a label showing relay and fuse location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2130
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay
Connector
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay
Connector > Page 2133
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay
Connector > Page 2134
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel
Pump Relay Operation
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Operation
NAME OF CODE:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
WHEN MONITORED:
With the ignition key ON and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
SET CONDITION:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). One side of
the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "RUN"
position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the
powertrain control module (PCM). The PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either
the RUN or CRANK position and engine RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM
will remove the fuel pump relay control circuit ground.
POSSIBLE CAUSES:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel
Pump Relay Operation > Page 2137
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit Trouble Code
Name of Code:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key on and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the PDC. One side of the relay control coil is
supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "run position". The circuit is
completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the powertrain control module. The
PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either the run or crank position and engine
RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM will remove the fuel pump relay control
circuit ground.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2138
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump relay.
Terminal 85 -- The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A -- When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87 When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should not show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one
end of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the
jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2139
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
NOTE: Other testing for this system or component is done at the system level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2143
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2146
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2147
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2148
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2151
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2152
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
> Page 2158
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2161
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2162
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 2167
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2170
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2171
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2172
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2173
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2174
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing > Page 2177
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Component Testing > Page 2178
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 2181
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 2182
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2186
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2187
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2188
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Lamps and Indicators Cooling System/Temperature Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2191
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2192
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2199
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2200
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2201
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2202
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2203
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Failure to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Failure to Start Test > Page 2206
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement > Page 2209
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit G4 provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) indicating fuel tank level. This
circuit connects to cavity 23 of the PCM connector.
The G4 circuit is also used for the fuel gauge located in the instrument cluster. For operation of fuel
gauge, See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Fuel Gauge/Description and
Operation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 2214
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2217
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2218
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2219
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2220
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2221
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2225
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2226
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2227
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The intake air temperature sensor measures the temperature of the air as it enters the engine. The
sensor supplies one of the inputs the PCM uses to determine injector pulse-width.
CONSTRUCTION
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, located on the intake manifold, combines the MAP
and Intake Air Temperature (IAT) functions into one sensor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The intake air temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on
circuit K21. Circuit K21 connects to cavity 37 of the PCM connector.
From circuit K21 the intake air temperature sensor draws voltage from the PCM. The sensor is a
variable resistor As intake air temperature changes the resistance in the sensor changes causing a
change in current draw.
The PCM provides ground for the intake air temperature sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit
K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Helpful Information
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2230
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2231
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2235
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2236
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2237
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 2240
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2241
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The MAP sensor puts out a low voltage signal (0.5 to 1.8 volts) at idle when the manifold vacuum is
high, and a higher voltage signal (3.9 to 4.8 volts) at open throttle when the manifold vacuum is
low.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications > Page 2246
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2247
Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2248
IAT/Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2249
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
OPERATION
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sen son The MAP sensor function converts intake manifold
pressure into voltage. The PCM monitors the MAP sensor output voltage. As vacuum increases,
MAP sensor voltage decreases proportionately. Also, as vacuum decreases, MAP sensor voltage
increases proportionately.
During cranking, before the engine starts running, the PCM determines atmosphenc air pressure
from the MAP sensor voltage. While the engine operates, the PCM determines intake manifold
pressure from the MAP sensor voltage. Based on MAP sensor voltage and inputs from other
sensors, the PCM adjusts spark advance and the air/fuel mixture.
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (MAP/IAT) sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Manifold Absolute
Pressure (MAP) sensor. Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K1 delivers the MAP signal to the PCM. Circuit K1 connects to cavity 36 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the MAP sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 82 MAP Sensor Connector
CAUTION: When testing the MAP sensor, be sure that the harness wires are not damaged by the
test meter probes.
1. Test the MAP sensor output voltage at the MAP sensor connector between terminals 1 and 4
(Fig. 82). With the ignition switch ON and the engine
not running, output voltage should be 4 to 5 volts. The voltage should drop to 1.5 to 2.1 volts with a
hot, neutral idle speed condition. If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, go to step 3.
2. Test PCM terminal 36 for the same voltage described in the previous step to verify wire harness
condition. Repair as required. 3. Test the MAP sensor ground circuit at sensor connector terminal 1
and PCM terminal 43.
- If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, repair as required.
4. Test MAP sensor supply voltage between sensor connector terminals 3 and 1 with the key ON.
The voltage should be approximately 5 volts ±
0.5V). Five volts (± 0.5V) should also be at terminal 61 of the PCM. If OK, replace MAP sensor.
- If not OK, repair or replace the wire harness as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2252
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2253
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 2254
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Upstream and Downstream
Heated Oxygen Sensors Torque = 28 Nm (20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations > Page 2260
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor
Bank Locations > Page 2261
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2262
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2263
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2264
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay. The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground path circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors.
The A142 circuit also splices to cavity 6 of the PCM. The input provided by circuit A142 at cavity 6
tells the PCM that the ASD relay energized.
Circuit K41 delivers the signal from the upstream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit K41
connects to cavity 30 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K141 delivers the signal from the down-stream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit
K141 connects to cavity 51 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides a ground for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensor signals
(circuit K41 and K141) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector
Circuit Z1 provides ground for the heater circuits in each sensor. Circuit Z1 terminates at the left
side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator, and
the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors. The PCM controls the ground circuit for
each of the components powered by circuit A142.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 2267
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Test
NOTE: Use an ohmmeter to test the heating element of the oxygen sensors.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from each oxygen sensor.
- The white wires in the sensor connector are the power and ground circuits for the heater
elements.
2. Connect the ohmmeter test leads to terminals of the white wires in the heated oxygen sensor
connector.
- Replace the heated oxygen sensor if the resistance is not between 4 and 7 ohms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 19 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
NOTE: The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust pipe behind the catalytic
convertor (Fig. 19).
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig. 20 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent (Fig. 20).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream O2 Sensor > Page 2270
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 18 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector. 3. Remove sensor using an oxygen
sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or equivalent (Fig. 18).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2271
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2276
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2277
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2278
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2279
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2284
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2285
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2286
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2287
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information > Page 2290
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2291
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2292
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2296
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2297
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 2.2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2301
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2304
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2305
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2306
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2307
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2308
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2309
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2310
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2311
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2312
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2313
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2314
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2315
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2316
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2317
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2318
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2319
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> System Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed. Refer to the
Powertrain Management/Computer and Control Systems/Diagnostic Procedures for diagnosis and
testing of this component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> System Operation > Page 2322
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor-PCM Input
Fig. 17 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Automatic Transmission
Fig. 18 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Manual Transmission
PURPOSE
The sensor input is used by the PCM to determine vehicle speed and distance traveled.
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor generates 8 pulses per sensor revolution. These signals, in conjunction
with a closed throttle signal from the throttle position sensor, indicate a closed throttle deceleration
to the PCM. Under deceleration conditions, the PCM adjusts the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor to
maintain a desired MAP value.
When the vehicle is stopped at idle, a closed throttle signal is received by the PCM (but a speed
sensor signal is not received). Under idle conditions, the PCM adjusts the IAC motor to maintain a
desired engine speed.
The vehicle speed sensor signal is also used to operate: Speedometer
- Speed control
- Daytime Running Lights (Canadian Vehicles only).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the Vehicle Speed Sensor
(VSS). The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit G7 from the VSS provides an input signal to the PCM. The G7 circuit connects to cavity 66
of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the VSS signal (circuit G7) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit G7 splices to the speedometer and odometer in the instrument cluster.
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2325
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 24 Vehicle Speed Sensor
Fig. 7 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Connector
Fig. 8 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Speedometer Pinion
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2326
NOTE: The vehicle speed sensor is located in the transmission extension housing (Fig. 24).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 2. Remove the sensor mounting bolt. 3. Lift the
sensor out of the transaxle extension housing. Ensure the 0-ring was removed with the sensor.
NOTE: The speed sensor gear meshes with a gear on the output shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. With 0-ring in place, install sensor and seat sensor by hand -- to ensure proper gear
engagement. 2. Install mounting bolt and torque bolt to 2.2 Nm (20 in lb). 3. Connect electrical
connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2332
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2333
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2334
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2335
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information > Page 2338
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2339
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2340
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam
Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam
Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 2346
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2350
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2351
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2352
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2353
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing > Page 2356
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component
Testing > Page 2357
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement > Page 2360
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor
Replacement > Page 2361
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2368
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2369
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2370
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2371
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2372
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to
Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to
Start Test > Page 2375
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft
Position Sensor Replacement > Page 2378
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2383
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2387
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2388
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2389
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page
2392
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2393
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Fuel
Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Minimum Air Flow Idle Odometer <= 1,000 Miles ................................................................................
............................................................................................. 550 - 1,300 rpm Odometer >= 1,000
Miles ....................................................................................................................................................
......................... 600 - 1,300 rpm
Note: Idle speed range achieved through Minimum Air Flow Idle Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2402
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 31 PCV Vacuum Nipple
1. Turn ignition key off. 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold nipple (Fig. 31).
Cap the PCV vacuum nipple.
Fig. 32 Purge Hose
3. Disconnect purge hose from the nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 32).
Fig. 33 Orifice 6457 Attached To Purge Nipple
4. Use a piece of hose to attach Air Metering Orifice 6457 (0.125 in. orifice) or equivalent, to the
purge nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 33). 5. Ensure that all accessories are off. 6. Connect the
DRB or equivalent scan tool to the data link connector inside the passenger compartment. 7. Run
engine in Park or Neutral until the cooling fan has cycled on and off at least once (180°F). 8. Using
the DRB or equivalent scan tool, access Minimum Airflow Idle Speed. 9. The following will then
occur:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2403
- Idle air control motor will fully close
- Idle spark advance will become fixed
- PCM will go open loop enriched
- DRB or equivalent scan tool displays engine RPM
10. If idle RPM is within the range shown below, throttle body minimum airflow is set correctly.
Odometer Reading Idle RPM
Below 1,000 Miles 550 - 1,300 RPM
Above 1,000 Miles 600 - 1,300 RPM
11. If idle RPM is above specifications, use the DRB or equivalent scan tool to check idle air control
motor operation. If idle air control motor is OK,
replace throttle body. If idle air flow is below specification, shut off the engine and clean the throttle
body as follows: a. Remove the throttle body from engine.
WARNING: Clean throttle body in a well ventilated area. Wear rubber or butyl gloves, do not let
Mopar parts cleaner come in contact with eyes or skin. Avoid ingesting the cleaner. Wash
thoroughly after using cleaner.
b. While holding the throttle open, spray the entire throttle body bore and the manifold side of the
throttle plate with Mopar Parts Cleaner. Only
use Mopar Parts Cleaner to clean the throttle body.
c. Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom of throttle body bore and the edges and
manifold side of the throttle blade. The edges of the
throttle blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest to the throttle blade when is closed,
must be free of deposits.
d. Use compressed air to dry the throttle body. e. Inspect throttle body for foreign material. f.
Install throttle body on manifold.
g. Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow is still not within specifications, the problem is
not caused by the throttle body.
12. Shut off engine. 13. Remove Air Metering Orifice 6457 or equivalent. Install purge hose. 14.
Remove cap from PCV valve. Connect hose to PCV valve. 15. Remove DRB or equivalent scan
tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Fig. 104 Air Intake Duct
Fig. 105 Removal/Installation of Air Inlet Duct
NOTE: Neon vehicles do not use a heated air inlet system. The PCM adjusts fuel injector pulse
width and ignition timing to compensate for different ambient temperatures.
NOTE: The air cleaner attaches to a bracket on the rear of the cylinder head. An ambient air duct
supplies underhood air for the engine.
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake tube (Fig. 104) from air cleaner and intake manifold (Fig. 105).
Fig. 106 Removal/Installation Air Cleaner Front Housing and Element
2. Tighten clasps on top of air cleaner housing. Rotate front of housing forward then lift front away
from air cleaner housing (Fig 106). 3. Remove air cleaner element from front housing (Fig. 106).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2408
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element into front housing. 2. Rotate front of housing forward then lower into
place and locate tabs in slots.
- Fasten clasps on top of air cleaner housing.
- Install air intake duct at air cleaner and intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 2413
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2424
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Plastic clips in various locations protect the cables from damage. When the cables are replaced the
clips must be used to prevent damage to the cables. The #1 cable must be routed under the PCV
hose and clipped to the #2 cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Ignition Cable: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2427
Ignition Cable: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Testing For Open Circuits, High Resistance and Loose Terminals
Use an ohmmeter to check cables for opens, loose terminals or high resistance as follows:
1. Remove cable from spark plug. 2. Remove cable from the coil tower. 3. Connect the ohmmeter
between the spark plug end terminal and the coil end terminal.
- Make sure ohmmeter probes are in good contact.
- Resistance should be within tolerance shown in the cable resistance chart.
- If resistance is not within tolerance, replace cable assembly. Test all spark plug cables in the
same manner.
- If no problems are found, SEE Ignition System/System Diagnosis/Testing For Spark At Coil.
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Testing For Punctures and Cracks
When testing cables for punctures and cracks with an oscilloscope and an inductive voltage probe,
follow the instructions of the equipment manufacturers.
CAUTION: Do not leave any one spark plug cable disconnected for more than 30 seconds during
test or possible heat damage to catalytic converter will occur.
If an oscilloscope and inductive probe are not available, cables can be tested as follows:
1. With the engine not running, connect one end of a test probe (i.e. a piece of wire with insulated
alligator clips on each end) to a good ground, other
end free for probing.
WARNING: The ignition system generates approximately 40,000 volts. Personal injury could result
from contact with this system.
2. With the engine running, move test probe along entire length of all cables (approximately 0 to 1/8
inch gap).
- If punctures or cracks are present there will be a noticeable spark jump from the faulty area to the
probe.
- Replace cracked, leaking or faulty cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Cleaning
Clean high tension cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Cleaning > Page 2430
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Replacement
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: The cables insulate the spark plugs and cover the top of the spark plug tube (Fig. 3).
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
REMOVAL
1. Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Lightly grasp the top of the cable. 2. Rotate the insulator
1/2 turn and pull straight up in a steady motion. 3. To replace the cables, disconnect the cable from
the ignition coil.
INSTALLATION
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube.Then connect the other end to coil pack.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Electrode Gap ......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... (0.033-0.038 in) Torque ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm
(20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2434
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Plug Type ............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... RC9YC Thread Size ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
(14mm) 3/4 in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2435
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Resistor spark plugs are used in this engine.
Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes and fouled, cracked or broken
porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from the
engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended.
Faulty or fouled spark plugs may perform well at idle speed, but frequently fail at higher engine
speeds. Faulty plugs can be identified in a number of ways: poor fuel economy, power loss,
decrease in engine speed, hard starting and, in general, poor engine performance.
Spark plugs also malfunction because of carbon fouling, excessive electrode air gap, or a broken
insulator. SEE Powertrain Management/Ignition System/Testing and Inspection/Procedures, for
spark plug diagnosis.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2438
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2439
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2440
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2441
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2442
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Heavy Colored Deposits
DESCRIPTION:
Colored coatings heavily deposited on the portion of the plug projecting into the chamber and on
the side facing the intake valve.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Leaking Valve Seals (1 or 2 cylinders) - Check the valve seals. Replace if necessary. Clean, regap,
and reinstall
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Normal Operating Conditions
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
The few deposits present will be probably light tan or slightly gray in color with most grades of
commercial gasoline. There will not be evidence of electrode burning. Gap growth will not average
more than approximately 0.025 mm (0.001 in) per 1600 km (1000 miles) of operation for non
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2443
platinum spark plugs. Non-platinum spark plugs that have normal wear can usually be cleaned,
have the electrodes filed and regapped, and then reinstalled.
CAUTION: Never attempt to file the electrodes or use a wire brush for cleaning platinum spark
plugs. This would damage the platinum pads which would shorten spark plug life.
Some fuel refiners in several areas of the United States have introduced a manganese additive
(MMT) for unleaded fuel. During combustion, fuel with MMT may coat the entire tip of the spark
plug with a rust colored deposit. The rust color deposits can be misdiagnosed as being caused by
coolant in the combustion chamber. Spark plug performance may be affected by MMT deposits.
Oil or Ash Encrusted
OIL OR ASH ENCRUSTED
Oil Or Ash Encrusted
If one or more plugs are oil or ash encrusted, evaluate the engine for the cause of oil entering the
combustion chambers. Sometimes fuel additives can cause ash encrustation on an entire set of
spark plugs. Ash encrusted spark plugs can be cleaned and reused.
Premature Electrode Wear - Preignition Damage
PREIGNITION DAMAGE
Preignition Damage
Excessive combustion chamber temperature can cause preignition damage. First, the center
electrode dissolves and the ground electrode dissolves somewhat later. Insulators appear relatively
deposit free. Other possible causes include ignition timing over-advanced and incorrect spark plug
heat range.
Spark plugs are designed to operate within a specific temperature range, called spark plug heat
range. Variations in thickness and length of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2444
center electrode and porcelain insulator change how fast the plug can dissipate heat and determine
the plugs heat range.
Determine if the spark plugs are the correct type, as specified on the VECI label, or if other
operating conditions are causing engine overheating.
Red, Brown, Yellow or White Deposits - Fuel Additives
SCAVENGER DEPOSITS
Scavenger Deposits
Fuel scavenger deposits may be either white or yellow. They may appear to be harmful, but are a
normal condition caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. These additives are designed to
change the chemical nature of deposits and decrease spark plug misfire tendencies. Notice that
accumulation on the ground electrode and shell area may be heavy but the deposits are easily
removed using standard procedures. Spark plugs with scavenger deposits can be considered
normal in condition, cleaned and reused.
Shiny Yellow Glaze
COMBUSTION DEPOSITS
A shiny yellow glaze coating on the spark plug insulator is evidence of metallic by-products of fuel
combustion, caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. Avoid sudden acceleration with wide
open throttle after long periods of low speed driving. Spark plugs with combustion deposits can be
cleaned and reused.
Spark Plug Inspection
- Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes. Also check for fouled, cracked
or broken porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from
the engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended in the Maintenance
Schedules.
- Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned and reused if not otherwise defective -- SEE
Spark Plug Condition. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file. Adjust the gap between the electrodes to the specified dimension. The spark plug gap is 0.033
to0.038 in.
- Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion resulting
in a change in the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Wet Oily Deposits
FUEL FOULING
A spark plug that is coated with excessive wet fuel is called fuel fouled. This condition is normally
observed during hard start periods. Clean fuel fouled spark plugs with compressed air and reinstall
them in the engine.
White or Gray - Burned or Blistered Insulator
SPARK PLUG OVERHEATING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 2445
Spark Plug Overheating
Overheating is indicated by a white or gray center electrode insulator that also appears blistered.
The increase in electrode gap will be considerably in excess of 0.001 in. per 1000 miles of
operation. This suggests that a plug with a cooler heat range rating should be used. Over
advanced ignition timing, detonation and cooling system malfunctions also can cause spark plug
overheating. Also check for lean air-fuel mixture. Check the torque value of the plugs to ensure
good plug-engine seat contact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2446
Spark Plug: Adjustments
Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Fig.2 Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Check the spark plug gap with a gap gauge. If the gap is not correct, adjust it by bending the
ground -- center electrode.
Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information (VECI) label, (under hood).
If label is gone, or not readable, verify system and use the following specification.
Plug Gap ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.033 to 0.038 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2447
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
CAUTION: Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of the spark plug insulator,
turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL
1. Remove the spark plug using a quality socket with a rubber or foam insert. 2. Inspect the spark
plug condition.
SPARK PLUG CLEANING
Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned using commercially available spark plug
cleaning equipment. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file before adjusting gap.
CAUTION: Never use a motorized wire wheel brush to clean the spark plugs. Metallic deposits will
remain on the spark plug insulator and will cause plug misfire.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap.
SPARK PLUG INSTALLATION
1. To avoid cross threading, start the spark plug into the cylinder head by hand. 2. Tighten spark
plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque. 3. Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of
the spark plug insulator covers the upper end of the spark plug tube. 4. Connect coil.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
COMPRESSION PRESSURE (at 250 - 400 RPM):
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................ 1172 - 1551 kPa (170 - 225 psi) Minimum .............................................................
................................................................................................................................... 689 kPa (100
psi)
COMPRESSION PRESSURE DIFFERENCE OF ALL CYLINDER:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 25%
VACUUM:
Manifold ...............................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 60 kPa (18 inches Hg)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2451
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
PROCEDURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Disconnect coil wire from distributor and secure to good ground to prevent a spark from starting
a fire (Conventional Ignition System). For
Direct Ignition System (DIS) disconnect the coil connector.
5 . Be sure throttle blade is fully open during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gage
adaptor into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Crank engine until maximum pressure is
reached on gage.
Record this pressure as #1 cylinder pressure.
7. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 8. Compression should not be less than 689
kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder. 9. If one or more
cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression test.
10. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second compression
test, it could indicate the existence of a problem
in the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a
guide to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the
cause of low compression unless some malfunction is present.
11. Clean or replace spark plugs as necessary and adjust gap. Tighten to specifications. 12. Test
resistance of spark plug cables. Perform secondary circuit inspection. 13. Test coil output voltage,
primary and secondary resistance. Replace parts as necessary. 14. Check fuel pump pressure at
idle and different RPM ranges. 15. The air filter elements should be replaced as specified. 16.
Inspect crankcase ventilation system. 17. Inspect and adjust accessory belt drives. 18. Road test
vehicle as a final test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates this engine is equipped with hydraulic lifters or lash adjusters and
therefore does not require adjustment.
See "Rocker Arm: Service and Repair" for further information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Clutch Relay Operation
A/C Signal: Description and Operation A/C Clutch Relay Operation
Theory of Operation:
The A/C compressor clutch relay controls the 12 volt source for the A/C clutch. The relay is located
in the power distribution center. One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the
ignition switch is turned to the run position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay
coil is grounded by the powertrain control module (PCM). When A/C is requested, the PCM adjusts
the idle speed to accommodate the A/C compressor load on the engine. The PCM grounds the
relay control circuit after the PCM receives an A/C request and adjustment of the idle speed has
been implemented.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Clutch Relay Operation > Page 2461
A/C Signal: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Name of Code:
A/C Clutch Relay Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key in the run position and battery voltage above 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the A/C clutch relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The A/C compressor clutch relay controls the 12 volt source for the A/C clutch. The relay is located
in the power distribution center. One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the
ignition switch is turned to the run position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay
coil is grounded by the powertrain control module (PCM). When A/C is requested, the PCM adjusts
the idle speed to accommodate the A/C compressor load on the engine. The PCM grounds the
relay control circuit after the PCM receives an A/C request and adjustment of the idle speed has
been implemented.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Compressor clutch relay control circuit open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2465
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2466
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2467
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The intake air temperature sensor measures the temperature of the air as it enters the engine. The
sensor supplies one of the inputs the PCM uses to determine injector pulse-width.
CONSTRUCTION
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, located on the intake manifold, combines the MAP
and Intake Air Temperature (IAT) functions into one sensor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The intake air temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on
circuit K21. Circuit K21 connects to cavity 37 of the PCM connector.
From circuit K21 the intake air temperature sensor draws voltage from the PCM. The sensor is a
variable resistor As intake air temperature changes the resistance in the sensor changes causing a
change in current draw.
The PCM provides ground for the intake air temperature sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit
K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2470
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2471
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 2475
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2478
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2479
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Component Description
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Component Description
PURPOSE
When the brake switch is activated, the PCM receives an input indicating that the brakes are being
applied.
The brake switch is mounted on the brake pedal support bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Component Description > Page 2485
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Switch Sense Circuit
Name of Code:
Brake (Stop Lamp) Switch Sense Circuit
When Monitored:
With engine running.
Set Condition:
Decel (30 - 0 mph). The PCM monitors the brake switch signal expecting it to be continuously low
while the vehicle speed cycles 16 times. The count is reset to zero whenever the brake switch
indicates a high signal. Accel (0 - 20 mph): The PCM monitors the brake switch signal expecting it
to be high while the following maneuver occurs 16 times. After the vehicle speed increases, the
PCM must accumulate 6 seconds while delta throttle voltage is above 0.02 volts. The count is reset
to zero whenever the brake switch indicates a low signal.
Theory of Operation:
The brake switch signal is used to disable speed control by venting the Speed Control (S/C) servo.
The brake switch signal is used to disable (3 speed ATX) the part throttle unlock, as well as
disabling the vehicle speed sensor diagnostics. The signal from the brake switch is used to enable
OBDII purge monitor. It also modifies the stall torque management control.
Possible Causes:
- Brake switch failure
- Switch alignment
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 2490
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2493
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2494
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2495
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2496
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2497
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2500
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2501
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 2504
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 2505
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2509
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2510
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2511
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Lamps and Indicators Cooling System/Temperature Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2514
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2515
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2522
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2523
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2524
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2525
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2526
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test > Page 2529
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement > Page 2532
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Data Link Connector: Locations
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
Data Link Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2538
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2539
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2540
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2541
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2542
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2543
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2544
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2545
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2546
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2547
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2548
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2549
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2550
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2551
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2552
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2553
Data Link Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2554
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
PURPOSE
Communication link to Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Technician can access inputs and memory including:
- Sensor input values
- Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) stored in memory
- Last deactivation cause (i.e.. speed control last shut off by; speed control switch, brake switch or
no crank sensor signal).
Technician can actuate most PCM output devices.
NOTE: Monitoring inputs, reading memory -- other than codes -- and actuating output devices can
only be accomplished through the use of a scan tool. SEE Computers and Control System/Testing
and Inspection.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 supplies battery voltage to the universal data link connector. Circuit A14 originates in
the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and connects to a battery fed bus bar. A 20 Amp fuse protects
circuit A14.
A twisted pair of wires, circuits D1 and D2, from the Airbag Control Module (ACM) connect to the
universal data link connector.
Ground circuit Z12 splices to two cavities of the data link connector. The Z12 circuit also connects
to cavities 10 and 50 of the PCM connector.
Circuit D20 connects to cavity 75 of the PCM and to the universal data link connector. Circuit D20
is the SCI receive circuit for the PCM.
Circuit D21 connects to cavity 65 of the PCM and to the universal data link connector. Circuit D21
is the SCI transmit circuit for the PCM. The D21 circuit splices to the ABS module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Data Link Connector: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The grounding point for circuit Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Circuit Z12 also supplies ground for the PCM high current drivers and has the same termination
point as circuit Z11.
If the system loses ground for the ganged circuits at the left side radiator closure panel the vehicle
will not operate. Check the connection at the ganged ground circuit eyelet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > EGR Backpressure Transducer
> Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 EGR System
Fig. 2 Electronic EGR Transducer (EET)
The electronic EGR transducer (EET) contains an electrically operated solenoid and a
back-pressure transducer (Fig. 2). The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) operates the solenoid.
Exhaust system back-pressure controls the transducer. When exhaust system back-pressure becomes high enough, it fully closes a bleed valve in the
transducer.
- When the PCM de-energizes the solenoid and back-pressure closes the transducer bleed valve,
vacuum flows through the transducer to operate the EGR valve.
De-energizing the solenoid, but not fully closing the transducer bleed hole (because of low
back-pressure), varies the strength of vacuum applied to the EGR valve. Varying the strength of the vacuum changes the amount of EGR supplied to the engine. This
provides the correct amount of exhaust gas recirculation for different operating conditions.
This system does not allow EGR at idle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > EGR Backpressure Transducer
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2560
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 EGR System
NOTE: If the EGR system operates incorrectly, replace the entire EGR valve and transducer
together. The EGR valve and Electronic EGR Transducer (EET) are calibrated together.
NOTE: The EGR valve and EET attach to the rear of the cylinder head (Fig. 1).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect vacuum supply tube from EET solenoid. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from
solenoid. 3. Remove EGR tube to EGR valve screws. 4. Remove EGR valve mounting screws.
Remove EGR valve and transducer. 5. Clean gasket surfaces. Discard old gaskets. If necessary,
clean EGR passages.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install EGR valve with new gaskets. 2. Finger tighten EGR tube fasteners. 3. Tighten
EGR tube fasteners to 11 Nm (95 in lb) torque. 4. Tightening EGR valve mounting screws to 22 Nm
(200 in lb) torque. 5. Connect vacuum supply tube to solenoid. 6. Attach electrical connector to
solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Specifications
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
PCM 60-Way Connector Torque = 4 Nm (35 in lb) PCM Mounting Screws = 4 Nm (35 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2564
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2567
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2568
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2569
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2570
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2571
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2572
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2573
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2574
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2575
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2576
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2577
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2578
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2579
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2580
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2581
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2582
Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2583
Powertrain Control Module: Service Precautions
- Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is off. Failure to do so could
damage the module.
- When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end)
of the connector.
- Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause it to fail
because of corrosion.
- Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
- Operation of any type, including idling, should be avoided if engine misfiring occurs. Under this
condition, the exhaust system operates at abnormally high temperature, which may cause damage
to the catalyst or under-body parts of the vehicle.
- Alteration or deterioration of ignition or fuel system, or any type of operating condition which
results in engine misfiring must be corrected to avoid overheating the catalytic converter.
- Proper maintenance and tune-up, according to manufacturer's specifications, should be made to
correct abnormal conditions as soon as possible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 from the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies battery voltage to cavity 46 of the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). A 20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuit A14.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2586
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation PCM Operation
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor (Fig. 2).
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
PCM Inputs: Air Conditioning Controls
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor
- Ignition Switch (A21)
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oxygen Sensors
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receiver
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Transmission Park/Neutral Switch (Automatic Transmission)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
PCM Outputs:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2587
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Air Conditioning WOT Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp
- Data Link Connector
- Duty Cycle EVAP Canister Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor
- Ignition Coils
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp
- Radiator Fan Relay
- Speed Control Solenoids
- Tachometer
- Torque Convertor Clutch Solenoid
Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts: Fuel Injector Pulse Width
- Idle Speed
- Ignition Spark Advance
- Ignition Coil Dwell
- EVAP Canister Purge Operation.
The PCM Regulates: Cooling Fan
- Air Conditioning
- Speed Control System
- Generator Charge Rate -- by Adjusting The Generator Field
The PCM Also Performs Diagnostics
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on: Battery Voltage
- Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Content (Oxygen Sensor)
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on: Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on: Air Conditioning Sense
- Battery Temperature
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Engine Run Time
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
- Vehicle Distance (Speed)
ASD and Fuel Pump Relay Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2588
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are mounted externally, but turned on and off by
the PCM.
Crankshaft Position (Engine Speed) Signal The crankshaft position sensor signal is sent to the
PCM. If the PCM does not receive the signal within approximately one second of engine cranking,
it deactivates the ASD relay and fuel pump relay When these relays deactivate, power is shut off
from the fuel injectors, ignition coils, heating element in the oxygen sensors and the fuel pump.
PCM Regulated Output Supply Voltages The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes
battery voltage to a regulated 8 volts direct current to power: Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
The PCM also provides a 5 volt direct current supply for: Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
- Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2589
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Powertrain Control Module The speed control electronic control circuitry is integrated into the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The PCM is located in the engine compartment. The PCM
speed control functions are monitored by the On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). All OBD-sensed
systems are monitored by the PCM. Each monitored circuit is assigned a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC). The PCM will store a DTC in electronic memory for any failure it detects. The PCM cannot
be repaired and must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Powertrain Control Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit A14 connects to a bus bar in the PDC that the battery feeds. Circuit A14 powers the
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay and fuel pump relay The A14 circuit also splices to the data link
connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2592
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
NOTE: The PCM attaches to the inner fender panel next to the washer fluid bottle on the driver
side (Fig. 100).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Disconnect positive cable from battery. 3. Remove
washer bottle neck. 4. Squeeze tabs on Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling PDC up to
remove it from bracket.
- Lay PDC aside to gain access to PCM bracket screws.
5. Remove screws attaching PCM to body. 3. Lift PCM up and disconnect the 2 40-way connector
7. Remove PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the 2 40-way connector to PCM. 2. Install PCM. Tighten mounting screws to 4 Nm (35 in
lb) torque. 3. Install PDC by pushing down into brackets. 4. Install washer bottle neck. 5. Connect
positive cable to battery. 6. Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit G4 provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) indicating fuel tank level. This
circuit connects to cavity 23 of the PCM connector.
The G4 circuit is also used for the fuel gauge located in the instrument cluster. For operation of fuel
gauge, See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Fuel Gauge/Description and
Operation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description > Page 2597
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2600
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2601
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 2602
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2603
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2604
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
IAC Motor-To-Throttle Body Bolts 7 Nm (60 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2608
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2609
Idle Air Control Motor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2610
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The idle air control (IAC) motor is used by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to help regulate
idle speed. The motor controls the amount of air allowed to bypass the throttle blade. The PCM
controls the motor using four driver circuits to position the stepper motor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) operates the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor through 4 circuits
K39, K40, K59, and K60. Each circuit connects to separate cavities in the PCM connector. Circuit K39 connects to cavity 57 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K40 connects to cavity 48 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K59 connects to cavity 58 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K60 connects to cavity 49 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2611
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
Fig. 95 Servicing Idle Air Control Motor
CAUTION: When servicing throttle body components, always reassemble components with new
0-rings and seals where applicable. Never use lubricants on 0-rings or seals, damage may result. If
assembly of component is difficult, use water to aid assembly. Use care when removing hoses to
prevent damage to hose or hose nipple.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Remove electrical connector from idle air control
motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove the EVAP purge hose from the throttle body. 4.
Remove throttle body. 5. Remove idle air control motor mounting screws (Fig. 95). 6. Remove
motor from throttle body Ensure the 0-ring is removed with the motor.
INSTALLATION
1. The new idle air control motor has a new 0-ring installed on it.
- If pintle measures more than 1 inch (25 mm) it must be retracted.
- Use the DRB Idle Air Control Motor Open/Close Test to retract the pintle (battery must be
connected).
2. Carefully place idle air control motor into throttle body 3. Install mounting screws. Tighten screws
to 7 Nm (60 in lb) torque. 4. Install throttle body. 5. Connect electrical connector to idle air control
motor and throttle position sensor. 6. Connect the EVAP purge hose to the throttle body nipple. 7.
Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2616
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2617
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2618
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2619
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2620
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2621
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2622
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2623
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2624
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2625
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2626
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2627
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2628
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2629
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2630
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2631
Vehicle Communication System Schematic
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2635
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2636
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2637
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2640
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2641
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2645
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page
2648
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page
2649
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2650
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information >
Page 2653
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information >
Page 2654
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Service Engine Soon lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is in the ON position and prior
to starting the vehicle. The lamp will turn off after the vehicle is started.
If while the vehicle is running a problem is detected in the engine control system the lamp is
illuminated. This is accomplished by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) grounding the G3
circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The MAP sensor puts out a low voltage signal (0.5 to 1.8 volts) at idle when the manifold vacuum is
high, and a higher voltage signal (3.9 to 4.8 volts) at open throttle when the manifold vacuum is
low.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2662
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2663
Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2664
IAT/Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2665
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
OPERATION
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sen son The MAP sensor function converts intake manifold
pressure into voltage. The PCM monitors the MAP sensor output voltage. As vacuum increases,
MAP sensor voltage decreases proportionately. Also, as vacuum decreases, MAP sensor voltage
increases proportionately.
During cranking, before the engine starts running, the PCM determines atmosphenc air pressure
from the MAP sensor voltage. While the engine operates, the PCM determines intake manifold
pressure from the MAP sensor voltage. Based on MAP sensor voltage and inputs from other
sensors, the PCM adjusts spark advance and the air/fuel mixture.
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (MAP/IAT) sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Manifold Absolute
Pressure (MAP) sensor. Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K1 delivers the MAP signal to the PCM. Circuit K1 connects to cavity 36 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the MAP sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 82 MAP Sensor Connector
CAUTION: When testing the MAP sensor, be sure that the harness wires are not damaged by the
test meter probes.
1. Test the MAP sensor output voltage at the MAP sensor connector between terminals 1 and 4
(Fig. 82). With the ignition switch ON and the engine
not running, output voltage should be 4 to 5 volts. The voltage should drop to 1.5 to 2.1 volts with a
hot, neutral idle speed condition. If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, go to step 3.
2. Test PCM terminal 36 for the same voltage described in the previous step to verify wire harness
condition. Repair as required. 3. Test the MAP sensor ground circuit at sensor connector terminal 1
and PCM terminal 43.
- If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, repair as required.
4. Test MAP sensor supply voltage between sensor connector terminals 3 and 1 with the key ON.
The voltage should be approximately 5 volts ±
0.5V). Five volts (± 0.5V) should also be at terminal 61 of the PCM. If OK, replace MAP sensor.
- If not OK, repair or replace the wire harness as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2668
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2669
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2670
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Upstream and Downstream
Heated Oxygen Sensors Torque = 28 Nm (20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations > Page 2676
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations > Page 2677
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2678
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2679
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2680
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay. The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground path circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors.
The A142 circuit also splices to cavity 6 of the PCM. The input provided by circuit A142 at cavity 6
tells the PCM that the ASD relay energized.
Circuit K41 delivers the signal from the upstream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit K41
connects to cavity 30 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K141 delivers the signal from the down-stream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit
K141 connects to cavity 51 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides a ground for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensor signals
(circuit K41 and K141) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector
Circuit Z1 provides ground for the heater circuits in each sensor. Circuit Z1 terminates at the left
side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator, and
the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors. The PCM controls the ground circuit for
each of the components powered by circuit A142.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2683
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Test
NOTE: Use an ohmmeter to test the heating element of the oxygen sensors.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from each oxygen sensor.
- The white wires in the sensor connector are the power and ground circuits for the heater
elements.
2. Connect the ohmmeter test leads to terminals of the white wires in the heated oxygen sensor
connector.
- Replace the heated oxygen sensor if the resistance is not between 4 and 7 ohms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Downstream O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 19 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
NOTE: The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust pipe behind the catalytic
convertor (Fig. 19).
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig. 20 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent (Fig. 20).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Downstream O2 Sensor > Page 2686
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 18 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector. 3. Remove sensor using an oxygen
sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or equivalent (Fig. 18).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2687
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2692
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2693
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2694
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2695
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Specifications
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
PCM 60-Way Connector Torque = 4 Nm (35 in lb) PCM Mounting Screws = 4 Nm (35 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2700
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2703
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2704
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2705
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2706
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2707
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2708
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2709
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2710
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2711
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2712
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2713
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2714
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2715
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2716
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2717
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2718
Powertrain Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2719
Powertrain Control Module: Service Precautions
- Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is off. Failure to do so could
damage the module.
- When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end)
of the connector.
- Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause it to fail
because of corrosion.
- Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
- Operation of any type, including idling, should be avoided if engine misfiring occurs. Under this
condition, the exhaust system operates at abnormally high temperature, which may cause damage
to the catalyst or under-body parts of the vehicle.
- Alteration or deterioration of ignition or fuel system, or any type of operating condition which
results in engine misfiring must be corrected to avoid overheating the catalytic converter.
- Proper maintenance and tune-up, according to manufacturer's specifications, should be made to
correct abnormal conditions as soon as possible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 from the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies battery voltage to cavity 46 of the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). A 20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuit A14.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2722
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation PCM Operation
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
Fig. 3 Data Link Connector
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is a digital computer containing a microprocessor (Fig. 2).
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine and vehicle operations through
devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
PCM Inputs: Air Conditioning Controls
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor
- Ignition Switch (A21)
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oxygen Sensors
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receiver
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Transmission Park/Neutral Switch (Automatic Transmission)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
PCM Outputs:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2723
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Air Conditioning WOT Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp
- Data Link Connector
- Duty Cycle EVAP Canister Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor
- Ignition Coils
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp
- Radiator Fan Relay
- Speed Control Solenoids
- Tachometer
- Torque Convertor Clutch Solenoid
Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts: Fuel Injector Pulse Width
- Idle Speed
- Ignition Spark Advance
- Ignition Coil Dwell
- EVAP Canister Purge Operation.
The PCM Regulates: Cooling Fan
- Air Conditioning
- Speed Control System
- Generator Charge Rate -- by Adjusting The Generator Field
The PCM Also Performs Diagnostics
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on: Battery Voltage
- Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Gas Content (Oxygen Sensor)
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on: Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (Crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Intake Air Temperature
- Knock Sensor
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on: Air Conditioning Sense
- Battery Temperature
- Battery Voltage
- Brake Switch
- Coolant Temperature
- Engine Speed (crankshaft Position Sensor)
- Engine Run Time
- Manifold Absolute Pressure
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- Throttle Position
- Transmission Gear Selection (Park/Neutral Switch)
- Vehicle Distance (Speed)
ASD and Fuel Pump Relay Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2724
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are mounted externally, but turned on and off by
the PCM.
Crankshaft Position (Engine Speed) Signal The crankshaft position sensor signal is sent to the
PCM. If the PCM does not receive the signal within approximately one second of engine cranking,
it deactivates the ASD relay and fuel pump relay When these relays deactivate, power is shut off
from the fuel injectors, ignition coils, heating element in the oxygen sensors and the fuel pump.
PCM Regulated Output Supply Voltages The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes
battery voltage to a regulated 8 volts direct current to power: Camshaft Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
The PCM also provides a 5 volt direct current supply for: Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
- Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 2725
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Powertrain Control Module The speed control electronic control circuitry is integrated into the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The PCM is located in the engine compartment. The PCM
speed control functions are monitored by the On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). All OBD-sensed
systems are monitored by the PCM. Each monitored circuit is assigned a Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC). The PCM will store a DTC in electronic memory for any failure it detects. The PCM cannot
be repaired and must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Powertrain Control Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit A14 connects to a bus bar in the PDC that the battery feeds. Circuit A14 powers the
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay and fuel pump relay The A14 circuit also splices to the data link
connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 2728
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 100 Powertrain Control Module
NOTE: The PCM attaches to the inner fender panel next to the washer fluid bottle on the driver
side (Fig. 100).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Disconnect positive cable from battery. 3. Remove
washer bottle neck. 4. Squeeze tabs on Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling PDC up to
remove it from bracket.
- Lay PDC aside to gain access to PCM bracket screws.
5. Remove screws attaching PCM to body. 3. Lift PCM up and disconnect the 2 40-way connector
7. Remove PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the 2 40-way connector to PCM. 2. Install PCM. Tighten mounting screws to 4 Nm (35 in
lb) torque. 3. Install PDC by pushing down into brackets. 4. Install washer bottle neck. 5. Connect
positive cable to battery. 6. Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2732
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2735
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 2736
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2737
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2740
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2741
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
2746
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2749
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2750
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 2755
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2758
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2759
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2760
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2761
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2762
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing > Page 2765
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing > Page 2766
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Sensor Replacement > Page 2769
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft
Sensor Replacement > Page 2770
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm (165 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2774
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2775
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2776
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Fig.13 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The combination coolant temperature sensor has two elements. One element supplies coolant temperature signal to the PCM.
- The other element supplies coolant temperature signal to the instrument panel gauge cluster.
The PCM determines engine coolant temperature from the coolant temperature sensor.
OPERATION
As coolant temperature varies the coolant temperature sensors resistance changes resulting in a
different input voltage to the PCM and the instrument panel gauge cluster.
When the engine is cold, the PCM will provide slightly richer air-fuel mixtures and higher idle
speeds until normal operating temperatures are reached.
The coolant sensor threads into the intake manifold next to the thermostat housing (Fig. 13).
New sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
on circuit K2. The sensor also operates the engine cool and temperature gauge in the instrument
cluster on circuit G20. See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Lamps and Indicators Cooling System/Temperature Gauge/Description and Operation
From circuit K2 the engine coolant temperature sensor draws up to 5 Volts from the PCM. The
sensor is a variable resistor. As coolant temperature changes, the resistance in the sensor
changes causing a change in current draw. The K2 circuit connects to cavity 26 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the engine coolant temperature sensor signal (circuit K2) through
circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Component Testing
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 80 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Location-DOHC
1. With the key off, disconnect wire harness connector from coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 80).
Fig. 27 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
2. Connect a high input impedance (digital) volt-ohmmeter to terminals A and B (Fig. 27). The
ohmmeter should read as follows:
- Engine/Sensor at normal operating temperature around 200°F should read approximately 700 to
1,000 ohms.
- Engine/Sensor at room temperature around 70°F ohmmeter should read approximately 7,000 to
13,000 ohms.
3. Test the resistance of the wire harness between the PCM 60-way connector terminal 28 and the
sensor harness connector. Also check for
continuity between PCM 60-way connector terminal 51 and the sensor harness connector. Refer to
electrical diagrams for circuit information. If the resistance is greater than 1 ohm, repair the wire
harness as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 2779
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
The engine coolant temperature sensor is case grounded. The case ground provides the ground
for the coolant temperature gauge circuit G20. Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals
from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 2780
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
Fig.39 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The engine coolant temperature sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head. New
sensors have sealant applied to the threads.
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect coolant
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (165 in lb) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2787
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2788
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2789
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2790
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2791
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure
to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure
to Start Test > Page 2794
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement > Page 2797
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Description
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit G4 provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) indicating fuel tank level. This
circuit connects to cavity 23 of the PCM connector.
The G4 circuit is also used for the fuel gauge located in the instrument cluster. For operation of fuel
gauge, See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Fuel Gauge/Description and
Operation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Description > Page 2802
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit
Operation Check
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit
Operation Check > Page 2805
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit
Operation Check > Page 2806
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit
Operation Check > Page 2807
Fuel Level Sensor: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2808
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2809
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2813
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2814
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2815
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
PURPOSE
The intake air temperature sensor measures the temperature of the air as it enters the engine. The
sensor supplies one of the inputs the PCM uses to determine injector pulse-width.
CONSTRUCTION
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor, located on the intake manifold, combines the MAP
and Intake Air Temperature (IAT) functions into one sensor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The intake air temperature sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on
circuit K21. Circuit K21 connects to cavity 37 of the PCM connector.
From circuit K21 the intake air temperature sensor draws voltage from the PCM. The sensor is a
variable resistor As intake air temperature changes the resistance in the sensor changes causing a
change in current draw.
The PCM provides ground for the intake air temperature sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit
K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Helpful Information
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2818
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2819
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2823
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2824
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2825
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
> Page 2828
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2829
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The MAP sensor puts out a low voltage signal (0.5 to 1.8 volts) at idle when the manifold vacuum is
high, and a higher voltage signal (3.9 to 4.8 volts) at open throttle when the manifold vacuum is
low.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2834
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Torque
Aluminum Manifold = 3 Nm (30 in lbs) Plastic Manifold = 2 Nm (20 in lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2835
Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2836
IAT/Map Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2837
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.15 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
OPERATION
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sen son The MAP sensor function converts intake manifold
pressure into voltage. The PCM monitors the MAP sensor output voltage. As vacuum increases,
MAP sensor voltage decreases proportionately. Also, as vacuum decreases, MAP sensor voltage
increases proportionately.
During cranking, before the engine starts running, the PCM determines atmosphenc air pressure
from the MAP sensor voltage. While the engine operates, the PCM determines intake manifold
pressure from the MAP sensor voltage. Based on MAP sensor voltage and inputs from other
sensors, the PCM adjusts spark advance and the air/fuel mixture.
The MAP/Intake Air Temperature Sensor (MAP/IAT) sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Manifold Absolute
Pressure (MAP) sensor. Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K1 delivers the MAP signal to the PCM. Circuit K1 connects to cavity 36 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the MAP sensor signal (circuit K21) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
Fig. 82 MAP Sensor Connector
CAUTION: When testing the MAP sensor, be sure that the harness wires are not damaged by the
test meter probes.
1. Test the MAP sensor output voltage at the MAP sensor connector between terminals 1 and 4
(Fig. 82). With the ignition switch ON and the engine
not running, output voltage should be 4 to 5 volts. The voltage should drop to 1.5 to 2.1 volts with a
hot, neutral idle speed condition. If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, go to step 3.
2. Test PCM terminal 36 for the same voltage described in the previous step to verify wire harness
condition. Repair as required. 3. Test the MAP sensor ground circuit at sensor connector terminal 1
and PCM terminal 43.
- If OK, go to next step.
- If not OK, repair as required.
4. Test MAP sensor supply voltage between sensor connector terminals 3 and 1 with the key ON.
The voltage should be approximately 5 volts ±
0.5V). Five volts (± 0.5V) should also be at terminal 61 of the PCM. If OK, replace MAP sensor.
- If not OK, repair or replace the wire harness as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Component Testing > Page 2840
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2841
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
Map/Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Fig. 98 MAP/IAT Sensor-DOHC
NOTE: The MAP/IAT sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 98).
Fig. 97 Air Inlet Duct-DOHC
REMOVAL
1. Remove air inlet duct wing nut and duct from intake manifold (Fig. 97).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2842
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the MAP/IAT sensor. 3. Remove sensor mounting
screws. 4. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while making sure not to damage 0-ring seals. 2. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque for a plastic manifold and 3 Nm (30 in lb) for a aluminum
manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor 4. Install air inlet duct wing nut and duct from
intake manifold, insure that the duct does not interfer with ignition cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Upstream and Downstream
Heated Oxygen Sensors Torque = 28 Nm (20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
> Page 2848
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Oxygen Sensor Bank Locations
> Page 2849
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2850
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2851
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank #2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/2.
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder. See: Ignition
System/Firing Order/Specifications - If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2852
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay. The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground path circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors.
The A142 circuit also splices to cavity 6 of the PCM. The input provided by circuit A142 at cavity 6
tells the PCM that the ASD relay energized.
Circuit K41 delivers the signal from the upstream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit K41
connects to cavity 30 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K141 delivers the signal from the down-stream heated oxygen sensor to the PCM. Circuit
K141 connects to cavity 51 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides a ground for the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensor signals
(circuit K41 and K141) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector
Circuit Z1 provides ground for the heater circuits in each sensor. Circuit Z1 terminates at the left
side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator, and
the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors. The PCM controls the ground circuit for
each of the components powered by circuit A142.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
> Page 2855
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection Oxygen Sensor Heater Circuit Test
NOTE: Use an ohmmeter to test the heating element of the oxygen sensors.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector from each oxygen sensor.
- The white wires in the sensor connector are the power and ground circuits for the heater
elements.
2. Connect the ohmmeter test leads to terminals of the white wires in the heated oxygen sensor
connector.
- Replace the heated oxygen sensor if the resistance is not between 4 and 7 ohms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Downstream O2
Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 19 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
NOTE: The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust pipe behind the catalytic
convertor (Fig. 19).
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig. 20 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent (Fig. 20).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Downstream O2
Sensor > Page 2858
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream O2 Sensor
Fig. 18 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector. 3. Remove sensor using an oxygen
sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or equivalent (Fig. 18).
INSTALLATION
1. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18 mm X 1.5 +
6E tap. 2. If reusing the original sensor, coat the sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such
as Loctite® 771-64 or equivalent.
- New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
3. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2859
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2864
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2865
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2866
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2867
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2872
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2873
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2874
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2875
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 2878
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2879
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
2880
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2884
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2885
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 2.2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2889
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2892
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2893
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2894
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2895
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2896
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2897
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2898
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2899
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2900
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2901
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2902
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2903
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2904
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2905
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2906
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2907
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed. Refer to the
Powertrain Management/Computer and Control Systems/Diagnostic Procedures for diagnosis and
testing of this component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Operation > Page 2910
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor-PCM Input
Fig. 17 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Automatic Transmission
Fig. 18 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Manual Transmission
PURPOSE
The sensor input is used by the PCM to determine vehicle speed and distance traveled.
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor generates 8 pulses per sensor revolution. These signals, in conjunction
with a closed throttle signal from the throttle position sensor, indicate a closed throttle deceleration
to the PCM. Under deceleration conditions, the PCM adjusts the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor to
maintain a desired MAP value.
When the vehicle is stopped at idle, a closed throttle signal is received by the PCM (but a speed
sensor signal is not received). Under idle conditions, the PCM adjusts the IAC motor to maintain a
desired engine speed.
The vehicle speed sensor signal is also used to operate: Speedometer
- Speed control
- Daytime Running Lights (Canadian Vehicles only).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the Vehicle Speed Sensor
(VSS). The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit G7 from the VSS provides an input signal to the PCM. The G7 circuit connects to cavity 66
of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the VSS signal (circuit G7) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit G7 splices to the speedometer and odometer in the instrument cluster.
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2913
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 24 Vehicle Speed Sensor
Fig. 7 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Connector
Fig. 8 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Speedometer Pinion
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2914
NOTE: The vehicle speed sensor is located in the transmission extension housing (Fig. 24).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 2. Remove the sensor mounting bolt. 3. Lift the
sensor out of the transaxle extension housing. Ensure the 0-ring was removed with the sensor.
NOTE: The speed sensor gear meshes with a gear on the output shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. With 0-ring in place, install sensor and seat sensor by hand -- to ensure proper gear
engagement. 2. Install mounting bolt and torque bolt to 2.2 Nm (20 in lb). 3. Connect electrical
connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2919
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2920
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2921
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2922
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 2925
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2926
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2927
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Torque Reduction Signal >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Torque Reduction Signal: Description and Operation
TORQUE MANAGEMENT INPUT
Circuit T10 connects from the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) cavity 63. This is the torque management request from the TCM to the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2935
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor Mounting Bolt 2.2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2939
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2942
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2943
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2944
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2945
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2946
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2947
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2948
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2949
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2950
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2951
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2952
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2953
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2954
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2955
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2956
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2957
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed. Refer to the
Powertrain Management/Computer and Control Systems/Diagnostic Procedures for diagnosis and
testing of this component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Operation > Page 2960
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor-PCM Input
Fig. 17 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Automatic Transmission
Fig. 18 Vehicle Speed Sensor -- Manual Transmission
PURPOSE
The sensor input is used by the PCM to determine vehicle speed and distance traveled.
OPERATION
The vehicle speed sensor generates 8 pulses per sensor revolution. These signals, in conjunction
with a closed throttle signal from the throttle position sensor, indicate a closed throttle deceleration
to the PCM. Under deceleration conditions, the PCM adjusts the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor to
maintain a desired MAP value.
When the vehicle is stopped at idle, a closed throttle signal is received by the PCM (but a speed
sensor signal is not received). Under idle conditions, the PCM adjusts the IAC motor to maintain a
desired engine speed.
The vehicle speed sensor signal is also used to operate: Speedometer
- Speed control
- Daytime Running Lights (Canadian Vehicles only).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the Vehicle Speed Sensor
(VSS). The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit G7 from the VSS provides an input signal to the PCM. The G7 circuit connects to cavity 66
of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the VSS signal (circuit G7) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit G7 splices to the speedometer and odometer in the instrument cluster.
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2963
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 24 Vehicle Speed Sensor
Fig. 7 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Connector
Fig. 8 Vehicle Speed Sensor And Speedometer Pinion
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2964
NOTE: The vehicle speed sensor is located in the transmission extension housing (Fig. 24).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from sensor. 2. Remove the sensor mounting bolt. 3. Lift the
sensor out of the transaxle extension housing. Ensure the 0-ring was removed with the sensor.
NOTE: The speed sensor gear meshes with a gear on the output shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. With 0-ring in place, install sensor and seat sensor by hand -- to ensure proper gear
engagement. 2. Install mounting bolt and torque bolt to 2.2 Nm (20 in lb). 3. Connect electrical
connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Voltage Signal > Component
Information > Specifications
Voltage Signal: Specifications
The PCM tries to maintain system voltage between 12.9 volts and 15.0 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Voltage Signal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2968
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Voltage Signal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2969
Voltage Signal: Description and Operation
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The PCM monitors battery voltage input to determine fuel injector pulse width and generator field
control voltage.
Injector Pulse Width If voltage is low the PCM will increase pulse width (the period of time that the
injector is energized).
Generator Field Voltage The PCM tries to maintain a system voltage between 12.9 volts and 15.0
volts. The voltage determined by the PCM as the final goal for the charging system is called
"control" voltage. This control voltage is determined from the battery temp sensor for ambient
sensor and the sensed voltage system voltage at the PCM. The control voltage is compared to the
sensed voltage continuously during running. If the sensed voltage is less than the control voltage the PCM will supply more ground to the field
circuit.
- If the sensed voltage is more than the control voltage the PCM will supply less ground to the field
circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Catalyst Shield
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Catalyst Shield: Description and Operation
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts.
PURPOSE
The heat shield is needed to protect both the car and the environment from the high temperatures
developed in the vicinity of the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: Avoid application of rust prevention compounds or undercoating materials to exhaust
system floor pan heat shield on cars. Light over-spray near the edges is permitted. Application of
coating will greatly reduce the efficiency of the heat shields resulting in excessive floor pan
temperatures and objectionable fumes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications
Canister Purge Solenoid: Specifications
Solenoid Coil Resistance @ 20°C (68°F)
......................................................................................................................................................... 25
- 35 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2979
Canister Purge Solenoid: Locations
Fig. 101 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation & EVAP Purge Solenoid Location
EVAP Purge Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2980
Evaporative Solenoid Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2981
Canister Purge Solenoid: Description and Operation
Fig. 101 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation & EVAP Purge Solenoid Location
PURPOSE
The duty cycle EVAP purge solenoid regulates the rate of vapor flow from the EVAP canister to the
throttle body. The PCM operates the solenoid.
OPERATION
During the cold start warm-up period and the hot start time delay, the PCM does not energize the
solenoid. When de-energized, no vapors are purged.
When purging, the PCM energizes and de-energizes the solenoid approximately 5 or 10 times per
second, depending upon operating conditions. The PCM varies the vapor flow rate by changing solenoid pulse width.
- Pulse width is the amount of time the solenoid energizes.
The solenoid attaches to a bracket which is attached to the front engine mount (Fig. 101).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit F12 supplies battery voltage to the Duty Cycle EVAP/Purge solenoid. The Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) switches ground path for the solenoid ON and OFF through circuit K52.
Circuit F12 connects to a bus bar in the fuse block fed by circuit A21. A 15 Amp fuse in the fuse
block, cavity 10, protects circuit F12. Circuit F12 also connects to cavity 20 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K52 connects to cavity 68 of the PCM, and cavity 1 of the solenoid connector.
NOTE: The solenoid will not operate properly unless it is installed with the electrical connector at
the top.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > EVAP Purge Solenoid Inspection
Canister Purge Solenoid: Testing and Inspection EVAP Purge Solenoid Inspection
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION PURGE SOLENOID INSPECTION
NOTE: When disconnecting the vacuum hose, place an identification mark on it for proper
re-connection.
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the solenoid valve. 2. Disconnect the harness connector. 3.
Connect a hand vacuum pump to nipple (A) of the solenoid valve. 4. Check airtightness by applying
a vacuum with voltage applied directly from the battery to the purge control solenoid valve.
Battery Voltage / Normal Condition. Applied .......................................................................................
.......................................................................................................... Vacuum Leaks Not Applied ......
..............................................................................................................................................................
............. Vacuum Maintained
5. Measure the resistance between the terminals of the solenoid valve.
- Standard value: 25-35 ohms [at 20°C (68°F)]
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > EVAP Purge Solenoid Inspection > Page
2984
Canister Purge Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit F12 splices to feed the Antilock Brake System (ABS) control module, PCM, Electronic EGR
Transducer (EET) solenoid, leak detection pump, and the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) solenoid.
The F12 circuit also connects to a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) that supplies
voltage to the coil side of radiator fan relays, A/C clutch relay, and fuel pump relay.
In the START or RUN position, the ignition switch connects circuit A1 from the fuse block and
circuit A21. Circuit A1 connects to battery voltage and is protected by a 30 Amp fuse in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2985
Canister Purge Solenoid: Service and Repair
Fig. 101 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation & EVAP Purge Solenoid Location
NOTE: The solenoid attaches to a bracket near the front engine mount. The solenoid will not
operate unless it is installed correctly
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from solenoid. 2. Disconnect vacuum tubes from solenoid. 3.
Remove solenoid from bracket.
NOTE: The top of the solenoid has TOP printed on it. The solenoid will not operate unless it is
installed correctly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install solenoid on bracket. 2. Connect vacuum tube to solenoid. 3. Connect electrical connector
to solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations
Fig.1 EVAP Canister
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations > Page 2989
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Description and Operation
Fig. 2 EVAP Canister
All vehicles use a sealed, maintenance free, evaporative (EVAP) canister.
Fuel tank pressure vents into the canister. The canister temporarily holds the fuel vapors until
intake manifold vacuum draws them into the combustion chamber. The PCM purges the canister through the duty cycle EVAP purge solenoid.
- The PCM purges the canister at predetermined intervals and engine conditions.
The canister mounts to a bracket behind the front fascia on the passengers side of the vehicle (Fig.
2). The vacuum and vapor tube connect to the top of the canister.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > EVAP System - Leak
Detection Pump Misdiagnosis
Leak Detection Pump: Technical Service Bulletins EVAP System - Leak Detection Pump
Misdiagnosis
NUMBER: 18-01-00
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 4, 2000
SUBJECT: Misdiagnosed Leak Detection Pump Systems With DTC P1494, P0442, P0455, OR
P0456
MODELS: 1997 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van 1997 - 2000 (AN) Dakota 1997 - 2000 (BR/BE) Ram truck
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango 1997 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 - 2000 (JA)
Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1997 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 - 2000 (LH)
Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/3OOMNision 1997 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/CaravanNoyager 1997 2000 (PL) Neon 1997 - 2000 (PR) Prowler 1997 - 2000 (SR) ViperNiper GIS 1997 - 2000 (TJ)
Wrangler 1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee 1997 - 2000 (XJ) Cherokee 1997 - 1998 (ZJ)
GrandCherokee
DISCUSSION: During evaporative system diagnosis, Leak Detection Pumps have mistakenly been
replaced. A thorough inspection for pinched, kinked, or disconnected supply vacuum lines (as
currently listed in the Powertrain Diagnostic Procedures) is a critical step in diagnosing DTC P1494
(LDP SW OR MECHANICAL FAULT). Additionally, the other evaporative leak faults (DTC P0442 SMALL LEAK, P0455 - LARGE LEAK, and P0456 - VERY SMALL LEAK) should have the supply
vacuum lines examined for pinches or kinks prior to any LDP component replacement.
The supply vacuum lines should be checked from the engine compartment all the way to the fuel
tank, including the LDP and purge system.
NOTE:
VERIFY ALL RELATED SUPPLY VACUUM LINE ROUTINGS FOR PINCHES, KINKS, OR
DISCONNECTION'S BEFORE REPLACING LDP SYSTEM COMPONENTS.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Vacuum Pump
Leak Detection Pump
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Vacuum Pump > Page 2996
EVAP System Service Port
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 2997
Leak Detection Pump Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 2998
Leak Detection Pump: Description and Operation
Fig 4 Evaporative System Monitor
PURPOSE
The leak detection pump is a device used to detect a leak in the evaporative system.
OPERATION
The pump contains a 3 port solenoid, a pump that contains a switch, a spring loaded canister vent
valve seal, 2 check valves and a spring diaphragm.
Immediately after a cold start, engine temperature between 40°F and 86°F, the 3 port solenoid is
briefly energized. This initializes the pump by drawing air into the pump cavity and also closes the vent seal.
During non-test test conditions, the vent seal is held open by the pump diaphragm assembly which
pushes it open at the fill travel position. The vent seal will remain closed while the pump is cycling.
This is due to the operation of the 3 port solenoid which prevents the diaphragm assembly from
reaching full travel. After the brief initialization period, the solenoid is de-energized, allowing
atmospheric pressure to enter the pump cavity. This permits the spring to drive the diaphragm
which forces air out of the pump cavity and into the vent system. When the solenoid is energized
and de-energized, the cycle is repeated creating flow in typical diaphragm pump fashion.
The pump is controlled in 2 modes:
PUMP MODE: The pump is cycled at a fixed rate to achieve a rapid pressure build in order to
shorten the overall test time.
TEST MODE: The solenoid is energized with a fixed duration pulse. Subsequent fixed pulses occur
when the diaphragm reaches the switch closure point.
Leak Test The spring in the pump is set so that the system will achieve an equalized pressure of
about 7.5 inches of water.
When the pump starts, the cycle rate is quite high. As the system becomes pressurized pump rate
drops. If there is no leak the pump will quit.
- If there is a leak, the test is terminated at the end of the test mode.
Purge Monitor If there is no leak, the purge monitor is run. If the cycle rate increases due to the
flow through the purge system, the test is passed and the diagnostic is complete.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 2999
The canister vent valve will unseal the system after completion of the test sequence as the pump
diaphragm assembly moves to the full travel position.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Power for the vapor canister leak detector is provided on circuit F12. This circuit is protected by a
15 Amp fuse located in cavity 10 of the fuse block. Power for the fuse is supplied on circuit A21
from the ignition switch. Circuit A21 is HOT in the START and RUN position only.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the leak detection pump
solenoid and leak detection pump switch.
Circuit K106 is connected to cavity 77 of the PCM connector and to the leak detection solenoid.
Circuit K107 is connected to cavity 72 of the PCM connector and to the leak detection pump switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Backpressure Transducer > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 EGR System
Fig. 2 Electronic EGR Transducer (EET)
The electronic EGR transducer (EET) contains an electrically operated solenoid and a
back-pressure transducer (Fig. 2). The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) operates the solenoid.
Exhaust system back-pressure controls the transducer. When exhaust system back-pressure becomes high enough, it fully closes a bleed valve in the
transducer.
- When the PCM de-energizes the solenoid and back-pressure closes the transducer bleed valve,
vacuum flows through the transducer to operate the EGR valve.
De-energizing the solenoid, but not fully closing the transducer bleed hole (because of low
back-pressure), varies the strength of vacuum applied to the EGR valve. Varying the strength of the vacuum changes the amount of EGR supplied to the engine. This
provides the correct amount of exhaust gas recirculation for different operating conditions.
This system does not allow EGR at idle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Backpressure Transducer > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3004
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 EGR System
NOTE: If the EGR system operates incorrectly, replace the entire EGR valve and transducer
together. The EGR valve and Electronic EGR Transducer (EET) are calibrated together.
NOTE: The EGR valve and EET attach to the rear of the cylinder head (Fig. 1).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect vacuum supply tube from EET solenoid. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from
solenoid. 3. Remove EGR tube to EGR valve screws. 4. Remove EGR valve mounting screws.
Remove EGR valve and transducer. 5. Clean gasket surfaces. Discard old gaskets. If necessary,
clean EGR passages.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install EGR valve with new gaskets. 2. Finger tighten EGR tube fasteners. 3. Tighten
EGR tube fasteners to 11 Nm (95 in lb) torque. 4. Tightening EGR valve mounting screws to 22 Nm
(200 in lb) torque. 5. Connect vacuum supply tube to solenoid. 6. Attach electrical connector to
solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
EGR System Components
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3008
EGR Solenoid Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3009
EGR Control Solenoid: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit F12 supplies battery voltage to the Electronic EGR Transducer (EET) solenoid. The
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) switches ground path for the solenoid ON and OFF through
circuit K35.
Circuit F12 connects to a bus bar in the fuse block fed by circuit A21. A 15 Amp fuse in the fuse
block, cavity 10, protects circuit F12. Circuit F12 also connects to cavity 20 of the PCM.
Circuit K35 connects to cavity 40 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
EGR Control Solenoid: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit F12 splices to feed the ABS control module, PCM, Duty Cycle EVAP/Purge solenoid, leak
detection pump, and the TCC solenoid. The F12 circuit also connects to a bus bar in the Power
Distribution Center (PDC) that supplies voltage to the coil side of radiator fan relays, A/C clutch
relay, and fuel pump relay.
In the START or RUN position, the ignition switch connects circuit A1 from the fuse block and
circuit A21. Circuit A1 connects to battery voltage and is protected by a 30 Amp fuse in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page
3012
EGR Control Solenoid: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
TESTING ELECTRICAL SOLENOID PORTION OF VALVE
This is not to be used as a complete test of the EGR system.
Electrical operation of the valve should be checked with the DRB or equivalent scan tool. Refer to
the appropriate procedures. Replace solenoid if necessary, unit serviced only as an assembly
Fig 4 EGR System
TESTING VACUUM TRANSDUCER PORTION OF VALVE
NOTE: The first part of this test will determine if the transducer diaphragm at the back-pressure
side of the valve has ruptured or is leaking. The second part of the test will determine if engine
vacuum (full-manifold) is flowing from the inlet to the outlet side of the valve. This is not to be used
as a complete test of the EGR system.
1. Disconnect the rubber back-pressure hose from the fitting at the bottom of EGR valve (Fig. 4). 2.
Connect a hand-held vacuum pump to this fitting. 3. Apply 10 inches of vacuum to this fitting. 4. If
vacuum falls off, the valve diaphragm is leaking. 5. Replace the EGR valve assembly. Proceed to
next step for further testing. 6. Remove the rubber hose at the vacuum inlet fitting (Fig. 4) on the
EGR valve. 7. Connect a vacuum gauge to this disconnected hose. 8. Start the engine and bring to
operating temperature.
- Hold engine speed at approximately 1,500 rpm.
9. Check for steady engine vacuum (full-manifold) at this hose.
10. If engine vacuum (full-manifold) is not present, check vacuum line to engine and repair as
necessary before proceeding to next step. 11. Reconnect the rubber hose to the vacuum inlet
fitting (Fig. 4) on the EGR valve. 12. Disconnect the rubber hose at the vacuum outlet fitting (Fig. 4)
on the EGR valve. 13. Connect a vacuum gauge to this fitting. 14. Disconnect the electrical
connector (Fig. 4) at the valve control.
- This will simulate an open circuit (no ground from the PCM) at the valve.
15. Start the engine and bring to operating temperature. 16. Hold the engine speed to
approximately 2,000 rpm while checking for engine vacuum (full-manifold) at this fitting.
- To allow full manifold vacuum to flow through the valve, exhaust back-pressure must be present
at valve.
- It must be high enough to hold the bleed valve in the transducer portion of the valve closed.
- Have a helper momentarily (a second or two) hold a rag over the tailpipe opening to build some
exhaust back-pressure while observing the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page
3013
vacuum gauge.
- Heavy gloves should be worn.
CAUTION: Do not cover the tailpipe opening for an extended period of time as damage to
components or overheating may result.
17. As temporary back-pressure is built, full manifold vacuum should be observed at the vacuum
outlet fitting.
- Without back-pressure, and engine at approximately 2,000 rpm, the gauge reading will be low.
- This low reading is normal.
- At idle speed, the gauge reading will be erratic.
- This is also normal.
18. If full manifold vacuum is not present at the outlet fitting, but was present at the inlet fitting,
replace the valve.
NOTE: The EGR valve, valve control and attaching hoses are serviced as one assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Control Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3014
EGR Control Solenoid: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 EGR System
NOTE: If the EGR system operates incorrectly, replace the entire EGR valve and transducer
together. The EGR valve and Electronic EGR Transducer (EET) are calibrated together.
NOTE: The EGR valve and EET attach to the rear of the cylinder head (Fig. 1).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect vacuum supply tube from EET solenoid. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from
solenoid. 3. Remove EGR tube to EGR valve screws. 4. Remove EGR valve mounting screws.
Remove EGR valve and transducer. 5. Clean gasket surfaces. Discard old gaskets. If necessary,
clean EGR passages.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install EGR valve with new gaskets. 2. Finger tighten EGR tube fasteners. 3. Tighten
EGR tube fasteners to 11 Nm (95 in lb) torque. 4. Tightening EGR valve mounting screws to 22 Nm
(200 in lb) torque. 5. Connect vacuum supply tube to solenoid. 6. Attach electrical connector to
solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Specifications
EGR Tube: Specifications
EGR tube to intake manifold ................................................................................................................
....................................................... 11 Nm (95 in lb)
EGR tube to EGR valve .......................................................................................................................
....................................................... 11 Nm (95 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3018
EGR Tube: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 EGR System
Fig. 3 EGR Tube Stud Bolts
NOTE: The EGR tube attaches to the intake manifold plenum below the throttle body and EGR
valve (Fig. 1).
REMOVAL
1. Remove screws attaching EGR tube to intake manifold (Fig. 3). 2. Remove EGR tube to EGR
valve screws. 3. Remove EGR tube. Clean gasket surface on the EGR valve. Wipe clean the
grommet on the intake manifold.
NOTE: The rubber grommet that seals the EGR tube to intake manifold connection is reusable.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install the EGR tube and fasteners. 2. Tighten the EGR tube to intake manifold plenum
screws to 11 Nm (95 in. lbs) torque. 3. Tighten the EGR tube to EGR valve screws to 11 Nm (95 in
lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Specifications
EGR Valve: Specifications
EGR valve to cyl. head ........................................................................................................................
...................................................... 22 Nm (200 in lb)
EGR tube to EGR valve .......................................................................................................................
....................................................... 11 Nm (95 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3022
EGR Valve: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
To assist in the control of oxides of nitrogen (NOx) in engine exhaust, all engines are equipped with
an exhaust gas recirculation system. The use of exhaust gas to dilute incoming air/fuel mixtures
lowers peak flame temperatures during combustion, thus limiting the formation of NOx.
OPERATION
Exhaust gases are taken from the number four exhaust port through a hole in the end of the
cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3023
EGR Valve: Testing and Inspection
Fig 4 EGR System
EGR VALVE LEAKAGE TEST
This is not to be used as a complete test of the EGR system.
If the engine will not idle, dies out on idle, or idle is rough or slow, the poppet valve (Fig. 4) at the
base of the EGR valve may be leaking in the closed position.
1. The engine should be off for the following test. 2. Disconnect the rubber hose from the fitting
(Fig. 4) at the top (vacuum motor) side of the EGR valve.
a. Connect a hand-held vacuum pump to this fitting. b. Apply 15 inches of vacuum to the pump. c.
Observe the gauge reading on the pump. d. If vacuum falls off, the diaphragm in the EGR valve
has ruptured. e. Replace the EGR valve. Note: The EGR valve, valve control and attaching hoses
are serviced as one assembly. f.
Proceed to the next step.
3. A small metal fitting (back-pressure fitting) is located at the base of the EGR valve (Fig. 4).
- A rubber back-pressure hose connects it to the back-pressure fitting on the EGR valve control.
- Disconnect this rubber hose at the EGR valve fitting.
4. Remove the air cleaner housing from the throttle body 5. Using compressed air, and an air
nozzle with a rubber tip, apply approximately 50 psi of regulated shop air to the metal
back-pressure fitting on
the EGR valve.
6. By hand, open the throttle to the wide open position.
- Air SHOULD NOT BE HEARD emitting from the intake manifold while applying air pressure at the
back-pressure fitting.
7. If air CAN BE HEARD emitting from the intake manifold, the poppet valve (Fig. 4) is leaking at
the bottom of the EGR valve.
- Replace the EGR valve.
NOTE: The EGR valve, valve control and attaching hoses are serviced as one assembly. Do not
attempt clean the old EGR valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3024
EGR Valve: Service and Repair
Fig.3 EGR System
NOTE: If the EGR system operates incorrectly, replace the entire EGR valve and transducer
together. The EGR valve and electrical transducer (EET) are calibrated together.
NOTE: The EGR valve attaches to the rear of the cylinder head (Fig. 3). EGR transducer is
attached to the air inlet duct.
REMOVAL
1. Remove EGR transducer from air inlet duct. 2. Disconnect vacuum supply tube from EGR
transducer solenoid. 3. Disconnect electrical connector from solenoid. 4. Remove air inlet duct. 5.
Remove EGR tube to EGR valve screws. 6. Remove EGR valve mounting screws. Remove EGR
valve and transducer. 7. Clean gasket surfaces. Discard old gaskets. If necessary, clean EGR
passages.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install EGR valve with new gaskets. 2. Finger tighten EGR tube fasteners. 3. Tighten
EGR tube fasteners to 11 Nm (95 in lb) torque. 4. Tightening EGR valve mounting screws to 22 Nm
(200 in lb) torque. 5. Install air inlet duct. 6. Connect vacuum supply tube to solenoid. 7. Attach
electrical connector to solenoid. 8. Install EGR transducer onto air inlet duct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Positive Crankcase Ventilation: Description and Operation
Intake manifold vacuum removes crankcase vapors and piston blow-by from the separator.
Emissions pass through the PCV valve into the intake manifold plenum. The vapors become part of
the calibrated air-fuel mixture, are burned and then expelled with the exhaust gases. The air
cleaner supplies make up air when the engine does not have enough vapor or blow-by gases.
NOTE: In this system, fresh air does not enter the crankcase.
PCV VALVE
The PCV valve contains a spring loaded plunger. The plunger meters the amount of crankcase
vapors routed into the combustion chamber based on intake manifold vacuum.
Fig. 7 Engine Off Or Engine Backfire - No Vapor Flow
When the engine is not operating or during an engine backfire, the spring forces the plunger back
against the seat. This prevents vapors from flowing through the valve (Fig. 7).
Fig. 8 High Intake Manifold Vacuum - Minimal Vapor Flow
When the engine is at idle or cruising, high manifold vacuum is present. At these times manifold
vacuum is able to completely compress the spring and pull the plunger to the top of the valve (Fig.
8). In this position there is minimal vapor flow through the valve.
Fig. 9 Moderate Intake Manifold Vacuum - Maximum Vapor Flow
During periods of moderate intake manifold vacuum the plunger is only pulled part way back from
the inlet. This results in maximum vapor flow through the valve (Fig. 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3028
Positive Crankcase Ventilation: Testing and Inspection
Fig.9 PVC Test-Typical
WARNING: Apply parking brake and/or block wheels before performing any test or adjustment with
the engine operating.
With the engine idling, remove the PCV valve from its attaching point. If the valve is operating
properly, a hissing noise will be heard and a strong vacuum felt when placing a finger over the
valve inlet (Fig. 9).
With the engine off, shake the valve. The valve should rattle when shaken. Replace the valve if it
does not operate properly. Do not attempt to clean the PCV valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 3037
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Minimum Air Flow Idle Odometer <= 1,000 Miles ................................................................................
............................................................................................. 550 - 1,300 rpm Odometer >= 1,000
Miles ....................................................................................................................................................
......................... 600 - 1,300 rpm
Note: Idle speed range achieved through Minimum Air Flow Idle Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Page 3041
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 31 PCV Vacuum Nipple
1. Turn ignition key off. 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold nipple (Fig. 31).
Cap the PCV vacuum nipple.
Fig. 32 Purge Hose
3. Disconnect purge hose from the nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 32).
Fig. 33 Orifice 6457 Attached To Purge Nipple
4. Use a piece of hose to attach Air Metering Orifice 6457 (0.125 in. orifice) or equivalent, to the
purge nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 33). 5. Ensure that all accessories are off. 6. Connect the
DRB or equivalent scan tool to the data link connector inside the passenger compartment. 7. Run
engine in Park or Neutral until the cooling fan has cycled on and off at least once (180°F). 8. Using
the DRB or equivalent scan tool, access Minimum Airflow Idle Speed. 9. The following will then
occur:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Page 3042
- Idle air control motor will fully close
- Idle spark advance will become fixed
- PCM will go open loop enriched
- DRB or equivalent scan tool displays engine RPM
10. If idle RPM is within the range shown below, throttle body minimum airflow is set correctly.
Odometer Reading Idle RPM
Below 1,000 Miles 550 - 1,300 RPM
Above 1,000 Miles 600 - 1,300 RPM
11. If idle RPM is above specifications, use the DRB or equivalent scan tool to check idle air control
motor operation. If idle air control motor is OK,
replace throttle body. If idle air flow is below specification, shut off the engine and clean the throttle
body as follows: a. Remove the throttle body from engine.
WARNING: Clean throttle body in a well ventilated area. Wear rubber or butyl gloves, do not let
Mopar parts cleaner come in contact with eyes or skin. Avoid ingesting the cleaner. Wash
thoroughly after using cleaner.
b. While holding the throttle open, spray the entire throttle body bore and the manifold side of the
throttle plate with Mopar Parts Cleaner. Only
use Mopar Parts Cleaner to clean the throttle body.
c. Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom of throttle body bore and the edges and
manifold side of the throttle blade. The edges of the
throttle blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest to the throttle blade when is closed,
must be free of deposits.
d. Use compressed air to dry the throttle body. e. Inspect throttle body for foreign material. f.
Install throttle body on manifold.
g. Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow is still not within specifications, the problem is
not caused by the throttle body.
12. Shut off engine. 13. Remove Air Metering Orifice 6457 or equivalent. Install purge hose. 14.
Remove cap from PCV valve. Connect hose to PCV valve. 15. Remove DRB or equivalent scan
tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications
Accelerator Pedal: Specifications
Accelerator Pedal to Dash Nuts 12 Nm (105 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3046
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair
Fig. 35 Accelerator Pedal and Throttle Cable-Front View
Fig. 36 Accelerator Pedal and Throttle Cable-Rear View
CAUTION: When servicing the accelerator pedal, throttle cable or speed control cable, do not
damage or kink the core wire inside the cable sheathing.
REMOVAL
1. Working from the engine compartment, remove the throttle control shield. 2. Hold the throttle
body throttle lever in the wide open position.
- Remove the throttle cable from the throttle body cam.
3. From inside the vehicle, hold up the pedal and remove the cable retainer and throttle cable from
the upper end of the pedal shaft (Fig. 35) and (Fig.
36).
4. Working from the engine compartment, remove nuts from accelerator pedal attaching studs (Fig.
35).
- Remove assembly from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position accelerator pedal assembly on dash panel. Install retaining nuts.
- Tighten retaining nuts to 12 Nm (105 in lb) torque.
2. From inside the vehicle, hold up the pedal and install the throttle cable and cable retainer in the
upper end of the pedal shaft. 3. From the engine compartment hold the throttle body lever in the
wide open position and install the throttle cable.
- Install the throttle control shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Fig. 104 Air Intake Duct
Fig. 105 Removal/Installation of Air Inlet Duct
NOTE: Neon vehicles do not use a heated air inlet system. The PCM adjusts fuel injector pulse
width and ignition timing to compensate for different ambient temperatures.
NOTE: The air cleaner attaches to a bracket on the rear of the cylinder head. An ambient air duct
supplies underhood air for the engine.
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake tube (Fig. 104) from air cleaner and intake manifold (Fig. 105).
Fig. 106 Removal/Installation Air Cleaner Front Housing and Element
2. Tighten clasps on top of air cleaner housing. Rotate front of housing forward then lift front away
from air cleaner housing (Fig 106). 3. Remove air cleaner element from front housing (Fig. 106).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3051
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element into front housing. 2. Rotate front of housing forward then lower into
place and locate tabs in slots.
- Fasten clasps on top of air cleaner housing.
- Install air intake duct at air cleaner and intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - High Driveability Index Fuels
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - High Driveability Index Fuels
NO: 14-08-97
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: Nov. 21, 1997
SUBJECT: Poor Driveability With High DI (Driveability Index) Fuel
MODELS:
1996 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1996 - 1998 (AN) Dakota
1996 - 1998 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1998 (DN) Durango
1996 - 1998 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 1998 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1996 - 1998 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1996 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1996 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1998 (SR) Viper Roadster/Coupe
1997 - 1998 (TJ) Wrangler
1996 - 1998 (XJ) Cherokee
1995 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Long cold start times, warm-up sags, hesitations, and driveway die outs. These symptoms are
most noticeable and severe at moderate ambient temperatures between 4 - 27 degrees C (40 - 80
degrees F).
DISCUSSION:
Gasoline with a high Driveability Index (DI) can cause the above described symptoms. DI is a
measure of the gasolines total volatility, or tendency to vaporize completely. A high DI number is
less volatile than a low DI number. Most premium gasoline sold in the U.S. has a higher (worse) DI
index than regular or mid-grade gasoline. Use of premium gasoline is NOT recommended for
vehicles designed to run on 87 (R+M)/2 regular or 89 (R+M)/2 midgrade gasoline. High DI
gasolines also cause higher emissions for the same reasons they cause driveability problems.
For vehicles that require an octane rating of 91 (R+M)/2, premium is recommended, or possibly
required. Using premium fuel with a higher than recommended octane rating is not recommended.
Owners who experience fuel related cold start and warm up driveability problems should try a
gasoline with the recommended octane rating or different brands of gasoline until they find one that
provides good performance.
The octane quality of gasoline is only a measure of its resistance to spark knock. The use of higher
than recommended octane gasoline under normal operating conditions does NOT improve
startability, idle quality, fuel economy, driveability, acceleration, engine durability, or emissions. In
fact, most higher octane gasolines available in the U.S. have higher DI values than regular
gasoline. Customers are most likely to experience poor driveability with premium gasoline than with
regular.
Some vehicles, such as Viper, Prowler, 5.9L Grand Cherokee, 2.0L Turbo Talon, and 2.0L DOHC
Neon have been specifically designed to take advantage of higher octane. These vehicles may
have higher compression ratios, and/or more aggressive spark calibrations which provide optimum
performance with the specified higher octane. However, other vehicles which are not specifically
designed and calibrated to take advantage of higher octane will not benefit from higher octane.
Some vehicles may experience light spark knock in situations such as trailer towing or climbing
steep sustained grades. Light knock or "ping" under these conditions is not harmful. However, if the
customer is concerned about light knock under these circumstances, the use of 89 (R+M)/2 or
even 91 (R+M)/2 premium gasoline may be temporarily warranted. If a vehicle is experiencing
heavy spark knock on gasoline with its designed octane rating, this may be an indication of
excessive combustion chamber deposits, or some other problem. Combustion chamber deposits
can be removed with Mopar Combustion Chamber Conditioner p/n 04318001. Standard diagnostic
procedures may help in identifying other potential causes of excessive knock.
Some gasoline marketers may advertise that their premium gasoline contains extra detergent
additives. Under provisions of the Clean Air Act, ALL gasoline sold in the U.S. must contain
effective deposit control additives. Nevertheless, if fuel injector or intake valve deposits are
suspected of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - High Driveability Index Fuels > Page 3056
contributing to poor performance, occasional use of Mopar Fuel Injector Clean Up p/n 04549613 is
a much less expensive way to maintain engine cleanliness than regular use of premium gasoline.
The charts (Figures 1 & 2) show the negative effects of high DI fuel as related to customer
satisfaction.
If fuel quality is suspected in causing a customers driveability concern, your zone technical office
may be able to provide direction on procedures for fuel sample analysis.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3057
Fuel: Specifications
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
The vehicle is designed to meet all emission regulations and provide excellent fuel economy when
using high quality unleaded gasoline having a minimum octane rating of 87.
The vehicle will operate on fuels ranging from regular unleaded having a minimum posted octane
of 87 to premium unleaded with a minimum posted octane of 91. However, mid-grade unleaded
fuel with a minimum octane rating of 89 is recommended. The use of premium unleaded gasoline
will further improve performance.
If the vehicle develops occasional light spark knock (ping) at low engine speeds this is not harmful.
However; continued heavy spark knock at high speeds can cause damage and should be corrected
immediately. Engine damage as a result of heavy spark knock operation may not be covered by
the new vehicle warranty.
In addition to using unleaded gasoline with the proper octane rating, those that contain detergents,
corrosion and stability additives are recommended. Using gasoline that has these additives will
help improve fuel economy, reduce emissions, and maintain vehicle performance.
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard starting, stalling, and stumble. If you
experience these problems, try another brand of gasoline before considering service for the
vehicle.
ADDITIVES & OXYGENATE BLENDS
Additives - The use of gasoline containing detergents, corrosion and stability additives is
recommended, as these additives will improve fuel economy, reduce emissions, and maintain
vehicle performance.
Fuel Quality - Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard starting, stalling, and
stumble. If you experience these problems, try another brand of gasoline before considering
service for the vehicle.
Pinging/Knocking - Light knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to your engine. However,
continued heavy spark knock at high speeds can cause damage and should be reported to your
dealer immediately.
CAUTION: Engine damage resulting from operating with a heavy spark knock may not be covered
by the new vehicle warranty.
GASOLINE/OXYGENATE BLENDS
Ethanol - (Ethyl or Grain Alcohol) properly blended, is used as a mixture of 10 percent ethanol and
90 percent gasoline. Gasoline blended with ethanol may be used in your vehicle.
Methanol - (Methyl or Wood Alcohol) is used in a variety of concentrations when blended with
unleaded gasoline. You may find fuels containing 3 percent or more methanol along with other
alcohols called cosolvents.
CAUTION: Do not use gasoline containing Methanol. Use of methanol/gasoline blends may result
in starting and driveability problems and damage critical fuel system components. Problems that
are the result of using methanol/gasoline blends may not be covered by the new vehicle warranty.
CLEAN AIR GASOLINE
MTBE/ETBE - Many gasoline are now being blended that contribute to cleaner air, especially in
those areas of the country where pollution levels are high. These new blends provide a cleaner
burning fuel and some are referred to as reformulated gasoline..
MTBE (Methyl Tertiary Butyl Ether) blends are a mixture of unleaded gasoline and up to 15 percent
MTBE. Gasoline blended with MTBE may be used in your vehicle.
ETBE (Ethyl Tertiary Butyl Ether) blends are a mixture of unleaded gasoline and up to up to 17
percent ETBE. Gasoline blended with ETBE may be used in your vehicle.
ADDITIVE CAUTION: Many materials intended for gum and varnish removal may contain active
solvents or similar ingredients that can be harmful to fuel system gasket and diaphragm materials.
Indiscriminate use of fuel system cleaning agents should be avoided.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation
Fig. 4 Pressure Vacuum Filler Cap
WARNING: Remove fuel filler tube cap to relieve tank pressure before removing or repairing fuel
system components.
PURPOSE
A pressure-vacuum relief cap seals the fuel tank (Fig. 4).
The loss of any fuel or vapor out of the filler tube neck is prevented by the use of a safety filler cap.
OPERATION
Tightening the cap on the fuel filler tube forms a seal between them.
The relief valves in the cap are a safety feature. They prevent possible excessive pressure or
vacuum in the tank. Excessive fuel tank pressure could be caused by a malfunction in the system
or damage to the vent lines.
The seal between the cap and filler tube breaks when the cap is removed. Breaking the seal
relieves fuel tank pressure.
Pressure Release The cap releases only under significant pressure 10.9 to 13.45 kPa (1.58 to 1.95
psi).
Vacuum Release The vacuum release for all gas caps is between 0.97 and 2.0 kPa (0.14 and 0.29
psi).
Replacement If the filler cap needs replacement, only use an original equipment or equivalent unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 degrees C (1000 degrees F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 3065
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Fuel Pressure Test Port--Typical
Fig. 12 Releasing Fuel Pressure
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. NEVER smoke while servicing vehicle.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove fuel filler cap. 3. Remove protective cap from
fuel pressure test port on fuel rail Fig. 1. 4. Place open end of fuel pressure release hose Special
Tool number C-4799-1, into an approved gasoline container. 5. Connect other end of hose
C-4799-1 to fuel pressure test port Fig. 2.
- Fuel pressure will bleed off through the hose into the gasoline container. (Fuel gauge C-4799-A
contains hose C-4799-1.)
6. Replace Pressure test port cap when finished releasing pressure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Injector Circuit Test Revisions
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Injector Circuit Test Revisions
NUMBER: 26-05-98E
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: May, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 2.0L, 2.4L, 2.5L, 3.3L, 3.5L Passenger Car Powertrain Diagnostic Manual Publication Number 81-699-96040
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the injector circuit test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Injector Circuit Test Revisions > Page 3070
153
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Injector Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
.......................................... 12 ohms at 20 ° C (68 ° F)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3073
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3074
Injector Connector -- Typical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Injectors Description
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation Fuel Injectors Description
Fig. 4 Fuel Injector
Fig. 5 Fuel Injector Location-Typical
OPERATION
The fuel injectors are 12 ohm electrical solenoids (Fig. 4). The injector contains a pintle that closes
off an orifice at the nozzle end. When electric current is supplied to the injector the armature and
needle move a short distance against a spring, allowing fuel to flow out the orifice. Because the fuel
is under high pressure, a fine spray is developed in the shape of a hollow cone. The spraying
action atomizes the fuel, adding it to the air entering the combustion chamber.
The injectors are positioned in the intake manifold with the nozzle ends directly above the intake
valve port (Fig. 5).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down ( ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay. The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 supplies voltage for the fuel injectors. The PCM controls the ground circuit of each
injector. Circuit K11 is the ground circuit for Injector #1. Circuit K11 connects to cavity 13 of the PCM.
- Circuit K12 is the ground circuit for Injector #2. Circuit K12 connects to cavity 17 of the PCM.
- Circuit K13 is the ground circuit for Injector #3. Circuit K13 connects to cavity 7 of the PCM.
- Circuit K14 is the ground circuit for Injector #4. Circuit K14 connects to cavity 16 of the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Injectors Description > Page 3077
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation Injector Control Circuit Trouble Code
Name of Code:
Injector Control Circuit
When Monitored:
With battery voltage greater than 12 volts, the auto shutdown relay energized, injector pulse width
less than 10 ms, and engine speed less than 3,000 rpm.
Set Condition:
This trouble code takes 0.64 to 10.0 seconds to set when no inductive kick is sensed 0.18 ms after
injector turn off, and with no other injectors on.
Theory of Operation:
Fuel injectors are high-impedance solenoids controlled by the PCM. Battery voltage is supplied by
the ASD relay. The injector on time (pulse width) is controlled by the amount of time the PCM
grounds the injector control circuit. By varying this time, more or less fuel is allowed to flow through
the injector.
Possible Causes:
- Open or shorted injector driver circuit
- Open injector
- Open ASD supply at injector
- PCM failure
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator, and
the upstream and downstream heated oxygen sensors. The PCM controls the ground circuit for
each of the components powered by circuit A142.
The injectors operate in sequence.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3080
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Resistance Test
Related Images
Check resistance between the injector terminals. Resistance should be between 10 and 16 ohms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3081
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Diagnostic Chart
Fuel Injector Diagnosis
For fuel injector diagnosis, refer to the Fuel Injector Diagnosis charts. For poor fuel economy
diagnosis or engine miss also consider transmission problems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3082
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
Fig. 27 Fuel Rail and Injectors
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Release fuel system pressure. 3. Disconnect fuel
supply tube from rail. 4. Disconnect electrical connectors from fuel injectors (Fig. 27). 5. Remove
fuel rail mounting screws. 6. Lift rail off of intake manifold. Cover the fuel injector openings in the
intake manifold.
Fig. 28 Fuel Injector Retainer
7. Remove fuel injector retainer (Fig. 28).
Fig. 29 Fuel Injector 0-Rings
8. Pull injector out of fuel rail. Replace fuel injector 0-rings (Fig. 29).
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to the upper 0-ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3083
2. Install injector in cup on fuel rail. 3. Install retaining clip. 4. Apply a light coating of clean engine
oil to the 0-ring on the nozzle end of each injector. 5. Insert fuel injector nozzles into openings in
intake manifold. Seat the injectors in place. Tighten fuel rail mounting screws to 22.5 Nm ± 3 Nm
(200 ± 30 in lb).
6. Attach electrical connectors to fuel injectors. 7. Conned fuel supply tube to fuel rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Line Coupler: Description and Operation
Fig 13 Plastic Retainer Type Fitting
Different types of quick-connect fittings are used to attach various fuel system components. These
are: a single-tab type, a two-tab type or a plastic retainer ring type. Some are equipped with safety
latch clips.
CAUTION: The interior components (O-rings, spacers) of quick connect fittings are not serviced
separately. Do not attempt to repair damaged fittings or fuel lines/tubes. If repair is necessary,
replace the complete fuel tube assembly.
Fuel tubes connect fuel system components with plastic quick-connect fuel fittings. The fitting
contains non-serviceable O-ring seals.
CAUTION: Quick-connect fittings are not serviced separately. Do not attempt to repair damaged
quick-connect fittings or fuel tubes. Replace the complete fuel tube/quick-connect fitting assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Plastic Retaining Ring Type Fitting
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Plastic Retaining Ring Type Fitting
Fig 13 Plastic Retainer Type Fitting
NOTE: This type of fitting can be identified by the use of a full-round plastic retainer ring (Fig. 13)
usually black in color.
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure (even with the engine off). Before
servicing any fuel system hoses, fittings or lines, the fuel system pressure must be released.
Perform Fuel Pressure Release procedure.
CAUTION: The interior components (O-rings, spacers, retainers) of this type of quick-connect fitting
are not serviced separately. Do not attempt to repair damaged fittings or fuel lines/tubes. If repair is
necessary, replace the complete fuel tube assembly.
DISCONNECTION/CONNECTION
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the battery. 2. Perform the fuel pressure release
procedure. 3. Clean the fitting of any foreign material before disassembly. 4. To release the fuel
system component from the quick-connect fitting: firmly push the fitting towards the component
being serviced while firmly
pushing the plastic retaining ring into the fitting (Fig. 13) With the plastic ring depressed, pull the
fitting from the component. -
The plastic retainer ring must be pressed squarely into the fitting body. If this retainer is cocked
during removal, it may be difficult to disconnect fitting. Use an open-end wrench on the shoulder of
the plastic retainer ring to aid in disconnection.
5. After disconnection, the plastic retainer ring will remain with the quick-connect fitting connector
body. 6. Inspect fitting connector body, plastic retainer ring and fuel system component for
damage.
- Replace as necessary.
7. Prior to connecting the quick-connect fitting to component being serviced, check condition of
fitting and component.
- Clean the parts with a lint-free cloth.
- Lubricate them with clean engine oil.
8. Insert the quick-connect fitting into the component being serviced until a click is felt. 9. Verify a
locked condition by firmly pulling on fuel tube and fitting ( 15-30 lbs).
10. Connect negative battery cable to battery. 11. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Plastic Retaining Ring Type Fitting > Page 3089
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Fittings
Fig. 14 Plastic Quick-Connect Fitting/Fuel Tube Connection
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before disconnecting a quick-connect fittings. Refer to
the fuel pressure release procedure.
NOTE: When disconnecting a quick-connect fitting, the retainer will remain on the fuel tube nipple.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Perform Fuel Pressure Release Procedure. 3.
Squeeze retainer tabs together and pull fuel tube/quick-connect fitting assembly off of fuel tube
nipple. The retainer will remain on fuel tube.
CAUTION: Never install a quick-connect fitting without the retainer being either on the fuel tube or
already in the quick-connect fitting. In either case, ensure the retainer locks securely into the
quick-connect fitting by firmly pulling on fuel tube and fitting to ensure it is secured.
INSTALLATION
1. Using a clean lint free cloth clean the fuel tube nipple and retainer. 2. Prior to connecting the
fitting to the fuel tube, coat the fuel tube nipple with clean 30 weight engine oil. 3. Push the
quick-connect fitting over the fuel tube until the retainer seats and a click is heard. 4. The
quick-connect fitting has windows in the sides of the casing.
- When the fitting completely attaches to the fuel tube, the retainer locking ears and the fuel tube
shoulder are visible in the windows.
- If they are not visible, the retainer was not properly installed (Fig. 14).
- Do not rely upon the audible click to confirm a secure connection.
CAUTION: When using the ASD Fuel System Test, the Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay remains
energized for either 7 minutes, until the test is stopped, or until the ignition switch is turned to the
Off position.
5. Use the DRB scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation
Fig. 2 Side View-Filter/Regulator
A combination fuel filter and fuel pressure regulator is used on all gas powered engines. It is
located on the top of the fuel pump module. A separate frame mounted fuel filter is not used.
Fuel Pressure Regulator Operation: The pressure regulator is a mechanical device that is
calibrated to maintain fuel system operating pressure of approximately 338 kPa (49 psi) at the fuel
injectors.
It contains a diaphragm, calibrated springs and a fuel return valve. The internal fuel filter (Fig. 2) is
also part of the assembly
Fuel is supplied to the filter/regulator by the electric fuel pump through an opening tube at the
bottom of filter/regulator.
The fuel pump module contains a check valve to maintain some fuel pressure when the engine is
not operating. This will help to start the engine.
If fuel pressure at the pressure regulator exceeds approximately 49 psi, an internal diaphragm
closes and excess fuel pressure is routed back into the tank through the pressure regulator. A
separate fuel return line is not used with any gas powered engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3093
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
Fig. 18 Locking Spring Tab
WARNING: The fuel system is under a constant pressure, even with engine off before servicing the
fuel filter/fuel pressure regulator, the fuel system pressure must be released.
NOTE: The fuel filter/fuel pressure regulator is located on the top of fuel pump module. Fuel pump
module removal is not necessary.
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Disconnect fuel supply line at the Filter/Regulator nipple. 3. Depress
locking spring tab on side of Fuel/Regulator (Fig. 18) and rotate 9O° counter-clockwise and pull
out.
NOTE: Make sure that the upper and lower 0-rings are on the Filter/Regulator assembly, and lightly
lubricate the 0-rings with engine oil.
Fig. 19 Spring Tab In Locating Slot
INSTALLATION
1. Insert filter/regulator into the opening in the fuel pump module, align the two hold down tabs with
the flange. 2. While applying downward pressure, rotate the Filter/Regulator clockwise until the the
spring tab engages the locating slot (Fig. 19). 3. Connect the fuel line to the Filter/Regulator. 4.
Lower vehicle from hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Test Port >
Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Locations
Typical -- SOHC Shown
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3106
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The inside top of the PDC
cover has a label showing relay and fuse location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3107
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector > Page 3110
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector > Page 3111
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Relay Operation
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Operation
NAME OF CODE:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
WHEN MONITORED:
With the ignition key ON and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
SET CONDITION:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). One side of
the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "RUN"
position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the
powertrain control module (PCM). The PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either
the RUN or CRANK position and engine RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM
will remove the fuel pump relay control circuit ground.
POSSIBLE CAUSES:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Relay Operation > Page 3114
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit Trouble Code
Name of Code:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key on and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the PDC. One side of the relay control coil is
supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "run position". The circuit is
completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the powertrain control module. The
PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either the run or crank position and engine
RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM will remove the fuel pump relay control
circuit ground.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3115
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump relay.
Terminal 85 -- The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A -- When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87 When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should not show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one
end of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the
jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3116
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
NOTE: Other testing for this system or component is done at the system level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Specifications
Fuel Rail: Specifications
Fuel Rail Bolts 23 Nm (195 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3120
Fuel Rail: Description and Operation
Fig. 3 Fuel Rail-Typical
The fuel rail supplies the necessary fuel to each individual fuel injector and is mounted to the intake
manifold (Fig. 3). The fuel pressure regulator is no longer mounted to the fuel rail on any engine. It
is now located on the fuel tank mounted fuel pump module. The fuel rail is not repairable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair
Fig. 33 Fuel Filler Neck
REMOVAL
1. Loosen fuel filler tube cap. 2. Remove fuel filler neck screws (Fig. 33). 3. Disconnect fuel fill
vapor tube. 4. Disconnect fuel filler tube from fuel tank. Remove filler neck.
INSTALLATION
1. Reverse for installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description > Page 3129
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 3132
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 3133
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 3134
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3135
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3136
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Mounting
Straps > Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Tank Mounting Straps: Specifications
Fuel Tank Straps torque = 23 Nm (250 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Fuel Pump Module
NOTE: The fuel pump module is installed in the top of the fuel tank (Fig. 1).
The fuel pump module contains the following: Electric fuel pump
- Fuel pump reservoir
- Inlet strainer
- Fuel filter/pressure regulator
- Fuel gauge sending unit
- Fuel supply line connection
The inlet strainer, fuel pressure regulator and fuel level sensor are the only serviceable items. If the
fuel pump requires service, replace the fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3143
Fuel Tank Unit: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Fuel Pump Module Removal
WARNING: Release fuel system pressure before servicing fuel system components. Service
vehicles in well ventilated areas and avoid ignition sources. never smoke while servicing the
vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Drain the fuel.
WARNING: The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is
drained. The fuel in the reservoir will spill out when the module is removed.
2. Disconnect fuel line from fuel pump module by depressing quick connect retainers with thumb
and fore finger. 3. Slide fuel pump module electrical connector lock to unlock. 4. Disconnect the
electrical connection from the fuel pump module by pushing down on connector retainer and pulling
connector off of module. 5. Use a transmission jack to support the fuel tank. remove bolts from fuel
tank straps. 6. Lower tank slightly
Fig. 17 Fuel Tank Locknut
7. Use Special Tool 6856 to remove fuel pump module locknut (Fig. 17). 8. Remove fuel pump and
0-ring seal from tank. Discard old seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe seal area of tank clean and place a new seal in position in the tank opening. 2. Position
fuel pump in the tank. Make sure the alignment tab on the underside of the fuel pump module
flange sits in the notch on the fuel tank. 3. Position the locknut over the fuel pump module. 4.
Tighten the locknut using Special Tool 6856 to 55 Nm (40.5 ft lb) (Fig. 17).
CAUTION: Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
5. Fill fuel tank. Check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
IAC Motor-To-Throttle Body Bolts 7 Nm (60 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3147
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3148
Idle Air Control Motor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3149
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The idle air control (IAC) motor is used by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to help regulate
idle speed. The motor controls the amount of air allowed to bypass the throttle blade. The PCM
controls the motor using four driver circuits to position the stepper motor.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) operates the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor through 4 circuits
K39, K40, K59, and K60. Each circuit connects to separate cavities in the PCM connector. Circuit K39 connects to cavity 57 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K40 connects to cavity 48 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K59 connects to cavity 58 of the PCM connector.
- Circuit K60 connects to cavity 49 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3150
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
Fig. 95 Servicing Idle Air Control Motor
CAUTION: When servicing throttle body components, always reassemble components with new
0-rings and seals where applicable. Never use lubricants on 0-rings or seals, damage may result. If
assembly of component is difficult, use water to aid assembly. Use care when removing hoses to
prevent damage to hose or hose nipple.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery 2. Remove electrical connector from idle air control
motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove the EVAP purge hose from the throttle body. 4.
Remove throttle body. 5. Remove idle air control motor mounting screws (Fig. 95). 6. Remove
motor from throttle body Ensure the 0-ring is removed with the motor.
INSTALLATION
1. The new idle air control motor has a new 0-ring installed on it.
- If pintle measures more than 1 inch (25 mm) it must be retracted.
- Use the DRB Idle Air Control Motor Open/Close Test to retract the pintle (battery must be
connected).
2. Carefully place idle air control motor into throttle body 3. Install mounting screws. Tighten screws
to 7 Nm (60 in lb) torque. 4. Install throttle body. 5. Connect electrical connector to idle air control
motor and throttle position sensor. 6. Connect the EVAP purge hose to the throttle body nipple. 7.
Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3154
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page
3157
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page
3158
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3159
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information >
Page 3162
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD)
Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information >
Page 3163
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3169
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The fuel pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The inside top of the PDC
cover has a label showing relay and fuse location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3170
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector > Page
3173
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Fuel Pump Relay Connector > Page
3174
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Relay
Operation
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Operation
NAME OF CODE:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
WHEN MONITORED:
With the ignition key ON and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
SET CONDITION:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
THEORY OF OPERATION:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). One side of
the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "RUN"
position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the
powertrain control module (PCM). The PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either
the RUN or CRANK position and engine RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM
will remove the fuel pump relay control circuit ground.
POSSIBLE CAUSES:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump Relay
Operation > Page 3177
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit Trouble Code
Name of Code:
Fuel Pump Relay Control Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key on and battery voltage greater than 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the fuel pump relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The fuel pump relay controls the 12-volt source to the fuel pump. If the vehicle is equipped with a
power distribution center, the relay is located in the PDC. One side of the relay control coil is
supplied with 12 volts when the ignition switch is turned to the "run position". The circuit is
completed when the other side of the relay coil is grounded by the powertrain control module. The
PCM grounds the relay when the ignition switch is in either the run or crank position and engine
RPM is detected. If engine RPM is not detected, the PCM will remove the fuel pump relay control
circuit ground.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Fuel pump relay control circuit is open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
- Connector terminals
- Connector wires
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3178
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump relay.
Terminal 85 -- The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A -- When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87 When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should not show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one
end of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the
jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3179
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
NOTE: Other testing for this system or component is done at the system level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Fig. 15 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3183
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). The PDC is located next to the battery
in the engine compartment. For the location of the relay within the PDC refer to the PDC cover for
location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 3186
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams Power Distribution
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > ASD Relay Connector > Page 3187
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3188
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
PURPOSE
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel injectors, electronic
ignition coil and the heating elements in the oxygen sensors.
OPERATION
A buss bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and
contact side of the relay
The ASD relay power circuit contains a 20 amp fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the
relay. The fuse also protects the power circuit for the fuel pump relay and pump. The fuse is located in
the PDC.
The PCM controls the ASD relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the relay on
and off. The PCM turns the ground path off when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
- When the ignition switch is in ON or START, the PCM monitors the crankshaft and camshaft
position sensor signals to determine engine speed and ignition timing (coil dwell).
- If the PCM does not receive crankshaft and camshaft position sensor signals when the ignition
switch is in the Run position, it will de-energize the ASD relay
The ASD relay is located in the PDC (Fig. 20). The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse identification.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Power for
the coil and contact side of the relay is supplied on circuit A14. This circuit is HOT at all times and
protected by a 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) controls the ground path for the coil side of the relay on
circuit K51. This circuit connects to cavity 67 of the PCM.
When the PCM supplies the ground path on circuit K51 the contacts in the relay CLOSE
connecting circuits A14 and A142. The A142 circuit is spliced and supplies power to the generator,
fuel injectors, PCM, ignition coil, and heated oxygen sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 20 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3191
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump & ASD Relay Test
Fig. 29 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered (Fig. 29).
OPERATION
Terminal 30: Is connected to battery voltage at all times for both the ASD relay and fuel pump
relay.
Terminal 85: The powertrain control module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the relay through
terminal number 85.
Terminal 86: Supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay. There is no wire terminal in the cavity.
OFF Position Terminal 87A: When PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal
number 87A connects to terminal 30. This is the OFF position.
- Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- There is no wire or terminal in the cavity.
In the OFF position voltage is not supplied to the rest of the circuit.
ON Position Terminal 87: When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87
connects to terminal 30. This is the ON position.
- Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
TEST
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86 of the relay. The resistance should
be between 70 to 80 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals 30 and 87A of the relay. The ohmmeter should
show continuity between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between relay terminals
87 and 30 of the relay The ohmmeter should show an open circuit at this time. 5. Connect one end
of a jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper
wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or heavier) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. DO NOT attach the other end of
the jumper wire to the relay at this time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3192
WARNING: Do not allow ohmmeter to contact terminals 85 or 86 during this test.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD show continuity between relay terminals 87 and 30.
- The ohmmeter SHOULD NOT show continuity between relay terminals 87A and 30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires.
Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance tests. If the relay passed the tests,
it operates properly Check the remainder of the ASD and fuel pump relay circuits. Refer to
electrical diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Rollover Valve, Fuel Tank >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Rollover Valve: Description and Operation
All models pass a full 360 degree rollover test without fuel leakage. To accomplish this, fuel and
vapor flow controls are required for all fuel tank connections.
All Neon vehicles have two rollover valves. One in the fuel filler tube and the other on the top of the
fuel tank. The valves prevent fuel flow through the fuel tank vent valve hoses should the vehicle
rollover.
An evaporation control system is connected to the rollover valve(s) to reduce emissions of fuel
vapors into the atmosphere. When fuel evaporates from the fuel tank, vapors pass through vent
hoses or tubes to a charcoal canister where they are temporarily held. When the engine is running,
the vapors are drawn into the intake manifold. Certain models are also equipped with a
self-diagnosing system using a Leak Detection Pump (LDP). Refer to Emission Control Systems for
additional information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Rollover Valve, Fuel Tank >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filler Tube Rollover Valve Replacement
Rollover Valve: Service and Repair Fuel Filler Tube Rollover Valve Replacement
Fig 34 Fuel Filler Tube Rollover Valve
NOTE: The rollover valve is mounted in the fuel filler tube (Fig. 34).
REMOVAL
1. To release fuel tank pressure, remove the fuel filler tube cap. 2. Disconnect vapor tube from
rollover valve. 3. Using a straight screwdriver, pry the valve out of the grommet in the fuel filler
tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a light coating of power steering fluid to the grommet. 2. Install valve in grommet. 3. Attach
vapor tube to valve. 4. Install fuel filler tube cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Rollover Valve, Fuel Tank >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filler Tube Rollover Valve Replacement > Page 3198
Rollover Valve: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Rollover Valve Replacement
REMOVAL
1. To release fuel tank pressure, remove the fuel filler tube cap. 2. Remove fuel tank. Refer to
procedure. 3. Disconnect vapor tube from rollover valve. 4. Using a straight screwdriver, pry the
valve out of the grommet in the fuel filler tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a light coating of power steering fluid to the grommet. 2. Install valve in grommet. 3. Attach
vapor tube to valve. 4. Install fuel tank. Refer to procedure. See: Fuel Tank/Service and
Repair/Fuel Tank Replacement 5. Install fuel filler tube cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications >
Page 3204
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3205
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3206
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3207
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful
Information > Page 3210
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3211
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3212
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications
Throttle Body: Specifications
Throttle Body Mounting Bolts 23 Nm (200 in lb)
Throttle Control Shield 5.6 Nm (50 in lb)
IAC Motor-To-Throttle Body Bolts 7 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3216
Throttle Body: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 31 PCV Vacuum Nipple
1. Turn ignition key off. 2. Disconnect the PCV valve hose from the intake manifold nipple (Fig. 31).
Cap the PCV vacuum nipple.
Fig. 32 Purge Hose
3. Disconnect purge hose from the nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 32).
Fig. 33 Orifice 6457 Attached To Purge Nipple
4. Use a piece of hose to attach Air Metering Orifice 6457 (0.125 in. orifice) or equivalent, to the
purge nipple on the throttle body (Fig. 33). 5. Ensure that all accessories are off. 6. Connect the
DRB or equivalent scan tool to the data link connector inside the passenger compartment. 7. Run
engine in Park or Neutral until the cooling fan has cycled on and off at least once (180°F). 8. Using
the DRB or equivalent scan tool, access Minimum Airflow Idle Speed. 9. The following will then
occur:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3217
- Idle air control motor will fully close
- Idle spark advance will become fixed
- PCM will go open loop enriched
- DRB or equivalent scan tool displays engine RPM
10. If idle RPM is within the range shown below, throttle body minimum airflow is set correctly.
Odometer Reading Idle RPM
Below 1,000 Miles 550 - 1,300 RPM
Above 1,000 Miles 600 - 1,300 RPM
11. If idle RPM is above specifications, use the DRB or equivalent scan tool to check idle air control
motor operation. If idle air control motor is OK,
replace throttle body. If idle air flow is below specification, shut off the engine and clean the throttle
body as follows: a. Remove the throttle body from engine.
WARNING: Clean throttle body in a well ventilated area. Wear rubber or butyl gloves, do not let
Mopar parts cleaner come in contact with eyes or skin. Avoid ingesting the cleaner. Wash
thoroughly after using cleaner.
b. While holding the throttle open, spray the entire throttle body bore and the manifold side of the
throttle plate with Mopar Parts Cleaner. Only
use Mopar Parts Cleaner to clean the throttle body.
c. Using a soft scuff pad, clean the top and bottom of throttle body bore and the edges and
manifold side of the throttle blade. The edges of the
throttle blade and portions of the throttle bore that are closest to the throttle blade when is closed,
must be free of deposits.
d. Use compressed air to dry the throttle body. e. Inspect throttle body for foreign material. f.
Install throttle body on manifold.
g. Repeat steps 1 through 14. If the minimum air flow is still not within specifications, the problem is
not caused by the throttle body.
12. Shut off engine. 13. Remove Air Metering Orifice 6457 or equivalent. Install purge hose. 14.
Remove cap from PCV valve. Connect hose to PCV valve. 15. Remove DRB or equivalent scan
tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
Fig. 88 Throttle Body Cables Attachment to Throttle Body
Fig. 89 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
REMOVAL
1. Remove throttle cable cover. 2. Remove throttle body cables using the following procedures. 3.
Remove throttle cable from throttle body cam (Fig. 88) and (Fig. 89). 4. Compress the retaining
tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket (Fig. 89).
Fig. 90 Transmission Kickdown Cable Connector
5. Hold throttle lever in the wide open position.
- Using finger pressure only remove kickdown cable by PUSHING connector off the lever nail head
(Fig. 88) and (Fig. 90). DO NOT try to pull connector off perpendicular to the lever.
6. Compress the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket (Fig. 89).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3220
Fig. 91 Speed Control Cable Connector
7. if equipped with speed control, hold throttle lever in the wide open position. Using finger pressure
only -- remove speed control cable by
PUSHING connector off the lever nail head (Fig. 88) and (Fig. 91). DO NOT try to pull connector off
perpendicular to the lever.
8. Compress the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket (Fig. 89). 9. Remove 2
screws holding cable mounting bracket and support bracket.
10. Remove TPS connection 11. Remove Idle Air Control motor connector. 12. Remove EVAP
purge hose. 13. Remove throttle body mounting bolts. Remove throttle body.
Fig. 92 Re-Usable Throttle Body Gasket
14. The rubber 0-ring gasket on the intake manifold is reusable. Wipe the 0-ring clean before
installing throttle body (Fig. 92).
INSTALLATION
1. Install throttle body on intake manifold. Tighten mounting bolts to 23 Nm (200 in lb). 2. Attach
cable mounting bracket and support bracket with 2 screws. 3. Connect electrical connection to
throttle body. 4. Connect the EVAP purge hose. 5. Install cable housing(s) retainer tabs into
bracket. 6. Install throttle body cables using the following procedures. 7. From the engine
compartment, rotate the throttle lever forward to the wide open position and install throttle cable
clasp (Fig. 89). 8. If equipped with speed control, rotate throttle lever forward to the wide open
position and slide speed control cable connector onto nail head. 9. Rotate throttle lever forward to
the wide open position and slide kickdown cable connector onto nail head.
10. Install throttle cable cover. Tighten bolt to 5.6 Nm (50 in lb).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3221
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
Fig. 86 Throttle Cable Attachment to Throttle Body
Fig. 87 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
REMOVAL
1. Remove throttle cable cover. 2. Remove throttle cable from the throttle body cam (Fig. 86) and
(Fig. 87). 3. Compress the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket (Fig. 87). 4. If
equipped with speed control, remove speed control cable from throttle lever by sliding clasp out
hole used for throttle cable. 5. Remove 2 screws holding cable mounting bracket and support
bracket. 6. Remove TPS connector. 7. Remove Idle Air Control motor connector. 8. Remove the
EVAP purge hose. 9. Remove throttle body mounting bolts. Remove throttle body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3222
Fig. 92 Re-Usable Throttle Body Gasket
10. The rubber 0-ring gasket on the intake manifold is reusable.
- Wipe the 0-ring clean before installing throttle body (Fig. 92).
INSTALLATION
1. Install throttle body on intake manifold. Tighten mounting bolts to 23 Nm (200 in lb). 2. Attach
cable mounting bracket and support bracket with 2 screws. 3. Connect the electrical connection to
the throttle body. 4. Connect the EVAP purge hose to the throttle body 5. Install cable housing(s)
retainer tabs into bracket. 6. If equipped with speed control. rotate the throttle lever forward to the
wide open position and install speed control cable clasp (Fig. 87). 7. Rotate throttle lever to wide
open position and install throttle cable clasp (Fig. 87). 8. Install throttle cable cover. Tighten bolt to
5.6 Nm (50 in lb).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
Fig. 5 Throttle Body Cables Attachment To Throttle Body
Fig. 6 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
REMOVAL
1. Working from the engine compartment, remove throttle cable from throttle body cam (Figs. 5 and
6). 2. Compress the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket (Fig. 6).
Fig. 2 Accelerator Pedal And Throttle Cable -- Rear View
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3227
Fig. 2 Accelerator Pedal And Throttle Cable -- Rear View
3. From inside the vehicle, hold the throttle pedal up and remove the cable retainer and cable from
upper end of pedal shaft (Fig. 1 and Fig. 2). 4. Remove retainer clip from throttle cable and
grommet at the dash panel (Fig. 2). 5. From the engine compartment, pull the throttle cable out of
the dash panel grommet. The grommet should remain in the dash panel.
INSTALLATION
1. From the engine compartment, push the housing end fitting into the dash panel grommet. 2.
Install cable housing (throttle body end) into the cable mounting bracket on the engine. 3. From
inside the vehicle, hold up pedal and feed throttle cable core wire through hole in upper end of the
pedal shaft. Install cable retainer (Fig. 2). 4. Install cable retainer clip (Fig. 2). 5. From the engine
compartment, rotate the throttle lever forward to the wide open position and install cable clasp (Fig.
6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3228
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
Throttle Control Shield
REMOVAL
1. Remove throttle control shield.
Fig. 3 Throttle Cable Attachment To Throttle Body
Fig. 4 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 3229
2. Working from the engine compartment, remove the throttle cable from the throttle body lever. 3.
Compress the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket.
Fig. 1 Accelerator Pedal And Throttle Cable -- Front View
Fig. 2 Accelerator Pedal And Throttle Cable -- Rear View
4. From inside the vehicle, hold the accelerator pedal up and remove the cable retainer and cable
from upper end of pedal shaft. 5. Remove retainer clip from throttle cable and grommet at the dash
panel. 6. From the engine compartment, pull the throttle cable out of the dash panel grommet. The
grommet should remain in the dash panel.
INSTALLATION
1. From the engine compartment, push the housing end fitting into the dash panel grommet. 2.
Install cable housing (throttle body end) into the cable mounting bracket on the engine. 3. From
inside the vehicle, hold up pedal and feed throttle cable core wire through hole in upper end of the
pedal shaft. Install cable retainer. 4. Install cable retainer clip. 5. From the engine compartment,
rotate the throttle lever forward to the wide open position and install cable clasp. 6. Install throttle
control shield. 7. Tighten screw to 5.6 Nm (50 in lb).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
As the throttle plate rotates, the TP sensor provides a variable 0 to 5 volt signal to PCM cavity 10.
Sensor Resistance ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 3.5k to 6.5k ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3234
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Torque = 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3235
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3236
Throttle Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3237
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 16 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor -- Typical
PURPOSE
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) input to
determine current engine operating conditions.
The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on these inputs.
OPERATION
The TPS mounts to the throttle body and connects to the throttle blade shaft.
The TPS is a variable resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade position.
- As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts DC to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to
the powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position.
The TPS output voltage to the PCM varies: At minimum throttle opening (idle) -- from 0.38 to 1.03 volts.
- AT Wide open throttle -- 3.1 to 4.0 volts.
The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 16).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
From the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit K6 supplies 5 Volts to the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS). Circuit K6 connects to cavity 61 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K22 delivers the TPS signal to the PCM. Circuit K22 connects to cavity 35 of the PCM
connector.
The PCM provides ground for the TPS signal (circuit K22) through circuit K4. Circuit K4 connects to
cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K6 splices to supply 5 Volts to the Throttle Position Sensor. Circuit K4 splices to supply
ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3240
Throttle Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
To perform a complete test of the this sensor and its circuitry use a DRB or equivalent scan tool
and follow the appropriate procedures. To test the throttle position sensor only, refer to the
following:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be tested with a digital voltmeter (DVM). The center
terminal of the sensor is the output terminal. One of the other terminals is a 5 volt supply and the
remaining terminal is ground.
Connect the DVM between the center and sensor ground terminal. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for
correct pinout.
With the ignition switch in the ON position, check the output voltage at the center terminal wire of
the connector. Check the output voltage at idle and at Wide-Open-Throttle (WOT). At idle, TPS output voltage should be approximately O.38 volts- to 1.2 volts.
- At wide open throttle, TPS output voltage should be approximately 3.1 volts to 4.4 volts.
- The output voltage should gradually increase as the throttle plate moves slowly from idle to WOT.
NOTE: Check for spread terminals at the sensor and PCM connections before replacing the TPS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3241
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
The TPS was not designed to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3242
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 22 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle Air Control Motor
NOTE: The throttle position sensor attaches to the side of the throttle body (Fig. 22).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect EVAP purge hose from throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from idle air
control motor and throttle position sensor. 3. Remove throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Remove
throttle position sensor mounting screws. 5. Remove throttle position sensor.
Fig. 23 Throttle Position Sensor Installation
INSTALLATION
1. The throttle shaft end of the throttle body slides into a socket in the TPS (Fig. 23). The socket
has two tabs inside it. The throttle shaft rests against
the tabs. When indexed correctly, the TPS can rotate clockwise a few degrees to line up the mounting screw
holes with the screw holes in the throttle body The TPS has slight tension when rotated into
position.
- If it is difficult to rotate the TPS into position, install the sensor with the throttle shaft on the other
side of the tabs in the socket.
2. Tighten mounting screws to 2 Nm (20 in lb) torque.
- After installing the TPS, the throttle plate should be closed.
- If the throttle plate is open, install the sensor on the other side of the tabs in the socket.
3. Install throttle body Refer to procedure. 4. Attach electrical connectors to idle air control motor
and throttle position sensor. 5. Install EVAP purge hose to throttle body nipple.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage Diagnosis > Page 3255
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3258
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3259
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3260
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3261
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3262
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 3265
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 3266
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 3269
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 3270
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3277
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3278
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3279
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3280
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3281
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test > Page 3284
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement > Page 3287
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3291
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Plastic clips in various locations protect the cables from damage. When the cables are replaced the
clips must be used to prevent damage to the cables. The #1 cable must be routed under the PCV
hose and clipped to the #2 cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Ignition Cable: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: Resistance cables are identified by the words Electronic Suppression.
Spark plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer electrical current from the coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder.
- The resistor type, nonmetallic spark plug cables provide suppression of radio frequency
emissions from the ignition system.
CHECKING
Check for brittle or cracked insulation.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil and spark plugs. Terminals should be fully seated.
- The nipples and spark plug covers should be in good condition.
- Nipples should fit tightly on the coil.
- Spark plug boot should completely cover the spark plug hole in the cylinder head cover.
Install the boot until the terminal snaps over the spark plug. A snap must be felt to ensure the spark plug cable terminal engaged the spark plug.
- Loose cable connections will corrode, increase resistance and permit water to enter the towers.
- These conditions can cause ignition malfunction.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3294
Ignition Cable: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Testing For Open Circuits, High Resistance and Loose Terminals
Use an ohmmeter to check cables for opens, loose terminals or high resistance as follows:
1. Remove cable from spark plug. 2. Remove cable from the coil tower. 3. Connect the ohmmeter
between the spark plug end terminal and the coil end terminal.
- Make sure ohmmeter probes are in good contact.
- Resistance should be within tolerance shown in the cable resistance chart.
- If resistance is not within tolerance, replace cable assembly. Test all spark plug cables in the
same manner.
- If no problems are found, SEE Ignition System/System Diagnosis/Testing For Spark At Coil.
SECONDARY IGNITION CABLE RESISTANCE
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
Testing For Punctures and Cracks
When testing cables for punctures and cracks with an oscilloscope and an inductive voltage probe,
follow the instructions of the equipment manufacturers.
CAUTION: Do not leave any one spark plug cable disconnected for more than 30 seconds during
test or possible heat damage to catalytic converter will occur.
If an oscilloscope and inductive probe are not available, cables can be tested as follows:
1. With the engine not running, connect one end of a test probe (i.e. a piece of wire with insulated
alligator clips on each end) to a good ground, other
end free for probing.
WARNING: The ignition system generates approximately 40,000 volts. Personal injury could result
from contact with this system.
2. With the engine running, move test probe along entire length of all cables (approximately 0 to 1/8
inch gap).
- If punctures or cracks are present there will be a noticeable spark jump from the faulty area to the
probe.
- Replace cracked, leaking or faulty cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Cleaning
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Cleaning
Clean high tension cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Cleaning > Page 3297
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair Replacement
Fig. 3 Spark Plug Cables
NOTE: The cables insulate the spark plugs and cover the top of the spark plug tube (Fig. 3).
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
REMOVAL
1. Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Lightly grasp the top of the cable. 2. Rotate the insulator
1/2 turn and pull straight up in a steady motion. 3. To replace the cables, disconnect the cable from
the ignition coil.
INSTALLATION
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube.Then connect the other end to coil pack.
Be sure that the plastic clip on PCV hose is positioned so that cable clip is beneath hose, and that
#1 cable is snapped into this clip to protect it from metal PCV clamp.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Ignition Coil: Electrical Specifications
Coil Resistance
Primary @ 21-27°C (70-80°F)
........................................................................................................................................................
0.45 to 0.65 ohms Secondary @ 21-27°C (70-80°F)
.............................................................................................................................................. 7,000 to
15,800 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3302
Ignition Coil: Mechanical Specifications
Ignition Coil Mounting Bolts .................................................................................................................
..................................................... 11 Nm (95 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3303
Fig.30 Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Coil: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3306
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3307
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3308
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3309
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3310
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3311
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3312
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3313
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3314
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3315
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3316
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3317
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3318
Ignition Coil: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3319
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3320
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3321
Ignition Coil Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3322
Cable Routing and Firing Order
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3323
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
Fig.4 Ignition Coil Pack
WARNING: The direct ignition system generates approximately 40,000 volts. Personal injury could
result from contact with this system.
OPERATION
The coil pack consists of 2 coils molded together The coil pack is mounted on the valve cover (Fig.
4). High tension leads route to each cylinder from the coil. The coil fires two spark plugs every
power stroke. One plug is the cylinder under compression, the other cylinder fires on the exhaust
stroke. Coil number one fires cylinder 1 and 4. Coil number two fires cylinders 2 and 3. The PCM
determines which of the coils to charge and fire at the correct time.
Fig.5 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay provides battery voltage to the ignition coil. The PCM provides a
ground contact (circuit) for energizing the coil. When the PCM breaks the contact, the energy in the
coil primary transfers to the secondary causing the spark. The PCM will de-energize the ASD relay
if it does not receive the crankshaft position sensor and camshaft position sensor inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3324
Coil Polarity
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit A14 is a bus bar in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and connects to battery voltage.
The contact side of the Automatic Shut Down ( ASD) relay connects circuit A14 and circuit A142. A
20 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuits A14 and A142.
Circuit A14 also supplies voltage to the coil side of the ASD relay The Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) controls the ground path circuit for the coil side of the ASD relay on circuit K51. Circuit K51
connects to cavity 67 of the PCM connector.
Circuit A142 supplies voltage for the ignition coil pack. The coil pack consists of two individual coils
molded together. The PCM controls the ground circuit of each coil. Circuit K19 is the ground circuit for the ignition coil that fires spark plugs # 1 and # 4. Circuit K19
connects to cavity 2 of the PCM.
- Circuit K17 is the ground circuit for the ignition coil that fires spark plugs #2 and # 3. Circuit K17
connects to cavity 3 of the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Helpful Information
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit A142 splices to supply voltage to the fuel injectors, ignition coil, ASD relay, generator,
upstream heated oxygen sensor and downstream heated oxygen sensor. The PCM controls the
ground circuit for each of the components powered by circuit A142.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3327
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection Ignition Coil Test
Fig.18 Terminal Identification
NOTE: Coil one fires cylinders 1 and 4, coil two fires cylinders 2 and 3. Each coil tower is labeled
with the number of the corresponding cylinder.
1. Remove the ignition cables and measure the resistance of the cables. Resistance must be
between ranges shown. Replace any cable not within
tolerance.
Secondary Ignition Cable Resistance
Minimum Maximum
Cables #1 & #4 3,050 Ohms 4,250 Ohms
Cables #2 & #3 2,300 Ohms 3,300 Ohms
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from the coil pack.
3. Measure the primary resistance of each coil. At the coil, connect an ohmmeter between the B+
pin and the pin corresponding to the cylinders in
question (Fig. 18). Resistance on the primary side of each coil should be 0.45 - 0.65 ohm. Replace
the coil if resistance is not within tolerance.
4. Remove ignition cables from the secondary towers of the coil. Measure the secondary resistance
of the coil between the towers of each individual
coil (Fig. 19). Secondary resistance should be 11,000 to 14,000 ohms. Replace the coil if
resistance is not within tolerance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 3328
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
Fig.30 Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
NOTE: The electronic ignition coil pack attaches to a bracket mounted on top of the cylinder head
cover (Fig. 30).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from coil pack. 2. Remove coil pack mounting nuts. 3. Remove
coil. 4. Install coil pack on valve cover. 5. Transfer spark plug cables to new coil pack.
- The coil pack towers are numbered with the cylinder identification.
NOTE: Be sure the ignition cables snap onto the towers.
Ignition Coil Mounting Bolts .................................................................................................................
.................................................... 11 Nm (95 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3332
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3333
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3334
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3337
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 3338
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis
NO: 09-07-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Dec. 11, 1998
SUBJECT: Oil Seepage At Cam Position Sensor/Misinterpreted Head Gasket Leak
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 09-02-94, DATED MAR. 18,
1994, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1994
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-95054). THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
MODELS:
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible (Export Market) 1995
- 1999 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (GS) Caravan/Voyager (Export Market) 1996 - 1999 (NS) Town &
Country/Caravan/Voyager
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO MODELS WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC OR A 2.4L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Whenever performing oil leak diagnosis on one of these models carefully inspect the cam sensor
area to determine if the leak originates from the seal or from other sources. A leak in this area can
be mis-interpreted as a leaking head gasket. Additionally, whenever a head gasket is replaced, the
cam seal should always be replaced to prevent the possibility of the vehicle returning with oil
seepage.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam Position Sensor - Oil Seepage
Diagnosis > Page 3344
Camshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by a rotating target magnet attached to the rear of the camshaft. When the north pole of the magnet passes under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When the the south pole passes under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3347
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor Torque = 9 Nm (80 in lb) Camshaft Position Sensor Target Magnet
Torque = 3 Nm (30 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3348
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3349
Camshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3350
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Camshaft Position Sensor
PURPOSE
The PCM determines fuel injection synchronization and cylinder identification from inputs provided
by the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor. From the two inputs, the PCM
determines crankshaft position.
Fig. 6 Target Magnet
Fig. 7 Target Magnet Polarity
OPERATION
The camshaft position sensor attaches to the rear of the cylinder head. A target magnet attaches to
the rear of the camshaft and indexes to the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3351
correct position. The target magnet has four different poles arranged in an asymmetrical pattern
(Fig. 6). As the target magnet rotates, the camshaft position sensor senses the change in polarity
(Fig. 7).
The sensor output switch switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.30 volts) as the target magnet
rotates. When the north pole of the target magnet passes under the sensor, the output switches high.
- The sensor output switches low when the south pole of the target magnet passes underneath.
Fig. 24 Square Wave Pattern In Crankshaft Degrees
Square Wave Output The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or
crankshaft position sensor switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (less than 0.5 volts). By connecting
an oscilloscope to the sensor output circuit, technicians can view the square wave pattern
produced by the voltage swing (Fig. 24).
If the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor don't produce a square wave
pattern, check the 8-volt supply circuit that feeds both sensors.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the camshaft position
sensor The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K44 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K44 circuit connects to cavity
33 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the camshaft position sensor signal (circuit K44) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The output voltage of a properly operating camshaft position sensor or crankshaft position sensor
switches from high (5.0 volts) to low (0.3 volts). By connecting an oscilloscope and engine analyzer
to the vehicle, technicians can view the square wave pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 3354
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Component Testing > Page 3355
Camshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft Sensor Replacement
Camshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 9 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
NOTE: The camshaft position sensor is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head.
REMOVAL
1. Remove filtered air tube from the throttle body and air cleaner housing. 2. Disconnect electrical
connector from camshaft position sensor. 3. Remove camshaft position sensor mounting screws.
Remove sensor.
Fig.35 Target Magnet Removal/Installation
4. Loosen screw attaching target magnet to rear of camshaft (Fig. 35).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 3358
Fig.36 Target Magnet Installation
NOTE: The target magnet has locating dowels that fit into machined locating holes in the end of the
camshaft (Fig. 36).
INSTALLATION
1. Install target magnet in end of camshaft. Tighten mounting screw to 3 Nm (30 in lb) torque. 2.
Install camshaft position sensor. Tighten sensor mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in lb) torque. 3.
Carefully attach electrical connector to camshaft position sensor. Installation at an angle may
damage the sensor pins. 4. Install filtered air tube. Tighten clamps to 3 Nm ±1 (25 in lb ±5) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sensor Replacement > Page 3359
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start
Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Cam/Crank Sensor - No Start Diagnostics
NO: 18-24-97
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Aug. 8, 1997
SUBJECT:
No Start Diagnostics Cam/Crank Sensor
$01 and $28
MODELS:
1997 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L DOHC/SOHC (NATURALLY
ASPIRATED), 2.4L, 3.3L, 3.5L, OR 3.8L ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
If a vehicle exhibits a no-start due to failure of the cam or crank sensor, the opposite sensor may
be reported as the DTC (i.e. bad cam sensor sets crank sensor DTC and vice versa). The faulty
sensor may generate a signal strong enough (at key "ON") to be interpreted by the controller as a
legitimate signal. Since the engine is not running, the opposite sensor will not be generating any
pulses. The controller, expecting corresponding pulses from both sensors, matures a fault for the
sensor that is not generating any pulses. In this case, the good sensor is reported as faulty.
To verify which sensor is at fault, use the DRB III and select DRB III Standalone, 1994 - 1998
Diagnostics, select Engine system, select Monitor Display, and No Start monitor. Under the No
Start monitor the cam and crank sensors should display a no response or LOST on the display. If a
sensor is reporting a signal at key ON", it should be replaced.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
The sensor signal is created by the notches in the crankshaft pulse ring passing under the sensor. When a notch is under the sensor, the signal remains at 5 volts.
- When there isn't a notch under the sensor, the signal drops to 0.3 volt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3366
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts ........................................................................................................
.......................................................... 9 Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3367
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3368
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3369
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
Fig. 14 Timing Reference Notches
Fig.6 Timing Reference Notches
PURPOSE
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input.
From the crankshaft position sensor input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle
(position).
OPERATION
The second crankshaft counterweight has machined into it two sets of four timing reference
notches including a 60° signature notch (Fig. 14).
The notches generate pulses from high to low in the crankshaft position sensor output voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3370
- When a metal portion of the counterweight aligns with the crankshaft position sensor, the sensor
output voltage goes low (less than 0.5 volts).
- When a notch aligns with the sensor, voltage goes high (5.0 volts).
- As a group of notches pass under the sensor, the output voltage switches from low (metal) to high
(notch) then back to low.
By counting the pulses and referencing the pulse from the 60° signature notch, the PCM calculates
crankshaft angle (position). In each group of timing reference notches: The first notch represents 69° before top dead center (BTDC).
- The second notch represents 49° BTDC.
- The third notch represents 29°.
- The last notch in each set represents 9° before top dead center BTDC.
The timing reference notches are machined at 20° increments. From the voltage pulse-width the
PCM tells the difference between the timing reference notches and the 60° signature notch. The 60° signature notch produces a longer pulse-width than the smaller timing reference notches.
- If the camshaft position sensor input switches from high to low when the 60° signature notch
passes under the crankshaft position sensor, the PCM knows cylinder number one is the next
cylinder at TDC.
Oscilloscope Display of Waveform If available, an oscilloscope can display the square wave
patterns of each voltage pulse. From the frequency of the output voltage pulses, the PCM
calculates engine speed. The width of the pulses represent the amount of time the output voltage stays high before switching
back to low.
- The period of time the sensor output voltage stays high before switching back to low is referred to
as pulse-width.
- The faster the engine is operating, the smaller the pulse-width on the oscilloscope.
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter (Fig. 15).
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit K7 supplies 8 Volts from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to the crankshaft position
sensor. The K7 circuit connects to cavity 44 of the PCM connector.
Circuit K24 from the sensor provides an input signal to the PCM. The K24 circuit connects to cavity
32 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the crankshaft position sensor signal (circuit K24) through circuit K4.
Circuit K4 connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Failure to Start Test
Fig.20 Ignition Coil Engine Harness Connector
This no-start test checks the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor.
Use the DRB or scan tool to test the camshaft position sensor and the sensor circuits. Refer to
Diagrams/Electrical for circuit information.
The PCM supplies 8 volts to the camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor through
one circuit. If the 8-volt supply circuit shorts to ground, neither sensor will produce a signal (output
voltage to the PCM).
When the ignition key is turned and left in the On position, the PCM automatically energizes the
auto shutdown (ASD) relay. However, the PCM de-energizes the relay within one second because
it has not received a crankshaft position sensor signal indicating engine rotation.
During cranking, the ASD relay will not energize until the PCM receives a camshaft position sensor
signal. Secondly, the ASD relay remains energized only if the PCM senses a crankshaft position
sensor signal immediately after detecting the camshaft position sensor signal.
1. Check battery voltage. Voltage should be approximately 12.66 volts or higher to perform failure
to start test.
2. Disconnect the harness connector from the coil pack (Fig. 20).
3. Connect a test light to the B+ (battery voltage) terminal of the coil electrical connector and
ground. The B+ wire for the DIS coil is the center
terminal. Do not spread the terminal with the test light probe.
4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.- The test light should flash ON and then OFF. Do not
turn the Key to OFF position, leave it in the ON
position.
a. If the test light flashes momentarily, the PCM grounded the ASD relay. Proceed to step 5.
b. If the test light did not flash, the ASD relay did not energize. The cause is either the relay or one
of the relay circuits. Use the DRB or scan tool
to test the ASD relay and circuits. Check for codes and follow procedures. SEE Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/ Diagnostic Charts. Refer to Diagrams/Electrical for circuit
information.
5. Crank the engine. (If the key was placed in the OFF position after step 4, place the key in the ON
position before cranking. Wait for the test light
to flash once, then crank the engine.)
6. If the test light momentarily flashes during cranking, the PCM is not receiving a crankshaft
position sensor signal.
7. If the test light did not flash during cranking, unplug the crankshaft position sensor connector.
Turn the ignition key to the off position. Turn the
key to the ON position, wait for the test light to momentarily flash once, then crank the engine. If the
test light momentarily flashes, the crankshaft position sensor is shorted and must be replaced. If
the light did not flash, the cause of the no-start is in either the crankshaft position sensor/ camshaft
position sensor 8 volt supply circuit, or the camshaft position sensor output or ground circuits.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Failure to Start Test > Page 3373
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K7 splices to supply 8 Volts to the camshaft position sensor and vehicle speed sensor.
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Knock sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement
Fig 7 Crankshaft Position Sensor
NOTE: The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above
the oil filter.
1. Disconnect electrical connector from crankshaft position sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting
screw. Remove sensor. 3. Reverse procedure for installation.
Crankshaft Position Sensor Bolts torque
....................................................................................................................................................... 9
Nm (80 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Position Sensor Replacement >
Page 3376
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Camshaft/Crankshaft Timing Relearn
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-01-98.
Camshaft and Crankshaft Timing Relearn
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
the instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "miscellaneous" screen (or appropriate screen on
generic scan tool). 3. Select "re-learn cam/crank" option and follow directions on DRB screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3381
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor Torque = 10 Nm (7 ft lb or 90 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3385
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3386
Knock Sensor Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3387
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 11 Knock Sensor
PURPOSE
When the knock sensor detects a knock in one of the cylinders, it sends an input signal to the
PCM. In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled amount.
OPERATION
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which sends an input voltage (signal) to the PCM.
As the intensity of the engine knock vibration increases, the knock sensor output voltage also
increases.
The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 11).
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The knock sensor provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on circuit K42. Circuit
K42 connects to cavity 24 of the PCM connector.
The PCM provides ground for the knock sensor signal (circuit K42) through circuit K4. Circuit K4
connects to cavity 43 of the PCM connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
Circuit K4 splices to supply ground for the signals from the following:
- Upstream heated oxygen sensor
- Downstream heated oxygen sensor
- Battery temperature sensor
- Camshaft position sensor
- Crankshaft position sensor
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Throttle position sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 3390
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection Component Testing
The knock sensor can be tested with a digital voltmeter. Sensor output should be between 80 mV
and 4 volts with the engine running between 576 and 2,208 rpm. If the output falls outside of this
range a DTC will be set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3391
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Knock Sensor
NOTE: The knock sensor threads into the side of the cylinder block in front of the starter (Fig. 16).
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from knock sensor. 2. Use a crow foot socket to remove the
knock sensors.
INSTALLATION
1. Install knock sensor. Tighten knock sensor to 10 Nm (7 ft lb) torque.
CAUTION: Over or under tightening effects knock sensor performance, possibly causing improper
spark control.
2. Attach electrical connector to knock sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Electrode Gap ......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... (0.033-0.038 in) Torque ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm
(20 ft lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3395
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Plug Type ............................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... RC9YC Thread Size ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
(14mm) 3/4 in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3396
Spark Plug: Description and Operation
Resistor spark plugs are used in this engine.
Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes and fouled, cracked or broken
porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from the
engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended.
Faulty or fouled spark plugs may perform well at idle speed, but frequently fail at higher engine
speeds. Faulty plugs can be identified in a number of ways: poor fuel economy, power loss,
decrease in engine speed, hard starting and, in general, poor engine performance.
Spark plugs also malfunction because of carbon fouling, excessive electrode air gap, or a broken
insulator. SEE Powertrain Management/Ignition System/Testing and Inspection/Procedures, for
spark plug diagnosis.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3399
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3400
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3401
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3402
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator
ELECTRODE INSULATOR
Chipped Electrode Insulator
Electrode Insulator
A chipped electrode insulator usually results from bending the center electrode while adjusting the
spark plug electrode gap. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can separate the
insulator from the center electrode. A sudden rise in tip temperature or severe operating conditions
are also possible causes. Spark plugs with chipped electrode insulators must be replaced.
Brown to Gray/Tan Color - Normal Operating Condition
DESCRIPTION:
Brown to greyish-tan deposits and slight electrode wear.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Normal wear - Clean, regap, and install, if wear is not excessive
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Dry, Fluffy Black Deposits - Cold or Carbon Fouling
COLD FOULING (CARBON FOULING)
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
Cold fouling is sometimes referred to as carbon fouling because the deposits that cause cold
fouling are basically carbon. A dry, black deposit on one or two plugs in a set may be caused by
sticking valves or misfire conditions. Cold (carbon) fouling of the entire set may be caused by a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3403
clogged air cleaner or poor ignition output.
Cold fouling is normal after short operating periods. The spark plugs do not reach a high enough
operating temperature during short operating periods. Replace carbon fouled plugs with new spark
plugs.
Electrode Gap Bridging
ELECTRODE GAP BRIDGING
Electrode Gap Bridging
Loose deposits in the combustion chamber can cause electrode gap bridging. The deposits
accumulate on the spark plugs during continuous stop-and-go driving. When the engine is
suddenly subjected to a high torque load, the deposits partially liquefy and bridge the gap between
the electrodes. This short circuits the electrodes. Spark plugs with electrode gap bridging can be
cleaned and reused.
Heavy Colored Deposits
DESCRIPTION:
Colored coatings heavily deposited on the portion of the plug projecting into the chamber and on
the side facing the intake valve.
POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................................................
Leaking Valve Seals (1 or 2 cylinders) - Check the valve seals. Replace if necessary. Clean, regap,
and reinstall
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................
Normal Operating Conditions
NORMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Normal Operation And Cold(Carbon) Fouling
The few deposits present will be probably light tan or slightly gray in color with most grades of
commercial gasoline. There will not be evidence of electrode burning. Gap growth will not average
more than approximately 0.025 mm (0.001 in) per 1600 km (1000 miles) of operation for non
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3404
platinum spark plugs. Non-platinum spark plugs that have normal wear can usually be cleaned,
have the electrodes filed and regapped, and then reinstalled.
CAUTION: Never attempt to file the electrodes or use a wire brush for cleaning platinum spark
plugs. This would damage the platinum pads which would shorten spark plug life.
Some fuel refiners in several areas of the United States have introduced a manganese additive
(MMT) for unleaded fuel. During combustion, fuel with MMT may coat the entire tip of the spark
plug with a rust colored deposit. The rust color deposits can be misdiagnosed as being caused by
coolant in the combustion chamber. Spark plug performance may be affected by MMT deposits.
Oil or Ash Encrusted
OIL OR ASH ENCRUSTED
Oil Or Ash Encrusted
If one or more plugs are oil or ash encrusted, evaluate the engine for the cause of oil entering the
combustion chambers. Sometimes fuel additives can cause ash encrustation on an entire set of
spark plugs. Ash encrusted spark plugs can be cleaned and reused.
Premature Electrode Wear - Preignition Damage
PREIGNITION DAMAGE
Preignition Damage
Excessive combustion chamber temperature can cause preignition damage. First, the center
electrode dissolves and the ground electrode dissolves somewhat later. Insulators appear relatively
deposit free. Other possible causes include ignition timing over-advanced and incorrect spark plug
heat range.
Spark plugs are designed to operate within a specific temperature range, called spark plug heat
range. Variations in thickness and length of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3405
center electrode and porcelain insulator change how fast the plug can dissipate heat and determine
the plugs heat range.
Determine if the spark plugs are the correct type, as specified on the VECI label, or if other
operating conditions are causing engine overheating.
Red, Brown, Yellow or White Deposits - Fuel Additives
SCAVENGER DEPOSITS
Scavenger Deposits
Fuel scavenger deposits may be either white or yellow. They may appear to be harmful, but are a
normal condition caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. These additives are designed to
change the chemical nature of deposits and decrease spark plug misfire tendencies. Notice that
accumulation on the ground electrode and shell area may be heavy but the deposits are easily
removed using standard procedures. Spark plugs with scavenger deposits can be considered
normal in condition, cleaned and reused.
Shiny Yellow Glaze
COMBUSTION DEPOSITS
A shiny yellow glaze coating on the spark plug insulator is evidence of metallic by-products of fuel
combustion, caused by chemical additives in certain fuels. Avoid sudden acceleration with wide
open throttle after long periods of low speed driving. Spark plugs with combustion deposits can be
cleaned and reused.
Spark Plug Inspection
- Remove the spark plugs and examine them for burned electrodes. Also check for fouled, cracked
or broken porcelain insulators. Keep plugs arranged in the order in which they were removed from
the engine. An isolated plug displaying an abnormal condition indicates that a problem exists in the
corresponding cylinder. Replace spark plugs at the intervals recommended in the Maintenance
Schedules.
- Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned and reused if not otherwise defective -- SEE
Spark Plug Condition. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file. Adjust the gap between the electrodes to the specified dimension. The spark plug gap is 0.033
to0.038 in.
- Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion resulting
in a change in the spark plug gap. Tighten spark plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque.
Wet Oily Deposits
FUEL FOULING
A spark plug that is coated with excessive wet fuel is called fuel fouled. This condition is normally
observed during hard start periods. Clean fuel fouled spark plugs with compressed air and reinstall
them in the engine.
White or Gray - Burned or Blistered Insulator
SPARK PLUG OVERHEATING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Broken, Cracked or Chipped Insulator > Page 3406
Spark Plug Overheating
Overheating is indicated by a white or gray center electrode insulator that also appears blistered.
The increase in electrode gap will be considerably in excess of 0.001 in. per 1000 miles of
operation. This suggests that a plug with a cooler heat range rating should be used. Over
advanced ignition timing, detonation and cooling system malfunctions also can cause spark plug
overheating. Also check for lean air-fuel mixture. Check the torque value of the plugs to ensure
good plug-engine seat contact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 3407
Spark Plug: Adjustments
Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Fig.2 Setting Spark Plug Electrode Gap
Check the spark plug gap with a gap gauge. If the gap is not correct, adjust it by bending the
ground -- center electrode.
Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information (VECI) label, (under hood).
If label is gone, or not readable, verify system and use the following specification.
Plug Gap ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.033 to 0.038 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 3408
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise,
cross ignition of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
CAUTION: Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of the spark plug insulator,
turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL
1. Remove the spark plug using a quality socket with a rubber or foam insert. 2. Inspect the spark
plug condition.
SPARK PLUG CLEANING
Spark plugs that have low mileage may be cleaned using commercially available spark plug
cleaning equipment. After cleaning, file the center electrode flat with a small point file or jewelers
file before adjusting gap.
CAUTION: Never use a motorized wire wheel brush to clean the spark plugs. Metallic deposits will
remain on the spark plug insulator and will cause plug misfire.
CAUTION: Always tighten spark plugs to the specified torque. Over tightening can cause distortion
and change the spark plug gap.
SPARK PLUG INSTALLATION
1. To avoid cross threading, start the spark plug into the cylinder head by hand. 2. Tighten spark
plugs to 28 Nm (20 ft lb) torque. 3. Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of
the spark plug insulator covers the upper end of the spark plug tube. 4. Connect coil.
SPARK PLUG TUBES
The spark plugs tubes are pressed into the cylinder head. Sealant is applied to the end of the tube
before installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
The Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid is located on the Valve Body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3417
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3418
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3419
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3420
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3421
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3422
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3423
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3424
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3425
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3426
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3427
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3428
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3429
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3430
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3431
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3432
Connector Pin-Outs (Part 31 Of 32)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3433
Fuel And Ignition Diagrams (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3434
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
If the solenoid wiring connector is unplugged, the torque converter will not engage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The PRNDL lamp receives power on the E2 circuit from the 4 Amp fuse located in the fuse block in
cavity 12. The fuse receives power from the headlamp switch. Circuit E2 also powers the ash
receiver lamp.
When the headlamp switch is moved to the PARK or ON position, current flows through the fuse to
the PRNDL lamp. The ground for the lamp is supplied on the Z3 circuit, and terminates at the
instrument panel left center support. This circuit is also spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, the
ignition switch lamp, and the glove box lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3453
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3454
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB
Readiness Monitor Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 25-02-98 Date: 981023
I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information
NO: 25-02-98
GROUP: Emissions
DATE: Oct. 23, 1998
SUBJECT:
I/M (Inspection Maintenance) Testing - OBD II "CARB" Readiness Monitor Information
MODELS:
1996 - 1999 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1996 - 1999 (AN) Dakota
1996 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1998 - 1999 (DN) Durango
1996 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1996 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 1999 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1999 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper Roadster/Coupe
1997 - 1999 (TJ) Wrangler
1999 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1996 - 1999 (XJ) Cherokee
1996 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO NATURALLY ASPIRATED (NON-TURBO) GASOLINE
ENGINES.
DISCUSSION:
Some states that require I/M inspections are beginning to include OBD II "CARB" Readiness as a
prerequisite to an I/M test. OBD Readiness tells an I/M station if the OBD II systems have run their
self test. Owners, in those states that use OBD Readiness, may be denied an I/M test if one or
more of the Readiness monitors read "NO" or in other words the OBD II monitors have not run their
tests.
It is important to understand that the MIL will not be illuminated because OBD Readiness reads
"NO". MIL illumination happens when an actual malfunction or failure of a monitored emissions
system occurs. It is possible to have MIL illumination for a detected failure while at the same time
having a "NO" for an OBO Readiness monitor.
NOTE:
MIL ILLUMINATION INDICATES ADDITIONAL PROBLEMS WITH THE VEHICLE. FURTHER
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WILL BE REQUIRED BEFORE PROCEEDING FURTHER WITH THIS
BULLETIN.
OBD Readiness that reads "NO" can be caused by the following: PCM reprogramming, PCM
replacement, fault code erasure, battery disconnects and/or replacement. If any of the above items
occur before an I/M test, a good chance exists that one or more of the monitors will read "NO" for
OBD Readiness.
Some customers may be directed back to their dealers for assistance when an I/M test station has
not allowed an I/M test due to Readiness status. The following procedures will help technicians
efficiently run the Readiness tests so an owner can have their I/M test completed.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7000/7001 J1962Cable
1 CH7OlO J1962 MMC Cable
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB
Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3463
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 25-01-01-91 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves operating the vehicle under specific parameters to run or complete the OBD
monitors. The number of monitors applicable to a vehicle will vary by type of vehicle and emissions
application. In addition, the parameters to run each monitor will vary.
Preliminary Checks
1. Perform a MIL bulb check by switching the ignition key "ON" (engine off). The MIL will illuminate
as a bulb check. If the MIL does not illuminate, repair the bulb or bulb circuit.
2. Connect a DRB III(R) to the vehicle. Select DRB III(R) standalone, current model year
diagnostics, engine, DTC's and related functions, read DTC's.
3. Verity that no emission related DTC's are present and that the MIL is not illuminated with the
engine running.
NOTE:
EMISSION RELATED DTC'S AND MIL ILLUMINATION MAY PREVENT OTHER OBD MONITORS
FROM RUNNING. DTC'S THAT ILLUMINATE THE MIL MUST BE REPAIRED BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO RUN THE MONITORS.
OBD "CARB" Readiness Check
1. With the DRB III(R) select engine, OBD II monitors, CARB Readiness Status.
2. Read the monitor status. "YES" tells you that monitor has run and is ready for an I/M test, "NO"
tells you that the monitor must be run. If all monitors listed read "YES", the vehicle can be returned
to the customer for completion of their I/M test. Only monitors that read "NO" must be run to read
"YES".
NOTE:
THE MONITORS LISTED IN THE OBD "CARB" READINESS SCREEN ARE THE ONLY ONES
APPLICABLE FOR THE VEHICLE BEING WORKED ON.
The vehicle must be operated in various conditions (speed, temperature, etc.) for the monitors to
run. Each monitor includes a pre-test and monitor test that can be viewed on the DRB III(R). The
pre-test/monitor test screen lists all the preliminary parameters that must be met along with the
running parameters for that specific monitor to run. An example of one screen is shown in Figure 1.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB
Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3464
NOTE:
1997 AND PREVIOUS MODEL VEHICLES WILL HAVE A DIFFERENT LOOKING SCREEN.
PRESS THE F1 KEY TO OBTAIN MONITOR RUN CONDITIONS. THE WAY IN WHICH THE
MONITORS RUN WILL BE SIMILAR.
The following explains how to interpret each section of the screen:
PRE-TEST REQUIREMENTS
The pre-test requirements include all the operating parameters that must be met before the actual
test can run. The vehicle must be operated until each item within the pre-test section are fulfilled.
LOW VALUE/HIGH VALUE/BAR GRAPH
The low value/high value provides the minimum and maximum operating conditions for each item
(ie ECT Range must be between 170° and 260° F in Figure 1). The bar graph will begin to fill when
the lowest value required for each item is met. This provides a visual indication that the parameters
are being met. The vehicle should be driven until most of each pre-test bar graph is filled.
MONITOR REQUIREMENTS
Once all pre-test requirements are met, the vehicle must be brought within the parameters listed in
the monitor requirements section for the monitors to begin running. As the monitor begins to run,
the DRB III(R) will begin to beep. This is an audible indication that the test is in progress. If vehicle
operation falls outside any of the parameters, the beeping will stop. If this occurs, the technician
must determine if the pre-test requirements or the monitor requirements have fallen outside the
window for the test and the vehicle must be driven accordingly for the test to restart. When the
monitor completes its test, the DRB III(R) will beep 3 consecutive times.
NOTE:
THE PURGE FLOW PRE-TEST SCREEN WILL LOOK DIFFERENT THAN THE REST OF THE
PRE-TEST/MONITOR SCREENS. PRESS THE F1 KEY ON THE DRB III(R) TO SEE A SIMILAR
SCREEN FOR THIS MONITOR.
MONITOR RUN PROCESS
The following will provide the most efficient order along with tips to help run through the monitor
tests quickly. The monitors listed include all possible monitors for either Front Wheel Drive or Rear
Wheel Drive vehicles. The vehicle being worked on may have fewer monitors than the maximum
available. Only those listed on the DRB III(R) are applicable for the vehicle being worked on. The
only monitors that will require attention are those that read "NO" under the OBD "CARB"
Readiness Status screen.
Front Wheel Drive
1. Evaporative Leak Detection Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight
soak either indoors or out depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must be
between 4° and 32° C (40° and 90° F) with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10 ° F) of
ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test screen
on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining requirements.
2. Catalyst Monitor - The vehicle must be driven at highway speeds for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transaxle, use fourth gear to help meet the
requirements.
3. EGR Monitor - It is necessary to maintain TPS, MAP, and RPM ranges listed in the pre-test
screen for this test to complete.
4. O2 Sensor Monitor - The vehicle must be driven and brought to a stop for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. Automatic transaxle vehicles must be left in drive during the stop period.
5. Purge Monitor - To see a similar screen format as listed in Figure 1, press the F1 key on the
DRB III(R) while in the Purge Flow Pre-Test screen. The purge free (PF) cells must update and the
monitor will attempt to run on every other throttle closure. Automatic transaxle vehicles must be left
in drive for the test to run. If all parameters are met and the test still will not run, place your foot on
the brake, open the throttle to 1/4 and then quickly close the throttle. This should allow the PF cells
to update.
6. O2 Sensor Heater Monitor - The open throttle time for the O2 Heater pre-test must be exceeded.
This monitor will run after the ignition key is switched "Off". After the DRB III(R) switches to No
Response (approximately 3 minutes) turn the ignition key "On" and check the O2 Sensor Heater
monitor status. It should have switched to "YES". All other monitors should be completed before
running this test.
Rear Wheel Drive
1. O2 Sensor Heater Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight soak either
indoors or outdoors depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must be between
18° and 38° C (0° and 100° F with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10° F) of
ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test screen
on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB
Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3465
requirements.
2. Evaporative Leak Detection Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight
soak either indoors or outdoors depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must
be between 4° and 32° C (40° and 90° F) with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10 ° F)
of ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test
screen on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining requirements.
3. Catalyst Monitor - The vehicle must be driven at highway speeds for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, use 4th gear to help meet
the requirements.
4. O2 Sensor Monitor - The vehicle must be driven and brought to a stop for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. Automatic transmission vehicles must be left in drive during the stop period.
5. Purge Monitor - To see a similar screen format as listed in Figure 1, press the F1 key on the
DRB III(R) while in the Purge Flow Pre-Test screen. The purge free (PF) cells must update and the
monitor will attempt to run on every other throttle closure. Automatic transmission vehicles must be
left in drive for the test to run. If all parameters are met and the test will still not run, place your foot
on the brake, open the throttle to 1/4 and then quickly close the throttle. This should allow the PF
cells to update.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 182896 > Oct > 96 > PCM - Stumble/Rpm Flare/Low
Performance With A/C ON
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest PCM - Stumble/Rpm Flare/Low
Performance With A/C ON
NO: 18-28-96
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Cold Start Stumble, RPM Flare (MTX), Performance With A/C On, Radiator Steams
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1997 MODELS BUILT PRIOR TO SEPTEMBER 23, 1996 MDH
(09-23-XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
1. Engine stumble within 10 seconds of a cold start. If this condition persists after repair, it is
recommended to change fuel brands.
2. RPM flares slightly when A/C or power steering loads are released, MTX only.
3. Vehicle lacks performance on low speed tip-in with A/C on, more noticeable on ATX vehicles.
Does not improve vehicle launch performance.
4. Radiator "steams" during warm-up.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III) with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are functioning
as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Test the Idle Air Control (IAC) by performing the IAC wiggle test. Select Engine System Test IAC
wiggle test, follow screen prompts. If the IAC wiggle test fails, repair as necessary before
proceeding. If the IAC wiggle test passes and no DTC's are present, perform the Repair Procedure.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
All Symptoms (Flash Programming)
1 CH6000 Scan Tool(DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000 J1962 Cable
1 4669020 Label - Authorized Software Update
1 4275086 Label - Authorized Modification
NOTE:
THE MDS AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM THIS REPAIR AND THE SYSTEM
MUST BE OPERATING WITH RELEASE 20 OR HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1117 OR
HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This repair involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software (calibration changes) for all conditions listed.
1. Connect the MDS (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and power
them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select #2 MDS DIAGNOSTICS on the DRB III MAIN MENU Screen.
3. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 182896 > Oct > 96 > PCM - Stumble/Rpm Flare/Low
Performance With A/C ON > Page 3470
4. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS, then
press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING MDS
& DRB III on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
6. Follow the steps presented on the MDS and DRB III which will allow the DRB III to obtain the
current part number of the PCM.
7. The MDS will display the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and the appropriate
replacement part number, then press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
If the PCM on the vehicle has already been updated or programmed, a NO UPDATES AVAILABLE
message will be displayed. Check the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and compare it to the
part number displayed. If the PCM has already been updated, then another condition exists that will
require further diagnosis and repair.
8. The MDS and DRB III will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
programming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" P/N 4669020. Attach
the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the Authorized Modification Label and attach the label near
the VECI Label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-46-92 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-037-05 Date: 051020
Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
NUMBER: 18-037-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 20, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-020-02, DATED JUNE 24, 2002 WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Flash Programming Failure Recovery Using DRBIII(R)
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin provides guidelines, to minimize flash reprogramming problems, and
information on recovery procedures for failed flash attempts.
MODELS:
1992 - 1994 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2003 (AB) Ramvan/Wagon
1992 - 1994 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1995 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 2002 (BRIBE) Ram Pickup
2004 - 2006 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2005 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2005 (KJ) Liberty/Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2003 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2006 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2006 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3476
1995 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
NOTE:
Many of the reasons a flash reprogramming procedure may not complete are documented in this
service bulletin, but if you are constantly having issues performing the flash reprogramming
procedure using a specific DRBIII(R), it is suggested you send the DRBIII(R) in question to
SPX/Miller Special Tools for service.
Occasionally a flash update procedure may not complete properly and/or the diagnostic equipment
may lock up or become disconnected during the procedure. Flash Reprogramming is a "CRITICAL
PROCESS"; an error may result in a no-start/failed control module. Most modules, encountering an
interruption or failure while reprogramming, are recoverable; a recoverable module is not covered
under the provisions of the warranty.
This service bulletin covers items that may cause this condition, a process to restart the flash
procedure, and miscellaneous information that will help prevent needless replacement of control
modules.
GENERAL: Flash Reprogramming is only authorized by a specific SERVICE BULLETIN, or
RECALL.
Review the entire Service Bulletin/Recall prior to performing a flash reprogramming update. Often
other parts may need to be serviced, replaced, or tested, prior to flash reprogramming, and ARE
REQUIRED as part of completing the Service Bulletin/Recall.
When flashing a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or Transmission Control Module (TCM) there
are other legal requirements with labeling issues that are included in those service bulletins.
Other non-emission related modules, such as instrument clusters and Body Control Modules
(BCMs) do not require labels.
FLASH REPROGRAMMING SEQUENCE OF EVENTS
The process of flash reprogramming is similar to flashing the BIOS on a Personal Computer.
Interruptions, voltage problems, and a variety of other outside interactions can potentially interfere
with the process. This document seeks to provide information to minimize problems associated
with vehicle control module flash reprogramming. The description that follows is for most PCMs
and some TCMs. Other modules use different initiation procedures.
The process starts by selecting an update from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS and then
"loading" that update into the DRBIII(R). Once the flash reprogramming update is loaded into the
DRBIII(R), and before the flash reprogramming begins, the DRBIII(R) verifies that the update
loaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS is the proper update for the module. This is done
using part number supersedence. This verification occurs only if an update is required, available
(on the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS) and has been selected for programming.
^ The module is then placed into "Boot Strap" programming mode by the DRBIII(R). This module
mode gives the DRBIII(R) permission and the ability to proceed with the flash reprogramming
session.
^ Next, the current part number, which resides in the module's flash memory, is stored in a "Safe
Memory" location within the module. This memory location is not affected by flash memory erasure
and reprogramming, which are to follow.
^ Once the part number is safely stored, the flash memory in the control module is erased. From
this point forward any interruption in the flash process,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3477
will result in a Non-Responsive module (NR). A NR module is a module that is either partially
erased or partially programmed.
^ After erasure, the actual reprogramming procedure starts, and the update software is
programmed into the flash memory within the module.
^ When reprogramming is completed, the flash memory is verified through an internal process in
the DRBIII(R) using a "Check Sum". This value is compared against another value that represents
what should be in memory and when matched, verifies successful reprogramming.
^ Next, a DRBIII(R) prompt is displayed instructing that the ignition switch be turned OFF. The
module exits the "Boot Strap" mode when the switch is turned off.
^ After a slight pause, the DRBIII(R) will prompt for the ignition switch to be turned ON. The
DRBIII(R) then reads the new part number in flash memory (along with a new computer program
the new part number is placed into the module's memory). If the new part number matches the
expected part number, the flash reprogramming session has completed successfully.
SOFTWARE VERSIONS MUST BE CURRENT
Before attempting a flash reprogramming session using the TechCONNECT Client, make sure you
have the most current DRBIII(R) software installed.
To verify whether your DRBIII(R) software is current, check the upper right-hand corner of the
TechCONNECT Client screen for DRBIII(R) Available Version, DRBIII(R) Current Version.
Often, because of multiple DRBIII(R)s in the shop, not all will get updated on a timely manner. The
installed DRBIII(R) software version can generally be found at the bottom center of most screens.
Alternately the version can be checked by pressing 6, 2, 5 from the DRBIII(R) Main Menu and
comparing it to what is available from a current TechCONNECT Client as described above.
If the TechCONNECT Client is current and the DRBIII(R) is not, it may be due to the fact that the
TechCONNECT Client does not force DRBIII(R) updates for "minor" revisions. Changes and new
support are added to the Vehicle Flash application on "minor" revisions on a regular basis. This is
why your TechCONNECT Client and DRBIII(R) must have the LATEST software revisions
installed.
DO NOT PASS on the option for updating to a "minor" revision!
Major updates require the DRBIII(R) to be updated prior to allowing any flash programming.
DRBIII(R) CABLES
A NEW DRBIII(R) cable was released as an Essential Service Tool! CH7000A - 8 ft.
Cable, DRBIII(R) to OBDII (J1962) DLC Connector.
CH7000A is the required cable for ALL flash reprogramming. The older CH7000 cable can be used
for diagnostics ONLY. One (1) cable was shipped to all dealerships. Easily identified, the correct
cable has a RED connector, which plugs into the DRBIII(R).
The cable modification enhances the DRBIII(R) communication capabilities when dealing with the
flash requirements of certain controllers/ECUs affected in part by the recent changes in DLC
connector configurations.
The new cable is required for ALL flash reprogramming sessions, and can be used wherever the
previous CH700017001 cables were used.
While not recommended for flash reprogramming usage, if you require a longer cable, there is also
a 12-foot cable released under pin CH7001A
The production of the previous CH700017001 cables has ceased. All orders placed will be
superseded to part number CH7000A/CH7001A.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3478
NOTE:
Consider all cables wear items. Always inspect for worn, damaged cables, connectors that are
damaged or do not lock securely, and all mating connections including checking for corrosion on
the pins. REPLACE ALL suspect cables. Do not use worn or damaged cables when flash
reprogramming.
Failure to use the new cable or to use a damaged cable often results in failed flash reprogramming
sessions.
The 2 door Sebring, Stratus, and Avenger coupes (supplied by MMC) generally use the CH7O1O
cable (Pre-OBDII MMC vehicles will use the CH7005 cable).
TechCONNECT CABLE (GPIB)
Replace any suspect GPIB cable.
The GPIB cable provides the connection between TechCONNECT Client and the DRBIII(R).
This cable is used by the TechCONNECT Client for vehicle part number reads and to send update
files to the DRBIII(R).
Inspect this cable for loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If
this cable becomes disconnected during a flash session, you may have to reload the update file
that you selected on the TechCONNECT Client.
TROUBLESHOOTING CONNECTIVITY OF THE DRBIII(R) UNIT TO THE TechCONNECT
APPLICATION.
1. Turn-on the power to the DRBIII(R) unit.
2. Select option 2 "Connect to TechCONNECT" and press Enter.
3. Attach the male mini D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable (part number
CH7035B) to the DRBIII(R) unit.
4. Insure that the larger female D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable is
properly attached to the male D-shell amphenol GPIB connector on the GPIB-USB-B protocol
converter, (part number CHGPIB-B).
5. Attach the USB cable from the GPIB-USB-B protocol converter to one of the USB ports on the
rear panel of the client CPU.
6. When the cable is attached to the USB port of the CPU for the first time, Windows 2000 will
detect the device and install software for it. Please wait for 25-30 seconds to complete the
installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3479
ISIS NULL MODEM CABLE
Replace any suspect null modem cables.
International (ISIS), a PC-based CD program similar to TechCONNECT Client uses a null modem
cable for vehicle part number reads and to send update files to the DRBIII(R). Inspect this cable for
loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If this cable becomes
disconnected during a flash download session, you will have to reload the update file or files.
GENERAL NOTES FOR CABLES AND VEHICLE CONNECTIONS
Consider ALL cables to be wear items.
Many successful dealers have dedicated cables devoted to "Flash ONLY".
Always have spare CH7000A, CH7010 and CH2002 GPIB or null modem cables available.
Inspect vehicle diagnostic connectors for potential problems that might cause communication
interruptions.
There are now clip repair kits available through teamPSE to replace the retaining clips for two of
these cables. To protect the DRBIII(R) from internal damage, the clips are designed to fail at above
25 lbs. of axial force. Kits are described in the table.
It is a good practice to discard cables that have damage to the pins, cuts, corrosion, or general
damage beyond the retaining clips.
ST22 SEBRING STRATUS 2 DOOR COUPES (2001-2005)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3480
These vehicles use MMC based modules. The CH8432 Supplemental Reprogramming Tool (SRT)
was shipped as a 2001 Essential Tool. The flash reprogramming update files will be downloaded
from TechCONNECT Client to the SRT for flash reprogramming sessions on these vehicles. Users
should closely follow the instructions that come with the tool. If the tool has not been initialized,
there is a known condition where it may take up to 5 or more attempts for it to fully initialize and
become functional.
NOTE:
Once it has successfully flashed, it is initialized and no further action is required.
PREPARING TO FLASH
It is highly recommended that a sign, or other process, be used that notifies other users that a
FLASH SESSION IS IN-PROGRESS and must NOT be interrupted. Interrupting some flash
reprogramming sessions at critical junctures can render a module inoperative. Another user may
not realize that a flash session is in-progress and may disturb or disconnect the DRBIII(R) or do
something on the vehicle that could interrupt the flash process.
Before starting the flash session, read, record and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle.
Also "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R) and download the flash since this will erase the flash file from the
DRBIII(R) memory. (To "Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the
same time. Then press "F4").
Be sure to arrange the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R) so that no cables are stretched across an
area where someone might trip over or kick a cable. When setting up your DRBIII(R), insure that it
rests on a surface where it will not fall or be bumped during reprogramming e.g.: DRBIII's have
been known to be swept off vehicle windshields by accident when a user bumps the wiper switch).
Check User settings on the DRBIII(R). From the DRBIII(R) Main menu, press 6,1 and check to
make sure item 1. Echo on PC is set to OFF. On occasion, when Echo on PC is set to ON, flash
reprogramming errors may occur.
VEHICLE BATTERY VOLTAGE
The flash programming procedure puts a load on the electrical system that may last from five to
twenty minutes depending on the particular flash reprogramming update. Connect a battery
charger to the vehicle. Set the charger to as close to 14 volts as possible. If the charger has a
timer, set it for 30 minutes BEFORE starting a flash reprogramming session. This will help to
prevent unwanted resets by either the DRBIII(R) and/or the vehicle module that are caused by
voltage fluctuations.
Alternately, as a bare minimum, use a "Battery Jump Box" when a battery charger is unavailable to
ensure adequate and stable system voltages on the module being flash reprogrammed.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Connected/Disconnected Flash Mode Using TechCONNECT
CONNECTED MODE FLASHING USING TechCONNECT
NOTE:
Capable but not recommended.
In this mode, the DRBIII(R) remains connected to the TechCONNECT Client and the vehicle
throughout the flash session. The DRBIII(R) is connected to the TechCONNECT Client using the
GPIB (CH7035) cable and to the vehicle using the vehicle I/O cable (the CH7000A for most
vehicles).
This mode is useful when the TechCONNECT Client is next to the vehicle being flashed.
Another advantage of this mode is that you are able to determine all available flash updates for the
vehicle you are connected to by clicking on the "Read Part Number(s) From Vehicle" button.
Again, it is important that other users do not attempt to reboot or move the TechCONNECT Client
while a flash update is in-progress.
The reprogramming procedure of this mode is initiated by selecting the controller option and
clicking "Download/Update" button on the TechCONNECT client.
DISCONNECTED FLASH MODE
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3481
This is the preferred method.
This mode allows a user to flash a vehicle without being connected to the TechCONNECT Client.
This is a popular mode for flashing in a remote area of the service garage or in a back lot.
Before you attempt to use this mode, you must configure the DRBIII(R) for the desired update(s).
To do this, you must connect the DRBIII(R) to the TechCONNECT Client using the GPIB cable and
the CH7025 cable. It is not necessary to be connected to a vehicle. The GPIB (CH7035) cable will
be used to communicate with the TechCONNECT Client (for update file downloading) while the
CH7025 cable is used to provide power to the DRBIII(R).
After making the above connections, you are able to select one or more updates that you want to
perform. These selections are made by highlighting the desired updates and then clicking on the
"Download/Update" button by selecting the DRBIII(R) option on the TechCONNECT client.
Obviously, the DRBIII(R) does not have unlimited memory. If the file size of the selected updates
exceeds 948 KB, the "DRB Space Used" indicator (at the bottom-center of the TechCONNECT
Client screen) will change color from GREEN to RED. At this point you must de-select entries until
the indicator changes color to GREEN again.
When the updates have finished downloading, you may disconnect from the TechCONNECT Client
and take the DRBIII(R) to wherever the vehicle is located. The updates will remain in DRBIII(R)
memory for 8 hours while the DRBIII(R) is without power. If the DRBIII(R) is powered up for several
minutes before the 8 hour time period has expired, the update files will remain on the DRBIII(R) for
another 8 hours without power.
To start the actual flash process, after connecting to the vehicle in Disconnected Mode, you must
press "7 - Vehicle Flash" from the Main Menu on the DRBIII(R). Step by step instruction will follow
on the DRBIII(R) display. As with Connected Flash Mode, take the necessary precautions to insure
that others are aware of the flash session and that nothing disturbs the vehicle, DRBIII(R), or
cabling while performing the flash. Remember to use a battery charger set to 14 volts or a "battery
jump box".
Pay Attention While Performing Flash Reprogram Procedures
PAY ATTENTION WHILE PERFORMING FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURES
Before downloading the flash files, double check to see if the files that you have selected are the
appropriate ones for that vehicle. Don't forget about the "Read Part Numbers From Vehicle" option
on TechCONNECT Client, this can be of great assistance when trying to flash a module. If the files
selected don't download on the first attempt, try again.
The technician should NOT leave the vehicle when flash reprogramming a module.
Again, check to make sure that all cable connections are secure and that the DRBIII(R) rests on a
stable surface. If you are using a battery charger, insure that the settings and charging times are
correct and that the battery post clamps are securely fastened.
Read, record, and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle. Read and record the module type and part
number from the module that is to be flash reprogrammed.
Some control modules are not "abort-recovery" capable. When this is true, the scan tool will
indicate so by displaying a WARNING message prior to the start of reprogramming. For these
modules it is especially important that all precautions and procedures, outlined here, are carefully
followed.
Pay special attention to DRBIII(R) screen directions relating to key cycles. Missing a "Key ON" or
"Key OFF" can cause the module to have to be reflashed again. Due to the variety of module types
and vehicle options, you can't always anticipate key prompts, so be alert and ready to respond to
DRBIII(R) instructions.
Some screens will also instruct that certain modules, connectors or fuses be disconnected or pulled
prior to the start of reprogramming and re-installed immediately after completion. Be careful not to
anticipate the steps or order of operations for reprogramming any vehicle modules. Because of the
many possible changes that occur with each new release of scan tool software, always allow the
TSB/Recall and scan tool instructions to be your guide while performing flash reprogramming.
Flash reprogramming sessions usually range from 5 to 20 minutes. If the flash session has not
completed within 25 minutes after starting a flash reprogramming update, an error has most likely
occurred (Record the message that appears on the screen when a failure occurs). If this is the
case, or if you know that the flash process was interrupted, cycle the ignition key (OFF to the
locked position, then back ON). Reset the DRBIII(R) (power down for 4 seconds and then power
up) before attempting to restart the flash process. If the module still won't respond, turn the ignition
key off, disconnect the module from the vehicle for 2 minutes, reconnect the module, turn the
ignition key to run and try to restart the flash process again.
Regardless of what mode that you are in (Connected Flash or Disconnected Flash), if you have
tried twice (2 times) unsuccessfully to do a flash recovery and ALL DRBIII(R) instructions were
followed, perform the following:
^ Cold boot the DRBIII(R). This resets memory and removes all update files from the DRBIII(R).
(Push MORE and YES buttons at the same time, then press F4).
^ Reload the flash update file from the TechCONNECT Client.
^ If it fails to complete in the connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before
re-attempting the flash download to the DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3482
^ Proceed to reflash the module.
On vehicles that have multiple flash updates available, always complete and verify each flash
update before attempting the next one.
After all flash reprogramming is completed, read and erase all DTCs in all modules on the vehicle.
A variety of DTCs may be set, which are usually related to a loss of communication with the
module(s) being reprogrammed.
Verify the update by reading the new part number using the DRBIII(R). A good double check is to
read the part number using DRBIII(R) stand alone.
At times, other modules, wired in parallel, to the DLC connector have prevented flash
reprogramming sessions to be successful. After the failed attempt, review the appropriate wiring
diagram for the vehicle you are flash reprogramming and, with the key "OFF"; disconnect the other
modules and retry the flash. Complete the flash, turn the key "OFF" and reconnect any modules
that were disconnected. Refer to the "Programmable Modules" section later in this document for
more information.
Error Messages
ERROR MESSAGES
Block Echo/Compare Errors
Block Echo and Block Compare errors are often caused by voltage fluctuations, faulty I/O cables
(CH7OOOA, CH7005, CH7010) or faulty communication connections at the diagnostic connector.
Inspect for these conditions and review the sections on Vehicle Battery Voltage and Cable
recommendations.
Checksum Errors
Checksum Errors are generally caused by corrupt flash update files, which can be caused by
DRBIII(R) memory problems. If the DRBIII(R) has been without power for more than 8 hours, the
update files and system memory could be in a corrupted state. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (To
"Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the same time. Then press
"F4"). Reload the flash update file(s) from the TechCONNECT CLIENT. If it fails to complete in the
connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before re-attempting the flash download to
the DRBIII(R). Then re-attempt the flash reprogramming process.
Enhanced and Original Abort Recovery
ENHANCED ABORT RECOVERY
Interruptions in the flash process are one of the main reasons for failed flash sessions and
non-responsive (NR) modules. Interrupting the flash process after the erase phase has started will
leave the control module in a non-functional state.
Generally, but not always, NR modules may be recovered successfully.
Briefly, abort recovery is the process used to get a NR module back to a fully functional state with
the latest software update. The technician should be familiar with the other sections in this
document and follow all DRBIII(R) user prompts carefully.
There are two methods for abort-recovery. The newer method is called "Enhanced Abort
Recovery". This is the preferred method since the original method takes several minutes longer
and requires the correct selection of module type from a list of possible PCM's or TCM's.
Starting with Release 60.1, a new useful feature was added to the flash reprogramming application
for Engine and Transmission control modules. The DRBIII(R) "writes" the YME and Controller Type
information to a "Safe Memory" location. This method allows for rapid recovery of the module part
number and minimizes errors that could otherwise be made by selecting the wrong controller type.
It also assumes that the user will attempt abort recovery for a failed flash attempt before moving to
another vehicle with the same DRBIII(R). If you need to move to another vehicle for flash
reprogramming you must erase the saved recovery information in order to successfully perform
flash reprogramming. Be careful to match the YME information displayed on the enhanced abort
recovery screen with the vehicle and module that you are attempting to recover. If you use the
recovery file on a different vehicle and module you could damage the module.
The recovery information will be displayed on your DRBIII(R), at the start of a flash session, only if
you previously encountered a problem that prevented a flash session from completing normally. If
your prior flash session was successful, the DRBIII(R) automatically erases the recovery file so that
the flash application will not show any recovery information at the start of your next flash session.
Enhanced abort recovery features:
^ Reduces the amount of time for the Module ID process.
^ Lowers the risk of possible user mistakes by presenting the user the Year, Model, Engine, and
Controller Type.
^ Currently only applicable to Engine and Transmission flash reprogramming.
^ The enhanced abort recovery file will only be erased upon a successful flash or manually by the
user.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3483
^ Cold booting (simultaneously pushing MORE & YES, then F4) the DRBIII(R) will not erase the
enhanced abort recovery file, but cold booting the DRBIII(R) will still erase the flash file so it can be
reloaded.
^ The user has a choice, at the start of a flash session, whether or not to use the enhanced abort
recovery feature. If the user chooses to erase the recovery file, then the DRBIII(R) will use the
original method of abort recovery.
^ Cycling the ignition key, when prompted by the DRBIII(R), is still necessary to put the controller
into bootstrap (reprogramming) mode.
ORIGINAL ABORT RECOVERY
If the choice is made to use the original method of abort recovery, a NR module is not always able
to provide the DRBIII with ID information. In this case the technician must enter this when prompted
by the DRBIII(R). Be patient when performing this process. If the module does not respond to
standard diagnostic requests, the DRBIII(R) may take several minutes before it determines that the
engine module is in a NR state. At this point, the DRBIII(R) displays the prompt "Could not
determine engine controller type. Please select from list" along with a list of possible controller
types (if the DRBIII(R) is attempting to identify a TCM, the prompt will say "trans" instead of
"engine" and list the possible trans controller types). Because of module variations, it is important
to correctly identify the PCM/TCM type so that the correct flash procedure is used. Failure to do
this will cause further problems and may damage the module. Tables are provided below to help
identify the proper module type to select. These tables correctly identify the modules that were on
the vehicles when they were built. However, some vehicles will have module types which were
superseded to a new type when a replacement part was installed (ie: EATX4 modules replaced
with an EATX4A). Correctly identify these modules using DRBIII(R) Standalone prior to attempting
flash reprogramming.
NOTE:
When instructed to turn the key to the LOCKED position, be sure that the key is not just turned to
the OFF position. The key must be rotated to the point at which it can be removed from the ignition
switch. On most vehicles the switch is on the steering column and at this position the steering
column is LOCKED. When instructed to turn the key to the RUN position, be careful not to turn the
key past this position which may engage the starter motor. This creates electrical noise which
interferes with the flash process.
General Steps for Abort Recovery
1. Review all Tips and Techniques before continuing. Pay special attention to the section on
Preparing to Flash a controller and to the Programmable Modules section.
2. Cycle the vehicle's ignition key to the LOCKED position and back to the RUN position.
3. Reset the DRBIII(R) by disconnecting the vehicle cable from the DRBIII(R) for 4 seconds and
then reconnecting the cable.
4. Depending on where the flash session was aborted, the DRBIII(R) may require that the
technician identify the control module type that was being flash reprogrammed. Use the PCM/TCM
configuration table below as a guide. This step is not necessary if using the enhanced abort
recovery method.
5. After selecting the proper control module type or choosing enhanced abort recovery, follow the
prompts that are displayed on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
If an error message is displayed at this point, an incorrect module type was most likely selected. If
this occurs, start the process over.
6. If the recovery process is unsuccessful, perform the following:
a. Review the TSB/Recall notice (authorizing the flash update) and all Tips and Techniques in this
document.
b. Reboot/Restart the TechCONNECT Client.
c. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (Press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R) at the same
time, then press F4).
d. Start this process over from item # 1. If using Disconnected Mode, the flash update will have to
be reloaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS DVD.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3484
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3485
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3486
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3487
Programmable Modules
The following pages list the various modules that have flash reprogramming capability. It does not
mean that a flash is currently available. What will be described are the module types and
variations, followed by items to note, and finally, abort recovery specifics if applicable.
Powertrain Modules - Engine and Transmission
ENGINE - POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3488
There are a variety of Engine (PCM) modules that are flash reprogrammable. Suggestions that are
somewhat unique to each type will have comments. Prior to reprogramming a PCM, retrieve the
module information and module type using your DRBII I®. PCM information is used by many
modules. Be sure to check DIG's before and after performing all flash reprogramming event.
The DTC's associated with flash reprogramming generally relate to "lack of communication" with
the other modules during the reprogramming session.
SBEC
Types:
SBEC, SBEC 2, SBEC 3, SBEC 3+, SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+, and SBEC 3B
NOTE:
During recovery, if the DRBIII® is not seeing the key off, you may need to remove power (B+) to
PCM by removing fuse(s) or disconnecting the PCM. When DRBIII® states to turn key ON,
reconnect fuse or harness connection.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow instructions on the DRBIII® for the module type. See table above.
^ Some SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+ AND SBEC 3B may be in a state where they can not correctly
identify a key cycle. In this case a Modified Key Cycle routine is required.
This state is present when the following message is displayed on the DRBIII(R): "Can not read Part
Number. Did not see Key On or PCM/TCM Controller may not be flashable". When this occurs
restart the flash session and when prompted to turn the ignition key to the LOCKED position, pull
the fuse(s) that supply battery power to the module instead. When prompted to turn the key to the
RUN position, replace the battery supply fuse(s) instead.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC, JTEC+
NOTE:
Viper ALL - Roll down windows especially Coupes before attempting a flash.
NOTE:
1999 WJ JTEC with Speed Proportional Steering module. Disconnect before and reconnect after
the PCM flash reprogramming session. Also see Transmission.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC Types:
^ NGC 1, NGC 2, and NGC 3
NOTE:
There are derivatives of NGC 3 that will be significant when reprogramming and or testing. NGC
modules use one of the longest time spans for flash reprogramming (approximately 15 minutes).
The NGCI and NGC3 controllers incorporate both an engine as well as a transmission controller in
a common package. The NGC2 controller incorporates the engine controller and an Electronic
Throttle Control (ETC) module in place of the TCM. All NGC controllers can be visually identified by
noting its four (4) wiring connectors. On manual transmission applications and the NGC2, only 3
connectors may be populated with pins.
NOTE:
On certain vehicles, the ABS CAB module connector MUST be disconnected prior to performing
this Repair Procedure. The CAB module and the PCM are connected at the same diagnostic
connector pin (Pin # 9). Turn ignition switch to the OFF position, disconnect the CAB module
connector, and reprogram the PCM per the Repair Procedure. When reprogramming is complete
turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, connect the CAB module connector, and then check for
DTC's. If the PCM becomes "locked" during reprogramming because the ABS CAB module
connector was not disconnected, then the PCM may be recovered by following the procedure in
this NOTE.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3489
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ Power down the DRBIII(R) then cycle ignition before powering up the DRBIII(R) to attempt the
flash.
CUMMINS
Types:
^ CM551 and CM84x series
NOTE:
Cummins flash reprogrammable PCMs are used on 1998.5 and newer Dodge Trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. Model Year 2000 and earlier vehicles have one Engine
Control Fuse to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). Model Year 2001 and later have two Engine
Control Fuses (one 20 Amp and one 30 Amp) to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). The fuse(s)
are located in the PDC and need to be pulled/removed, when prompted, for at least 10 seconds.
SIEMENS
Types:
^ SIM-70
NOTE:
The SIM-70 is currently used on BUX PL and PG vehicles with a 1.6L ONLY. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
BOSCH
Types:
^ EDC15V, EDC15-C5, and EDC16
NOTE:
While there have been other Bosch modules, the EDC15V is not flash reprogrammable.
Transmission controllers are usually flashed on the vehicle (since 1996).
Technicians may set the pinion factor on "NEW" modules either before or after flash
reprogramming. Suggestions follow.
After flash reprogramming and before returning the vehicle to the customer, always perform a
"QuickLearn" to the TCM.
EATX
Types:
^ EATX, EATX 2, EATX 3, EATX 3A, EATX 3B, EATX 4, and EATX 4A
NOTE:
Table shows which TCM was installed "as-built". Often TCMs are superseded by parts and or a
service bulletin.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ 1999 - 2000 WJ and 2000 AN/DN using 4.7L engines the service replacement EATX4A part
numbers 56041814AD and 56028227AH currently display a P/N read failed error after the flash is
completed during PIN verification. This DOES NOT mean the flash failed. Check for the part
number using DRBIII(R) in standalone mode. This exists only for the service replacement modules
listed above. Flash reprogramming for OE modules flash and read the part number correctly.
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3490
^ NGC1, NGC2, NGC3
NOTE:
The NGC I1and NGC 3 have the EATX/XCORE and Engine modules combined. NGC 2 does not.
Vehicles with automatic transmissions using NGC2 will use an EATX4A.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ 2002 DR, 2002.5 DN, 2003 AN/DN and later with NGC have shown that in some instances the
CAB controller may need to be disconnected when attempting to flash the NGC controller. (This
should only be performed if an error occurs at the very beginning of the TCM flash portion.)
SIEMENS
Types:
^ EG552
NOTE:
EGS52 is used with the A580 automatic transmission WG Grand Cherokees with a 2.7L diesel
engine (BUX), ZH Crossfire and VA Sprinter.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC,JTEC+
NOTE:
Except for the 45RFE, 545RFE, and AW4 automatic transmissions, the JTEC controller also
provides transmission control functions on Dodge trucks and Jeep vehicles. Additionally, they are
used on some Cummins equipped Dodge trucks with manual and automatic transmissions.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
PRE 1996 EATX TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULES
Prior to 1996 there was not a vehicle SCI communication wire going to the FWD EATX controller
only to the PCM. Those vehicle TCMs only communicate to the DRBIII(R) using CCD
communications.
For these FWD vehicles, use the CH5500 kit and CH7025 DIN cable when connecting those
modules to the DRBIII(R) vehicle connector.
For 1992-1993 vehicles, the TCM modules were upgraded to MY1995 software. Because of this
you will need to use the Yellow SuperCard2, CH8361,to set pinion factor or when using a "new"
(superseded) TCM from parts as only the SuperCard2 properly sets the pinion factor on these
updated modules.
Additionally, when flashing or installing P/Ns 4796121, 4796122, 4796123, or 4796124.
The wire from cavity 49 must be removed from the TCM connector, refer to service bulletin
18-24-95.
Types:
^ TCCM
NOTE:
These modules are found on AN, DN, and DR trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3491
NON-POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULES
BODY CONTROL MODULE (BCM)
Types:
^ BCM
NOTE:
Body control modules are found on passenger vehicles.
NOTE:
The following vehicle BCMs support flash reprogramming: CS, JR, KJ, LH, RS, WJ, and ZB.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ BUX ONLY for 2001 JR - Compass/Mini Trip (BCM) Flash - Use special international release
software version 52.25
^ 2001 LH - there is NO abort recovery available for the BCM.
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE (CTM)
Types:
^ CTM
NOTE:
CTMs are found on: AB, AN, DN, BR, and BE trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)
Types:
^ EVIC
NOTE:
02-03 LH & WJ, and 03-04 KJ
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
FRONT CONTROL MODULE (FCM)
Types:
^ FCM
NOTE:
Front control modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (IPM)
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3492
^ 1PM
NOTE:
Integrated power modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
POWER LIFT GATE (PLG)
Types:
^ PLC
NOTE:
Power liftgate modules are found on CS and RS.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (PSDM)
Types:
^ PSDM
NOTE:
Passenger power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. DRIVER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (DSDM)
Types:
^ DSDM
NOTE:
Driver power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NOTE:
When flashing a vehicle that is equipped with both Passenger and Driver Power Sliding Doors, you
must Reboot the DRBIII(R) and cycle the ignition key before flashing the next door module.
DRIVER DOOR MODULE (DDM)
Types:
^ DDM
NOTE:
Driver Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER DOOR MODULE (PDM)
Types:
^ PDM
NOTE:
Passenger Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLUSTERS/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (MIC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3493
Types:
^ MICs, eMICs
NOTE:
MICs that have flash reprogramming are on the following vehicles: DR, JR, KJ, PL, PT, WJ, ZB
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. In certain cases, you will be asked to cycle the ignition key
and pull a specific fuse.
^ The DRBIII(R) may power down during the procedure with some modules. This is NORMAL and
is explained in the user prompts displayed during abort-recovery. Take the time to read and
understand the instructions before proceeding.
ALARM REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE (ARKEM)
Types:
^ ARKEM
NOTE:
Arkem modules are found on PL and PT vehicles. There are up to and after modules.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLIMATE CONTROL (ATC, HVAC)
Types:
^ HVAC, ATC, MTC
NOTE:
Generally, reprogramming for these modules is done using the standalone application rather than
the Vehicle Flash application.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
ADJUSTABLE PEDAL MODULE (APM)
Types:
^ APM
NOTE:
Found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
RAIN SENSOR MODULE (RSM)
Types:
^ RSM
NOTE:RSM modules are found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3494
INTRUSION TRANSCEIVER MODULE (ITM)
Types:
^ ITM
^ Updates for this module, to version 7.05 have involved a coordinated BCM flash update. See the
TSB for important instructions.
NOTE:
ITM modules are found on WJ (BUX) and KJ (BUX) vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEMS (SRS) - AIRBAGS, ETC.
Types:
^ SRS, ORC
NOTE:
While used on most vehicles, only CS, JR, LH, PT, RS, and WJ vehicles have the potential to
support flash updates.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-47-98 > Dec > 98 > PCM - Symptomless Misfire DTC's/MIL ON
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Symptomless
Misfire DTC's/MIL ON
NO: 18-47-98
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Dec. 18, 1998
SUBJECT: Symptom less Misfire Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's)
MODELS:
1997 - 1999 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC ENGINE
BUILT PRIOR TO NOV. 3, 1998 (MDH 1103XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may exhibit a condition where the MIL illuminates for misfire but no reasons can be
found for the misfire fault occurrence. In some cases, there may be minor engine roughness on
initial cold engine start-up. Customers may explain the condition as a MIL illumination "only" with
no other symptoms felt or noticed. In many cases the occurrence is experienced on a cold engine
start.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R)) with
the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If non misfire related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If SINGLE or MULTIPLE CYLINDER MIS-FIRE DTC's are present, follow all mis-fire diagnostics
listed in the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual before proceeding with this flash repair. If
no cause for the MIS-FIRE DTC's are found, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER SHOULD BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
EQUIPMENT/PARTS REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 04669020 Label - Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label Authorized Modification
NOTE:
THE MDS AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM THIS REPAIR AND THE SYSTEM
MUST BE OPERATING WITH RELEASE 21 OR HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1175 OR
HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software (calibration changes).
1. Connect the MDS (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS 1 OR MDS 2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU Screen.
3. Select # 1 MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB UPDATE on the DRB III(R).
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS, then
press NEXT MENU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-47-98 > Dec > 98 > PCM - Symptomless Misfire DTC's/MIL ON > Page 3499
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING MDS
& DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS and DRB III(R) which will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS will display the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and the appropriate
replacement part number, then press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
If the PCM on the vehicle has already been updated or programmed, a NO UPDATES AVAILABLE
message will be displayed. Check the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and compare it to the
part number displayed. If the PCM has already been updated, then another condition exists that will
require further diagnosis and repair.
9. The MDS and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
programming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI Label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-40-99 PCM, Reprogram 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 25-02-98 Date: 981023
I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information
NO: 25-02-98
GROUP: Emissions
DATE: Oct. 23, 1998
SUBJECT:
I/M (Inspection Maintenance) Testing - OBD II "CARB" Readiness Monitor Information
MODELS:
1996 - 1999 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1996 - 1999 (AN) Dakota
1996 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1998 - 1999 (DN) Durango
1996 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1999 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1996 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 1999 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1999 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper Roadster/Coupe
1997 - 1999 (TJ) Wrangler
1999 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1996 - 1999 (XJ) Cherokee
1996 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO NATURALLY ASPIRATED (NON-TURBO) GASOLINE
ENGINES.
DISCUSSION:
Some states that require I/M inspections are beginning to include OBD II "CARB" Readiness as a
prerequisite to an I/M test. OBD Readiness tells an I/M station if the OBD II systems have run their
self test. Owners, in those states that use OBD Readiness, may be denied an I/M test if one or
more of the Readiness monitors read "NO" or in other words the OBD II monitors have not run their
tests.
It is important to understand that the MIL will not be illuminated because OBD Readiness reads
"NO". MIL illumination happens when an actual malfunction or failure of a monitored emissions
system occurs. It is possible to have MIL illumination for a detected failure while at the same time
having a "NO" for an OBO Readiness monitor.
NOTE:
MIL ILLUMINATION INDICATES ADDITIONAL PROBLEMS WITH THE VEHICLE. FURTHER
DIAGNOSIS AND REPAIR WILL BE REQUIRED BEFORE PROCEEDING FURTHER WITH THIS
BULLETIN.
OBD Readiness that reads "NO" can be caused by the following: PCM reprogramming, PCM
replacement, fault code erasure, battery disconnects and/or replacement. If any of the above items
occur before an I/M test, a good chance exists that one or more of the monitors will read "NO" for
OBD Readiness.
Some customers may be directed back to their dealers for assistance when an I/M test station has
not allowed an I/M test due to Readiness status. The following procedures will help technicians
efficiently run the Readiness tests so an owner can have their I/M test completed.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7000/7001 J1962Cable
1 CH7OlO J1962 MMC Cable
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3504
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 25-01-01-91 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves operating the vehicle under specific parameters to run or complete the OBD
monitors. The number of monitors applicable to a vehicle will vary by type of vehicle and emissions
application. In addition, the parameters to run each monitor will vary.
Preliminary Checks
1. Perform a MIL bulb check by switching the ignition key "ON" (engine off). The MIL will illuminate
as a bulb check. If the MIL does not illuminate, repair the bulb or bulb circuit.
2. Connect a DRB III(R) to the vehicle. Select DRB III(R) standalone, current model year
diagnostics, engine, DTC's and related functions, read DTC's.
3. Verity that no emission related DTC's are present and that the MIL is not illuminated with the
engine running.
NOTE:
EMISSION RELATED DTC'S AND MIL ILLUMINATION MAY PREVENT OTHER OBD MONITORS
FROM RUNNING. DTC'S THAT ILLUMINATE THE MIL MUST BE REPAIRED BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO RUN THE MONITORS.
OBD "CARB" Readiness Check
1. With the DRB III(R) select engine, OBD II monitors, CARB Readiness Status.
2. Read the monitor status. "YES" tells you that monitor has run and is ready for an I/M test, "NO"
tells you that the monitor must be run. If all monitors listed read "YES", the vehicle can be returned
to the customer for completion of their I/M test. Only monitors that read "NO" must be run to read
"YES".
NOTE:
THE MONITORS LISTED IN THE OBD "CARB" READINESS SCREEN ARE THE ONLY ONES
APPLICABLE FOR THE VEHICLE BEING WORKED ON.
The vehicle must be operated in various conditions (speed, temperature, etc.) for the monitors to
run. Each monitor includes a pre-test and monitor test that can be viewed on the DRB III(R). The
pre-test/monitor test screen lists all the preliminary parameters that must be met along with the
running parameters for that specific monitor to run. An example of one screen is shown in Figure 1.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3505
NOTE:
1997 AND PREVIOUS MODEL VEHICLES WILL HAVE A DIFFERENT LOOKING SCREEN.
PRESS THE F1 KEY TO OBTAIN MONITOR RUN CONDITIONS. THE WAY IN WHICH THE
MONITORS RUN WILL BE SIMILAR.
The following explains how to interpret each section of the screen:
PRE-TEST REQUIREMENTS
The pre-test requirements include all the operating parameters that must be met before the actual
test can run. The vehicle must be operated until each item within the pre-test section are fulfilled.
LOW VALUE/HIGH VALUE/BAR GRAPH
The low value/high value provides the minimum and maximum operating conditions for each item
(ie ECT Range must be between 170° and 260° F in Figure 1). The bar graph will begin to fill when
the lowest value required for each item is met. This provides a visual indication that the parameters
are being met. The vehicle should be driven until most of each pre-test bar graph is filled.
MONITOR REQUIREMENTS
Once all pre-test requirements are met, the vehicle must be brought within the parameters listed in
the monitor requirements section for the monitors to begin running. As the monitor begins to run,
the DRB III(R) will begin to beep. This is an audible indication that the test is in progress. If vehicle
operation falls outside any of the parameters, the beeping will stop. If this occurs, the technician
must determine if the pre-test requirements or the monitor requirements have fallen outside the
window for the test and the vehicle must be driven accordingly for the test to restart. When the
monitor completes its test, the DRB III(R) will beep 3 consecutive times.
NOTE:
THE PURGE FLOW PRE-TEST SCREEN WILL LOOK DIFFERENT THAN THE REST OF THE
PRE-TEST/MONITOR SCREENS. PRESS THE F1 KEY ON THE DRB III(R) TO SEE A SIMILAR
SCREEN FOR THIS MONITOR.
MONITOR RUN PROCESS
The following will provide the most efficient order along with tips to help run through the monitor
tests quickly. The monitors listed include all possible monitors for either Front Wheel Drive or Rear
Wheel Drive vehicles. The vehicle being worked on may have fewer monitors than the maximum
available. Only those listed on the DRB III(R) are applicable for the vehicle being worked on. The
only monitors that will require attention are those that read "NO" under the OBD "CARB"
Readiness Status screen.
Front Wheel Drive
1. Evaporative Leak Detection Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight
soak either indoors or out depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must be
between 4° and 32° C (40° and 90° F) with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10 ° F) of
ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test screen
on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining requirements.
2. Catalyst Monitor - The vehicle must be driven at highway speeds for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transaxle, use fourth gear to help meet the
requirements.
3. EGR Monitor - It is necessary to maintain TPS, MAP, and RPM ranges listed in the pre-test
screen for this test to complete.
4. O2 Sensor Monitor - The vehicle must be driven and brought to a stop for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. Automatic transaxle vehicles must be left in drive during the stop period.
5. Purge Monitor - To see a similar screen format as listed in Figure 1, press the F1 key on the
DRB III(R) while in the Purge Flow Pre-Test screen. The purge free (PF) cells must update and the
monitor will attempt to run on every other throttle closure. Automatic transaxle vehicles must be left
in drive for the test to run. If all parameters are met and the test still will not run, place your foot on
the brake, open the throttle to 1/4 and then quickly close the throttle. This should allow the PF cells
to update.
6. O2 Sensor Heater Monitor - The open throttle time for the O2 Heater pre-test must be exceeded.
This monitor will run after the ignition key is switched "Off". After the DRB III(R) switches to No
Response (approximately 3 minutes) turn the ignition key "On" and check the O2 Sensor Heater
monitor status. It should have switched to "YES". All other monitors should be completed before
running this test.
Rear Wheel Drive
1. O2 Sensor Heater Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight soak either
indoors or outdoors depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must be between
18° and 38° C (0° and 100° F with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10° F) of
ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test screen
on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
25-02-98 > Oct > 98 > I/M Testing - OBDII CARB Readiness Monitor Information > Page 3506
requirements.
2. Evaporative Leak Detection Monitor - This test will require a cold start (possibly an overnight
soak either indoors or outdoors depending on conditions). The ambient (outside) temperature must
be between 4° and 32° C (40° and 90° F) with the engine coolant temperature within 6° C (10 ° F)
of ambient/battery temperature. Once the above criteria are met, use the pre-test/monitor test
screen on the DRB III(R) to determine the remaining requirements.
3. Catalyst Monitor - The vehicle must be driven at highway speeds for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, use 4th gear to help meet
the requirements.
4. O2 Sensor Monitor - The vehicle must be driven and brought to a stop for the time listed in the
pre-test screen. Automatic transmission vehicles must be left in drive during the stop period.
5. Purge Monitor - To see a similar screen format as listed in Figure 1, press the F1 key on the
DRB III(R) while in the Purge Flow Pre-Test screen. The purge free (PF) cells must update and the
monitor will attempt to run on every other throttle closure. Automatic transmission vehicles must be
left in drive for the test to run. If all parameters are met and the test will still not run, place your foot
on the brake, open the throttle to 1/4 and then quickly close the throttle. This should allow the PF
cells to update.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
182896 > Oct > 96 > PCM - Stumble/Rpm Flare/Low Performance With A/C ON
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Stumble/Rpm
Flare/Low Performance With A/C ON
NO: 18-28-96
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Cold Start Stumble, RPM Flare (MTX), Performance With A/C On, Radiator Steams
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1997 MODELS BUILT PRIOR TO SEPTEMBER 23, 1996 MDH
(09-23-XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
1. Engine stumble within 10 seconds of a cold start. If this condition persists after repair, it is
recommended to change fuel brands.
2. RPM flares slightly when A/C or power steering loads are released, MTX only.
3. Vehicle lacks performance on low speed tip-in with A/C on, more noticeable on ATX vehicles.
Does not improve vehicle launch performance.
4. Radiator "steams" during warm-up.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III) with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are functioning
as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Test the Idle Air Control (IAC) by performing the IAC wiggle test. Select Engine System Test IAC
wiggle test, follow screen prompts. If the IAC wiggle test fails, repair as necessary before
proceeding. If the IAC wiggle test passes and no DTC's are present, perform the Repair Procedure.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
All Symptoms (Flash Programming)
1 CH6000 Scan Tool(DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000 J1962 Cable
1 4669020 Label - Authorized Software Update
1 4275086 Label - Authorized Modification
NOTE:
THE MDS AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM THIS REPAIR AND THE SYSTEM
MUST BE OPERATING WITH RELEASE 20 OR HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1117 OR
HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This repair involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software (calibration changes) for all conditions listed.
1. Connect the MDS (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and power
them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select #2 MDS DIAGNOSTICS on the DRB III MAIN MENU Screen.
3. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
182896 > Oct > 96 > PCM - Stumble/Rpm Flare/Low Performance With A/C ON > Page 3511
4. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS, then
press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING MDS
& DRB III on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
6. Follow the steps presented on the MDS and DRB III which will allow the DRB III to obtain the
current part number of the PCM.
7. The MDS will display the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and the appropriate
replacement part number, then press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
If the PCM on the vehicle has already been updated or programmed, a NO UPDATES AVAILABLE
message will be displayed. Check the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and compare it to the
part number displayed. If the PCM has already been updated, then another condition exists that will
require further diagnosis and repair.
8. The MDS and DRB III will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
programming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" P/N 4669020. Attach
the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the Authorized Modification Label and attach the label near
the VECI Label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-46-92 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-037-05 Date: 051020
Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
NUMBER: 18-037-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 20, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-020-02, DATED JUNE 24, 2002 WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Flash Programming Failure Recovery Using DRBIII(R)
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin provides guidelines, to minimize flash reprogramming problems, and
information on recovery procedures for failed flash attempts.
MODELS:
1992 - 1994 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2003 (AB) Ramvan/Wagon
1992 - 1994 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1995 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 2002 (BRIBE) Ram Pickup
2004 - 2006 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2005 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2005 (KJ) Liberty/Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2003 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2006 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2006 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3517
1995 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
NOTE:
Many of the reasons a flash reprogramming procedure may not complete are documented in this
service bulletin, but if you are constantly having issues performing the flash reprogramming
procedure using a specific DRBIII(R), it is suggested you send the DRBIII(R) in question to
SPX/Miller Special Tools for service.
Occasionally a flash update procedure may not complete properly and/or the diagnostic equipment
may lock up or become disconnected during the procedure. Flash Reprogramming is a "CRITICAL
PROCESS"; an error may result in a no-start/failed control module. Most modules, encountering an
interruption or failure while reprogramming, are recoverable; a recoverable module is not covered
under the provisions of the warranty.
This service bulletin covers items that may cause this condition, a process to restart the flash
procedure, and miscellaneous information that will help prevent needless replacement of control
modules.
GENERAL: Flash Reprogramming is only authorized by a specific SERVICE BULLETIN, or
RECALL.
Review the entire Service Bulletin/Recall prior to performing a flash reprogramming update. Often
other parts may need to be serviced, replaced, or tested, prior to flash reprogramming, and ARE
REQUIRED as part of completing the Service Bulletin/Recall.
When flashing a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or Transmission Control Module (TCM) there
are other legal requirements with labeling issues that are included in those service bulletins.
Other non-emission related modules, such as instrument clusters and Body Control Modules
(BCMs) do not require labels.
FLASH REPROGRAMMING SEQUENCE OF EVENTS
The process of flash reprogramming is similar to flashing the BIOS on a Personal Computer.
Interruptions, voltage problems, and a variety of other outside interactions can potentially interfere
with the process. This document seeks to provide information to minimize problems associated
with vehicle control module flash reprogramming. The description that follows is for most PCMs
and some TCMs. Other modules use different initiation procedures.
The process starts by selecting an update from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS and then
"loading" that update into the DRBIII(R). Once the flash reprogramming update is loaded into the
DRBIII(R), and before the flash reprogramming begins, the DRBIII(R) verifies that the update
loaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS is the proper update for the module. This is done
using part number supersedence. This verification occurs only if an update is required, available
(on the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS) and has been selected for programming.
^ The module is then placed into "Boot Strap" programming mode by the DRBIII(R). This module
mode gives the DRBIII(R) permission and the ability to proceed with the flash reprogramming
session.
^ Next, the current part number, which resides in the module's flash memory, is stored in a "Safe
Memory" location within the module. This memory location is not affected by flash memory erasure
and reprogramming, which are to follow.
^ Once the part number is safely stored, the flash memory in the control module is erased. From
this point forward any interruption in the flash process,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3518
will result in a Non-Responsive module (NR). A NR module is a module that is either partially
erased or partially programmed.
^ After erasure, the actual reprogramming procedure starts, and the update software is
programmed into the flash memory within the module.
^ When reprogramming is completed, the flash memory is verified through an internal process in
the DRBIII(R) using a "Check Sum". This value is compared against another value that represents
what should be in memory and when matched, verifies successful reprogramming.
^ Next, a DRBIII(R) prompt is displayed instructing that the ignition switch be turned OFF. The
module exits the "Boot Strap" mode when the switch is turned off.
^ After a slight pause, the DRBIII(R) will prompt for the ignition switch to be turned ON. The
DRBIII(R) then reads the new part number in flash memory (along with a new computer program
the new part number is placed into the module's memory). If the new part number matches the
expected part number, the flash reprogramming session has completed successfully.
SOFTWARE VERSIONS MUST BE CURRENT
Before attempting a flash reprogramming session using the TechCONNECT Client, make sure you
have the most current DRBIII(R) software installed.
To verify whether your DRBIII(R) software is current, check the upper right-hand corner of the
TechCONNECT Client screen for DRBIII(R) Available Version, DRBIII(R) Current Version.
Often, because of multiple DRBIII(R)s in the shop, not all will get updated on a timely manner. The
installed DRBIII(R) software version can generally be found at the bottom center of most screens.
Alternately the version can be checked by pressing 6, 2, 5 from the DRBIII(R) Main Menu and
comparing it to what is available from a current TechCONNECT Client as described above.
If the TechCONNECT Client is current and the DRBIII(R) is not, it may be due to the fact that the
TechCONNECT Client does not force DRBIII(R) updates for "minor" revisions. Changes and new
support are added to the Vehicle Flash application on "minor" revisions on a regular basis. This is
why your TechCONNECT Client and DRBIII(R) must have the LATEST software revisions
installed.
DO NOT PASS on the option for updating to a "minor" revision!
Major updates require the DRBIII(R) to be updated prior to allowing any flash programming.
DRBIII(R) CABLES
A NEW DRBIII(R) cable was released as an Essential Service Tool! CH7000A - 8 ft.
Cable, DRBIII(R) to OBDII (J1962) DLC Connector.
CH7000A is the required cable for ALL flash reprogramming. The older CH7000 cable can be used
for diagnostics ONLY. One (1) cable was shipped to all dealerships. Easily identified, the correct
cable has a RED connector, which plugs into the DRBIII(R).
The cable modification enhances the DRBIII(R) communication capabilities when dealing with the
flash requirements of certain controllers/ECUs affected in part by the recent changes in DLC
connector configurations.
The new cable is required for ALL flash reprogramming sessions, and can be used wherever the
previous CH700017001 cables were used.
While not recommended for flash reprogramming usage, if you require a longer cable, there is also
a 12-foot cable released under pin CH7001A
The production of the previous CH700017001 cables has ceased. All orders placed will be
superseded to part number CH7000A/CH7001A.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3519
NOTE:
Consider all cables wear items. Always inspect for worn, damaged cables, connectors that are
damaged or do not lock securely, and all mating connections including checking for corrosion on
the pins. REPLACE ALL suspect cables. Do not use worn or damaged cables when flash
reprogramming.
Failure to use the new cable or to use a damaged cable often results in failed flash reprogramming
sessions.
The 2 door Sebring, Stratus, and Avenger coupes (supplied by MMC) generally use the CH7O1O
cable (Pre-OBDII MMC vehicles will use the CH7005 cable).
TechCONNECT CABLE (GPIB)
Replace any suspect GPIB cable.
The GPIB cable provides the connection between TechCONNECT Client and the DRBIII(R).
This cable is used by the TechCONNECT Client for vehicle part number reads and to send update
files to the DRBIII(R).
Inspect this cable for loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If
this cable becomes disconnected during a flash session, you may have to reload the update file
that you selected on the TechCONNECT Client.
TROUBLESHOOTING CONNECTIVITY OF THE DRBIII(R) UNIT TO THE TechCONNECT
APPLICATION.
1. Turn-on the power to the DRBIII(R) unit.
2. Select option 2 "Connect to TechCONNECT" and press Enter.
3. Attach the male mini D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable (part number
CH7035B) to the DRBIII(R) unit.
4. Insure that the larger female D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable is
properly attached to the male D-shell amphenol GPIB connector on the GPIB-USB-B protocol
converter, (part number CHGPIB-B).
5. Attach the USB cable from the GPIB-USB-B protocol converter to one of the USB ports on the
rear panel of the client CPU.
6. When the cable is attached to the USB port of the CPU for the first time, Windows 2000 will
detect the device and install software for it. Please wait for 25-30 seconds to complete the
installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3520
ISIS NULL MODEM CABLE
Replace any suspect null modem cables.
International (ISIS), a PC-based CD program similar to TechCONNECT Client uses a null modem
cable for vehicle part number reads and to send update files to the DRBIII(R). Inspect this cable for
loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If this cable becomes
disconnected during a flash download session, you will have to reload the update file or files.
GENERAL NOTES FOR CABLES AND VEHICLE CONNECTIONS
Consider ALL cables to be wear items.
Many successful dealers have dedicated cables devoted to "Flash ONLY".
Always have spare CH7000A, CH7010 and CH2002 GPIB or null modem cables available.
Inspect vehicle diagnostic connectors for potential problems that might cause communication
interruptions.
There are now clip repair kits available through teamPSE to replace the retaining clips for two of
these cables. To protect the DRBIII(R) from internal damage, the clips are designed to fail at above
25 lbs. of axial force. Kits are described in the table.
It is a good practice to discard cables that have damage to the pins, cuts, corrosion, or general
damage beyond the retaining clips.
ST22 SEBRING STRATUS 2 DOOR COUPES (2001-2005)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3521
These vehicles use MMC based modules. The CH8432 Supplemental Reprogramming Tool (SRT)
was shipped as a 2001 Essential Tool. The flash reprogramming update files will be downloaded
from TechCONNECT Client to the SRT for flash reprogramming sessions on these vehicles. Users
should closely follow the instructions that come with the tool. If the tool has not been initialized,
there is a known condition where it may take up to 5 or more attempts for it to fully initialize and
become functional.
NOTE:
Once it has successfully flashed, it is initialized and no further action is required.
PREPARING TO FLASH
It is highly recommended that a sign, or other process, be used that notifies other users that a
FLASH SESSION IS IN-PROGRESS and must NOT be interrupted. Interrupting some flash
reprogramming sessions at critical junctures can render a module inoperative. Another user may
not realize that a flash session is in-progress and may disturb or disconnect the DRBIII(R) or do
something on the vehicle that could interrupt the flash process.
Before starting the flash session, read, record and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle.
Also "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R) and download the flash since this will erase the flash file from the
DRBIII(R) memory. (To "Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the
same time. Then press "F4").
Be sure to arrange the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R) so that no cables are stretched across an
area where someone might trip over or kick a cable. When setting up your DRBIII(R), insure that it
rests on a surface where it will not fall or be bumped during reprogramming e.g.: DRBIII's have
been known to be swept off vehicle windshields by accident when a user bumps the wiper switch).
Check User settings on the DRBIII(R). From the DRBIII(R) Main menu, press 6,1 and check to
make sure item 1. Echo on PC is set to OFF. On occasion, when Echo on PC is set to ON, flash
reprogramming errors may occur.
VEHICLE BATTERY VOLTAGE
The flash programming procedure puts a load on the electrical system that may last from five to
twenty minutes depending on the particular flash reprogramming update. Connect a battery
charger to the vehicle. Set the charger to as close to 14 volts as possible. If the charger has a
timer, set it for 30 minutes BEFORE starting a flash reprogramming session. This will help to
prevent unwanted resets by either the DRBIII(R) and/or the vehicle module that are caused by
voltage fluctuations.
Alternately, as a bare minimum, use a "Battery Jump Box" when a battery charger is unavailable to
ensure adequate and stable system voltages on the module being flash reprogrammed.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Connected/Disconnected Flash Mode Using TechCONNECT
CONNECTED MODE FLASHING USING TechCONNECT
NOTE:
Capable but not recommended.
In this mode, the DRBIII(R) remains connected to the TechCONNECT Client and the vehicle
throughout the flash session. The DRBIII(R) is connected to the TechCONNECT Client using the
GPIB (CH7035) cable and to the vehicle using the vehicle I/O cable (the CH7000A for most
vehicles).
This mode is useful when the TechCONNECT Client is next to the vehicle being flashed.
Another advantage of this mode is that you are able to determine all available flash updates for the
vehicle you are connected to by clicking on the "Read Part Number(s) From Vehicle" button.
Again, it is important that other users do not attempt to reboot or move the TechCONNECT Client
while a flash update is in-progress.
The reprogramming procedure of this mode is initiated by selecting the controller option and
clicking "Download/Update" button on the TechCONNECT client.
DISCONNECTED FLASH MODE
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3522
This is the preferred method.
This mode allows a user to flash a vehicle without being connected to the TechCONNECT Client.
This is a popular mode for flashing in a remote area of the service garage or in a back lot.
Before you attempt to use this mode, you must configure the DRBIII(R) for the desired update(s).
To do this, you must connect the DRBIII(R) to the TechCONNECT Client using the GPIB cable and
the CH7025 cable. It is not necessary to be connected to a vehicle. The GPIB (CH7035) cable will
be used to communicate with the TechCONNECT Client (for update file downloading) while the
CH7025 cable is used to provide power to the DRBIII(R).
After making the above connections, you are able to select one or more updates that you want to
perform. These selections are made by highlighting the desired updates and then clicking on the
"Download/Update" button by selecting the DRBIII(R) option on the TechCONNECT client.
Obviously, the DRBIII(R) does not have unlimited memory. If the file size of the selected updates
exceeds 948 KB, the "DRB Space Used" indicator (at the bottom-center of the TechCONNECT
Client screen) will change color from GREEN to RED. At this point you must de-select entries until
the indicator changes color to GREEN again.
When the updates have finished downloading, you may disconnect from the TechCONNECT Client
and take the DRBIII(R) to wherever the vehicle is located. The updates will remain in DRBIII(R)
memory for 8 hours while the DRBIII(R) is without power. If the DRBIII(R) is powered up for several
minutes before the 8 hour time period has expired, the update files will remain on the DRBIII(R) for
another 8 hours without power.
To start the actual flash process, after connecting to the vehicle in Disconnected Mode, you must
press "7 - Vehicle Flash" from the Main Menu on the DRBIII(R). Step by step instruction will follow
on the DRBIII(R) display. As with Connected Flash Mode, take the necessary precautions to insure
that others are aware of the flash session and that nothing disturbs the vehicle, DRBIII(R), or
cabling while performing the flash. Remember to use a battery charger set to 14 volts or a "battery
jump box".
Pay Attention While Performing Flash Reprogram Procedures
PAY ATTENTION WHILE PERFORMING FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURES
Before downloading the flash files, double check to see if the files that you have selected are the
appropriate ones for that vehicle. Don't forget about the "Read Part Numbers From Vehicle" option
on TechCONNECT Client, this can be of great assistance when trying to flash a module. If the files
selected don't download on the first attempt, try again.
The technician should NOT leave the vehicle when flash reprogramming a module.
Again, check to make sure that all cable connections are secure and that the DRBIII(R) rests on a
stable surface. If you are using a battery charger, insure that the settings and charging times are
correct and that the battery post clamps are securely fastened.
Read, record, and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle. Read and record the module type and part
number from the module that is to be flash reprogrammed.
Some control modules are not "abort-recovery" capable. When this is true, the scan tool will
indicate so by displaying a WARNING message prior to the start of reprogramming. For these
modules it is especially important that all precautions and procedures, outlined here, are carefully
followed.
Pay special attention to DRBIII(R) screen directions relating to key cycles. Missing a "Key ON" or
"Key OFF" can cause the module to have to be reflashed again. Due to the variety of module types
and vehicle options, you can't always anticipate key prompts, so be alert and ready to respond to
DRBIII(R) instructions.
Some screens will also instruct that certain modules, connectors or fuses be disconnected or pulled
prior to the start of reprogramming and re-installed immediately after completion. Be careful not to
anticipate the steps or order of operations for reprogramming any vehicle modules. Because of the
many possible changes that occur with each new release of scan tool software, always allow the
TSB/Recall and scan tool instructions to be your guide while performing flash reprogramming.
Flash reprogramming sessions usually range from 5 to 20 minutes. If the flash session has not
completed within 25 minutes after starting a flash reprogramming update, an error has most likely
occurred (Record the message that appears on the screen when a failure occurs). If this is the
case, or if you know that the flash process was interrupted, cycle the ignition key (OFF to the
locked position, then back ON). Reset the DRBIII(R) (power down for 4 seconds and then power
up) before attempting to restart the flash process. If the module still won't respond, turn the ignition
key off, disconnect the module from the vehicle for 2 minutes, reconnect the module, turn the
ignition key to run and try to restart the flash process again.
Regardless of what mode that you are in (Connected Flash or Disconnected Flash), if you have
tried twice (2 times) unsuccessfully to do a flash recovery and ALL DRBIII(R) instructions were
followed, perform the following:
^ Cold boot the DRBIII(R). This resets memory and removes all update files from the DRBIII(R).
(Push MORE and YES buttons at the same time, then press F4).
^ Reload the flash update file from the TechCONNECT Client.
^ If it fails to complete in the connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before
re-attempting the flash download to the DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3523
^ Proceed to reflash the module.
On vehicles that have multiple flash updates available, always complete and verify each flash
update before attempting the next one.
After all flash reprogramming is completed, read and erase all DTCs in all modules on the vehicle.
A variety of DTCs may be set, which are usually related to a loss of communication with the
module(s) being reprogrammed.
Verify the update by reading the new part number using the DRBIII(R). A good double check is to
read the part number using DRBIII(R) stand alone.
At times, other modules, wired in parallel, to the DLC connector have prevented flash
reprogramming sessions to be successful. After the failed attempt, review the appropriate wiring
diagram for the vehicle you are flash reprogramming and, with the key "OFF"; disconnect the other
modules and retry the flash. Complete the flash, turn the key "OFF" and reconnect any modules
that were disconnected. Refer to the "Programmable Modules" section later in this document for
more information.
Error Messages
ERROR MESSAGES
Block Echo/Compare Errors
Block Echo and Block Compare errors are often caused by voltage fluctuations, faulty I/O cables
(CH7OOOA, CH7005, CH7010) or faulty communication connections at the diagnostic connector.
Inspect for these conditions and review the sections on Vehicle Battery Voltage and Cable
recommendations.
Checksum Errors
Checksum Errors are generally caused by corrupt flash update files, which can be caused by
DRBIII(R) memory problems. If the DRBIII(R) has been without power for more than 8 hours, the
update files and system memory could be in a corrupted state. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (To
"Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the same time. Then press
"F4"). Reload the flash update file(s) from the TechCONNECT CLIENT. If it fails to complete in the
connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before re-attempting the flash download to
the DRBIII(R). Then re-attempt the flash reprogramming process.
Enhanced and Original Abort Recovery
ENHANCED ABORT RECOVERY
Interruptions in the flash process are one of the main reasons for failed flash sessions and
non-responsive (NR) modules. Interrupting the flash process after the erase phase has started will
leave the control module in a non-functional state.
Generally, but not always, NR modules may be recovered successfully.
Briefly, abort recovery is the process used to get a NR module back to a fully functional state with
the latest software update. The technician should be familiar with the other sections in this
document and follow all DRBIII(R) user prompts carefully.
There are two methods for abort-recovery. The newer method is called "Enhanced Abort
Recovery". This is the preferred method since the original method takes several minutes longer
and requires the correct selection of module type from a list of possible PCM's or TCM's.
Starting with Release 60.1, a new useful feature was added to the flash reprogramming application
for Engine and Transmission control modules. The DRBIII(R) "writes" the YME and Controller Type
information to a "Safe Memory" location. This method allows for rapid recovery of the module part
number and minimizes errors that could otherwise be made by selecting the wrong controller type.
It also assumes that the user will attempt abort recovery for a failed flash attempt before moving to
another vehicle with the same DRBIII(R). If you need to move to another vehicle for flash
reprogramming you must erase the saved recovery information in order to successfully perform
flash reprogramming. Be careful to match the YME information displayed on the enhanced abort
recovery screen with the vehicle and module that you are attempting to recover. If you use the
recovery file on a different vehicle and module you could damage the module.
The recovery information will be displayed on your DRBIII(R), at the start of a flash session, only if
you previously encountered a problem that prevented a flash session from completing normally. If
your prior flash session was successful, the DRBIII(R) automatically erases the recovery file so that
the flash application will not show any recovery information at the start of your next flash session.
Enhanced abort recovery features:
^ Reduces the amount of time for the Module ID process.
^ Lowers the risk of possible user mistakes by presenting the user the Year, Model, Engine, and
Controller Type.
^ Currently only applicable to Engine and Transmission flash reprogramming.
^ The enhanced abort recovery file will only be erased upon a successful flash or manually by the
user.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3524
^ Cold booting (simultaneously pushing MORE & YES, then F4) the DRBIII(R) will not erase the
enhanced abort recovery file, but cold booting the DRBIII(R) will still erase the flash file so it can be
reloaded.
^ The user has a choice, at the start of a flash session, whether or not to use the enhanced abort
recovery feature. If the user chooses to erase the recovery file, then the DRBIII(R) will use the
original method of abort recovery.
^ Cycling the ignition key, when prompted by the DRBIII(R), is still necessary to put the controller
into bootstrap (reprogramming) mode.
ORIGINAL ABORT RECOVERY
If the choice is made to use the original method of abort recovery, a NR module is not always able
to provide the DRBIII with ID information. In this case the technician must enter this when prompted
by the DRBIII(R). Be patient when performing this process. If the module does not respond to
standard diagnostic requests, the DRBIII(R) may take several minutes before it determines that the
engine module is in a NR state. At this point, the DRBIII(R) displays the prompt "Could not
determine engine controller type. Please select from list" along with a list of possible controller
types (if the DRBIII(R) is attempting to identify a TCM, the prompt will say "trans" instead of
"engine" and list the possible trans controller types). Because of module variations, it is important
to correctly identify the PCM/TCM type so that the correct flash procedure is used. Failure to do
this will cause further problems and may damage the module. Tables are provided below to help
identify the proper module type to select. These tables correctly identify the modules that were on
the vehicles when they were built. However, some vehicles will have module types which were
superseded to a new type when a replacement part was installed (ie: EATX4 modules replaced
with an EATX4A). Correctly identify these modules using DRBIII(R) Standalone prior to attempting
flash reprogramming.
NOTE:
When instructed to turn the key to the LOCKED position, be sure that the key is not just turned to
the OFF position. The key must be rotated to the point at which it can be removed from the ignition
switch. On most vehicles the switch is on the steering column and at this position the steering
column is LOCKED. When instructed to turn the key to the RUN position, be careful not to turn the
key past this position which may engage the starter motor. This creates electrical noise which
interferes with the flash process.
General Steps for Abort Recovery
1. Review all Tips and Techniques before continuing. Pay special attention to the section on
Preparing to Flash a controller and to the Programmable Modules section.
2. Cycle the vehicle's ignition key to the LOCKED position and back to the RUN position.
3. Reset the DRBIII(R) by disconnecting the vehicle cable from the DRBIII(R) for 4 seconds and
then reconnecting the cable.
4. Depending on where the flash session was aborted, the DRBIII(R) may require that the
technician identify the control module type that was being flash reprogrammed. Use the PCM/TCM
configuration table below as a guide. This step is not necessary if using the enhanced abort
recovery method.
5. After selecting the proper control module type or choosing enhanced abort recovery, follow the
prompts that are displayed on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
If an error message is displayed at this point, an incorrect module type was most likely selected. If
this occurs, start the process over.
6. If the recovery process is unsuccessful, perform the following:
a. Review the TSB/Recall notice (authorizing the flash update) and all Tips and Techniques in this
document.
b. Reboot/Restart the TechCONNECT Client.
c. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (Press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R) at the same
time, then press F4).
d. Start this process over from item # 1. If using Disconnected Mode, the flash update will have to
be reloaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS DVD.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3525
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3526
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3527
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3528
Programmable Modules
The following pages list the various modules that have flash reprogramming capability. It does not
mean that a flash is currently available. What will be described are the module types and
variations, followed by items to note, and finally, abort recovery specifics if applicable.
Powertrain Modules - Engine and Transmission
ENGINE - POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3529
There are a variety of Engine (PCM) modules that are flash reprogrammable. Suggestions that are
somewhat unique to each type will have comments. Prior to reprogramming a PCM, retrieve the
module information and module type using your DRBII I®. PCM information is used by many
modules. Be sure to check DIG's before and after performing all flash reprogramming event.
The DTC's associated with flash reprogramming generally relate to "lack of communication" with
the other modules during the reprogramming session.
SBEC
Types:
SBEC, SBEC 2, SBEC 3, SBEC 3+, SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+, and SBEC 3B
NOTE:
During recovery, if the DRBIII® is not seeing the key off, you may need to remove power (B+) to
PCM by removing fuse(s) or disconnecting the PCM. When DRBIII® states to turn key ON,
reconnect fuse or harness connection.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow instructions on the DRBIII® for the module type. See table above.
^ Some SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+ AND SBEC 3B may be in a state where they can not correctly
identify a key cycle. In this case a Modified Key Cycle routine is required.
This state is present when the following message is displayed on the DRBIII(R): "Can not read Part
Number. Did not see Key On or PCM/TCM Controller may not be flashable". When this occurs
restart the flash session and when prompted to turn the ignition key to the LOCKED position, pull
the fuse(s) that supply battery power to the module instead. When prompted to turn the key to the
RUN position, replace the battery supply fuse(s) instead.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC, JTEC+
NOTE:
Viper ALL - Roll down windows especially Coupes before attempting a flash.
NOTE:
1999 WJ JTEC with Speed Proportional Steering module. Disconnect before and reconnect after
the PCM flash reprogramming session. Also see Transmission.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC Types:
^ NGC 1, NGC 2, and NGC 3
NOTE:
There are derivatives of NGC 3 that will be significant when reprogramming and or testing. NGC
modules use one of the longest time spans for flash reprogramming (approximately 15 minutes).
The NGCI and NGC3 controllers incorporate both an engine as well as a transmission controller in
a common package. The NGC2 controller incorporates the engine controller and an Electronic
Throttle Control (ETC) module in place of the TCM. All NGC controllers can be visually identified by
noting its four (4) wiring connectors. On manual transmission applications and the NGC2, only 3
connectors may be populated with pins.
NOTE:
On certain vehicles, the ABS CAB module connector MUST be disconnected prior to performing
this Repair Procedure. The CAB module and the PCM are connected at the same diagnostic
connector pin (Pin # 9). Turn ignition switch to the OFF position, disconnect the CAB module
connector, and reprogram the PCM per the Repair Procedure. When reprogramming is complete
turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, connect the CAB module connector, and then check for
DTC's. If the PCM becomes "locked" during reprogramming because the ABS CAB module
connector was not disconnected, then the PCM may be recovered by following the procedure in
this NOTE.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3530
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ Power down the DRBIII(R) then cycle ignition before powering up the DRBIII(R) to attempt the
flash.
CUMMINS
Types:
^ CM551 and CM84x series
NOTE:
Cummins flash reprogrammable PCMs are used on 1998.5 and newer Dodge Trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. Model Year 2000 and earlier vehicles have one Engine
Control Fuse to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). Model Year 2001 and later have two Engine
Control Fuses (one 20 Amp and one 30 Amp) to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). The fuse(s)
are located in the PDC and need to be pulled/removed, when prompted, for at least 10 seconds.
SIEMENS
Types:
^ SIM-70
NOTE:
The SIM-70 is currently used on BUX PL and PG vehicles with a 1.6L ONLY. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
BOSCH
Types:
^ EDC15V, EDC15-C5, and EDC16
NOTE:
While there have been other Bosch modules, the EDC15V is not flash reprogrammable.
Transmission controllers are usually flashed on the vehicle (since 1996).
Technicians may set the pinion factor on "NEW" modules either before or after flash
reprogramming. Suggestions follow.
After flash reprogramming and before returning the vehicle to the customer, always perform a
"QuickLearn" to the TCM.
EATX
Types:
^ EATX, EATX 2, EATX 3, EATX 3A, EATX 3B, EATX 4, and EATX 4A
NOTE:
Table shows which TCM was installed "as-built". Often TCMs are superseded by parts and or a
service bulletin.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ 1999 - 2000 WJ and 2000 AN/DN using 4.7L engines the service replacement EATX4A part
numbers 56041814AD and 56028227AH currently display a P/N read failed error after the flash is
completed during PIN verification. This DOES NOT mean the flash failed. Check for the part
number using DRBIII(R) in standalone mode. This exists only for the service replacement modules
listed above. Flash reprogramming for OE modules flash and read the part number correctly.
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3531
^ NGC1, NGC2, NGC3
NOTE:
The NGC I1and NGC 3 have the EATX/XCORE and Engine modules combined. NGC 2 does not.
Vehicles with automatic transmissions using NGC2 will use an EATX4A.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ 2002 DR, 2002.5 DN, 2003 AN/DN and later with NGC have shown that in some instances the
CAB controller may need to be disconnected when attempting to flash the NGC controller. (This
should only be performed if an error occurs at the very beginning of the TCM flash portion.)
SIEMENS
Types:
^ EG552
NOTE:
EGS52 is used with the A580 automatic transmission WG Grand Cherokees with a 2.7L diesel
engine (BUX), ZH Crossfire and VA Sprinter.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC,JTEC+
NOTE:
Except for the 45RFE, 545RFE, and AW4 automatic transmissions, the JTEC controller also
provides transmission control functions on Dodge trucks and Jeep vehicles. Additionally, they are
used on some Cummins equipped Dodge trucks with manual and automatic transmissions.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
PRE 1996 EATX TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULES
Prior to 1996 there was not a vehicle SCI communication wire going to the FWD EATX controller
only to the PCM. Those vehicle TCMs only communicate to the DRBIII(R) using CCD
communications.
For these FWD vehicles, use the CH5500 kit and CH7025 DIN cable when connecting those
modules to the DRBIII(R) vehicle connector.
For 1992-1993 vehicles, the TCM modules were upgraded to MY1995 software. Because of this
you will need to use the Yellow SuperCard2, CH8361,to set pinion factor or when using a "new"
(superseded) TCM from parts as only the SuperCard2 properly sets the pinion factor on these
updated modules.
Additionally, when flashing or installing P/Ns 4796121, 4796122, 4796123, or 4796124.
The wire from cavity 49 must be removed from the TCM connector, refer to service bulletin
18-24-95.
Types:
^ TCCM
NOTE:
These modules are found on AN, DN, and DR trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3532
NON-POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULES
BODY CONTROL MODULE (BCM)
Types:
^ BCM
NOTE:
Body control modules are found on passenger vehicles.
NOTE:
The following vehicle BCMs support flash reprogramming: CS, JR, KJ, LH, RS, WJ, and ZB.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ BUX ONLY for 2001 JR - Compass/Mini Trip (BCM) Flash - Use special international release
software version 52.25
^ 2001 LH - there is NO abort recovery available for the BCM.
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE (CTM)
Types:
^ CTM
NOTE:
CTMs are found on: AB, AN, DN, BR, and BE trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)
Types:
^ EVIC
NOTE:
02-03 LH & WJ, and 03-04 KJ
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
FRONT CONTROL MODULE (FCM)
Types:
^ FCM
NOTE:
Front control modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (IPM)
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3533
^ 1PM
NOTE:
Integrated power modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
POWER LIFT GATE (PLG)
Types:
^ PLC
NOTE:
Power liftgate modules are found on CS and RS.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (PSDM)
Types:
^ PSDM
NOTE:
Passenger power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. DRIVER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (DSDM)
Types:
^ DSDM
NOTE:
Driver power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NOTE:
When flashing a vehicle that is equipped with both Passenger and Driver Power Sliding Doors, you
must Reboot the DRBIII(R) and cycle the ignition key before flashing the next door module.
DRIVER DOOR MODULE (DDM)
Types:
^ DDM
NOTE:
Driver Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER DOOR MODULE (PDM)
Types:
^ PDM
NOTE:
Passenger Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLUSTERS/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (MIC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3534
Types:
^ MICs, eMICs
NOTE:
MICs that have flash reprogramming are on the following vehicles: DR, JR, KJ, PL, PT, WJ, ZB
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. In certain cases, you will be asked to cycle the ignition key
and pull a specific fuse.
^ The DRBIII(R) may power down during the procedure with some modules. This is NORMAL and
is explained in the user prompts displayed during abort-recovery. Take the time to read and
understand the instructions before proceeding.
ALARM REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE (ARKEM)
Types:
^ ARKEM
NOTE:
Arkem modules are found on PL and PT vehicles. There are up to and after modules.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLIMATE CONTROL (ATC, HVAC)
Types:
^ HVAC, ATC, MTC
NOTE:
Generally, reprogramming for these modules is done using the standalone application rather than
the Vehicle Flash application.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
ADJUSTABLE PEDAL MODULE (APM)
Types:
^ APM
NOTE:
Found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
RAIN SENSOR MODULE (RSM)
Types:
^ RSM
NOTE:RSM modules are found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3535
INTRUSION TRANSCEIVER MODULE (ITM)
Types:
^ ITM
^ Updates for this module, to version 7.05 have involved a coordinated BCM flash update. See the
TSB for important instructions.
NOTE:
ITM modules are found on WJ (BUX) and KJ (BUX) vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEMS (SRS) - AIRBAGS, ETC.
Types:
^ SRS, ORC
NOTE:
While used on most vehicles, only CS, JR, LH, PT, RS, and WJ vehicles have the potential to
support flash updates.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-47-98 > Dec > 98 > PCM - Symptomless Misfire DTC's/MIL ON
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins PCM - Symptomless
Misfire DTC's/MIL ON
NO: 18-47-98
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Dec. 18, 1998
SUBJECT: Symptom less Misfire Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's)
MODELS:
1997 - 1999 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L SOHC/DOHC ENGINE
BUILT PRIOR TO NOV. 3, 1998 (MDH 1103XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may exhibit a condition where the MIL illuminates for misfire but no reasons can be
found for the misfire fault occurrence. In some cases, there may be minor engine roughness on
initial cold engine start-up. Customers may explain the condition as a MIL illumination "only" with
no other symptoms felt or noticed. In many cases the occurrence is experienced on a cold engine
start.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R)) with
the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If non misfire related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If SINGLE or MULTIPLE CYLINDER MIS-FIRE DTC's are present, follow all mis-fire diagnostics
listed in the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual before proceeding with this flash repair. If
no cause for the MIS-FIRE DTC's are found, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER SHOULD BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
EQUIPMENT/PARTS REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 04669020 Label - Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label Authorized Modification
NOTE:
THE MDS AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM THIS REPAIR AND THE SYSTEM
MUST BE OPERATING WITH RELEASE 21 OR HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1175 OR
HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software (calibration changes).
1. Connect the MDS (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS 1 OR MDS 2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU Screen.
3. Select # 1 MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB UPDATE on the DRB III(R).
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS, then
press NEXT MENU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-47-98 > Dec > 98 > PCM - Symptomless Misfire DTC's/MIL ON > Page 3540
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING MDS
& DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS and DRB III(R) which will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS will display the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and the appropriate
replacement part number, then press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
If the PCM on the vehicle has already been updated or programmed, a NO UPDATES AVAILABLE
message will be displayed. Check the part number of the PCM on the vehicle and compare it to the
part number displayed. If the PCM has already been updated, then another condition exists that will
require further diagnosis and repair.
9. The MDS and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
programming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI Label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-40-99 PCM, Reprogram 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
The Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid is located on the Valve Body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3549
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3550
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3551
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3552
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3553
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3554
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3555
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3556
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3557
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3558
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3559
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3560
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3561
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3562
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3563
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3564
Connector Pin-Outs (Part 31 Of 32)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3565
Fuel And Ignition Diagrams (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3566
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
If the solenoid wiring connector is unplugged, the torque converter will not engage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
The Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid is located on the Valve Body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3574
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3575
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3576
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3577
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3578
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3579
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3580
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3581
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3582
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3583
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3584
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3585
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3586
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3587
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3588
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3589
Connector Pin-Outs (Part 31 Of 32)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 3590
Fuel And Ignition Diagrams (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3591
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
If the solenoid wiring connector is unplugged, the torque converter will not engage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Band: Specifications
ADJUSTMENTS:
Kickdown, Backed Off From 8 Nm (72 inch lbs.)
........................................................................................................................................... 2 1/4
Turns Low-Reverse, Backed Off From 5 Nm (41 inch lbs.)
...................................................................................................................................... 3 1/2 Turns
TORQUE:
Kickdown Band Adjustment Locknut
................................................................................................................................................... 47
Nm (35 ft. lbs.) Reverse Band Adjustment Locknut
................................................................................................................................................. 14 Nm
(125 inch lbs.) Reverse Band Shaft Plug .............................................................................................
........................................................................ 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3595
Band: Adjustments
KICKDOWN BAND (FRONT)
The kickdown band adjusting screw is located on left side (top front) of the transaxle case. 1.
Loosen locknut and back-off nut approximately five turns. Test adjusting screw for free turning in
the transaxle case. 2. Using wrench, tighten adjusting screw to 8 Nm (72 inch lbs.). 3. Back-off
adjusting screw 2 1/4 turns. Hold adjusting screw in this position and tighten locknut to 47 Nm (35
ft. lbs.)
LOW/REVERSE BAND (REAR)
To adjust low/reverse band, proceed as follows: 1. Loosen and back off locknut approximately five
turns. 2. Using an inch-pound torque wrench, tighten adjusting screw to 5 Nm (41 inch lbs.) true
torque. 3. Back-off adjusting screw 3 1/2 turns. 4. Tighten locknut to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
Cover Bolts ..........................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) Lower Cover Screw ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................ 41 Nm (30 ft.
lbs.) To Cylinder Block Bolts ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
Rear Cover To Case Screw .................................................................................................................
................................................ 19 Nm (165 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Clutch: Specifications
CLEARANCES:
Front Clutch (Non-Adjustable)*
................................................................................................................................ 1.27 - 2.79 mm
(0.050 - 0.110 inch) Rear Clutch 4 Disc (Adjustable)
............................................................................................................................... 0.71 - 1.10 mm
(0.028 - 0.043 inch)
SELECTIVE SNAP RINGS:
Size 1 ...................................................................................................................................................
...................... 1.22 - 1.27 mm (0.048 - 0.050 inch) Size 2 ..................................................................
....................................................................................................... 1.52 - 1.57 mm (0.060 - 0.062
inch) Size 3 ..........................................................................................................................................
............................... 1.73 - 1.78 mm (0.068 - 0.070 inch) Size 4 .........................................................
................................................................................................................ 1.88 - 1.93 mm (0.074 0.076 inch) Size 5 ................................................................................................................................
......................................... 2.21 - 2.26 mm (0.087 - 0.089 inch)
* NOTE: Measured From Reaction Plate To "Farthest Wave" On A 4 Disc Setup.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3605
Measuring Rear Clutch Plate Clearance
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Carrier Assembly, A/T > Carrier Bearings, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Carrier Bearings: Specifications
Retainer Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
................................................ 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Case, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Differential Case: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 19 Nm (165 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Ring Gear, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Extension Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Extension Housing: Specifications
To Case Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
................................................ 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3627
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3628
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3629
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF+4 Fluid Usage/Applications
NUMBER: 21-010-06
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: April 14, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-004-04, DATED MARCH
16, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3630
2007 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - 2007 (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to AW-4 transmissions, Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire
transmissions, MK/PM vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) and WG
vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a W5J400 or NAG1 transmission
(sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE NOTED ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4 can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4(R) is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3631
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Service Fill ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 3.7L (4.0 Qt) Overhaul with torque converter empty
..............................................................................................................................................................
8.1L (8.6 Qt) Overhaul with torque converter empty (fleet vehicles)
..................................................................................................................................... 8.7L (9.2 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3634
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type Type ............................................................................................................
....................................................... MOPAR ATF +4 Type 9602 or Equivalent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Filter - A/T: Specifications
Mounting Screw ...................................................................................................................................
................................................... 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Line/Hose: Specifications
To Radiator ..........................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) To Transaxle ....................................................
................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm (250
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 19 Nm (165 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications
CLEARANCE:
Outer Gear To Pocket
....................................................................................................................................... 0.045 - 0.141
mm (0.0018 - 0.0056 inch) Outer Gear Side Clearance
................................................................................................................................ 0.020 - 0.046 mm
(0.0008 - 0.0018 inch) Inner Gear Side Clearance
................................................................................................................................ 0.020 - 0.046 mm
(0.0008 - 0.0018 inch)
TORQUE:
To Case Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 31 Nm (275 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3647
Fluid Pump: Description and Operation
The oil pump used is an internal-external gear type design.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Governor: Specifications
Counterweight Screw ..........................................................................................................................
................................................ 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) To Support Bolt ...............................................
........................................................................................................................................ 7 Nm (60
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3651
Governor: Description and Operation
The governor can be serviced by removing the transaxle oil pan and valve body assembly. The
governor can be unbolted from the governor support and removed from the transaxle for
reconditioning or replacement.
When cleaning or assembling the governor, be sure the governor valves move freely in the bores
of the governor body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Input Shaft: Specifications
End Play ..............................................................................................................................................
.......................... 0.19 - 1.50 mm (0.008 - 0.060 inch)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The PRNDL lamp receives power on the E2 circuit from the 4 Amp fuse located in the fuse block in
cavity 12. The fuse receives power from the headlamp switch. Circuit E2 also powers the ash
receiver lamp.
When the headlamp switch is moved to the PARK or ON position, current flows through the fuse to
the PRNDL lamp. The ground for the lamp is supplied on the Z3 circuit, and terminates at the
instrument panel left center support. This circuit is also spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, the
ignition switch lamp, and the glove box lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Output Shaft: Specifications
Gear Strap Bolts ..................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.) Shaft Nut ..........................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 271 Nm (200
ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Pan Gasket - Reusable Design/Installation
Technical Service Bulletin # 21-05-99A Date: 990903
A/T Pan Gasket - Reusable Design/Installation
NUMBER: 21-05-99 Rev. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: Sep. 03, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-05-99 DATED MARCH 5,
1999 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL PARTS AND MODEL
COVERAGE.
SUBJECT: Reusable Automatic Transmission Oil Pan Gasket
OVERVIEW: This bulletin announces availability and installation of a reusable automatic
transmission oil pan gasket.
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
**1989** - 1993 (AG) Daytona
**1989** - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron Convertible
**1989** - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati TC
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1993 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - **2000** (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - **2000** (GS) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - **2000** (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
**1993 - 2000 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/New Yorker/LHS/Vision/300M**
1996 - **2000** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon**
**1997 - 2000 (PR) Prowler**
DISCUSSION:
A reusable silicone gasket has been developed to replace the RTV method of sealing the
automatic transmission oil pan. Due to more frequent Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) change
intervals and the possibility of the fluid foaming if it comes in contact with uncured RTV it is
recommended that this gasket be used in all applications.
NOTE:
THIS GASKET CAN BE REUSED UP TO THREE (3) TIMES.
PARTS REQUIRED:
**1 05011113AA Gasket, Transmission Oil Pan, 31TH**
**1 05011114AA Gasket, Transmission Oil Pan, 42LE**
1 05011115AA Gasket, Transmission Oil Pan, 41TE/AE
POLICY: INFORMATION ONLY
POLICY: Information Only
Installation Procedure
1. With oil pan removed from transmission case for routine service or transmission repair proceed
to step # 2.
2. Clean any residue from oil pan and magnet.
3. Replace O-ring and filter on bottom of valve body.
4. Using a plastic or wooden scraper, remove old RTV from transmission case rails.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Pan Gasket - Reusable Design/Installation > Page 3673
CAUTION:
ALUMINUM COMPONENTS ARE VERY SUSCEPTABLE TO METAL TRANSFER WHEN OLD
GASKET MATERIAL IS REMOVED FROM THEM. USE EXTREME CARE WHEN CLEANING
THESE COMPONENTS.
5. Apply thin coat of transmission fluid to oil pan and transmission case pan rails.
6. Orient reusable gasket properly with bolt holes and assemble oil pan and gasket to transmission
case. Tighten oil pan bolts to 19 Nm (165 in lbs.).
7. Refill transmission to the proper level with MOPAR ATF + 3 Type 7176, p/n 05010124AA, or
MOPAR ATF +4 Type 9602, p/n 05013457AA, for 1999 JA/LH/PR vehicles.
CAUTION:
DO NOT OVERFILL TRANSAXLE. DO NOT ADD OIL IF LEVEL IS BETWEEN: LOWER HOLES
FOR WARM OIL (100°F). UPPER HOLES FOR HOT OIL (180°F.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3674
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
NOTE: The pump oil seal can be replaced without removing the pump and reaction shaft support
assembly from the transaxle case.
REMOVAL
Screw seal remover Tool C-3981-B, or equivalent into seal, then tighten screw portion of tool to
withdraw the seal.
INSTALLATION
To install a new seal, place seal in opening of the pump housing (lip side facing inward). Using Tool
C-4193 and Handle Tool C-4171, or equivalents, drive new seal into housing until tool bottoms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3679
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3680
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Shift Interlock Cable: Service and Repair Removal
1. Disconnect and isolate, the battery negative (-) cable from the vehicle battery. 2. Remove
console assembly.
3. Remove the gearshift knob set screw and knob.
4. Remove the screws retaining the gearshift indicator bezel and remove bezel and indicator lamp.
5. Pry up the adjuster lock on the shifter/ignition interlock cable. Unsnap the shifter/ignition interlock
cable end fitting from the groove in the
gearshift mechanism.
6. Remove the cable core end from the plastic cam of the shifter mechanism. 7. Pull cable up and
out of the gearshift mechanism.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3686
8. Remove the three screws along the bottom of the lower steering column cover and screw on the
left outward face of cover. 9. Grasp the cover and pull rearward until the clips disengage.
10. Remove two screws at the upper area of the column liner and lower left corner. 11. Remove
steering column cover and steering column cover liner. 12. Lift up the top cover and cluster bezel
until the clips disengage and separate to provide clearance.
13. Insert a screwdriver into access hole in the lower shroud. Depress the cylinder button while
rotating the cylinder with the key inserted between the
ON and START positions. This will disengage the cylinder from the column.
14. Pull out the key cylinder.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3687
15. Remove the three lower-to-upper shroud attaching screws through the bottom of the lower
shroud. 16. Separate the upper and 1ower shrouds.
17. Grasp the interlock cable clip and connector. Remove the cable from the interlock housing. 18.
Unclip the cable from the retaining clip located within the wiring harness. 19. Remove interlock
cable from under center console mounting bracket and out front of dash panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3688
Shift Interlock Cable: Service and Repair Installation
CAUTION: When installing interlock cable assembly, care must be taken not to bend exposed
cable wire and slug at shifter end of cable.
1. Route interlock cable into lower dash panel. 2. Install the ignition switch into housing. Turn the
ignition switch to the RUN position.
3. Install the interlock cable into the interlock housing at the steering column. Verify the cable snaps
into the housing. 4. Install interlock cable into routing clip located within the wiring harness. 5.
Route interlock cable to the console. 6. Install the cable core end to the plastic cam of the shifter
mechanism. Snap the shifter/ignition interlock cable end fitting into the groove in the
gearshift mechanism.
7. Adjust the Shifter/Ignition Interlock System. 8. Perform the Shifter/Ignition Interlock System
operation check. 9. Install console assembly.
10. Install screws retaining the gearshift indicator bezel and install bezel and indicator lamp. 11.
Install the gearshift knob set screw and knob. 12. Install two screws at the upper area of the
column liner and lower left corner. 13. Snap the clips in at the lower column cover. Install the three
screws along the bottom of the lower steering column cover and screw on the left
outward face of cover.
14. Install key cylinder. 15. Position the shrouds in place. Install the three lower-to-upper shroud
attaching screws through the bottom of the lower shroud. 16. Reinstall the ignition lock cylinder into
housing. 17. Reconnect the battery negative (-) cable to the vehicle battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3689
Shift Interlock Cable: Service and Repair Adjustment
If ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position, with shifter in PARK, an adjustment of the
Interlock System may be required. To adjust Shifter/Ignition Interlock System, follow procedure
listed below:
1. Disconnect and isolate, the battery negative (-) cable from the vehicle battery. 2. Remove
console assembly. 3. Remove the gearshift knob set screw and knob. 4. Remove the screws
retaining the gearshift indicator bezel and remove bezel and indicator lamp. 5. Reinstall the
gearshift knob. 6. Place shifter in PARK. 7. Turn ignition switch to the LOCK or ACCESSORY
position. If cable has lost its adjustment, manually position cable to get key into LOCK or
ACCESSORY position. Grasp slug on interlock cable with needle nose pliers and pull back on
cable. This will allow the ignition switch to be turned to the LOCK or ACCESSORY position.
8. Check that the interlock cable slug is completely seated into the shifter interlock lever. 9. Check
that the ignition switch is still in the LOCK or ACCESSORY position.
10. Pry up the adjuster lock on the shifter/ignition interlock cable.
11. Place a 1 mm (0.040) shim between the larger diameter portion of the shifter gate pin and the
plastic cam. 12. The spring on the interlock cable should automatically compensate for the slack in
the adjuster. 13. Then snap the interlock adjuster lock onto the cable, and remove the shim. 14.
After adjusting the interlock system, perform the Interlock System Operation Check.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation
The transaxle is controlled by a lever type gearshift incorporated within the console. The control
has six selector lever positions: P (Park), R (Reverse), N (Neutral), and D (Drive), 2 (Second), and
1 (First). The parking lock is applied by moving the selector lever past a gate to the (P) position. Do
not apply the parking lock until the vehicle has stopped; otherwise, a severe banging noise will
occur.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3693
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove console assembly.
2. Remove the gearshift knob set screw and knob. 3. Remove the screws retaining the gearshift
indicator bezel and remove bezel and indicator lamp.
4. Using a flat-blade pry tool, remove the shifter cable end from the gearshift pin. 5. Pry the two
tabs on the cable conduit end away from the gearshift mechanism and pull up on the cable.
Remove the gearshift cable from the
gearshift mechanism.
6. Pry up the adjuster lock on the shifter/ignition interlock cable. Unsnap the shifter/ignition interlock
cable end fitting from the groove in the
gearshift mechanism. Remove the cable core end from the plastic cam of the shifter mechanism.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3694
7. Remove the nuts at the base of the gearshift mechanism. Remove the shifter mechanism.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse removal steps. Refer to Gearshift Cable Adjustment for proper cable
adjustment procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Cable: Specifications
To Case Bolt ........................................................................................................................................
............................................... 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) Manual Control Lever Screw
..............................................................................................................................................................
12 Nm (105 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3699
Shift Cable: Adjustments
1. Set parking brake, then remove floor console. 2. Place gear selector lever in (P) park position,
then unsnap collar at shifter cable. 3. Move gear selector lever on transaxle to park position, then
verify that both shifter lever and transaxle are in park position.
4. Rotate collar on shift cable adjuster until it seats against plastic housing, Fig.4. Collar must seat
against plastic housing to achieve required detent
lock position.
5. Inspect adjustment as follows:
a. Detent position for neutral and drive should be within limits of hand lever gate stops. b. Key start
must occur only when shift lever is in neutral or park positions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3700
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect both battery cables. 2. Pull up and remove the power distribution center. 3. Remove
the battery thermo-guard. 4. Remove the battery and battery holddown from the battery tray. 5.
Remove the battery tray and cruise control servo (if equipped).
6. Remove the screw from the cable bracket at the transaxle. 7. Squeeze the three metal tabs in
and remove the cable from the bracket. 8. Remove the floor console.
9. Remove the gearshift knob set screw and knob.
10. Remove gearshift indicator lamp at shifter bezel.
11. Remove the screws retaining the shifter bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3701
12. Using a flat-blade pry tool, remove the shifter cable core end from the shift lever pin. 13. Using
a small screwdriver, pry the cable conduit end tabs away from the shifter mechanism. Pull up on
the conduit end and slide the end out of the
gearshift mechanism.
14. Remove the three nuts retaining the shift cable grommet plate to the floor pan. 15. Hoist
vehicle.
16. Remove the one screw at the shift cable grommet plate. 17. Loosen screws on shift cable
grommet plate. Slide plate out and away from heat shield. 18. Carefully remove the cable from the
underbody by unfolding the cable retainer clip as you go along.
INSTALLATION
1. To install gearshift cable, reverse removal procedure. 2. Adjust gearshift cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Specifications
To Transaxle Case Bolt .......................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) Throttle Lever To Transaxle Shaft Bolt
.............................................................................................................................................. 12 Nm
(105 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3705
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments
The throttle pressure cable adjustment is very important to proper transaxle operation. This
adjustment positions a valve which controls shift speed, shift quality, and part throttle downshift
sensitivity. If the setting is too long, early shifts and slippage between shifts may occur. If the
setting is too short, shifts may be delayed and part throttle downshifts may be very sensitive.
1. Perform transaxle throttle pressure cable adjustment while engine is at normal operating
temperature. 2. Release cross-lock on the cable assembly (pull cross-lock upward). 3. To ensure
proper adjustment, the cable must be free to slide all the way toward the engine, against its stop,
after the cross-lock is released. 4. Move transaxle throttle control lever fully clockwise, against its
internal stop, and press cross-lock downward into locked position.
The adjustment is complete and transaxle throttle cable backlash was automatically removed.
Test cable freedom of operation by moving the transaxle throttle lever forward counterclockwise).
Then slowly release it to confirm it will return fully rearward (clockwise).
No lubrication is required for any component of the throttle cable system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3706
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Unsnap the throttle pressure cable end at the throttle control lever at transaxle.
2. Squeeze the retaining tabs inward at the mounting bracket. Remove the cable from the bracket.
3. Unsnap the cable end from the throttle linkage cam. Squeeze the tabs inward at the bracket.
Remove the cable from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
To install cable, reverse removal procedure. Then adjust using the following procedure:
Adjustment Procedure The throttle pressure cable adjustment is very important to proper transaxle
operation. This adjustment positions a valve that controls shift speed, shift quality, and part throttle
downshift sensitivity. If the setting is too long, early shifts and slippage between shifts may occur. If
the setting is too short, shifts may be delayed and part throttle downshifts may be very sensitive. 1.
Perform transaxle throttle pressure cable adjustment while engine is at normal operating
temperature. 2. Release cross-lock on the cable assembly (pull cross-lock upward) See illustration.
3. To insure proper adjustment, the cable must be free to slide all the way toward the engine,
against its stop, after the cross-lock is released.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3707
4. Move transaxle throttle control lever fully clockwise, against its internal stop, and press
cross-lock downward into locked position.
The adjustment is complete and transaxle throttle cable backlash was automatically removed.
Test cable freedom of operation by moving the transaxle throttle lever forward (counterclockwise).
Then slowly release it to confirm it will return fully rearward (clockwise).
No lubrication is required for any component of the throttle cable system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter: Specifications
Outer Diameter ....................................................................................................................................
................................................ 241 mm (9.48 inches)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch: Description and Operation
A torque converter clutch is standard on all vehicles. The torque converter clutch is activated only
in direct drive and is controlled by the engine electronics. A solenoid on the valve body, is powered
by the powertrain control module to activate the torque converter clutch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
The Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid is located on the Valve Body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3719
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3720
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3721
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3722
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3723
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3724
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3725
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3726
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3727
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3728
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3729
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3730
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3731
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3732
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3733
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3734
Connector Pin-Outs (Part 31 Of 32)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3735
Fuel And Ignition Diagrams (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3736
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
If the solenoid wiring connector is unplugged, the torque converter will not engage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Cooler: Specifications
Hose Clamps .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3740
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation
Oil coolers are internal oil to coolant type, mounted in the radiator lower tank. Rubber oil lines feed
the oil cooler and the automatic transmission. Use only approved transmission oil cooler hose.
Tighten Oil Cooler Hose Clamps to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.).
NOTE: Since these are molded to fit space available, molded hoses are recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3741
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair
FLUSHING COOLERS AND TUBES
When a transaxle failure has contaminated the fluid, the oil cooler (s) must be flushed. The cooler
bypass valve in the transaxle must be replaced also. The torque converter must also be replaced
with an exchange unit. This will insure that metal particles or sludged oil are not later transferred
back into the reconditioned (or replaced) transaxle.
There are two different procedures for flushing coolers and lines. The recommended procedure is
to use Tool 6906 Cooler Flusher, or equivalent. The other procedure is to use a hand suction gun
and mineral spirits.
WARNING: Wear protective eye-wear that meets the requirements of OSHA and ANSI Z87.1-1968. wear
standard industrial rubber gloves.
- Keep lighted cigarettes, sparks, flames, and other ignition sources away from the area to prevent
the ignition of combustible liquids and gases. Keep a class (B) fire extinguisher in the area where
the flusher will be used.
- Keep the area well ventilated.
- Do not let flushing solvent come in contact with your eyes or skin: if eye contamination occurs,
flush eyes with water for 15 to 20 seconds. Remove contaminated clothing and wash affected skin
with soap and water. Seek medical attention.
Cooler Flush Using Tool 6906, or Equivalent 1. Remove cover plate filler plug on Tool 6906, or
equivalent. Fill reservoir 1/2 to 3/4 full of fresh flushing solution. Flushing solvents are
petroleum based solutions generally used to clean automatic transmission components. DO NOT
use solvents containing acids, water, gasoline, or any other corrosive liquids.
2. Reinstall filler plug on Tool 6906, or equivalent. 3. Verify pump power switch is turned OFF.
Connect red alligator clip to positive (+) battery post. Connect black (-) alligator clip to a good
ground.
4. Disconnect the cooler lines at the transmission.
NOTE: When flushing transmission cooler and lines, ALWAYS reverse flush.
5. Connect the BLUE pressure line to the OUTLET (From) cooler line. 6. Connect the CLEAR
return line to the INLET (To) cooler line 7. Turn pump ON for two to three minutes to flush cooler(s)
and lines. Monitor pressure readings and clear return lines. Pressure readings should
stabilize below 20 psi. for vehicles equipped with a single cooler and 30 psi. for vehicles equipped
with dual coolers. If flow is intermittent or exceeds these pressures, replace cooler.
8. Turn pump OFF. 9. Disconnect CLEAR suction line from reservoir at cover plate. Disconnect
CLEAR return line at cover plate, and place it in a drain pan. 10. Turn pump ON for 30 seconds to
purge flushing solution from cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF. 11. Place CLEAR suction line into a
one quart container of MOPAR type 9602 automatic transmission fluid, or equivalent. 12. Turn
pump ON until all transmission fluid is removed from the one quart container and lines. This purges
any residual cleaning solvent from
the transmission cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF.
13. Disconnect alligator clips from battery. Reconnect flusher lines to cover plate, and remove
flushing adapters from cooler lines.
Cooler Flush Using Suction Gun And Mineral Spirits 1. Disconnect the cooler lines at the
transmission. 2. Using a hand suction gun filled with mineral spirits, reverse flush the cooler. Force
mineral spirits into the From Cooler line of the cooler and
catch the exiting spirits from the To Cooler line. Observe for the presence of debris in the exiting
fluid. Continue until fluid exiting is clear and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3742
free from debris.
3. Using compressed air (under 40 psi) in intermittens spurts, blow any remaining mineral spirits
from the cooler, again in the reverse direction. 4. Pump one (1) quart of automatic transmission
fluid through the cooler before reconnecting. 5. If at any stage of the cleaning process, the cooler
does not freely pass fluid, the cooler must be replaced.
OIL COOLER FLOW CHECK
After the new or repaired transmission has been installed and filled, the oil cooler flow should be
checked using the following procedure: 1. Disconnect the From Cooler line at the transmission and
place a collecting container under the disconnected line. 2. Run the engine at curb idle speed, with
the shift selector in NEUTRAL. 3. If the fluid flow is intermittent or takes more than 20 seconds to
collect one quart, the cooler should be replaced.
CAUTION: With the fluid set at the proper level, fluid collection should not exceed (1) quart, or
internal damage to the transmission may occur.
4. If flow is found to be within acceptable limits, reconnect the cooler line. Then fill transaxle to the
proper level, using the approved type of
automatic transmission fluid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3749
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3750
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure
Test Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations
31TH Transmission
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Body: Specifications
To Case Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) Valve Body Screw ...........................................
........................................................................................................................................ 5 Nm (45
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3757
Valve Body: Diagrams
Steel Ball Locations
Pressure Regulators And Manual Controls
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3758
Governor Controls
Pressure Regulator Valve Plugs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3759
Shift Valves And Shuttle Valve
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly
Valve Body: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Detent Spring Attaching Screw And Spring
Using Tool L-4553 On Valve Body Screw
Remove Or Install Valve Body Screws
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3762
Transfer Plate And Separator Plate
Steel Ball Locations
Remove Or Install Throttle Shaft E-Clip
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3763
Throttle Shaft E-Clip, Washer, And Seal
Manual Valve Lever Assembly
Throttle Valve Lever Assembly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3764
Manual Valve
Pressure Regulator And Adjusting Screw Bracket
Pressure Regulators And Manual Controls
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3765
Governor Controls
Pressure Regulator Valve Plugs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3766
Shift Valves And Shuttle Valve
NOTE: Tighten all valve body screws to 5 Nm (40 inch lbs.).
Do not clamp any portion of valve body or transfer plate in a vise. Any slight distortion of the
aluminum body or transfer plate will result in sticking valves, excessive leakage, or both. When
removing or installing valves or plugs, slide them in or out carefully. Do not use force.
NOTE: Tag all springs as they are removed for reassembly identification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3767
Valve Body: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
Allow all parts to soak a few minutes in a suitable clean solvent. Wash thoroughly and blow dry with
compressed air. Be sure all passages are clean and free from obstructions.
Inspect manual and throttle valve operating levers and shafts for being bent, worn or loose. If a
lever is loose on its shaft, it should be replaced. Do not attempt to straighten bent levers.
Inspect all mating surfaces for burrs, nicks and scratches. Minor blemishes may be removed with
crocus cloth. using only a very light pressure. Using a straightedge. inspect all mating surfaces for
warpage or distortion. Slight distortion may be corrected, using a surface plate. Be sure all
metering holes in steel plate are open. Using a penlight, inspect bores in valve body for scores,
scratches, pits, and irregularities.
Inspect all valve springs for distortion and collapsed coils. Inspect all valves and plugs for burrs,
nicks, and scores. Small nicks and scores may be removed with crocus cloth, providing extreme
care is taken not to round off sharp edges. The sharpness of these edges is vitally important. It
prevents foreign matter from lodging between valve and valve body. This reduces the possibility of
sticking. Inspect all valves and plugs for freedom of operation in valve body bores.
When bores, valves, and plugs are clean and dry, the valves and plugs should fall freely in the
bores. The valve body bores do not change their dimensions with use. Therefore, a valve body that
was functioning properly when vehicle was new, will operate correctly if it is properly and
thoroughly cleaned. There is no need to replace a valve body unless it is damaged in handling.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3768
Valve Body: Service and Repair 31TH 3-Speed
Cleaning and Inspection
CLEANING AND INSPECTION
1. Allow all parts to soak a few minutes in a suitable clean solvent. Wash thoroughly and blow dry
with compressed air. Make sure all passages are
clean and free from obstructions.
2. Inspect manual and throttle valve operating levers and shafts for being bent, worn or loose. If a
lever is loose on its shaft, it should be replaced. Do
not attempt to straighten bent levers.
3. Inspect all mating surfaces for burrs, nicks and scratches. Minor blemishes may be removed with
crocus cloth, using only a very light pressure.
Using a straightedge, inspect all mating surfaces for warpage or distortion. Slight distortion may be
corrected, using a surface plate. Make sure all metering holes in steel plate are open. Using a pen
light, inspect bores in valve body for scores scratches, pits and irregularities.
4. Inspect all valve springs for distortion and collapsed coils. Inspect all valves and plugs for burrs,
nicks, and scores. Small nicks and scores may be
removed with crocus cloth, providing extreme care is taken not to round off sharp edges. The
sharpness of these edges is vitally important because it prevents foreign matter from lodging
between valve and valve body, thus reducing possibility of sticking. Inspect all valves and plugs for
freedom of operation in valve body bores.
5. When bores, valves, and plugs are clean and dry, the valves and plugs should fall freely in the
bores. The valve body bores do not change
dimensionally with use. Therefore, a valve body that was functioning properly when vehicle was
new, will operate correctly if it is properly and thoroughly cleaned. There is no need to replace
valve body unless it is damaged in handling.
6. Installation is the reverse of removal. Tighten all valve body screws to 5 Nm (40 in.lbs.). Fill
transaxle to the proper level with ATF.
Overhaul
VALVE BODY RECONDITION
NOTE: Prior to removing any transaxle subassemblies, plug all openings and thoroughly clean
exterior of the unit, preferably by steam. Cleanliness through entire disassembly and assembly
cannot be overemphasized. When disassembling, each part should be washed in a suitable
solvent, then dried by compressed air. Do not wipe parts with shop towels. All mating surfaces in
the transaxles are accurately machined; therefore, careful handling of all parts must be exercised
to avoid nicks or burrs. Remove all old R.T.V. sealant before applying new R.T.V. sealant. Use only
R.T.V. sealant when installing oil pan.
Oil Pan Bolts
Oil Pan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3769
1. Remove or install neutral starting and back-up lamp switch.
Oil Filter Screws
Oil Filter
Parking Rod E-Clip
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3770
Parking Rod
Valve Body Attaching Bolts
Valve Body And Governor Tubes
CAUTION: Do not clamp any portion of valve body or transfer plate in a vise. Any slight distortion of
the aluminum body or transfer plate will result in sticking valves, excessive leakage, or both. When
removing or installing valves or plugs, slide them in or out carefully. Do not use force.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3771
Detent Spring Attaching Screw And Spring
WARNING: Tag all springs as they are removed for reassembly identification.
Valve Body Screws
Valve Body Screws
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3772
Transfer Plate And Separator Plate
Steel Ball Locations
Throttle Shaft E-Clip
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3773
E-Clip, Washer And Oil Seal
Manual Valve Lever And Assembly
Throttle Valve Lever And Assembly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3774
Manual Valve
Pressure Regulator And Adjusting Screw Bracket
Pressure Regulators And Manual Controls
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3775
Governor Plugs
Pressure Regulator Valve Plugs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly and Assembly > Page 3776
Shift And Shuttle Valve
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Cable > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Clutch Cable: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The clutch cable has a unique self-adjuster mechanism built into the cable which compensates for
clutch disc wear. The cable requires no maintenance or lubrication. There are no serviceable
components on the cable assembly.
DESCRIPTION
The manual transaxle clutch release system has a unique self-adjusting mechanism to compensate
for clutch disc wear. This adjuster mechanism is located within the clutch cable assembly. The
preload spring maintains tension on the cable. This tension keeps the clutch release bearing
continuously loaded against the fingers of the clutch cover assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Cable > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3781
Clutch Cable: Adjustments
NOTE: The manual transaxle clutch release system has a unique self-adjusting mechanism to
compensate for clutch disc wear. This adjuster mechanism is located within the clutch cable
assembly. The preload spring maintains tension on the cable. This tension keeps the clutch release
bearing continuously loaded against the fingers of the clutch cover assembly.
ADJUSTER MECHANISM FUNCTION CHECK
1. With slight pressure, pull the clutch release lever end of the cable to draw the cable taut. Push
the clutch cable housing toward the dash panel.
With less than 25 lbs. of effort the cable housing should move 30 - 50 mm. This indicates proper
adjuster mechanism function. If the cable does not adjust, determine if the mechanism is properly
seated on the bracket.
2. If the adjust mechanism functions properly, guide the cable through the slot in the transaxle
housing. Connect cable to release lever, seating the
cupped washer securely on lever tangs.
3. Pull back on clutch cable housing and insert into transaxle housing. 4. Reinstall cable inspection
cover and air cleaner assembly. Check clutch pedal position switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Cable > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3782
Clutch Cable: Service and Repair
CLUTCH CABLE The manual transaxle clutch release system has a unique self-adjusting
mechanism to compensate for clutch disc wear. This adjuster mechanism is located within the
clutch cable assembly. The preload spring maintains tension on the cable. This tension keeps the
clutch release bearing continuously loaded against the fingers of the clutch cover assembly.
REMOVAL 1. Pull up and remove Power Distribution Center. 2. Remove transaxle splash cover. 3.
Pun back on clutch cable housing and disengage cable from housing. 4. Guide cable through slot
in transaxle and disconnect cable from release lever. 5. Disconnect clutch cable from clutch pedal
up- stop/spacer
Note: Depressing the clutch pedal provides access to the clutch cable strand. Disconnect the cable
end from the spacer by inserting a hooked tool into the clearance hole on the inboard side of the
up-upstop/spacer. Now push the cable out- ward. Remove the upstop/spacer by inserting a
screwdriver between the spacer and the shoulder of the pin on the clutch pedal.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the clutch cable housing to move It from the dash panel. Damage to the
cable if adjuster may occur.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Cable > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3783
6. Cable End Removal:Use a slight twisting motion while grasping the grommet and body to
remove the cable from the dash panel and clutch
bracket. a screwdriver may be required to dislodge the cable grommet from the dash panel. Use
caution to avoid damage to the cable grommet.
INSTALLATION: 1. Using a slight twisting motion, insert the self adjuster mechanism end of the
clutch cable through the dash panel hole and into the bracket 2. Seat the 8mm wide groove on the
cable grommet in the dash panel. Make sure the self adjuster is firmly seated against the clutch
bracket to ensure
proper adjuster mechanism function.
3. Connect the clutch cable to the up-step/spacer. 4. Connect the up-stop/spacer to the clutch
pedal. 5. Adjuster mechanism function check: With slight pressure, pull the clutch release lever end
of the cable to draw the cable taut. Push the clutch cable
housing toward the dash panel (With less than 15 lbs. of effort the cable housing should move
30-50mm). This indicates proper adjuster mechanism function. If the cable does not adjust,
determine if the mechanism is properly seated on the bracket.
6. If the adjust mechanism functions properly, guide the cable through the slot in the transaxle
housing. Connect cable to release lever, seating the
cupped washer securely on lever tangs.
7. Pull back on clutch cable housing and insert into transaxle housing. 8. Reinstall splash cover and
Power Distribution Center. Check clutch pedal position switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Clutch Disc: Description and Operation
The clutch disc has cushion springs riveted to the disc hub assembly. The clutch disc facings are
riveted to the cushion springs. The facings are made from a non-asbestos material.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Clutch Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................ DOT3 Brake Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component Information
> Specifications
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Specifications
Pivot Shaft Nut .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 3794
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Description and Operation
The clutch pedal is connected to the cable through a plastic spacer. The upper end of the clutch
pedal pivots in the pedal bracket on two nylon bushings and a shaft. These bushings do not require
periodic lubrication.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch pedal position switch functions as a safety interlock device. It prevents possible engine
cranking with the clutch engaged.
The clutch pedal position switch is wired in series between the starter relay coil and the ignition
switch.
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3798
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRICAL TEST
Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness from instrument panel wiring harness. Using an
ohmmeter, check for continuity between the two terminals in the connector on the switch harness.
There should be no continuity between the terminals when the switch is in its normal (fully
extended) position. When the switch is depressed more than 1.25 mm (0.050 inch), the ohmmeter
should show continuity (zero ohms).
If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch is defective, and must be replaced.
MECHANICAL TEST
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN NEUTRAL, turn the key to the start position. The vehicle
should not crank. If the vehicle cranks, the switch is defective (shorted out) and must be replaced.
If the vehicle does not crank proceed to the next step.
WARNING: Before performing this step, be sure that the area in front of the vehicle is clear of
obstructions and people. Vehicle may move when performing this test.
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN GEAR, turn the key to the start position and hold it there.
Slowly depress the clutch pedal and feel for any vehicle motion when the starter is energized. If
there is no motion the switch is working properly.
If motion is felt, check to see if the switch is making contact when the pedal is between 25 mm (1.0
inch) and 6 mm (0.25 inch) from the floor. If this condition is met, then the problem is either the
clutch or the self-adjusting cable. If this condition is not met, then the switch mounting tab on the
brake bracket is bent, and the brake bracket must be replaced.
If vehicle will not crank, even with clutch pedal pressed to the floor, refer to illustrated chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3799
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3800
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
NOTES:
^ The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
^ The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical harness to switch connector. 2. Depress wing tabs on switch and push
switch out of mounting bracket. Then slide wires through slot in bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide switch wires through slot in switch bracket. 2. Line up switch tab with slot in switch bracket
and push switch into position. Do not pull on the switch wires to seat switch into bracket, switch
damage may occur.
3. Attach switch wiring harness to vehicle wiring harness. 4. After installation, the switch must be
checked for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Release Bearing: Description and Operation
A sleeve-type release bearing is used to engage and disengage the clutch cover pressure plate.
The bearing is prelubed during manufacture and is a sealed unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3804
Clutch Release Bearing: Service and Repair
NOTE: Remove the transaxle from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Move the lever and bearing assembly to a vertical in-line position. Grasp the release lever with
two hands in the pivot stud socket area. Pull with
even pressure and the lever will pop off the pivot-stud. Do not use a screwdriver or pry bar to pop
off the lever. This may damage the spring clip on the lever.
2. As a unit, remove the fork from the bearing thrust plate. Be careful not to damage retention tabs
on bearing. 3. Examine the condition of the bearing. It is pre-lubricated and sealed and should not
be immersed in oil or solvent. 4. The bearing should turn smoothly when held in the hand under a
light thrust load. A light drag caused by the lubricant fill is normal. If the bearing
is noisy, rough, or dry, replace the complete bearing assembly with a new bearing.
5. Check the condition of the pivot stud spring clips on back side of clutch fork. If the clips are
broken or distorted, replace the clutch fork.
INSTALLATION
1. The pivot ball pocket in the fork is Teflon coated and should be installed WITHOUT any lubricant
such as grease. Using grease will break down
the Teflon coating. Be sure the ball stud and fork pocket are clean of contamination and dirt.
2. Assemble the fork to the bearing. The small pegs on the bearing must go over the fork arms. 3.
Slide the bearing and fork assembly onto the input shaft bearing retainer, as a unit. 4. Snap the
clutch fork onto the pivot ball. 5. Reinstall transaxle assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Release Fork: Description and Operation
The release bearing is operated by a pivoting release fork in the clutch housing. The fork pivots on
a ball stud within the housing. The release fork is actuated by a self-adjusting clutch cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3808
Clutch Release Fork: Service and Repair
NOTE: Remove the transaxle from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Move the lever and bearing assembly to a vertical in-line position. Grasp the release lever with
two hands in the pivot stud socket area. Pull with
even pressure and the lever will pop off the pivot-stud. Do not use a screwdriver or pry bar to pop
off the lever. This may damage the spring clip on the lever.
2. As a unit, remove the fork from the bearing thrust plate. Be careful not to damage retention tabs
on bearing. 3. Examine the condition of the bearing. It is pre-lubricated and sealed and should not
be immersed in oil or solvent. 4. The bearing should turn smoothly when held in the hand under a
light thrust load. A light drag caused by the lubricant fill is normal. If the bearing
is noisy, rough, or dry, replace the complete bearing assembly with a new bearing.
5. Check the condition of the pivot stud spring clips on back side of clutch fork. If the clips are
broken or distorted, replace the clutch fork.
INSTALLATION
1. The pivot ball pocket in the fork is Teflon coated and should be installed WITHOUT any lubricant
such as grease. Using grease will break down
the Teflon coating. Be sure the ball stud and fork pocket are clean of contamination and dirt.
2. Assemble the fork to the bearing. The small pegs on the bearing must go over the fork arms. 3.
Slide the bearing and fork assembly onto the input shaft bearing retainer, as a unit. 4. Snap the
clutch fork onto the pivot ball. 5. Reinstall transaxle assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pressure Plate > Component Information >
Specifications
Pressure Plate: Specifications
MODULAR CLUTCH
Drive Plate To Clutch Bolts ..................................................................................................................
................................................ 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
CONVENTIONAL CLUTCH
To Flywheel Bolts ................................................................................................................................
........................................... 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pressure Plate > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3812
Pressure Plate: Description and Operation
The clutch cover pressure plate assembly is a diaphragm type unit with a one-piece diaphragm
spring with multiple release fingers. The pressure plate release fingers are preset during
manufacture and are not adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications
Axle Shaft: Specifications
Bracket To Transmission .....................................................................................................................
..................................................... 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) To Frame Bracket ............................................
......................................................................................................................................... 54 Nm (40
ft. lbs.) To Transmission Bracket .........................................................................................................
................................................................. 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3818
Driveshaft Assembly Components (Exploded View)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3819
Axle Shaft: Application and ID
Driveshafts and driveshaft inner and outer boots can be identified as shown. Driveshaft boot
location on the driveshaft assemblies is determined by the number of convolutions on the
driveshaft boot. Refer to illustration for the correct location of the sealing boots.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3820
Axle Shaft: Description and Operation
Vehicles equipped with either an automatic or manual transmission use the unequal-length
driveshaft system.
Vehicles equipped with automatic transaxles use a solid short interconnecting shaft on the left side.
The right side of the vehicle uses a longer solid interconnecting shaft.
Vehicles equipped with manual transaxles use a larger diameter (32 mm) short interconnecting
shaft on the left side. The right side uses a longer interconnecting damper.
Driveshafts used on both the right and left sides of the vehicle use a tuned rubber damper weight.
The damper weight applications vary by which side of the vehicle the driveshaft is located on and
the transmission application of the vehicle. When replacing a driveshaft, be sure the replacement
driveshaft has the same damper weight as the original.
Both driveshaft assemblies use the same type of inner and outer joints. The inner joint of both
driveshaft assemblies is a tripod joint, and the outer joint of both driveshaft assemblies is a Rzeppa
joint. Both tripod joints and Rzeppa joints are true constant velocity (C/V) joint assemblies. The
inner tripod joint allows for the changes in driveshaft length through the jounce and rebound travel
of the front suspension.
On vehicles equipped with ABS brakes, the outer C/V joint is equipped with a tone wheel used to
determine vehicle speed for ABS brake operation.
The inner tripod joint of both driveshafts is splined into the transaxle side gears. The inner tripod
joints are retained in the side gears of the transaxle using a snap ring located in the stub shaft of
the tripod joint. The outer C/V joint has a stub shaft that is splined into the wheel hub and retained
by a hub nut using a nut lock and cotter pin.
NOTE: This vehicle does not use a rubber-lip bearing seal as on previous front-wheel-drive cars to
prevent contamination of the front wheel bearing. On these vehicles, the face of the outer C/V joint
fits deeply into the steering knuckle, using a close outer C/V joint-to-steering knuckle fit. This
design deters direct water splash on bearing seal while allowing any water that gets in, to run out
the bottom of the steering knuckle bearing bore. it is important to thoroughly clean the outer C/V
joint and the wheel bearing area in the steering knuckle before it is assembled after servicing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3821
Axle Shaft: Testing and Inspection
LEAKAGE INSPECTION
1. Check for grease in the vicinity of the inboard tripod joint and outboard C/V joint; this is a sign of
inner or outer joint seal boot or seal boot clamp
damage.
2. A light film of grease may appear on the right inner tripod joint seal boot; this is considered
normal and should not require replacement of the seal
boot.
NOISE AND/OR VIBRATION IN TURNS
A clicking noise and/or a vibration in turns could be caused by one of the following conditions: 1.
Damaged outer C/V or inner tripod joint seal boot or seal boot clamps. This will result in the loss
and/or contamination of the joint grease,
resulting in inadequate lubrication of the joint.
2. Noise may also be caused by another component of the vehicle coming in contact with the
driveshafts.
CLUNKING NOISE DURING ACCELERATION
This noise may be a result of one of the following conditions: 1. A torn seal boot on the inner or
outer joint of the driveshaft assembly. 2. A loose or missing clamp on the inner or outer joint of the
driveshaft assembly. 3. A damaged or worn driveshaft C/V joint.
SHUDDER OR VIBRATION DURING ACCELERATION
This problem could be a result of: 1. A worn or damaged driveshaft inner tripod joint. 2. A sticking
tripod joint spider assembly (inner tripod joint only). 3. Improper wheel alignment. Refer to Steering
and Suspension for alignment checking and setting procedures and specifications.
VIBRATION AT HIGHWAY SPEEDS
This problem could be a result of: 1. Foreign material (mud, etc.) packed on the backside of the
wheel(s). 2. Out of balance front tires or wheels. 3. Improper tire and/or wheel runout.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Removal
The content of this article reflects the changes called out by TSB 26-01-95.
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
- Boot sealing is vital to retain special lubricants and to prevent foreign contaminants from entering
the C/V joint. Mishandling, such as allowing the assemblies to dangle unsupported, or pulling or
pushing the ends can cut boots or damage C/V joints. During removal and installation procedures,
always support both ends of the driveshaft to prevent damage.
- The driveshaft, when installed, acts as a bolt and secures the front hub/bearing assembly. If
vehicle is to be supported or moved on its wheels with a driveshaft removed, install a
PROPER-SIZED BOLT AND NUT through front hub. Tighten bolt and nut to 183 Nm (135 ft. lbs.).
This will ensure that the hub bearing cannot loosen.
1. Remove cotter pin, nut lock, and spring washer from the end of the outer C/V joint stub axle.
2. Loosen (but do not remove) stub axle-to-hub/bearing retaining nut. Loosen hub nut while vehicle
is on the floor with the brakes applied. The front
hub and driveshaft are splined together and retained by the hub nut.
3. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact-type hoist. 4. Remove front tire and
wheel assembly from the hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3824
5. Remove front disc brake caliper assembly to steering knuckle bolts.
6. Remove disc brake caliper assembly from steering knuckle. Caliper is removed by first lifting
bottom of caliper away from steering knuckle, and
then removing top of caliper out from under steering knuckle.
7. Support brake caliper/adapter assembly using a wire hook, not by the brake flex hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3825
8. Remove braking disc from front hub. 9. Remove nut attaching outer tie rod end to steering
knuckle. Nut is to be removed from tie rod end using the following procedure: Hold tie rod end
stud with a 11/32 socket while loosening and removing nut.
10. Remove the tie rod end stud from steering knuckle arm using Special Tool MB-990630, or
equivalent.
11. Remove nut and bolt retaining ball joint stud into steering knuckle.
NOTE: Use caution when separating ball joint stud from steering knuckle, so ball joint seal does not
get damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3826
12. Separate ball joint stud from steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm.
NOTE: Care must be taken not to separate the inner ON joint during this operation. Do not allow
driveshaft to hang by inner ON joint, driveshaft must be supported.
13. Pull steering knuckle assembly out and away from outer C/V joint of the driveshaft assembly.
14. Support outer end of the driveshaft assembly.
NOTE: Removal of the inner tripod joints is made easier if you apply outward pressure on the joint
as you strike the punch with a hammer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3827
15. Remove the inner tripod joints from the side gears of the transaxle using a punch to dislodge
the inner tripod joint retaining ring from the transaxle
side gear. If removing the right side inner tripod joint, position the punch against the inner tripod
joint. Strike the punch sharply with a hammer to dislodge the right inner joint from the side gear. If
removing the left side inner tripod joint, position the punch in the groove of the inner tripod joint.
Strike the punch sharply with a hammer to dislodge the left inner tripod joint from the side gear.
16. Hold inner tripod joint and interconnecting shaft of driveshaft assembly. Remove inner tripod
joint from transaxle by pulling it straight out of
transaxle side gear and transaxle oil seal. When removing tripod joint, do not let spline or snap ring
drag across sealing lip of the transaxle to tripod joint oil seal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3828
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Installation
The content of this article reflects the changes called out by TSB 26-01-95.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The driveshaft, when installed, acts as a bolt and secures the front hub/bearing
assembly. If vehicle is to be supported or moved an its wheels with a driveshaft removed, install a
PROPER-SIZED BOLT AND NUT through front hub. Tighten bolt and nut to 183 Nm (135 ft lbs.).
This will ensure that the hub bearing cannot loosen.
1. Thoroughly clean spline and oil seal sealing surface, on tripod joint. Lightly lubricate oil seal
sealing surface on tripod joint with fresh clean
transmission lubricant.
2. Holding driveshaft assembly by tripod joint and interconnecting shaft, install Tripod joint into
transaxle side gear as far as possible by hand. 3. Carefully align tripod joint with transaxle side
gears. Then grasp driveshaft interconnecting shaft and push tripod joint into transaxle side gear
until
fully seated. Test that snap ring is fully engaged with side gear by attempting to remove tripod joint
from transaxle by hand. If snap ring is fully engaged with side gear tripod joint will not be removable
by hand.
4. Clean all debris and moisture out of steering knuckle.
5. Ensure that front of outer C/V joint, which fits into steering knuckle, is free of debris and moisture
before assembling into steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3829
6. Slide driveshaft back into front hub. Install steering knuckle onto the ball joint stud.
7. Install a NEW steering knuckle to ball joint stud clamping bolt and nut. Tighten the nut and bolt to
95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). 8. Install tie rod end into steering knuckle. Start tie rod end to steering knuckle
nut onto stud of tie rod end. While holding stud of tie rod end
stationary, tighten tie rod end to steering knuckle nut. Then, using a crowfoot and 11/32 socket,
tighten tie rod end nut to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.).
9. Install braking disc back on hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3830
10. Install disc brake caliper assembly on steering knuckle. Caliper is installed by first sliding top of
caliper under top abutment on steering knuckle.
Then installing bottom of caliper against bottom abutment of steering knuckle.
11. Install caliper assembly to steering knuckle bolts. Tighten to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.).
12. Clean all foreign matter from threads of outer C/V joint stub axle. Install hub nut and washer
onto the threads of the stub axle and tighten nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3831
13. With vehicle brakes applied to keep axle shaft from turning, tighten hub nut to 183 Nm (135 ft.
lbs.).
14. Install spring washer, hub nut lock and new cotter pin on outer C/V joint stub axle. Wrap the
cotter pin prongs tightly around the hub nut lock. 15. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install
front wheel lug nuts and tighten to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 16. Check for correct fluid level in
transaxle assembly. 17. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3832
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Overhaul
NOTE: The only service that is to be performed on the driveshaft assemblies is the replacement of
the driveshaft seal boots.
If any failure of internal driveshaft components is diagnosed during a vehicle road test or
disassembly of the driveshaft, the driveshaft will need to be replaced as an assembly.
NOTE: Lubricant requirements and quantities are different for inner joints than for outer joints. Use
only the recommended lubricants in the required quantities when servicing driveshaft assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
Removal
NOTES:
- To remove sealing boot from driveshaft for replacement, the driveshaft assembly must be
removed from the vehicle.
- The inner tripod joints use no internal retention in the tripod housing to keep the spider assembly
in the housing. Therefore, do not pull on the interconnecting shaft to disengage tripod housing from
transmission stub shaft. Removal in this manner will cause damage to the inboard joint sealing
boots.
1. Remove the driveshaft requiring boot replacement from the vehicle.
2. Remove large boot clamp that retains inner tripod joint sealing boot to tripod joint housing and
discard. Then remove small clamp that retains inner
tripod joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft and discard. Remove the sealing boot from the
tripod housing and slide it down the interconnecting shaft.
CAUTION: When removing the spider joint from the tripod joint housing, hold the rollers in place on
the spider bunions to prevent the rollers and needle bearings from falling away.
3. Slide the interconnecting shaft and spider assembly out of the tripod joint housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3837
4. Remove snap ring that retains spider assembly to interconnecting shaft. Remove the spider
assembly from interconnecting shaft. If spider assembly
will not come off interconnecting shaft by hand, it can be removed by tapping spider assembly with
a brass drift. Do not hit the outer tripod bearings in an attempt to remove spider assembly from
interconnecting shaft.
5. Slide sealing boot off interconnecting shaft. 6. Thoroughly clean and inspect spider assembly,
tripod joint housing, and interconnecting shaft for any signs of excessive wear. If any parts show
signs
of excessive wear, the driveshaft assembly will require replacement. Component parts of these
driveshaft assemblies are not serviceable.
Installation
NOTE: The inner tripod joint sealing boots are made from two different types of material.
High-temperature applications use silicone rubber whereas standard temperature applications use
Hytrel plastic. The silicone sealing boots are soft and pliable. The Hytrel sealing boots are stiff and
rigid. The replacement sealing boot MUST BE the same type of material as the sealing boot that
was removed.
1. Slide inner tripod joint seal boot retaining clamp, onto interconnecting shaft. Then slide the
replacement inner tripod joint sealing boot onto
interconnecting shaft. Inner tripod joint seal boot MUST be positioned on interconnecting shaft, so
the raised bead on the inside of the seal boot is in groove on interconnecting shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3838
2. Install spider assembly onto interconnecting shaft with chamfer on spider assembly toward
interconnecting shaft. Spider assembly must be
installed on interconnecting shaft far enough to fully install spider retaining snap ring. If spider
assembly will not fully install on interconnecting shaft by hand, it can be installed by tapping the
spider body with a brass drift. Do not hit the outer tripod bearings in an attempt to install spider
assembly on interconnecting shaft.
3. Install the spider assembly to interconnecting shaft retaining snap ring into groove on end of
interconnecting shaft. Be sure the snap ring is fully
seated into groove on interconnecting shaft.
4. Distribute 1/2 the amount of grease provided in the seal boot service package (DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER TYPE OF GREASE) into tripod
housing. Put the remaining amount into the sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3839
5. Align tripod housing with spider assembly and then slide tripod housing over spider assembly
and interconnecting shaft. 6. Install inner tripod joint seal boot to interconnecting shaft clamp evenly
on sealing boot.
7. Clamp sealing boot onto interconnecting shaft using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A and the
following procedure. Place crimping tool C-4975-A
over bridge of clamp. Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until jaws on tool are closed
completely together, face to face.
CAUTION: Seal must not be dimpled, stretched, or out-of-shape in any way. If seal is NOT shaped
correctly, equalize pressure in seal and shape it by hand.
8. Position sealing boot into the tripod housing retaining groove. Install seal boot retaining clamp
evenly on sealing boot.
CAUTIONS: The following positioning procedure determines the correct air pressure inside the inner tripod joint
assembly prior to clamping the sealing boot to inner tripod joint housing. If this procedure is not
done prior to clamping sealing boot to tripod joint housing, boot durability can be adversely
affected.
- When venting the inner tripod joint assembly, use care so inner tripod sealing boot does not get
punctured or, in any other way, damaged. If sealing boot is punctured or damaged while being
vented, the sealing boot can not be used.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3840
9. Insert a trim stick between the tripod joint and the sealing boot to vent inner tripod joint
assembly, When inserting trim stick between tripod
housing and sealing boot, ensure trim stick is held flat and firmly against the tripod housing. If this
is not done, damage to the sealing boot can occur. If inner tripod joint has a Hytrel (hard plastic)
sealing boot, be sure trim stick is inserted between soft rubber insert and tripod housing, and not
the hard plastic sealing boot and soft rubber insert.
10. With trim stick inserted between sealing boot and tripod joint housing, position inner tripod joint
on driveshaft until correct sealing boot edge to
edge length is obtained for type of sealing boot material being used, Then remove the trim stick.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3841
11. Clamp tripod joint sealing boot to tripod joint using required procedure for type of boot clamp
application, If seal boot uses crimp type boot
clamp, clamp sealing boot onto tripod housing using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A. Place
crimping tool C-4975-A over bridge of clamp. Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until jaws on
tool are closed completely together, face-to-face.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3842
12. If seal boot uses low profile latching type boot clamp, clamp sealing boot onto tripod housing
using clamp locking tool, Snap-On YA3050 (or an
equivalent). Place prongs of clamp locking tool in the holes of the clamp. Squeeze tool together
until top band of clamp is latched behind the two tabs on lower band of clamp.
13. Install the Driveshaft requiring boot replacement back on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3843
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Outer CV Joint Sealing Boot
Removal
NOTE: To remove outer C/V joint sealing boot from a Driveshaft for replacement, the driveshaft
assembly must be removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove driveshaft assembly requiring boot replacement from vehicle.
2. Remove large boot clamp retaining C/V joint sealing boot to C/V joint housing and discard.
Remove small clamp that retains outer C/V joint sealing
boot to interconnecting shaft and discard. Remove sealing boot from outer C/V joint housing and
slide it down interconnecting shaft.
3. Wipe away grease to expose outer C/V joint and interconnecting shaft.
4. Remove outer C/V joint from interconnecting shaft using the following procedure: Support
interconnecting shaft in a vise equipped with protective
caps on jaws of vise to prevent damage to interconnecting shaft. Then, using a soft-faced hammer,
sharply hit the end of the C/V joint housing to dislodge housing from internal circlip on
interconnecting shaft. Then slide outer C/V joint off end of interconnecting shaft, joint may have to
be tapped off shaft using a soft-faced hammer.
5. Remove large circlip from the interconnecting shaft before attempting to remove outer C/V joint
sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3844
6. Slide failed sealing boot off interconnecting shaft. 7. Thoroughly clean and inspect outer C/V joint
assembly and interconnecting joint for any signs of excessive wear. If any parts show signs of
excessive
wear, the driveshaft assembly will require replacement. Component parts of these driveshaft
assemblies are not serviceable.
Installation
1. Slide new sealing boot to interconnecting shaft retaining clamp onto interconnecting shaft. Slide
the outer C/V joint assembly sealing boot onto the
interconnecting shaft. Seal boot MUST be positioned on interconnecting shaft so the raised bead
on the inside of the seal boot is in groove on interconnecting shaft.
2. Align splines on interconnecting shaft with splines on cross of outer C/V joint assembly and start
outer C/V joint onto interconnecting shaft.
3. Install outer C/V joint assembly onto interconnecting shaft by using a soft-faced hammer and
tapping end of stub axle (with nut installed) until
outer C/V joint is fully seated on interconnecting shaft.
4. Outer C/V joint assembly must be installed on interconnecting shaft until cross of outer C/V joint
assembly is seated against circlip on
interconnecting shaft.
5. Distribute 1/2 the amount of grease provided in seal boot service package (DO NOT USE ANN
OTHER TYPE OF GREASE) into outer C/V joint
assembly housing. Put the remaining amount into the sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3845
6. Install outer C/V joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft clamp evenly on sealing boot.
7. Clamp sealing boot onto interconnecting shaft using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A, or
equivalent and the following procedure. Place crimping
tool C-4975-A, or equivalent over bridge of clamp. Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A, or
equivalent until jaws on tool are closed completely together, face to face.
CAUTION: Seal must not be dimpled, stretched, or out-of-shape in any way. If seal is NOT shaped
correctly, equalize pressure in seal and shape it by hand.
8. Position outer C/V joint sealing boot into its retaining groove on outer C/V joint housing. Install
sealing boot to outer Char joint retaining clamp
evenly on sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Inner Tripod Joint Sealing Boot Replacement
> Page 3846
9. Clamp sealing boot onto outer C/V joint housing using Crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A, or
equivalent and the following procedure. Place
crimping tool C-4975-A, or equivalent over bridge of clamp. Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A,
or equivalent until jaws on tool are closed completely together, face to face.
10. Install the driveshaft requiring boot replacement back on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Mechanical Specifications
Front
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
................................................ 216 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Hub Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 3851
Wheel Bearing: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Wheel Bearing Grease NLGI GC rated automotive grease
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3852
Wheel Bearing: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front
The front wheel hub bearing used is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing.
The wheel bearing is serviced separately from the front steering knuckle and front hub assembly.
Installation and retention of the front wheel bearing into the steering knuckle, is by means of an
interference press fit using a retaining compound and a retaining snap ring. Installation of the front
hub into the front wheel bearing, must be done after wheel bearing and retaining snap ring is
installed in steering knuckle.
The unit 1 wheel bearing is serviced only as a complete assembly less the wheel hub. If the front
wheel bearing requires replacement, the hub must be removed from the original wheel bearing and
transferred to the replacement bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 3855
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear
All vehicles are equipped with permanently lubricated and sealed for life rear wheel bearings.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units. However, if servicing
of a rear wheel bearing is required, refer to procedures in Testing and Inspection and Service and
Repair for the inspection and replacement of the rear wheel bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Front
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front
NOTE: The hub bearing is designed for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of periodic
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub
bearing.
With the wheel, disc brake caliper. and brake rotor removed, rotate the wheel hub. Any roughness
or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the hub bearing
exhibits any of these conditions during diagnosis, the hub bearing will require replacement, the
bearing is not serviceable.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the hub bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 3858
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear
The rear hub and bearing assembly is designed for the life of the vehicle and should require no
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for evaluation of bearing condition. With wheel
and brake drum removed, rotate flanged outer ring of hub. Excessive roughness, lateral play or
resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or bearing failure. If the rear wheel bearings exhibit
these conditions during inspection, the hub and bearing assembly should be replaced. Damaged
bearing seals and resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing replacement. Moderate
grease loss from bearing is considered normal and should not require replacement of the hub and
bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Removal
1. Remove the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Front Steering
Knuckle/Service and Repair
NOTE: The removal and installation of the steering knuckle hub bearing is to ONLY be done with
the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the hub bearing from the steering
knuckle MUST be done using an arbor press and the following procedure.
2. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on the steering knuckle and hub/bearing
assembly as shown to support steering knuckle
when pressing out hub.
3. Position steering knuckle and hub and bearing in an arbor press supported by Bearing Splitter,
Special Tool P334 as shown. 4. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on the small
end of the hub to drive hub out of bearing. Using arbor press remove hub from
bearing. The one bearing race will come out with hub when hub is removed from bearing.
5. Remove Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent from the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: Safety goggles and or face protection should always be worn when removing the snap
ring retaining the hub/bearing in the steering knuckle. When the snap ring is removed from the
steering knuckle it could fly out of the steering knuckle with great force possibly causing personal
injury.
6. Using a screw driver, remove the snap ring retaining the hub bearing in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 3861
7. Place steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. Press blocks
must not obstruct hub bearing bore in steering knuckle so
bearing can be pressed out of knuckle. Place Bearing Driver, Special Tool MB-990799, or
equivalent on outer race of hub bearing. Press hub bearing completely out of the steering knuckle.
8. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on hub so it is between the flange of the
hub and the bearing race remaining on the hub.
Place hub, bearing race and the bearing splitter in an arbor press as shown. Place Driver, Special
Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on end of hub. Press the hub out of the bearing race.
Installation
1. Wipe bore of steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTIONS: Do not use any type of solvent on the hub bearing when cleaning it.
- The hub bearing must be wiped as clean as possible. Any remaining rust preventative on the
bearing can effect the bonding action of the adhesive to the bearing.
2. Clean the rust preventative from the replacement hub bearing using a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTION: When applying adhesive to bore of steering knuckle, do not allow adhesive to get into
the snap ring in bore or on the seal of the hub bearing
3. Apply Loctite Adhesive #640 or an equivalent, to the bore of the steering knuckle. The adhesive
is to be applied to the entire bore wall surface,
from the shoulder at the bottom to just below the snap ring groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 3862
4. Place new hub bearing into bore of steering knuckle so it is square with the bore. Place steering
knuckle in arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
C-4698-2, or equivalent supporting steering knuckle. Place Diver, Special Tool 5052, or equivalent
on outer race of the hub bearing. Press hub bearing into steering knuckle until it is fully bottom in
bearing bore of steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When installing the retaining snap ring for the hub bearing care must be taken not to
damage seal on new hub bearing.
5. Install hub bearing retaining snap ring into snap ring groove in hub bearing bore of steering
knuckle. Be sure snap ring is fully seated in snap ring
groove.
6. Place steering knuckle with hub bearing installed in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
MB-990799, or equivalent supporting inner race of
the hub bearing. Place hub in nub bearing making sure it is square with bearing. Place Driver,
Special Tool 6522, or equivalent on front face of hub. Press the hub into the hub bearing until hub
is fully bottomed in hub bearing.
7. Install the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly on the vehicle. See:
Steering and Suspension/Steering/Front Steering
Knuckle/Service and Repair
8. Install the wheel and tire on the vehicle. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Set the front wheel Toe to the required specification.
CAUTION: After the vehicle is aligned it can only be moved a short distance and then parked. Do
not move the vehicle any further until the adhesive has cured for a minimum of two hours. Driving
the vehicle before the adhesive is allowed to cure properly, will affect the retention of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 3863
bearing in the bore of the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 3864
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
3. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub And Bearing Dust Cap
4. Remove dust cap. from rear hub/bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 3865
5. Remove hub/bearing assembly to rear spindle retaining nut. 6. Remove rear hub/bearing
assembly from rear spindle by pulling straight of spindle by hand.
INSTALL
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
1. Position hub/bearing assembly on rear spindle. 2. Install a new hub nut and tighten to a torque of
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). 3. Install dust cap; using a soft faced hammer. 4. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
5. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer To Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair.
6. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear
Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear
Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop > Page 3875
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 >
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 >
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop > Page 3881
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3882
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
183 Nm (135 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
To Crankshaft Bolts .............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) To Torque Converter Bolts ...............................
........................................................................................................................................ 68 Nm (50 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications
Flywheel: Specifications
To Crankshaft Bolts .............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The PRNDL lamp receives power on the E2 circuit from the 4 Amp fuse located in the fuse block in
cavity 12. The fuse receives power from the headlamp switch. Circuit E2 also powers the ash
receiver lamp.
When the headlamp switch is moved to the PARK or ON position, current flows through the fuse to
the PRNDL lamp. The ground for the lamp is supplied on the Z3 circuit, and terminates at the
instrument panel left center support. This circuit is also spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, the
ignition switch lamp, and the glove box lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
To Engine Bolts ...................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
End Plate Cover Bolts .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Attaching Bolts .................................................
........................................................................................................................................ 29 Nm (21 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Ring Gear, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 81 Nm (60 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
Mounting ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................... 30 Nm (267 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid ..............................................................................................................................
............................................. 1.9-2.2L (4.0-4.6 Pints)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3915
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid
MOPAR type M.S. 9417 Manual Transaxle Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Output Shaft: Specifications
Bearing Race Retaining Strap .............................................................................................................
.................................................. 11 Nm (96 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Reverse Gear Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications
Reverse Gear Shaft: Specifications
Mounting Bolt .......................................................................................................................................
................................................... 26 Nm (19 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, M/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Shift Shaft Seal Replacement
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Shift Shaft Seal Replacement
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the shift shafts from the transaxle to service the shift shaft
seals.
REMOVAL
Using a pick tool, pry up on the shift shaft seal and remove seal from bore.
INSTALLATION
1. Position new shift shaft seal in bore. 2. Install shift shaft seal into bore using an appropriate size
deep-well socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, M/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Shift Shaft Seal Replacement > Page 3926
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Transaxle Side Seal Replacement
NOTE: The axle shaft seals are identical for both sides of the differential and will interchange.
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft. 2. Insert a flat-blade pry tool at outer edge of axle shaft seal. 3. Tap on the
pry tool with a small hammer and remove axle shaft seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean axle shaft seal bore of any excess sealant. 2. Align axle shaft seal with axle shaft seal
bore. 3. Install axle seal on tool # 6709 and C-4171, or equivalents and insert into axle shaft seal
bore. 4. Tap seal into position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Gearshift Knob Replacement
Shifter M/T: Service and Repair Gearshift Knob Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Pull shifter boot down and away from shifter roll pin. 2. Pry legs of shift knob away from shift
lever roll pin using a flat blade pry tool. 3. Remove knob from shifter handle.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse removal procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Gearshift Knob Replacement > Page 3931
Shifter M/T: Service and Repair Gearshift Boot Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove shifter knob. 2. Remove the console assembly. 3. Snip the plastic retaining clips at the
base of the boot. Remove the boot from the gearshift mechanism.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse removal procedure. Install new plastic retaining clips.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Gearshift Knob Replacement > Page 3932
Shifter M/T: Service and Repair Gearshift Mechanism Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove shifter knob. 2. Remove console assembly. 3. Remove shifter boot. 4. Remove
gearshift cables. 5. Remove the parking brake mechanism. Refer to Brakes and Traction Control
for procedure. 6. Remove the airbag control module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts for
procedure. 7. Remove the two remaining nuts at the base of the gearshift mechanism. Remove
shifter.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse removal procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Cable: Specifications
Crossover Cable Adjustment Screw ....................................................................................................
........................................................... 8 Nm (70 inch) Bracket To Transaxle ......................................
.................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm (250
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3937
Shift Cable: Adjustments
The gearshift selector cable is not adjustable. If adjustment is required, only the crossover cable
may be adjusted.
1. Remove gearshift console from vehicle.
Gearshift Crossover Cable Adjustment
2. Loosen crossover cable adjustment screw.
Crossover Lever Attachment To Transaxle
3. Using a 1/4 inch drill bit or suitable equivalent, pin crossover cable lever to transaxle. Ensure drill
bit engages through crossover lever into
transaxle case at least one half inch.
4. Ensure shift lever is in the spring loaded neutral position. If necessary, move lever forward and
back, then allow lever to fall into it's natural neutral
position.
5. Without allowing movement in either cable or lever, hand tighten crossover cable adjustment
screw, then tighten screw to specifications. 6. Remove pin from transaxle crossover lever, then
check transaxle shift functions. 7. Install gearshift console.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3938
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
NOTE: Use this procedure if either of the shift cables require replacement.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. Disconnect Power Distribution Center from battery tray and set aside. 2. Remove air cleaner
inlet horn. 3. Remove battery and battery tray.
Shift Cable Removal
4. Disconnect gear shift cable ends from transaxle shift levers.
CAUTION: Pry up with equal force on both sides of shifter cable isolator bushings to avoid
damaging cable isolator bushings.
5. Remove cable to bracket retaining clips at transaxle.
CAUTION: It is recommended that new cable retaining clips be used for reinstallation.
6. Pull cables up out of transaxle bracket. 7. Remove console from vehicle.
Cable Retaining Clips
8. Remove floor pan grommet retaining nuts. 9. Remove cable retaining clips at shifter.
CAUTION: It is recommended that new cable retaining clips be used for reinstallation.
10. Disconnect shift cables from shifter. Pry with equal force on both sides of shifter cable isolator
bushings to avoid damaging bushings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3939
Shift Cable Floor Grommet
11. Lift vehicle on hoist. Remove self tapping screws securing grommet plate to underbody heat
shield and floor pan. 12. Detach cables from cable support clip in tunnel above exhaust catalyst.
13. Remove shift cables from vehicle.
To install, reverse removal procedure. After cables have been replaced, cable adjustment should
be checked.
CAUTION: Only the crossover cable is adjustable. The selector cable does not have any
adjustment capabilities.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Speedometer Gear, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Speedometer Gear, M/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove wiring connector from speed sensor.
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing. This prevents the possibility of dirt
from entering the transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt. 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle during sensor removal, drive gear must
be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. To install, reverse removal procedure. 2. Confirm vehicle speedometer is functioning properly
following installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3953
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3954
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Locations
The Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid is located on the Valve Body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3963
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3964
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3965
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3966
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3967
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3968
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3969
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3970
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3971
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3972
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3973
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3974
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3975
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3976
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3977
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3978
Connector Pin-Outs (Part 31 Of 32)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3979
Fuel And Ignition Diagrams (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3980
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
If the solenoid wiring connector is unplugged, the torque converter will not engage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The PRNDL lamp receives power on the E2 circuit from the 4 Amp fuse located in the fuse block in
cavity 12. The fuse receives power from the headlamp switch. Circuit E2 also powers the ash
receiver lamp.
When the headlamp switch is moved to the PARK or ON position, current flows through the fuse to
the PRNDL lamp. The ground for the lamp is supplied on the Z3 circuit, and terminates at the
instrument panel left center support. This circuit is also spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, the
ignition switch lamp, and the glove box lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor Mounting Screws 2 Nm (20 in lb)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3999
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4000
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 20 Park/Neutral Switch
OPERATION
On vehicles with 3-speed automatic transmission the park/neutral switch provides an input to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The park/neutral position switch is located on the automatic transaxle housing Fig. 20. Manual
transaxles do not use park/neutral switches. The switch provides an input to the PCM to indicate
whether the automatic transaxle is in Park/Neutral, or a drive gear selection. This input is used to
determine idle speed (varying with gear selection) and ignition timing advance. The park/neutral
input is also used to cancel vehicle speed control. The park/neutral switch is sometimes referred to
as the neutral safety switch.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
When CLOSED the Transmission Range Switch (TRS) provides an input to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on circuit T41. This circuit connects to cavity 76 of the PCM connector. The T41
circuit is spliced and provides a ground path for the engine starter relay, and the Transmission
Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) AMBER WARNING LAMP
The ABS system uses an Amber ABS Warning Lamp, located in the instrument cluster. The
purpose of the warning lamp is discussed in detail below.
When Detection Occurs The ABS warning lamp will turn on when the Controller Antilock Brake
(CAB) detects a condition which results in a shutdown of ABS function. The ABS Warning Lamp is
normally on until the CAB completes its self tests and turns the lamp off (approximately 4-5
seconds after the ignition switch is turned on). When the ABS warning lamp is on, only the ABS
function of the brake system if affected. The standard brake system and the ability to stop the car
will not be affected when only the ABS warning lamp is on.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Locations
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The system relay is used for the operation of the Anti Lock Brake (ABS) system. Power for the
relay is supplied on the B57 circuit from cavity 57 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB).
Ground for the relay is on the Z1 circuit. This ground is spliced in with the pump motor and
terminates at the left headlamp ground.
When the system is operating normally power for the contact side of the relay is supplied from the
CAB on the B57 circuit. It passes through the relay to the Z1 ground and terminates at the left
headlamp ground. If a problem is detected in the system, the contact side of the relay switches
from the Z1 to the F12 circuit. This causes the ABS warning lamp in the instrument cluster to
illuminate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay > Page 4011
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relays
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
SYSTEM RELAY
The main purpose of the system relay is to put the Antilock Brake System (ABS) into a stand-by
mode for ABS operation. The System Relay is energized by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
shortly after the ignition switch is turned on.
When Energized - by the CAB, the System Relay turns off the ABS warning lamp and provides 12
volts to the CAB. This voltage can then be used by the CAB to energize the Decay Solenoids
during ABS braking. When energized, the System Relay also provides the Pump/Motor Relay coil
with 12 volts. The ground path to the Pump/Motor Relay is completed by the CAB during ABS
braking.
When De-energized - the ABS warning lamp is illuminated, voltage to the Decay Solenoids is cut
off, and the Pump/Motor Relay is prevented from energizing. Typically, the System Relay is
de-energized by the CAB when a fault is detected that requires turning ABS off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
> Component Information > Locations
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4015
Brake Fluid Pump: Description and Operation
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU) PUMP MOTOR ASSEMBLY
The HCU contains 2 Pump Assemblies, one each for the primary and secondary hydraulic circuits.
Both pumps are driven by a common electric motor which is part of the Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU). The pumps pick up fluid from the sumps to supply build pressure to the brakes during an
Antilock Brake System (ABS) stop. The motor only runs during an ABS stop and is controlled by
the Controller Antilock Brakes (CAB) via the Pump/Motor Relay. The Pump/Motor Assembly is not
a serviceable item. If it requires service the HCU must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Description
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
PURPOSE
Pump/Motor power is supplied by the Pump/Motor Relay. The pump motor relay is also part of the
relay box mounted to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). If pump/motor relay replacement is
required, it is also only serviced by the replacement of the relay box assembly.
FUNCTION
Voltage for the 12 volt side of the relay coil is provided by the System Relay. The ground path
through the relay coil is completed by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) during Antilock Brake
System (ABS) braking. The relay contacts are closed when the relay is energized. This provides 12
volts to the pump/motor as needed during ABS braking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4020
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Anti Lock Brake (ABS) pump motor relay controls when the pump motor runs. Power for the
coil side of the relay is supplied from cavity 47 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) on the B47
circuit. This circuit also supplies voltage for the contact side of the system relay The ground side of
the coil is controlled by the B116 circuit. Circuit B116 connects to cavity 16 of the CAB connector.
Circuit B120 from cavity 20 of the CAB connector powers the ABS pump motor. This circuit is also
used as an input to the CAB for pump motor monitoring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Braking Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit L50 is an input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB). The L50 connects to cavity 13 of the
CAB connector. Circuit L50 is spliced in with the stop lamps and is used to provide the CAB with
information on when the brakes are being applied.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations
Diagnostic Connector - ABS: Locations
Controller Antilock Brake
On this vehicle, the ABX-4 brake system (DRB) diagnostic connector is located under the steering
column cover, directly below the steering column. The ABX-4 system uses the ISO 9141-K
connector which is shared by other vehicle diagnostic systems such as the powertrain control
module and air bag.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations > Page 4027
Diagnostic Connector - ABS: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit D21 is used for diagnostics of a fault with the Antilock Brake (ABS) system. It is spliced in
with the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuits and used as an output from the Controller Anti
Lock Brake (CAB). Circuit D21 connects to cavity 51 of the CAB connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations > Page 4028
Diagnostic Connector - ABS: Testing and Inspection
- Check the 15 Amp fuse located in cavity 10 of the fuse block.
- Check the 40 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
- Check for a good ground at the left headlamp ground.
- Check the case ground on the CAB
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
Controller Antilock Brake
The CAB is mounted under the instrument panel behind the drivers side kick panel of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4032
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
Controller Antilock Brake
PURPOSE
The Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) is a microprocessor based device which monitors the Antilock
Brake System (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when in an ABS stop. The CAB is
mounted under the instrument panel on the drivers side kick panel. The CAB uses a 60 way
electrical connector on the vehicle wiring harness. The power source for the CAB is through the
ignition switch in the Run or On position.
NOTE: The CAB is not on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) bus.
THE PRIMARY FUNCTIONS OF THE CAB
- Detect wheel locking tendencies.
- Control fluid modulation to the brakes while in ABS mode.
- Monitor the system for proper operation.
- Provide communication to the DRB scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
The CAB Continuously Monitors - the speed of each wheel through the signals generated at the
Wheel Speed Sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the CAB commands the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) to modulate brake fluid
pressure in some or all of the hydraulic circuits. The CAB continues to control pressure in individual
hydraulic circuits until a locking tendency is no longer present.
The ABS System Is Constantly Monitored - by the CAB for proper operation. If the CAB detects a
fault, it will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp and disable the ABS braking system. The normal
Non ABS braking system will remain operational.
The CAB Contains A Self-diagnostic Program - which will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp
when a ABS system fault is detected.
Faults Are Then Stored - in a diagnostic program memory. There are multiple fault messages
which may be stored in the CAB and displayed through the DRB. These fault messages will remain
in the CAB memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The fault messages can be cleared
by using the DRB diagnostics tester, or they will be automatically cleared from the memory after
the vehicle is driven approximately 3500 miles.
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE INPUTS
^ Four wheel speed sensors. ^ Stop lamp switch. ^ Ignition switch. ^ System relay voltage. ^
Ground. ^ Pump/Motor Relay Monitor ^ Diagnostics Communications
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE OUTPUTS
^ 4 Decay Solenoids ^ ABS warning lamp. ^ System relay actuation. ^ Diagnostic communication. ^
Pump motor relay actuation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4033
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Controller Antilock Brake
REMOVE
1. Turn vehicle ignition off.
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
2. Disconnect the wiring harness 60 way connector from the Controller Antilock Brake Module
(CAB). Verify that the vehicle ignition is off before
removing the 60 way connector.
CAB Bracket To Kick Panel Mounting
3. Remove the 2 controller bracket to drivers side cowl mounting nuts. 4. Remove the CAB from
the vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Install CAB and mounting bracket on mounting studs located on passenger side kick panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4034
2. Install the 2 CAB bracket mounting nuts and securely tighten. 3. Install the 60-way wiring
harness connector by hand into the 60-way CAB connector, as far as possible. Then use the CAB
connector retaining
bolt to fully seat wiring harness connector into the CAB.
4. Torque the 60-way connector retaining bolt to 4 Nm (38 inch lbs.). 5. If a new CAB is being has
been installed, it must be initialized prior to the vehicle being driven. The CAB is initialized using
the DRB Scan Tool
and the initializing procedure described upon selecting Bendix ABX-4 Diagnostics. New controllers
are programmed to flash the ABS warning lamp until initialized by the installing technician.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications
Hydraulic Control Unit: Specifications
To Mounting Bracket Bolts ..................................................................................................................
............................................... 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) Bracket To Frame Rail Mounting Bolt (Top)
...................................................................................................................................... 18 Nm (160
inch lbs.) Bracket To Frame Rail Mounting Bolts (Side)
................................................................................................................................... 22 Nm (200
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4038
Hydraulic Control Unit
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4039
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE ONLY PARTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU) THAT ARE
SERVICEABLE ARE THE RELAY BOX, THE PROPORTIONING VALVES, AND THE HCU
MOUNTING BRACKET. THE REMAINING COMPONENTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL
UNIT HCU ARE NOT SERVICEABLE ITEMS. NO ATTEMPT SHOULD EVER BE MADE TO
REMOVE OR SERVICE ANY OTHER PARTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation General Information
Hydraulic Control Unit
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is located under the master cylinder and power brake booster
and is mounted to the left frame rail. The HCU contains the following components for controlling the
vehicle's braking system during Antilock Brake System (ABS) braking: 4 Decay Valves, 4 Shuttle
Valves, 2 Fluid Sumps, a Pump/Motor and a relay box. Also attached to the HCU are the rear
brake Proportioning Valves and the vehicles 6 hydraulic brake tubes.
Decay Solenoids There are 4 decay solenoids, one for each wheel. In the released position they
provide a fluid path from the master cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. In the actuated
(decay) position, they provide a fluid path from wheel brakes of the vehicle to the sumps. The
Decay solenoids are spring loaded in the released (build) position during normal braking.
Shuttle Valves There are 4 Shuttle Valves, one for each wheel. The Shuttle Valve is a hydraulically
actuated valve which shuttles when the decay solenoid and pump are energized. This places an
orifice (restriction) in the line between the pump and the decay solenoid. This restriction provides a
controlled build rate to each wheel brake during an ABS stop. The Shuttle Valve will remain in the
orificed position until the ABS cycle is complete. When the ABS cycle has been completed the
decay solenoids will return to their released position which will equalize the pressure across the
Shuttle Valves. When the pressure equalizes, the spring loaded Shuttle Orifice valves will return to
the unrestricted position.
Fluid Sumps There are two fluid sumps in the HCU, one each for the primary and secondary
hydraulic circuits. The fluid sumps temporarily store brake fluid that is decayed from the wheel
brakes during an ABS cycle. This fluid is then delivered to the pump to provide build pressure. The
typical pressure in the sumps is 50 psi, during ABS operation only.
Pump Motor Assembly The HCU contains 2 Pump Assemblies, one each for the primary and
secondary hydraulic circuits. Both pumps are driven by a common electric motor which is part of
the HCU. The pumps pick up fluid from the sumps to supply build pressure to the brakes during an
ABS stop. The motor only runs during an ABS stop and is controlled by the Controller Antilock
Brake (CAB) via the Pump/Motor Relay. The Pump/Motor Assembly is not a serviceable item. If it
requires service the HCU must be replaced.
Relay Box ABX-4 utilizes two relays contained in a relay box mounted to the HCU. The relay box
contains a System Relay and a Pump/Motor Relay. A single 10-way connector provides the
electrical interface. The relay box is serviceable as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 4042
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control Unit Decay Solenoids
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT DECAY SOLENOIDS
There are 4 decay solenoids, one for each wheel. In the released position they provide a fluid path
from the Master Cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. In the actuated (decay) position, they
provide a fluid path from wheel brakes of the vehicle to the sumps. The Decay Solenoids are spring
loaded in the released (build) position during normal braking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 4043
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control Unit Shuttle Valves
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT SHUTTLE VALVES
There are 4 Shuttle Valves, one for each wheel. The Shuttle Valve is a hydraulically actuated valve
which shuttles when the decay solenoid and pump are energized. This places an orifice (restriction)
in the line between the pump and the decay solenoid. This restriction provides a controlled build
rate to each wheel brake during an ABS stop. The Shuttle Valve will remain in the orificed position
until the ABS cycle is complete. When the ABS cycle has been completed the decay solenoids will
return to their released position which will equalize the pressure across the Shuttle Valves. When
the pressure equalizes, the spring loaded Shuttle Orifice valves will return to the unrestricted
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General
Information > Page 4044
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Modulator Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The hydraulic modulator is used for the controlling of the brake system pressure to the wheels. The
modulator is made up of four solenoids.
Circuits involved are, B142 for the left front wheel, B143 for the right front wheel, B146 for the left
rear wheel, and B148 for the right rear wheel.
The solenoids use a common ground on the Z1 circuit. There are two Z1 circuits from the
modulator. Both of these grounds terminate at the left headlamp ground, and are spliced in with the
Anti Lock Brake System (ABS) pump motor and the ABS system relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service and Repair Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) Replacement
Removal
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate cable.
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
2. Disconnect vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level sensor at base of master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
3. Disconnect primary and secondary brake tubes from master cylinder housing. Install plugs at
brake tube outlets of master cylinder assembly. 4. Clean area where master cylinder attaches to
booster using a suitable brake cleaner.
CAUTION: On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before
removing master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be
done simply by pumping the brake pedal, with the engine not running, until a firm brake pedal is
achieved.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4047
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
5. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder to power brake booster unit. 6. Slide master
cylinder assembly straight out, and away from power brake booster unit.
Electrical Connections To HCU And Relay Box
7. Disconnect the 6 way connector from the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) wiring harness and 10
way connector from the relay box located on the
HCU.
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes From Master Cylinder To HCU
8. Remove the primary and secondary master cylinder brake tubes from the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4048
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
9. Remove the chassis brake tubes from the proportioning valves and outlet ports of the (HCU).
10. Raise vehicle.
Hydraulic Control Unit Mounting Bracket
11. Loosen and remove the 2 bolts attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the side of the front
frame rail. 12. Lower vehicle. 13. Loosen and remove the bolts attaching the HCU mounting
bracket to the top of the frame rail. 14. Remove HCU and its mounting bracket as an assembly
from the vehicle.
Installation
PROCEDURE
Hydraulic Control Unit Mounting Bracket
1. Install the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) and mounting bracket as an assembly, on left front
frame rail of the vehicle, aligning tabs on mounting
bracket with holes in frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4049
2. Install and loosely tighten the bolt attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the top of the frame
rail. 3. Raise vehicle. 4. Install the 2 bolts attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the side of the
front frame rail. Then torque both mounting bolts to 28 Nm (200 inch
lbs.).
5. Lower vehicle. 6. Torque bolt attaching HCU mounting bracket to top of frame rail to 20 Nm (180
inch lbs.).
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
7. Install the 4 chassis brake tubes onto the proportioning valves and outlet ports of the HCU.
Torque the 4 chassis brake tube nuts to 17 Nm (145
inch lbs.).
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes From Master Cylinder To HCU
8. Install primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder onto the HCU, with tube nuts
only hand tightened.
Electrical Connections To HCU And Relay Box
9. Install vehicle wiring harness connectors onto the 10 way, and 6 way connectors, located on the
relay box of the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4050
Removing Seal From Vacuum Booster
10. Remove vacuum seal located in the front of the power brake vacuum booster. Vacuum seal is
removed by carefully inserting a small screw driver
between the push rod of the power brake vacuum booster and vacuum seal and pry seal out of
power brake vacuum booster. Do not attempt to pry seal out of master cylinder by inserting a tool
between seal and power brake vacuum booster.
11. Remove old vacuum seal from master cylinder, if the vacuum seal came out of power brake
vacuum booster when master cylinder was removed
this step is not necessary.
CAUTION: When replacing the master cylinder on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a NEW vacuum
seal MUST be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure detailed below
for installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. Be sure old vacuum seal is removed
from power brake vacuum booster before attempting to install new seal.
CAUTION: When lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric
Compound. Using any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate
long term lubrication of the push rod.
Lubricating Master Cylinder Push Rod
12. Lubricate master cylinder push rod as indicated only using Mopar Dielectric Grease-And No
Substitutes.
Fig 19 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Installation. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4051
Fig 20 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Seating. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
13. Install vacuum seal on master cylinder push rod as shown with notches on vacuum seal
pointing toward master cylinder housing. Then slide
vacuum seal onto master push rod until seal is seated against master cylinder housing before
installing master cylinder on power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure old vacuum seal is removed from power brake
vacuum booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If vacuum seal
is not removed, refer to Brakes, Master Cylinder Service and Repair for required vacuum seal
removal procedure.
14. Position master cylinder on studs of power brake unit, aligning push rod on power brake
vacuum booster with master cylinder push rod.
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
15. Install the 2 master cylinder to power brake unit mounting nuts and torque to 28 Nm (250 inch
lbs.).
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
16. Connect brake tubes to master cylinder primary and secondary ports. Torque all tube nuts to 17
Nm (145 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4052
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
17. Install the wiring harness connector on the master cylinder reservoir brake fluid level switch. 18.
Bleed the base brakes and the ABS brakes hydraulic systems. Refer to Brakes Service and Repair
and Antilock Brake System Service and Repair
for the required procedures.
19. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS brake systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4053
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service and Repair Relay Box Replacement
GENERAL INFORMATION
The System Relay and Pump/Motor Relay are both serviced together as an assembly with the
relay box. The relay box is mounted directly to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). To remove the
relay box from the HCU, the HCU requires removal from the vehicle. This is to allow visual access
of the relay box to HCU electrical connection. Visual access to this connection is necessary to be
sure connection is correctly made when installing relay box on the HCU.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable.
2. Remove the HCU from the vehicle. Refer to Hydraulic Control Unit Removal, for the required
HCU removal procedure.
Relay Box To HCU Mounting Screws
3. Unclip the 6 way wiring harness connector from the relay box.
4. Remove the 2 screws attaching the relay box assembly to the HCU. Remove only the 2 screws
mounting the relay box to the HCU. Do not remove the pump motor mounting screws.
Relay Box To HCU Electrical Connection
5. Grasp relay box. Without twisting or rocking, pull relay box away from pump motor housing until
connector on relay box unplugs from the pump motor terminal. This is a tight connection, relay box
will require a good amount of force to unplug from pump motor.
6. Remove relay box from HCU.
INSTALL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control
Unit (HCU) Replacement > Page 4054
Pump Motor To Relay Box Electrical Seal
1. Be sure electrical connector seal is installed in pump motor housing before installing relay box. If
electrical connector seal is cracked, brittle or in any way damaged it must be replaced before
installing relay box.
2. Position relay box on HCU and carefully align the terminals on the relay box with the terminals
on the pump motor.
3. Grasp relay box with both hands. Then without twisting or rocking, push relay box onto the pump
motor electrical connector as far as possible by hand.
4. Install and securely tighten the 2 screws attaching the relay box assembly to the HCU.
5. Reconnect the 6 way connector onto the relay box.
6. Install the HCU back in the vehicle. Refer to Hydraulic Control Unit Installation, for the required
HCU installation procedure.
7. Connect the negative (-) ground cable back on the negative post of the battery.
8. Bleed the base brakes and the ABS brakes hydraulic systems. Refer to Brakes Service and
Repair and Antilock Brake System Service and Repair for the required procedures.
9. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions
Wheel Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-10-99I
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: October, 1999
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1993-1997 Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 ABS Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96026
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revisions to the ABS test procedures for wheel speed sensors
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4059
39
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4060
43
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4061
45
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4062
47
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4063
51
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4064
55
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4065
57
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4066
59
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4067
63
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4068
67
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4069
69
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4070
71
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4071
173
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4072
177
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4073
179
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4074
181
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4075
187
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4076
191
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4077
193
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4078
195
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4079
201
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4080
205
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4081
207
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4082
209
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test Revisions >
Page 4083
256
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4084
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Rear
Clearance Minimum Clearance 0.014 in 0.016 in
Maximum Clearance 0.047 in 0.047 in
Runout 0.006 in 0.006 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4085
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service Precautions
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
There are four wheel speed sensors, one at each wheel. The sensors use a tone wheel to
determine wheel speed. Input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) is done on the following
circuits. All of these circuits are a twisted pair. B8 and B9 for the left front wheel (cavity 8 and cavity
9). B6 and B7 for the right front wheel (cavity 6 and cavity 7). B3 and B4 for the left rear wheel
(cavity 3 and cavity 4). B1 and B2 for the right rear wheel (cavity 1 and cavity 2).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 4088
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensors and Tone Wheels
Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Drum Brakes
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Rear Disc Brakes
One Wheel Speed Sensor (WSS) is located at each wheel and sends a small AC signal to the
Controller Antilock Brake (CAB). This signal is generated by magnetic induction created when a
toothed sensor ring (tone wheel) passes the stationary magnetic Wheel Speed Sensor. The CAB
converts the AC signal generated at each wheel into a digital signal. If a wheel locking tendency is
detected by the CAB, it will then modulate hydraulic pressure via the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
to prevent the wheel(s) from locking.
The front Wheel Speed Sensor is attached to a boss in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is part
of the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear drum brake
applications is mounted to the rear brake support plate and the rear tone wheel is an integral part
of the rear wheel hub and bearing assembly. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear disc brake
applications is mounted to the rear disc brake adapter and the rear tone wheel is also an integral
part of the rearwheel hub and bearing assembly. The speed sensor air gap on both applications is
NOT adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 4089
The four Wheel Speed Sensors are serviced individually. The front Tone Wheels are serviced as
an assembly with the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Tone Wheels are serviced as an
assembly with the rear hub and bearing assembly.
Correct ABS system operation is dependent on accurate wheel speed signals. The vehicle's
wheels and tires must all be the same size and type to generate accurate signals. Variations in
wheel and tire size can produce inaccurate wheel speed signals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4090
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CAREFUL INSPECTION
Carefully inspect tone wheel at the suspected faulty wheel speed sensor for missing, chipped or
broken teeth, this can cause erratic speed sensor signals. Tone wheels should show no evidence
of contact with the wheel speed sensors. If contact was made, determine cause and correct before
replacing the wheel speed sensor.
Excessive Runout - of the tonewheel can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Refer to
Tone-wheel Runout under Specification. Replace drive shaft assembly or rear hub/bearing
assembly if tonewheel runout exceeds the specification.
Inspect For Looseness - on their mounting surfaces. Tone wheels are pressed onto their mounting
surfaces and should not rotate independently from the mounting surface. Check the wheel speed
sensor head alignment to the tone wheel. Also check the gap between the speed sensor head and
the tone wheel to ensure it is at specification. See: Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Speed Sensor Cable To Wiring Herness Connection
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Attaching Bolt
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4093
4. Remove wheel speed sensor head to steering knuckle attaching bolt. 5. Carefully, remove
sensor head from steering knuckle. If the sensor has seized, due to corrosion, DO NOT USE
PLIERS ON SENSOR HEAD. Use
a hammer and a punch and tap edge of sensor ear, rocking the sensor side to side until free.
6. Remove the speed sensor cable assembly grommets from the retaining bracket. Remove speed
sensor cable routing clip from the frame of the
vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector to the vehicle wiring harness. 2. Install the
speed sensor cable assembly grommets into the retaining bracket. Install speed sensor cable
routing clip onto the frame of the vehicle. 3. Install wheel speed sensor to steering knuckle
attaching screw. Torque the attaching screw to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 4. Install the wheel and tire
assembly on vehicle. 5. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS
systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4094
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Speed Sensor Connection To Vehicle Wiring Harness
Speed Sensor Head Mounting And Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body. 4. Remove the
speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting bracket. Then
remove the speed sensor cable from the
routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
5. Remove bolt attaching the rear wheel speed sensor to the disc brake adapter. The remove bolt
attaching speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear
strut assembly.
6. Remove speed sensor head from the disc brake adapter. If the speed sensor head has seized in
the adapter, DO NOT USE PLIERS ON SENSOR
HEAD.
INSTALL
1. Install wheel speed sensor head into disc brake adapter. 2. Install wheel speed sensor attaching
bolt. Tighten the attaching bolt to a torque of 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 3. Install the brake flex hose and
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut bracket. 4. Install wheel speed sensor
cable into the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube. 5. Plug speed
sensor cable connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install clip attaching speed sensor cable
connector to vehicle body. 6. Install the tire and wheel assembly on vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the base and ABS systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures
GENERAL INFORMATION
The base brake system must be bled anytime air is permitted to enter the hydraulic system, due to
disconnection of brake lines, hoses or components. The Antilock Brake System (ABS), particularly
the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU), should only be bled when the HCU is. replaced or removed from
the vehicle, or if there is reason to believe the HCU has ingested air. Under most circumstances
that would require brake bleeding, only the base brake system needs to be bled. It is important to
note that excessive air in the brake system will cause a soft or spongy feeling brake pedal.
During Bleeding Operations - be sure that the brake fluid level remains close to the FULL level in
the reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add DOT 3 brake
fluid as required. The Bendix ABX-4 Brake System must be bled as two independent braking
systems. The non ABS portion of the brake system is to be bled the same as any non ABS system.
Refer to Brakes Service and Repair for the proper bleeding procedure to be used. This brake
system can be either pressure bled or manually bled. The ABS portion of brake system MUST be
bled separately. This bleeding procedure requires the use of the DRB scan tool and the bleeding
sequence procedure outlined below.
ABS BLEEDING PROCEDURE
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence MUST be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding. The ABS system can be bled using a Manual bleeding procedure
or standard Pressure Bleeding Equipment. If the brake system is to be bled using pressure
bleeding equipment, refer to Brakes Service and Repair.
1. Assemble and install all brake system components on vehicle making sure all hydraulic fluid
lines are installed and properly torqued.
ABS System Diagnostic Connector
2. Connect the DRB scan tool to the diagnostics connector. The diagnostics connector is located
under the steering column cover, directly below the steering column.
3. Using the DRB scan tool, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, remove them using the DRB scan tool.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE. BRAKE FLUID AT
HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure as
outlined in Brakes Service and Repair.
5. Using the DRB scan tool, go to the "Bleed ABS" routine. Apply the brake pedal firmly and initiate
the "Bleed ABS" cycle one time. Release the brake pedal.
6. Bleed the base brake system again, as in step Step 4 above.
7. Repeat steps Step 5 and Step 6 above until brake fluid flows clear and free of bubbles. Check
brake fluid level in reservoir periodically to prevent reservoir from running low on brake fluid.
8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure brake are operating correctly and that pedal is solid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures > Page 4099
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure Bleeding (Preferred Procedure)
Air Trapped In Brake System
Method For Purging Air From Brake System
Bleeder Screw
CAUTION:
- Before removing the Master Cylinder cover, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder.
- Use bleeder tank Special Tool C-3496-B, or equivalent with required adapter for the master
cylinder reservoir to pressurize the hydraulic system for bleeding.
NOTE:
- For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Hydraulic Control Unit.
- Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding equipment.
PROCEDURE
When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines or valves far
upstream, as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures > Page 4100
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out. The following wheel sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic
system should be used to ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
^ Left rear wheel
^ Right front wheel
^ Right rear wheel
^ Left front wheel
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw starting at the right rear wheel and feed the hose
into a clear jar containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
2. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain an steady stream of brake fluid.
3. After 4 to 8 ounces of fluid has been bled through the brake and an air-free flow is maintained in
the clear plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
4. Repeat the procedure at all the other remaining bleeder screws. Then check the pedal for travel.
If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, enough fluid has not passed through the
system to expel all the trapped air. Be sure to monitor the fluid level in the pressure bleeder. It must
stay at the proper level so air will not be allowed to reenter the brake system through the master
cylinder reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions
Brake Warning Indicator: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-97F
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1997
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997-1998 Teves Mark IV, Teves Mark 20 ABS Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number 81-699-97012
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revisions to the ABS warning light procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions > Page 4105
244
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions > Page 4106
245
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > General Information
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation General Information
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
GENERAL INFORMATION
The red Brake warning lamp is located in the instrument panel cluster and is used to indicate a low
brake fluid condition or that the parking brake is applied. In addition, the brake warning lamp is
turned on as a bulb check by the ignition switch when the ignition switch is placed in the crank
position. Problems with this system will generally be of the type where the warning lamp fails to
turn on when it should, or remains on when it should not. The warning lamp bulb is supplied a 12
volt ignition feed anytime the ignition switch is on. The bulb is then illuminated by completing the
ground circuit either through the park brake switch, the fluid level sensor in the master cylinder
reservoir, or the ignition switch in the crank position.
PURPOSE
The Brake Fluid Level sensor is located in the brake fluid reservoir of the master cylinder assembly.
The purpose of the sensor is to provide the driver with an early warning that the brake fluid level in
the master cylinder reservoir has dropped to below normal. This may indicate an abnormal loss of
brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir resulting from a leak in the hydraulic system. As the
fluid drops below the minimum level, the fluid level sensor closes the brake warning light circuit.
This will turn on the red brake warning light. At this time, master cylinder fluid reservoir should be
checked and filled to the full mark with DOT 3 brake fluid.
NOTE: If brake fluid level has dropped in master cylinder fluid reservoir, the entire brake hydraulic
system should he checked for evidence of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > General Information > Page 4109
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation ABS Warning Lamp Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The ABS warning lamp is an output from the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) and the Antilock
Brake System (ABS) relay box. It is used to alert the operator of a problem in the ABS system. The
G19 circuit from the CAB and the ABS system relay is used to detect a problem. If a problem is
detected, the CAB grounds the G19 circuit and illuminates the lamp in the instrument cluster.
Circuit G19 is also an output of the CAB to the ABS system relay contact side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > General Information > Page 4110
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Warning Lamp Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Brake Warning Indicator lamp is used to alert the operator of a problem with the vehicles
braking system. The lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is turned to START position to
perform a self check.
There are two switches used in this system and they are wired in parallel form. A parking brake
switch located on the parking brake mechanism will illuminate the lamp if the normally OPEN
switch is CLOSED. This switch is case grounded.
The other switch used is the brake warning lamp switch. This switch is normally OPEN. When the
brake system pressure is below a predetermined level the switch CLOSES and completes a path to
ground from the G9 circuit at the cluster, through the switch, to the left headlamp ground.
If the vehicle is built for use in Canada the parking brake switch is used for the Daytime Running
Lamp Module (DRL).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection Brake System Warning Lamp Test
The brake warning lamp illuminates when the parking brake is applied with ignition switch turned to
the ON position. The same lamp will also illuminate if one of the two service brake systems fail the
when brake pedal is applied.
To test the system:
- As the ignition switch is turned to the start position the lamp should light.
- Turn ignition switch to the ON position and apply the parking brake. The lamp should light.
If lamp fails to light inspect for:
- A burned out lamp
- Loose, corroded or damaged socket
- A damaged circuit board
- A broken or disconnected wire at the switch
- Defective switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test > Page 4113
Brake Warning Lamp Functional Check
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test > Page 4114
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 5 Amp fuse in cavity 11 of the fuse block.
- Check the 4 Amp fuse in cavity 12 of the fuse block.
- Check the Ignition Off Draw fuse in the PDC.
- Check for a good ground at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications Brake Caliper to Steering Knuckle Torque
Brake Caliper to Steering Knuckle Torque
Brake Caliper Bolt 31 Nm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Brake Caliper: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD AIR PRESSURE EVER BE USED TO REMOVE A
PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM SUCH A
PRACTICE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 4121
Brake Caliper: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on the
caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
- Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will cause
bore distortion and binding of piston.
- Force must be applied to the piston uniformly to avoid cocking and binding of the piston in the
bore of the caliper.
- When inspecting caliper piston, do not use anything but solvents to clean piston surface. If
surface of piston cannot be cleaned using only solvents, piston must be replaced.
NOTE:
- When being installed, extreme caution must be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin
bolts.
- Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times to
insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
- When using Caliper Honing Tool, Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent, coat the stones and bore
with brake fluid. After honing the bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff
non-metallic rotary brush.
- Use extreme care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the
caliper with brake fluid; wipe dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean a second time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Caliper
Brake Caliper: Description and Operation Front Caliper
Exploded View Of Front Caliper
Fig. 2 Piston Seal Function
GENERAL INFORMATION
The caliper is mounted to the steering knuckle using bushings, sleeves and 2 guide pin bolts which
thread directly into bosses on the steering knuckle. Two machined abutments on the steering
knuckle position the caliper. The guide pin bolts, sleeves and bushings control the side to side
movement of the caliper. The piston seal is designed to pull the piston back into the bore of the
caliper when the brake pedal is released. This maintains the proper brake shoe to rotor clearance.
The caliper is a one piece casting with the inboard side containing a single piston cylinder bore.
The front disc brake caliper piston, is manufactured from a phenolic compound. The outside
diameter of the caliper piston is 54 mm. A square cut rubber piston seal is located in a machined
groove in the caliper cylinder bore. This provides a hydraulic seal between the piston and the
cylinder wall. A rubber dust boot is installed in the cylinder bore opening and in a groove in the
piston. This prevents contamination in the bore area. As front disc brake linings wear, master
cylinder reservoir brake fluid level will drop. Fluid level should be checked after replacing linings.
Front disc brakes are equipped with an audible wear indicator on the outboard brake pad. This
sensor omits a sound when the brake lining may need inspection and/or replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front Caliper > Page 4124
Brake Caliper: Description and Operation Rear Caliper
Rear Disc Brake Assembly
GENERAL INFORMATION
Vehicles are equipped with a caliper assembly that has a 34 mm (1.43 in.) piston and uses a solid
non-vented rotor. The caliper assembly on all applications float on rubber bushings using internal
metal sleeves which are attached to the adapter using threaded guide pin bolts. The adapter and
rotor shield are mounted to the rear suspension knuckles of vehicle. The adapter is used to mount
the brake shoes and actuating cables for the parking brake system. The adapter also mounts the
rear caliper assembly to the vehicle. The adapter has two machined abutments which are used to
position and align the caliper and brake pads for movement inboard and outboard.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4125
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection
PISTON SEAL
Check for brake fluid leaks in and around dust boot area and inboard brake pad, and for any
ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot. If the dust boot is damaged, or a fluid leak
is visible, disassemble caliper assembly and install a new piston seal and dust boot, and piston if
scored.
GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS
Check the guide pin dust boots to determine if they are in good condition. Replace if they are
damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Guide Pin Bushing Disassembly or Assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front
Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
Removing Caliper Assembly From Steering Knuckle
Storing Brake Caliper
CAUTION: During service procedures, grease or any other foreign material must be kept off caliper
assembly, surfaces of braking rotor and external surfaces of hub. Handling of the braking rotor and
caliper should be done in such a way as to avoid deformation of the rotor and scratching or nicking
of the brake linings. During removal and installation of a wheel and tire assembly, use care not to
strike the caliper.
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4128
2. Remove the front wheel and tire assemblies from this vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 brake caliper to
steering knuckle guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper from steering knuckle, by first rotating free end
of caliper away from steering knuckle. Then slide opposite end of caliper out from
under machined abutment on steering knuckle.
5. Support the disc brake caliper firmly using a wire hanger. This is required to prevent the weight
of the caliper from damaging the flexible brake
hose.
Installing Caliper Assembly On Steering Knuckle
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing a caliper after new brake shoes have been
installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both steering
knuckle abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar* Multipurpose Lubricant, or equivalent. 3. If
removed, install the front rotor on the hub, making sure it is squarely seated on face of hub.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
4. Carefully position brake caliper and brake shoe assemblies by hooking the end of the caliper
under the edge of the steering knuckle. Then rotate
caliper into position on the steering knuckle. Make sure that caliper guide pin bolts, bushings and
sleeves are clear of the steering knuckle bosses.
5. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten to 18 to 20 Nm (192 in. lbs.). Extreme caution
should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide
pin bolts.
6. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 7. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 9. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
* Mopar is a registered trade mark of Chrysler Corporation.
Rear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4129
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
Caliper Removal/Installation
Storing Caliper
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel and tire assemblies
from vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 caliper assembly to adapter guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper
assembly from adapter and rotor by first rotating top of caliper assembly away from adapter, and
then lifting caliper assembly off
lower machined abutment on adapter.
5. Support caliper assembly firmly from rear strut to prevent weight of caliper from damaging the
flexible brake hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4130
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing the disc brake caliper, after new brake shoes
have been installed.
1. Completely retract caliper piston back into piston bore of caliper assembly. 2. Lubricate both
adapter abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar* Multipurpose Lubricant, or equivalent. 3. If
removed, install the rear rotor on the hub making sure it is squarely seated on the face of the hub.
CAUTION: Use care when installing caliper assembly onto adapter so the guide pin bushings and
sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
4. Carefully lower caliper and brake shoe assemblies over braking disc (rotor) reversing the
required removal procedure. Make sure that the caliper
guide pin bolts, bushings and sleeves are clear of the adapter bosses.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
5. Install caliper assembly guide pin bolts into adapter and tighten. Then torque both guide pin bolts
to 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.). 6. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 7. Tighten the wheel mounting stud
nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half specification. Then repeat the tightening
sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 9. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
* Mopar is a registered trademark of Chrysler Corporation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4131
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Disassembly
PROCEDURE WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD AIR PRESSURE EVER BE USED
TO REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
1. Remove caliper from brake rotor. Hang assembly on a wire hook away from rotor, so hydraulic
fluid cannot get on rotor. Place a small piece of
wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of bore. Then apply and hold
down the brake pedal to any position beyond the first
inch of pedal travel. This will prevent loss of brake fluid from the master cylinder.
3. If both front caliper pistons are to be removed, disconnect brake tube at flexible brake hose at
frame rail. Plug brake tube and remove piston from
opposite caliper using the same process as above for the first piston removal.
4. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion and binding of piston.
5. To disassemble caliper, mount in a vise equipped with protective jaws. 6. Remove guide pin
sleeves and guide pin bushings. Refer to Guide Pin Removal.
Fig. 10 Dust Boot Removal
7. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4132
Removing Piston Seal From Caliper
8. Using a soft tool, such as a plastic trim stick, work piston seal out of its groove in caliper piston
bore. Discard old seal. Do not use a screw driver
or other metal tool for this operation, because of the possibility of scratching piston bore or burring
edges of seal groove.
9. Clean all parts using alcohol or a suitable solvent and wipe dry using only a lint free cloth. No lint
residue can remain in caliper bore. Clean out all
drilled passages and bores. Whenever a caliper has been disassembled, a new boot and seal must
be installed at assembly.
Honing Brake Caliper Piston Bore
10. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent providing the diameter of the bore is not increased more than
0.0254 mm 0.001 inch..
11. If the bore does not clean up within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
Install a new piston if the old one is pitted or
scored.
NOTE: When using Caliper Honing Tool, Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent, coat the stones and
bore with brake fluid. After honing the bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff
non-metallic rotary brush.
NOTE: Use extreme care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing
the caliper with brake fluid; wipe dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean a second time.
CAUTION: When inspecting caliper piston, do not use anything but solvents to clean piston
surface. If surface of piston cannot be cleaned using only solvents, piston must be replaced.
12. Inspect caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace piston if there is
evidence of scratches, pitting or physical damage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4133
Assembly
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion and binding of piston.
1. Clamp caliper in a vise with protective caps installed on jaws of vise..
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
2. Dip new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install in the groove of the caliper bore. Seal should
be positioned at one area in groove and gently
worked around the groove, using only your fingers until properly seated. NEVER USE AN OLD
PISTON SEAL. Be sure that fingers are clean and seal is not twisted or rolled.
3. Coat new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside boot. 4. Position
dust boot over piston after coating with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force must be applied to the piston uniformly to avoid cocking and binding of the piston
in the bore of the caliper.
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
5. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 6.
Position dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4134
7. Using a hammer and Installer Piston Caliper Boot, Special Tool C-4689 and Handle, Special
Tool C-4171, or equivalent, drive boot into
counterbore of the caliper.
8. Install guide pin sleeves and bushings. Refer to Guide Pin Installation. 9. Install brake pads.
Refer to Disc Brake Pad Installation.
10. Before installing caliper assembly on vehicle, inspect brake rotor. If any conditions as described
in Checking Brake Rotor for Runout and
Thickness are present the rotor, must be replaced or refaced. If the rotor does not require any
servicing, install caliper assembly.
11. Install brake hose onto caliper using banjo bolt. Torque the brake hose to caliper assembly
banjo bolt to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs). New seal washers
MUST always be used when installing brake hose to caliper.
12. Bleed the brake system.
Removal
GENERAL INFORMATION
The double pin caliper uses a sealed for life bushing and sleeve assembly If required this assembly
can be serviced using the following procedure.
PROCEDURE
1. Remove caliper from brake rotor. Hang caliper assembly on a wire hook away from the brake
rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4135
Removing Inner Sleeve From Bushing
2. Push out and then pull the steel sleeve from the inside of the bushing using your fingers as
shown above.
Removing Bushing From Caliper
3. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the bushing. Then pull on the opposite side to remove
the bushing from the brake caliper housing.
Installation
PROCEDURE
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section of the bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4136
Installing Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper housing. Do not use a sharp object to perform this step
due to possible damage to the bushing.
Bushing Correctly Installed In Caliper
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. Flanges should be seated evenly
on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar, Silicone Dielectric Compound or an
equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4137
Fig 7 Installing Caliper Sleeves
5. Install guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until seal area of bushing is past seal groove in
sleeve. 6. Holding convoluted boot end of bushing with one hand, push steel sleeve bushing
through boot until one end of bushing is fully seated into seal
groove on one end of sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4138
Fig 8 Installed Caliper Bushing Sleeve
7. Holding sleeve in place, work other end of bushing over end of sleeve and into the seal grove on
sleeve. Be sure other end of bushing did not come
out of seal grove in sleeve.
8. When the sleeve is seated properly into the bushing, the sealed for life sleeve/bushing can be
held between your fingers and easily slid back and
forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 4139
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pad: > 05-10-97 > Dec > 97 > Front Brakes - Squeal or
Creep/Groan
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Front Brakes - Squeal or Creep/Groan
NO: 05-10-97
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Dec. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Front Brake Squeal And/Or Creep/Groan
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES WITH 14" DISC/DRUM (SALES CODE BRA AND BRJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake squeal moderate brake pedal application, or creep/groan
sound during zero speed creeping brake apply.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Drive the vehicle at 10 to 20 MPH, with moderate pressure apply the brakes. If a squeal sound is
heard perform the Repair Procedure.
2. With the brake pedal applied, place the transmission in "drive" and slowly release the brakes
until the vehicle just begins to creep. If a loud grinding, crunching, or groaning noise is heard from
the front brakes, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05011069AA Pad Set, Front Disc Brake
REPAIR PROCEDURE: This bulletin involves the replacement of the front brake pads.
1. Remove and replace the front brake pads following the repair procedure provided in the
appropriate Neon Service Manual, Group 5.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 05-70-22-90 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pad: > 05-10-97 > Dec > 97 > Front Brakes - Squeal
or Creep/Groan
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Brakes - Squeal or Creep/Groan
NO: 05-10-97
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Dec. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Front Brake Squeal And/Or Creep/Groan
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES WITH 14" DISC/DRUM (SALES CODE BRA AND BRJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Front brake squeal moderate brake pedal application, or creep/groan
sound during zero speed creeping brake apply.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Drive the vehicle at 10 to 20 MPH, with moderate pressure apply the brakes. If a squeal sound is
heard perform the Repair Procedure.
2. With the brake pedal applied, place the transmission in "drive" and slowly release the brakes
until the vehicle just begins to creep. If a loud grinding, crunching, or groaning noise is heard from
the front brakes, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05011069AA Pad Set, Front Disc Brake
REPAIR PROCEDURE: This bulletin involves the replacement of the front brake pads.
1. Remove and replace the front brake pads following the repair procedure provided in the
appropriate Neon Service Manual, Group 5.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 05-70-22-90 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Front
Brake Pad: Specifications Front
Brake Shoe Thickness Measurement
The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at the thinnest part of
the assembly.
When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of approximately 7.95 mm (5/16 inch) or
less, they should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Front > Page 4155
Brake Pad: Specifications Rear
Brake Shoe Thickness Measurement
The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at the thinnest part of
the assembly.
When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of approximately 7.0 mm (9/32 inch), they
should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Brake Pad: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: ALTHOUGH FACTORY INSTALLED BRAKE LININGS ARE MADE FROM
ASBESTOS FREE MATERIALS, SOME AFTER MARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS. THIS SHOULD BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE'S
BRAKE SYSTEM, WHEN AFTERMARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY HAVE BEEN INSTALLED ON
THE VEHICLE. ALWAYS WEAR A RESPIRATOR WHEN CLEANING BRAKE COMPONENTS AS
ASBESTOS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS BODILY HARM SUCH AS ASBESTOSIS AND OR CANCER.
NEVER CLEAN BRAKE COMPONENTS BY USING COMPRESSED AIR, USE ONLY A VACUUM
CLEANER SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE REMOVAL OF BRAKE DUST. IF A VACUUM
CLEANER IS NOT AVAILABLE, CLEAN BRAKE PARTS USING ONLY WATER DAMPENED
SHOP TOWELS. DO NOT CREATE BRAKE LINING DUST BY SANDING BRAKE LININGS
WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE. DISPOSE OF ALL DUST AND DIRT SUSPECTED OF
CONTAINING ASBESTOS FIBERS USING ONLY SEALED AIR TIGHT BAGS OR CONTAINERS.
FOLLOW ALL RECOMMENDED SAFETY PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL
SAFETY AND HEALTH ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
AGENCY (EPA), FOR HANDLING AND DISPOSAL OF PRODUCTS CONTAINING ASBESTOS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 4158
Brake Pad: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION: Use care when installing caliper assembly onto adapter, so the guide pin bushings and
sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
Removal
WARNING: ALTHOUGH FACTORY INSTALLED BRAKE LININGS ARE MADE FROM
ASBESTOS FREE MATERIALS, SOME AFTER MARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS. THIS SHOULD BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE'S
BRAKE SYSTEM, WHEN AFTERMARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY HAVE BEEN INSTALLED ON
THE VEHICLE. ALWAYS WEAR A RESPIRATOR WHEN CLEANING BRAKE COMPONENTS AS
ASBESTOS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS BODILY HARM SUCH AS ASBESTOSIS AND OR CANCER.
NEVER CLEAN BRAKE COMPONENTS BY USING COMPRESSED AIR, USE ONLY A VACUUM
CLEANER SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE REMOVAL OF BRAKE DUST. IF A VACUUM
CLEANER IS NOT AVAILABLE, CLEAN BRAKE PARTS USING ONLY WATER DAMPENED
SHOP TOWELS. DO NOT CREATE BRAKE LINING DUST BY SANDING BRAKE LININGS
WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE. DISPOSE OF ALL DUST AND DIRT SUSPECTED OF
CONTAINING ASBESTOS FIBERS USING ONLY SEALED AIR TIGHT BAGS OR CONTAINERS.
FOLLOW ALL RECOMMENDED SAFETY PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL
SAFETY AND HEALTH ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
AGENCY (EPA), FOR HANDLING AND DISPOSAL OF PRODUCTS CONTAINING ASBESTOS.
GENERAL INFORMATION
During service procedures, grease or any other foreign material must be kept off caliper assembly,
surfaces of braking rotor and external surfaces of hub. Handling of the braking rotor and caliper
should be done in such a way as to avoid deformation of the rotor and scratching or nicking of the
brake linings. If inspection reveals that the square sectioned caliper piston seal is worn or
damaged, it should be replaced immediately. During removal and installation of a wheel and tire
assembly, use care not to strike the caliper.
NOTE: Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
PROCEDURE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove front wheel and tire assemblies
from vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 caliper to steering knuckle guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper from
steering knuckle, by first rotating free end of caliper away from steering knuckle. Then slide
opposite end of caliper out from
under machined abutment on steering knuckle.
Storing Brake Caliper
5. Support caliper firmly to prevent weight of caliper from damaging the flexible brake hose. 6.
Remove front brake rotor from hub by pulling it straight off wheel mounting studs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4161
Removing Outboard Brake Pad
7. Remove outboard brake pad by prying the pad retaining clip over raised area on caliper. Then
slide the pad down and off the caliper.
Removing Inboard Brake Pad From Piston
8. Pull inboard brake pad away from piston until retaining clip is free from cavity in piston.
CALIPER INSPECTION
Check caliper for piston seal leaks (brake fluid in and around boot area and inboard lining) and for
any ruptures of the piston dust boot. If boot is damaged, or fluid leak is visible, disassemble caliper
and install a new seal and boot, (and piston if scored). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
Check the caliper dust boot and caliper pin bushings to determine if they are in good condition.
Replace if they are damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
Installation
WARNING: ALTHOUGH FACTORY INSTALLED BRAKE LININGS ARE MADE FROM
ASBESTOS FREE MATERIALS, SOME AFTER MARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS. THIS SHOULD BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE'S
BRAKE SYSTEM, WHEN AFTERMARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY HAVE BEEN INSTALLED ON
THE VEHICLE. ALWAYS WEAR A RESPIRATOR WHEN CLEANING BRAKE COMPONENTS AS
ASBESTOS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS BODILY HARM SUCH AS ASBESTOSIS AND OR CANCER.
NEVER CLEAN BRAKE COMPONENTS BY USING COMPRESSED AIR, USE ONLY A VACUUM
CLEANER SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE REMOVAL OF BRAKE DUST. IF A VACUUM
CLEANER IS NOT AVAILABLE, CLEAN BRAKE PARTS USING ONLY WATER DAMPENED
SHOP TOWELS. DO NOT CREATE BRAKE LINING DUST BY SANDING BRAKE LININGS
WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE. DISPOSE OF ALL DUST AND DIRT SUSPECTED OF
CONTAINING ASBESTOS FIBERS USING ONLY SEALED AIR TIGHT BAGS OR CONTAINERS.
FOLLOW ALL RECOMMENDED SAFETY PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL
SAFETY AND HEALTH ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
AGENCY (EPA), FOR HANDLING AND DISPOSAL OF PRODUCTS CONTAINING ASBESTOS.
NOTE: Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
CALIPER INSPECTION
Check caliper for piston seal leaks (brake fluid in and around boot area and inboard lining) and for
any ruptures of the piston dust boot. If boot is damaged, or fluid leak is visible, disassemble caliper
and install a new seal and boot, (and piston if scored). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4162
and Repair.
Check the caliper dust boot and caliper pin bushings to determine if they are in good condition.
Replace if they are damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
PROCEDURE
1. Completely retract caliper piston back into piston bore of caliper assembly. This is required for
caliper installation with new brake shoe
assemblies.
2. Lubricate both steering knuckle abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar Multipurpose
Lubricant, or equivalent. 3. Install the front rotor on the hub, making sure it is squarely seated on
face of hub. 4. Remove the protective paper from the noise suppression gasket on both the inner
and outer brake shoe assemblies (if equipped).
Front Brake Shoe Assembly Identification
NOTE: The inboard and outboard brake shoes are not common.
Inboard Brake Shoe
5. Install the new inboard brake shoe assembly into the caliper piston by firmly pressing into piston
bore with thumbs. Be sure inboard brake shoe
assembly is positioned squarely against face of caliper piston.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4163
Installing Outboard Brake Shoe
6. Slide the new outboard brake shoe assembly onto the caliper assembly.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
7. Carefully position brake caliper and brake shoe assemblies over brake rotor by hooking end of
caliper under the steering knuckle. Then rotate
caliper into position on steering knuckle. Make sure that caliper guide pin bolts, bushings and
sleeves are clear of the steering knuckle bosses.
8. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten to 18 to 20 Nm (192 in. lbs.). Extreme caution
should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide
pin bolts.
9. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
10. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
11. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 12. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
Cleaning and Inspection
LINING WEAR
If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will
be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the wheel and tire assemblies, and the
calipers. Remove the front disc brake shoes. Refer to Disc Brake Pad Rear Removal.
Material Thickness The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at
the thinnest part of the assembly. When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of
approximately 7.95 mm (5/16 inch) they should be replaced. Replace both brake shoe assemblies
(inboard and outboard). It is necessary that both front wheel sets be replaced whenever brake shoe
assemblies on either side are replaced.
If Replacement Is Not Required If the brake shoe assemblies do not require replacement, reinstall,
the assemblies making sure each brake shoe is returned to the original position. Refer to Disc
Brake Pad Front Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4164
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
Removal
WARNING: ALTHOUGH FACTORY INSTALLED BRAKE LININGS ARE MADE FROM
ASBESTOS FREE MATERIALS, SOME AFTER MARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS. THIS SHOULD BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE'S
BRAKE SYSTEM, WHEN AFTERMARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY HAVE BEEN INSTALLED ON
THE VEHICLE. ALWAYS WEAR A RESPIRATOR WHEN CLEANING BRAKE COMPONENTS AS
ASBESTOS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS BODILY HARM SUCH AS ASBESTOSIS AND OR CANCER.
NEVER CLEAN BRAKE COMPONENTS BY USING COMPRESSED AIR, USE ONLY A VACUUM
CLEANER SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE REMOVAL OF BRAKE DUST. IF A VACUUM
CLEANER IS NOT AVAILABLE, CLEAN BRAKE PARTS USING ONLY WATER DAMPENED
SHOP TOWELS. DO NOT CREATE BRAKE LINING DUST BY SANDING BRAKE LININGS
WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE. DISPOSE OF ALL DUST AND DIRT SUSPECTED OF
CONTAINING ASBESTOS FIBERS USING ONLY SEALED AIR TIGHT BAGS OR CONTAINERS.
FOLLOW ALL RECOMMENDED SAFETY PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL
SAFETY AND HEALTH ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
AGENCY (EPA), FOR HANDLING AND DISPOSAL OF PRODUCTS CONTAINING ASBESTOS.
GENERAL INFORMATION
During service procedures, grease or any other foreign material must be kept off caliper assembly,
surfaces of braking rotor and external surfaces of hub. Handling of the braking rotor and caliper
should be done in such a way as to avoid deformation of the rotor and scratching or nicking of the
brake linings.If inspection reveals that the square sectioned caliper piston seal is worn or damaged,
it should be replaced immediately. During removal and installation of a wheel and tire assembly,
use care not to strike the caliper.
NOTE: Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
PROCEDURE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel and tire assemblies
from vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 caliper assembly to adapter guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper
assembly from adapter and rotor by first rotating top of caliper assembly away from adapter, and
then lifting caliper assembly off
lower machined abutment on adapter.
Storing Caliper
5. Support caliper assembly firmly from rear strut to prevent weight of caliper from damaging the
flexible brake hose. 6. Remove rear rotor from hub/bearing assembly. Then inspect drum-in-hat
parking brake shoes and parking brake braking surface on rotor for any
signs of excessive wear or damage. Replace parking brake shoes if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4165
Removing/Installing Outboard Brake Shoe
7. Remove outboard brake pad from caliper by prying brake pad retaining clip over raised area on
caliper. Then slide brake pad down and off the
caliper.
Removing Inboard Brake Pad
8. Pull inboard brake pad away from caliper piston, until retaining clip is free from cavity in piston.
CALIPER INSPECTION
Check caliper for piston seal leaks (brake fluid in and around boot area and inboard lining) and for
any ruptures of the piston dust boot. If boot is damaged, or fluid leak is visible, disassemble caliper
and install a new seal and boot, (and piston if scored). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
Check the caliper dust boot and caliper pin bushings to determine if they are in good condition.
Replace if they are damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
Installation
WARNING: ALTHOUGH FACTORY INSTALLED BRAKE LININGS ARE MADE FROM
ASBESTOS FREE MATERIALS, SOME AFTER MARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS. THIS SHOULD BE TAKEN INTO ACCOUNT WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE'S
BRAKE SYSTEM, WHEN AFTERMARKET BRAKE LININGS MAY HAVE BEEN INSTALLED ON
THE VEHICLE. ALWAYS WEAR A RESPIRATOR WHEN CLEANING BRAKE COMPONENTS AS
ASBESTOS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS BODILY HARM SUCH AS ASBESTOSIS AND OR CANCER.
NEVER CLEAN BRAKE COMPONENTS BY USING COMPRESSED AIR, USE ONLY A VACUUM
CLEANER SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE REMOVAL OF BRAKE DUST. IF A VACUUM
CLEANER IS NOT AVAILABLE, CLEAN BRAKE PARTS USING ONLY WATER DAMPENED
SHOP TOWELS. DO NOT CREATE BRAKE LINING DUST BY SANDING BRAKE LININGS
WHEN SERVICING A VEHICLE. DISPOSE OF ALL DUST AND DIRT SUSPECTED OF
CONTAINING ASBESTOS FIBERS USING ONLY SEALED AIR TIGHT BAGS OR CONTAINERS.
FOLLOW ALL RECOMMENDED SAFETY PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL
SAFETY AND HEALTH ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4166
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA), FOR HANDLING AND DISPOSAL OF
PRODUCTS CONTAINING ASBESTOS.
NOTE: Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
CALIPER INSPECTION
Check caliper for piston seal leaks (brake fluid in and around boot area and inboard lining) and for
any ruptures of the piston dust boot. If boot is damaged, or fluid leak is visible, disassemble caliper
and install a new seal and boot, (and piston if scored). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
Check the caliper dust boot and caliper pin bushings to determine if they are in good condition.
Replace if they are damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and
Repair.
PROCEDURE
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the piston bore of the caliper assembly. This is
required for caliper installation when new brake pad
assemblies are installed on caliper.
2. Lubricate both adapter abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar Multipurpose Lubricant, or
equivalent.
3. Install rear rotor on the hub making sure it is squarely seated on face of hub. 4. Remove
protective paper from noise suppression gasket on both inner and outer brake pad assemblies (if
equipped). 5. Install new inboard brake shoe assembly into caliper piston by firmly pressing into
piston bore with thumbs. Be sure inboard brake shoe assembly
is positioned squarely against face of caliper piston.
6. Slide new outboard brake pad assembly onto the caliper assembly. Be sure retaining clip is
squarely seated in the depressed areas on the caliper.
CAUTION: Use care when installing caliper assembly onto adapter, so the guide pin bushings and
sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
7. Carefully lower caliper and brake shoe assemblies over braking disc (rotor) reversing the
required removal procedure. Make sure that caliper guide
pin bolts, bushings and sleeves are clear of the adapter bosses.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
8. Install caliper assembly guide pin bolts into adapter and tighten. Then torque both guide pin bolts
to 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.). 9. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
10. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
11. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 12. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
Cleaning and Inspection
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4167
LINING WEAR
If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition of the lining, a physical check will
be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the wheel and tire assemblies, and the
calipers. Remove the rear disc brake shoes. Refer to Disc Brake Pad Rear Removal.
Material Thickness The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at
the thinnest part of the assembly. When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of
approximately 7.0 mm (9/32 inch) they should be replaced. Replace both brake shoe assemblies
(inboard and outboard). It is necessary that both rear wheel sets be replaced whenever brake shoe
assemblies on either side are replaced.
If Replacement Is Not Required If the brake shoe assemblies do not require replacement, reinstall,
the assemblies making sure each brake shoe is returned to the original position. Refer to Disc
Brake Pad Rear Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Rotor Specifications
Rotor Specifications
BRAKE ROTOR Front Rear
ROTOR TYPE Vented Solid
ROTOR THICKNESS 19.87 - 20.13 mm (0.782 - 0.793 in.) 8.75 - 9.25 mm (0.344 - 0.364 in.)
MINIMUM ROTOR THICKNESS 18.4 mm (0.724 in.) 7.25 mm (0.285 in.)
Brake rotor minimum thickness is cast/stamped on the outer
surface of the rotor hub. This marking includes 0.76 mm
(0.030 in.) allowable rotor wear beyond the recommended
0.76 mm (0.030 in.) of rotor refacing.
ROTOR THICKNESS VARIATION 0.013 mm (0.0005 in.) 0.013 mm (0.0005 in.)
ROTOR RUNOUT * 0.13 mm (0.005 in.) 0.13 mm (0.005 in.)
* TIR - Total Indicator Reading (measured on vehicle)
ROTOR MICRO-FINISH 15 - 80 RMS 15 - 80 RMS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4171
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service Precautions
NOTE:
- Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor to within service tolerances
to ensure proper brake action.
- All rotors have markings for minimum allowable thickness cast on an un-machined surface of the
rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4172
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection
Checking Rotor For Runout
Indexing Rotor And Hub
Checking Hub For Runout
GENERAL INFORMATION
Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor within service tolerances to
ensure proper brake action. Before refinishing or refacing a rotor, the disc should be checked and
inspected for the following conditions:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4173
^ Braking surface scoring, rust, impregnation of lining material and worn ridges.
^ Excessive lateral runout or wobble.
^ Thickness variation (Parallelism).
^ Dishing or distortion (Flatness).
If a vehicle has not been driven for a period of time, the rotor surface will rust in the area not
covered by the brake lining and cause noise and chatter when the brakes are applied. Excessive
wear and scoring of the rotor can cause temporary improper lining contact if ridges are not
removed before installation of new brake pad assemblies. Some discoloration or wear of the rotor
surface is normal and does not require resurfacing when linings are replaced. Excessive runout or
wobble in a rotor can increase pedal travel due to piston knock back. This will increase guide pin
sleeve wear due to tendency of caliper to follow rotor wobble. Thickness variation in a rotor can
also result in pedal pulsation, chatter and surge due to variation in brake output. This can also be
caused by excessive runout in rotor or hub. Dishing or distortion can be caused by extreme heat
and abuse of the brakes.
RUNOUT
On vehicle rotor runout is the combination of the individual runout of the hub face and the runout of
the rotor. (The hub and rotor runouts are separable). To measure runout on the vehicle, remove the
wheel and reinstall the lug nuts tightening the rotor to the hub. Mount Dial Indicator, Special Tool
C-3339 with Mounting Adapter, Special Tool SP-1910, or equivalents on steering arm. Dial
indicator plunger should contact braking surface of rotor approximately one inch from edge of rotor.
Check lateral runout (both sides of rotor) runout should not exceed 0.13 mm (0.005 inch). If runout
is in excess of the specification, check the lateral runout of the hub face. Before removing rotor
from hub, make a chalk mark across both the rotor and one wheel stud on the high side of runout
so you'll know exactly how the rotor and hub was originally mounted. Remove rotor from hub.
Install Dial Indicator, Special Tool C-3339 and Mounting Adapter, Special Tool SP- 1910, or
equivalents on steering knuckle. Position stem so it contacts hub face near outer diameter. Care
must be taken to position stem outside the stud circle but inside the chamfer on the hub rim. Clean
hub surface before checking. Runout should not exceed 0.08 mm (0.003 inch). If runout exceeds
this specification, hub must be replaced. Refer to Steering and Suspension. If hub runout does not
exceed this specification, install rotor on hub with chalk marks two wheel studs apart. Tighten nuts
in the proper sequence and torque to specifications. Finally, check runout of rotor to see if runout is
now within specifications. If runout is not within specifications, install a new rotor or reface rotor,
being careful to remove as little as possible from each side of rotor. Remove equal amounts from
each side of rotor. Do not reduce thickness below minimum thickness cast into the unmachined
surface of the rotor.
Checking Rotor For Thickness Variation
THICKNESS VARIATION
Thickness variation measurements of rotor should be made in conjunction with runout. Measure
thickness of rotor at 12 equal points with a micrometer at a radius approximately 25 mm (1 inch)
from edge of rotor. If thickness measurements vary by more than 0.013 mm (0.0005 inch) rotor
should be removed and resurfaced, or a new rotor installed. If cracks or burned spots are evident,
rotor must be replaced. Light scoring and/or wear is acceptable. If heavy scoring or warping is
evident, the rotor must be machined or replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4174
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair
Fig 6 Refacing Brake Disc
Fig 7 Refacing Brake Disc -- Final Finish
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4175
Front Rotor Thickness Markings
NOTE: All rotors have markings for minimum allowable thickness cast on an un-machined surface
of the rotor.
NOTE: Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor to within service
tolerances to ensure proper brake action.
MACHINING PROCEDURES
If the rotor surface is deeply scored or warped, or there is a complaint of brake roughness or
pulsation, the rotor should be resurfaced, refaced or replaced. The previous image shows the
location of measurements and specifications when servicing the rotor. This marking includes 0.76
mm (0.030 inch) allowable rotor wear beyond the recommended 0.76 mm (0.030 inch) of rotor
refacing. The collets, shafts and adapters used on the brake lathe and the bearing cups in the rotor
MUST be clean and free from any chips or contamination. When mounting the rotor on the brake
lathe, strict attention to the brake lathe manufacturer's operating instructions is required. If the rotor
is not mounted properly, the lateral runout will be worse after refacing or resurfacing than before.
REFACING BRAKE ROTOR
Refacing of the rotor is not required each time the brake pads are replaced.When refacing a rotor
the required 0.8 mm (0.003 inch) Total Indicator Reading (TIR) and 0.013 mm (0.0005 inch)
thickness variation limits MUST BE MAINTAINED. Extreme care in the operation of rotor turning
equipment is required. The use of a double straddle cutter that machines both sides of the rotor at
the same time is highly recommended.
RESURFACING BRAKE ROTOR
This operation can be used when rotor surface is rusty, has lining deposits or excessive lateral
runout or thickness variation is evident. A sanding rotor attachment will remove surface
contamination without removing much rotor material. It will generally follow variations in thickness
that are in the rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Backing Plate: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During
Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Backing Plate: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During
Low Speed Stop > Page 4185
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Backing Plate: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes Howl During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Backing Plate: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes Howl During Low Speed Stop > Page 4191
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4192
Backing Plate: Specifications
Support Plate To Knuckle Casting Attaching Bolts
.................................................................................................................................. 75 Nm (55 ft.
lbs.) Tube Nut To Wheel Cylinder Fitting
.................................................................................................................................................... 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.). Hub And Bearing Assembly Retaining Nut
.......................................................................................................................................... 217 Nm
(160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal
Backing Plate: Service and Repair Removal
PROCEDURE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove rear tire and wheel assembly
from vehicle.
Rear Hub And Bearing Dust Cap
3. Remove bearing dust cap from the rear hub and bearing assembly.
4. Remove the rear hub and bearing assembly retaining nut. Then remove the rear hub and
bearing assembly from spindle. 5. Remove rear brake shoe assemblies from the brake support
plate. Refer to Rear Brake Shoes Service and Repair Removal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4195
6. Disconnect rear brake flex hose tube from wheel cylinder. 7. Remove park brake actuator lever
from the park brake cable.
8. Position a 1/2 wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable. Compress
cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
housing out of support plate. Remove wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear brake support plate. Alternate method is to use a aircraft type hose clamp
over cable housing end fitting compressing the three fingers.
9. Remove the 4 brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies. Separate
brake support plate from rear suspension knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4196
Backing Plate: Service and Repair Installation
PROCEDURE
1. Install brake support plate and gasket on rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque support plate
to knuckle casting attaching bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft.
lbs.).
2. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate. 3. Hand start hydraulic brake hose
tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.). 4.
Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator. 5. Install rear brake shoe assemblies on
the brake support plate. Refer to Rear Brake Shoes Service and Repair installation.
6. Install rear hub and bearing assembly on rear spindle. Install a NEW hub and bearing assembly
retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly
retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). Install dust cap.
7. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation. 8. Install brake
drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes. 9. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal
several times to do final adjustment of the brake shoe assemblies.
10. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half specification. Then
repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Drum: Specifications
Rear Drum Specifications
Nominal Diameter ................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 7.875"
Maximum Machine Limit ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 7.904"
Discard Diameter .................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 7.921"
Runout Limit ........................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 0.006"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4200
Brake Drum: Service and Repair
Brake Drum And Hub And Bearing Assembly
REMOVE
Further clearance can be obtained by backing off the brake automatic adjuster screw. Remove
rubber plug from top of brake support plate. Rotate automatic adjuster screw assembly with an
upward motion, using a medium size screwdriver. 1.
Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies from the vehicle.
3. Remove rear brake drum to hub retaining clips (if equipped).
4. Remove rear brake drum from rear hub/bearing assembly.
5. Inspect brake linings for wear, shoe alignment and contamination.
Maximum Brake Drum Diameter Identification
Measure drum runout and diameter. If not to specification, reface drum. (Runout should not exceed
0.1524 mm or 0.006 inch). The diameter variation (oval shape) of the drum braking surface must
not exceed either 0.0635 mm (0.0025 inch) in 30° or 0.0889 mm (0.0035 inch) in 360°. All brake
drums are marked with the maximum allowable brake drum diameter.
INSTALL
1. Install rear brake drum assembly on rear hub and bearing assembly. 2. Install the wheel and tire
assembly. 3. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to
half specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Removal
PROCEDURE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove the rear wheel and tire
assemblies from the vehicle.
Rear Brake Drum Assembly
3. Remove rear brake drum to hub retaining clips (if equipped). Then remove rear brake drum from
hub and bearing assembly.
Automatic Adjustment Lever Spring
4. Remove adjustment lever to brake shoe spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4205
5. Remove automatic adjustment lever.
6. Remove both brake shoe assembly to brake support plate hold down clips and pins.
7. Remove lower brake shoe to anchor plate return spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4206
8. Remove the park brake lever pin to rear brake shoe retaining clip.
Remove/Install Brake Shoes
9. Remove front and rear brake shoe assemblies, upper return spring and automatic adjuster screw
from brake support plate as an assembly.
CLEANING AND INSPECTION
Clean metal portion of brake shoes. Check to see if shoes are bent. Lining should show contact
across entire width and from heel to toe, otherwise replace. Shoes with lack of contact at toe or
heel may be improperly ground. Clean and inspect support and adjusting screws. Apply a thin coat
of Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant or equivalent to the threads of the self adjuster. Replace
adjusting screw if corroded. If old springs have overheated or are damaged, replace. Overheating
indications are paint discoloration or distorted end coils.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4207
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Installation
CLEANING AND INSPECTION
Clean metal portion of brake shoes. Check to see if shoes are bent. Lining should show contact
across entire width and from heel to toe, otherwise replace. Shoes with lack of contact at toe or
heel may be improperly ground. Clean and inspect support and adjusting screws. Apply a thin coat
of Mopar Multi-Purpose Lubricant or equivalent to the threads of the self adjuster. Replace
adjusting screw if corroded. If old springs have overheated or are damaged, replace. Overheating
indications are paint discoloration or distorted end coils.
PROCEDURE
1. Lubricate the eight shoe contact areas on the support plate and anchor using Mopar
Multi-Purpose Lubricant or equivalent. 2. Assemble front and rear brake shoe assembly, automatic
adjuster screw and upper return spring before installation on brake support plate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4208
Remove/Install Brake Shoes
3. Install the pre-assembled brake shoes, automatic adjuster screw and upper return spring on the
brake support plate. 4. Install the wave washer on the pin of park brake lever.
5. Install pin on park brake lever into hole in rear brake shoe assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4209
6. Install both brake shoe, to brake support plate, hold down pins and clips.
7. Install the lower brake shoe to anchor plate return spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4210
8. Install the automatic adjustment lever, on the front brake shoe of the rear wheel brake assembly.
Automatic Adjustment Lever Spring
9. Install the automatic adjustment lever to front brake shoe assembly spring.
10. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation. 11. Install the
rear brake drums on the hubs. 12. Adjust rear brake shoes. 13. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
14. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
15. Road test vehicle. The automatic adjuster will continue the brake adjustment during the road
test of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder 115 in.lb
Tube Nut 145 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4214
Rear Wheel Cylinder (Exploded View)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4215
Wheel Cylinder: Service Precautions
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake shoe assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Remove rear brake drum. 4. Remove rear brake shoe
assemblies from the brake support plate. Refer to Brake Shoe Service and Repair Removal. 5. If
brake shoes are wet with grease or brake fluid, remove and replace. 6. Disconnect the rear brake
flex hose from the wheel cylinder. 7. Remove rear wheel cylinder attaching bolts. 8. Remove rear
wheel cylinder assembly from brake support plate.
INSTALL
1. Apply a small bead of silicone sealer around the mating surface of the wheel cylinder to brake
support plate.
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake shoe assemblies.
2. Install wheel cylinder onto brake support plate. Tighten the attaching bolts to 13 Nm (115 in.
lbs.). 3. Hand start hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to 17 Nm
(145 in. lbs.). 4. Install rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate. Refer to Brake Shoe
Service and Repair Installation. 5. Install rear brake drum onto rear hub. 6. Install the wheel and tire
assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to
half specification. Then
repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4218
7. Adjust the rear brakes. 8. Bleed the entire brake system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4219
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
With brake drums removed, inspect the wheel cylinder boots for evidence of a brake fluid leak.
Visually check the boots for cuts, tears, or heat cracks. If any of these conditions exist, the wheel
cylinders should be completely cleaned, inspected and new parts installed.
If a wheel cylinder is leaking and the brake lining material is saturated with brake fluid, the brake
shoes must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4220
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Wheel Cylinder Overhaul
Fig 3 Wheel Cylinder
DISASSEMBLE
To disassemble the wheel cylinders, proceed as follows: 1.
Pry boots away from cylinders and remove.
2. Press IN on one piston to force out opposite piston, cup and spring. Then using a soft tool such
as a dowel rod, press out the cup and piston that remain in the wheel cylinder.
3. Wash wheel cylinder, pistons, and spring in clean brake fluid or alcohol; DO NOT USE ANY
PETROLEUM BASE SOLVENTS. clean thoroughly and blow dry with compressed air. Inspect
cylinder bore and piston for scoring and pitting. Do not use a rag as lint from the rag will stick to
bore surfaces..
4. Wheel cylinder bores and pistons that are badly scored or pitted should be replaced. Cylinder
walls that have light scratches, or show signs of corrosion, can usually be cleaned with crocus
cloth, using a circular motion. Black stains on the cylinder walls are caused by piston cups and will
not impair operation of cylinder.
ASSEMBLE
Before assembling the pistons and new cups in the wheel cylinders, dip them in clean brake fluid. If
the boots are deteriorated, cracked or do not fit tightly on the pistons or the cylinder casting, install
new boots. 1.
Coat cylinder bore with clean brake fluid.
2. Lightly coat the sealing lip and outer surfaces of the wheel cylinder cups with Mopar
Protect-A-Cup Lubricant.
3. Install expansion spring with cup expanders in cylinder. Install cups in each end of cylinder with
open end of cups facing each other.
4. Install piston in each end of cylinder having the flat face of each piston contacting the flat face of
each cup, already installed.
5. Coat the interior surfaces of the push on boots with the Mopar Protect-A-Cup Lubricant
6. Install a boot over each end of cylinder. Be careful not to damage boot during installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures
GENERAL INFORMATION
The base brake system must be bled anytime air is permitted to enter the hydraulic system, due to
disconnection of brake lines, hoses or components. The Antilock Brake System (ABS), particularly
the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU), should only be bled when the HCU is. replaced or removed from
the vehicle, or if there is reason to believe the HCU has ingested air. Under most circumstances
that would require brake bleeding, only the base brake system needs to be bled. It is important to
note that excessive air in the brake system will cause a soft or spongy feeling brake pedal.
During Bleeding Operations - be sure that the brake fluid level remains close to the FULL level in
the reservoir. Check the fluid level periodically during the bleeding procedure and add DOT 3 brake
fluid as required. The Bendix ABX-4 Brake System must be bled as two independent braking
systems. The non ABS portion of the brake system is to be bled the same as any non ABS system.
Refer to Brakes Service and Repair for the proper bleeding procedure to be used. This brake
system can be either pressure bled or manually bled. The ABS portion of brake system MUST be
bled separately. This bleeding procedure requires the use of the DRB scan tool and the bleeding
sequence procedure outlined below.
ABS BLEEDING PROCEDURE
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence MUST be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding. The ABS system can be bled using a Manual bleeding procedure
or standard Pressure Bleeding Equipment. If the brake system is to be bled using pressure
bleeding equipment, refer to Brakes Service and Repair.
1. Assemble and install all brake system components on vehicle making sure all hydraulic fluid
lines are installed and properly torqued.
ABS System Diagnostic Connector
2. Connect the DRB scan tool to the diagnostics connector. The diagnostics connector is located
under the steering column cover, directly below the steering column.
3. Using the DRB scan tool, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it
does, remove them using the DRB scan tool.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE. BRAKE FLUID AT
HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure as
outlined in Brakes Service and Repair.
5. Using the DRB scan tool, go to the "Bleed ABS" routine. Apply the brake pedal firmly and initiate
the "Bleed ABS" cycle one time. Release the brake pedal.
6. Bleed the base brake system again, as in step Step 4 above.
7. Repeat steps Step 5 and Step 6 above until brake fluid flows clear and free of bubbles. Check
brake fluid level in reservoir periodically to prevent reservoir from running low on brake fluid.
8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure brake are operating correctly and that pedal is solid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures > Page 4226
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure Bleeding (Preferred Procedure)
Air Trapped In Brake System
Method For Purging Air From Brake System
Bleeder Screw
CAUTION:
- Before removing the Master Cylinder cover, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder.
- Use bleeder tank Special Tool C-3496-B, or equivalent with required adapter for the master
cylinder reservoir to pressurize the hydraulic system for bleeding.
NOTE:
- For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Hydraulic Control Unit.
- Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding equipment.
PROCEDURE
When bleeding the brake system, some air may be trapped in the brake lines or valves far
upstream, as much as ten feet from the bleeder screw.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Brake System Bleeding Procedures > Page 4227
Therefore, it is essential to have a fast flow of a large volume of brake fluid when bleeding the
brakes to ensure all the air gets out. The following wheel sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic
system should be used to ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
^ Left rear wheel
^ Right front wheel
^ Right rear wheel
^ Left front wheel
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw starting at the right rear wheel and feed the hose
into a clear jar containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
2. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain an steady stream of brake fluid.
3. After 4 to 8 ounces of fluid has been bled through the brake and an air-free flow is maintained in
the clear plastic hose and jar, close the bleeder screw.
4. Repeat the procedure at all the other remaining bleeder screws. Then check the pedal for travel.
If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, enough fluid has not passed through the
system to expel all the trapped air. Be sure to monitor the fluid level in the pressure bleeder. It must
stay at the proper level so air will not be allowed to reenter the brake system through the master
cylinder reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications Brake Caliper to Steering Knuckle Torque
Brake Caliper to Steering Knuckle Torque
Brake Caliper Bolt 31 Nm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Brake Caliper: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD AIR PRESSURE EVER BE USED TO REMOVE A
PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM SUCH A
PRACTICE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 4233
Brake Caliper: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on the
caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
- Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will cause
bore distortion and binding of piston.
- Force must be applied to the piston uniformly to avoid cocking and binding of the piston in the
bore of the caliper.
- When inspecting caliper piston, do not use anything but solvents to clean piston surface. If
surface of piston cannot be cleaned using only solvents, piston must be replaced.
NOTE:
- When being installed, extreme caution must be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin
bolts.
- Before vehicle is moved after any brake service work, pump the brake pedal several times to
insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal.
- When using Caliper Honing Tool, Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent, coat the stones and bore
with brake fluid. After honing the bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff
non-metallic rotary brush.
- Use extreme care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the
caliper with brake fluid; wipe dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean a second time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Caliper
Brake Caliper: Description and Operation Front Caliper
Exploded View Of Front Caliper
Fig. 2 Piston Seal Function
GENERAL INFORMATION
The caliper is mounted to the steering knuckle using bushings, sleeves and 2 guide pin bolts which
thread directly into bosses on the steering knuckle. Two machined abutments on the steering
knuckle position the caliper. The guide pin bolts, sleeves and bushings control the side to side
movement of the caliper. The piston seal is designed to pull the piston back into the bore of the
caliper when the brake pedal is released. This maintains the proper brake shoe to rotor clearance.
The caliper is a one piece casting with the inboard side containing a single piston cylinder bore.
The front disc brake caliper piston, is manufactured from a phenolic compound. The outside
diameter of the caliper piston is 54 mm. A square cut rubber piston seal is located in a machined
groove in the caliper cylinder bore. This provides a hydraulic seal between the piston and the
cylinder wall. A rubber dust boot is installed in the cylinder bore opening and in a groove in the
piston. This prevents contamination in the bore area. As front disc brake linings wear, master
cylinder reservoir brake fluid level will drop. Fluid level should be checked after replacing linings.
Front disc brakes are equipped with an audible wear indicator on the outboard brake pad. This
sensor omits a sound when the brake lining may need inspection and/or replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front Caliper > Page 4236
Brake Caliper: Description and Operation Rear Caliper
Rear Disc Brake Assembly
GENERAL INFORMATION
Vehicles are equipped with a caliper assembly that has a 34 mm (1.43 in.) piston and uses a solid
non-vented rotor. The caliper assembly on all applications float on rubber bushings using internal
metal sleeves which are attached to the adapter using threaded guide pin bolts. The adapter and
rotor shield are mounted to the rear suspension knuckles of vehicle. The adapter is used to mount
the brake shoes and actuating cables for the parking brake system. The adapter also mounts the
rear caliper assembly to the vehicle. The adapter has two machined abutments which are used to
position and align the caliper and brake pads for movement inboard and outboard.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4237
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection
PISTON SEAL
Check for brake fluid leaks in and around dust boot area and inboard brake pad, and for any
ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot. If the dust boot is damaged, or a fluid leak
is visible, disassemble caliper assembly and install a new piston seal and dust boot, and piston if
scored.
GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS
Check the guide pin dust boots to determine if they are in good condition. Replace if they are
damaged, dry, or found to be brittle. Refer to Guide Pin Bushing Disassembly or Assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front
Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
Removing Caliper Assembly From Steering Knuckle
Storing Brake Caliper
CAUTION: During service procedures, grease or any other foreign material must be kept off caliper
assembly, surfaces of braking rotor and external surfaces of hub. Handling of the braking rotor and
caliper should be done in such a way as to avoid deformation of the rotor and scratching or nicking
of the brake linings. During removal and installation of a wheel and tire assembly, use care not to
strike the caliper.
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4240
2. Remove the front wheel and tire assemblies from this vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 brake caliper to
steering knuckle guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper from steering knuckle, by first rotating free end
of caliper away from steering knuckle. Then slide opposite end of caliper out from
under machined abutment on steering knuckle.
5. Support the disc brake caliper firmly using a wire hanger. This is required to prevent the weight
of the caliper from damaging the flexible brake
hose.
Installing Caliper Assembly On Steering Knuckle
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing a caliper after new brake shoes have been
installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both steering
knuckle abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar* Multipurpose Lubricant, or equivalent. 3. If
removed, install the front rotor on the hub, making sure it is squarely seated on face of hub.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
4. Carefully position brake caliper and brake shoe assemblies by hooking the end of the caliper
under the edge of the steering knuckle. Then rotate
caliper into position on the steering knuckle. Make sure that caliper guide pin bolts, bushings and
sleeves are clear of the steering knuckle bosses.
5. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten to 18 to 20 Nm (192 in. lbs.). Extreme caution
should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide
pin bolts.
6. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 7. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 9. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
* Mopar is a registered trade mark of Chrysler Corporation.
Rear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4241
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
Caliper Removal/Installation
Storing Caliper
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel and tire assemblies
from vehicle. 3. Remove the 2 caliper assembly to adapter guide pin bolts. 4. Remove caliper
assembly from adapter and rotor by first rotating top of caliper assembly away from adapter, and
then lifting caliper assembly off
lower machined abutment on adapter.
5. Support caliper assembly firmly from rear strut to prevent weight of caliper from damaging the
flexible brake hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4242
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing the disc brake caliper, after new brake shoes
have been installed.
1. Completely retract caliper piston back into piston bore of caliper assembly. 2. Lubricate both
adapter abutments with a liberal amount of Mopar* Multipurpose Lubricant, or equivalent. 3. If
removed, install the rear rotor on the hub making sure it is squarely seated on the face of the hub.
CAUTION: Use care when installing caliper assembly onto adapter so the guide pin bushings and
sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
4. Carefully lower caliper and brake shoe assemblies over braking disc (rotor) reversing the
required removal procedure. Make sure that the caliper
guide pin bolts, bushings and sleeves are clear of the adapter bosses.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
5. Install caliper assembly guide pin bolts into adapter and tighten. Then torque both guide pin bolts
to 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.). 6. Install the wheel and tire assembly. 7. Tighten the wheel mounting stud
nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half specification. Then repeat the tightening
sequence to the
full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
8. Remove jackstands or lower hoist. Before moving vehicle, pump the brake pedal several times
to insure the vehicle has a firm brake pedal. 9. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to
wear off any foreign material on the brakes and to seat the brake pads.
* Mopar is a registered trademark of Chrysler Corporation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4243
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
Disassembly
PROCEDURE WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD AIR PRESSURE EVER BE USED
TO REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
1. Remove caliper from brake rotor. Hang assembly on a wire hook away from rotor, so hydraulic
fluid cannot get on rotor. Place a small piece of
wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of bore. Then apply and hold
down the brake pedal to any position beyond the first
inch of pedal travel. This will prevent loss of brake fluid from the master cylinder.
3. If both front caliper pistons are to be removed, disconnect brake tube at flexible brake hose at
frame rail. Plug brake tube and remove piston from
opposite caliper using the same process as above for the first piston removal.
4. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion and binding of piston.
5. To disassemble caliper, mount in a vise equipped with protective jaws. 6. Remove guide pin
sleeves and guide pin bushings. Refer to Guide Pin Removal.
Fig. 10 Dust Boot Removal
7. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4244
Removing Piston Seal From Caliper
8. Using a soft tool, such as a plastic trim stick, work piston seal out of its groove in caliper piston
bore. Discard old seal. Do not use a screw driver
or other metal tool for this operation, because of the possibility of scratching piston bore or burring
edges of seal groove.
9. Clean all parts using alcohol or a suitable solvent and wipe dry using only a lint free cloth. No lint
residue can remain in caliper bore. Clean out all
drilled passages and bores. Whenever a caliper has been disassembled, a new boot and seal must
be installed at assembly.
Honing Brake Caliper Piston Bore
10. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent providing the diameter of the bore is not increased more than
0.0254 mm 0.001 inch..
11. If the bore does not clean up within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
Install a new piston if the old one is pitted or
scored.
NOTE: When using Caliper Honing Tool, Special Tool C-4095, or equivalent, coat the stones and
bore with brake fluid. After honing the bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff
non-metallic rotary brush.
NOTE: Use extreme care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing
the caliper with brake fluid; wipe dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean a second time.
CAUTION: When inspecting caliper piston, do not use anything but solvents to clean piston
surface. If surface of piston cannot be cleaned using only solvents, piston must be replaced.
12. Inspect caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace piston if there is
evidence of scratches, pitting or physical damage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4245
Assembly
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion and binding of piston.
1. Clamp caliper in a vise with protective caps installed on jaws of vise..
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
2. Dip new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install in the groove of the caliper bore. Seal should
be positioned at one area in groove and gently
worked around the groove, using only your fingers until properly seated. NEVER USE AN OLD
PISTON SEAL. Be sure that fingers are clean and seal is not twisted or rolled.
3. Coat new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside boot. 4. Position
dust boot over piston after coating with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force must be applied to the piston uniformly to avoid cocking and binding of the piston
in the bore of the caliper.
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
5. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 6.
Position dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4246
7. Using a hammer and Installer Piston Caliper Boot, Special Tool C-4689 and Handle, Special
Tool C-4171, or equivalent, drive boot into
counterbore of the caliper.
8. Install guide pin sleeves and bushings. Refer to Guide Pin Installation. 9. Install brake pads.
Refer to Disc Brake Pad Installation.
10. Before installing caliper assembly on vehicle, inspect brake rotor. If any conditions as described
in Checking Brake Rotor for Runout and
Thickness are present the rotor, must be replaced or refaced. If the rotor does not require any
servicing, install caliper assembly.
11. Install brake hose onto caliper using banjo bolt. Torque the brake hose to caliper assembly
banjo bolt to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs). New seal washers
MUST always be used when installing brake hose to caliper.
12. Bleed the brake system.
Removal
GENERAL INFORMATION
The double pin caliper uses a sealed for life bushing and sleeve assembly If required this assembly
can be serviced using the following procedure.
PROCEDURE
1. Remove caliper from brake rotor. Hang caliper assembly on a wire hook away from the brake
rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4247
Removing Inner Sleeve From Bushing
2. Push out and then pull the steel sleeve from the inside of the bushing using your fingers as
shown above.
Removing Bushing From Caliper
3. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the bushing. Then pull on the opposite side to remove
the bushing from the brake caliper housing.
Installation
PROCEDURE
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section of the bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4248
Installing Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper housing. Do not use a sharp object to perform this step
due to possible damage to the bushing.
Bushing Correctly Installed In Caliper
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. Flanges should be seated evenly
on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar, Silicone Dielectric Compound or an
equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4249
Fig 7 Installing Caliper Sleeves
5. Install guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until seal area of bushing is past seal groove in
sleeve. 6. Holding convoluted boot end of bushing with one hand, push steel sleeve bushing
through boot until one end of bushing is fully seated into seal
groove on one end of sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4250
Fig 8 Installed Caliper Bushing Sleeve
7. Holding sleeve in place, work other end of bushing over end of sleeve and into the seal grove on
sleeve. Be sure other end of bushing did not come
out of seal grove in sleeve.
8. When the sleeve is seated properly into the bushing, the sealed for life sleeve/bushing can be
held between your fingers and easily slid back and
forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4251
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Specification ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. DOT 3
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE J1703
NOTE: The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4255
Brake Fluid: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in
the brake system will result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4256
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION:
The hydraulic fluid used in automotive brake systems is hygroscopic. This means that the hydraulic
fluid tends to absorb moisture from the atmosphere over periods of time. As hydraulic brake fluid
absorbs moisture, it effects the function of the vehicles hydraulic brake system. For this reason, the
vehicle's hydraulic brake fluid should be drained and replaced using fresh clean hydraulic brake
fluid every two years. When replacing hydraulic brake fluid, use only Mopar brake fluid or an
equivalent from a sealed container. Brake fluid must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid. This
includes the master cylinder, proportioning valves, caliper seals, wheel cylinder seals, ABS
hydraulic control unit (HCU), and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4257
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
Master Cylinder Fluid Level
CAUTION:Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use
petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in the brake system will result.
Check master cylinder reservoir brake fluid level a minimum of twice a year. Master cylinder
reservoirs are marked with the words FULL AND MIN indicating proper range of the master
cylinder fluid level. If necessary, add specified brake fluid bringing level to the FULL mark on the
side of the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Switch <-->
[Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Switch <-->
[Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4261
Brake Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair
GENERAL INFORMATION
The master cylinder or brake fluid reservoir does not have to be removed from vehicle for
replacement of the brake fluid level sensor.
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
1. Remove wiring harness connector from brake fluid reservoir level sensor.
Brake Fluid Level Switch Retaining Tabs
2. Compress retaining tabs on end of brake fluid level switch.
Removing/Installing Fluid Reservoir Level Switch
3. While compressing retaining tabs, grasp opposite end of brake fluid level switch and pull it out of
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir. 4. Correctly align the replacement level switch with its
mounting hole in the brake fluid reservoir. Push switch into fluid reservoir until retaining tabs
are fully expanded on opposite side of fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Switch <-->
[Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4262
5. Install the wiring harness connector onto the brake fluid level switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Brake Hose/Line: Description and Operation
The purpose of the chassis brake tubes and flex hoses is to transfer the pressurized brake fluid
developed by the master cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. The chassis tubes are steel
with a corrosion resistant coating applied to the external surfaces and the flex hoses are made of
reinforced rubber. The rubber flex hoses allow for the movement of the vehicle's suspension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Hoses
Brake Hose/Line: Testing and Inspection Brake Hoses
Flexible rubber hose is used at both front and rear brakes. Inspection of brake hoses should be
performed whenever the brake system is serviced and every 7,500 miles or 12 months, whichever
comes first (every engine oil change). Inspect hydraulic brake hoses for severe surface cracking,
scuffing, worn spots or physical damage. If the fabric casing of the rubber hose becomes exposed
due to cracks or abrasions in the rubber hose cover, the hose should be replaced immediately.
Eventual deterioration of the hose can take place with possible burst failure. Faulty installation can
cause twisting, resulting in wheel, tire, or chassis interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Hoses > Page 4268
Brake Hose/Line: Testing and Inspection Brake Lines
The steel brake tubing should be inspected periodically for evidence of corrosion, physical damage
or contact with moving or hot components of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Line Replacement
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Brake Line Replacement
GENERAL INFORMATION
Always use Mopar replacement brake hose assemblies to ensure quality, correct length and
superior fatigue life. Care should be taken to make sure. that the tube and hose mating surfaces
are clean and free from nicks and burrs. Hose assemblies for each brake are unique and not
interchangeable.Use new copper seal washers on all connections using Banjo Bolts and tighten all
fittings to their specified torques.
PROCEDURE
The flexible front hydraulic brake hose should always be installed on the vehicle by first attaching
the Banjo connector to the caliper assembly. Then bolt the intermediate hose bracket to the strut
assembly allowing the bracket to position the hose to prevent twisting. Attach the hose to brake
tubing, before attaching to front frame rail. Then tighten all brake line fittings to specified torque. On
vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, install rear brake hoses first to wheel cylinders and rear
struts and then attach hose bracket to body. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, attach
brake hoses to calipers and struts first and then attach brake hose bracket to body. Following this
procedure will reduce potential for twisting brake during installation procedure. Only double wall
4.75 mm (3/16 in.) steel brake line tubing, with Al- Rich/ZN-AL alloy coating should be used for
replacement. Care must be taken when replacing brake tubing, to be sure the proper bending and
flaring tools and procedures are used to avoid kinking. Do not route the tubes against sharp edges,
moving components or into hot areas. All tubes should be properly attached with recommended
retaining clips.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Line Replacement > Page 4271
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Brake Tubing Repair/Tube Flaring
Tube End Properly Prepared For Flaring
Double Inverted Brake Tube Flare
NOTE: Place tube nut on tubing before flaring the tubing.
GENERAL INFORMATION
Only double wall 4.75 mm (3/16 in.) steel tubing with Al-rich/ZN-AL alloy coating and the correct
tube nuts are to be used for replacement of a hydraulic brake tube. Care should be taken when
repairing brake tubing, to be sure the proper bending and flaring tools and procedures are used, to
avoid kinking. Do not route the tubes against sharp edges, moving components or into hot areas.
All tubes should be properly attached with recommended retaining clips. Using Tubing Cutter,
Special Tool C-3478-A or equivalent, cut off damaged seat or tubing. Ream out any burrs or rough
edges showing on inside of tubing. This will make the ends of tubing square and ensure better
seating of flared end tubing.
DOUBLE INVERTED TUBING FLARES
To make a double inverted tubing flare. Open handles of Flaring Tool, Special Tool C-4047 or
equivalent. Then rotate jaws of tool until the mating jaws of tubing size are centered between
vertical posts on tool. Slowly close handles with tubing inserted in jaws but do not apply heavy
pressure to handle as this will lock tubing in place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Line Replacement > Page 4272
Place gauge (Form A) on edge over end of brake tubing. Push tubing through jaws until end of
tubing contacts the recessed notch in gauge matching the tubing size. Squeeze handles of flaring
tool and lock tubing in place. Place 3/16 inch plug of gauge (A) down in end of tubing. Swing
compression disc over gauge and center tapered flaring screw in recess of disc. Screw in until plug
gauge has seated on jaws of flaring tool. This action has started to invert the extended end of the
tubing. Remove gauge and continue to screw down until tool is firmly seated in tubing. Remove
tubing from flaring tool and inspect seat. Refer to tube routing diagrams for proper brake tube
routing and clip locations. Replace any damaged tube routing clips.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Line Replacement > Page 4273
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Brake Tubing/Hose Replacement
GENERAL INFORMATION
Always use Mopar replacement brake hose assemblies to ensure quality, correct length and
superior fatigue life. Care should be taken to make sure. that the tube and hose mating surfaces
are clean and free from nicks and burrs. Hose assemblies for each brake are unique and not
interchangeable.Use new copper seal washers on all connections using Banjo Bolts and tighten all
fittings to their specified torques.
PROCEDURE
The flexible front hydraulic brake hose should always be installed on the vehicle by first attaching
the Banjo connector to the caliper assembly. Then bolt the intermediate hose bracket to the strut
assembly allowing the bracket to position the hose to prevent twisting. Attach the hose to brake
tubing, before attaching to front frame rail. Then tighten all brake line fittings to specified torque. On
vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, install rear brake hoses first to wheel cylinders and rear
struts and then attach hose bracket to body. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, attach
brake hoses to calipers and struts first and then attach brake hose bracket to body. Following this
procedure will reduce potential for twisting brake during installation procedure. Only double wall
4.75 mm (3/16 in.) steel brake line tubing, with Al- Rich/ZN-AL alloy coating should be used for
replacement. Care must be taken when replacing brake tubing, to be sure the proper bending and
flaring tools and procedures are used to avoid kinking. Do not route the tubes against sharp edges,
moving components or into hot areas. All tubes should be properly attached with recommended
retaining clips.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4274
Cutting And Flaring Of Brake Fluid Tubing
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Proportioning Valve - Pressure Adapter Tool Revision
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Technical Service Bulletins Proportioning Valve - Pressure
Adapter Tool Revision
NUMBER: 05-03-00
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: April 14, 2000
SUBJECT: Proportioning Valve Brake Pressure Adapter Tool Revision
MODELS: 1995-1999 (PL) Neon
DISCUSSION:
Figure 1
Diagnosing and testing the brake proportioning valves following the procedure in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual calls for the use of the Brake Pressure Adapter Set 6805 and Brake Gauge
Set C-4007-A. Alternate adapters from prior tool shipments should now be used on the Neon in
place of the adapters provided in the Brake Pressure Adapter Set 6805. When the Neon Service
Manual calls for Adapter 6805-3, use Adapter 8187-2 (Figure 1) which was shipped with the 1998
Concorde/Intrepid special tools in kit 8180CC or stored on panel 78. When the Neon Service
Manual calls for Adapter 6805-4, use Adapter 6833-1 (Figure 1) which was shipped in the 1996
Minivan special tool kit and stored on panel 70. If you are unable to locate these adapters (6833-1 &
8187-2), they are available separately through Miller Special Tools (1-800-801-5420).
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > With Antilock Brakes
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Specifications With Antilock Brakes
Proportioning Valve .............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) Tube Nut ...........................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 17 Nm (145 in.
lbs.) Split Point .....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 400 psi Slope ........................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... 0.34 Inlet Pressure ....................................................................................................................
........................................................................................ 1000 psi Outlet Pressure ............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 550-650 psi
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > With Antilock Brakes > Page 4281
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Specifications Without Antilock Brakes
Brake Line Tube Nuts At The Proportioning Valve
.............................................................................................................................. 17 Nm (145 in.
lbs.) Split Point .....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 400 psi Slope:
Disc/Drum ............................................................................................................................................
................................................................. 0.43 Disc/Disc ....................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... 0.34
Inlet Pressure ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 1000 psi Outlet Pressure:
Disc/Drum ............................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 600-700 psi Disc/Disc ....................................................................
............................................................................................................................... 550-650 psi
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4282
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) has the
correct thread sizes for installation into the HCU and installation of the proportioning valve.
- Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into proportioning valve, has the correct thread
sizes for installation into the proportioning valve and installation of brake tube fitting into
proportioning valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4283
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Application and ID
Fig 35 Type 3 Proportioning Valve Identification
Fig 35 Type 3 Proportioning Valve Identification
SALES CODE, BRAKE SYSTEM TYPE AND IDENTIFICATION
BRA (14" Disc/Drum): Black Band BRB (14" Disc/Disc): Bar Code Label
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4284
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Description and Operation
Fig 35 Type 3 Proportioning Valve Identification
Master Cylinder For ABS Equipped Vehicles
Fig 4 Type 3 Master Cylinder. Less ABS
GENERAL INFORMATION
This vehicle uses screw-in proportioning valves at the Master Cylinder or Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) instead of the combination valve used in prior designs. With this new design, the chassis
brake tubes connect directly from the master cylinder or HCU to the brake flex hose. The non-ABS
master cylinders are a four outlet design with two screw-in proportioning valves attached directly to
the inboard side of the master cylinder housing. The ABS Master Cylinders are a two outlet design
with the screw-in proportioning valves attached directly to the HCU.
PURPOSE
Proportioning valves balance front to rear braking by controlling at a given ratio, the increase in
rear brake system hydraulic pressure above a preset level (split point). Under light pedal
application, the proportioning valve allows full hydraulic pressure to be applied to the rear brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4285
IDENTIFICATION
There are two proportioning valve assemblies used in each vehicle. Due to differences in thread
sizes, each proportioning valve has a different part number. During any service procedures identify
valve assemblies by supplier part number and or the color identification band.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Testing and Inspection Proportioning Valve Testing
With Antilock Brakes
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
Proportioning Valve Installation For Pressure Testing
Pressure Gauges Installed On Pressure Test Fittings At Hydraulic Control Unit
PROCEDURE
1. Road test vehicle to verify premature rear wheel Antilock Brake System (ABS) cycling, to
determine which proportioning valve needs to be tested. 2. Remove hydraulic brake tube from one
of the proportioning valves. 3. Then remove proportioning valve from that outlet port of the
Hydraulic Control Unit HCU.
CAUTION: Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into the HCU, has the correct thread
sizes for installation into the HCU and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing > Page 4288
installation of the proportioning valve.
4. Install Pressure Test Fitting, Special Tool 6805-1 or 6805-2, or equivalents into the outlet port of
the HCU. 5. Install proportioning valve into pressure test fitting installed in the HCU outlet port.
CAUTION: Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into proportioning valve, has the correct
thread sizes for installation into the proportioning valve and installation of brake tube fitting into
proportioning valve.
6. Install Pressure Test Fitting, Special Tool 6805-3 or 6805-4, or equivalents into the outlet of the
proportioning valve. 7. Connect brake tube onto pressure test fitting installed in proportioning valve.
8. Install a Pressure Gauge, Special Tool C-4007-A, or equivalent into each pressure test fitting.
Bleed air out of hose from pressure test fitting to
pressure gauge, at pressure gauge to remove all trapped air.
9. With the aid of a helper, apply pressure to the brake pedal until reading on proportioning valve
inlet gauge, is at the pressure shown on the
following chart. Then check the pressure reading on the proportioning valve outlet gauge. If
proportioning valve outlet pressure does not agree with value shown on the following chart, when
inlet pressure shown on chart is obtained, replace the proportioning valve. If proportioning valve is
within pressure specifications do not replace proportioning valve.
10. Install proportioning valve in HCU and hand tighten until proportioning is fully installed and
0-ring seal is seated into HCU. Then torque
proportioning valve to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
11. Install brake tube on proportioning valve. Torque tube nut to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.). 12. Bleed the
affected brake line. See Bleeding Brake System in the Service Adjustments section of the manual
for proper bleeding procedure. 13. Repeat steps 2 through 12 for the second proportioning valve.
14. Check rear wheel brake shoe linings for contamination or for replacement brake shoes not
meeting OEM brake lining material specifications.
These conditions can also be a possible cause for a premature rear wheel skid.
Without Antilock Brakes
Non ABS Proportioning Valve Location
Proportioning Valve Installation For Pressure Testing
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing > Page 4289
Pressure Gauges Installed On Pressure Test Fittings
TESTING
1. After road testing vehicle to determine which rear wheel exhibits premature rear wheel skid, to
determine which proportioning valve needs to be
tested.
2. Remove hydraulic brake line from proportioning valve controlling the rear wheel of the vehicle
which has premature wheel skid. 3. Then remove the proportioning valve from the rear brake line.
CAUTION: Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into proportioning valve, has the correct
thread sizes for installation into the
proportioning valve and installation of brake tube fitting.
4. Install Pressure Test Fitting, Special Tool 6805-1 or 6805-2, or equivalents on rear brake tube
which the proportioning valve was removed from. 5. Install proportioning valve into pressure test
fitting installed on rear brake tube.
CAUTION: Be sure the pressure test fitting being installed into proportioning valve, has the correct
thread sizes for installation into the
proportioning valve and installation of brake tube fitting.
6. Install Pressure Test Fitting, Special Tool 6805-3 or 6805-4, or equivalents into outlet of the
proportioning valve. 7. Connect brake hydraulic line onto pressure test fitting installed in
proportioning valve 8. Install a Pressure Gauge, Special Tool C-400 7-A, or equivalent into each
pressure test fitting. Bleed air out of hose from pressure test fitting to
pressure gauge, at pressure gauge to remove all trapped air. hose.
9. With the aid of a helper, apply pressure to the brake pedal until reading on proportioning valve
inlet gauge, is at the pressure shown on the
following chart. Then check the pressure reading on the proportioning valve outlet gauge. If
proportioning valve outlet pressure does not agree with value shown on the following chart, when
inlet pressure shown on chart is obtained, replace the proportioning valve. If proportioning valve is
within pressure specifications do not replace proportioning valve.
10. Check rear wheel brake shoe linings for contamination or for replacement brake shoes not
meeting OEM brake lining material specifications.
These conditions can also be a possible cause for a premature rear wheel skid.
11. Install proportioning valve in rear brake line and hand tighten both tube nuts until they are fully
seated in proportioning valve. 12. Tighten both brake line tube nuts at the proportioning valve to a
torque of 17 Nm (145 in-lbs.). 13. Bleed the affected brake line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing > Page 4290
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Testing and Inspection With ABS
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
TESTING
If premature rear wheel ABS cycling occurs on a hard brake application, it could be an indication
that a malfunction has occurred with one of the proportioning valves. One proportioning valve
controls the right rear brake, and the other proportioning valve controls the left rear brake. Since
ABS cycles both rear brakes together, both valves must be tested to isolate the suspect
proportioning valve. The test procedure is the same for both rear wheel proportioning valves. The
pressure test fittings used for each proportioning valve though are different due to proportioning
valve and brake tube nut thread sizes being unique for each rear wheel. Refer to procedures for
testing the required proportioning valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing > Page 4291
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Testing and Inspection Without ABS
Non ABS Proportioning Valve Location
Proportioning Valve Installation For Pressure Testing
Pressure Gauges Installed On Pressure Test Fittings
CAUSES
If premature rear wheel skid occurs on a hard brake application, it could be an indication that a
malfunction has occurred with one of the rear brake proportioning valves.
TESTING
One proportioning valve controls the right rear brake, and the other proportioning valve controls the
left rear brake. Therefore, a road test to determine which rear brake slides first is essential. Once
the wheel which slides first is determined, refer to procedures to diagnose the proportioning valve.
The test procedure for a premature rear wheel skid is the same for both rear wheel proportioning
valves. The pressure test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Proportioning Valve Testing > Page 4292
fittings used for each proportioning valve though are different due to proportioning valve and brake
tube nut thread sizes being unique for each rear wheel. After road testing vehicle to determine
which wheel skids first, the proper test fittings required will have to be determined. Then refer to
procedures for testing the required proportioning valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > With Antilock Brakes
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair With Antilock Brakes
Rear Wheel Proportioning Valve Location On HCU
GENERAL INFORMATION
The HCU does not require removal from the vehicle for the replacement of the proportioning
valves. Use the proportioning valve test procedure under Testing and Inspection to determine
which proportioning valve requires replacement, then replace it using procedure below.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect the brake tube fitting from the proportioning valve requiring removal from the HCU. 2.
Remove proportioning valve requiring replacement, from the HCU.
INSTALL
1. Wet O-ring seal on new proportioning valve using clean fresh brake fluid. 2. Install proportioning
valve in HCU and hand tighten until proportioning is fully installed and 0-ring seal is seated into
HCU. Then torque
proportioning valve to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
3. Install brake tube on proportioning valve. Tighten tube nut to 17 Nm (145 inch lbs.) torque. 4.
Bleed the base brakes hydraulic system. Refer to Brakes Service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > With Antilock Brakes > Page 4295
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair Without Antilock Brakes
Fig 35 Type 3 Proportioning Valve Identification
Non-ABS Proportioning Valve Locations On Master Cylinder
CAUTION: Proportioning valves should never be disassembled.
GENERAL INFORMATION
There are two proportioning valve assemblies used in each vehicle. Due to different thread sizes,
each proportioning valve has a different part number. During any service procedures identify the
proportioning valve assemblies by supplier part number and or the color identification band. If
premature rear wheel skid occurs on hard brake application, it could be an indication that a
malfunction has occurred with one of the proportioning valves. One proportioning valve controls the
right rear brake, and the other proportioning valve controls the left rear brake. Therefore, a road
test to determine which rear brake slides first is essential. If a malfunctioning proportioning valve is
suspected on a vehicle. Refer to Testing and Inspection.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect brake tube from proportioning valve requiring removal from the master cylinder. 2.
Remove proportioning valve from the master cylinder requiring replacement.
INSTALL
1. Wet 0-ring seal on new proportioning valve using clean fresh brake fluid. 2. Install proportioning
valve in master cylinder and hand tighten until proportioning valve and 0-ring seal is fully seated in
master cylinder. Torque
proportioning valve to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
3. Install brake tube on proportioning valve. tighten tube nut to 17 Nm (145 in lbs.) torque. 4. Bleed
the affected brake line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4296
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Tools and Equipment
Proportioning Valve Pressure Test Fitting
Proportioning Valve Pressure Test Gauge Set
GENERAL INFORMATION
The new in-line proportioning valves used on this vehicle, require new pressure fittings to test for
proper proportioning valve function. The pressure fittings are installed before and after the
proportioning valve being tested to verify proportioning valve is maintaining the required hydraulic
pressure to the rear wheel brake which it controls.
CONDITION
If a condition of premature rear wheel skid occurs on a vehicle the proportioning valve should
always be tested prior to it being replaced. This is due to the fact that there are conditions other
then a faulty proportioning valve which can cause a premature rear wheel skid.
TOOLS
Testing proportioning valve pressures on a vehicle with or without ABS requires using the same
special tools. There are 4 new Pressure Fittings, Special Tool 6805 or equivalent which are to be
used for testing the proportioning valves. These same pressure fittings are used if the proportioning
valves are either mounted in the HCU, on an antilock equipped vehicle, or in-line on the brake tube
on non-antilock equipped vehicles. The pressure gauges used with the pressure test fittings for
testing the in-line proportioning valves on both non-ABS and ABS brakes, is the Pressure Gauge
Set, Special Tool C-4007-A, or equivalent currently used for testing the combination valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications
Hydraulic Control Unit: Specifications
To Mounting Bracket Bolts ..................................................................................................................
............................................... 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) Bracket To Frame Rail Mounting Bolt (Top)
...................................................................................................................................... 18 Nm (160
inch lbs.) Bracket To Frame Rail Mounting Bolts (Side)
................................................................................................................................... 22 Nm (200
inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4300
Hydraulic Control Unit
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4301
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE ONLY PARTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU) THAT ARE
SERVICEABLE ARE THE RELAY BOX, THE PROPORTIONING VALVES, AND THE HCU
MOUNTING BRACKET. THE REMAINING COMPONENTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL
UNIT HCU ARE NOT SERVICEABLE ITEMS. NO ATTEMPT SHOULD EVER BE MADE TO
REMOVE OR SERVICE ANY OTHER PARTS OF THE HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation General Information
Hydraulic Control Unit
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is located under the master cylinder and power brake booster
and is mounted to the left frame rail. The HCU contains the following components for controlling the
vehicle's braking system during Antilock Brake System (ABS) braking: 4 Decay Valves, 4 Shuttle
Valves, 2 Fluid Sumps, a Pump/Motor and a relay box. Also attached to the HCU are the rear
brake Proportioning Valves and the vehicles 6 hydraulic brake tubes.
Decay Solenoids There are 4 decay solenoids, one for each wheel. In the released position they
provide a fluid path from the master cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. In the actuated
(decay) position, they provide a fluid path from wheel brakes of the vehicle to the sumps. The
Decay solenoids are spring loaded in the released (build) position during normal braking.
Shuttle Valves There are 4 Shuttle Valves, one for each wheel. The Shuttle Valve is a hydraulically
actuated valve which shuttles when the decay solenoid and pump are energized. This places an
orifice (restriction) in the line between the pump and the decay solenoid. This restriction provides a
controlled build rate to each wheel brake during an ABS stop. The Shuttle Valve will remain in the
orificed position until the ABS cycle is complete. When the ABS cycle has been completed the
decay solenoids will return to their released position which will equalize the pressure across the
Shuttle Valves. When the pressure equalizes, the spring loaded Shuttle Orifice valves will return to
the unrestricted position.
Fluid Sumps There are two fluid sumps in the HCU, one each for the primary and secondary
hydraulic circuits. The fluid sumps temporarily store brake fluid that is decayed from the wheel
brakes during an ABS cycle. This fluid is then delivered to the pump to provide build pressure. The
typical pressure in the sumps is 50 psi, during ABS operation only.
Pump Motor Assembly The HCU contains 2 Pump Assemblies, one each for the primary and
secondary hydraulic circuits. Both pumps are driven by a common electric motor which is part of
the HCU. The pumps pick up fluid from the sumps to supply build pressure to the brakes during an
ABS stop. The motor only runs during an ABS stop and is controlled by the Controller Antilock
Brake (CAB) via the Pump/Motor Relay. The Pump/Motor Assembly is not a serviceable item. If it
requires service the HCU must be replaced.
Relay Box ABX-4 utilizes two relays contained in a relay box mounted to the HCU. The relay box
contains a System Relay and a Pump/Motor Relay. A single 10-way connector provides the
electrical interface. The relay box is serviceable as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
> Page 4304
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control Unit Decay Solenoids
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT DECAY SOLENOIDS
There are 4 decay solenoids, one for each wheel. In the released position they provide a fluid path
from the Master Cylinder to the wheel brakes of the vehicle. In the actuated (decay) position, they
provide a fluid path from wheel brakes of the vehicle to the sumps. The Decay Solenoids are spring
loaded in the released (build) position during normal braking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
> Page 4305
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Control Unit Shuttle Valves
HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT SHUTTLE VALVES
There are 4 Shuttle Valves, one for each wheel. The Shuttle Valve is a hydraulically actuated valve
which shuttles when the decay solenoid and pump are energized. This places an orifice (restriction)
in the line between the pump and the decay solenoid. This restriction provides a controlled build
rate to each wheel brake during an ABS stop. The Shuttle Valve will remain in the orificed position
until the ABS cycle is complete. When the ABS cycle has been completed the decay solenoids will
return to their released position which will equalize the pressure across the Shuttle Valves. When
the pressure equalizes, the spring loaded Shuttle Orifice valves will return to the unrestricted
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
> Page 4306
Hydraulic Control Unit: Description and Operation Hydraulic Modulator Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The hydraulic modulator is used for the controlling of the brake system pressure to the wheels. The
modulator is made up of four solenoids.
Circuits involved are, B142 for the left front wheel, B143 for the right front wheel, B146 for the left
rear wheel, and B148 for the right rear wheel.
The solenoids use a common ground on the Z1 circuit. There are two Z1 circuits from the
modulator. Both of these grounds terminate at the left headlamp ground, and are spliced in with the
Anti Lock Brake System (ABS) pump motor and the ABS system relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service and Repair Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) Replacement
Removal
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate cable.
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
2. Disconnect vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level sensor at base of master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
3. Disconnect primary and secondary brake tubes from master cylinder housing. Install plugs at
brake tube outlets of master cylinder assembly. 4. Clean area where master cylinder attaches to
booster using a suitable brake cleaner.
CAUTION: On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before
removing master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be
done simply by pumping the brake pedal, with the engine not running, until a firm brake pedal is
achieved.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4309
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
5. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder to power brake booster unit. 6. Slide master
cylinder assembly straight out, and away from power brake booster unit.
Electrical Connections To HCU And Relay Box
7. Disconnect the 6 way connector from the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) wiring harness and 10
way connector from the relay box located on the
HCU.
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes From Master Cylinder To HCU
8. Remove the primary and secondary master cylinder brake tubes from the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4310
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
9. Remove the chassis brake tubes from the proportioning valves and outlet ports of the (HCU).
10. Raise vehicle.
Hydraulic Control Unit Mounting Bracket
11. Loosen and remove the 2 bolts attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the side of the front
frame rail. 12. Lower vehicle. 13. Loosen and remove the bolts attaching the HCU mounting
bracket to the top of the frame rail. 14. Remove HCU and its mounting bracket as an assembly
from the vehicle.
Installation
PROCEDURE
Hydraulic Control Unit Mounting Bracket
1. Install the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) and mounting bracket as an assembly, on left front
frame rail of the vehicle, aligning tabs on mounting
bracket with holes in frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4311
2. Install and loosely tighten the bolt attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the top of the frame
rail. 3. Raise vehicle. 4. Install the 2 bolts attaching the HCU mounting bracket to the side of the
front frame rail. Then torque both mounting bolts to 28 Nm (200 inch
lbs.).
5. Lower vehicle. 6. Torque bolt attaching HCU mounting bracket to top of frame rail to 20 Nm (180
inch lbs.).
Proportioning Valve Location On Hydraulic Control Unit
7. Install the 4 chassis brake tubes onto the proportioning valves and outlet ports of the HCU.
Torque the 4 chassis brake tube nuts to 17 Nm (145
inch lbs.).
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes From Master Cylinder To HCU
8. Install primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder onto the HCU, with tube nuts
only hand tightened.
Electrical Connections To HCU And Relay Box
9. Install vehicle wiring harness connectors onto the 10 way, and 6 way connectors, located on the
relay box of the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4312
Removing Seal From Vacuum Booster
10. Remove vacuum seal located in the front of the power brake vacuum booster. Vacuum seal is
removed by carefully inserting a small screw driver
between the push rod of the power brake vacuum booster and vacuum seal and pry seal out of
power brake vacuum booster. Do not attempt to pry seal out of master cylinder by inserting a tool
between seal and power brake vacuum booster.
11. Remove old vacuum seal from master cylinder, if the vacuum seal came out of power brake
vacuum booster when master cylinder was removed
this step is not necessary.
CAUTION: When replacing the master cylinder on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a NEW vacuum
seal MUST be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure detailed below
for installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. Be sure old vacuum seal is removed
from power brake vacuum booster before attempting to install new seal.
CAUTION: When lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric
Compound. Using any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate
long term lubrication of the push rod.
Lubricating Master Cylinder Push Rod
12. Lubricate master cylinder push rod as indicated only using Mopar Dielectric Grease-And No
Substitutes.
Fig 19 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Installation. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4313
Fig 20 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Seating. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
13. Install vacuum seal on master cylinder push rod as shown with notches on vacuum seal
pointing toward master cylinder housing. Then slide
vacuum seal onto master push rod until seal is seated against master cylinder housing before
installing master cylinder on power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure old vacuum seal is removed from power brake
vacuum booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If vacuum seal
is not removed, refer to Brakes, Master Cylinder Service and Repair for required vacuum seal
removal procedure.
14. Position master cylinder on studs of power brake unit, aligning push rod on power brake
vacuum booster with master cylinder push rod.
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
15. Install the 2 master cylinder to power brake unit mounting nuts and torque to 28 Nm (250 inch
lbs.).
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
16. Connect brake tubes to master cylinder primary and secondary ports. Torque all tube nuts to 17
Nm (145 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4314
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
17. Install the wiring harness connector on the master cylinder reservoir brake fluid level switch. 18.
Bleed the base brakes and the ABS brakes hydraulic systems. Refer to Brakes Service and Repair
and Antilock Brake System Service and Repair
for the required procedures.
19. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS brake systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4315
Hydraulic Control Unit: Service and Repair Relay Box Replacement
GENERAL INFORMATION
The System Relay and Pump/Motor Relay are both serviced together as an assembly with the
relay box. The relay box is mounted directly to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). To remove the
relay box from the HCU, the HCU requires removal from the vehicle. This is to allow visual access
of the relay box to HCU electrical connection. Visual access to this connection is necessary to be
sure connection is correctly made when installing relay box on the HCU.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable.
2. Remove the HCU from the vehicle. Refer to Hydraulic Control Unit Removal, for the required
HCU removal procedure.
Relay Box To HCU Mounting Screws
3. Unclip the 6 way wiring harness connector from the relay box.
4. Remove the 2 screws attaching the relay box assembly to the HCU. Remove only the 2 screws
mounting the relay box to the HCU. Do not remove the pump motor mounting screws.
Relay Box To HCU Electrical Connection
5. Grasp relay box. Without twisting or rocking, pull relay box away from pump motor housing until
connector on relay box unplugs from the pump motor terminal. This is a tight connection, relay box
will require a good amount of force to unplug from pump motor.
6. Remove relay box from HCU.
INSTALL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) Replacement > Page 4316
Pump Motor To Relay Box Electrical Seal
1. Be sure electrical connector seal is installed in pump motor housing before installing relay box. If
electrical connector seal is cracked, brittle or in any way damaged it must be replaced before
installing relay box.
2. Position relay box on HCU and carefully align the terminals on the relay box with the terminals
on the pump motor.
3. Grasp relay box with both hands. Then without twisting or rocking, push relay box onto the pump
motor electrical connector as far as possible by hand.
4. Install and securely tighten the 2 screws attaching the relay box assembly to the HCU.
5. Reconnect the 6 way connector onto the relay box.
6. Install the HCU back in the vehicle. Refer to Hydraulic Control Unit Installation, for the required
HCU installation procedure.
7. Connect the negative (-) ground cable back on the negative post of the battery.
8. Bleed the base brakes and the ABS brakes hydraulic systems. Refer to Brakes Service and
Repair and Antilock Brake System Service and Repair for the required procedures.
9. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder: Mechanical Specifications
With Antilock Brakes
To Vacuum Booster Mounting Nut
..................................................................................................................................................... 28
Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Without Antilock Brakes
Master Cylinder To Booster Mounting Nuts
.......................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm (250
in. lbs.) Brake Tubes To Master Cylinder Ports
.................................................................................................................................................. 17 Nm
(145 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 4321
Brake Master Cylinder: Fluid Type Specifications
Fill brake fluid reservoir with brake fluid conforming to DOT 3 specifications such as Mopar or an
equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4322
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4323
Brake Master Cylinder: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before removing
master cylinder to prevent booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done simply by
pumping the brake pedal until a firm pedal is achieved, with the ignition off.
- On vehicles equipped with ABS, the master cylinder is used to create the seal for holding vacuum
in the power brake vacuum booster. The vacuum seal in the front of the power brake vacuum
booster MUST be replaced whenever the master cylinder is removed from the power brake
vacuum booster.
- When replacing the master cylinder on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a NEW vacuum seal MUST
be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure detailed below for
installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. Be sure old vacuum seal is removed from
power brake vacuum booster before attempting to install new seal.
- Then lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric Compound. Using
any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate long term
lubrication of the push rod.
- If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure old vacuum seal is removed from power brake vacuum
booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If vacuum seal is not
removed, refer to Removal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation > With Antilock Brakes
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation With Antilock Brakes
Master Cylinder Assembly
GENERAL INFORMATION
The Bendix ABX-4 Brake System uses a modified Master Cylinder and Power Brake Vacuum
Booster assembly. The Master Cylinder primary and secondary outputs go directly to the Hydraulic
Control Unit (HCU). The vehicle uses screw-in proportioning valves at the Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU) instead of the combination valve used in prior designs. With this new design, the chassis
brake tubes connect directly from the HCU to the brake flex hose. This vehicle uses a center valve
design master cylinder and has a two outlet design with the screw-in proportioning valves attached
directly to the HCU. Vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes use a master cylinder with a 21 mm
bore diameter, while vehicles equipped with rear disc brake use a 7/8" bore master cylinder.
DESIGN
The brake system master cylinder assembly consists of the following components. The body of the
master cylinder is an anodized aluminum casting. It has a machined bore to accept the master
cylinder piston and threaded ports with seats for hydraulic brake line connections. The brake fluid
reservoir of the master cylinder assembly is made of a see through polypropylene type plastic. The
primary outlet port supplies hydraulic pressure to the right front and left rear brakes. The secondary
outlet port supplies hydraulic pressure to the left front and right rear brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation > With Antilock Brakes > Page 4326
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation Without Antilock Brakes
Fig 4 Type 3 Master Cylinder. Less ABS
Non ABS Master Cylinder Primary And Secondary Ports
GENERAL INFORMATION
This vehicle is available with three different master cylinders. The vehicle uses screw-in
proportioning valves at the master cylinder instead of the combination valve used in prior designs.
With this new design, the chassis brake tubes connect directly from the master cylinder to the
brake flex hose. A standard compensating port designis used. The master cylinder has a four outlet
design with two screw-in proportioning valves attached directly to the inboard side of the master
cylinder housing. The ABS master cylinders are a two outlet design with the screw-in proportioning
valves attached directly to the HCU. Vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes use a master
cylinder with a 21 mm bore diameter, while vehicles equipped with rear disc brake use a 7/8" bore
master cylinder.
DESIGN
The brake system master cylinder assembly consists of the following components. The body of the
master cylinder is an anodized aluminum casting. It has a machined bore to accept the master
cylinder piston and threaded ports with seats for hydraulic brake line connections. The brake fluid
reservoir of the master cylinder assembly is made of a see through polypropylene type plastic. The
primary outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the left front and right rear brakes. The secondary
outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the right front and left rear brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bleeding
Bench Bleeding
Bleeding Tubes Attached To ABS Master Cylinder
Bleeding Tubes Attached To Non-ABS Master Cylinder
Bleeding Master Cylinder
PROCEDURE
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise. Attach Bleeding Tubes, Special Tool 6802, or equivalent to
the master cylinder outlet ports. Position bleeding
tubes so the outlets of the bleeding tubes will be below the surface of the brake fluid when reservoir
is filled to proper level.
2. Fill brake fluid reservoir with brake fluid conforming to DOT 3 specifications such as Mopar or an
equivalent. 3. Using a wooden dowel. Depress push rod slowly, and then allow pistons to return to
the released position. Continue to repeat this step several
times after no more air bubbles are expelled from bleed tubes to ensure all air is bled from the
master cylinder.
4. Remove bleeding tubes from master cylinder outlet ports, plug outlet ports and install fill cap on
reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4329
5. Remove master cylinder from vise.
NOTE: It is not necessary to bleed the brakes entire hydraulic system after replacing the master
cylinder. However, the master cylinder must have been thoroughly bled and filled to the proper
level upon installation on the power brake vacuum booster.
Manual Bleeding
Air Trapped In Brake System
Method For Purging Air From Brake System
Bleeder Screw
CAUTION:
- Before removing the Master Cylinder cover, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter
from dropping into the master cylinder.
NOTE:
- For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Hydraulic Control Unit.
- Correct bleeding of the brakes hydraulic system without the use of pressure bleeding equipment
will require the aid of a helper.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4330
BLEEDING BRAKES WITHOUT A PRESSURE BLEEDER
The following wheel sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to ensure
adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
^ Left rear wheel
^ Right front wheel
^ Right rear wheel
^ Left front wheel
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw starting at the right rear wheel and feed the hose
into a clear jar containing enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the hose.
2. Pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it down before the bleeder screw is opened.
3. Open the bleeder screw at least 1 full turn. When the bleeder screw opens the brake pedal will
drop.
4. Close the bleeder screw. Release the brake pedal only after the bleeder screw is closed.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3, four or five times at each bleeder screw. Then check the pedal for
travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, enough fluid has not passed through
the system to expel all the trapped air. Be sure to monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir. It must stay at the proper level so air will not be allowed to re-enter the brake system.
6. Test drive vehicle to be sure brakes are operating correctly and that pedal is solid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4331
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Replacement
Removal
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before
removing master cylinder to prevent booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done
simply by pumping the brake pedal until a firm pedal is achieved, with the ignition off.
1. On ABS equipped vehicles, be sure engine is not running, and pump the brake pedal until a firm
pedal is achieved (4-5 strokes).
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
2. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from brake fluid level sensor, in master cylinder brake
fluid reservoir.
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes Without ABS Brakes
3. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder. Install plugs at all
open brake tube outlets on master cylinder
assembly.
4. On vehicles equipped with ABS, clean area where master cylinder attaches to booster using a
suitable brake cleaner product such as Mopar Brake
Parts Cleaner or an equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4332
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
5. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder housing to power brake vacuum booster. 6. Slide
master cylinder assembly straight out of the power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: On vehicles equipped with ABS, the master cylinder is used to create the seal for
holding vacuum in the power brake vacuum booster. The vacuum seal in the front of the power
brake vacuum booster MUST be replaced whenever the master cylinder is removed from the
power brake vacuum booster.
Removing Seal From Vacuum Booster
7. If vehicle is equipped with ABS, remove vacuum seal located in the front of the power brake
vacuum booster. Vacuum seal is removed by
carefully inserting a small screw driver between the push rod of the power brake vacuum booster
and vacuum seal and pry seal out of power brake vacuum booster. Do not attempt to pry seal out
of master cylinder by inserting a tool between seal and power brake vacuum booster.
Installation
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: When replacing the master cylinder on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a NEW vacuum
seal MUST be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure detailed below
for installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. Be sure old vacuum seal is removed
from power brake vacuum booster before attempting to install new seal.
CAUTION: Then lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric
Compound. Using any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate
long term lubrication of the push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4333
Lubricating Master Cylinder Push Rod
1. Lubricate master cylinder push rod as indicated in only using Mopar Dielectric Grease-And No
Substitutes. Refer to the Mopar Chemicals Catalog
to obtain the required lubricant.
Fig 19 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Installation. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
Fig 20 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Seating. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
2. Install vacuum seal on master cylinder push rod as shown with notches on vacuum seal pointing
toward master cylinder housing. Then slide
vacuum seal onto master push rod until seal is seated against master cylinder housing before
installing master cylinder on power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure old vacuum seal is removed from power brake
vacuum booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If vacuum seal
is not removed, refer to Removal.
3. Position master cylinder on studs of power brake unit, aligning push rod on power brake vacuum
booster with master cylinder push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4334
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
4. Install the 2 master cylinder to power brake unit mounting nuts and torque to 28 Nm (250 in.
lbs.).
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes Without ABS Brakes
5. Connect brake tubes to master cylinder primary and secondary ports. Torque all tube nuts to 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.).
Removal
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before
removing master cylinder to prevent booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done
simply by pumping the brake pedal until a firm pedal is achieved, with the ignition off.
1. On ABS equipped vehicles, be sure engine is not running, and pump the brake pedal until a firm
pedal is achieved (4-5 strokes).
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
2. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from brake fluid level sensor, in master cylinder brake
fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4335
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
3. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder. Install plugs at all
open brake tube outlets on master cylinder
assembly.
4. On vehicles equipped with ABS, clean area where master cylinder attaches to booster using a
suitable brake cleaner product such as Mopar Brake
Parts Cleaner or an equivalent.
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
5. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder housing to power brake vacuum booster. 6. Slide
master cylinder assembly straight out of the power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: On vehicles equipped with ABS, the master cylinder is used to create the seal for
holding vacuum in the power brake vacuum booster. The vacuum seal in the front of the power
brake vacuum booster MUST be replaced whenever the master cylinder is removed from the
power brake vacuum booster.
Removing Seal From Vacuum Booster
7. If vehicle is equipped with ABS, remove vacuum seal located in the front of the power brake
vacuum booster. Vacuum seal is removed by
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4336
carefully inserting a small screw driver between the push rod of the power brake vacuum booster
and vacuum seal and pry seal out of power brake vacuum booster. Do not attempt to pry seal out
of master cylinder by inserting a tool between seal and power brake vacuum booster.
Installation
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: When replacing the master cylinder on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a NEW vacuum
seal MUST be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure detailed below
for installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. Be sure old vacuum seal is removed
from power brake vacuum booster before attempting to install new seal.
CAUTION: Then lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric
Compound. Using any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate
long term lubrication of the push rod.
Lubricating Master Cylinder Push Rod
1. Lubricate master cylinder push rod as indicated in only using Mopar Dielectric Grease-And No
Substitutes. Refer to the Mopar Chemicals Catalog
to obtain the required lubricant.
Fig 19 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Installation. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
Fig 20 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Seating. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
2. Install vacuum seal on master cylinder push rod as shown with notches on vacuum seal pointing
toward master cylinder housing. Then slide
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4337
vacuum seal onto master push rod until seal is seated against master cylinder housing before
installing master cylinder on power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure old vacuum seal is removed from power brake
vacuum booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If vacuum seal
is not removed, refer to Master Cylinder Removal in this section of the service manual for required
vacuum seal removal procedure.
3. Position master cylinder on studs of power brake unit, aligning push rod on power brake vacuum
booster with master cylinder push rod.
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
4. Install the 2 master cylinder to power brake unit mounting nuts and torque to 28 Nm (250 in.
lbs.).
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
5. Connect brake tubes to master cylinder primary and secondary ports. Torque all tube nuts to 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4338
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Reservoir Replacement
Removing Fluid Reservoir from Master Cylinder
NOTE: To replace the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir on this vehicle, it is not necessary to
remove the master cylinder from the power brake vacuum booster.
1. Using Mopar, Brake Parts Cleaner or an equivalent, thoroughly clean the master cylinder and
brake fluid reservoir. 2. Remove the brake fluid reservoir filler cap. 3. Using a syringe or equivalent
type tool, empty as much brake fluid as possible from the reservoir.
CAUTION: Do not pry fluid reservoir off master cylinder using a tool, damage to the reservoir or
master cylinder can result.
4. Remove brake fluid reservoir from master cylinder by rocking the reservoir from side to side
while pulling upward on the fluid reservoir. 5. Remove master cylinder housing to brake fluid
reservoir sealing grommets.
CAUTION: To ensure a leak proof seal when installing a fluid reservoir, never reuse the original
fluid reservoir to master cylinder sealing grommets.
6. Install new master cylinder housing to brake fluid reservoir sealing grommets in master cylinder
housing. 7. Lubricate reservoir mounting area with fresh clean brake fluid. Place reservoir in
position over grommets. Seat reservoir into grommets using a
rocking motion while firmly pressing down on fluid reservoir.
8. Be sure reservoir is positioned properly. 9. Make sure bottom of fluid reservoir touches top of
both sealing grommets.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4339
Brake Master Cylinder: Tools and Equipment
Handle C-4171
Special Tools C-4689
Special Tools 6802
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder 115 in.lb
Tube Nut 145 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4343
Rear Wheel Cylinder (Exploded View)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4344
Wheel Cylinder: Service Precautions
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake shoe assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Remove rear brake drum. 4. Remove rear brake shoe
assemblies from the brake support plate. Refer to Brake Shoe Service and Repair Removal. 5. If
brake shoes are wet with grease or brake fluid, remove and replace. 6. Disconnect the rear brake
flex hose from the wheel cylinder. 7. Remove rear wheel cylinder attaching bolts. 8. Remove rear
wheel cylinder assembly from brake support plate.
INSTALL
1. Apply a small bead of silicone sealer around the mating surface of the wheel cylinder to brake
support plate.
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake shoe assemblies.
2. Install wheel cylinder onto brake support plate. Tighten the attaching bolts to 13 Nm (115 in.
lbs.). 3. Hand start hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to 17 Nm
(145 in. lbs.). 4. Install rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate. Refer to Brake Shoe
Service and Repair Installation. 5. Install rear brake drum onto rear hub. 6. Install the wheel and tire
assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to
half specification. Then
repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4347
7. Adjust the rear brakes. 8. Bleed the entire brake system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4348
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
With brake drums removed, inspect the wheel cylinder boots for evidence of a brake fluid leak.
Visually check the boots for cuts, tears, or heat cracks. If any of these conditions exist, the wheel
cylinders should be completely cleaned, inspected and new parts installed.
If a wheel cylinder is leaking and the brake lining material is saturated with brake fluid, the brake
shoes must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4349
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair Wheel Cylinder Overhaul
Fig 3 Wheel Cylinder
DISASSEMBLE
To disassemble the wheel cylinders, proceed as follows: 1.
Pry boots away from cylinders and remove.
2. Press IN on one piston to force out opposite piston, cup and spring. Then using a soft tool such
as a dowel rod, press out the cup and piston that remain in the wheel cylinder.
3. Wash wheel cylinder, pistons, and spring in clean brake fluid or alcohol; DO NOT USE ANY
PETROLEUM BASE SOLVENTS. clean thoroughly and blow dry with compressed air. Inspect
cylinder bore and piston for scoring and pitting. Do not use a rag as lint from the rag will stick to
bore surfaces..
4. Wheel cylinder bores and pistons that are badly scored or pitted should be replaced. Cylinder
walls that have light scratches, or show signs of corrosion, can usually be cleaned with crocus
cloth, using a circular motion. Black stains on the cylinder walls are caused by piston cups and will
not impair operation of cylinder.
ASSEMBLE
Before assembling the pistons and new cups in the wheel cylinders, dip them in clean brake fluid. If
the boots are deteriorated, cracked or do not fit tightly on the pistons or the cylinder casting, install
new boots. 1.
Coat cylinder bore with clean brake fluid.
2. Lightly coat the sealing lip and outer surfaces of the wheel cylinder cups with Mopar
Protect-A-Cup Lubricant.
3. Install expansion spring with cup expanders in cylinder. Install cups in each end of cylinder with
open end of cups facing each other.
4. Install piston in each end of cylinder having the flat face of each piston contacting the flat face of
each cup, already installed.
5. Coat the interior surfaces of the push on boots with the Mopar Protect-A-Cup Lubricant
6. Install a boot over each end of cylinder. Be careful not to damage boot during installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service Precautions
Parking Brake Cable: Service Precautions
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE PRELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
NOTE: Remove only one rear park brake cable from rear brakes at a time. Failure to do so will
result in high efforts required to connect park brake cables to equalizer or park brake lever at rear
wheel brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Cable Removal
NOTE: Remove only one rear park brake cable from rear brakes at a time. Failure to do so will
result in high efforts required to connect park brake cables to equalizer or park brake lever at rear
wheel brakes.
PROCEDURE
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Out Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
1. Remove screws attaching rear of center console assembly to floor pan of vehicle.
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
2. Remove the 2 screws located in cup holders attaching front of center console to console bracket.
3. Raise park brake lever as high as it will go for the clearance required to remove the center
console. 4. Remove center console assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4356
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE PRELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
5. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Lever
6. Grasp park lever output cable by hand and pull rearward. Continue pulling on cable until a 3/16
in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and sector
gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off park
brake cables.
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
7. Remove rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer. 8. Remove rear seat
cushion from vehicle.
Rear Door Sill Scuff Plates
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4357
9. Remove scuff plates from right and left rear door sills. Scuff plates are attached to door sills
using clips on bottom of scuff plates. Remove by
carefully prying scuff plate retaining clips out of door sills.
10. Fold rear carpeting forward to expose park brake cables.
Compressing Park Brake Cable Retaining Tabs
11. Install the box end of a 1/2 in. wrench over the park brake cable retainer as indicated. This will
compress tabs on park brake cable retainer,
allowing cable to be removed from console bracket. From under carpet, grasp park brake cable
housing and pull cable straight out of console bracket.
12. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 13. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
Rear Brake Drum
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4358
Rear Brake Rotor
14. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub/Bearing Dust Cap Removal
15. Remove dust cap from rear hub/ bearing assembly.
Hub/Bearing Assembly Retaining Nut
16. Remove hub/bearing assembly retaining nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4359
Hub/Bearing Removal From Spindle (Drum Brakes Shown)
17. Remove the rear hub/bearing assembly from the rear spindle.
Park Brake Cable Attachment To Actuating Lever
Brake Adjustment Lever Actuating Spring
18. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove park brake cable from park brake
actuating lever. Then remove the actuating spring between
brake shoe adjustment lever and brake shoe assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4360
Parking Brake Shoe Assemblies
Parking Brake Actuator Lever
19. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove brake shoe assemblies from rear disc
brake adapter. Then remove parking brake actuating
lever from the park brake cable.
Park Brake Cable Removal From Brake Support Plate
20. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove park brake cable from rear brake support
plate. Park brake cable is removed from brake
support plate using a 1/2 in. wrench as shown above to compress locking tabs on park brake cable
retainer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4361
Park Brake Cable Removal From Disc Brake Adapter
21. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove park brake cable from rear disc brake
adapter. Park brake cable is removed from disc brake
adapter using a screwdriver as shown to compress locking tabs on park brake cable retainer.
Park Brake Cable Routing Bracket
22. Remove park brake cable routing bracket from vehicle frame rail.
Park Brake Cable Seal At Floor Pan
23. Remove park brake cable and sealing grommet from floor pan of vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4362
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Cable Installation
PROCEDURE
1. Install park brake cable into floor pan of vehicle making sure sealing grommet is installed in floor
pan as far as possible to insure proper seal. 2. Install park brake cable into brake support plate or
rear disc brake adapter. Be sure locking tabs on cable retainer are expanded to ensure park
brake cable is securely held in support plate or adapter.
Park Brake Cable Routing Bracket
3. Install park brake cable routing bracket on frame rail. Install and securely tighten routing bracket
attaching bolt.
Park Brake Cable Attachment To Actuating Lever
Brake Adjustment Lever Actuating Spring
4. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, install park brake cable on park brake cable
actuating lever. Then install actuating spring between
brake shoe assembly and brake adjustment lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4363
Parking Brake Shoe Assemblies
Parking Brake Actuator Lever
5. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, install park brake shoes actuator lever on park
brake cable. Then install park brake shoe assemblies on
disc brake adapter.
6. Install the hub/bearing assembly on the rear spindle. Then install A NEW rear hub/bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub/bearing assembly
retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
7. Install hub/bearing assembly dust cap, using a soft faced hammer. 8. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Rear Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
9. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair for installation procedure.
10. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle, tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4364
11. Lower vehicle.
Seal Grommet Installation In Floor Pan
12. Grasp park brake cable to floor pan seal grommet by hand, and pull it into floor pan to ensure
seal grommet is fully seated into floor pan.
Park Brake Cable Installed In Retaining Bracket
13. Route park brake cable under carpeting and up to park brake cable retaining bracket on floor
pan. Then install park brake cable into retaining
bracket. Be sure tabs on park brake cable retainer, have expanded out to hold park brake cable in
retaining bracket.
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
14. Install rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever cable. 15. Reposition rear
carpeting. 16. Install both rear door sill plate scuff moldings, by snapping them onto rear door sills.
17. Install lower rear seat cushion. Be sure lower seat cushion is fully installed in retainers on floor
pan of vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4365
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever
18. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin (3/16 in. drill bit) and quickly remove it from the park
brake lever mechanism. This will allow the park
brake lever mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
19. Cycle park brake lever ounce to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever to
its released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle, they should rotate freely without dragging.
20. Apply park brake to full engagement. 21. Install center console assembly. 22. Install the center
console assembly attaching screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Parking Brake Lever: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 4370
Parking Brake Lever: Vehicle Damage Warnings
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE RELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair Parking Brake Lever Removal
Brake Lever Assembly And Output Cable
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
PARK BRAKE LEVER OUTPUT CABLE
On this vehicle, the park brake lever output cable is not replaceable as a separate component of
the park brake lever. Never attempt to repair the park brake output cable in any manner.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Out Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal > Page 4373
PROCEDURE
1. Remove the screws attaching the rear of the center console assembly to console bracket.
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
2. Remove the 2 screws located in cup holders, attaching front of center console assembly to
console bracket. 3. Raise park brake hand lever as high as it will go to get the required clearance
to remove the center console. 4. Remove center console assembly.
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE RELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
5. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Lever
6. Grasp park brake lever output cable by hand and pull rearward. Continue pulling on cable until a
3/16 in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and
sector gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off
park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal > Page 4374
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
7. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer.
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
8. Remove wiring harness electrical connector for brake warning light ground from the park brake
lever.
Park Brake Lever Attachment To Console Bracket
9. Remove the 2 nuts attaching the park brake lever to the console bracket. Remove park brake
lever mechanism from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal > Page 4375
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair Parking Brake Lever Installation
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
PROCEDURE
Park Brake Lever Attachment To Console Bracket
1. Place park brake lever on console bracket. Install and securely tighten the 2 attaching nuts.
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
2. Install both rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever output cable. 3. Ensure that
park brake cable is correctly installed and aligned with cable track on park brake lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal > Page 4376
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever
4. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin and quickly remove it from the park brake lever
mechanism. This will allow the park brake lever
mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
5. Connect electrical connector for brake warning lamp onto terminal on park brake lever assembly.
6. Cycle park brake lever once to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever its
released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle. They should rotate freely without dragging.
7. Raise park brake lever to its fully engaged position. This is necessary to allow installation of the
center console. 8. Install center console assembly
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Out Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Parking Brake Lever Removal > Page 4377
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
9. Install the 4 center console assembly attaching screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Parking Brake Shoe: Description and Operation
Parking Brake Assembly For Rear Disc Brake
The parking brakes on vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes consist of a small duo-servo brake
assembly mounted to the disc brake caliper adapter. The hat (center) section of the rear rotor
serves as the braking surface (drum) for the parking brakes. This park brake application uses the
same operating cable configuration as the drum brake equipped vehicles, but different cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Removal
PROCEDURE
1. Remove rear disc brake caliper assembly from adapter and rotor. See: Disc Brake System/Brake
Caliper/Service and Repair 2. Remove rear rotor from rear hub. 3. Remove dust cap from rear hub.
4. Remove rear hub and bearing assembly retaining nut and washer. 5. Remove rear hub and
bearing assembly from rear spindle.
Rear Brake Shoe Hold-Down Clip
6. Remove rear brake shoe assembly hold down clip. 7. Turn brake shoe adjuster wheel until
adjuster is at shortest length.
Park Brake Shoe Adjuster Assembly
8. Remove adjuster assembly from the parking brake shoe assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4383
Brake Shoe Lower Return Spring
9. Remove lower shoe to shoe spring.
Brake Shoe And Upper Spring
10. Pull rear brake shoe assembly away from anchor. Then remove rear brake shoe and upper
spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4384
Front Hold Down Clip And Brake Shoe
11. Remove front brake shoe hold-down clip. Then remove front brake shoe assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4385
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Installation
PROCEDURE
Front Hold Down Clip And Brake Shoe
1. Install front brake shoe and hold down clip.
Brake Shoe And Upper Spring
2. Install rear brake shoe and the upper brake shoe to shoe return spring. 3. Pull rear brake shoe
over anchor block until properly located on adapter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4386
Brake Shoe Lower Return Spring
4. Install the lower shoe to shoe return spring.
Park Brake Shoe Adjuster Assembly
5. Install brake shoe adjuster assembly with star wheel rearward.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4387
Rear Brake Shoe Hold-Down Clip
6. Install rear brake shoe hold down clip. 7. Adjust brake shoes to a diameter to 171 mm (6.75
inch). 8. Install rear hub and bearing assembly on spindle. 9. Install A NEW hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque the hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 168 Nm (124 ft. lbs.).
10. Install hub and bearing assembly dust cap. 11. Install rear rotor. 12. Install rear disc brake
caliper on the adapter. 13. Install wheel and tire assemblies. 14. Tighten wheel stud nuts to 109 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
Master Cylinder Mounting Nuts
............................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) Power Brake Vacuum Booster Mounting Nuts
...................................................................................................................................... 29 Nm (250
in. lbs.) Tube Nuts ...............................................................................................................................
................................................................ 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4392
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service Precautions
CAUTION: When installing the routing clip and brake tubes on the mounting stud, do not bend or
kink the chassis brake line tubes. Be sure the chassis brake tubes are routed correctly. The
chassis brake tubes can not touch each other or other components or the body of the vehicle.
NOTE: The vacuum booster assembly is not a repairable part and must be replaced as a complete
unit if it is found to be faulty in any way. The vacuum brake booster check valve is not repairable
but can be replaced as a component of the vacuum booster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4393
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
Vacuum Booster Identification
Vacuum Booster Assembly
GENERAL INFORMATION
All vehicles use a 230 mm single diaphragm power brake vacuum booster. There are however two
different booster designs; one for vehicles equipped with ABS and one for vehicles without ABS.
These two boosters differ at the interface to the master cylinder. If the power brake booster
requires replacement be sure it is replaced with the correct part. The power brake booster can be
identified by the tag attached to the body of the booster assembly. This tag contains the following
information: The production part number of the power booster assembly, the date it was built, who
manufactured it, and brake sales code. The power brake booster reduces the amount of force
required by the driver to obtain the necessary hydraulic pressure to stop vehicle. The power brake
booster is vacuum operated. The vacuum is supplied from the intake manifold on the engine
through the power brake booster check valve.
NOTE: The power brake booster assembly is not a repairable part and must be replaced as a
complete unit if it is found to be faulty in any way. The power booster vacuum check valve is not
repairable but can be replaced as an assembly.
PURPOSE
As the brake pedal is depressed, the power booster input rod moves forward. This opens and
closes valves in the power booster, allowing atmospheric pressure to enter on one side of a
diaphragm. Engine vacuum is always present on the other side. This difference in pressure forces
the output rod of the power booster out against the primary piston of the master cylinder. As the
pistons in the master cylinder move forward this creates the hydraulic pressure in the brake
system. Different engine options available for this vehicle require that different vacuum hose
routings be used.
LOCATION
The power brake vacuum booster assembly mounts on the engine side of the dash panel. It is
connected to the brake pedal by the input push rod. A vacuum line connects the power booster to
the intake manifold. The master cylinder is bolted to the front of the power brake vacuum booster
assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Removal
PROCEDURE
CAUTION: On ABS equipped vehicles, vacuum in power booster must be pumped down before
removing master cylinder to prevent booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done
simply by pumping the brake pedal until a firm pedal is achieved, with the ignition off.
1. On ABS equipped vehicles, with engine not running, pump the brake pedal until a firm pedal is
achieved (4-5 strokes).
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
2. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level sensor located in master
cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes Without ABS Brakes
Fig 7 Type 3 Primary And Secondary Output Ports. With ABS
3. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder. Install plugs at all
open brake tube outlets on master cylinder
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4396
assembly.
4. On vehicles equipped with ABS, clean area where master cylinder attaches to booster using a
suitable brake cleaner such as Mopar Brake Parts
Cleaner or an equivalent.
Master Cylinder Mounting To Vacuum Booster
5. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder housing to power brake vacuum booster. 6. Slide
master cylinder assembly straight out of the power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: On vehicles equipped with ABS, the master cylinder is used to create the seal for
holding vacuum in the power brake vacuum booster. The vacuum seal in the front of the power
brake vacuum booster MUST be replaced whenever the master cylinder is removed from the
power brake vacuum booster.
Removing Seal From Vacuum Booster
7. If vehicle is equipped with ABS, remove vacuum seal located in the front of the power brake
vacuum booster. Vacuum seal is removed by
carefully inserting a small screw driver between the push rod of the power brake vacuum booster
and vacuum seal and prying seal out of power brake vacuum booster. Do not attempt to pry seal
out of master cylinder by inserting a tool between seal and power brake vacuum booster.
Power Brake Vacuum Booster Check Valve
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4397
8. Disconnect vacuum hoses from check valve on power brake vacuum booster. Do not remove
check valve from power brake vacuum booster.
NOTE: If vehicle is equipped with antilock brakes, the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) needs to be
removed from the vehicle to allow removal of the power brake vacuum booster. Refer to Antilock
Brake System Hydraulic Control Unit Service and Repair.
Input Rod Retaining Pin
9. Locate the power brake vacuum booster input rod to brake pedal attachment under instrument
panel. Position a small screwdriver under the center
tang of the retaining clip.
CAUTION: Discard retaining clip when removed, it is not to be reused. Replace only with a new
retaining clip when assembled.
10. Rotate screwdriver enough to allow retaining clip tang to pass over the end of the brake pedal
pin.
Power Brake Booster Mounting
11. Remove the 4 nuts attaching the power brake vacuum booster to the dash panel. The nuts are
accessible from under the instrument panel in the
area of the steering column and brake pedal bracket.
12. Slide power brake vacuum booster forward until mounting studs clear dash panel, then tilt the
booster up and to the center of the vehicle to
remove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4398
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Installation
PROCEDURE
1. Position power brake booster onto dash panel.
Power Brake Booster Mounting
2. Install and torque the 4 power brake vacuum booster mounting nuts to 29 Nm (250 in. lbs.)
torque. 3. Using Lubriplate, or equivalent, coat the surface of the brake pedal pin where it contacts
the brake vacuum booster input rod. 4. Connect power brake vacuum booster input rod to brake
pedal pin and install a NEW retaining clip. Use only a new retainer clip DO NOT USE
the old clip.
5. Connect all previously removed vacuum hoses onto power brake vacuum booster check valve.
6. If vehicle is equipped with ABS, install Hydraulic Control Unit HCU. Refer to Antilock Brake
System Hydraulic Control Unit Service and Repair.
CAUTION: When replacing the power brake vacuum booster on a vehicle equipped with ABS, a
NEW vacuum seal MUST be installed in the power brake vacuum booster. Use only the procedure
detailed below for installing vacuum seal into power brake vacuum booster. If old vacuum seal
came out with master cylinder when it was removed from power brake vacuum booster, be sure it
is removed from master cylinder before attempting to install master cylinder into power brake
vacuum booster.
CAUTION: When lubricating master cylinder push rod, use only Mopar Silicone Dielectric
Compound. Using any other type of grease or lubricant on the push rod, will not provide adequate
long term lubrication of the push rod.
Lubricating Master Cylinder Push Rod
7. Lubricate master cylinder push rod as indicated in only using Mopar Dielectric Grease-And No
Substitutes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4399
Fig 19 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Installation. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
Fig 20 Type 3 Vacuum Seal Seating. Neon Models Equipped With ABS
8. Install vacuum seal on master cylinder push rod as shown with notches on vacuum seal pointing
toward master cylinder housing. Then slide
vacuum seal onto master push rod until seal is seated against master cylinder housing before
installing master cylinder on power brake vacuum booster.
CAUTION: If vehicle is equipped with ABS, be sure the old vacuum seal is removed from power
brake vacuum booster before attempting to install master cylinder and NEW vacuum seal. If
vacuum seal is not removed, refer to Master Cylinder Service and Repair Removal.
9. Position master cylinder on studs of power brake unit, aligning push rod on power brake vacuum
booster with master cylinder push rod.
10. Install the 2 master cylinder mounting nuts and torque to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) torque.
Primary And Secondary Brake Tubes Without ABS Brakes
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4400
Bleeding Tubes Attached To Non-ABS Master Cylinder
11. Connect brake tubes to master cylinder primary and secondary ports. Torque all tube nuts to 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.) torque. 12. Reconnect wiring connector to fluid level sensor. 13. Adjust stop lamp
switch as necessary. 14. Bleed brake system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The system relay is used for the operation of the Anti Lock Brake (ABS) system. Power for the
relay is supplied on the B57 circuit from cavity 57 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB).
Ground for the relay is on the Z1 circuit. This ground is spliced in with the pump motor and
terminates at the left headlamp ground.
When the system is operating normally power for the contact side of the relay is supplied from the
CAB on the B57 circuit. It passes through the relay to the Z1 ground and terminates at the left
headlamp ground. If a problem is detected in the system, the contact side of the relay switches
from the Z1 to the F12 circuit. This causes the ABS warning lamp in the instrument cluster to
illuminate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > ABS System Relay > Page 4407
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS System Relays
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
SYSTEM RELAY
The main purpose of the system relay is to put the Antilock Brake System (ABS) into a stand-by
mode for ABS operation. The System Relay is energized by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
shortly after the ignition switch is turned on.
When Energized - by the CAB, the System Relay turns off the ABS warning lamp and provides 12
volts to the CAB. This voltage can then be used by the CAB to energize the Decay Solenoids
during ABS braking. When energized, the System Relay also provides the Pump/Motor Relay coil
with 12 volts. The ground path to the Pump/Motor Relay is completed by the CAB during ABS
braking.
When De-energized - the ABS warning lamp is illuminated, voltage to the Decay Solenoids is cut
off, and the Pump/Motor Relay is prevented from energizing. Typically, the System Relay is
de-energized by the CAB when a fault is detected that requires turning ABS off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Description
System Relay And Pump Motor Relay Box
PURPOSE
Pump/Motor power is supplied by the Pump/Motor Relay. The pump motor relay is also part of the
relay box mounted to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). If pump/motor relay replacement is
required, it is also only serviced by the replacement of the relay box assembly.
FUNCTION
Voltage for the 12 volt side of the relay coil is provided by the System Relay. The ground path
through the relay coil is completed by the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) during Antilock Brake
System (ABS) braking. The relay contacts are closed when the relay is energized. This provides 12
volts to the pump/motor as needed during ABS braking.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pump Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4412
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Anti Lock Brake (ABS) pump motor relay controls when the pump motor runs. Power for the
coil side of the relay is supplied from cavity 47 of the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) on the B47
circuit. This circuit also supplies voltage for the contact side of the system relay The ground side of
the coil is controlled by the B116 circuit. Circuit B116 connects to cavity 16 of the CAB connector.
Circuit B120 from cavity 20 of the CAB connector powers the ABS pump motor. This circuit is also
used as an input to the CAB for pump motor monitoring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
Controller Antilock Brake
The CAB is mounted under the instrument panel behind the drivers side kick panel of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4416
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
Controller Antilock Brake
PURPOSE
The Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) is a microprocessor based device which monitors the Antilock
Brake System (ABS) during normal braking and controls it when in an ABS stop. The CAB is
mounted under the instrument panel on the drivers side kick panel. The CAB uses a 60 way
electrical connector on the vehicle wiring harness. The power source for the CAB is through the
ignition switch in the Run or On position.
NOTE: The CAB is not on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) bus.
THE PRIMARY FUNCTIONS OF THE CAB
- Detect wheel locking tendencies.
- Control fluid modulation to the brakes while in ABS mode.
- Monitor the system for proper operation.
- Provide communication to the DRB scan tool while in diagnostic mode.
The CAB Continuously Monitors - the speed of each wheel through the signals generated at the
Wheel Speed Sensors to determine if any wheel is beginning to lock. When a wheel locking
tendency is detected, the CAB commands the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) to modulate brake fluid
pressure in some or all of the hydraulic circuits. The CAB continues to control pressure in individual
hydraulic circuits until a locking tendency is no longer present.
The ABS System Is Constantly Monitored - by the CAB for proper operation. If the CAB detects a
fault, it will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp and disable the ABS braking system. The normal
Non ABS braking system will remain operational.
The CAB Contains A Self-diagnostic Program - which will turn on the Amber ABS Warning Lamp
when a ABS system fault is detected.
Faults Are Then Stored - in a diagnostic program memory. There are multiple fault messages
which may be stored in the CAB and displayed through the DRB. These fault messages will remain
in the CAB memory even after the ignition has been turned off. The fault messages can be cleared
by using the DRB diagnostics tester, or they will be automatically cleared from the memory after
the vehicle is driven approximately 3500 miles.
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE INPUTS
^ Four wheel speed sensors. ^ Stop lamp switch. ^ Ignition switch. ^ System relay voltage. ^
Ground. ^ Pump/Motor Relay Monitor ^ Diagnostics Communications
CONTROLLER ANTILOCK BRAKE OUTPUTS
^ 4 Decay Solenoids ^ ABS warning lamp. ^ System relay actuation. ^ Diagnostic communication. ^
Pump motor relay actuation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4417
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Controller Antilock Brake
REMOVE
1. Turn vehicle ignition off.
CAB 60-Way Wiring Harness Connector
2. Disconnect the wiring harness 60 way connector from the Controller Antilock Brake Module
(CAB). Verify that the vehicle ignition is off before
removing the 60 way connector.
CAB Bracket To Kick Panel Mounting
3. Remove the 2 controller bracket to drivers side cowl mounting nuts. 4. Remove the CAB from
the vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Install CAB and mounting bracket on mounting studs located on passenger side kick panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4418
2. Install the 2 CAB bracket mounting nuts and securely tighten. 3. Install the 60-way wiring
harness connector by hand into the 60-way CAB connector, as far as possible. Then use the CAB
connector retaining
bolt to fully seat wiring harness connector into the CAB.
4. Torque the 60-way connector retaining bolt to 4 Nm (38 inch lbs.). 5. If a new CAB is being has
been installed, it must be initialized prior to the vehicle being driven. The CAB is initialized using
the DRB Scan Tool
and the initializing procedure described upon selecting Bendix ABX-4 Diagnostics. New controllers
are programmed to flash the ABS warning lamp until initialized by the installing technician.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4423
Brake Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair
GENERAL INFORMATION
The master cylinder or brake fluid reservoir does not have to be removed from vehicle for
replacement of the brake fluid level sensor.
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
1. Remove wiring harness connector from brake fluid reservoir level sensor.
Brake Fluid Level Switch Retaining Tabs
2. Compress retaining tabs on end of brake fluid level switch.
Removing/Installing Fluid Reservoir Level Switch
3. While compressing retaining tabs, grasp opposite end of brake fluid level switch and pull it out of
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir. 4. Correctly align the replacement level switch with its
mounting hole in the brake fluid reservoir. Push switch into fluid reservoir until retaining tabs
are fully expanded on opposite side of fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Switch <--> [Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4424
5. Install the wiring harness connector onto the brake fluid level switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Braking Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit L50 is an input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB). The L50 connects to cavity 13 of the
CAB connector. Circuit L50 is spliced in with the stop lamps and is used to provide the CAB with
information on when the brakes are being applied.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions
Wheel Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-10-99I
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: October, 1999
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1993-1997 Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 ABS Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number
81-699-96026
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revisions to the ABS test procedures for wheel speed sensors
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4432
39
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4433
43
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4434
45
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4435
47
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4436
51
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4437
55
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4438
57
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4439
59
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4440
63
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4441
67
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4442
69
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4443
71
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4444
173
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4445
177
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4446
179
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4447
181
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4448
187
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4449
191
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4450
193
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4451
195
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4452
201
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4453
205
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4454
207
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4455
209
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > ABS - Kelsey Hayes EBC-5H, EBC 310 Test
Revisions > Page 4456
256
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4457
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Rear
Clearance Minimum Clearance 0.014 in 0.016 in
Maximum Clearance 0.047 in 0.047 in
Runout 0.006 in 0.006 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4458
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service Precautions
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
There are four wheel speed sensors, one at each wheel. The sensors use a tone wheel to
determine wheel speed. Input to the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) is done on the following
circuits. All of these circuits are a twisted pair. B8 and B9 for the left front wheel (cavity 8 and cavity
9). B6 and B7 for the right front wheel (cavity 6 and cavity 7). B3 and B4 for the left rear wheel
(cavity 3 and cavity 4). B1 and B2 for the right rear wheel (cavity 1 and cavity 2).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 4461
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensors and Tone Wheels
Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Drum Brakes
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor With Rear Disc Brakes
One Wheel Speed Sensor (WSS) is located at each wheel and sends a small AC signal to the
Controller Antilock Brake (CAB). This signal is generated by magnetic induction created when a
toothed sensor ring (tone wheel) passes the stationary magnetic Wheel Speed Sensor. The CAB
converts the AC signal generated at each wheel into a digital signal. If a wheel locking tendency is
detected by the CAB, it will then modulate hydraulic pressure via the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
to prevent the wheel(s) from locking.
The front Wheel Speed Sensor is attached to a boss in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is part
of the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear drum brake
applications is mounted to the rear brake support plate and the rear tone wheel is an integral part
of the rear wheel hub and bearing assembly. The rear Wheel Speed Sensor on rear disc brake
applications is mounted to the rear disc brake adapter and the rear tone wheel is also an integral
part of the rearwheel hub and bearing assembly. The speed sensor air gap on both applications is
NOT adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 4462
The four Wheel Speed Sensors are serviced individually. The front Tone Wheels are serviced as
an assembly with the outboard constant velocity joint. The rear Tone Wheels are serviced as an
assembly with the rear hub and bearing assembly.
Correct ABS system operation is dependent on accurate wheel speed signals. The vehicle's
wheels and tires must all be the same size and type to generate accurate signals. Variations in
wheel and tire size can produce inaccurate wheel speed signals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4463
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
CAREFUL INSPECTION
Carefully inspect tone wheel at the suspected faulty wheel speed sensor for missing, chipped or
broken teeth, this can cause erratic speed sensor signals. Tone wheels should show no evidence
of contact with the wheel speed sensors. If contact was made, determine cause and correct before
replacing the wheel speed sensor.
Excessive Runout - of the tonewheel can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Refer to
Tone-wheel Runout under Specification. Replace drive shaft assembly or rear hub/bearing
assembly if tonewheel runout exceeds the specification.
Inspect For Looseness - on their mounting surfaces. Tone wheels are pressed onto their mounting
surfaces and should not rotate independently from the mounting surface. Check the wheel speed
sensor head alignment to the tone wheel. Also check the gap between the speed sensor head and
the tone wheel to ensure it is at specification. See: Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Speed Sensor Cable To Wiring Herness Connection
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Attaching Bolt
Front Wheel Speed Sensor Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4466
4. Remove wheel speed sensor head to steering knuckle attaching bolt. 5. Carefully, remove
sensor head from steering knuckle. If the sensor has seized, due to corrosion, DO NOT USE
PLIERS ON SENSOR HEAD. Use
a hammer and a punch and tap edge of sensor ear, rocking the sensor side to side until free.
6. Remove the speed sensor cable assembly grommets from the retaining bracket. Remove speed
sensor cable routing clip from the frame of the
vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable connector to the vehicle wiring harness. 2. Install the
speed sensor cable assembly grommets into the retaining bracket. Install speed sensor cable
routing clip onto the frame of the vehicle. 3. Install wheel speed sensor to steering knuckle
attaching screw. Torque the attaching screw to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 4. Install the wheel and tire
assembly on vehicle. 5. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and ABS
systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4467
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Speed Sensor Connection To Vehicle Wiring Harness
Speed Sensor Head Mounting And Cable Routing
NOTE: Proper installation of the Wheel Speed Sensor Cables is critical to continued system
operation. Be sure that cables are installed, routed and clipped properly. Failure to install speed
sensor cables as in the on car service section of this manual, may result in contact with moving
parts or over extension of cables, resulting in an open circuit.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the tire and
wheel assembly from the vehicle. 3. Unplug speed sensor cable connector from vehicle wiring
harness. Remove clip attaching speed sensor cable connector to vehicle body. 4. Remove the
speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting bracket. Then
remove the speed sensor cable from the
routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
5. Remove bolt attaching the rear wheel speed sensor to the disc brake adapter. The remove bolt
attaching speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear
strut assembly.
6. Remove speed sensor head from the disc brake adapter. If the speed sensor head has seized in
the adapter, DO NOT USE PLIERS ON SENSOR
HEAD.
INSTALL
1. Install wheel speed sensor head into disc brake adapter. 2. Install wheel speed sensor attaching
bolt. Tighten the attaching bolt to a torque of 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) 3. Install the brake flex hose and
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut bracket. 4. Install wheel speed sensor
cable into the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube. 5. Plug speed
sensor cable connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install clip attaching speed sensor cable
connector to vehicle body. 6. Install the tire and wheel assembly on vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the base and ABS systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 4473
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4476
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4477
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch pedal position switch functions as a safety interlock device. It prevents possible engine
cranking with the clutch engaged.
The clutch pedal position switch is wired in series between the starter relay coil and the ignition
switch.
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4481
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRICAL TEST
Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness from instrument panel wiring harness. Using an
ohmmeter, check for continuity between the two terminals in the connector on the switch harness.
There should be no continuity between the terminals when the switch is in its normal (fully
extended) position. When the switch is depressed more than 1.25 mm (0.050 inch), the ohmmeter
should show continuity (zero ohms).
If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch is defective, and must be replaced.
MECHANICAL TEST
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN NEUTRAL, turn the key to the start position. The vehicle
should not crank. If the vehicle cranks, the switch is defective (shorted out) and must be replaced.
If the vehicle does not crank proceed to the next step.
WARNING: Before performing this step, be sure that the area in front of the vehicle is clear of
obstructions and people. Vehicle may move when performing this test.
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN GEAR, turn the key to the start position and hold it there.
Slowly depress the clutch pedal and feel for any vehicle motion when the starter is energized. If
there is no motion the switch is working properly.
If motion is felt, check to see if the switch is making contact when the pedal is between 25 mm (1.0
inch) and 6 mm (0.25 inch) from the floor. If this condition is met, then the problem is either the
clutch or the self-adjusting cable. If this condition is not met, then the switch mounting tab on the
brake bracket is bent, and the brake bracket must be replaced.
If vehicle will not crank, even with clutch pedal pressed to the floor, refer to illustrated chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4482
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4483
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
NOTES:
^ The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
^ The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical harness to switch connector. 2. Depress wing tabs on switch and push
switch out of mounting bracket. Then slide wires through slot in bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide switch wires through slot in switch bracket. 2. Line up switch tab with slot in switch bracket
and push switch into position. Do not pull on the switch wires to seat switch into bracket, switch
damage may occur.
3. Attach switch wiring harness to vehicle wiring harness. 4. After installation, the switch must be
checked for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4488
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Neutral Safety Switch: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4492
Neutral Safety Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4493
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4499
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4500
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4501
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4502
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: CHECK TO ENSURE THAT THE TRANSMISSION IS IN THE PARK
POSITION/NEUTRAL WITH THE PARKING BRAKE APPLIED
Relay Test
The starter relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine compartment.
Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location. Remove the starter relay from the PDC
as described to perform the following tests:
1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30, and
no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 Ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 3. Connect a battery B+ lead to terminals 86 and a
ground lead to terminal 85 to energize the relay The relay should click. Also test for continuity
between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A and 30. If OK, refer to
Relay Circuit Test procedure. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to battery voltage and should be hot at
all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the PDC fuse as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position, but is not used for this application. Go to Step
3.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. This terminal supplies battery
voltage to the starter solenoid field coils. There should be continuity between the cavity for relay
terminal 87 and the starter solenoid terminal at all times. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the starter solenoid as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. It is energized when
the ignition switch is held in the Start position.
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the clutch pedal must be fully depressed for this test.
Check for battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86 with the ignition switch in the Start
position, and no voltage when the ignition switch is released to the On position. If OK, go to Step 5.
If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an open or short circuit to the ignition switch
and repair, if required. If the circuit to the ignition switch is OK, see the Ignition Switch Test
procedure. If not OK with a manual transmission, check the circuit between the relay and the clutch
pedal position switch for an open or a short. If the circuit is OK, see the Clutch Pedal Position
Switch/Brake pedal Switch/Sensor Test procedure.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. On vehicles with an
automatic transmission, it is grounded through
the park/neutral position switch only when the gearshift selector lever is in the Park or Neutral
positions. On vehicles with a manual transmission, it is grounded at all times. Check for continuity
to ground at the cavity for relay terminal 85. If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an
open or short circuit to the park/neutral position switch and repair, if required. If the circuit is OK,
see the Park/Neutral Position Switch/Neutral Safety Switch Test procedure. If not OK with a
manual transmission, repair the circuit to ground as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Service Precautions
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Page 4507
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature. This temperature
data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the (PCM) to vary the battery charging
rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is gradually reduced at warmer
temperatures.
Battery Temperature Sensor
The sensor is located forward of the vehicle battery, and is attached to the battery tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to Powertrain
Management/Computer and Controls/Testing and Inspection.
1. The sensor is located under the battery and is attached to the battery tray. A two-wire pigtail
harness is attached directly to the sensor. The
opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25 °C (75-80 °F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) Ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below
the specification, replace the sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 4510
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Make sure ignition switch is in OFF position and all accessories are OFF.
Disconnect Battery Negative Cable
2. Remove battery negative cable first then the positive cable.
Battery Thermoguard
3. Remove battery thermoguard.
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN.
Air Inlet Tube Pull Strap
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 4511
4. Remove temperature sensor mounting nut from battery tray.
Battery Temperature Sensor Connector
5. Disconnect sensor wire connector.
INSTALL
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Generator: Electrical Specifications
Voltage
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) regulates charging system voltage by controlling the generator
field source (+) circuit.
The voltage range is 12.9 to 15.0 volts
Rated Amps
Rated SAE Amps .................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 83 amps
Minimum Test Amps ............................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 75 amps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4517
Generator: Mechanical Specifications
DESCRIPTION = TORQUE Battery Terminal Nut = 9 N.m (75 in. lbs.)
Battery Hold Down Clamp Bolt = 9 N.m (75 in. lbs.)
Generator Mounting Bolt = 54 N.m (40 ft. lbs.)
Generator Pivot Bolt = 54 N.m (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4518
Generator: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The generator is belt-driven by the engine. It is serviced only as a complete assembly. If the
generator fails for any reason, the entire assembly must be replaced. As the energized rotor begins
to rotate within the generator, the spinning magnetic field induces a current into the windings of the
stator coil. Once the generator begins producing sufficient current, it also provides the current
needed to energize the rotor. The Y type stator winding connections deliver the induced AC current
to 3 positive and 3 negative diodes for rectification. From the diodes, rectified DC current is
delivered to the vehicle electrical system through the generator, battery, and ground terminals.
Noise emitting from the generator may be caused by: Worn, loose or defective bearings
- Loose or defective drive pulley
- Incorrect, worn, damaged or misadjusted drive belt
- Loose mounting bolts
- Misaligned drive pulley
- Defective stator or diode
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4519
Generator: Service and Repair
REMOVE
Removal/Installation Of Battery Cables
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Loosen but DO NOT remove the generator adjustment nut.
3. Raise vehicle with front wheels turned fully to the right. 4. Remove the plastic lower splash
shield.
Generator Rear View
5. Disconnect the generator field circuit wiring connector. Squeeze locking tab to release.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4520
Wire Terminal Connection
6. Remove the B+ terminal nut and wire.
Generator Front View
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Generator <--> [Alternator] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4521
Generator Rear View
7. Loosen pivot bolt, but do not remove. 8. Remove the generator drive belt. The generator spill
shield does not need to be removed. 9. Remove three mounting pivot bracket bolts.
10. Remove pivot bolt and bracket. 11. Holding the generator in one hand, remove adjustment nut
and slide the generator off the T-bolt. The T-bolt does not need to be removed. 12. Lower the
generator and remove through the wheel well.
INSTALL
1. For installation, reverse above procedures. The generator field connector has a locking tab and
will snap when fully installed. Tighten all fasteners
to the proper torque. Refer to Starting and Charging/Battery/Torque Specifications chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Voltage Regulator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Voltage Regulator: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The Electronic Voltage Regulator (EVR) is not a separate component. It is actually a voltage
regulating circuit located within the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The EVR is not serviced
separately. If replacement is necessary, the PCM must be replaced.
Operation: The amount of DC current produced by the generator is controlled by EVR circuitry
contained within the PCM. This circuitry is connected in series with the generators second rotor
field terminal and its ground.
Voltage is regulated by cycling the ground path to control the strength of the rotor magnetic field.
The EVR circuitry monitors system line voltage and battery temperature. It then compensates and
regulates generator current output accordingly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch pedal position switch functions as a safety interlock device. It prevents possible engine
cranking with the clutch engaged.
The clutch pedal position switch is wired in series between the starter relay coil and the ignition
switch.
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4529
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
ELECTRICAL TEST
Disconnect clutch pedal position switch harness from instrument panel wiring harness. Using an
ohmmeter, check for continuity between the two terminals in the connector on the switch harness.
There should be no continuity between the terminals when the switch is in its normal (fully
extended) position. When the switch is depressed more than 1.25 mm (0.050 inch), the ohmmeter
should show continuity (zero ohms).
If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch is defective, and must be replaced.
MECHANICAL TEST
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN NEUTRAL, turn the key to the start position. The vehicle
should not crank. If the vehicle cranks, the switch is defective (shorted out) and must be replaced.
If the vehicle does not crank proceed to the next step.
WARNING: Before performing this step, be sure that the area in front of the vehicle is clear of
obstructions and people. Vehicle may move when performing this test.
With the park brake set and the vehicle IN GEAR, turn the key to the start position and hold it there.
Slowly depress the clutch pedal and feel for any vehicle motion when the starter is energized. If
there is no motion the switch is working properly.
If motion is felt, check to see if the switch is making contact when the pedal is between 25 mm (1.0
inch) and 6 mm (0.25 inch) from the floor. If this condition is met, then the problem is either the
clutch or the self-adjusting cable. If this condition is not met, then the switch mounting tab on the
brake bracket is bent, and the brake bracket must be replaced.
If vehicle will not crank, even with clutch pedal pressed to the floor, refer to illustrated chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4530
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4531
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
NOTES:
^ The clutch pedal position switch is mounted to a bracket located behind the clutch pedal. The
switch is held in place by four plastic wing tabs.
^ The clutch pedal position switch IS NOT adjustable. The pedal blade contacts the switch in the
down position.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical harness to switch connector. 2. Depress wing tabs on switch and push
switch out of mounting bracket. Then slide wires through slot in bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide switch wires through slot in switch bracket. 2. Line up switch tab with slot in switch bracket
and push switch into position. Do not pull on the switch wires to seat switch into bracket, switch
damage may occur.
3. Attach switch wiring harness to vehicle wiring harness. 4. After installation, the switch must be
checked for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detents
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detents:
- Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4536
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Ignition Lock Cylinder Detentes
The lock cylinder is inserted in the end of the housing opposite the ignition switch. The ignition key
rotates the cylinder to 5 different detentes: Accessory
- Off (lock)
- Unlock
- On/Run
- Start
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Place key cylinder in RUN position.
- Through the hole in the lower shroud, depress lock cylinder retaining tab and remove key
cylinder.
INSTALLATION
1. Install key in lock cylinder.
- Turn key to run position (retaining tab on lock cylinder can be depressed).
Socket In Lock Cylinder Housing
2. The shaft at the end of the lock cylinder aligns with the socket in the end of the housing.
- To align the socket with the lock cylinder, ensure the socket is in the Run position.
3. Align the lock cylinder with the grooves in the housing.
- Slide the lock cylinder into the housing until the tab sticks through the opening in the housing.
4. Turn the key to the Off position. Remove the key. 5. Connect negative cable to battery
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Specifications
Neutral Safety Switch: Specifications
Mounting Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4540
Neutral Safety Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4541
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVE
Battery Cable Removal And Installation
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Vehicles equipped with A/C:
a. Using a floor jack or jack stand, support the engine and transmission assembly so they will not
rotate.
Front Engine Mount Bolt Removal
b. Remove the front engine mount bolt from the insulator and front crossmember mounting bracket.
c. Lower the front of the engine, rotate the engine forward, allowing easier removal of starter motor.
4. For easier servicing, do not remove the wiring from starter at this time.
Starter Removal
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 4545
5. Remove two bolts attaching starter to transmission housing. 6. Remove starter/starter solenoid
assembly from transmission housing. Position the starter to gain access to the wiring connectors.
Wire Connection
7. Remove the battery positive cable nut and remove the battery positive and generator output wire
from the starter. 8. Disconnect push-on solenoid connector. 9. Position the starter vertically such
that the pinion end faces downward.
10. Remove the starter through the bottom of the vehicle. Move aside A/C plumbing as necessary.
INSTALL
1. Clean corrosion/dirt from the cable and wire terminals before installing wiring to the solenoid. 2.
Connect the battery positive and generator output wire to the starter solenoid post.
CAUTION: It is critical that the generator output terminal be connected to the battery positive
terminal of the starter solenoid, for proper operation of the charging and cranking systems.
3. Connect the push-on solenoid connector. 4. Position the starter face into transmission housing.
Support starter in pilot and start the top bolt. 5. Attach ground cable to lower mounting bolt and
start bolt. 6. Ensure the proper starter alignment before tightening the starter mounting bolts to 54
N.m (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 7. Vehicles equipped with A/C:
a. Using a floor jack or jack stand, raise the engine and transmission assembly to the original
position. b. Install the front engine mount bolt through the insulator and front crossmember
mounting bracket. c. Tighten bolt to 54 N.m (40 ft. lbs.) torque.
8. Lower vehicle and connect battery cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 4550
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 4551
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 4552
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 4553
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: CHECK TO ENSURE THAT THE TRANSMISSION IS IN THE PARK
POSITION/NEUTRAL WITH THE PARKING BRAKE APPLIED
Relay Test
The starter relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine compartment.
Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location. Remove the starter relay from the PDC
as described to perform the following tests:
1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30, and
no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 Ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 3. Connect a battery B+ lead to terminals 86 and a
ground lead to terminal 85 to energize the relay The relay should click. Also test for continuity
between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A and 30. If OK, refer to
Relay Circuit Test procedure. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to battery voltage and should be hot at
all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the PDC fuse as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position, but is not used for this application. Go to Step
3.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. This terminal supplies battery
voltage to the starter solenoid field coils. There should be continuity between the cavity for relay
terminal 87 and the starter solenoid terminal at all times. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the starter solenoid as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. It is energized when
the ignition switch is held in the Start position.
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the clutch pedal must be fully depressed for this test.
Check for battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86 with the ignition switch in the Start
position, and no voltage when the ignition switch is released to the On position. If OK, go to Step 5.
If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an open or short circuit to the ignition switch
and repair, if required. If the circuit to the ignition switch is OK, see the Ignition Switch Test
procedure. If not OK with a manual transmission, check the circuit between the relay and the clutch
pedal position switch for an open or a short. If the circuit is OK, see the Clutch Pedal Position
Switch/Brake pedal Switch/Sensor Test procedure.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. On vehicles with an
automatic transmission, it is grounded through
the park/neutral position switch only when the gearshift selector lever is in the Park or Neutral
positions. On vehicles with a manual transmission, it is grounded at all times. Check for continuity
to ground at the cavity for relay terminal 85. If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an
open or short circuit to the park/neutral position switch and repair, if required. If the circuit is OK,
see the Park/Neutral Position Switch/Neutral Safety Switch Test procedure. If not OK with a
manual transmission, repair the circuit to ground as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Starter Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: CHECK TO ENSURE THAT THE TRANSMISSION IS IN THE PARK POSITION WITH
THE PARKING BRAKE APPLIED
1. Verify battery condition. Battery must be in good condition with a full charge before performing
any starter tests. Refer to Starting and Charging
/Battery/Battery Tests.
2. Perform Starter Solenoid test BEFORE performing the starter relay test. 3. Raise the vehicle. 4.
Perform a visual inspection of the starter/ starter solenoid for corrosion, loose connections or faulty
wiring. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Locate and remove the starter relay from the Power Distribution
Center (PDC). Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location. 7. Connect a remote
starter switch or a jumper wire between the remote battery positive post and terminal 87 of the
starter relay connector.
a. If engine cranks, starter/starter solenoid is good. Go to the Starter Relay Test. b. If engine does
not or solenoid chatters, check wiring and connectors from starter relay to starter solenoid for loose
or corroded connections.
Particularly at starter terminals.
c. Repeat test. If engine still fails to crank properly, trouble is within starter or starter mounted
solenoid, and replace starter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
> Page 4566
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
> Page 4567
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 232497 > May > 97 > Customer Interest for Diode: >
07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 232497 > May > 97 > Customer Interest for Diode: >
07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4577
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 232497 > May > 97 > Customer Interest for Diode: >
07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4578
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > Page 4579
Stabilizer Bushing: Testing and Inspection
Inspect for broken or distorted sway bar bushings, bushing retainers, and worn or damaged sway
bar to strut attaching links. If sway bar to front suspension cradle bushing replacement is required,
bushing can be removed from sway bar by opening slit and peeling bushing off sway bar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center: Locations
Fig.31 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4583
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The power distribution center (PDC) is located next to the battery in the engine compartment. The
PDC contains the starter relay, radiator fan relay, A/C compressor clutch relay, auto shutdown
relay, fuel pump relay and several fuses. For the location of the relay within the PDC, refer to the
PDC cover for location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Distribution Center: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4586
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4587
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4588
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4589
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4590
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4591
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4592
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4593
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4594
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4595
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4596
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4597
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4598
Power Distribution Center: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4599
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4600
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4601
Power Distribution Center: Connector Views
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4602
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4603
Power Distribution Center: Electrical Diagrams
Power Distribution
Power Distribution (Part 1 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4604
Power Distribution (Part 2 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4605
Power Distribution (Part 3 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4606
Power Distribution (Part 4 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4607
Power Distribution (Part 5 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4608
Power Distribution (Part 6 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4609
Power Distribution (Part 7 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4610
Power Distribution (Part 8 Of 8)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Ground Distribution
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4611
Ground Distribution (Part 1 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4612
Ground Distribution (Part 2 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4613
Ground Distribution (Part 3 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4614
Ground Distribution (Part 4 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4615
Ground Distribution (Part 5 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4616
Ground Distribution (Part 6 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4617
Ground Distribution (Part 7 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4618
Ground Distribution (Part 8 Of 8)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations
Fuse: Locations
Fuse Locations
Fuse Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4626
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4627
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4628
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4629
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4630
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4631
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4632
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4633
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4634
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4635
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4636
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4637
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4638
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4639
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4640
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4641
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4642
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 2)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4643
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4644
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4645
Fuse Block (Part 3 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4646
Fuse Block (Part 4 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4647
Fuse Block (Part 5 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4648
Fuse Block (Part 6 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4649
Fuse Block (Part 7 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4650
Fuse Block (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4651
Fuse Block (Part 9 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4652
Fuse Block (Part 10 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4653
Fuse Block (Part 11 Of 11)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions
Multiple Junction Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector
Pinout Revisions
NUMBER: 26-10-96C
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: October, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Wiring diagram revisions to the connector pin-outs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page
4658
8W-43-3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page
4659
8W-80-5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page
4660
8W-80-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4670
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98 > Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4671
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service Precautions
Parking Brake Cable: Service Precautions
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE PRELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
NOTE: Remove only one rear park brake cable from rear brakes at a time. Failure to do so will
result in high efforts required to connect park brake cables to equalizer or park brake lever at rear
wheel brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Cable Removal
NOTE: Remove only one rear park brake cable from rear brakes at a time. Failure to do so will
result in high efforts required to connect park brake cables to equalizer or park brake lever at rear
wheel brakes.
PROCEDURE
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Out Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
1. Remove screws attaching rear of center console assembly to floor pan of vehicle.
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
2. Remove the 2 screws located in cup holders attaching front of center console to console bracket.
3. Raise park brake lever as high as it will go for the clearance required to remove the center
console. 4. Remove center console assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4676
WARNING: WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS
REQUIRED, THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE PRELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
5. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Lever
6. Grasp park lever output cable by hand and pull rearward. Continue pulling on cable until a 3/16
in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and sector
gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off park
brake cables.
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
7. Remove rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer. 8. Remove rear seat
cushion from vehicle.
Rear Door Sill Scuff Plates
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4677
9. Remove scuff plates from right and left rear door sills. Scuff plates are attached to door sills
using clips on bottom of scuff plates. Remove by
carefully prying scuff plate retaining clips out of door sills.
10. Fold rear carpeting forward to expose park brake cables.
Compressing Park Brake Cable Retaining Tabs
11. Install the box end of a 1/2 in. wrench over the park brake cable retainer as indicated. This will
compress tabs on park brake cable retainer,
allowing cable to be removed from console bracket. From under carpet, grasp park brake cable
housing and pull cable straight out of console bracket.
12. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 13. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
Rear Brake Drum
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4678
Rear Brake Rotor
14. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub/Bearing Dust Cap Removal
15. Remove dust cap from rear hub/ bearing assembly.
Hub/Bearing Assembly Retaining Nut
16. Remove hub/bearing assembly retaining nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4679
Hub/Bearing Removal From Spindle (Drum Brakes Shown)
17. Remove the rear hub/bearing assembly from the rear spindle.
Park Brake Cable Attachment To Actuating Lever
Brake Adjustment Lever Actuating Spring
18. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove park brake cable from park brake
actuating lever. Then remove the actuating spring between
brake shoe adjustment lever and brake shoe assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4680
Parking Brake Shoe Assemblies
Parking Brake Actuator Lever
19. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove brake shoe assemblies from rear disc
brake adapter. Then remove parking brake actuating
lever from the park brake cable.
Park Brake Cable Removal From Brake Support Plate
20. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove park brake cable from rear brake support
plate. Park brake cable is removed from brake
support plate using a 1/2 in. wrench as shown above to compress locking tabs on park brake cable
retainer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4681
Park Brake Cable Removal From Disc Brake Adapter
21. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove park brake cable from rear disc brake
adapter. Park brake cable is removed from disc brake
adapter using a screwdriver as shown to compress locking tabs on park brake cable retainer.
Park Brake Cable Routing Bracket
22. Remove park brake cable routing bracket from vehicle frame rail.
Park Brake Cable Seal At Floor Pan
23. Remove park brake cable and sealing grommet from floor pan of vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4682
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair Cable Installation
PROCEDURE
1. Install park brake cable into floor pan of vehicle making sure sealing grommet is installed in floor
pan as far as possible to insure proper seal. 2. Install park brake cable into brake support plate or
rear disc brake adapter. Be sure locking tabs on cable retainer are expanded to ensure park
brake cable is securely held in support plate or adapter.
Park Brake Cable Routing Bracket
3. Install park brake cable routing bracket on frame rail. Install and securely tighten routing bracket
attaching bolt.
Park Brake Cable Attachment To Actuating Lever
Brake Adjustment Lever Actuating Spring
4. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, install park brake cable on park brake cable
actuating lever. Then install actuating spring between
brake shoe assembly and brake adjustment lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4683
Parking Brake Shoe Assemblies
Parking Brake Actuator Lever
5. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, install park brake shoes actuator lever on park
brake cable. Then install park brake shoe assemblies on
disc brake adapter.
6. Install the hub/bearing assembly on the rear spindle. Then install A NEW rear hub/bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub/bearing assembly
retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
7. Install hub/bearing assembly dust cap, using a soft faced hammer. 8. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Rear Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
9. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer to Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair for installation procedure.
10. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle, tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4684
11. Lower vehicle.
Seal Grommet Installation In Floor Pan
12. Grasp park brake cable to floor pan seal grommet by hand, and pull it into floor pan to ensure
seal grommet is fully seated into floor pan.
Park Brake Cable Installed In Retaining Bracket
13. Route park brake cable under carpeting and up to park brake cable retaining bracket on floor
pan. Then install park brake cable into retaining
bracket. Be sure tabs on park brake cable retainer, have expanded out to hold park brake cable in
retaining bracket.
Park Brake Cables At Equalizer
14. Install rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever cable. 15. Reposition rear
carpeting. 16. Install both rear door sill plate scuff moldings, by snapping them onto rear door sills.
17. Install lower rear seat cushion. Be sure lower seat cushion is fully installed in retainers on floor
pan of vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cable Removal > Page 4685
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever
18. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin (3/16 in. drill bit) and quickly remove it from the park
brake lever mechanism. This will allow the park
brake lever mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
19. Cycle park brake lever ounce to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever to
its released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle, they should rotate freely without dragging.
20. Apply park brake to full engagement. 21. Install center console assembly. 22. Install the center
console assembly attaching screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Customer Interest for Diode: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98
> Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-04-98 Date: 980417
Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats
NO: 07-04-98
GROUP: Cooling
DATE: Apr. 17, 1998
SUBJECT: Vehicle Overheats (Radiator Fan Inoperative) Or Radiator Fan Runs Continuously
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 07-07-97 DATED FEBRUARY
20, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1997 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL
(PUBLICATION NUMBER 81-699-98004). THE REVISION PROVIDES A NEW PART NUMBER
FOR THE RADIATOR FAN RELAY. THE CHANGE IS HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AT TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PRIOR TO
SEPTEMBER 11, 1997 (MDH 0911XX). TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE
ELEVENTH POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle overheats or radiator fan continues to run.
DIAGNOSIS:
Actuate the radiator fan relay using the DRB III. If the radiator fan does not come on or fan runs
continuously, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05293157AA Jumper Wire With Diode, Radiator Fan
**1 04707286 Relay, Radiator Fan**
2 06015756 Tie Strap
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-65-12-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves installing a radiator fan jumper wire assembly into the headlamp and dash
wiring harness, and replacing the solid state relay.
1. Raise the hood and disconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Customer Interest for Diode: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98
> Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4695
2. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Locate the left (driver's side) black fan motor connector. Retract the red latch on the two-way
female connector, depress the thumb latch, and disconnect the connector from the fan (Figure 1). If
the wiring to the fan motor is clipped into the fan support, gently pry it out of the hole so the fan is
not damaged.
4. Pry out the two christmas tree type retainers located on the lower radiator enclosure
reinforcement.
5. Install the jumper wire assembly (p/n 052931 57AA) between the radiator fan and the headlamp
and dash harness:
A. Attach the black two-way male connector with the clip into the outboard hole, so the connector
faces outboard toward the left side of the vehicle. Attach the second clip into the inboard hole of the
lower reinforcement that the original wiring came out of (Figure 2).
B. Connect the original two-way black connector to the new mating connector installed in the
previous step and slide the red latch into the locked position.
6. Connect the two-way female black connector on the new jumper assembly to the fan connector
and slide the red latch into the locked position. If the original wiring to the fan was clipped into the
fan support, snap the new clip on the jumper into the same hole.
7. Bundle the excess original fan wiring and tie strap to the main bundle of vehicle wiring in the
front left corner in two places.
NOTE:
ENSURE THAT THE WIRING BUNDLE IS SECURE AND DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH ANY
OTHER COMPONENTS.
8. The solid state fan relay is located on the left front rail. Retract the red latch on the black
four-way connector and disconnect from the solid state fan relay.
9. Remove the two screws that secure the relay to the side of the left front rail and remove the
relay.
10. Install the new solid state fan relay ** (p/n 04707286)** and locate the index pin on the relay
into the locator hole in the rail. Secure with the two screws and torque to 5 N.m (45 in.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Diode: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Customer Interest for Diode: > 07-04-98 > Apr > 98
> Cooling System - Fan ON Continuously/Overheats > Page 4696
11. Connect the four way connector and slide the red latch into the locked position.
12. Lower the vehicle and connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center: Locations
Fig.31 Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4700
Power Distribution Center (Top)
The Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The power distribution center (PDC) is located next to the battery in the engine compartment. The
PDC contains the starter relay, radiator fan relay, A/C compressor clutch relay, auto shutdown
relay, fuel pump relay and several fuses. For the location of the relay within the PDC, refer to the
PDC cover for location. Check electrical terminals for corrosion and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Distribution Center: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4703
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4704
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4705
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4706
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4707
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4708
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4709
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4710
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4711
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4712
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4713
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4714
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4715
Power Distribution Center: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4716
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4717
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4718
Power Distribution Center: Connector Views
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4719
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4720
Power Distribution Center: Electrical Diagrams
Power Distribution
Power Distribution (Part 1 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4721
Power Distribution (Part 2 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4722
Power Distribution (Part 3 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4723
Power Distribution (Part 4 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4724
Power Distribution (Part 5 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4725
Power Distribution (Part 6 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4726
Power Distribution (Part 7 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4727
Power Distribution (Part 8 Of 8)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Ground Distribution
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4728
Ground Distribution (Part 1 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4729
Ground Distribution (Part 2 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4730
Ground Distribution (Part 3 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4731
Ground Distribution (Part 4 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4732
Ground Distribution (Part 5 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4733
Ground Distribution (Part 6 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4734
Ground Distribution (Part 7 Of 8)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4735
Ground Distribution (Part 8 Of 8)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations
Fuse: Locations
Fuse Locations
Fuse Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4743
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4744
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4745
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4746
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4747
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4748
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4749
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4750
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4751
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4752
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4753
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4754
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4755
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4756
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4757
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4758
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4759
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 2)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4760
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block (Part 1 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4761
Fuse Block (Part 2 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4762
Fuse Block (Part 3 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4763
Fuse Block (Part 4 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4764
Fuse Block (Part 5 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4765
Fuse Block (Part 6 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4766
Fuse Block (Part 7 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4767
Fuse Block (Part 8 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4768
Fuse Block (Part 9 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4769
Fuse Block (Part 10 Of 11)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4770
Fuse Block (Part 11 Of 11)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions
Multiple Junction Connector: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector
Pinout Revisions
NUMBER: 26-10-96C
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: October, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Wiring diagram revisions to the connector pin-outs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page 4775
8W-43-3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page 4776
8W-80-5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Diagram Connector Pinout Revisions > Page 4777
8W-80-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 4787
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 4788
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page
4794
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 > Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page
4795
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
NO: 02-04-97
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Front End Alignment Torque Specifications & Shock Adjustment Procedures On
Competition Package
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE SALES
CODE (ACR) SUSPENSION SALES CODE (SDK).
DISCUSSION:
The alignment on ACR equipped vehicles must be set to the preferred specifications provided in
the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) page 2-7. After each final
setting the nuts should then be torqued to 75 ft.lbs plus an additional 90 degree turn. It is important
that the proper torque be used to maintain the proper alignment. If the alignment is outside of
specifications, rapid and excessive tire wear will result.
Starting in 1997, Neon competition package (ACR) vehicles come equipped with adjustable strut
dampers on all four wheels. The struts are finely tuned to the ride and handling profile of the entire
suspension system. If the customer wishes to change the dampening force for special conditions
the dampening characteristics of the strut dampers are adjustable on the ACR equipped vehicles.
The knob for adjusting the strut can be found in a packet located in the glove compartment. The
adjustment procedures are as follows:
1. The top end of the adjusting rod has flats over which the adjusting knob will fit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment >
Page 4800
2. Install the knob over the top end of the front or rear damper and lock it into position by turning
counterclockwise slowly until the knob engages, (Illustration).
3. Turn the adjusting knob clockwise, if resistance is felt do not use force, as the damper is in an
unadjusted position. Reverse the adjustment slightly and try again. When the damper is in the full
clockwise position, this is the minimum (City Ride) position.
4. To adjust the dampening force, the adjusting knobs has to be turned in the direction of the arrow
for increased dampening and the opposite direction for decreased dampening.
NOTE:
BOTH THE LEFT AND RIGHT STRUT DAMPERS MUST BE ADJUSTED IDENTICALLY.
FAILURE TO DO SO COULD PRODUCE UNSTABLE HANDLING AND UNEVEN TIRE TREAD
WEAR.
5. The following is a description of the various settings and the adjustment procedure.
A. City Ride - To enjoy the most comfortable city ride, the struts should be left in the "minimum"
position as they are set from the assembly plant. To set to minimum the knob should be turned
completely clockwise.
B. Cross Country - The cross country setting will give the car a firmer handling characteristic, but
yet will still be very comfortable to drive. To set, turn the adjusting knob 1/2 turn counter clockwise
from the "minimum" position.
C. G.T./Aggressive Driving - This setting equates the car's handling to a cross-country grand
turismo car, offering increased cornering ability, improved road feel and precise directional stability
at higher speeds. To set turn the adjusting knob 1 turn counter clockwise from the "minimum"
position.
6. Remove the adjusting knob before closing the hood or trunk. The vehicle should not be driven
with the adjusting knob in place.
NOTE:
DURING INSPECTION/SERVICING A THIN FILM OF OIL AND DUST COLLECTION MAY BE
NOTICED ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE STRUT TUBE. THIS IS A NORMAL CONDITION WHICH
OCCURS DURING THE DAMPER INTERNAL SEAL "BREAK-IN" PERIOD AND DOES NOT
AFFECT THE PERFORMANCE OF THE STRUT AND DOES NOT INDICATE THE NEED FOR
STRUT REPLACEMENT. STRUT REPLACEMENT SHOULD ONLY OCCUR IF THE STRUT
LEAKAGE IS SUFFICIENT TO COVER THE ENTIRE STRUT DAMPER TUBE AND HAS
"DRIPPED" ONTO THE LOWER CONTROL ARM OR ONTO THE PAVEMENT DURING
OVERNIGHT PARKING.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-96D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision the front end alignment specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions > Page 4805
2-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
NO: 02-04-97
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Front End Alignment Torque Specifications & Shock Adjustment Procedures On
Competition Package
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE SALES
CODE (ACR) SUSPENSION SALES CODE (SDK).
DISCUSSION:
The alignment on ACR equipped vehicles must be set to the preferred specifications provided in
the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) page 2-7. After each final
setting the nuts should then be torqued to 75 ft.lbs plus an additional 90 degree turn. It is important
that the proper torque be used to maintain the proper alignment. If the alignment is outside of
specifications, rapid and excessive tire wear will result.
Starting in 1997, Neon competition package (ACR) vehicles come equipped with adjustable strut
dampers on all four wheels. The struts are finely tuned to the ride and handling profile of the entire
suspension system. If the customer wishes to change the dampening force for special conditions
the dampening characteristics of the strut dampers are adjustable on the ACR equipped vehicles.
The knob for adjusting the strut can be found in a packet located in the glove compartment. The
adjustment procedures are as follows:
1. The top end of the adjusting rod has flats over which the adjusting knob will fit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 02-04-97 > May > 97 > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment >
Page 4811
2. Install the knob over the top end of the front or rear damper and lock it into position by turning
counterclockwise slowly until the knob engages, (Illustration).
3. Turn the adjusting knob clockwise, if resistance is felt do not use force, as the damper is in an
unadjusted position. Reverse the adjustment slightly and try again. When the damper is in the full
clockwise position, this is the minimum (City Ride) position.
4. To adjust the dampening force, the adjusting knobs has to be turned in the direction of the arrow
for increased dampening and the opposite direction for decreased dampening.
NOTE:
BOTH THE LEFT AND RIGHT STRUT DAMPERS MUST BE ADJUSTED IDENTICALLY.
FAILURE TO DO SO COULD PRODUCE UNSTABLE HANDLING AND UNEVEN TIRE TREAD
WEAR.
5. The following is a description of the various settings and the adjustment procedure.
A. City Ride - To enjoy the most comfortable city ride, the struts should be left in the "minimum"
position as they are set from the assembly plant. To set to minimum the knob should be turned
completely clockwise.
B. Cross Country - The cross country setting will give the car a firmer handling characteristic, but
yet will still be very comfortable to drive. To set, turn the adjusting knob 1/2 turn counter clockwise
from the "minimum" position.
C. G.T./Aggressive Driving - This setting equates the car's handling to a cross-country grand
turismo car, offering increased cornering ability, improved road feel and precise directional stability
at higher speeds. To set turn the adjusting knob 1 turn counter clockwise from the "minimum"
position.
6. Remove the adjusting knob before closing the hood or trunk. The vehicle should not be driven
with the adjusting knob in place.
NOTE:
DURING INSPECTION/SERVICING A THIN FILM OF OIL AND DUST COLLECTION MAY BE
NOTICED ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE STRUT TUBE. THIS IS A NORMAL CONDITION WHICH
OCCURS DURING THE DAMPER INTERNAL SEAL "BREAK-IN" PERIOD AND DOES NOT
AFFECT THE PERFORMANCE OF THE STRUT AND DOES NOT INDICATE THE NEED FOR
STRUT REPLACEMENT. STRUT REPLACEMENT SHOULD ONLY OCCUR IF THE STRUT
LEAKAGE IS SUFFICIENT TO COVER THE ENTIRE STRUT DAMPER TUBE AND HAS
"DRIPPED" ONTO THE LOWER CONTROL ARM OR ONTO THE PAVEMENT DURING
OVERNIGHT PARKING.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-96D
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1996
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon - Publication Number 81-270-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision the front end alignment specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 26-12-96D > Dec > 96 > Steering/Suspension - Alignment Specifications Revisions
> Page 4816
2-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4817
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 02-09-99 Date: 990702
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4818
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4819
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part Technical Service Bulletin # 02-09-99 Date: 990702
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4820
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4821
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 4822
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 4823
Alignment: Specifications
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-96.
NOTE: All alignment specifications are taken at curb height.
FRONT:
Camber: Acceptable Range ................................................................................................................
........................................................................ -0.4° to +0.4° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 0.0° S/C ACR only [3] ...............................................................................................................
.......................................................................... -2.4° to +0.4°
Total Toe [1]: Acceptable Range .........................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.3° in to 0.1° out Preferred Setting ............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............ 0.1° in S/C ACR only [3] .........................................................................................................
................................................................... 0.30° In to 0.70° Out
Caster*: Acceptable Range .................................................................................................................
....................................................................... +1.8° to +3.8° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ +2.8°
* Side To Side Caster: Not To Exceed ................................................................................................
................................................................................................. 1.0° or less
REAR:
Camber: Acceptable Range ................................................................................................................
.................................................................... -0.75° to +0.25° Preferred Setting ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... -0.25° S/C ACR only [3] ...............................................................................................................
...................................................................... -1.00° to +0.25°
Total Toe [1] [2]: Acceptable Range ....................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 0.3° in to 0.1°out Preferred Setting .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 0.1° in S/C ACR only [3] ....................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.30° In to 0.50° Out
Thrust Angle ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................... -0.10° to +0.10°
[1]: Total toe is the arithmetic sum of the left and right wheel toe settings. Positive is toe-in,
negative is toe-out. Total toe must be equally split between each front wheel to ensure the steering
wheel is centered after setting toe. Left and right toe must be equal to within 0.02 degrees.
[2]: Toe-out when backed on to the alignment rack is toe in when driving.
[3]: The alignment specifications shown, are only for vehicles which are equipped with the ACR
(Competition Package) sales code. This specification is listed to show the adjustable range for the
Camber and Toe on the front and rear suspension of a vehicle with the Competition Package.
These alignment specifications are only to be used at the request of the vehicle owner and only
when the vehicle is going to be used in a competition event. The alignment is to be set back to the
preferred setting before the vehicle is returned to normal operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 4824
Alignment: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify any suspension or steering components by heating or bending
of the component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 4825
Alignment: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
Proper vehicle wheel alignment is the proper adjustment of all interrelated front and rear
suspension angles. These angles are what affects the handling and steering of the vehicle when it
is in motion. The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment will vary depending
on the type and manufacturer of the equipment being used. Instructions furnished by the
manufacturer of the equipment being used should always be followed to ensure accuracy of the
alignment, except alignment specifications recommended by Chrysler Corporation MUST ALWAYS
be used.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify any suspension or steering components by heating or bending
of the component.
ORDER OF ADJUSTMENTS
Wheel alignment adjustments should be made in the following sequence, to ensure that an
accurate alignment is performed.
1. Rear Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for both total toe and thrust angle. 2. Front
Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for total toe. 3. Toe is measured in degrees or inches
and is the distance that the front edges of the tires are closer (or farther apart) than the rear edges.
4. Thrust Angle is defined as the average of the Toe settings on each rear wheel. If this
measurement is out of specification, re-adjust rear wheel Toe
so that each wheel has 1/2 of the total Toe measurement. When re-adjusting, do not exceed the
total Toe specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 4826
Alignment: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact damage, the steering
column to steering gear coupling must be inspected.
PRE-ALIGNMENT VEHICLE INSPECTION
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment factors, the following
inspection and necessary corrections must be made on those parts which influence the steering of
the vehicle. 1. Be sure the fuel tank is full when the wheel alignment specifications are checked
and or adjusted. A full tank of fuel weighs approximately 75
pounds, if the fuel tank is not full this reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the vehicle
and the alignment specifications.
2. Alignment specifications of a vehicle can be the most accurately checked and set when the
passenger compartment and trunk of the vehicle are
vacant with the exception of the spare tire. People, luggage, and any other appreciable weight will
adversely affect the checking and setting of the camber specification.
3. Check and if required, inflate all of the tires to the recommended air pressure. All tires must be of
the same size and in good condition and
have approximately the same tread wear. Note the type of tread wear on the tire, this will aid in
diagnosing problems.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for radial runout. 5. Before beginning the alignment
process, inspect all suspension component fasteners for looseness and/or loss of specified torque.
6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering linkage for looseness and any signs of wear
and or damage. 7. Inspect the tie rod ends for looseness and any signs of wear and or damage. 8.
Inspect the rubber bushings on all suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any
bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment Bolt Package Installation
1. If front and or rear camber readings obtained are not within the required specification range, a
Mopar (R) Service Kit is available to provide the
required adjustment. The kit contains new bolts and nuts for the strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle attachment. The bolts contained in the service kit, are slightly undersize allowing for
movement between the strut clevis bracket and steering knuckle. The movement allowed by the
undersize bolts will provide approximately 2 degrees of camber adjustment per side of vehicle. To
install new bolts in service kit follow the procedure below.
CAUTION: The Mopar (R) Service Kit for allowing adjustment of front and rear camber are different
for the front and rear of the vehicle. When using the service kits be sure that the front and rear strut
attaching bolts are always used in the right location on the vehicle.
2. Raise front and or rear of vehicle until tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle and rear knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated
and must not be turned during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering
knuckles.
3. Remove original upper bolt attaching the front or rear strut clevis bracket to the steering knuckle
or rear knuckle. 4. Loosen lower bolt attaching strut clevis bracket to steering knuckle or rear
knuckle ONLY enough to allow knuckle to move in clevis bracket. 5. Install bolt from service kit into
the upper strut clevis bracket to steering knuckle or rear knuckle mounting hole.
CAUTION: Only the nuts supplied in the service kits MUST be used with the service kit
replacement bolts. The original nuts will not properly secure the strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle or rear knuckle.
6. Install nut provided in service kit on the replacement bolt. 7. Tighten upper bolt and nut from
service kit until snug, but still allowing movement between strut clevis bracket and knuckle. 8.
Remove original lower bolt. Install bolt from service kit into the bottom hole of the strut clevis
bracket. Install nut and snug. 9. Lower vehicle until full weight of vehicle is supported by the
suspension and then jounce front and rear of vehicle an equal amount of times.
10. Adjust front and or rear camber to the preferred setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the
front or rear tire. When camber is correctly set
tighten upper and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce front and rear of vehicle an equal
amount of times and verify front and rear camber setting.
11. When vehicle is at correct camber setting torque both front strut clevis bracket to steering
knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an
additional 1/4 turn after required torque is met. Torque rear strut clevis bracket to rear knuckle
attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
12. If Toe readings obtained are not within the required specification range, adjust Toe to meet the
preferred specification setting. Toe is adjustable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4829
using the following Toe setting procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4830
Alignment: Service and Repair Checking Wheel Alignment Angles
GENERAL INFORMATION
Front and rear Caster and Camber settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is
designed, by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is called a Net Build vehicle
and results in no required adjustment of Caster and Camber after vehicle is built or when servicing
the suspension components. Thus Caster and Camber are not normally considered an adjustable
specification when performing an alignment on this vehicle. Though Caster and Camber are not
adjustable they must be checked to ensure they meet vehicle specifications.
If front and or rear camber is found not to meet the vehicle alignment specifications, it can be
adjusted using a Mopar (R) Service Kit developed to allow for camber adjustment. If a vehicle's
front or rear camber is found to be outside the specifications, the vehicles suspension components
should be inspected for any signs of damage on bending. This must be done before using the
Mopar (R) Service Kit for setting camber to meet required specification.
If a vehicles caster is not within manufacturers alignment specifications, check for damaged
suspension components or body parts. This type of damage can cause component locations to
move affecting vehicle alignment. No adjustment can be made for the Caster setting on this
vehicle.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicles Caster or Camber by heating, bending or any
other modification of the suspension components.
PROCEDURE
1. Correctly position vehicle on alignment rack and install all required equipment on vehicle, per the
alignment equipment manufacturers
specifications.
2. Center the steering wheel and lock in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: Prior to reading each alignment specification, jounce the front and rear of the vehicle an
equal number of times. Induce jounce (rear first then front) by grasping center of bumper and
jouncing each end of vehicle an equal number of times. Bumper should always be released when
vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Correctly jounce vehicle and read front and rear alignment settings and compare to vehicle
specifications for Camber, Caster and Toe. If front and
rear camber readings are within required specifications proceed to step Step 3 in the Front And
Rear Toe Setting procedure. If Camber readings are not within specifications refer to step Step 1 in
the camber adjustment bolt package installation procedure, for the front and rear Camber
adjustment procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4831
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Alignment
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact damage, the steering
column to steering gear coupling must be inspected.
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment factors, the following
inspection and necessary corrections must be made on those parts which influence the steering of
the vehicle. 1. Be sure the fuel tank is full when the wheel alignment specifications are checked
and or adjusted. A full tank of fuel weighs approximately 75
pounds, if the fuel tank is not full this reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the vehicle
and the alignment specifications.
2. Alignment specifications of a vehicle can be the most accurately checked and set when the
passenger compartment and trunk of the vehicle are
vacant with the exception of the spare tire. People, luggage, and any other appreciable weight will
adversely affect the checking and setting of the camber specification.
3. Check and if required, inflate all of the tires to the recommended air pressure. All tires must be of
the same size and in good condition and
have approximately the same tread wear. Note the type of tread wear on the tire, this will aid in
diagnosing problems.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for radial runout. 5. Before beginning the alignment
process, inspect all suspension component fasteners for looseness and/or loss of specified torque.
6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering linkage for looseness and any signs of wear
and or damage. 7. Inspect the tie rod ends for looseness and any signs of wear and or damage. 8.
Inspect the rubber bushings on all suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any
bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4832
Alignment: Service and Repair Front and Rear Toe Setting Procedure
1. Prepare vehicle as described in the Pre-Alignment Vehicle Inspection procedure. 2. Center
steering wheel and lock in place using a steering wheel clamp. 3. When performing the Toe setting
procedure, set rear wheel Toe to preferred specification first, then set front wheel Toe to the
preferred
specification.
4. Loosen nuts on attaching bolts, for the left and right rear lateral links to rear crossmember.
5. Rotate lateral link adjustment cams until the preferred rear Toe specification is obtained.
6. While holding Toe adjustment cams from turning, tighten left and right lateral links to rear
crossmember attaching bolt nuts. This will securely hold
adjustment cams in position. Then while holding lateral link attaching bolt and adjustment cam from
turning, torque nut of lateral link attaching bolt to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not twist front inner tie rod to steering gear rubber boots during front wheel Toe
adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4833
7. Loosen inner to outer tie rod end jam nuts. Grasp inner tie rods at serrations and rotate tie rods
to set the front wheel Toe to the preferred
specification.
8. Tighten tie rod locknuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 9. Adjust steering gear to tie rod boots at tie
rod.
10. Remove steering wheel clamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber
Adjustment Bolt Package Installation > Page 4834
Alignment: Service and Repair Order of Adjustments
Wheel alignment adjustments should be made in the following sequence, to ensure that an
accurate alignment is performed.
1. Rear Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for both total toe and thrust angle. 2. Front
Wheel Toe Adjustment within specifications for total toe. 3. Toe is measured in degrees or inches
and is the distance that the front edges of the tires are closer (or farther apart) than the rear edges.
4. Thrust Angle is defined as the average of the Toe settings on each rear wheel. If this
measurement is out of specification, re-adjust rear wheel Toe
so that each wheel has 1/2 of the total Toe measurement. When re-adjusting, do not exceed the
total Toe specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
> Page 4841
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4842
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4843
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4844
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises
Front Steering Knuckle: Customer Interest Front Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises
NO: 02-02-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Front Suspension
EFFECTIVE DATE: Dec. 15, 1997
SUBJECT: Popping/Creaking Noise in Front Suspension
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97 DATED FEBRUARY
28, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL FRONT
SUSPENSION NOISE DIAGNOSTICS/REPAIRS HAVE BEEN ADDED. THE ADDITIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front suspension may be experienced while:
^ Going in reverse or forward with the steering wheel turned completely in one direction (parking lot
maneuvers).
^ Shifting from drive to reverse, reverse to drive, etc.
^ Pulling in/out of driveway.
^ Large dips/bumps in the road such as speed bumps. **
DIAGNOSIS:
If the customer describes the front suspension noise in conditions such as those described above,
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE 1995 NEONS BUILT IN 1994 USED 13" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES WITH 13" OR 14"
WHEELS. LATER BUILT VEHICLES HAVE 13" OR 14" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES TO MATCH
ORIGINAL WHEEL SIZE. TO DETERMINE THE PROPER KNUCKLE SIZE, COUNT THE STUDS
ON THE HUB THEN REFER TO THE PARTS LIST PROVIDED IN THIS BULLETIN.
CAUTION:
DO NOT USE THE WHEEL SIZE TO DETERMINE PROPER KNUCKLE PART NUMBERS.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
**This bulletin involves inspecting/replacing as needed both front wheel bearings and steering
knuckles, front upper strut mounts, engine mounts, and lubing the driveshafts.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 4854
**NOTE:
USE TABLE TO DETERMINE WHICH STEPS TO PERFORM BASED ON VEHICLE BUILD DATE
AND IF TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97, DATED FEBRUARY 28, 1997 HAS BEEN
PERFORMED.**
NOTE:
ALL FRONT KNUCKLE/BEARING/HUB REPAIR PROCEDURES FOR STEPS 1 THROUGH 5,
CAN BE FOUND IN THE 1998 NEON SERVICE MANUAL (PUBLICATION NUMBER
81-270-8025) GROUP 2 (SUSPENSION).
1. Remove both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
2. Press the hub out of the old knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
3. Press the old hubs into the new knuckle/bearing assemblies.
**4. Before the knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies are installed on the vehicle, put a small amount of
grease (Wheel Bearing Lube - p/n 04318064) on the
entire face of the driveshaft that makes contact with the hub bearing assembly (Figure 1).**
5. Install both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 4855
**6. Replace the upper strut mount by following the procedures in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025),
Removal/Installation, pages 2-16 to 2-17, and Assembly/Disassembly procedures 1 thru 5 on
pages 2-30 to 2-31 (Figure 2). The torque for the new upper strut mount nuts is 61 Nm (45 ft.lbs).**
**7. Remove and replace the right engine mount as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) (SOHC - pg
9-18)(DOHC - pg 9-64). After replacing the right engine mount, squirt enough grease (Silicone
Spray - p/n 04318070) between the mount snubber and the engine bracket to fill the gap (Figure
3).**
NOTE:
IF THE SILICONE SPRAY (P/N 04318070) IS NOT AVAILABLE, ANOTHER SILICONE SPRAY
MAY BE USED. HOWEVER THE SUBSTITUTE SILICONE SPRAY MUST NOT BE PETROLEUM
BASED.
**8. Inspect and tighten remaining suspension components to specification; repair or replace as
needed.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
02-05-30-93 Knuckles and Mounts - Replace - All 2.9 Hrs.
02-05-39-91 Upper Strut Mounts and Engine Mount - Replace 1.3 Hrs.
09-40-21-91 Engine Mount Replace 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises
Front Steering Knuckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Suspension - Popping/Creaking
Noises
NO: 02-02-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Front Suspension
EFFECTIVE DATE: Dec. 15, 1997
SUBJECT: Popping/Creaking Noise in Front Suspension
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97 DATED FEBRUARY
28, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL FRONT
SUSPENSION NOISE DIAGNOSTICS/REPAIRS HAVE BEEN ADDED. THE ADDITIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front suspension may be experienced while:
^ Going in reverse or forward with the steering wheel turned completely in one direction (parking lot
maneuvers).
^ Shifting from drive to reverse, reverse to drive, etc.
^ Pulling in/out of driveway.
^ Large dips/bumps in the road such as speed bumps. **
DIAGNOSIS:
If the customer describes the front suspension noise in conditions such as those described above,
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE 1995 NEONS BUILT IN 1994 USED 13" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES WITH 13" OR 14"
WHEELS. LATER BUILT VEHICLES HAVE 13" OR 14" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES TO MATCH
ORIGINAL WHEEL SIZE. TO DETERMINE THE PROPER KNUCKLE SIZE, COUNT THE STUDS
ON THE HUB THEN REFER TO THE PARTS LIST PROVIDED IN THIS BULLETIN.
CAUTION:
DO NOT USE THE WHEEL SIZE TO DETERMINE PROPER KNUCKLE PART NUMBERS.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
**This bulletin involves inspecting/replacing as needed both front wheel bearings and steering
knuckles, front upper strut mounts, engine mounts, and lubing the driveshafts.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 4861
**NOTE:
USE TABLE TO DETERMINE WHICH STEPS TO PERFORM BASED ON VEHICLE BUILD DATE
AND IF TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97, DATED FEBRUARY 28, 1997 HAS BEEN
PERFORMED.**
NOTE:
ALL FRONT KNUCKLE/BEARING/HUB REPAIR PROCEDURES FOR STEPS 1 THROUGH 5,
CAN BE FOUND IN THE 1998 NEON SERVICE MANUAL (PUBLICATION NUMBER
81-270-8025) GROUP 2 (SUSPENSION).
1. Remove both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
2. Press the hub out of the old knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
3. Press the old hubs into the new knuckle/bearing assemblies.
**4. Before the knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies are installed on the vehicle, put a small amount of
grease (Wheel Bearing Lube - p/n 04318064) on the
entire face of the driveshaft that makes contact with the hub bearing assembly (Figure 1).**
5. Install both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 4862
**6. Replace the upper strut mount by following the procedures in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025),
Removal/Installation, pages 2-16 to 2-17, and Assembly/Disassembly procedures 1 thru 5 on
pages 2-30 to 2-31 (Figure 2). The torque for the new upper strut mount nuts is 61 Nm (45 ft.lbs).**
**7. Remove and replace the right engine mount as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) (SOHC - pg
9-18)(DOHC - pg 9-64). After replacing the right engine mount, squirt enough grease (Silicone
Spray - p/n 04318070) between the mount snubber and the engine bracket to fill the gap (Figure
3).**
NOTE:
IF THE SILICONE SPRAY (P/N 04318070) IS NOT AVAILABLE, ANOTHER SILICONE SPRAY
MAY BE USED. HOWEVER THE SUBSTITUTE SILICONE SPRAY MUST NOT BE PETROLEUM
BASED.
**8. Inspect and tighten remaining suspension components to specification; repair or replace as
needed.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
02-05-30-93 Knuckles and Mounts - Replace - All 2.9 Hrs.
02-05-39-91 Upper Strut Mounts and Engine Mount - Replace 1.3 Hrs.
09-40-21-91 Engine Mount Replace 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4863
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
The steering knuckle is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut
assembly and lower control arm ball joint. The steering knuckle also has machined abutments on
the casting to support and align the front brake caliper assembly. The knuckle also holds the front
drive shaft outer C/V joint hub and bearing assembly. The hub is positioned through the bearing
and knuckle, with the constant velocity stub shaft splined through the hub. The outer C/V joint is
retained to the hub/ bearing using a hub nut. The hub nut is held on the stub shaft using a nut
retainer and cotter pin.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4864
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
The front suspension steering knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. IT
MUST BE REPLACED IF FOUND TO BE DAMAGED IN ANY WAY. If it is determined that the
steering knuckle is bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the
steering knuckle.
NOTE: On this vehicle the steering knuckle must be removed from the vehicle when servicing the
front hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Removal
1. Remove cotter pin, nut lock, and spring washer.
CAUTION: Wheel bearing damage will result if after loosening hub nut, vehicle is rolled on the
ground or the weight of the vehicle is allowed to be supported by the tires.
2. Loosen hub nut while vehicle is on the floor with the brakes applied. The hub and driveshaft are
splined together through the knuckle (bearing) and
retained by the hub nut.
3. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 4. Remove wheel lug
nuts, and front tire and wheel assembly from the hub.
5. Remove front disc brake caliper to steering knuckle attaching bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4867
6. Remove disc brake caliper assembly from steering knuckle. Caliper is removed by first lifting
bottom of caliper away from steering knuckle, and
then removing top of caliper out from under steering knuckle.
7. Support brake disc brake caliper assembly using a wire hook and not by hydraulic hose.
8. Remove the braking disc from the front hub/ bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4868
9. Remove the nut attaching outer tie rod end to the steering knuckle. Nut is to be removed from tie
rod end using the following procedure, hold tie rod
end stud with a 11/32 socket while loosening and removing nut with wrench.
10. Remove the tie rod end stud from steering knuckle arm, using Remover, Special Tool
MB-990635, or equivalent.
11. Remove nut and bolt, clamping ball joint stud, from steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4869
12. Separate ball joint stud from steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm.
NOTE: Use caution when separating ball joint stud from steering knuckle, so ball joint seal does not get
cut.
- Care must be taken not to separate the inner C/V joint during this operation. Do not allow
driveshaft to hang by inner C/V joint, driveshaft must be supported.
13. Pull steering knuckle assembly out and away from outer C/V joint of the driveshaft assembly.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
14. Remove the 2 steering knuckle to strut damper clevis bracket attaching bolts. 15. The cartridge
type front wheel bearing used on this vehicle is not transferable to the replacement steering
knuckle. If the replacement steering
knuckle does not come with a hub and bearing assembly, a new bearing must be installed in the
steering knuckle. Installation of the new wheel bearing must be done before installing steering
knuckle on vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4870
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Installation
1. Install a new cartridge hub and bearing assembly into the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
2. Install steering knuckle back in clevis bracket of strut damper assembly. Install the strut damper
to steering knuckle attaching bolts. Note: The
steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned in steering
knuckle during installation. Torque attaching nuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 1/4 turn
after specified torque is met.
3. Slide drive shaft back into front hub and bearing assembly. Then install steering knuckle onto the
ball joint stud.
4. Install a NEW steering knuckle to ball joint stud, clamp bolt and nut. Torque the clamp bolt to 100
Nm (75 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4871
5. Install tie rod end into the steering knuckle. Start tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut
onto stud of tie rod end. While holding stud of tie rod
end stationary, tighten tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut. Then using a crowfoot and
11/32 socket, torque tie rod end attaching nut to 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
6. Install braking disc back on hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4872
7. Install disc brake caliper assembly on steering knuckle. Caliper is installed by first sliding top of
caliper under top abutment on steering knuckle.
Then installing bottom of caliper against bottom abutment of steering knuckle.
8. Install caliper assembly to steering knuckle attaching bolts. Torque caliper assembly attaching
bolts to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.).
9. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the outer C/V joint stub axle. Install hub nut onto
threads of stub axle and tighten nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4873
10. With vehicle brakes applied to keep braking disc from turning, tighten hub nut to a torque of 183
Nm (135 ft. lbs.). 11. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install front wheel lug nuts and torque to
135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 12. Lower vehicle.
13. Install the spring washer, hub nut lock, and new cotter pin. Wrap cotter pin prongs tightly
around the hub nut lock. 14. Set front Toe on vehicle to required specification. Refer to Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in
Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Fluid: Customer Interest Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in
Cold Temperatures > Page 4883
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03
> Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03
> Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4889
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03
> Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4890
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03
> Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4891
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98
> Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Steering System - Noise in Cold
Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98
> Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures > Page 4896
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4902
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4903
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4904
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4905
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving parts. Do
not use automatic transmission fluid in the power steering system. Do not overfill the power
steering system.
Wipe reservoir filler cap free of dirt. Then check fluid level. The dipstick should indicate COLD
when fluid is at normal ambient temperature, approximately 21°C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F). In all pumps
add fluid as necessary, use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent. DO NOT USE
ANY TYPE OF AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4906
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
WARNING: Fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving parts. Do
not use automatic transmission fluid in the power steering system. Do not overfill the power
steering system.
Wipe reservoir filler cap free of dirt. Then check fluid level. The dipstick should indicate COLD
when fluid is at normal ambient temperature, approximately 21°C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F). In all pumps
add fluid as necessary, use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent. DO NOT USE
ANY TYPE OF AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jack stands or on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove hose clamp, attaching return hose to steel tube at power steering gear. Let power
steering fluid drain from return hose and power steering
fluid reservoir, until reservoir is empty.
3. Lower vehicle.
4. Remove the coolant overflow hose from the Coolant Recovery System (CRS) tank.
NOTE: Removal of the CRS tank improves access to the power steering fluid reservoir attaching
bolts.
5. Remove the nut and screw attaching the CRS tank to the dash panel. Remove the CRS tank
from the dash panel and lower it down on top of the
steering gear toward the center of the vehicle
CAUTION: Care must be used when removing and installing power steering fluid hoses on the
power steering fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to remove or install hoses on
nipples of power steering fluid reservoir, nipples can be broken off the reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4910
6. Remove the power steering fluid return and supply hose from the power steering fluid reservoir.
7. If vehicle is equipped with the single overhead cam engine, remove the 3 bolts attaching the
power steering fluid reservoir to the cylinder head.
8. If vehicle is equipped with the dual overhead cam engine, remove the 2 nuts attaching the power
steering fluid reservoir to the cylinder head. 9. Remove power steering fluid reservoir from vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering fluid reservoir on cylinder head. Install and securely tighten the power
steering fluid reservoir to cylinder head attaching
bolts.
2. Install the power steering fluid return and supply hose, on the power steering fluid reservoir
fittings. Be sure both hose clamps are installed on hose
past upset bead on power steering reservoir fittings.
3. Install engine coolant recovery system tank on dash panel of vehicle. Install and securely tighten
attaching bolts. 4. Install the coolant overflow hose from the CRS tank. 5. Raise vehicle. 6. Install
power steering return hose, on the steel tube at the power steering gear. Be sure hose clamp is
installed on hose past upset bead on power
steering gear steel tube.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4911
7. Fill power steering pump fluid reservoir to the proper level. 8. Start the engine and let run for a
few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 9. Add fluid if necessary. Repeat the above procedure until
the fluid level remains constant after running the engine.
10. Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 11. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering
wheel right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 12. Add power
steering fluid if necessary. 13. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to
lock. 14. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required. 15. If the fluid is extremely
foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Pressure and Return Line Tube Nuts
................................................................................................................................................... 31
Nm (275 inch lbs.) Pressure Hose Banjo Bolt .....................................................................................
.................................................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Routing Bracket ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
CAUTION: Care must be used when removing the power steering fluid supply hose from power
steering fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to remove hose from nipple on power
steering fluid reservoir, nipple can break off of the reservoir.
REMOVE
1. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering fluid supply hose to power steering fluid reservoir.
Then remove power steering fluid supply hose
from power steering fluid reservoir.
2. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering fluid supply hose to the power steering pump.
Then remove power steering fluid supply hose from
power steering pump fitting.
3. Remove power steering fluid supply hose from engine.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering fluid supply hose back on engine making sure it is correctly routed.
CAUTION: Care must be used when installing power steering fluid supply hose on power steering
fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to install hose on nipple of power steering fluid
reservoir, nipple can be broken off the reservoir.
2. Install power steering fluid supply hose on power steering fluid reservoir fitting. Install hose
clamp on power steering fluid supply hose at power
steering fluid reservoir. Be sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on power
steering fluid reservoir.
3. Install power steering fluid supply hose on power steering pump fitting. Install hose clamp on
power steering fluid supply hose at power steering
pump fitting. Be sure hose clamp is installed on power steering fluid supply hose past upset bead
on power steering pump fitting.
4. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 5. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 6. Raise
front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 7. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and
left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 8. Add power steering fluid if
necessary. 9. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4917
10. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required. 11. If the fluid is extremely foamy,
allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 12. After hose is
installed, check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4918
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Pressure Hose
Removal
CAUTION: Cap all open ends of hoses, power steering pump fittings and steering gear ports to
prevent entry of foreign material into the components.
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Remove bolt attaching power steering hose routing bracket to front suspension crossmember.
3. Disconnect power steering pressure hose at power steering gear. Drain power steering fluid from
power steering pump and hose through open end of
hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4919
4. Remove power steering pressure hose from routing clip on generator shield. 5. Lower vehicle.
6. Remove bolt, attaching power steering pressure hose routing clip, to generator shield.
7. Loosen and remove Banjo bolt, and power steering pressure hose from pressure fitting on power
steering pump. 8. Power steering fluid pressure hose is removed from the vehicle from the top of
the engine compartment. 9. Discard all used O-rings located at ends of power steering pressure
hose and Banjo bolt.
Installation
1. Install power steering pressure hose in vehicle from top of engine compartment. 2. Using a lint
free towel, wipe clean all open power steering hose ends, and the power steering pump and
steering gear ports.
3. Install new O-ring on end of power steering pressure hose banjo fitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4920
4. Install a new O-ring on power steering pressure hose banjo fitting bolt. 5. Lubricate both O-rings
using fresh clean power steering fluid. 6. Install banjo bolt into the power steering pressure hose
banjo fitting.
7. Attach power steering pressure hose to outlet fitting on power steering pump. Do not tighten or
torque pressure fitting Banjo bolt at this time.
8. Correctly route power steering pressure hose avoiding tight bends or kinking of the hose. Install
power steering pressure hose to generator shield
routing clip attaching screw but do not tighten at this time.
9. Raise vehicle.
CAUTION: Hoses must remain away from exhaust system, vehicle components and unfriendly
surfaces causing possible damage to power steering hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4921
10. Route power steering pressure hose to pressure port on power steering gear. Install power
steering pressure hose, on steering gear and loosely
install tube nut into steering gear. Tighten and torque tube nut after routing bracket is installed,
correctly positioning hoses in vehicle.
11. Install the power steering pressure and return hose routing clip on hoses. Install bolt attaching
routing clip to front suspension crossmember.
Torque routing clip to front suspension crossmember attaching bolt to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
12. Torque power steering pressure hose to steering gear tube nut to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
13. Install power steering pressure hose in routing clip on generator shield. 14. Lower Vehicle. 15.
Position locating pin on power steering pressure hose banjo fitting so it is against power steering
pump mounting bracket. While holding locating
pin against power steering pump bracket, torque pump end Banjo bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
16. Securely tighten bolt attaching power steering pressure hose bracket to generator shield. 17.
Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 18. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 19.
Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 20. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel
right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 21. Add power steering
fluid if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4922
22. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 23. Stop the engine.
Check the fluid level and refill as required. 24. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to
stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 25. After hose is installed, check for leaks at
all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4923
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Fluid Return Hose
CAUTION: Cap all open ends of hoses, power steering pump fittings and steering gear ports to
prevent entry of foreign material into the components.
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine parts and exhaust system may be extremely hot if engine
has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses. Do not allow hoses to
touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Remove hose clamp, attaching return hose to steel tube at power steering gear. Let power
steering fluid, drain from return hose and power steering
fluid reservoir, until reservoir is empty.
3. Remove power steering return hose from routing clip on generator shield. 4. Lower vehicle.
5. Remove tube clip at generator shield attaching power steering fluid return hose to power
steering fluid pressure hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Supply Hose From Reservoir to Pump > Page 4924
CAUTION: Care must be used when removing power steering fluid return hose from power
steering fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to remove hose from nipple on power
steering fluid reservoir, nipple can break off of the reservoir.
6. Remove hose clamp, attaching power steering return hose to power steering fluid reservoir.
Then remove power steering return hose from power
steering fluid reservoir
7. Remove the power steering return hose from the vehicle. The power steering return hose is
removed from the top of the engine compartment.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering return hose on vehicle. Power steering return hose is installed from the top
of the vehicles engine compartment.
CAUTION: Care must be used when installing power steering fluid return hose on power steering
fluid reservoir. If excessive force is used when trying to install hose on nipple of power steering fluid
reservoir, nipple can be broken off the reservoir.
2. Install power steering return hose on power steering fluid reservoir fitting. Install hose clamp on
power steering return hose at power steering fluid
reservoir. Be sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on power steering fluid
reservoir.
3. Raise vehicle. 4. Clip power steering return hose and pressure hose together. 5. Install power
steering return hose on steel tube at power steering gear. Install hose clamp on power steering
return hose at power steering gear. Be
sure hose clamp is installed on return hose past upset bead on steel tube at power gear.
6. Install power steering return hose on routing clip at generator shield. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Start
the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 9. Add fluid if necessary. Repeat
the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine.
10. Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 11. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering
wheel right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the engine off. 12. Add power
steering fluid if necessary. 13. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to
lock. 14. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required. 15. If the fluid is extremely
foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above procedure. 16. After hose is
installed, check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in
Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Pump: Customer Interest Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98 > Power Steering System - Noise in
Cold Temperatures > Page 4933
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of
Power Steering Assist
Power Steering Pump: Customer Interest Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97 > Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of
Power Steering Assist > Page 4938
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug >
03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug >
03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4944
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug >
03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4945
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug >
03 > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4946
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98
> Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Steering System - Noise in Cold
Temperatures
NO: 19-03-98
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Mar. 6, 1998
SUBJECT: Cold Start Power Steering Noise
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1998 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO 1999 LH VEHICLES BUILT THROUGH JULY 31, 1998 (MDH
0731XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Power steering system noise following cold engine starts in low ambient temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS:
The noise typically occurs in -12 C (10 F) or below ambient temperatures and lasts less than one
minute in duration. The noise occurs with and without steering wheel input and increases in
duration and intensity as the ambient temperature decreases below -12 C (10 F).
The power steering noise may remain present until the fluid begins to warm which occurs as the
fluid cycles through the power steering system with the engine running. The lower the ambient
temperature, the longer it will take for the fluid to warm.
If the power steering system demonstrates this symptom/condition and operates normally when the
fluid is warm, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
3 05010304AA Power Steering Fluid, Quart
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the original power steering fluid (MS-5931) with new power steering
fluid (MS-9933) which has improved cold temperature properties.
NOTE:
THE NEW POWER STEERING FLUID (MS-9933) WILL DECREASE THE TEMPERATURE AT
WHICH THE NOISE OCCURS AND REDUCE BOTH THE DURATION AND INTENSITY OF THE
NOISE. HOWEVER, THE POWER STEERING NOISE AT COLD ENGINE START MAY NOT BE
TOTALLY ELIMINATED ON ALL VEHICLES OR UNDER SEVERE COLD AMBIENT
TEMPERATURES.
1. With the engine at operating temperatures and not running, remove the power steering return
hose from the power steering cooler (Neon at the reservoir). Allow the power steering system to
drain.
2. Raise the front wheels off the ground.
3. Purge the fluid from the steering gear by slowly turning the steering wheel lock to lock several
times.
4. Reattach the power steering return hose to the power steering cooler (Neon to the reservoir).
5. Fill the power steering system to the max cold level with the new power steering fluid, p/n
05010304AA. Leave cap off.
6. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times. Top off fluid
level to max cold if necessary.
7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel lock to lock 3-4 times.
8. Shut off engine and repeat steps 1-5 to purge air from the power steering system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-03-98 > Mar > 98
> Power Steering System - Noise in Cold Temperatures > Page 4951
9. With the engine not running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary.
10. Start the engine. With the engine idling, maintain fluid level.
11. With The engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock at least 20 times. Top off
fluid level to max cold if necessary and reinstall the reservoir cap.
12. Return the steering wheel to center position. Lower front wheels to ground.
13. With engine running, slowly turn the steering wheel lock to lock to verify smooth, low noise
power assist operation and no system leaks. Recheck for proper fluid level.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8-New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97
> Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power
Steering Assist
NO: 07-04-97
GROUP: Accessory Belt
DATE: Jun. 6, 1997
SUBJECT: Momentary Loss Of Power Steering Assist When Driving Through Heavy Rain - Deep
Puddles
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Momentary loss of power steering assist when driving through heavy rain and/or deep puddles.
Loss of power steering is caused by water intrusion into the accessory drive belt area.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the belt for glazing and/or cracks, if either is found replace the belt following the repair
procedure found in the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) Page 7-21.
Determine the road conditions the driver of the vehicle was encountering at the time the loss of
power assist was experienced. If the driver indicates the loss of power steering assist was during
times of heavy rain or deep puddles, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 04612247 Belt, Accessory Drive - Power steering and A/C Compressor
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves correcting the tension on the power steering accessory drive belt.
1. Loosen the power steering pump locking bolts A and B and pivot bolt C (Illustration) to allow
adjustment of belt tension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 07-04-97 > Jun > 97
> Drive Belt - Momentary Loss of Power Steering Assist > Page 4956
2. Using a 1/2" breaker bar, adjust belt tension by applying torque to the square hole "D" on the
power steering pivot bracket. Adjust the tension as follows:
Belt tension with no belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 100 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
Belt tension with belt replacement:
A. Using the Belt Tension Gauge Special Tool Kit C-4162, adjust the belt tension to 135 lb.
B. Tighten in order, first tighten the locking bolt A to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs) then, bolt B to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs). Finally tighten the pivot bolt C to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs).
C. Start the engine and allow the vehicle to idle for 15 minutes to allow the belt to seat.
D. Repeat the belt tensioning procedure, set belt tension to 135 lb.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 07-20-11-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4962
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4963
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Pump: > 19-005-03 > Aug > 03 >
Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 4964
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Power Steering Pump: Mechanical Specifications
Bracket To Front Crossmember Attaching Bolts
...................................................................................................................................... 23 Nm (17 ft.
lbs.) Discharge Fitting ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................ 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.) To Bracket Mounting Bolts ........................
.............................................................................................................................................. 54 Nm
(40 ft. lbs.) Bracket To Engine Mounting .............................................................................................
...................................................................... 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 4967
Power Steering Pump: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Minimum Pressure At 1500 RPM
............................................................................................................................. 4.9 - 5.3
liters/minute (1.3 - 1.9 GPM) Control Valve Pressure Relief
......................................................................................................................................... 8240 - 8920
kPa (1195 - 1293 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4968
Power Steering Pump: Description and Operation
TTA Power Steering Pump
On all vehicles equipped with power steering, the hydraulic pressure for operation of the power
steering gear is provided by a belt driven power steering pump. The TTA power steering pump is a
constant flow rate and displacement, vane type pump.
In the event of a power steering pump drive belt failure, manual steering control of the vehicle can
still be maintained. However, under these conditions, steering effort will be significantly increased.
All vehicles equipped with power steering use a remote mounted reservoir for the power steering
fluid. The power steering fluid remote reservoir is mounted to the rear of the cylinder head on the
passenger side of the vehicle.
The service procedures for the TTA power steering pump are limited to the areas and components
listed below. No repair procedures are to be done on internal components of the TTA power
steering pumps.
- Repair of power steering fluid leaks from areas of the power steering pump sealed by O-rings is
allowed. However power steering pump shaft seal leakage will require replacement of the pump.
- Power steering fluid reservoirs, related components and attaching hardware.
- Power steering fluid reservoir filler cap/dipstick assemblies.
Because of unique shaft bearings, flow control levels or pump displacements, power steering
pumps may be used only on specific vehicle applications. Be sure that all power steering pumps
are only replaced with a pump that is the correct replacement for that specific application.
Hydraulic pressure is provided for operation of the power steering gear by the belt driven power
steering pump id. It is a constant displacement, vane type pump. The power steering pump is
connected to the steering gear by a power steering fluid pressure hose and return hose.
Rectangular pumping vanes in the shaft driven rotor, move power steering fluid from the intake to
the cam ring pressure cavities of the power steering pump. As the rotor begins to turn, centrifugal
force throws the vanes against the inside surface of the cam ring to pickup residual oil. This oil is
then forced into the high pressure area. As more oil is picked up by the vanes, the additional oil is
forced into the cavities of the thrust plate through two crossover holes in the cam ring and pressure
plate. The crossover holes empty into the high pressure area between the pressure plate and the
housing end cover.
As the high pressure area is filled, oil flows under the vanes in the rotor slots, forcing the vanes to
follow the inside surface of the cam ring. As the vanes reach the restricted area of the cam ring, oil
is forced out from between the vanes. When excess oil flow is generated during high-speed
operation, a regulated amount of oil returns to the pump intake side through a flow control valve.
The flow control valve reduces the power required to drive the pump and holds down temperature
build-up.
When steering conditions exceed maximum pressure requirements, such as when the wheels are
turned against the stops. The pressure built up in the steering gear exerts pressure on the spring
end of the flow control valve. The high pressure lifts the relief valve ball from its seat and allows oil
to flow through a trigger orifice located in the outlet fitting. This reduces pressure on the spring end
of the flow control valve which then opens and allows the oil to return to the intake side of the
pump. This action limits maximum pressure output of the pump to a safe level.
Under normal power steering pump operating conditions, pressure requirements of the pump are
below maximum, causing the pressure relief valve to remain closed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal
Replacement
NOTE: The power steering pump does not require removal from the engine for removal and
replacement of the flow control valve fitting O-Ring.
REMOVE
1. Remove the power steering fluid pressure hose from the power steering pump pressure fitting.
2. Remove the flow control valve fitting from the power steering pump housing. Prevent flow control
valve and spring from sliding out of housing
bore.
3. Remove and discard O-ring seal from fitting.
INSTALL
1. If necessary, clean and install flow control valve and spring in pump housing bore. 2. Install new
O-ring seal on fitting. 3. Install fitting in pump housing and tighten to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 4. Install
power steering fluid pressure hose on flow control valve fitting. 5. Position locating pin on power
steering pressure hose banjo fitting so it is against power steering pump mounting bracket. While
holding locating
pin against power steering pump bracket, torque banjo bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4971
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Initial Operation
CAUTION: The fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving
components. Use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid. Do not use automatic transmission fluid.
Do not overfill.
Wipe filler cap clean, then check the fluid level. The dipstick should indicate FULL COLD when the
fluid is at normal temperature of approximately 21° C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F).
1. Fill the pump fluid reservoir to the proper level and let the fluid settle for at least two (2) minutes.
2. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 3. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 4. Raise
the front wheels off the ground. 5. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and left,
lightly contacting the wheel stops. 6. Add power steering fluid if necessary. 7. Lower the vehicle
and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 8. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and
refill as required. 9. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and
repeat the above procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4972
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Mounting Bracket Replacement
DISASSEMBLE
1. Remove power steering pump from engine.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
2. Mount the power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket.
Mount Puller, Special Tool C-4333 or C-4068 on
power steering pump pulley. Remove the power steering pump pulley from the power steering
pump shaft.
3. Remove the 3 bolts attaching the power steering pump to the mounting bracket. 4. Remove
power steering pump from mounting bracket.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install power steering pump on mounting bracket. Install the 3 power steering pump mounting
bolts. Torque the 3 mounting bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft.
lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4973
2. Place power steering pump pulley squarely on end of power steering pump shaft. Mount
Installer, Special Tool C-4063 in internal threads of the
power steering pump shaft and against power steering pump pulley.
3. Ensuring that special tool and pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, force pulley onto power
steering pump shaft until flush with the end of the
shaft. When pulley is flush with shaft tool will no longer be able to be turned.
4. Remove Installer, Special Tool C-4063 from power steering pump. 5. Install power steering
pump and bracket assembly back on engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4974
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley Replacement
NOTE: The power steering pump must be removed from the vehicle for removal of the power
steering pump pulley.
REMOVE
1. Remove power steering pump from engine.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
2. Mount power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket. Install
Puller, Special Tool C-4333 or C-4068, or
equivalents on power steering pump pulley. Remove the power steering pump pulley from the
power steering pump shaft.
3. Replace power steering pump pulley if bent, cracked, or loose.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
INSTALL
1. Mount power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket. Then
place power steering pump pulley squarely on end of
power steering pump shaft. Mount Installer, Special Tool C-4063, or equivalent in internal threads
of the power steering pump shaft and against power steering pump pulley.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4975
2. Ensuring that special tool and pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, force pulley onto power
steering pump shaft until flush with the end of the
shaft. When pulley is flush with shaft tool will no longer be able to be turned.
3. Remove Installer, Special Tool C-4063, or equivalent from power steering pump. 4. Install power
steering pump and mounting bracket back on engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4976
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair
Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement
NOTE: The power steering pump does not require removal from the engine for removal and
replacement of the flow control valve fitting O-Ring.
REMOVE
1. Remove the power steering fluid pressure hose from the power steering pump pressure fitting.
2. Remove the flow control valve fitting from the power steering pump housing. Prevent flow control
valve and spring from sliding out of housing
bore.
3. Remove and discard O-ring seal from fitting.
INSTALL
1. If necessary, clean and install flow control valve and spring in pump housing bore. 2. Install new
O-ring seal on fitting. 3. Install fitting in pump housing and tighten to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 4. Install
power steering fluid pressure hose on flow control valve fitting. 5. Position locating pin on power
steering pressure hose banjo fitting so it is against power steering pump mounting bracket. While
holding locating
pin against power steering pump bracket, torque banjo bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
Power Steering Pump Initial Operation
CAUTION: The fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving
components. Use only Mopar (R) Power Steering Fluid. Do not use automatic transmission fluid.
Do not overfill.
Wipe filler cap clean, then check the fluid level. The dipstick should indicate FULL COLD when the
fluid is at normal temperature of approximately 21° C - 27°C (70°F - 80°F).
1. Fill the pump fluid reservoir to the proper level and let the fluid settle for at least two (2) minutes.
2. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 3. Add fluid if necessary.
Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the engine. 4. Raise
the front wheels off the ground. 5. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and left,
lightly contacting the wheel stops. 6. Add power steering fluid if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4977
7. Lower the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 8. Stop the engine. Check
the fluid level and refill as required. 9. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a
few minutes and repeat the above procedure.
Power Steering Pump Mounting Bracket Replacement
DISASSEMBLE
1. Remove power steering pump from engine.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
2. Mount the power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket.
Mount Puller, Special Tool C-4333 or C-4068 on
power steering pump pulley. Remove the power steering pump pulley from the power steering
pump shaft.
3. Remove the 3 bolts attaching the power steering pump to the mounting bracket. 4. Remove
power steering pump from mounting bracket.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install power steering pump on mounting bracket. Install the 3 power steering pump mounting
bolts. Torque the 3 mounting bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft.
lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4978
2. Place power steering pump pulley squarely on end of power steering pump shaft. Mount
Installer, Special Tool C-4063 in internal threads of the
power steering pump shaft and against power steering pump pulley.
3. Ensuring that special tool and pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, force pulley onto power
steering pump shaft until flush with the end of the
shaft. When pulley is flush with shaft tool will no longer be able to be turned.
4. Remove Installer, Special Tool C-4063 from power steering pump. 5. Install power steering
pump and bracket assembly back on engine.
Power Steering Pump Pulley Replacement
NOTE: The power steering pump must be removed from the vehicle for removal of the power
steering pump pulley.
REMOVE
1. Remove power steering pump from engine.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4979
2. Mount power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket. Install
Puller, Special Tool C-4333 or C-4068, or
equivalents on power steering pump pulley. Remove the power steering pump pulley from the
power steering pump shaft.
3. Replace power steering pump pulley if bent, cracked, or loose.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove power steering pump
pulley. This will damage the pulley and the power steering pump.
INSTALL
1. Mount power steering pump in a vise using the power steering pump mounting bracket. Then
place power steering pump pulley squarely on end of
power steering pump shaft. Mount Installer, Special Tool C-4063, or equivalent in internal threads
of the power steering pump shaft and against power steering pump pulley.
2. Ensuring that special tool and pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, force pulley onto power
steering pump shaft until flush with the end of the
shaft. When pulley is flush with shaft tool will no longer be able to be turned.
3. Remove Installer, Special Tool C-4063, or equivalent from power steering pump. 4. Install power
steering pump and mounting bracket back on engine.
Installation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4980
1. Install power steering pump and mounting bracket as an assembly back on the engine using
reverse of removal procedure.
2. Slide front power steering pump bracket between bracket mounting bolt and front engine mount.
Be sure washer on bolt is between the head of the
bolt and bracket and does not get trapped between bracket and engine mount.
3. Install the 2 power steering pump to cast mounting bracket attaching bolts. Do not tighten bolts
at this time. 4. Install power steering pump drive belt on power steering pump pulley.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4981
5. Install a 1/2 inch breaker bar in the square hole in the front power steering pump mounting
bracket. Then rotate pump in to obtain the correct drive
belt tension. When correct drive belt tension is obtained torque the 2 bolts at the power steering
pump cast mounting bracket to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) . Then torque the front power steering pump
mounting bracket bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
6. Install power steering supply hose on power steering pump suction fitting. Install hose clamp on
hose, being sure hose clamp is installed on hose
past upset bead on power steering pump tube.
7. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean all open power steering hose ends, and power steering pump
fittings.
8. Install a new O-ring on the end of the power steering pressure hose banjo fitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4982
9. Install a new O-ring on power steering fluid pressure hose banjo fitting bolt.
10. Lubricate both O-rings using fresh clean power steering fluid. 11. Install banjo bolt into the
power steering pressure hose banjo fitting.
12. Attach power steering pressure hose on outlet fitting of the power steering pump. 13. Position
locating pin on power steering pressure hose banjo fitting so it is against power steering pump
mounting bracket. While holding locating
pin against power steering pump bracket, torque pump end Banjo bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
14. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 15. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 16. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 17. Add
fluid if necessary. Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running
the engine. 18. Raise front wheels of vehicle off the ground. 19. Start engine, then slowly turn
steering wheel right and left several times until lightly contacting the wheel stops. Then turn the
engine off. 20. Add power steering fluid if necessary. 21. Lower the vehicle. Start engine again and
turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 22. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill
as required 23. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat
the above procedure. 24. After power steering pump is installed, check for leaks at all hose
connections and power steering pump fittings.
Removal
WARNING: Power steering oil, engine components and exhaust system may be extremely hot if
engine has been running. Do not start engine with any loose or disconnected hoses, or allow hoses
to touch hot exhaust manifold or catalyst.
The power steering pump removal procedure and pump and bracket fastener locations are the
same for both engine applications used for this vehicle. The front power steering pump bracket
must be removed as an assembly with the power steering pump and removed from the pump after
removing the pulley from the power steering pump.
1. Remove battery cable from (-) negative post on battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4983
2. Remove Banjo Bolt and power steering fluid pressure hose from pressure fitting on power
steering pump. 3. Discard all used O-rings on the power steering pressure hose Banjo fitting and
Banjo bolt.
4. Remove hose clamp attaching power steering fluid supply hose to the power steering pump
suction fitting. Remove power steering fluid supply
hose from power steering pump fitting.
5. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with a dual overhead cam engine, the bolt attaching the coolant
tube to the intake manifold needs to be removed. Refer to following step for required procedure.
6. Remove the bolt attaching the coolant tube to the bottom of the intake manifold. The bolt
requires removal to allow the coolant tube to be moved
out of the way for access to the power steering pump mounting bolt. The coolant tube does not
need to be removed or the cooling system drained.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4984
7. Remove the 2 power steering pump to cast bracket mounting and adjustment bolts.
NOTE: The power steering pump front mounting bracket is slotted at the bolt attaching it to the
front engine mount. This bolt only needs to be loosened to remove mounting bracket from engine.
8. Loosen bolt attaching the power steering pump front mounting to the front engine mount only far
enough to slide the bracket out from under the
bolt.
9. Remove power steering pump drive belt from power steering pump pulley.
10. Remove power steering pump and front mounting bracket as an assembly from the engine. 11.
Transfer required parts from removed power steering pump to replacement power steering pump.
Suction Port Seal Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump Flow Control Valve Seal Replacement > Page 4985
NOTE: The power steering pump does not require removal from the engine for removal and
replacement of the suction port O-Ring seal.
REMOVE
1. Remove power steering fluid supply hose from power steering pump suction port fitting. 2.
Remove bolt attaching power steering pump suction port fitting to the power steering pump. 3.
Remove the suction port fitting from the power steering pump. 4. Remove and discard O-ring seal
from suction port fitting.
INSTALL
1. Install new O-ring seal on suction fitting. 2. Install suction port fitting in power steering pump.
Install and securely tighten the suction port fitting attaching bolt. 3. Install power steering fluid
supply hose on suction port fitting, being sure hose clamp is installed on hose past upset bead on
suction port fitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Electrical Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4991
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
The power steering pressure switch is a normally closed switch.
The power steering pressure switch opens when pressure exceeds 500 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4992
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4993
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 15 Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
On vehicles equipped with power steering, a power steering pressure switch is used to improve the
vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch improves vehicle idle quality, by controlling engine idle
speed when required.
The switch (Fig. 15) provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine
RPM; such as during parking maneuvers.
OPERATION
The pressure switch functions by signaling the power train control module, that the power steering
system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when turning the front
tires of the vehicle, when the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When this
condition is sensed by the power train control module, through a signal from the power steering
pressure switch, engine idle speed is increased. This increase in engine idle speed compensates
for the additional load, thus maintaining the require engine idle speed and idle quality.
When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2,758 kPa (400 psi), the switch is open. The PCM
increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine stalling.
When pump pressure is low, the switch is closed.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear on vehicles
requiring its usage.
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power steering pressure switch opens and closes circuit K10 between the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) and ground. Circuit K10 connects to cavity 45 of the PCM connector.
Circuit Z12 provides ground for the power steering pressure switch. The grounding point for circuit
Z12 is the left side of the radiator closure panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4994
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, the use of a 7/8 inch
deep well socket is required. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic, electrical
connector area, of the power steering pressure switch.
REMOVE
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Locate power steering pressure switch on back
side of power steering gear. 4. Remove vehicle wiring harness connector, from power steering
pressure switch. 5. Remove power steering pressure switch, from power steering gear.
CAUTION: When tightening the power steering pressure switch after installation in steering gear,
do not exceed the torque specification shown in step 1 below. Over-tightening may result in
stripping the threads out of the pressure switch port on the steering gear.
INSTALL
1. Install power steering pressure switch into power steering gear by hand until fully seated. Then
torque power steering pressure switch to 8 Nm (70
inch lbs.).
2. Install vehicle wiring harness connector onto power steering pressure switch. Be sure latch on
wiring harness connector is fully engaged with
locking tab on power steering pressure switch.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid in power steering system. Only use Mopar (R),
Power Steering Fluid, or equivalent.
3. Fill power steering reservoir to correct fluid level. 4. Connect negative cable back on negative
post of battery. 5. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop to stop to bleed air
from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 5000
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Column Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Instrument Panel Assembly
1. Remove the three attachment screws along the bottom of the cover and screw on the left
outward face of cover. 2. Grasp the cover and pull rearward until the clips disengage.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Gear: > 19-04-96A > Jan > 97 > Steering Gear - Whistle/Hiss On Right
Turns
Steering Gear: Customer Interest Steering Gear - Whistle/Hiss On Right Turns
NO: 19-04-96 Rev. A
GROUP: Steering
EFFECTIVE DATE: Jan. 10, 1997
SUBJECT: Steering Noise When Turning Right
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-04-96, DATED AUGUST 9,
1996 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE NEON HAS BEEN ADDED. ALL
CHANGES TO THE PROCEDURE ARE MARKED WITH **ASTERISKS**
MODELS:
1995 - 1996 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus **1995 - 1997 (PL/1) Neon**
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH STANDARD STEERING, SALES
CODE SBA.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Whistle and/or hiss noise from steering gear when making right turns.
DIAGNOSIS:
To verify noise, heat the power steering fluid to 155-165° F by holding engine speed at 2000-3000
rpm. Turn the steering wheel to the left and hit the stop ten times. Turn the wheel to the right and
hit the stop ten times. Repeat this for a total of three times.
Return the steering wheel to the center position and let the engine idle. Very slowly, turn the wheel
to the right. Periodically stop and move the wheel back very slowly. Listen for a high pitched
"whistle". If a "whistle" exists it can be maintained by holding the wheel at that position.
Return the wheel to the center position. Turn the wheel to the right at a speed of approximately 12
rpm. Listen for a constant "hiss" noise.
If either of these noises exists during right hand turns, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04886335AA Gear Assembly, Power Steering (Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus)
**1 04897187AA Gear Assembly, Power Steering (Neon)**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the power steering gear with a revised part.
Remove and replace the power steering gear as described on page 19-36 of the 1996
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-6121). **For Neon refer to the 1997
Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) beginning on page 19-29.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-93 2.7 Hrs.
1995-1996 (Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus)
19-00-02-93 1.8 Hrs.
1995-1997 (Neon)
FAILURE CODE: 68 - Noisy
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Gear: > 19-04-96A > Jan > 97 > Steering Gear - Whistle/Hiss
On Right Turns
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering Gear - Whistle/Hiss On Right Turns
NO: 19-04-96 Rev. A
GROUP: Steering
EFFECTIVE DATE: Jan. 10, 1997
SUBJECT: Steering Noise When Turning Right
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 19-04-96, DATED AUGUST 9,
1996 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE NEON HAS BEEN ADDED. ALL
CHANGES TO THE PROCEDURE ARE MARKED WITH **ASTERISKS**
MODELS:
1995 - 1996 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus **1995 - 1997 (PL/1) Neon**
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH STANDARD STEERING, SALES
CODE SBA.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Whistle and/or hiss noise from steering gear when making right turns.
DIAGNOSIS:
To verify noise, heat the power steering fluid to 155-165° F by holding engine speed at 2000-3000
rpm. Turn the steering wheel to the left and hit the stop ten times. Turn the wheel to the right and
hit the stop ten times. Repeat this for a total of three times.
Return the steering wheel to the center position and let the engine idle. Very slowly, turn the wheel
to the right. Periodically stop and move the wheel back very slowly. Listen for a high pitched
"whistle". If a "whistle" exists it can be maintained by holding the wheel at that position.
Return the wheel to the center position. Turn the wheel to the right at a speed of approximately 12
rpm. Listen for a constant "hiss" noise.
If either of these noises exists during right hand turns, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04886335AA Gear Assembly, Power Steering (Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus)
**1 04897187AA Gear Assembly, Power Steering (Neon)**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the power steering gear with a revised part.
Remove and replace the power steering gear as described on page 19-36 of the 1996
Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-6121). **For Neon refer to the 1997
Neon Service Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) beginning on page 19-29.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-00-02-93 2.7 Hrs.
1995-1996 (Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus)
19-00-02-93 1.8 Hrs.
1995-1997 (Neon)
FAILURE CODE: 68 - Noisy
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5017
Steering Gear: Specifications
Attaching Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5018
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5019
Steering Gear: Service Precautions
NOTE: The power steering gear should NOT be serviced or adjusted. If a malfunction or oil leak
occurs with the steering gear, the complete steering gear needs to be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5020
Steering Gear: Description and Operation
The power steering system consists of these four major components. Power Steering Gear, Power
Steering Pump, Pressure Hose, and Return Line. Turning of the steering wheel is converted into
linear travel through the meshing of the helical pinion teeth with the rack teeth. Power assist
steering is provided by an open center, rotary type control valve which directs oil from the pump to
either side of the integral rack piston.
Road feel is controlled by the diameter of a torsion bar which initially steers the vehicle. This
movement directs oil behind the integral rack piston, which, in turn, builds up hydraulic pressure
and assists in the turning effort.
The drive tangs on the pinion of the power steering pump mate loosely with a stub shaft. This is to
permit manual steering control to be maintained if the drive belt on the power steering pump should
break. However, under these conditions, steering effort will be increased.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5021
Steering Gear: Testing and Inspection
GENERAL INFORMATION
The following procedure can be used to test the operation of the power steering system on the
vehicle. This test will provide the flow rate of the power steering pump along with the maximum
relief pressure. This test is to be performed any time a power steering system problem is present to
determine if the power steering pump or power steering gear is not functioning properly. The
following pressure and flow test is performed using Pressure/Flow Tester, Special Tool 6815, or
equivalent.
TEST PROCEDURE
1. Check power steering pump drive belt tension and adjust as necessary. 2. Disconnect power
steering fluid pressure hose, at power steering pump. Use a container for dripping fluid. 3. Connect
Pressure Gauge, Special Tool from kit 6815, or equivalent to both hoses using adapter fittings.
Connect spare pressure hose, to power
steering pump pressure hose banjo fitting.
4. Completely open valve on Special Tool 6815, or equivalent. 5. Start engine and let idle long
enough to circulate power steering fluid through flow/pressure test and get air out of fluid. Then
shut off engine. 6. Check power steering fluid level, and add fluid as necessary. Start engine again
and let idle. 7. Pressure gauge should read below 862 kPa (125 psi), if above, inspect the hoses for
restrictions and repair as necessary. The initial pressure
reading should be in the range of 345 - 552 kPa (50 - 80 psi). The flow meter should read between
1.3 - 1.4 GPM.
CAUTION: The following test procedure involves testing power steering pump maximum pressure
output and flow control valve operation. Do not leave valve closed for more than 5 seconds as the
pump could be damaged.
8. Close valve fully three times and record highest pressure indicated each time. All three readings
must be above specifications and within 345 kPa
(50 psi) of each other.
NOTE: Power steering pump maximum relief pressure is 8240 to 8920 kPa (1195 to 1293 psi). If power steering pump pressures above specifications but not within 345 kPa (50 psi) of each
other, then replace power steering pump.
- If pressures within 345 kPa (50 psi) of each other but below specifications, then replace power
steering pump.
CAUTION: Do not force the pump to operate against the stops for more than 5 seconds at a time
because, pump damage will result.
9. Open test valve. Turn steering wheel to the extreme left and right positions until against the
stops, recording the highest indicated pressure at each
position. Compare pressure gauge readings to power steering pump specifications. If highest
output pressures are not the same against either stop, the steering gear is leaking internally and
must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Removal
1. From interior of vehicle, disconnect the steering gear coupler, from the steering column shaft
coupler. 2. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 3. Remove both
front wheel and tire assemblies from the vehicle.
4. Remove engine/transaxle bobble dampener, on vehicles so equipped, from front suspension
crossmember. Bobble strut does not need to be
removed from transaxle assembly.
5. Remove nuts attaching both outer tie rod ends to the steering knuckles. Nuts are to be removed
from tie rod ends using the following procedure,
hold tie rod end stud with an 11/32 socket, while loosening and removing nut with wrench.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5024
Tie Rod End Removal From Steering Knuckle
6. Remove both tie rod end studs, from the steering knuckles, using Remover, Special Tool
MB-990635, or equivalent.
7. If equipped, remove vehicle wiring harness connector from the power steering fluid pressure
switch.
8. If vehicle is equipped with power steering, remove power steering pressure and return hose
routing bracket from front suspension crossmember.
The hose routing bracket does not have to be removed from the power steering pressure and
return hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5025
9. If vehicle is equipped with power steering, remove power steering fluid, pressure and return
hoses from the power steering gear assembly.
NOTE: This vehicle is designed and assembled using NET BUILD front suspension alignment
settings. This means that front suspension alignment settings are determined as the vehicle is
designed by the location of front suspension components in relation to the vehicle body. This
process is carried out when building the vehicle, by accurately locating the front suspension
crossmember, to master gage holes located in the underbody of the vehicle. With this method of
designing and building a vehicle, it is no longer possible to adjust a vehicles front suspension
alignment settings to the required specifications. Due to this, whenever the front suspension
crossmember is removed from a vehicle, it MUST be replaced in the same location on the body of
the vehicle it was removed from. Front suspension Toe settings though are still adjustable by the
outer tie rod ends.
CAUTION: Before removing front suspension crossmember from the vehicle, the location of the
front suspension crossmember MUST be scribed on body of vehicle per. This must be done so
crossmember can be relocated against body of vehicle in the same location when it is reinstalled. If
location of front suspension crossmember to body of vehicle is not maintained when vehicle is
assembled, NET BUILD front suspension alignment settings will not be obtained. This may lead to
handling and or tire wear problems.
10. Using an awl, scribe a line marking the location of where front suspension crossmember is
mounted against the body of the vehicle.
11. Position a transmission jack under the center of the front suspension crossmember.
Transmission jack is used to lower, support and raise front
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5026
suspension crossmember when removing steering gear assembly.
12. Loosen and fully remove the front 2 bolts attaching front suspension crossmember to frame
rails of vehicle. Then loosen the 2 rear bolts attaching
front suspension crossmember and lower control arm to body of vehicle. Lower front suspension
crossmember while loosening rear bolts, but do not remove rear bolts from crossmember.
13. Using transmission jack, lower front suspension crossmember enough to allow steering gear to
be removed from crossmember. When lowering
front suspension crossmember, do not let crossmember hang from lower control arms weight of
crossmember should be supported by transmission jack.
14. Loosen and remove the 4 bolts, attaching steering assembly to front suspension crossmember.
Then remove the steering gear assembly from the
front suspension crossmember.
15. Transfer required parts from removed steering gear assembly to the replacement steering gear,
new steering gear is being installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5027
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Installation
1. Install steering gear assembly on front suspension crossmember. Install the 4 steering gear
assembly to front crossmember mounting bolts. Torque
the 4 steering gear mounting bolts to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.).
2. Using the transmission jack, raise front suspension crossmember and steering gear against
body and frame rails of vehicle. Start the 2 rear bolts
into tapping plates, attaching front suspension crossmember to body of vehicle. Then install the 2
front bolts, attaching front suspension crossmember to frame rails of vehicle Tighten the 4
mounting bolts, until front suspension crossmember is against body of vehicle at the 4 mounting
points. Then torque the 4 mounting bolts to 2 Nm (20 inch lbs.) to hold front suspension
crossmember in position.
CAUTION: When front suspension crossmember is installed back in vehicle, crossmember MUST
be aligned with positioning marks previously scribed into body of vehicle. This MUST be done to
maintain NET BUILD front suspension alignment settings.
3. Using a soft face hammer, tap front suspension crossmember into position, until it is aligned with
the 2 previously scribed positioning marks on
body of vehicle. When front suspension crossmember is correctly positioned, torque the 2 rear
crossmember/lower control arm mounting bolts to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.). Then torque the 2 front
crossmember to frame rail attaching bolts to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5028
4. If vehicle is equipped with power steering, install power steering fluid pressure and return hoses
into correct fluid ports on power steering gear
assembly. Torque power steering fluid pressure and return lines to steering gear tube nuts to 31
Nm (275 inch lbs.).
5. If vehicle is equipped with power steering, install power steering pressure and return hose
routing bracket and attaching screw on front suspension
crossmember. Torque hose routing bracket to crossmember attaching bolt to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
6. If the vehicle is equipped with power steering, install vehicle wiring harness connector onto
power steering fluid pressure switch on steering gear
assembly. Be sure locking tab on wiring harness connector is securely latched to pressure switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5029
7. Install tie rod end into the steering knuckle. Start tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut
onto stud of tie rod end. While holding stud of tie
rod end stationary, tighten tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut. Then using a crowfoot and
11/32 socket, torque tie rod end attaching nut to 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
8. Install engine/transaxle bobble strut back on front suspension crossmember bracket. Install and
securely tighten the dampener to crossmember
attaching bolt.
9. Install the wheel and tire assemblies back on vehicle. Tighten the wheel nuts to 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.) torque.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5030
11. From interior of vehicle, reconnect the steering gear coupler with the steering column shaft
coupler. Install steering gear coupler retaining pinch
bolt and torque to 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.). Be sure to install the upper to lower steering couplet
retaining bolt, retention pin.
CAUTION: Do not use automatic transmission fluid.
12. Fill power steering pump fluid reservoir to the (Full-Cold) proper level. 13. Start the engine and
let run for a few seconds. Then turn the engine off. 14. Add fluid if necessary. 15. Raise front
wheels of vehicle off the ground. 16. Start engine and turn steering wheel several times from stop
to stop to bleed air from fluid in system. Stop engine, check fluid level, and inspect
system for leaks. Fill pump reservoir to correct level with Mopar (R), Power Steering Fluid, or
equivalent.
17. Lower front wheels of vehicle back on the ground.
CAUTION: During this procedure do not allow the steering gear inner tie rod boots to become
twisted.
18. Adjust the front Toe setting on the vehicle. Refer to Alignment.
Outer Tie Rod End Jam Nut
19. Tighten tie rod jam nut to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) torque. 20. Adjust steering gear to tie rod boots at
tie rods.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Steering Shaft Coupler: Description and Operation
This vehicle uses a differently designed coupling for connecting the steering column to the steering
gear.
This coupling is different in its appearance and in the way it functions than the previous coupling
used on this vehicle and couplings used on other Chrysler vehicles. This coupling functions by
bending at the bellows section of the coupling on impact, where as the previous coupling separated
at its detachable joint on an impact.
This coupling incorporates a hollow convoluted tube which allows the coupling to bend as required
when a vehicle is involved in a collision. The previous coupling used on this vehicle incorporated 2
release washers which allowed the coupling to separate into 2 pieces, if necessary, when a vehicle
was involved in a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 5034
Steering Shaft Coupler: Testing and Inspection
GENERAL INFORMATION
The steering column coupling MUST be inspected whenever a vehicle is involved in an impact or
whenever any of the following conditions exist. 1. The steering column coupling must be inspected
whenever a vehicle is involved in a collision which deploys the air bag, regardless of the
extent of damage done to the vehicle.
2. If a vehicle is involved in an impact of the vehicles front suspension or under carriage, which
results in any type of damage to the front
suspension crossmember.
3. Under any conditions which result in the steering column assembly or steering column shaft
receiving a force great enough to move the
steering column or shaft forward or rearward in a vehicle.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1. Remove the pinch bolt safety pin from the steering column shaft coupling pinch bolt. 2. Loosen
the coupling pinch bolt retaining nut and remove pinch bolt from steering coupler. (Pinch bolt nut is
caged to coupler and is not
removable.) Then separate the steering column shaft coupling from the steering column to steering
gear coupling.
3. Remove the silencer seal enclosing the steering column coupling.
4. Inspect steering column coupling in the following areas for signs of damage:
- Inspect the sealing collar on the steering column coupling to ensure the it is not cracked, broken,
or otherwise damaged requiring coupling replacement.
- Inspect the convoluted section of the steering column coupling for the following conditions or any
other visible signs of damage. Uneven spacing between the convolutes on the coupling.
- Dings or dents in the convolutes of the coupling or anywhere else on the coupling wall.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 5035
- A bend in the convoluted section of the coupling.
NOTES: If any of the preceding conditions exist the steering coupling MUST be replaced.
- The steering gear must be removed from the vehicle to allow access for replacement of the
steering coupling.
5. If steering coupling does not require replacement, install steering column coupling silencer seal
back on vehicle. 6. Ensure front wheels of vehicle are positioned straight-ahead and then align and
attach steering column to steering coupling. Install the coupling
pinch bolt. Tighten the pinch bolt nut to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.). Be sure to install upper to
lower steering coupling pinch bolt safety pin.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 19-02-99A > Oct > 99 > Steering Wheel/Steering Column Clunking Or Rattle
Technical Service Bulletin # 19-02-99A Date: 991022
Steering Wheel/Steering Column - Clunking Or Rattle
NUMBER: 19-02-99 Rev. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Oct. 22, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS 19-01-98 DATED
FEBRUARY 6, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE
1998 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-99003) AND
19-02-99 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISION ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS
CHANGES.
SUBJECT: Clunking Or Rattle In Steering Wheel/Steering Column
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves resetting the steering column preload.
MODELS: 1995 - **2000**
(JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Steering wheel/column clunking or rattle is more frequent while hitting
bumps or on hard turns.
DIAGNOSIS: Inspect steering wheel/column for any rattle or clunking noise. If symptoms exist
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05015627AA Bolt, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, PL
1 **06506112AA Bolt, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, JA/JX**
1 **06036212AA Clip, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, JA/JX**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-20-12-96 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
NOTE:
THE VEHICLE WHEELS NEED TO BE ON THE GROUND (SUPPORTING VEHICLE WEIGHT)
WHEN PERFORMING THIS REPAIR.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with a tilt steering column, adjust to the full up position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 19-02-99A > Oct > 99 > Steering Wheel/Steering Column Clunking Or Rattle > Page 5044
3. Detach the lower steering column intermediate shaft from the steering gear shaft (Figure 1). This
allows the steering column preload to reset.
4. Re-attach the intermediate shaft to the steering gear using a new pinch bolt from the Parts
Required section of this bulletin. Tighten the bolt to 27 N.m (240 in. lbs.).
5. Install the retaining clip/pin into the pinch bolt (Figure 1).
NOTE:
A NEW STEERING GEAR COUPLING PINCH BOLT MUST BE USED WHEN RE-ATTACHING
THE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT TO THE STEERING GEAR. THIS BOLT HAS A LOCKING PATCH
THAT IS DESTROYED WHEN THE NUT IS REMOVED.
6. Connect the battery negative cable and reset the clock.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 19-02-99A > Oct > 99 > Steering Wheel/Steering
Column - Clunking Or Rattle
Technical Service Bulletin # 19-02-99A Date: 991022
Steering Wheel/Steering Column - Clunking Or Rattle
NUMBER: 19-02-99 Rev. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Oct. 22, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS 19-01-98 DATED
FEBRUARY 6, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE
1998 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-99003) AND
19-02-99 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISION ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS
CHANGES.
SUBJECT: Clunking Or Rattle In Steering Wheel/Steering Column
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves resetting the steering column preload.
MODELS: 1995 - **2000**
(JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Steering wheel/column clunking or rattle is more frequent while hitting
bumps or on hard turns.
DIAGNOSIS: Inspect steering wheel/column for any rattle or clunking noise. If symptoms exist
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05015627AA Bolt, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, PL
1 **06506112AA Bolt, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, JA/JX**
1 **06036212AA Clip, Steering Gear Coupler Retaining, JA/JX**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 19-20-12-96 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
NOTE:
THE VEHICLE WHEELS NEED TO BE ON THE GROUND (SUPPORTING VEHICLE WEIGHT)
WHEN PERFORMING THIS REPAIR.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with a tilt steering column, adjust to the full up position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 19-02-99A > Oct > 99 > Steering Wheel/Steering
Column - Clunking Or Rattle > Page 5050
3. Detach the lower steering column intermediate shaft from the steering gear shaft (Figure 1). This
allows the steering column preload to reset.
4. Re-attach the intermediate shaft to the steering gear using a new pinch bolt from the Parts
Required section of this bulletin. Tighten the bolt to 27 N.m (240 in. lbs.).
5. Install the retaining clip/pin into the pinch bolt (Figure 1).
NOTE:
A NEW STEERING GEAR COUPLING PINCH BOLT MUST BE USED WHEN RE-ATTACHING
THE INTERMEDIATE SHAFT TO THE STEERING GEAR. THIS BOLT HAS A LOCKING PATCH
THAT IS DESTROYED WHEN THE NUT IS REMOVED.
6. Connect the battery negative cable and reset the clock.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5051
Steering Wheel: Specifications
Retaining Nut .......................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications
Tie Rod End: Specifications
To Steering Knuckle Nut ......................................................................................................................
.................................................... 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) Jam Nut .............................................................
........................................................................................................................................ 61 Nm (45 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5056
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Loosen the inner tie rod to outer tie rod jam nut.
2. Remove the nut attaching the outer tie rod end to steering knuckle. Nut is to be removed from tie
rod end using the following procedure, hold tie
rod end stud with a 11/32 socket while loosening and removing nut with wrench.
3. Remove the tie rod end stud from steering knuckle arm, using Remover, Special Tool
MB-990635, or equivalent. 4. Remove the outer tie rod end from the inner tie rod by unthreading it
from the inner tie rod.
INSTALLATION
1. Install outer tie rod onto inner tie rod. Make sure jam nut is on inner tie rod. 2. Do not tighten jam
nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5057
3. Install the tie rod end into the steering knuckle. Start tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut
onto stud of tie rod end. While holding stud of tie
rod end stationary, tighten tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut. Then using a crowfoot and
11/32 socket, torque the tie rod end attaching nut to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: During this procedure do not allow the steering gear boot to become twisted.
4. Adjust the front Toe setting on the vehicle. Refer to Alignment. 5. Torque the tie rod jam nut to a
torque of 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Adjust the steering gear to inner tie rod boots at inner tie rod
if they became twisted during Toe adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Nut/Bolt ................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5062
Ball Joint: Description and Operation
The ball joint is pressed into the lower control arm and has a non-tapered stud with a notch for
steering knuckle clamp bolt clearance. The ball joint stud is clamped and locked into the steering
knuckle leg using a pinch bolt. The ball joint used on this vehicle is replaceable and if found
defective can be serviced as a separate component of the lower control arm assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5063
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 9 Ball Joint Wear Inspection
With the weight of the vehicle resting on the road wheels. Grasp the grease fitting as shown and
with no mechanical assistance or added force attempt to move the grease fitting.
If the ball joint is worn the grease fitting will move easily. If movement is noted, replacement of the
ball joint is recommended.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5064
Ball Joint: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Using a screw driver or other suitable tool, pry seal boot off of ball joint assembly.
2. Position Receiving Cup, Special Tool 6758, or equivalent to support lower control arm while
receiving ball joint assembly. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6804, or equivalent in top of ball joint assembly.
3. Using arbor press, press ball joint assembly completely out of lower control arm.
CAUTION: When installing ball joint in its mounting hole in lower control arm, position ball joint so
notch in ball joint stud is facing the front lower control arm bushing. This will ease assembly of ball
joint to steering knuckle when attempting to install pinch bolt.
INSTALLATION
1. By hand, position ball joint assembly into ball joint bore of lower control arm. Be sure ball joint
assembly is not cocked in the bore of the control
arm, this will cause binding of the ball joint assembly, when being pressed into lower control arm.
2. Position assembly in an arbor press with Receiving Cup, Special Tool 6758, or equivalent
supporting lower control arm. Then install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6804, or equivalent on the bottom of the ball joint assembly.
3. Carefully align all pieces. Using the arbor press apply pressure against ball joint assembly, until
ball joint is fully seated against bottom surface of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5065
lower control arm. Do not apply excessive pressure against ball joint and lower control arm.
4. Install a NEW ball joint assembly sealing boot on ball joint assembly. Install sealing boot as far
as possible on ball joint assembly.
CAUTION: Do not use an arbor press to install the sealing boot on the lower control arm ball joint
assembly. Damage to the sealing boot can occur do to excessive pressure applied to sealing boot
when being installed.
5. Position Receiving Cup, Special Tool 6758, or equivalent over sealing boot so it is aligned
properly with bottom edge of sealing boot. Apply
pressure BY HAND to special tool 6758, or equivalent until sealing boot is pressed squarely
against top surface of lower control arm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Control Arm Bushing: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 5075
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 5076
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
Control Arm Bushing: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration
NUMBER: 02-09-99
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: July 2, 1999
SUBJECT: Smooth Road Steering Wheel Vibration
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting and correcting front suspension components and
replacing the front suspension lower control arm rear bushing as needed.
MODELS:
1995-1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A smooth road steering wheel back and forth oscillation/vibration may be observed when driving at
around 72 MPH.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 5082
Test drive the vehicle on a smooth road with all accessories turned off to determine the speed and
magnitude of the vibration/shake condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Arm Bushing: > 02-09-99 > Jul > 99 >
Steering/Suspension - Smooth Road Vibration > Page 5083
2 05016581AA Bushing, Front Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace the front lower control arm rear isolator bushing following the procedure in
the appropriate Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
2. Set the wheel alignment using the procedures and the specifications found in the appropriate
Neon Service Manual, Section 2, Suspension.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-10-06-90 2.9 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lower Control Arm Front Isolator Bushing
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair Lower Control Arm Front Isolator Bushing
NOTE: To perform the removal and replacement of the lower control arm front isolator bushing, the
lower control arm must be removed from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the lower control arm assembly from the vehicle.
2. Mount Remover/Installer, Special Tool C-4212-F, or equivalent in a vise. Install Bushing
Remover, Special Tool 6804 and Bushing Receiver,
Special Tool 6758 on Special Tool C-4212-F, or equivalents.
3. Install lower control arm on Special Tools assembled for removal of the front isolator bushing as
shown. Be sure Special Tool 6758 is square on
lower control arm and Special Tool 6804 is positioned correctly on isolator bushing.
4. Tighten screw on Remover/Installer Special Tool C-4212-F, or equivalent to press front bushing
out of lower control arm.
INSTALLATION
1. Mount Installer Cup, Special Tool C-4212-F on Remover/Installer, Special Tool C-4212-F, or
equivalents. Then mount Bushing Installer; Special
Tool 6810 on screw portion of Remover/Installer Special Tool C-4212-F, or equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lower Control Arm Front Isolator Bushing > Page 5086
2. Start front bushing into lower control arm by hand, making sure it is square with its mounting
hole in the lower control arm. Bushing is to he
installed in lower control arm from the machined surface side of lower control arm bushing hole.
3. Install lower control arm as shown on Special Tools assembled for installing front isolator
bushing into lower control arm. Be sure Special Tool
C-4212-F, or equivalent is square on lower control arm and Special Tool 6810 is positioned
correctly on isolator bushing.
4. Tighten screw on Remover/Installer Special Tool C-4212-F, or equivalent pressing front bushing
into lower control arm. Continue pressing front
hushing into lower control arm until special tool 6810 is sitting flush on the machined surface of the
lower control arm. This will correctly position front hushing in lower control arm.
5. Install the lower control arm assembly back on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lower Control Arm Front Isolator Bushing > Page 5087
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair Lower Control Arm Rear Isolator Bushing
NOTE: Removal and installation of the lower control arm rear isolator bushing is done using an
arbor press. Do not attempt to use a different procedure from that below for the removal and
replacement of rear lower control arm bushing.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the lower control arm assembly from the vehicle.
2. Position lower control arm in an arbor press supported at rear bushing using Receiver Cup,
Special Tool 6556, or equivalent. Position
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6758, or equivalent on top of rear control arm bushing.
3. Press isolator bushing out of the lower control arm.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear bushing into the lower control arm in the direction indicated. Rear bushing must
be positioned in lower control arm with the void in
the bushing pointing toward the compression strut of the lower control arm as shown.
2. Place lower control arm in an arbor press supported at rear bushing hole using Receiver Cup,
Special Tool 6556, or equivalent. Correctly position
Remove Installer, Special Tool 6760, or equivalent on top of rear control arm bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Lower Control Arm Front Isolator Bushing > Page 5088
3. Press rear bushing into lower control arm, until flange on bushing is flush with machined surface
of lower control arm. 4. Install the lower control arm assembly hack on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle
on Bumps
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-47-97 Date: 970926
Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps
NO: 23-47-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: Sept. 26, 1997
SUBJECT: Creak/Rattle From Front Foot Well
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Creak/rattle from driver or passenger front foot well. The creak/rattle is more pronounced over
bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
Drive the vehicle over a bumpy road and listen for a creak/rattle in the foot well area. If creak/rattle
is heard proceed with the repair procedure on the side that the noise is heard. If the side the
creak/rattle is coming from cannot be determined by sound, torque each crossmember bolt to 163
Nm (120 ft lbs). If the bolt was at 163 Nm (120 ft.lbs), the torque is acceptable and no further action
is needed on that side. If the torque was not at 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs), proceed to the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 05011650AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Right)
AR(1) 05011651AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Left)
Each kit will include one of the following components:
Cage Nut, Crossmember Bolt, Crossmember Mastic Patch Drain Plug Access Hole Template
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
13-30-01-90 0.6 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves drilling an access hole to replace the crossmember bolt and cage nut, then
sealing the access hole.
1. Raise vehicle to gain access to the crossmember bolt.
2. Remove the crossmember bolt.
3. Lower the vehicle and open the door.
4. Slide the seat to the full rearward position. Remove the floor mat if so equipped.
5. Remove the scuff plate and kick panel.
6. Pull the carpet and pad away to access the floor.
7. Prop the clutch and brake pedal to make room for drilling (drivers side only).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle
on Bumps > Page 5097
8. Insert the template, mark and center punch the floor pan (Figure 1).
9. Using a drill and 70 mm (2-3/4") Dia hole saw, drill in the floor to access the cage nut.
10. Pry up on the cage surrounding the nut and slide the nut out.
11. Insert the new nut and bend the cage back into position to secure the nut.
12. Raise the vehicle and install the new bolt, torque to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
13. Lower the vehicle and vacuum all drill shavings.
14. Install the drain hole plug into the hole in the floor. Use a heat gun to seal the plug to the floor.
15. Center the mastic patch over the drain hole plug and install (Figure 2). To install, remove
backing paper and apply firm even pressure across the entire patch to seal.
16. Position pad and carpet into proper location.
17. Remove prop holding brake and clutch pedal if applied.
18. Install the scuff plate and kick panel.
19. Install floor mat and reposition seat.
20. Repeat procedure for other side if needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well Creak/Rattle on Bumps
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-47-97 Date: 970926
Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps
NO: 23-47-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: Sept. 26, 1997
SUBJECT: Creak/Rattle From Front Foot Well
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Creak/rattle from driver or passenger front foot well. The creak/rattle is more pronounced over
bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
Drive the vehicle over a bumpy road and listen for a creak/rattle in the foot well area. If creak/rattle
is heard proceed with the repair procedure on the side that the noise is heard. If the side the
creak/rattle is coming from cannot be determined by sound, torque each crossmember bolt to 163
Nm (120 ft lbs). If the bolt was at 163 Nm (120 ft.lbs), the torque is acceptable and no further action
is needed on that side. If the torque was not at 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs), proceed to the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 05011650AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Right)
AR(1) 05011651AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Left)
Each kit will include one of the following components:
Cage Nut, Crossmember Bolt, Crossmember Mastic Patch Drain Plug Access Hole Template
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
13-30-01-90 0.6 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves drilling an access hole to replace the crossmember bolt and cage nut, then
sealing the access hole.
1. Raise vehicle to gain access to the crossmember bolt.
2. Remove the crossmember bolt.
3. Lower the vehicle and open the door.
4. Slide the seat to the full rearward position. Remove the floor mat if so equipped.
5. Remove the scuff plate and kick panel.
6. Pull the carpet and pad away to access the floor.
7. Prop the clutch and brake pedal to make room for drilling (drivers side only).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well Creak/Rattle on Bumps > Page 5103
8. Insert the template, mark and center punch the floor pan (Figure 1).
9. Using a drill and 70 mm (2-3/4") Dia hole saw, drill in the floor to access the cage nut.
10. Pry up on the cage surrounding the nut and slide the nut out.
11. Insert the new nut and bend the cage back into position to secure the nut.
12. Raise the vehicle and install the new bolt, torque to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
13. Lower the vehicle and vacuum all drill shavings.
14. Install the drain hole plug into the hole in the floor. Use a heat gun to seal the plug to the floor.
15. Center the mastic patch over the drain hole plug and install (Figure 2). To install, remove
backing paper and apply firm even pressure across the entire patch to seal.
16. Position pad and carpet into proper location.
17. Remove prop holding brake and clutch pedal if applied.
18. Install the scuff plate and kick panel.
19. Install floor mat and reposition seat.
20. Repeat procedure for other side if needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5104
Cross-Member: Specifications
Attaching Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................ 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises
Front Steering Knuckle: Customer Interest Front Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises
NO: 02-02-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Front Suspension
EFFECTIVE DATE: Dec. 15, 1997
SUBJECT: Popping/Creaking Noise in Front Suspension
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97 DATED FEBRUARY
28, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL FRONT
SUSPENSION NOISE DIAGNOSTICS/REPAIRS HAVE BEEN ADDED. THE ADDITIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front suspension may be experienced while:
^ Going in reverse or forward with the steering wheel turned completely in one direction (parking lot
maneuvers).
^ Shifting from drive to reverse, reverse to drive, etc.
^ Pulling in/out of driveway.
^ Large dips/bumps in the road such as speed bumps. **
DIAGNOSIS:
If the customer describes the front suspension noise in conditions such as those described above,
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE 1995 NEONS BUILT IN 1994 USED 13" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES WITH 13" OR 14"
WHEELS. LATER BUILT VEHICLES HAVE 13" OR 14" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES TO MATCH
ORIGINAL WHEEL SIZE. TO DETERMINE THE PROPER KNUCKLE SIZE, COUNT THE STUDS
ON THE HUB THEN REFER TO THE PARTS LIST PROVIDED IN THIS BULLETIN.
CAUTION:
DO NOT USE THE WHEEL SIZE TO DETERMINE PROPER KNUCKLE PART NUMBERS.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
**This bulletin involves inspecting/replacing as needed both front wheel bearings and steering
knuckles, front upper strut mounts, engine mounts, and lubing the driveshafts.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 5113
**NOTE:
USE TABLE TO DETERMINE WHICH STEPS TO PERFORM BASED ON VEHICLE BUILD DATE
AND IF TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97, DATED FEBRUARY 28, 1997 HAS BEEN
PERFORMED.**
NOTE:
ALL FRONT KNUCKLE/BEARING/HUB REPAIR PROCEDURES FOR STEPS 1 THROUGH 5,
CAN BE FOUND IN THE 1998 NEON SERVICE MANUAL (PUBLICATION NUMBER
81-270-8025) GROUP 2 (SUSPENSION).
1. Remove both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
2. Press the hub out of the old knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
3. Press the old hubs into the new knuckle/bearing assemblies.
**4. Before the knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies are installed on the vehicle, put a small amount of
grease (Wheel Bearing Lube - p/n 04318064) on the
entire face of the driveshaft that makes contact with the hub bearing assembly (Figure 1).**
5. Install both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front Suspension Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 5114
**6. Replace the upper strut mount by following the procedures in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025),
Removal/Installation, pages 2-16 to 2-17, and Assembly/Disassembly procedures 1 thru 5 on
pages 2-30 to 2-31 (Figure 2). The torque for the new upper strut mount nuts is 61 Nm (45 ft.lbs).**
**7. Remove and replace the right engine mount as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) (SOHC - pg
9-18)(DOHC - pg 9-64). After replacing the right engine mount, squirt enough grease (Silicone
Spray - p/n 04318070) between the mount snubber and the engine bracket to fill the gap (Figure
3).**
NOTE:
IF THE SILICONE SPRAY (P/N 04318070) IS NOT AVAILABLE, ANOTHER SILICONE SPRAY
MAY BE USED. HOWEVER THE SUBSTITUTE SILICONE SPRAY MUST NOT BE PETROLEUM
BASED.
**8. Inspect and tighten remaining suspension components to specification; repair or replace as
needed.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
02-05-30-93 Knuckles and Mounts - Replace - All 2.9 Hrs.
02-05-39-91 Upper Strut Mounts and Engine Mount - Replace 1.3 Hrs.
09-40-21-91 Engine Mount Replace 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises
Front Steering Knuckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Front Suspension - Popping/Creaking
Noises
NO: 02-02-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Front Suspension
EFFECTIVE DATE: Dec. 15, 1997
SUBJECT: Popping/Creaking Noise in Front Suspension
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97 DATED FEBRUARY
28, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL FRONT
SUSPENSION NOISE DIAGNOSTICS/REPAIRS HAVE BEEN ADDED. THE ADDITIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH ASTERISKS.
MODELS: 1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front suspension may be experienced while:
^ Going in reverse or forward with the steering wheel turned completely in one direction (parking lot
maneuvers).
^ Shifting from drive to reverse, reverse to drive, etc.
^ Pulling in/out of driveway.
^ Large dips/bumps in the road such as speed bumps. **
DIAGNOSIS:
If the customer describes the front suspension noise in conditions such as those described above,
perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE 1995 NEONS BUILT IN 1994 USED 13" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES WITH 13" OR 14"
WHEELS. LATER BUILT VEHICLES HAVE 13" OR 14" KNUCKLE ASSEMBLIES TO MATCH
ORIGINAL WHEEL SIZE. TO DETERMINE THE PROPER KNUCKLE SIZE, COUNT THE STUDS
ON THE HUB THEN REFER TO THE PARTS LIST PROVIDED IN THIS BULLETIN.
CAUTION:
DO NOT USE THE WHEEL SIZE TO DETERMINE PROPER KNUCKLE PART NUMBERS.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
**This bulletin involves inspecting/replacing as needed both front wheel bearings and steering
knuckles, front upper strut mounts, engine mounts, and lubing the driveshafts.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 5120
**NOTE:
USE TABLE TO DETERMINE WHICH STEPS TO PERFORM BASED ON VEHICLE BUILD DATE
AND IF TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 02-02-97, DATED FEBRUARY 28, 1997 HAS BEEN
PERFORMED.**
NOTE:
ALL FRONT KNUCKLE/BEARING/HUB REPAIR PROCEDURES FOR STEPS 1 THROUGH 5,
CAN BE FOUND IN THE 1998 NEON SERVICE MANUAL (PUBLICATION NUMBER
81-270-8025) GROUP 2 (SUSPENSION).
1. Remove both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
2. Press the hub out of the old knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
3. Press the old hubs into the new knuckle/bearing assemblies.
**4. Before the knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies are installed on the vehicle, put a small amount of
grease (Wheel Bearing Lube - p/n 04318064) on the
entire face of the driveshaft that makes contact with the hub bearing assembly (Figure 1).**
5. Install both left and right front knuckle/bearing/hub assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Steering Knuckle: > 02-02-97A > Dec > 97 > Front
Suspension - Popping/Creaking Noises > Page 5121
**6. Replace the upper strut mount by following the procedures in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025),
Removal/Installation, pages 2-16 to 2-17, and Assembly/Disassembly procedures 1 thru 5 on
pages 2-30 to 2-31 (Figure 2). The torque for the new upper strut mount nuts is 61 Nm (45 ft.lbs).**
**7. Remove and replace the right engine mount as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) (SOHC - pg
9-18)(DOHC - pg 9-64). After replacing the right engine mount, squirt enough grease (Silicone
Spray - p/n 04318070) between the mount snubber and the engine bracket to fill the gap (Figure
3).**
NOTE:
IF THE SILICONE SPRAY (P/N 04318070) IS NOT AVAILABLE, ANOTHER SILICONE SPRAY
MAY BE USED. HOWEVER THE SUBSTITUTE SILICONE SPRAY MUST NOT BE PETROLEUM
BASED.
**8. Inspect and tighten remaining suspension components to specification; repair or replace as
needed.**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
02-05-30-93 Knuckles and Mounts - Replace - All 2.9 Hrs.
02-05-39-91 Upper Strut Mounts and Engine Mount - Replace 1.3 Hrs.
09-40-21-91 Engine Mount Replace 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5122
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
The steering knuckle is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut
assembly and lower control arm ball joint. The steering knuckle also has machined abutments on
the casting to support and align the front brake caliper assembly. The knuckle also holds the front
drive shaft outer C/V joint hub and bearing assembly. The hub is positioned through the bearing
and knuckle, with the constant velocity stub shaft splined through the hub. The outer C/V joint is
retained to the hub/ bearing using a hub nut. The hub nut is held on the stub shaft using a nut
retainer and cotter pin.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5123
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
The front suspension steering knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. IT
MUST BE REPLACED IF FOUND TO BE DAMAGED IN ANY WAY. If it is determined that the
steering knuckle is bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the
steering knuckle.
NOTE: On this vehicle the steering knuckle must be removed from the vehicle when servicing the
front hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Removal
1. Remove cotter pin, nut lock, and spring washer.
CAUTION: Wheel bearing damage will result if after loosening hub nut, vehicle is rolled on the
ground or the weight of the vehicle is allowed to be supported by the tires.
2. Loosen hub nut while vehicle is on the floor with the brakes applied. The hub and driveshaft are
splined together through the knuckle (bearing) and
retained by the hub nut.
3. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 4. Remove wheel lug
nuts, and front tire and wheel assembly from the hub.
5. Remove front disc brake caliper to steering knuckle attaching bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5126
6. Remove disc brake caliper assembly from steering knuckle. Caliper is removed by first lifting
bottom of caliper away from steering knuckle, and
then removing top of caliper out from under steering knuckle.
7. Support brake disc brake caliper assembly using a wire hook and not by hydraulic hose.
8. Remove the braking disc from the front hub/ bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5127
9. Remove the nut attaching outer tie rod end to the steering knuckle. Nut is to be removed from tie
rod end using the following procedure, hold tie rod
end stud with a 11/32 socket while loosening and removing nut with wrench.
10. Remove the tie rod end stud from steering knuckle arm, using Remover, Special Tool
MB-990635, or equivalent.
11. Remove nut and bolt, clamping ball joint stud, from steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5128
12. Separate ball joint stud from steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm.
NOTE: Use caution when separating ball joint stud from steering knuckle, so ball joint seal does not get
cut.
- Care must be taken not to separate the inner C/V joint during this operation. Do not allow
driveshaft to hang by inner C/V joint, driveshaft must be supported.
13. Pull steering knuckle assembly out and away from outer C/V joint of the driveshaft assembly.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
14. Remove the 2 steering knuckle to strut damper clevis bracket attaching bolts. 15. The cartridge
type front wheel bearing used on this vehicle is not transferable to the replacement steering
knuckle. If the replacement steering
knuckle does not come with a hub and bearing assembly, a new bearing must be installed in the
steering knuckle. Installation of the new wheel bearing must be done before installing steering
knuckle on vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5129
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair Installation
1. Install a new cartridge hub and bearing assembly into the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
2. Install steering knuckle back in clevis bracket of strut damper assembly. Install the strut damper
to steering knuckle attaching bolts. Note: The
steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned in steering
knuckle during installation. Torque attaching nuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 1/4 turn
after specified torque is met.
3. Slide drive shaft back into front hub and bearing assembly. Then install steering knuckle onto the
ball joint stud.
4. Install a NEW steering knuckle to ball joint stud, clamp bolt and nut. Torque the clamp bolt to 100
Nm (75 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5130
5. Install tie rod end into the steering knuckle. Start tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut
onto stud of tie rod end. While holding stud of tie rod
end stationary, tighten tie rod end to steering knuckle attaching nut. Then using a crowfoot and
11/32 socket, torque tie rod end attaching nut to 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
6. Install braking disc back on hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5131
7. Install disc brake caliper assembly on steering knuckle. Caliper is installed by first sliding top of
caliper under top abutment on steering knuckle.
Then installing bottom of caliper against bottom abutment of steering knuckle.
8. Install caliper assembly to steering knuckle attaching bolts. Torque caliper assembly attaching
bolts to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.).
9. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the outer C/V joint stub axle. Install hub nut onto
threads of stub axle and tighten nut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5132
10. With vehicle brakes applied to keep braking disc from turning, tighten hub nut to a torque of 183
Nm (135 ft. lbs.). 11. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install front wheel lug nuts and torque to
135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 12. Lower vehicle.
13. Install the spring washer, hub nut lock, and new cotter pin. Wrap cotter pin prongs tightly
around the hub nut lock. 14. Set front Toe on vehicle to required specification. Refer to Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Lateral Stabilizer Rod > Component Information >
Specifications
Lateral Stabilizer Rod: Specifications
Attaching Nut .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Lateral Stabilizer Rod > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5136
Lateral Stabilizer Rod: Testing and Inspection
Inspect the lateral link isolator bushings and sleeves for signs of damage or deterioration. If the
lateral link isolator bushings or sleeves are damaged or are deteriorated, replacement of the lateral
link assembly will be required. The isolator bushings are not serviceable as a separate component
of the lateral link assembly.
Inspect the lateral links for signs of contact with the ground or road debris which has bent or
caused other damage to the lateral link assembly. If the lateral link is bent or damaged, the lateral
link will require replacement. Do not attempt to repair or straighten a lateral link.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Lateral Stabilizer Rod > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5137
Lateral Stabilizer Rod: Service and Repair
GENERAL INFORMATION
The rear suspension lateral links are only serviced as complete assemblies. The isolator bushings
used in the lateral links are not serviced as separate components. The rear lateral link assemblies
are unique, having different size bushings to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cams. The
rearward lateral links, must be installed with small bushing sleeve at knuckle and large bushing
sleeve at rear crossmember. This is required to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cam.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the rear wheel
and tire assembly from the side of the vehicle requiring lateral link removal.
3. Remove the nut, bolt and washers attaching the lateral links to the knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Lateral Stabilizer Rod > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5138
4. Remove nut, bolt, washer and Toe adjustment cam, attaching lateral links requiring removal,
from rear crossmember. Then remove lateral links
from vehicle.
INSTALL
Rear lateral links when being installed, must be specifically positioned and orientated on the
vehicle. The lateral link having same size bushing sleeves, must be mounted to the crossmember
and knuckle toward front of vehicle. The lateral link with different size bushing sleeves, must be
mounted to the crossmember and knuckle toward rear of vehicle. The lateral link with small and
large bushing sleeves, must be installed with small bushing sleeve at knuckle and large bushing
sleeve at rear crossmember. This is required to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cam at rear
crossmember.
The lateral link mounting bolts are different lengths, and need to be installed in specific locations
and direction on vehicle. The lateral link mounting bolt at knuckle MUST be installed, with head of
bolt facing front of vehicle. The lateral link mounting bolt at crossmember MUST be installed, with
head of bolt facing rear of vehicle. The long attaching bolt must be used at rear crossmember and
short bolt used at knuckle. 1. Install washer on short lateral link attaching bolt. Then install short
lateral link attaching bolt, into lateral link having the same size bushing
sleeves. Then install lateral link, bolt and washer onto knuckle as an assembly, with head of bolt
facing to front of vehicle.
2. Install lateral link with small and large bushing sleeve, on lateral link attaching bolt in rear
knuckle. Small bushing sleeve must be installed on
bolt in rear knuckle with large bushing sleeve at crossmember of vehicle.
3. Install washer and nut onto lateral link attaching bolt at rear knuckle. Do not tighten the lateral
link to rear knuckle attaching bolt at this time.
4. Install Toe adjustment cam on long lateral link attaching bolt. Install long lateral link attaching
bolt and adjustment cam, into lateral link
toward rear of vehicle, having the large bushing sleeve. Then pass lateral link attaching bolt into
rear crossmember. Head of long lateral link to crossmember attaching bolt must face to rear of
vehicle when installed.
5. Position forward rear lateral link against rear crossmember. Then pass the lateral link attaching
bolt through front lateral link bushing sleeve. 6. Install washer and nut onto lateral link attaching bolt
at rear crossmember. Do not tighten the lateral link to rear crossmember attaching bolt at
this time.
7. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle to the ground. 9. With suspension supporting total weight of vehicle, and lateral
links at correct curb height, torque both lateral link attaching bolts to 95 Nm
(70 ft. lbs.).
10. Check and reset rear wheel TOE to specifications if required. Refer to Front And Rear Toe
Setting Procedure in Wheel Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Rear Knuckle: Description and Operation
A forged rear knuckle bolts to each rear strut assembly. The movement of the rear knuckle is
controlled laterally using two lateral arms attached to the knuckle. The outboard ends of the two
lateral arms are mounted forward and rearward of the spindle centerline, and inboard ends are
mounted to the rear crossmember. Fore and aft movement of the knuckle is controlled by using a
tension strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 5142
Rear Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
The rear suspension knuckle is not a repairable component of the rear suspension. If it is
determined that the knuckle is broken or bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made
to repair or to straighten the knuckle. THE KNUCKLE MUST BE REPLACED IF FOUND TO BE
DAMAGED IN ANY WAY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Removal
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the rear wheel
and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. If vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, remove the rear caliper assembly from the adapter.
Refer to Brakes and Traction Control. After
removing caliper assembly store caliper by hanging it from frame of vehicle. Do not let weight of
rear caliper assembly hang from flexible brake hose.
4. If vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, remove rear braking disc from hub. If vehicle is
equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum
from hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5145
5. If vehicle is equipped with ABS brakes, remove the speed sensor head from the rear brake
support plate or disc brake adapter.
6. Remove rear hub and bearing assembly retaining nut. Then remove the hub and bearing
assembly from knuckle.
7. If vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes remove the 4 bolts attaching rear brake support
plate to knuckle. Then remove brake support plate,
brake shoes and wheel cylinder as an assembly from rear knuckle. It is not necessary to remove
brake flex hose from wheel cylinder when removing support plate. Brake support plate when
removed, must be supported in same manner as caliper assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5146
8. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove the 4 bolts attaching disc brake adapter to
rear knuckle. Then remove the adapter, rotor shield,
park brake shoes and park brake cable as an assembly from knuckle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Loosen and remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in knuckle.
9. Loosen but do not remove at this time, the 2 strut assembly to knuckle attaching bolts. Then
remove the lateral links to knuckle attaching bolt.
10. Hold tension strut from turning by using a large adjustable wrench on flat of tension strut and
remove tension strut nut. Then remove nut, tension
strut retainer and rear tension strut bushing from tension strut at rear knuckle.
11. Remove both rear knuckle to strut assembly clevis bracket attaching bolts. If vehicle is
equipped with a rear sway bar also remove the sway bar link
to strut mounting bracket.
12. Remove knuckle assembly from strut, by sliding knuckle straight out of clevis bracket on strut
assembly. Then remove knuckle from tension strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5147
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Installation
1. Insert tension strut, tension strut bushing and tension strut retainer into knuckle. Then install
knuckle into clevis bracket on rear strut assembly. Be
sure stepped area of bushing is squarely seated into hole in knuckle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned
during installation. Tighten and torque nuts while holding bolts stationary in knuckle.
2. Install the 2 strut assembly clevis bracket to knuckle attaching bolts and nuts. Torque the
attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the lateral arms to knuckle attaching bolt, washers
and nut as shown. Do not tighten the lateral link bolt at this time. The vehicle must be at
curb height when tightening the lateral link bolts.
4. Install tension strut bushing, tension strut retainer and nut on tension strut. When installing
tension strut retainers, the retainers must be installed on
tension strut, with cupped side of retainer facing away from bushing and knuckle.
5. Position a large adjustable wrench on flat of tension strut to keep it from turning, and then torque
tension strut nut to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5148
6. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, install rear brake support plate assembly onto the
knuckle. Install the 4 bolts attaching rear brake
support plate to rear knuckle. Torque attaching bolts to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.).
7. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, install the disc brake adapter on knuckle Install the 4
bolts attaching the disc brake adapter to knuckle.
Torque attaching bolts to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5149
8. If vehicle is equipped with ABS brakes, install speed sensor head into rear brake support plate or
disc brake adapter. Torque speed sensor head
mounting bolt to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.).
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
9. Install rear hub and bearing assembly on knuckle. Install hub and bearing assembly retaining
nut, and torque to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs).
10. If vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, install rear braking disc on hub. If vehicle is
equipped with rear drum brakes, install the brake drum on
hub.
11. If vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, install rear braking disc on hub. Carefully install
rear brake caliper over braking disc and install on
adapter. Tighten the caliper assembly to adapter mounting bolts to 22 Nm (192 inch lbs.). Refer to
Brakes and Traction Control.
12. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half specification.
Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
13. Lower vehicle. 14. With suspension supporting total weight of vehicle, and lateral links at
correct curb height, torque both lateral link attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft.
lbs.).
15. Check and reset rear wheel TOE to specifications if required. Refer to Front And Rear Toe
Setting Procedure in Wheel Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Bushing >
Component Information > Specifications
Stabilizer Bushing: Specifications
FRONT:
Retainer Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
................................................. 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
REAR:
Retainer Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Bushing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5154
Stabilizer Bushing: Testing and Inspection
Inspect for broken or distorted sway bar bushings, bushing retainers, and worn or damaged sway
bar to strut attaching links. If sway bar to front suspension cradle bushing replacement is required,
bushing can be removed from sway bar by opening slit and peeling bushing off sway bar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Bushing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5155
Stabilizer Bushing: Service and Repair
If stabilizer bar to frame rail bushings require replacement at time of inspection, install new
bushings before installing stabilizer bar. Bushings are replaced by opening slit on bushings and
peeling them off stabilizer bar. Install new bushings on stabilizer bar, by spreading bushing at slit
and forcing them on stabilizer bar. Bushings must be installed on stabilizer bar with slit in bushing
facing rear of vehicle when stabilizer bar is installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Specifications
Stabilizer Link: Specifications
FRONT:
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
REAR:
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................ 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5159
Stabilizer Link: Testing and Inspection
Inspect the bushings and sleeves in the stabilizer bar attaching links for damage or deterioration.
Inspect the stabilizer bar attaching link to ensure it is not bent or broken. If any of these conditions
are present when inspecting the attaching links, replacement of the attaching link is required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 02-06-98A
> Jun > 98 > Front Suspension - Popping Noise On Bumps
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): All Technical Service Bulletins Front Suspension - Popping Noise
On Bumps
NO.: 02-06-95 Rev. A
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: Jun. 19, 1998
THIS BULLETIN SUPERCEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS 02-01-98 DATED MARCH
27, 1998 AND 02-06-98 DATED JUNE 5, 1998. BOTH BULLETINS SHOULD BE REMOVED
FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THE
SYMPTOM/CONDITION AND THE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE HAVE BEEN REVISED.
MODELS:
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front end while traveling over bumps with wheels straight or when
turning. ** The popping noise may be more apparent when suspension is wet, such as in a heavy
rain.
DIAGNOSIS:
**Wet the front coil springs and surrounding suspension components with a light spray from a
garden hose. Immediately drive the vehicle over a small bump (such as a speed bump) while
making a turn. If a popping noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure. **
PARTS REQUIRED:
2 05273399 Spring Sleeve, Front Coil Springs
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the addition of a spring sleeve to each front coil spring.
1. Remove the strut assembly as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 2-15.
2. Disassemble the strut assembly as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 2-30.
3. Clean the mating surface of the spring and strut spring seat. If surface rust is present, use a
smooth scuff pad to remove the rust.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 02-06-98A
> Jun > 98 > Front Suspension - Popping Noise On Bumps > Page 5168
NOTE:
THE EFFECTED AREA WILL SHOW SIGNS OF RUST OR PAINT WEAR. THIS IS THE AREA
THAT SHOULD BE COVERED BY THE SPRING SLEEVE.
4. Apply the spring sleeve (p/n 5273399) to the spring. The spring sleeve should be positioned onto
the spring to cover the effected area (Figure 1).
5. Assemble the strut assembly following the procedure in the 1995 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 2-32.
6. Install the strut assembly into the vehicle following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 2-16.
7. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-27-01-92 1.0 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 02-06-98A > Jun > 98
> Front Suspension - Popping Noise On Bumps
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Customer Interest Front Suspension - Popping Noise On Bumps
NO.: 02-06-95 Rev. A
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: Jun. 19, 1998
THIS BULLETIN SUPERCEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS 02-01-98 DATED MARCH
27, 1998 AND 02-06-98 DATED JUNE 5, 1998. BOTH BULLETINS SHOULD BE REMOVED
FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**. THE
SYMPTOM/CONDITION AND THE DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE HAVE BEEN REVISED.
MODELS:
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
**A popping noise from the front end while traveling over bumps with wheels straight or when
turning. ** The popping noise may be more apparent when suspension is wet, such as in a heavy
rain.
DIAGNOSIS:
**Wet the front coil springs and surrounding suspension components with a light spray from a
garden hose. Immediately drive the vehicle over a small bump (such as a speed bump) while
making a turn. If a popping noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure. **
PARTS REQUIRED:
2 05273399 Spring Sleeve, Front Coil Springs
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the addition of a spring sleeve to each front coil spring.
1. Remove the strut assembly as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 2-15.
2. Disassemble the strut assembly as outlined in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 2-30.
3. Clean the mating surface of the spring and strut spring seat. If surface rust is present, use a
smooth scuff pad to remove the rust.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): > 02-06-98A > Jun > 98
> Front Suspension - Popping Noise On Bumps > Page 5174
NOTE:
THE EFFECTED AREA WILL SHOW SIGNS OF RUST OR PAINT WEAR. THIS IS THE AREA
THAT SHOULD BE COVERED BY THE SPRING SLEEVE.
4. Apply the spring sleeve (p/n 5273399) to the spring. The spring sleeve should be positioned onto
the spring to cover the effected area (Figure 1).
5. Assemble the strut assembly following the procedure in the 1995 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 2-32.
6. Install the strut assembly into the vehicle following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 2-16.
7. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 02-27-01-92 1.0 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Description and Operation Front
Coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. During service procedures when both springs are removed,
mark springs to ensure installation in original position. Each coil spring comes with a plastic sleeve
on the second coil of the spring. This plastic sleeve is a noise insulator for the coil spring. If coil
springs require replacement, be sure that the springs needing replacement, are replaced with
springs meeting the correct load rating for the vehicle and its specific options.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5177
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Description and Operation Rear
Rear coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. During service procedures when both rear coil springs are
removed, mark the coil springs to ensure installation of the springs in their original position. If coil
springs require replacement, be sure the springs needing replacement, are replaced with springs
meeting the correct load rating for the vehicle and its specific options.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5178
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair
Coil springs are rated separately for each side of vehicle depending on optional equipment and
type of service. During service procedures where both springs are removed, mark springs (Chalk,
Tape, etc.) to ensure installation in original position. If the coils springs require replacement. Be
sure that the springs needing replacement, are replaced with springs meeting the correct load and
spring rate for the vehicle.
NOTE: During service procedures requiring removal or installation of a coil spring with Spring
Compressor, Special Tool C-4838, or equivalent. It is required that the first full top and bottom coil
of the coil spring be captured by the jaws of spring compressor.
Replacement of the coil spring requires removal of the strut assembly from the vehicle, and the
disassembly of the strut. Refer to strut for the required removal and replacement procedure for the
strut assembly. Then refer to strut for the required procedure to disassemble and assemble the
strut assembly for the removal of the coil spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Alignment & Suspension Specifications & Adjustment
NO: 02-04-97
GROUP: Suspension
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Front End Alignment Torque Specifications & Shock Adjustment Procedures On
Competition Package
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE SALES
CODE (ACR) SUSPENSION SALES CODE (SDK).
DISCUSSION:
The alignment on ACR equipped vehicles must be set to the preferred specifications provided in
the 1997 Neon Service Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) page 2-7. After each final
setting the nuts should then be torqued to 75 ft.lbs plus an additional 90 degree turn. It is important
that the proper torque be used to maintain the proper alignment. If the alignment is outside of
specifications, rapid and excessive tire wear will result.
Starting in 1997, Neon competition package (ACR) vehicles come equipped with adjustable strut
dampers on all four wheels. The struts are finely tuned to the ride and handling profile of the entire
suspension system. If the customer wishes to change the dampening force for special conditions
the dampening characteristics of the strut dampers are adjustable on the ACR equipped vehicles.
The knob for adjusting the strut can be found in a packet located in the glove compartment. The
adjustment procedures are as follows:
1. The top end of the adjusting rod has flats over which the adjusting knob will fit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Alignment & Suspension - Specifications & Adjustment > Page 5183
2. Install the knob over the top end of the front or rear damper and lock it into position by turning
counterclockwise slowly until the knob engages, (Illustration).
3. Turn the adjusting knob clockwise, if resistance is felt do not use force, as the damper is in an
unadjusted position. Reverse the adjustment slightly and try again. When the damper is in the full
clockwise position, this is the minimum (City Ride) position.
4. To adjust the dampening force, the adjusting knobs has to be turned in the direction of the arrow
for increased dampening and the opposite direction for decreased dampening.
NOTE:
BOTH THE LEFT AND RIGHT STRUT DAMPERS MUST BE ADJUSTED IDENTICALLY.
FAILURE TO DO SO COULD PRODUCE UNSTABLE HANDLING AND UNEVEN TIRE TREAD
WEAR.
5. The following is a description of the various settings and the adjustment procedure.
A. City Ride - To enjoy the most comfortable city ride, the struts should be left in the "minimum"
position as they are set from the assembly plant. To set to minimum the knob should be turned
completely clockwise.
B. Cross Country - The cross country setting will give the car a firmer handling characteristic, but
yet will still be very comfortable to drive. To set, turn the adjusting knob 1/2 turn counter clockwise
from the "minimum" position.
C. G.T./Aggressive Driving - This setting equates the car's handling to a cross-country grand
turismo car, offering increased cornering ability, improved road feel and precise directional stability
at higher speeds. To set turn the adjusting knob 1 turn counter clockwise from the "minimum"
position.
6. Remove the adjusting knob before closing the hood or trunk. The vehicle should not be driven
with the adjusting knob in place.
NOTE:
DURING INSPECTION/SERVICING A THIN FILM OF OIL AND DUST COLLECTION MAY BE
NOTICED ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE STRUT TUBE. THIS IS A NORMAL CONDITION WHICH
OCCURS DURING THE DAMPER INTERNAL SEAL "BREAK-IN" PERIOD AND DOES NOT
AFFECT THE PERFORMANCE OF THE STRUT AND DOES NOT INDICATE THE NEED FOR
STRUT REPLACEMENT. STRUT REPLACEMENT SHOULD ONLY OCCUR IF THE STRUT
LEAKAGE IS SUFFICIENT TO COVER THE ENTIRE STRUT DAMPER TUBE AND HAS
"DRIPPED" ONTO THE LOWER CONTROL ARM OR ONTO THE PAVEMENT DURING
OVERNIGHT PARKING.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5184
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Specifications
FRONT:
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................ 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.) Clevis Bracket To Steering Knuckle
............................................................................................................................................ 54 Nm (40
ft. lbs.) +90° Shaft Nut .........................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 74 Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
REAR:
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................ 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.) Clevis Bracket To Knuckle Nut/Bolt
.................................................................................................................................................... 95
Nm (70 ft. lbs.) Shaft Nut .....................................................................................................................
.......................................................................... 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Front
The front strut and suspension of the vehicle is supported by coil springs positioned around the
struts. The springs are contained between an upper seat, located just below the top strut mount
assembly and a lower spring seat on the strut lower housing.
The top of each strut assembly is bolted to the upper fender reinforcement (shock tower) through a
rubber isolated mount.
The bottom of the strut assembly attaches to the top of the steering knuckle using 2 thru-bolts and
prevailing torque nuts. Caster and camber is a fixed setting (net build) on all vehicles and is not
required to be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5187
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Rear
The rear strut assemblies support the weight of the vehicle using coil springs positioned around the
struts. The coil springs are contained between the upper mount of the strut assembly and a lower
spring seat on the body of the strut assembly.
The top of each strut assembly is bolted to the top of the inner fender through a rubber isolated
mount.
The bottom of the strut assembly attaches to the rear knuckle using 2 thru-bolts and prevailing
torque nuts. Rear Caster and camber on this vehicle is a fixed setting (net build) and is not required
to be adjusted as a normal procedure when performing an alignment on this vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Front
1. Inspect for damaged or broken coil springs. 2. Inspect for torn or damaged strut assembly dust
boots.
3. Lift dust boot and inspect strut assembly for evidence of fluid running from the upper end of fluid
reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid
running down the side and dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the
strut rod and strut shaft seal is not unusual and does not affect performance of the strut assembly.
Also inspect jounce bumpers for signs of damage or deterioration.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5190
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Rear
1. Inspect for damaged or broken coil springs. 2. Inspect for torn or damaged Strut assembly dust
boots. 3. Inspect for damaged lower spring isolator.
4. Lift dust boot and inspect strut assembly for evidence of fluid running from the upper end of fluid
reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid
running down the side and dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the
strut rod and strut shaft seal is not unusual and does not affect performance of the strut assembly.
Also inspect jounce bumpers for signs of damage or deterioration.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Replacement
Front
WARNING: Do not remove strut rod nut while strut assembly is installed in vehicle, or before strut
assembly spring is compressed.
REMOVE
1. Loosen wheel nuts. 2. Raise vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 3.
Remove wheel and tire assembly from location on front of' vehicle requiring Strut removal. 4. If
both strut assemblies arc removed, mark the Strut assemblies right or left according to which side
of' the vehicle they were removed from.
5. Remove hydraulic brake hose routing bracket and attaching screw from strut damper bracket. If
vehicle is equipped with Anti-Lock brakes,
hydraulic hose routing bracket is combined with speed sensor cable routing bracket.
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5193
6. Remove the 2 strut assembly clevis bracket to steering knuckle attaching bolts.
7. Remove the 3 nuts attaching the strut assembly upper mount to the strut tower of the vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Install strut assembly into strut tower, aligning the 3 studs on the upper strut mount into the holes
in shock tower. Ins tall the 3 upper strut mount
retaining nut and washer assemblies. Torque the 3 nuts to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckles.
2. Align strut assembly with steering knuckle. Position arm of steering knuckle into strut assembly,
aligning the strut assembly to steering knuckle
mounting holes. Install the 2 strut assembly to steering knuckle attaching bolts. Attaching bolts
should be installed with the nuts facing the front of the vehicle. Torque both attaching bolts to 53
Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 1/4 turn after specified torque is met.
3. Install hydraulic brake hose routing bracket and attaching screw onto strut damper bracket. If
vehicle is equipped with Anti-Lock brakes, hydraulic
hose routing bracket is combined with speed sensor cable routing bracket. Torque bracket
attaching bolts to 13 Nm (10 ft. lbs.).
4. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the
full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
Rear
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the rear wheel
and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. Remove hydraulic flex hose bracket, from bracket on rear strut assembly. If vehicle is equipped
with Anti-Lock brakes, the wheel speed sensor
cable routing clip is also attached to the strut assembly bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5194
4. Support rear knuckle, suspension and brake components of' vehicle before removing clevis
bracket to knuckle attaching bolts. Do not let weight of
rear knuckle and assembled components hang unsupported when strut is removed.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned
during removal. Remove nuts while holding bolts stationary in knuckle.
5. Remove the 2 clevis bracket bolts attaching strut assembly to rear knuckle. 6. Lower vehicle.
Access to rear upper strut mount to strut tower attaching bolts, is through the trunk of the vehicle.
7. Remove carpet (if required) from top of strut tower. Then remove rubber dust shield from top of
strut tower, this will allow easier access to upper
strut mount attaching nuts.
8. Loosen but do not remove the 4 upper strut mount to strut tower attaching nuts. Then while
supporting the strut assembly fully remove the 4 strut
mount attaching nuts.
9. Remove strut assembly from knuckle, by sliding knuckle out of clevis bracket on strut assembly.
Then remove strut assembly from vehicle.
INSTALL
1. Position strut assembly back into vehicle with the 4 studs on strut mount assembly through holes
in strut tower of vehicle. Install the 4 strut mount
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5195
to body attaching nuts onto mount studs. Torque the 4 strut mount to body attaching nuts to 34 Nm
(300 inch lbs).
2. Install dust shield into hole on top of strut tower. Install carpeting back on top of rear strut tower.
3. Raise vehicle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned
during installation. Install and torque nuts while holding bolts stationary in knuckle.
4. Install knuckle assembly into clevis bracket on strut assembly. Install the 2 clevis bracket to
knuckle assembly attaching bolts and nuts. Torque
both clevis bracket to knuckle assembly attaching nuts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
5. Install hydraulic flex hose bracket, on strut assembly bracket. Install and securely tighten bolt
attaching hose bracket to strut bracket. If vehicle is
equipped with Anti-Lock brakes, the wheel speed sensor cable routing clip is also attached to the
strut assembly bracket.
6. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half specification.
Then repeat tightening sequence to full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle to the ground. 8. Check and reset rear wheel TOE to specifications if required.
Refer to Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5196
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Overhaul
Front
DISASSEMBLE
1. Clamp the strut assembly in a vise, with the strut in a vertical position. When clamping the strut
assembly in the vise, do not clamp strut using the
body of the strut only by strut clevis bracket.
2. Mark coil spring and strut assembly right or left, according to which side of the vehicle the strut
was removed from, and which strut coil spring
was removed from.
WARNING: Do not remove strut rod nut, before strut assembly coil spring is compressed, removing spring
tension from upper spring seat and bearing assembly.
- When compressing coil spring for removal from strut assembly, the first full top and bottom coil of
the coil spring must be captured by the jaws of the coil spring compressor.
3. Compress the strut assembly coil spring, using Spring Compressor, Special Tool C-4838, or
equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5197
4. Install Socket, Strut Nut, Special Tool L-4558A (or L-4558), or equivalents on the strut shaft
retaining nut. Then install a 10 mm socket on the hex
of the strut damper shaft. While holding strut shaft from turning, remove the strut shaft retaining
nut.
5. Remove the strut assembly mount/isolator from the strut.
6. Remove the upper spring seat, pivot bearing and dust shield as an assembly from the strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5198
7. Remove the jounce bumper from the shaft of the strut assembly.
8. Remove the coil spring from the strut assembly. Mark left and right on the coil springs for their
installation back on the correct side of the vehicle.
WARNING: If a replacement coil spring is to be installed on the strut assembly, the first full top and
bottom coil of the spring must be captured by the jaws of the coil spring compressor.
9. Inspect the strut for any binding of the strut shaft over the full stroke of the shaft.
10. Inspect the strut mount and the upper spring seat assembly for any of the following conditions:
- Mount for cracks and distortion and retaining studs for any sign of damage.
- Severe deterioration of rubber isolator,
- Binding strut assembly pivot bearing. If pivot bearing is replaced it is to be installed with the white
side of bearing facing up.
- Inspect dust shield for rips and/or deterioration.
- Inspect jounce bumper for cracks and signs of deterioration.
11. Replace any components of the strut assembly found to be worn or defective during the
inspection, before assembling the strut.
ASSEMBLE
1. Clamp the strut assembly in a vise, with the strut in a vertical position. When clamping the strut
assembly in the vise, do not clamp strut using the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5199
body of the strut only by strut clevis bracket.
2. Install the compressed coil spring onto the strut. Coil spring is to be installed with smaller coil
down, so spring correctly seats on strut assembly. 3. Install jounce bumper on the strut shaft. 4.
Install dust shield, pivot bearing and upper spring seat as an assembly on the strut. 5. Position
upper spring seat alignment notch with clevis bracket on strut assembly. 6. Install strut mount on
strut assembly and the strut mount retaining nut on the shaft of the strut assembly.
WARNING: The following 2 steps must be completely done before spring compressor, special tool
C-4838 is released from the coil spring .
7. Install Socket, Strut Nut, Special Tool L-4558A (or L-4558), or equivalents on the strut shaft
retaining nut. Then install a 10 mm socket through
the center of the socket and on the hex of the strut shaft. While holding strut shaft from turning,
torque strut shaft retaining nut to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
8. Equally loosen both Spring Compressors, Special Tool C-4838, or equivalent until top coil of
spring is fully seated against upper spring seat and
strut mount. Then relieve all tension from spring compressors and remove spring compressors
from strut assembly spring.
Disassembly
NOTE: The rear strut unit is not serviced and must be replaced as an assembly if found to be
defective. The strut is available with 2 calibrations, be sure strut is replaced with an assembly of the
same calibration.
COMPONENTS
The components of the strut assembly listed below are replaceable if found to be defective. Coil spring (Coil springs come in a standard rate of 120 lbs. per inch be sure spring is replaced with
a spring of the same rate.)
- Dust shield
- Mount assembly
- Jounce Bumper
- Lower Spring Isolator
- Shaft Nut
PROCEDURE
1. Remove strut assembly requiring service from the vehicle.
2. Position strut assembly in a vise. Using paint or equivalent, mark the strut unit, lower spring
isolator, spring and upper strut mount for indexing of
the parts at assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5200
3. Position Spring Compressors, Special Tool C-4838, or equivalent on the strut assembly spring.
Compress coil spring until all load is removed from
upper strut mount assembly.
4. Install Strut Rod Socket, Special Tool, L-4558A or L-4558, or equivalents on strut shaft nut.
Inserted a 10 mm socket through special tool and
onto end of strut shaft to keep strut shaft from turning. Remove strut shaft nut from strut shaft.
5. Remove washer between strut shaft nut and upper strut mount and isolator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5201
6. Remove upper strut mount assembly from strut shaft and spring.
7. Remove the washer from strut shaft, that is between the strut upper mount assembly and dust
shield.
8. Remove the coil spring and spring compressor as an assembly from the strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5202
9. Remove the dust shield from the strut assembly.
10. Remove the jounce bumper from the shaft of the strut assembly.
11. Remove the coil spring lower isolator from the strut assembly spring seat. 12. Inspect all
disassembled components for signs of abnormal wear or failure replacing any components as
required. Inspect strut unit for signs of
abnormal oil leakage and for loss of gas charge. To check for loss of gas charge in strut unit. Push
strut shaft into body of strut and release, strut shaft should return to its fully extended position. If
strut shaft does not return to its fully extended position replace strut unit.
Assembly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5203
1. Install the original or a new isolator on lower spring seat of strut.
2. Install jounce bumper on strut shaft.
3. Install the dust shield on the strut assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5204
4. Lower the coil spring onto the strut unit. Position end of coil spring against edge of spring isolator
on lower spring seat of strut assembly.
5. Install washer on strut shaft with raised edge of washer facing upward.
6. Install the strut assembly upper mount onto the strut shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5205
7. Install the washer on the strut assembly upper mount. Washer must be installed with the raised
edge of the washer facing down. 8. Install the upper strut mount to strut shaft retaining nut.
9. Using Strut Rod Socket, Special Tool, L-4558A, or equivalent and a 10 mm socket to keep strut
shaft from turning, torque the strut shaft nut to 61
Nm (45 ft. lbs.).
10. Equally loosen the Spring Compressors, Special Tool C-4838, or equivalent until spring is
seated on upper strut mount and all tension is relieved
from the spring compressors.
11. Install the strut assembly back into the vehicle. 12. Check and reset rear wheel TOE to
specifications if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information >
Specifications
Trailing Arm: Specifications
Shaft Nut ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) Bracket To Body Attaching Bolts
.............................................................................................................................................................
95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5209
Trailing Arm: Description and Operation
The lateral arms and tension strut have rubber isolator bushings at each end. The lateral arms are
attached to the rear crossmember and knuckle, using a unique bolt and nut assembly at each end.
The lateral arm to rear crossmember attaching bolts are longer than the lateral arm to knuckle
attaching bolts. Each lateral arm to knuckle attaching bolt and nut assembly uses 2 flat washers.
Each lateral arm to rear crossmember attaching bolt uses 1 flat washer and 1 adjustment cam to
provide a means for rear wheel Toe adjustment. The tension strut assembly attaches to a bracket
on the frame rail and to the bottom of the knuckle.
Lateral arms, tension struts and knuckles are normally replaced only when the part has been
damaged or when the vehicle has been involved in an accident. If a suspension part has been
damaged, be sure to check the underbody dimensions of the car. If underbody dimensions of the
vehicle are not correct, the frame must be straightened before replacement suspension
components are installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5210
Trailing Arm: Testing and Inspection
Inspect the tension strut bushings and retainers for signs of deterioration or damage. If the tension
strut bushings are deteriorated or the retainers are damaged, replacement of the tension strut
bushings and or the retainers will be required. The bushings and retainers are serviceable as
separate components of the tension strut.
Inspect the tension strut for signs of contact with the ground or road debris which has bent or
caused other damage to the tension strut. If the tension strut is bent or damaged the tension strut
will require replacement. Do not attempt to repair or straighten a tension strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5211
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair
GENERAL INFORMATION
The rear suspension lateral links are only serviced as complete assemblies. The isolator bushings
used in the lateral links are not serviced as separate components. The rear lateral link assemblies
are unique, having different size bushings to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cams. The
rearward lateral links, must be installed with small bushing sleeve at knuckle and large bushing
sleeve at rear crossmember. This is required to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cam.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the rear wheel
and tire assembly from the side of the vehicle requiring lateral link removal.
3. Remove the nut, bolt and washers attaching the lateral links to the knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5212
4. Remove nut, bolt, washer and Toe adjustment cam, attaching lateral links requiring removal,
from rear crossmember. Then remove lateral links
from vehicle.
INSTALL
Rear lateral links when being installed, must be specifically positioned and orientated on the
vehicle. The lateral link having same size bushing sleeves, must be mounted to the crossmember
and knuckle toward front of vehicle. The lateral link with different size bushing sleeves, must be
mounted to the crossmember and knuckle toward rear of vehicle. The lateral link with small and
large bushing sleeves, must be installed with small bushing sleeve at knuckle and large bushing
sleeve at rear crossmember. This is required to accommodate the rear Toe adjustment cam at rear
crossmember.
The lateral link mounting bolts are different lengths, and need to be installed in specific locations
and direction on vehicle. The lateral link mounting bolt at knuckle MUST be installed, with head of
bolt facing front of vehicle. The lateral link mounting bolt at crossmember MUST be installed, with
head of bolt facing rear of vehicle. The long attaching bolt must be used at rear crossmember and
short bolt used at knuckle. 1. Install washer on short lateral link attaching bolt. Then install short
lateral link attaching bolt, into lateral link having the same size bushing
sleeves. Then install lateral link, bolt and washer onto knuckle as an assembly, with head of bolt
facing to front of vehicle.
2. Install lateral link with small and large bushing sleeve, on lateral link attaching bolt in rear
knuckle. Small bushing sleeve must be installed on
bolt in rear knuckle with large bushing sleeve at crossmember of vehicle.
3. Install washer and nut onto lateral link attaching bolt at rear knuckle. Do not tighten the lateral
link to rear knuckle attaching bolt at this time.
4. Install Toe adjustment cam on long lateral link attaching bolt. Install long lateral link attaching
bolt and adjustment cam, into lateral link
toward rear of vehicle, having the large bushing sleeve. Then pass lateral link attaching bolt into
rear crossmember. Head of long lateral link to crossmember attaching bolt must face to rear of
vehicle when installed.
5. Position forward rear lateral link against rear crossmember. Then pass the lateral link attaching
bolt through front lateral link bushing sleeve. 6. Install washer and nut onto lateral link attaching bolt
at rear crossmember. Do not tighten the lateral link to rear crossmember attaching bolt at
this time.
7. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
8. Lower vehicle to the ground. 9. With suspension supporting total weight of vehicle, and lateral
links at correct curb height, torque both lateral link attaching bolts to 95 Nm
(70 ft. lbs.).
10. Check and reset rear wheel TOE to specifications if required. Refer to Front And Rear Toe
Setting Procedure in Wheel Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Mechanical Specifications
Front
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
................................................ 216 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Hub Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5217
Wheel Bearing: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Wheel Bearing Grease NLGI GC rated automotive grease
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5218
Wheel Bearing: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front
The front wheel hub bearing used is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing.
The wheel bearing is serviced separately from the front steering knuckle and front hub assembly.
Installation and retention of the front wheel bearing into the steering knuckle, is by means of an
interference press fit using a retaining compound and a retaining snap ring. Installation of the front
hub into the front wheel bearing, must be done after wheel bearing and retaining snap ring is
installed in steering knuckle.
The unit 1 wheel bearing is serviced only as a complete assembly less the wheel hub. If the front
wheel bearing requires replacement, the hub must be removed from the original wheel bearing and
transferred to the replacement bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front > Page 5221
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear
All vehicles are equipped with permanently lubricated and sealed for life rear wheel bearings.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units. However, if servicing
of a rear wheel bearing is required, refer to procedures in Testing and Inspection and Service and
Repair for the inspection and replacement of the rear wheel bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Front
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front
NOTE: The hub bearing is designed for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of periodic
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub
bearing.
With the wheel, disc brake caliper. and brake rotor removed, rotate the wheel hub. Any roughness
or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the hub bearing
exhibits any of these conditions during diagnosis, the hub bearing will require replacement, the
bearing is not serviceable.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the hub bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Front > Page 5224
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear
The rear hub and bearing assembly is designed for the life of the vehicle and should require no
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for evaluation of bearing condition. With wheel
and brake drum removed, rotate flanged outer ring of hub. Excessive roughness, lateral play or
resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or bearing failure. If the rear wheel bearings exhibit
these conditions during inspection, the hub and bearing assembly should be replaced. Damaged
bearing seals and resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing replacement. Moderate
grease loss from bearing is considered normal and should not require replacement of the hub and
bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Removal
1. Remove the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. See:
Front Steering Knuckle/Service and Repair
NOTE: The removal and installation of the steering knuckle hub bearing is to ONLY be done with
the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the hub bearing from the steering
knuckle MUST be done using an arbor press and the following procedure.
2. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on the steering knuckle and hub/bearing
assembly as shown to support steering knuckle
when pressing out hub.
3. Position steering knuckle and hub and bearing in an arbor press supported by Bearing Splitter,
Special Tool P334 as shown. 4. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on the small
end of the hub to drive hub out of bearing. Using arbor press remove hub from
bearing. The one bearing race will come out with hub when hub is removed from bearing.
5. Remove Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent from the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: Safety goggles and or face protection should always be worn when removing the snap
ring retaining the hub/bearing in the steering knuckle. When the snap ring is removed from the
steering knuckle it could fly out of the steering knuckle with great force possibly causing personal
injury.
6. Using a screw driver, remove the snap ring retaining the hub bearing in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 5227
7. Place steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. Press blocks
must not obstruct hub bearing bore in steering knuckle so
bearing can be pressed out of knuckle. Place Bearing Driver, Special Tool MB-990799, or
equivalent on outer race of hub bearing. Press hub bearing completely out of the steering knuckle.
8. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on hub so it is between the flange of the
hub and the bearing race remaining on the hub.
Place hub, bearing race and the bearing splitter in an arbor press as shown. Place Driver, Special
Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on end of hub. Press the hub out of the bearing race.
Installation
1. Wipe bore of steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTIONS: Do not use any type of solvent on the hub bearing when cleaning it.
- The hub bearing must be wiped as clean as possible. Any remaining rust preventative on the
bearing can effect the bonding action of the adhesive to the bearing.
2. Clean the rust preventative from the replacement hub bearing using a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTION: When applying adhesive to bore of steering knuckle, do not allow adhesive to get into
the snap ring in bore or on the seal of the hub bearing
3. Apply Loctite Adhesive #640 or an equivalent, to the bore of the steering knuckle. The adhesive
is to be applied to the entire bore wall surface,
from the shoulder at the bottom to just below the snap ring groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 5228
4. Place new hub bearing into bore of steering knuckle so it is square with the bore. Place steering
knuckle in arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
C-4698-2, or equivalent supporting steering knuckle. Place Diver, Special Tool 5052, or equivalent
on outer race of the hub bearing. Press hub bearing into steering knuckle until it is fully bottom in
bearing bore of steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When installing the retaining snap ring for the hub bearing care must be taken not to
damage seal on new hub bearing.
5. Install hub bearing retaining snap ring into snap ring groove in hub bearing bore of steering
knuckle. Be sure snap ring is fully seated in snap ring
groove.
6. Place steering knuckle with hub bearing installed in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
MB-990799, or equivalent supporting inner race of
the hub bearing. Place hub in nub bearing making sure it is square with bearing. Place Driver,
Special Tool 6522, or equivalent on front face of hub. Press the hub into the hub bearing until hub
is fully bottomed in hub bearing.
7. Install the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly on the vehicle. See: Front
Steering Knuckle/Service and Repair 8. Install the wheel and tire on the vehicle. 9. Lower the
vehicle.
10. Set the front wheel Toe to the required specification.
CAUTION: After the vehicle is aligned it can only be moved a short distance and then parked. Do
not move the vehicle any further until the adhesive has cured for a minimum of two hours. Driving
the vehicle before the adhesive is allowed to cure properly, will affect the retention of the bearing in
the bore of the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 5229
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
3. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub And Bearing Dust Cap
4. Remove dust cap. from rear hub/bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 5230
5. Remove hub/bearing assembly to rear spindle retaining nut. 6. Remove rear hub/bearing
assembly from rear spindle by pulling straight of spindle by hand.
INSTALL
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
1. Position hub/bearing assembly on rear spindle. 2. Install a new hub nut and tighten to a torque of
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). 3. Install dust cap; using a soft faced hammer. 4. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
5. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer To Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair.
6. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During Low
Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl During Low
Speed Stop > Page 5240
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop > Page 5246
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5247
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
183 Nm (135 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Spare Tire > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Spare Tire: Description and Operation
The temporary spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be repaired
and reinstalled at the first opportunity, or replaced with a new. Do not exceed speeds of 50 MPH
when the temporary spare tire is in use on the vehicle. Refer to the Owner's Manual for complete
details.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Tire & Wheel - Runout
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Tire & Wheel - Runout
NO: 22-01-97
GROUP: Wheels & Tires
DATE: Jun. 13, 1997
SUBJECT: Tire & Wheel Runout
MODELS: 1994 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1994 - 1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1994 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Convertible
1994 - 1997 (AN) Dakota
1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1994 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 1997 (BR) Ram Pickup
1994 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1995 - 1997 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
1995 - 1997 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1994 - 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1996 - 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
1994 - 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
1997 (TJ) Wrangler
1994 - 1997 (XJ) Cherokee
1994 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1994 - 1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
Radial runout is the vertical distance between the high and low points on the tire or wheel edge
measured at the center line of the tread.
Lateral runout is the horizontal movement of the tire or wheel measured near the shoulder of the
tire.
Runout of more than the preferred specification may cause the vehicle to shake. Refer to the
following specifications and appropriate Service Manual procedures.
PREFERRED TIRE & WHEEL RUNOUT
Usually runout can be reduced by relocating the wheel and tire on the wheels studs and/or rotating
the tire on the wheel (match mounting).
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5257
Wheels: Specifications
Lug Nuts ..............................................................................................................................................
................................. 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5258
Wheels: Description and Operation
Original equipment wheels are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the specified
maximum vehicle capacity.
All models use steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. Every wheel has raised sections
between the rim flanges and rim drop well called safety humps.
Initial inflation of the tires forces the bead over these raised sections. In case of air loss the raised
sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the vehicle can be brought to a safe stop.
Cast aluminum wheels require special balance weights to fit on the thicker flange of the rim and
special wheel clamps for the alignment equipment.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum wheels use wheel nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is necessary to
ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Vehicles that are equipped with bolt-on wheel covers use large nose wheel nuts. The wheel nuts
used on a vehicle equipped with bolt-on wheel covers are externally threaded so that the wheel
covers can be attached to the wheel nuts.
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup of corrosion on the wheel mounting surface.
WARNING: Installing wheels without good metal-to-metal contact could cause loosening of wheel
lug nuts. This could adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5259
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
Wheels must be replaced if they:
- Have excessive run out
- Are bent or dented
- Leak air
- Have damaged wheel lug/ nut holes
Wheel repairs employing hammering, heating, welding or repairing leaks are not allowed.
Original equipment replacement wheels should be used. When obtaining replacement wheels, they
should be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The physical dimensions (diameter, width, offset,
pilot hole and bolt circle) of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: Failure to use equivalent replacement wheels may adversely affect the safety and
handling of the vehicle. Replacement with used wheels is not recommended. The service history of
the rim may have included severe treatment or very high mileage. The rim could fail without
warning.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5260
Wheels: Service and Repair
Lug Nut Tightening Sequence
To install the wheel and tire assembly, first position it properly on the mounting surface using the
hub pilot as a guide. Then progressively tighten the lug nuts in the proper sequence to half of the
required torque. Finally tighten the lug nuts in the proper sequence to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft.
lbs.). Never use oil or grease on studs or nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Mechanical Specifications
Front
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
................................................ 216 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Hub Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5265
Wheel Bearing: Fluid Type Specifications Lubricant Type
Lubricant Type
Wheel Bearing Grease NLGI GC rated automotive grease
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5266
Wheel Bearing: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Front
The front wheel hub bearing used is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing.
The wheel bearing is serviced separately from the front steering knuckle and front hub assembly.
Installation and retention of the front wheel bearing into the steering knuckle, is by means of an
interference press fit using a retaining compound and a retaining snap ring. Installation of the front
hub into the front wheel bearing, must be done after wheel bearing and retaining snap ring is
installed in steering knuckle.
The unit 1 wheel bearing is serviced only as a complete assembly less the wheel hub. If the front
wheel bearing requires replacement, the hub must be removed from the original wheel bearing and
transferred to the replacement bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Front > Page 5269
Wheel Bearing: Description and Operation Rear
All vehicles are equipped with permanently lubricated and sealed for life rear wheel bearings.
There is no periodic lubrication or maintenance recommended for these units. However, if servicing
of a rear wheel bearing is required, refer to procedures in Testing and Inspection and Service and
Repair for the inspection and replacement of the rear wheel bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Front
NOTE: The hub bearing is designed for the life of the vehicle and requires no type of periodic
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for diagnosing the condition of the hub
bearing.
With the wheel, disc brake caliper. and brake rotor removed, rotate the wheel hub. Any roughness
or resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or a failed hub bearing. If the hub bearing
exhibits any of these conditions during diagnosis, the hub bearing will require replacement, the
bearing is not serviceable.
Damaged bearing seals and the resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing
replacement. Moderate grease weapage from the hub bearing is considered normal and should not
require replacement of the hub bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5272
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection Rear
The rear hub and bearing assembly is designed for the life of the vehicle and should require no
maintenance. The following procedure may be used for evaluation of bearing condition. With wheel
and brake drum removed, rotate flanged outer ring of hub. Excessive roughness, lateral play or
resistance to rotation may indicate dirt intrusion or bearing failure. If the rear wheel bearings exhibit
these conditions during inspection, the hub and bearing assembly should be replaced. Damaged
bearing seals and resulting excessive grease loss may also require bearing replacement. Moderate
grease loss from bearing is considered normal and should not require replacement of the hub and
bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Removal
1. Remove the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. See:
Steering/Front Steering Knuckle/Service and Repair
NOTE: The removal and installation of the steering knuckle hub bearing is to ONLY be done with
the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the hub bearing from the steering
knuckle MUST be done using an arbor press and the following procedure.
2. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on the steering knuckle and hub/bearing
assembly as shown to support steering knuckle
when pressing out hub.
3. Position steering knuckle and hub and bearing in an arbor press supported by Bearing Splitter,
Special Tool P334 as shown. 4. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on the small
end of the hub to drive hub out of bearing. Using arbor press remove hub from
bearing. The one bearing race will come out with hub when hub is removed from bearing.
5. Remove Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent from the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: Safety goggles and or face protection should always be worn when removing the snap
ring retaining the hub/bearing in the steering knuckle. When the snap ring is removed from the
steering knuckle it could fly out of the steering knuckle with great force possibly causing personal
injury.
6. Using a screw driver, remove the snap ring retaining the hub bearing in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5275
7. Place steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. Press blocks
must not obstruct hub bearing bore in steering knuckle so
bearing can be pressed out of knuckle. Place Bearing Driver, Special Tool MB-990799, or
equivalent on outer race of hub bearing. Press hub bearing completely out of the steering knuckle.
8. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool P334, or equivalent on hub so it is between the flange of the
hub and the bearing race remaining on the hub.
Place hub, bearing race and the bearing splitter in an arbor press as shown. Place Driver, Special
Tool 6644-2, or equivalent on end of hub. Press the hub out of the bearing race.
Installation
1. Wipe bore of steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTIONS: Do not use any type of solvent on the hub bearing when cleaning it.
- The hub bearing must be wiped as clean as possible. Any remaining rust preventative on the
bearing can effect the bonding action of the adhesive to the bearing.
2. Clean the rust preventative from the replacement hub bearing using a clean dry shop towel.
CAUTION: When applying adhesive to bore of steering knuckle, do not allow adhesive to get into
the snap ring in bore or on the seal of the hub bearing
3. Apply Loctite Adhesive #640 or an equivalent, to the bore of the steering knuckle. The adhesive
is to be applied to the entire bore wall surface,
from the shoulder at the bottom to just below the snap ring groove.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5276
4. Place new hub bearing into bore of steering knuckle so it is square with the bore. Place steering
knuckle in arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
C-4698-2, or equivalent supporting steering knuckle. Place Diver, Special Tool 5052, or equivalent
on outer race of the hub bearing. Press hub bearing into steering knuckle until it is fully bottom in
bearing bore of steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When installing the retaining snap ring for the hub bearing care must be taken not to
damage seal on new hub bearing.
5. Install hub bearing retaining snap ring into snap ring groove in hub bearing bore of steering
knuckle. Be sure snap ring is fully seated in snap ring
groove.
6. Place steering knuckle with hub bearing installed in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool
MB-990799, or equivalent supporting inner race of
the hub bearing. Place hub in nub bearing making sure it is square with bearing. Place Driver,
Special Tool 6522, or equivalent on front face of hub. Press the hub into the hub bearing until hub
is fully bottomed in hub bearing.
7. Install the steering knuckle, hub and the hub bearing as an assembly on the vehicle. See:
Steering/Front Steering Knuckle/Service and Repair 8. Install the wheel and tire on the vehicle. 9.
Lower the vehicle.
10. Set the front wheel Toe to the required specification.
CAUTION: After the vehicle is aligned it can only be moved a short distance and then parked. Do
not move the vehicle any further until the adhesive has cured for a minimum of two hours. Driving
the vehicle before the adhesive is allowed to cure properly, will affect the retention of the bearing in
the bore of the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5277
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove rear wheel
and tire assembly.
3. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove brake drum from rear hub/bearing
assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes,
remove disc brake caliper from disc brake adapter, and then remove rotor from hub/ bearing
assembly.
Rear Hub And Bearing Dust Cap
4. Remove dust cap. from rear hub/bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5278
5. Remove hub/bearing assembly to rear spindle retaining nut. 6. Remove rear hub/bearing
assembly from rear spindle by pulling straight of spindle by hand.
INSTALL
CAUTION: The hub/bearing retaining nut must be tightened to but must not exceed its required
torque specification. The proper torque specification of the retaining nut is critical to the life of the
hub bearing.
1. Position hub/bearing assembly on rear spindle. 2. Install a new hub nut and tighten to a torque of
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). 3. Install dust cap; using a soft faced hammer. 4. On drum brake equipped
vehicles, install rear brake drum on hub/bearing assembly. On vehicles equipped with rear disc
brakes, install rotor on
hub/ bearing assembly.
Caliper Assembly Guide Pin Bolts
5. On disc brake equipped vehicles install disc brake caliper on disc brake adapter. Install the 2
caliper guide pin bolts and torque to 22 Nm (192 in.
lbs.). Refer To Disc Brake Caliper Service and Repair.
6. Install rear wheel and tire assembly on vehicle. Tighten all wheel stud nuts in crisscross pattern
to one-half specified torque. Then repeat pattern,
fully tightening stud nuts to 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.).
7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Cover: > 220396 > Oct > 96 > Wheel Covers Noisy/Missing/Loose
Wheel Cover: Customer Interest Wheel Covers - Noisy/Missing/Loose
NO: 22-03-96
GROUP: Wheels
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Noisy, Loose Or Missing Bolt-on Wheel Covers
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Noisy, loose or missing wheel covers due to loose or missing wheel cover nuts.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect each wheel cover nut and determine if loose. If the plastic nut is over-torqued, it will result
in a jumped thread and become loose. If the plastic nut has jumped a thread torque nut to 55 in.
lbs. Inspect the nut, if the nut is loose remove and inspect for damage. If one or more of the 5 nuts
is damaged proceed to the repair procedure. If nut is now secure no further action is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04656777 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4W)
AR 04656376 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4Y)
AR 04656825 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4J)
AR 04656251 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4C)
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin provides the procedure for the wheel cover installation.
1. Place wheel cover on wheel and firmly push down on center cap so that it is flat against the
wheel.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER ATTACHING NUTS SHOULD NEVER BE INSTALLED BY DRIVING THE
NUT ONTO THE WHEEL NUT WITH A RUBBER MALLET OR BY USING AN IMPACT WRENCH.
PLEASE INSURE THAT THE NEW VEHICLE PREP TECHNICIAN IS AWARE OF THIS
INFORMATION.
2. Hand tighten the wheel cover nuts until they begin to "ratchet" and then let the cover spring
back.
3. Torque the wheel cover nuts sequentially to between 45 to 55 in. lbs.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER NUT HAS A BUILT IN SAFEGUARD THAT WILL ALLOW THE NUT TO
JUMP A THREAD IF OVER-TORQUED. IF THIS CONDITION OCCURS, IT THE NUT SHOULD
BE TIGHTENED TO JUST BEFORE THE "JUMP" FEATURE. THE "JUMP" FEATURE CAN BE
FELT AS A POP WHEN THE NUT IS TORQUED OVER 55 IN. LBS.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-93 0.2 Hrs.
Inspect and Torque Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-94 0.2 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Cover: > 220396 > Oct > 96 > Wheel Covers Noisy/Missing/Loose
Wheel Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheel Covers - Noisy/Missing/Loose
NO: 22-03-96
GROUP: Wheels
DATE: Oct. 4, 1996
SUBJECT: Noisy, Loose Or Missing Bolt-on Wheel Covers
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Noisy, loose or missing wheel covers due to loose or missing wheel cover nuts.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect each wheel cover nut and determine if loose. If the plastic nut is over-torqued, it will result
in a jumped thread and become loose. If the plastic nut has jumped a thread torque nut to 55 in.
lbs. Inspect the nut, if the nut is loose remove and inspect for damage. If one or more of the 5 nuts
is damaged proceed to the repair procedure. If nut is now secure no further action is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04656777 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4W)
AR 04656376 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4Y)
AR 04656825 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4J)
AR 04656251 Wheel Cover And Nut Assembly (Sales Code W4C)
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin provides the procedure for the wheel cover installation.
1. Place wheel cover on wheel and firmly push down on center cap so that it is flat against the
wheel.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER ATTACHING NUTS SHOULD NEVER BE INSTALLED BY DRIVING THE
NUT ONTO THE WHEEL NUT WITH A RUBBER MALLET OR BY USING AN IMPACT WRENCH.
PLEASE INSURE THAT THE NEW VEHICLE PREP TECHNICIAN IS AWARE OF THIS
INFORMATION.
2. Hand tighten the wheel cover nuts until they begin to "ratchet" and then let the cover spring
back.
3. Torque the wheel cover nuts sequentially to between 45 to 55 in. lbs.
CAUTION:
THE WHEEL COVER NUT HAS A BUILT IN SAFEGUARD THAT WILL ALLOW THE NUT TO
JUMP A THREAD IF OVER-TORQUED. IF THIS CONDITION OCCURS, IT THE NUT SHOULD
BE TIGHTENED TO JUST BEFORE THE "JUMP" FEATURE. THE "JUMP" FEATURE CAN BE
FELT AS A POP WHEN THE NUT IS TORQUED OVER 55 IN. LBS.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-93 0.2 Hrs.
Inspect and Torque Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Labor Operation No: 22-20-01-94 0.2 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Cover - One or All
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5292
Wheel Cover: Description and Operation
A lock-on type wheel cover is used on certain models.
The wheel cover is locked to the wheel using the 5 nuts located in the wheel cover. The nuts in the
wheel cover, thread onto a special externally threaded wheel nut. This is the method used to retain
the wheel cover to the wheel.
The wheel cover retaining nut is retained in the wheel cover and will stay on the wheel cover when
unthreaded from the wheel nut. If required, the retaining nut for the lock-on wheel cover can be
removed from the wheel cover and replaced as a separate part of the lock-on wheel cover.
The lock-on wheel cover can not be removed from the wheel until all 5 of wheel cover retaining
nuts are unthreaded from the wheel nuts. Then the lock-on wheel cover can be removed by hand
from the wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Cover Replacement
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover Replacement
NOTE: When unthreading the wheel cover retaining nuts from the wheel nuts it is recommended
that a hand wrench be used and not an impact wrench. Use of an impact wrench could result in
damage to the lock-on wheel cover retaining nuts.
REMOVE
1. Unthread the 5 nuts attaching the wheel cover to the wheel nuts. 2. Grasp the wheel cover and
pull straight outward from the wheel. This will remove the wheel cover from the wheel.
Fig. 2
INSTALL
1. Align the valve notch in the wheel cover with the valve stem on the wheel. Align the wheel cover
retaining nuts with the externally threaded wheel
nuts.
2. By hand, start to thread all 5 of the wheel cover retaining nuts onto the externally threaded wheel
nuts.
NOTE: When tightening the wheel cover retaining nuts it is recommended that a hand wrench be
used and not an impact wrench. Use of an impact wrench could result in damage to the lock-on
wheel cover retaining nuts.
3. Tighten each of the wheel cover retaining nuts. If the retaining nut "jumps" a thread (slips), which
is an override feature of the retaining nut,
retighten the retaining nut to a point just prior to this occurring. To avoid rattling of the wheel cover
be sure all five retaining nuts are correctly tightened.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Wheel Cover Replacement > Page 5295
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Wheel Cover Retaining Nut Replacement
NOTE: If a retaining nut for the lock-on wheel is damaged, it can be replaced as a separate part of
the wheel cover. Use the following procedure for replacing a wheel cover retaining nut.
REMOVE
1. If required, remove the wheel cover from the wheel.
NOTE: The retaining nut flange can not be forced past the large retaining tab. When removing
retaining nut from wheel cover, the flange on the retaining nut must be forced past the 2 small
retaining tabs on wheel cover.
2. From the back side of the wheel cover, push outward and tilt the retaining nut sideways forcing
the flange on the retaining nut past the 2 small
retaining tabs in the retaining nut hole of the wheel cover.
3. When flange on retaining nut is past the 2 retaining tabs on the wheel cover, remove retaining
nut from wheel cover by pushing or pulling from
hole in wheel cover.
INSTALL
1. Install retaining nut in hole of wheel cover with retaining nut flange positioned under the large
retaining flange. 2. Push on hex of retaining nut forcing the retaining nut flange past the 2 small
retaining tabs in wheel cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear Brakes - Howl
During Low Speed Stop > Page 5305
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear
Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-01-98 Date: 980130
Rear Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop
NO: 05-01-98
GROUP: Brakes
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Howl From Rear Brakes During Low Speed Stop
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 05-08-97 DATED
NOVEMBER 7, 1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE SALES CODES
FOR COVERED VEHICLES HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL) Neon
**NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO ALL NON ABS EQUIPPED VEHICLES (SALES CODES BRA AND
BRC). VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH ABS DID NOT HAVE DRUM BRAKES.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A howl type noise coming from the rear brakes during a low speed (10
mph or less) brake apply in a forward direction. The condition may be more frequent in cold/damp
weather during the first few stops with cold brakes.
DIAGNOSIS: While traveling at 10 mph, lightly apply the brakes and listen for a low pitched howl
from the rear. If the noise is heard, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05011628AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Right)
1 05011629AA Brake Shoe Support Plate, Rear With Wheel Cylinder (Left)
2 04509544 Gasket, Brake Shoe Support Plate
2 06502432 Retaining Nut, Hub and Bearing Assembly
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
05-80-20-92 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves replacing the rear brake shoe support plate with a new brake shoe support
plate. Attached to the new plate will be the wheel cylinder assembly and a damper weight.
1. Raise the vehicle on jack stands or centered on a frame contact type hoist.
2. Remove rear wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the brake drum.
4. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub/bearing.
5. Remove the retaining nut holding the rear hub/bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub/bearing
from the spindle.
6. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
7. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose tube from the wheel cylinder.
8. Remove park brake actuator lever from the park brake cable.
9. Position a 1/2 in. wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress cable housing retaining fingers and start cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Nut: > 05-01-98 > Jan > 98 > Rear
Brakes - Howl During Low Speed Stop > Page 5311
housing out of support plate. Remove the wrench when retainer is free from the park brake cable
mounting hole in the rear of the brake shoe support plate.
10. Remove the four brake support plate to knuckle attaching bolt and washer assemblies.
Separate the brake shoe support plate from the rear suspension knuckle.
11. Transfer all brake hardware to the new backing plate.
NOTE:
THE NEW BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE COMES WITH THE WHEEL CYLINDER
ATTACHED. THE WHEEL CYLINDER ATTACHING BOLTS SHOULD NOT BE LOOSENED OR
REMOVED, AS THE POSITIONING OF THE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER IS CRITICAL.
12. Install the brake support plate and gasket on the rear suspension knuckle casting. Torque the
support plate to knuckle casting bolts to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
13. Insert parking brake cable end fitting into brake support plate.
14. Hand start the hydraulic brake hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Torque tube nut to wheel
cylinder fitting to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
15. Attach parking brake cable to the parking brake actuator.
16. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
17. Install rear hub and bearing assembly onto the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut. Torque hub and bearing assembly retaining nut to 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
Install the dust cap.
18. Adjust brake shoes assemblies so as not to interfere with brake drum installation.
19. Install brake drum. Adjust and bleed service brakes
20. After brake drums are installed, pump brake pedal several times to do final adjustment of the
brake shoe assemblies.
21. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper sequence
until all nuts are torqued to half the specification. Then repeat the tightening sequence to the full
specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
22. Repeat the procedure for the other side.
23. Test drive the vehicle, then visually inspect the rear brake to ensure no brake fluid leaks are
present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5312
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
183 Nm (135 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Stub Axle To Hub Bearing Nut
........................................................................................................................................................
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Wheel Tightening Sequence
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Tightening Sequence
Wheel Torque Sequence - Master
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Wheel Tightening Sequence > Page 5317
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Lug Nut Torque
Lug Nuts ..............................................................................................................................................
................................. 109 - 150 Nm (80 - 110 ft. lbs.) Lug Nut Hex Size .............................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
19 mm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Wheel Tightening Sequence > Page 5318
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Wheel Stud Size
Stud Size .............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ M12 x 1.5 mm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5319
Wheel Fastener: Description and Operation
If wheel attaching studs need to be replaced in the hub and bearing assembly the studs CAN NOT
be hammered out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out of the bearing flange,
damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature bearing failure.
The hub and bearing assembly does not require removal from the steering knuckle or the rear
knuckle to replace the wheel attaching studs in the hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5320
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
CAUTION: If wheel attaching stud needs to be replaced in the hub and bearing assembly the studs
CAN NOT be hammered out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out of the
bearing flange, damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature bearing
failure.
NOTES:
- The following procedure and special tools shown MUST be used when replacing wheel attaching
studs.
- The hub and bearing assembly does not require removal from the steering knuckle to replace
wheel attaching studs in the hub and bearing assembly.
REMOVE
1. Raise vehicle on jackstands or centered on a frame contact type hoist. 2. Remove the front
wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. Remove front disc brake caliper to steering knuckle attaching bolts.
4. Remove disc brake caliper assembly from steering knuckle. Caliper is removed by first lifting
bottom of caliper away from steering knuckle, and
then removing top of caliper out from under steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5321
5. Support the brake caliper assembly using a wire hook, not by the hydraulic flex hose.
6. Remove the braking disc from the front hub.
7. Install a lug nut on wheel stud to be removed from hub and bearing assembly, so threads on
stud are even with end of lug nut. Rotate hub so stud
requiring removal is aligned with notch cast into front of steering knuckle. Install Remover, Special
Tool C-4150, or equivalent on hub and bearing assembly flange and wheel stud.
8. Tighten down on special tool, pushing wheel stud out of the hub and bearing assembly flange.
When shoulder of wheel stud is past flange remove
special tool from hub and bearing assembly. Remove lug nut from stud and remove wheel stud
from flange.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5322
INSTALL
1. Install replacement wheel stud into flange of hub and bearing assembly. Install washers and
wheel lug nut on stud, with flat side of lug nut against
washers.
2. Tighten the wheel lug nut, pulling the wheel stud into the flange of the hub and bearing
assembly. When the head of the stud is fully seated against
the bearing flange, remove lug nut and washers from wheel stud.
3. Install braking disk back on front hub.
4. Install disc brake caliper assembly on steering knuckle. Caliper is installed by first sliding top of
caliper under top abutment on steering knuckle.
Then installing bottom of caliper against bottom abutment of steering knuckle.
5. Install the disc brake caliper assembly to steering knuckle attaching bolts and torque to 31 Nm
(23 ft. lbs.). 6. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install front wheel lug nuts and torque to 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation
The recirculation door actuator is a vacuum controlled actuator used to control movement of the
recirculation door in air conditioned equipped vehicles.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5328
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair
NOTE: The instrument panel must be removed from the vehicle to gain access to the recirculation
door actuator. Refer to: "Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators : Instrument Panel :
Service and Repair" See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel from vehicle. Refer to: "Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators : Instrument Panel : Service and
Repair" See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Service and Repair
Recirculation Door Actuator
2. Disconnect vacuum line from actuator. 3. Remove two nuts retaining vacuum actuator to
recirculation door housing. 4. Disconnect actuator from recirc. door link. 5. Remove recirculation
door actuator from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
For installation reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Adjustments > Mode Control Cable Adjustment
Air Door Cable: Adjustments Mode Control Cable Adjustment
1. Attach cable to actuator arm on mode door and clip black casing against the stop. 2. Attach
other end of cable to instrument panel control. 3. Turn the mode knob completely counterclockwise.
4. While holding the knob in the counterclockwise position, pull on the black casing of the mode
cable. This will take up any free play in the cable
and index the mode door to the mode knob.
5. Then snap the cable hold down clip into position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Adjustments > Mode Control Cable Adjustment > Page 5333
Air Door Cable: Adjustments Temperature Control Cable Adjustment
1. Attach cable to actuator arm on temperature door and clip black casing against the stop. 2.
Attach other end of cable to instrument panel control. 3. Turn the temperature knob completely
counterclockwise. 4. While holding the knob in the counterclockwise position pull on the black
casing of the temperature cable. This will take up any free play in the
cable and index the temperature door to the temperature knob.
5. Then snap the cable hold down clip into position. 6. Remount control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Mode Control Cable Replacement
NOTE: The Mode Control Cable can be removed and installed without having to remove the
instrument panel from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel upper cowl panel.
Bezel Removal
2. Remove right side upper instrument panel bezel.
Instrument Panel Center Vent
3. Remove center vent duct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement > Page 5336
Instrument Panel Defrost Duct
4. Remove upper defrost duct.
Instrument Panel Inner Defrost Duct
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement > Page 5337
5. Remove inner defrost duct. 6. Disconnect cable at heater unit. 7. Disconnect cable at control
panel. 8. Remove cable from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures, adjust cable and test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement > Page 5338
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Temperature Control Cable Replacement
NOTE: The Control Cable can be removed and installed without having to remove the instrument
panel from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Remove instrument panel upper cowl panel.
Bezel Removal
2. Remove right side upper instrument panel bezel. Refer to: "Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators : Instrument Panel : Service
and Repair" See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Center Vent
3. Remove center vent duct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement > Page 5339
Instrument Panel Defrost Duct
4. Remove upper defrost duct.
Instrument Panel Inner Defrost Duct
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Control Cable Replacement > Page 5340
5. Remove inner defrost duct. 6. Disconnect cable at heater unit. 7. Disconnect cable at control
panel. Remove control from instrument panel. 8. Remove cable from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
For installation reverse the above procedures, adjust cable and test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 240397 > Mar > 97 > Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing Temps
Blower Motor: Customer Interest Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing Temps
NO: 24-03-97
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Mar. 14, 1997
SUBJECT:
Blower Motor Does Not Operate In Freezing Temperatures
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-20-96 DATED
DECEMBER 20, 1996, WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1996 TECHNICAL SERVICE
BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-97010). A BLOWER MOTOR FOR A/C
EQUIPPED VEHICLES HAS BEEN ADDED. MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AFTER JULY 1, 1994 (MDH 07-01-XX), OR
VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO JULY 1, 1994 (MDH 07-01-XX) THAT HAVE HAD TECHNICAL
SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-94 PERFORMED. TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-94
INCLUDES THE INSTALLATION OF A DRAIN TUBE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Blower motor may be inoperable in temperatures at/or below freezing.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the blower motor fuse. If blown, inspect the blower motor for presence of ice or water. It
may be necessary to park the vehicle in a warm area to allow the blower motor to begin to thaw
and water to run out to verify the failure mode. If water or ice is found perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
**AR(1) 04644918 Blower Motor (With Air Conditioning)**
AR(1) 04644545 Blower Motor (Without Air Conditioning)
AR(1) 04687835 Fuse, Blower Motor
AR(1) 04783100 Drain Tube
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the positioning of the drain tube assembly and the replacement of the blower
motor and blower motor fuse.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 240397 > Mar > 97 > Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing Temps >
Page 5349
1. The drain tube is located up under the instrument panel to the left of the steering column. The
tube should be routed as shown in Figure 1.
2. If the drain tube is pushed over or pinched as shown in Figure 2, pull the lower end of the drain
and route as shown in Figure 1. If the drain tube will not straighten out to allow repositioning, the
drain tube must be replaced.
3. Insure that the end of the drain tube is properly located down into the sill as far as possible
without kinking the tube.
4. Replace the blower motor/wheel assembly by following the procedure in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) starting on page 24-18.
NOTE:
THE BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR AND CONNECTOR SHOULD BE CHECKED FOR SIGNS OF
DAMAGE AND REPAIRED/REPLACED AS NEEDED.
5. Replace the blower motor fuse and insure blower motor is now operating properly.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-55-01-93 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 240397 > Mar > 97 > Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing
Temps
Blower Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing Temps
NO: 24-03-97
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Mar. 14, 1997
SUBJECT:
Blower Motor Does Not Operate In Freezing Temperatures
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-20-96 DATED
DECEMBER 20, 1996, WHICH SHOULD BE NOTED IN THE 1996 TECHNICAL SERVICE
BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-97010). A BLOWER MOTOR FOR A/C
EQUIPPED VEHICLES HAS BEEN ADDED. MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AFTER JULY 1, 1994 (MDH 07-01-XX), OR
VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO JULY 1, 1994 (MDH 07-01-XX) THAT HAVE HAD TECHNICAL
SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-94 PERFORMED. TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-94
INCLUDES THE INSTALLATION OF A DRAIN TUBE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Blower motor may be inoperable in temperatures at/or below freezing.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the blower motor fuse. If blown, inspect the blower motor for presence of ice or water. It
may be necessary to park the vehicle in a warm area to allow the blower motor to begin to thaw
and water to run out to verify the failure mode. If water or ice is found perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
**AR(1) 04644918 Blower Motor (With Air Conditioning)**
AR(1) 04644545 Blower Motor (Without Air Conditioning)
AR(1) 04687835 Fuse, Blower Motor
AR(1) 04783100 Drain Tube
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the positioning of the drain tube assembly and the replacement of the blower
motor and blower motor fuse.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 240397 > Mar > 97 > Blower Motor - Inoperative In Freezing
Temps > Page 5355
1. The drain tube is located up under the instrument panel to the left of the steering column. The
tube should be routed as shown in Figure 1.
2. If the drain tube is pushed over or pinched as shown in Figure 2, pull the lower end of the drain
and route as shown in Figure 1. If the drain tube will not straighten out to allow repositioning, the
drain tube must be replaced.
3. Insure that the end of the drain tube is properly located down into the sill as far as possible
without kinking the tube.
4. Replace the blower motor/wheel assembly by following the procedure in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication Number 81-270-7025) starting on page 24-18.
NOTE:
THE BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR AND CONNECTOR SHOULD BE CHECKED FOR SIGNS OF
DAMAGE AND REPAIRED/REPLACED AS NEEDED.
5. Replace the blower motor fuse and insure blower motor is now operating properly.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-55-01-93 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5356
Blower Motor: Locations
The blower motor is located on the bottom right side of the evaporator case unit housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Circuit Operation
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
With the ignition switch in the RUN position, power flows from the 25 Amp fuse, in cavity 7 of the
fuse block, to the blower motor. Blower motor speed is controlled by the fan control switch located
in the instrument panel, and the resistor block.
Blower motor LOW speed operation is accomplished on the C4 circuit. When the control switch is
moved to the LOW speed position, current is passed on the C7 circuit through the blower motor
resistor to the C4 circuit. It then flows through the blower motor switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8
circuit terminates at a grounding point on the instrument panel left center support.
The operation of the blower motor M1 and M2 speed operations is the same as the LOW speed
except, the C5 circuit is used for the M1 speed and circuit C6 is used for M2 speed operation.
Blower motor HIGH speed operation is accomplished on the C7 circuit which supplies battery
voltage directly to the blower motor. There are no resistors used in the HIGH speed mode.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 5359
Blower Motor: Description and Operation System Operation
BLOWER MOTOR OPERATION
With the ignition switch in the RUN position, power flows from the 25 amp fuse, in cavity 7 of the
fuse block, to the blower motor. Blower motor speed is controlled by the fan control switch located
in the instrument panel, and by the resistor block.
Blower motor low-speed operation is accomplished on the C4 circuit. When the control switch is
moved to the low-speed position, current flows from the C7 circuit, through the blower motor
resistor, to the C4 circuit. It then flows through the blower motor switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8
circuit terminates at a grounding point located at the instrument panel left center support.
The operation of the blower motor M1 and M2 speed operations is the same as the low-speed
except that circuit C5 is used for the M1 speed, and circuit C6 is used for M2 speed operation.
Blower motor high-speed operation is accomplished on the C7 circuit, which supplies battery
voltage directly to the blower motor There are no resistors used in the high-speed mode.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Flow of Diagnosis
Blower Motor: Flow of Diagnosis
Blower Motor Noise and Vibration Diagnosis
Blower Motor Noise/Vibration Diagnosis
The resistor block supplies the blower motor with varied voltage (low and middle speeds) or battery
voltage (high speed).
CAUTION: Blower motor resistor block can be very hot, use caution when working on or near it. Do
not operate the blower motor with the resistor block removed from the heater-A/C housing.
Refer to the Blower Motor Vioration/Noise chart for diagnosis.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Flow of Diagnosis > Page 5362
Blower Motor Electrical Diagnosis
Blower Motor Electrical Diagnosis
For Blower motor electrical diagnosis refer to the above chart and also see Diagrams/Electrial.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Flow of Diagnosis > Page 5363
Blower Motor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
- Check the 30 Amp fuse located in the PDC for the radiator fan motor
- Check the 15 Amp fuse located in cavity 10 of the fuse block for the A/C compressor clutch relay
- Check the 10 Amp fuse located in the PDC for the A/C compressor clutch relay.
- Check the 25 Amp fuse located in cavity 7 of the fuse block for the blower motor.
- Check the right headlamp ground located at the right fender side shield.
- Check the left headlamp ground located on the left side of the radiator closure panel.
- On vehicles equipped with A/C check the refrigerant level. The system will not operate with a low
level of refrigerant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
With A/C
Blower Motor: Service and Repair With A/C
NOTE: The blower motor can be removed from the vehicle without having to remove the unit
housing assembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove right side scuff plate. 2. Pull back carpet. 3. Cut wheel housing silencer in line with
blower motor wiring. 4. Disconnect blower motor wiring connector. 5. Right Hand Drive (RHD)
vehicle remove the motor cover.
Blower Motor Retaining Screws
6. Remove three blower motor retaining screws. 7. Lower blower motor assembly from unit
housing.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures. Then tape silencer into position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
With A/C > Page 5366
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Without A/C
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect blower motor wiring connector.
Blower Motor Removal
2. Grasp the blower motor while pulling down tab. Turn approximately 1/8 turn counterclockwise
and remove blower motor assembly from unit
housing.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations
Resistor Block
The blower motor resistor is located in the cowl, at the base of the windshield. There are two
different resistor blocks depending on whether the vehicle is equipped with A/C or not.
WARNING: The blower motor resistors will get hot when in use. Do not touch resistor block if the
blower motor has been running.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5370
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Blower motor resistor block can be very hot, use caution when working on or near it. Do
not operate the blower motor with the resistor block removed.
REMOVAL
1. Remove windshield wipers. 2. Remove cowl top screen. 3. Disconnect the resistor block wiring
connector. 4. Remove two resistor block retaining screws. The screw threads attaching the resistor
block are not full length. It is necessary to gently pry out the
resistor block while turning the screws counterclockwise enabling the threads to engages.
5. Remove resistor block from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Blower Motor Switch: Testing and Inspection
Heater A/C Blower Switch Test
1. Remove Heater A/C control module.
Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Blower Switch Test. 3. If the switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace Heater A/C Control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7
check the lamps, replace if necessary.
Heater Blower Switch Test
1. Remove heater control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5374
Heater Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Heater Blower Test. 3. If switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace heater control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7 check the
lamps, replace if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5375
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
The switch is not serviced, replace heater A/C control. Refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning/Control Assembly/service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
Clutch Air Gap .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 0.35 - 0.65 mm (0.014 - 0.026 in.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Clutch Relay Operation
Compressor Clutch: Description and Operation A/C Clutch Relay Operation
Theory of Operation:
The A/C compressor clutch relay controls the 12 volt source for the A/C clutch. The relay is located
in the power distribution center. One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the
ignition switch is turned to the run position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay
coil is grounded by the powertrain control module (PCM). When A/C is requested, the PCM adjusts
the idle speed to accommodate the A/C compressor load on the engine. The PCM grounds the
relay control circuit after the PCM receives an A/C request and adjustment of the idle speed has
been implemented.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Clutch Relay Operation > Page 5382
Compressor Clutch: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Name of Code:
A/C Clutch Relay Circuit
When Monitored:
With the ignition key in the run position and battery voltage above 10 volts.
Set Condition:
An open or shorted condition is detected in the A/C clutch relay control circuit.
Theory of Operation:
The A/C compressor clutch relay controls the 12 volt source for the A/C clutch. The relay is located
in the power distribution center. One side of the relay control coil is supplied with 12 volts when the
ignition switch is turned to the run position. The circuit is completed when the other side of the relay
coil is grounded by the powertrain control module (PCM). When A/C is requested, the PCM adjusts
the idle speed to accommodate the A/C compressor load on the engine. The PCM grounds the
relay control circuit after the PCM receives an A/C request and adjustment of the idle speed has
been implemented.
Possible Causes:
- Relay coil open or shorted
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Compressor clutch relay control circuit open or shorted
- Inoperative circuit driver in powertrain control module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5383
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Compressor assembly must be removed from mounting. Although, refrigerant discharge is
not necessary.
Compressor Shaft Bolt And Clutch Plate
1. Remove the compressor shaft bolt. A band type oil filter removal tool can be placed around the
clutch plate to aid in bolt removal.
Clutch Plate And Shims
2. Tap the clutch plate with a plastic hammer and remove clutch plate and shim(s).
CAUTION: Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front
plate as this may damage the front plate assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5384
Removing Pulley Snap Ring
3. Remove pulley retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers (C-4574), and slide pulley assembly off
of compressor. 4. Remove coil wire bracket/ground clip screw and wire harness.
Clutch Coil Snap Ring
5. Remove snap ring retaining field coil onto compressor housing. Slide field coil off of compressor
housing. 6. Examine frictional faces of the clutch pulley and front plate for wear. The pulley and
front plate should be replaced if there is excessive wear or
scoring. If the friction surfaces are oily, inspect the shaft nose area of the compressor for oil and
remove the felt from the front cover. If the compressor felt is saturated with oil, the shaft seal is
leaking and will have to be replaced.
7. Check bearing for roughness or excessive leakage of grease. Replace bearing as required.
INSTALLATION
1. Align pin in back of field coil with hole in compressor end housing, and position field coil into
place. Make sure that lead wires are properly
routed, and fasten the diode and coil wire bracket with retaining screw.
2. Install field coil retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers (C- 4574). Press snap ring to make
sure it is properly seated in the groove.
NOTE: The bevel side of the snap ring must be outward. Also both eyelets must be to the right or
left of the pin on the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5385
CAUTION: If snap ring is not fully seated it will vibrate out, resulting in a clutch failure and severe
damage to the front face of the compressor.
CAUTION: Do not mar the pulley frictional surface.
Installing Pulley Assembly
3. Install pulley assembly to compressor. If necessary, tap gently with a block of wood on the
friction surface. 4. Install pulley assembly retaining snap ring (bevel side outward) with Snap Ring
Pliers (C-4574). Press the snap ring to make sure it is properly
seated in the groove.
NOTE: The bevel side of the snap ring must be facing outward.
5. If the original front plate assembly and pulley assembly are to be reused, the old shim(s) can be
used. If not, place a trial stack of shims, 2.54 mm
(0.10 in.) thick, on the shaft against the shoulder.
6. Install front plate assembly onto shaft. 7. If installing a new front plate and/or pulley assembly,
the gap between front plate and pulley face must be checked. Use the following procedure:
- Attach a dial indicator to front plate so that movement of the plate can be measured.
- With the dial indicator zeroed on the front plate, energize the clutch and record the amount of
movement.
- The readings should be 0.35 to 0.65 mm (0.014 to 0.026 in.). If proper reading is not obtained,
add or subtract shims until desired reading is obtained.
8. Install compressor shaft bolt. Tighten to 15.5 to 19.5 N.m (135 to 175 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Shims may compress after tightening shaft nut. Check air gap in four or more places to
verify if air gap is still correct. Spin pulley for final check.
CLUTCH BREAK-IN
After new clutch installation, cycle the A/C clutch 20 times (5 seconds ON and 5 seconds OFF).
During this procedure, set the system to the A/C mode, engine rpm at 1500-2000, and high blower
speed. This procedure (burnishing) will seat the opposing friction surfaces and provide a higher
clutch torque capability.
NOTE: Excessive clutch gap will result in clutch slippage or non-engagement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Compressor assembly must be removed from mounting. Although, refrigerant discharge is
not necessary.
Compressor Shaft Bolt And Clutch Plate
1. Remove the compressor shaft bolt. A band type oil filter removal tool can be placed around the
clutch plate to aid in bolt removal.
Clutch Plate And Shims
2. Tap the clutch plate with a plastic hammer and remove clutch plate and shim(s).
CAUTION: Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front
plate as this may damage the front plate assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5389
Removing Pulley Snap Ring
3. Remove pulley retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers (C-4574), and slide pulley assembly off
of compressor. 4. Remove coil wire bracket/ground clip screw and wire harness.
Clutch Coil Snap Ring
5. Remove snap ring retaining field coil onto compressor housing. Slide field coil off of compressor
housing. 6. Examine frictional faces of the clutch pulley and front plate for wear. The pulley and
front plate should be replaced if there is excessive wear or
scoring. If the friction surfaces are oily, inspect the shaft nose area of the compressor for oil and
remove the felt from the front cover. If the compressor felt is saturated with oil, the shaft seal is
leaking and will have to be replaced.
7. Check bearing for roughness or excessive leakage of grease. Replace bearing as required.
INSTALLATION
1. Align pin in back of field coil with hole in compressor end housing, and position field coil into
place. Make sure that lead wires are properly
routed, and fasten the diode and coil wire bracket with retaining screw.
2. Install field coil retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers (C- 4574). Press snap ring to make
sure it is properly seated in the groove.
NOTE: The bevel side of the snap ring must be outward. Also both eyelets must be to the right or
left of the pin on the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5390
CAUTION: If snap ring is not fully seated it will vibrate out, resulting in a clutch failure and severe
damage to the front face of the compressor.
CAUTION: Do not mar the pulley frictional surface.
Installing Pulley Assembly
3. Install pulley assembly to compressor. If necessary, tap gently with a block of wood on the
friction surface. 4. Install pulley assembly retaining snap ring (bevel side outward) with Snap Ring
Pliers (C-4574). Press the snap ring to make sure it is properly
seated in the groove.
NOTE: The bevel side of the snap ring must be facing outward.
5. If the original front plate assembly and pulley assembly are to be reused, the old shim(s) can be
used. If not, place a trial stack of shims, 2.54 mm
(0.10 in.) thick, on the shaft against the shoulder.
6. Install front plate assembly onto shaft. 7. If installing a new front plate and/or pulley assembly,
the gap between front plate and pulley face must be checked. Use the following procedure:
- Attach a dial indicator to front plate so that movement of the plate can be measured.
- With the dial indicator zeroed on the front plate, energize the clutch and record the amount of
movement.
- The readings should be 0.35 to 0.65 mm (0.014 to 0.026 in.). If proper reading is not obtained,
add or subtract shims until desired reading is obtained.
8. Install compressor shaft bolt. Tighten to 15.5 to 19.5 N.m (135 to 175 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Shims may compress after tightening shaft nut. Check air gap in four or more places to
verify if air gap is still correct. Spin pulley for final check.
CLUTCH BREAK-IN
After new clutch installation, cycle the A/C clutch 20 times (5 seconds ON and 5 seconds OFF).
During this procedure, set the system to the A/C mode, engine rpm at 1500-2000, and high blower
speed. This procedure (burnishing) will seat the opposing friction surfaces and provide a higher
clutch torque capability.
NOTE: Excessive clutch gap will result in clutch slippage or non-engagement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Compressor Shaft Seal: Service and Repair
COMPRESSOR FRONT SHAFT SEAL
The compressor front shaft seal is not serviceable. If a leak is detected at the shaft seal, the
compressor must be replaced as a unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
The condenser is located in front of the engine radiator. It has no serviceable parts. If damaged or
leaking, the condenser assembly must be replaced.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE SYSTEM BEFORE
REMOVING THE CONDENSER.
REMOVAL 1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C
system. 2. Remove battery support strut. 3. Remove refrigerant lines from condenser. 4. Remove
upper radiator mounts. 5. Remove condenser to radiator mounting screws. 6. Tilt radiator back and
remove condenser.
INSTALLATION For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Solid State Relay
The relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations > Page 5403
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater-A/C Control Lamp Replacement
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Heater-A/C Control Lamp Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Heater A/C Control. 2. Remove the two center knobs by pulling the knob rearward.
3. Replace the lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater-A/C Control Lamp Replacement > Page 5408
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Heater-A/C Control Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel. 2. Reach in and disconnect the wiring connector(s) for
the rear window defogger and/or fog lamp switch(s) as required. 3. Remove the six attaching
screws across the forward portion of the trim panel. Then lift the flange forward to disengage the
three locator pins. 4. Pull panel rearward disengaging the clips along the bottom. 5. Open the ash
receiver. 6. Remove the center bezel.
Heater A/C Control
7. Remove three attaching screws at corners of the control 8. Pull the control rearward and
disconnect the wiring connector. 9. Using a screwdriver, disengage the cable attachment clips.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits Odors
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-11-97 Date: 970711
A/C Evaporator - Emits Odors
NO: 24-11-97
GROUP: Heater & A/C
DATE: Jul. 11, 1997
SUBJECT: A/C Evaporator Odor
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-06-95 REV. A, DATED
MAY 26, 1995, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1995
SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-96084). THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO **ASTERISKS** ARE USED TO HIGHLIGHT THE CHANGES.
MODELS:
1992 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1994 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1992 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1992 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1992 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron Convertible
1992 - 1998 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1992 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 1998 (BR) Ram Pickup
1993 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1996 - 1998 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
1995 - 1998 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - 1998 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1996 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1998 (TJ) Wrangler
1992 - 1998 (XJ) Cherokee
1994 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market)
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core.
During normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the A/C evaporator. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
Operate the A/C system, if a musty odor is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 O4897625AA Cleaner, Aerosol Evaporator
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
24-65-02-93 AA, AC, AG, AJ, AY, PL, TJ, XJ, ZJ 0.7 Hrs.
AB, AN, AP, BR, GS, JA, JX, NS 0.6 Hrs.
LH 1.5 Hrs.
AS, ES 1.0 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits Odors > Page
5417
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves or other foreign material in the evaporator and HVAC
housing and applying Mopar aerosol evaporator cleaner.
NOTE:
FOLLOW ALL CAUTIONS AND WARNING SUPPLIED WITH THE AEROSOL EVAPORATOR
CLEANER; KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN; AVOID CONTACT WITH SKIN OR EYES;
WEAR SKIN AND EYE PROTECTION, IF SKIN OR EYE CONTACT OCCURS, WASH SKIN OR
FLUSH EYES WITH GENEROUS AMOUNTS OF WATER; AVOID BREATHING VAPORS.
1. Inspect the evaporator and HVAC housing for leaves or other foreign material that may be
blocking the air flow through the evaporator. If the build up is excessive replacement of the
evaporator may be required.
2. With the parking brake applied and the transmission in Park, start the engine and let idle. Put the
temperature control to full hot, blower speed to HIGH, select the PANEL and RE-CIRCULATE
modes. Open all windows about 13 mm (1/2 in.). Disable the A/C compressor clutch by
disconnecting its wiring connector or the wiring connector to the A/C pressure switch.
NOTE:
THIS PROCEDURE HEATS THE EVAPORATOR AND CAUSES MOISTURE TO EVAPORATE
FASTER. THE SLIGHTLY OPEN WINDOWS ALLOW MOISTURE TO ESCAPE THE VEHICLE
WITHOUT LOOSING MUCH HEAT. SOMETIMES, YOU MAY SEE A "FOG" CLOUDING THE
WINDOWS. AFTER THIS "FOG" HAS DISAPPEARED CONTINUE TO OPERATE THE HEATER
FOR ANOTHER 5 MINUTES. IF THE "FOG" NEVER APPEARED, OPERATE THE HEATER FOR
A MINIMUM OF 30 MINUTES.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Gain access to the evaporator cavity to apply the evaporator cleaner by:
AB, 1992-93 AN, GS, JA, JX, LH, NS and PL - Remove evaporator fin temperature sensor access
grommet. DO NOT REMOVE THE PROBE FROM THE EVAPORATOR.
BR, TJ, XJ, ZG, ZJ - Remove blower resistor.
For the above vehicles, place a piece of heavy masking tape over the opening in the evaporator
housing where the fin temperature sensor access grommet or blower resistor was removed, then
punch a small hole for the evaporator cleaner tube to be inserted into.
AA, AC, AG, AJ, AP, and AY - Remove the screw attaching the right side floor duct. Use an 1/8 in.
drill bit to drill through the bottom of the screw hole, Figure 1.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits Odors > Page
5418
1994-98 AN - Drill an 1/8 in. hole at the mid-point of the rounded corner created by the intersection
of the vertical and horizontal surfaces of the HVAC housing, refer to Figure 2. Place tape around
the drill bit to prevent the bit from entering the housing more a 1/4 in.
AS, ES - Remove the lower right instrument panel. Remove the blower motor cover. Make a
template as illustrated below and drill an 1/8 in. hole as shown in Figure 3. Be sure to angle drill as
illustrated.
Shake evaporator cleaner aerosol can well and insert the application tube in the access hole
created in step 3.
NOTE:
THE APPLICATION TUBE HAS A BLACK MARK AND A RED MARK ON IT INDICATING HOW
FAR THE TUBE SHOULD BE INSERTED INTO THE EVAPORATOR CAVITY. THE RED MARK
IS FOR AA, AC, AG, AJ, AP, AND AY BODY VEHICLES. THE BLACK MARK IS FOR ALL OTHER
VEHICLES.
5. Start the engine and let idle. Set the blower motor to HIGH.
6. Put on goggles and dust mask type breathing protection.
7. Spray the entire contents of the evaporator cleaner into the evaporator cavity.
NOTE:
A "FOG" MAY BE SEEN ENTERING THE PASSENGER COMPARTMENT WHILE THE
EVAPORATOR CLEANER IS BEING SPRAYED. THE EVAPORATOR CLEANER WILL NOT
STAIN OR HARM THE VEHICLE INTERIOR, BUT GOGGLES AND BREATHING PROTECTION
MUST BE WORN DURING CLEANER APPLICATION. DO NOT BREATH VAPORS!
8. When the can is empty, turn the ignition switch to the OFF position and let the vehicle sit for 20
minutes. This time will allow the cleaner to flow over and coat the evaporator fins and case
assembly.
9. Install whatever components that were removed to gain access for application of the cleaner. On
AS, ES and 1994-1998 AN, seal the access hole drilled in step 3
NOTE:
OWNERS OF NS/GS VEHICLES THAT OPERATE IN CONDITIONS WHERE THE AIR INLET TO
THE HVAC HOUSING IS SUBJECT TO FOREIGN MATERIAL, DEBRIS OR OTHER AIRBORNE
CONTAMINATES, MAY WANT TO CONSIDER HAVING A MOPAR ACCESSORY CABIN AIR
FILTER KIT INSTALLED, P/N 82202509. USE THE INSTRUCTIONS PACKAGED WITH THE KIT
TO INSTALL IT.
10. Open all of the vehicle windows about 13 mm (1/2 in.). Start the engine and let idle for a
MINIMUM of 30 minutes with the temperature control to full hot, blower speed to HIGH, PANEL
and RE-CIRCULATE modes selected. This will dry and cure the evaporator cleaner onto the
evaporator coil.
11. Connect the wiring disconnected in step 2 to re-enable the A/C compressor clutch.
12. Verify proper A/C operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits
Odors
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-11-97 Date: 970711
A/C Evaporator - Emits Odors
NO: 24-11-97
GROUP: Heater & A/C
DATE: Jul. 11, 1997
SUBJECT: A/C Evaporator Odor
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-06-95 REV. A, DATED
MAY 26, 1995, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1995
SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-96084). THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO **ASTERISKS** ARE USED TO HIGHLIGHT THE CHANGES.
MODELS:
1992 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1994 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1992 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1992 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1992 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron Convertible
1992 - 1998 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1992 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 1998 (BR) Ram Pickup
1993 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market)
1996 - 1998 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
1995 - 1998 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1996 - 1998 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - 1998 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision
1996 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1998 (TJ) Wrangler
1992 - 1998 (XJ) Cherokee
1994 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market)
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core.
During normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the A/C evaporator. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
Operate the A/C system, if a musty odor is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 O4897625AA Cleaner, Aerosol Evaporator
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No:
24-65-02-93 AA, AC, AG, AJ, AY, PL, TJ, XJ, ZJ 0.7 Hrs.
AB, AN, AP, BR, GS, JA, JX, NS 0.6 Hrs.
LH 1.5 Hrs.
AS, ES 1.0 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits
Odors > Page 5424
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves or other foreign material in the evaporator and HVAC
housing and applying Mopar aerosol evaporator cleaner.
NOTE:
FOLLOW ALL CAUTIONS AND WARNING SUPPLIED WITH THE AEROSOL EVAPORATOR
CLEANER; KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN; AVOID CONTACT WITH SKIN OR EYES;
WEAR SKIN AND EYE PROTECTION, IF SKIN OR EYE CONTACT OCCURS, WASH SKIN OR
FLUSH EYES WITH GENEROUS AMOUNTS OF WATER; AVOID BREATHING VAPORS.
1. Inspect the evaporator and HVAC housing for leaves or other foreign material that may be
blocking the air flow through the evaporator. If the build up is excessive replacement of the
evaporator may be required.
2. With the parking brake applied and the transmission in Park, start the engine and let idle. Put the
temperature control to full hot, blower speed to HIGH, select the PANEL and RE-CIRCULATE
modes. Open all windows about 13 mm (1/2 in.). Disable the A/C compressor clutch by
disconnecting its wiring connector or the wiring connector to the A/C pressure switch.
NOTE:
THIS PROCEDURE HEATS THE EVAPORATOR AND CAUSES MOISTURE TO EVAPORATE
FASTER. THE SLIGHTLY OPEN WINDOWS ALLOW MOISTURE TO ESCAPE THE VEHICLE
WITHOUT LOOSING MUCH HEAT. SOMETIMES, YOU MAY SEE A "FOG" CLOUDING THE
WINDOWS. AFTER THIS "FOG" HAS DISAPPEARED CONTINUE TO OPERATE THE HEATER
FOR ANOTHER 5 MINUTES. IF THE "FOG" NEVER APPEARED, OPERATE THE HEATER FOR
A MINIMUM OF 30 MINUTES.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Gain access to the evaporator cavity to apply the evaporator cleaner by:
AB, 1992-93 AN, GS, JA, JX, LH, NS and PL - Remove evaporator fin temperature sensor access
grommet. DO NOT REMOVE THE PROBE FROM THE EVAPORATOR.
BR, TJ, XJ, ZG, ZJ - Remove blower resistor.
For the above vehicles, place a piece of heavy masking tape over the opening in the evaporator
housing where the fin temperature sensor access grommet or blower resistor was removed, then
punch a small hole for the evaporator cleaner tube to be inserted into.
AA, AC, AG, AJ, AP, and AY - Remove the screw attaching the right side floor duct. Use an 1/8 in.
drill bit to drill through the bottom of the screw hole, Figure 1.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Case: > 24-11-97 > Jul > 97 > A/C Evaporator - Emits
Odors > Page 5425
1994-98 AN - Drill an 1/8 in. hole at the mid-point of the rounded corner created by the intersection
of the vertical and horizontal surfaces of the HVAC housing, refer to Figure 2. Place tape around
the drill bit to prevent the bit from entering the housing more a 1/4 in.
AS, ES - Remove the lower right instrument panel. Remove the blower motor cover. Make a
template as illustrated below and drill an 1/8 in. hole as shown in Figure 3. Be sure to angle drill as
illustrated.
Shake evaporator cleaner aerosol can well and insert the application tube in the access hole
created in step 3.
NOTE:
THE APPLICATION TUBE HAS A BLACK MARK AND A RED MARK ON IT INDICATING HOW
FAR THE TUBE SHOULD BE INSERTED INTO THE EVAPORATOR CAVITY. THE RED MARK
IS FOR AA, AC, AG, AJ, AP, AND AY BODY VEHICLES. THE BLACK MARK IS FOR ALL OTHER
VEHICLES.
5. Start the engine and let idle. Set the blower motor to HIGH.
6. Put on goggles and dust mask type breathing protection.
7. Spray the entire contents of the evaporator cleaner into the evaporator cavity.
NOTE:
A "FOG" MAY BE SEEN ENTERING THE PASSENGER COMPARTMENT WHILE THE
EVAPORATOR CLEANER IS BEING SPRAYED. THE EVAPORATOR CLEANER WILL NOT
STAIN OR HARM THE VEHICLE INTERIOR, BUT GOGGLES AND BREATHING PROTECTION
MUST BE WORN DURING CLEANER APPLICATION. DO NOT BREATH VAPORS!
8. When the can is empty, turn the ignition switch to the OFF position and let the vehicle sit for 20
minutes. This time will allow the cleaner to flow over and coat the evaporator fins and case
assembly.
9. Install whatever components that were removed to gain access for application of the cleaner. On
AS, ES and 1994-1998 AN, seal the access hole drilled in step 3
NOTE:
OWNERS OF NS/GS VEHICLES THAT OPERATE IN CONDITIONS WHERE THE AIR INLET TO
THE HVAC HOUSING IS SUBJECT TO FOREIGN MATERIAL, DEBRIS OR OTHER AIRBORNE
CONTAMINATES, MAY WANT TO CONSIDER HAVING A MOPAR ACCESSORY CABIN AIR
FILTER KIT INSTALLED, P/N 82202509. USE THE INSTRUCTIONS PACKAGED WITH THE KIT
TO INSTALL IT.
10. Open all of the vehicle windows about 13 mm (1/2 in.). Start the engine and let idle for a
MINIMUM of 30 minutes with the temperature control to full hot, blower speed to HIGH, PANEL
and RE-CIRCULATE modes selected. This will dry and cure the evaporator cleaner onto the
evaporator coil.
11. Connect the wiring disconnected in step 2 to re-enable the A/C compressor clutch.
12. Verify proper A/C operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-006-06 Date: 060810
A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
NUMBER: 24-006-06
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Approval Pending
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-013-05, DATED AUGUST
4, 2005, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL MODEL, YEAR AND
REVISED AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: A/C Cooling Coil Odor
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves and other foreign material, cleaning, and
treating the cooling coil and housing.
MODELS:
1995-2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1995-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - **2007** (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2007** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
2004 - **2007** (HB) Durango
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - **2007** (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/LHS/New Yorker/Intrepid/Vision
2005 - **2007** (LX) 300/**Charger**/Magnum
2005 - **2007** (ND) Dakota
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - **2007** (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - **2007** (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - **2007** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WJ/WG) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2007** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2007** (XK**/XH)** Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5434
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the cooling coil. During
normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the NC cooling coil. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the operator describes, or the technician experiences a musty odor when operating the A/C
system, perform the appropriate Repair Procedure based on the vehicle model.
PARTS REQUIRED:
A/C COOLING COIL CLEANER REQUIREMENTS BY VEHICLE MODEL
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5435
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK Vehicle Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH (2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles skip to step 8) (AB/CS**
vehicles proceed to next step), raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
4. On **2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), fabricate the cooling coil
drain plug as follows (Fig. 1):
a. Gather a 457.2 mm (18 in.) long, 9.8 mm (3/8 in.) drive socket extension; a deep 12 mm, 9.8 mm
(3/8 in.) drive socket, and a 152.4 mm (6 in.) piece of 15.9 mm (5/8 in.) ID heater hose, p/n
HHR00058AA
b. Place the socket on the end of the extension. Slide approximately 25.4 mm (1 in.) of the heater
hose over the socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5436
c. Slip the heater hose over the cooling coil drain tube, located above the right side of the
transmission using the socket and extension to reach up between the frame and the exhaust.
Leave the hose socket and extension in place (Fig. 2). Proceed to Step # 7.
5. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap/clamp.
6. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 12, other vehicles proceed to next step.
7. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
8. Remove passenger side floor mat.
9. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
10. On LX/RS/**WH/WK/XH**XK vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the glove
box to gain access to the blower motor resistor /power module. Refer to the detailed service
information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, Instrument Panel, Glove
Box
11. On LX/**WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles, remove the passenger side instrument panel silencer. Refer
to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body,
Instrument Panel, Instrument Panel Silencer. On 2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles remove the
blower motor and use a shop vacuum to clean the evaporator coil, reinstall the blower motor and
skip to step 18. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
12. Remove the 2 screws securing the blower motor resistor/power module in the NC housing and
remove the blower motor resistor/power module. Do not disconnect the electrical connector.
13. On LX/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), proceed to Step # 18
14. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C
air filter, remove the A/C air filter. Refer to the detailed service information available in
TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. If not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C air filter,
install the air filter door (do not install the air filter at this time).
18. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5437
19. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
20. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
21. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor/power module opening.
22. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
23. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
24. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 27. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
25. Remove the cap/clamp from the drain tube.
26. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
27. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
28. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
29. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening.
30. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
31. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
32. Start the engine.
33. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
34. Set the blower to HIGH.
35. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
36. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
37. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
38. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
39. Allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
41. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 44. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
42. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap.
43. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK/** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
44. Open all windows in the vehicle.
45. Remove the blower motor resistor/power module.
46. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5438
47. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
48. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
49. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
50. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 53. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
51. Remove the drain tube cap/clamp.
52. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
53. Start the engine.
54. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
55. Set the blower to HIGH.
56. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
57. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
58. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
59. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
60. Allow the engine to run for 20 minutes.
61. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
62. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
63. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 67. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
64. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
65. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 72, CS vehicles proceed to Step # 68, LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK**
vehicles proceed to Step # 66.
66. Lower the vehicle.
67. On **LX/WH/WK/XH/XK** vehicles (RS vehicles proceed to next step), install the right silencer
pad.
68. Install the glove box.
69. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to the next step. If equipped with an
A/C filter, remove the air filter door and install the A/C air filter. Replace with a new filter, if
necessary. See the parts table for the appropriate part number filter.
70. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
71. Install the floor mat.
72. Close the hood.
AN/DN/DR/HB/JR/KJ/LH/ND/PL/PT/TJ/WG/WJ Vehicles Procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5439
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
3. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle on a suitable hoist.
4. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), remove the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
5. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
6. On AN/DN/DR/HB/KJ vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), cap off the drain tube using
a suitable cap. When the drain tube is capped off, proceed to Step # 9.
7. On ND vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), plug the cooling coil drain using a piece of
plastic or a shop towel. When the drain tube is plugged, proceed to Step #9.
8. Clamp off the drain tube.
9. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
10. Remove passenger side floor mat.
11. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
12. If applicable, remove the silencer pad from under the instrument panel on the right side to gain
access to the blower motor.
13. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the lower right under panel duct
and blower motor cover.
14. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, and protective clothing.
NOTE:
No occupants should be in the vehicle during material application.
18. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
19. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
20. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner
onto the cooling coil until the required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number
of bottles).
21. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
22. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
23. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
24. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
25. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
26. One at a time, screw each bottle of normal tap water onto the applicator tool.
27. Spray all of the normal tap water onto the cooling coil until each bottle is empty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5440
28. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
29. Connect the negative battery cable.
30. Start the engine.
31. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
32. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
33. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
34. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
35. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
36. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
37. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
38. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
39. Install the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
40. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
41. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
42. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
43. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
44. Shake an 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
45. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle on
the cooling coil being carefully to cover the entire surface of the cooling coil.
46. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
47. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
48. Connect the negative battery cable.
49. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
50. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap.
51. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower the
vehicle.
52. Start the engine.
53. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
54. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
55. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
56. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5441
57. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
58. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
59. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
60. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
61. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
62. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
63. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), install the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
64. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
65. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), install the blower motor cover and lower
right under panel duct.
66. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
67. If applicable, install the silencer pad under the right side of the instrument panel.
68. Install floor mat.
69. Close the hood.
ST Vehicle Procedure
1. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
2. Remove passenger side floor mat.
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
4. Remove the joint duct. Refer to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT,
under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Blower Assembly and Resistor, Joint Duct.
5. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
6. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
7. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
8. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
9. Insert the applicator tool into the opening created by the joint duct removal.
10. Spray the full contents of 2 bottles of cooling coil cleaner onto the evaporator, moving the tool
so that the evaporator is completely covered, until both bottles are empty (16 oz. total).
11. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
12. Fill both of the empty cooling coil cleaner bottles with normal tap water.
13. Screw one bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
14. Insert the applicator tool into the opening of the heater/cooler unit at the evaporator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5442
15. Spray the full contents of water until the bottle is empty.
16. Repeat Step #13 through Step #15 using the second bottle of water. When both bottles of
water are empty, proceed to the next step.
17. Install the joint duct.
18. Disconnect the A/C clutch electrical connector at the A/C compressor.
19. Start the engine.
20. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
21. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
22. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
23. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
24. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
25. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
26. Turn the engine off.
27. Turn the ignition switch ON, do not start the engine, to allow blower motor operation.
28. Fully open all windows.
29. Remove the outer glove box and the inner glove box. Refer to the detailed service information
available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, 23C Body Interior, Instrument Panel
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
30. Shake the 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
31. Insert the applicator tool into the recirculation inlet (behind glove box opening). Spray the full
contents of the bottle in the airstream until the bottle is empty.
32. Start the engine.
33. Set the blower to HIGH.
34. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
35. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
36. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
37. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
38. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
39. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the off position.
41. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
42. Connect the A/C compressor clutch electrical connector at the compressor.
43. Open the right side panel outlet vent.
44. Install inner glove box.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5443
45. Install outer glove box.
46. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
47. Install floor mat.
VA Vehicle Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
2. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
3. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Remove the HVAC filter cover and HVAC filter. Refer to the detailed service information available
in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
6. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
7. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
8. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
9. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (pin 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
10. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
11. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
12. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
13. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
14. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
15. Remove the clamp from the drain tube.
16. Lower the vehicle.
17. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
18. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
19. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
20. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
21. Install the HVAC filter cover (do not install the HVAC filter at this time).
22. Start the engine.
23. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
24. Set the blower to HIGH.
25. Set the A/C switch to NC OFF.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5444
26. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
27. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
28. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
29. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
30. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
31. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
32. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
33. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
34. Open all windows in the vehicle.
35. Remove the HVAC filter cover.
36. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
37. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
38. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
39. Install the HVAC filter. Replace with a new filter, p/n 05103600AA, if necessary.
40. Install the HVAC filter cover.
41. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
42. Remove the drain tube clamp.
43. Lower the vehicle.
44. Start the engine.
45. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
46. Set the blower to HIGH.
47. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
48. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
49. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
50. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
51. With the engine running, allow the blower motor to operate for 20 minutes.
52. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
53. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
54. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5445
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
55. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
56. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-006-06 Date: 060810
A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
NUMBER: 24-006-06
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Approval Pending
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-013-05, DATED AUGUST
4, 2005, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL MODEL, YEAR AND
REVISED AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: A/C Cooling Coil Odor
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves and other foreign material, cleaning, and
treating the cooling coil and housing.
MODELS:
1995-2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1995-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - **2007** (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2007** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
2004 - **2007** (HB) Durango
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - **2007** (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/LHS/New Yorker/Intrepid/Vision
2005 - **2007** (LX) 300/**Charger**/Magnum
2005 - **2007** (ND) Dakota
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - **2007** (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - **2007** (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - **2007** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WJ/WG) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2007** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2007** (XK**/XH)** Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5451
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the cooling coil. During
normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the NC cooling coil. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the operator describes, or the technician experiences a musty odor when operating the A/C
system, perform the appropriate Repair Procedure based on the vehicle model.
PARTS REQUIRED:
A/C COOLING COIL CLEANER REQUIREMENTS BY VEHICLE MODEL
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5452
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK Vehicle Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH (2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles skip to step 8) (AB/CS**
vehicles proceed to next step), raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
4. On **2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), fabricate the cooling coil
drain plug as follows (Fig. 1):
a. Gather a 457.2 mm (18 in.) long, 9.8 mm (3/8 in.) drive socket extension; a deep 12 mm, 9.8 mm
(3/8 in.) drive socket, and a 152.4 mm (6 in.) piece of 15.9 mm (5/8 in.) ID heater hose, p/n
HHR00058AA
b. Place the socket on the end of the extension. Slide approximately 25.4 mm (1 in.) of the heater
hose over the socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5453
c. Slip the heater hose over the cooling coil drain tube, located above the right side of the
transmission using the socket and extension to reach up between the frame and the exhaust.
Leave the hose socket and extension in place (Fig. 2). Proceed to Step # 7.
5. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap/clamp.
6. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 12, other vehicles proceed to next step.
7. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
8. Remove passenger side floor mat.
9. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
10. On LX/RS/**WH/WK/XH**XK vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the glove
box to gain access to the blower motor resistor /power module. Refer to the detailed service
information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, Instrument Panel, Glove
Box
11. On LX/**WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles, remove the passenger side instrument panel silencer. Refer
to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body,
Instrument Panel, Instrument Panel Silencer. On 2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles remove the
blower motor and use a shop vacuum to clean the evaporator coil, reinstall the blower motor and
skip to step 18. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
12. Remove the 2 screws securing the blower motor resistor/power module in the NC housing and
remove the blower motor resistor/power module. Do not disconnect the electrical connector.
13. On LX/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), proceed to Step # 18
14. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C
air filter, remove the A/C air filter. Refer to the detailed service information available in
TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. If not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C air filter,
install the air filter door (do not install the air filter at this time).
18. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5454
19. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
20. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
21. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor/power module opening.
22. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
23. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
24. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 27. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
25. Remove the cap/clamp from the drain tube.
26. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
27. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
28. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
29. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening.
30. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
31. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
32. Start the engine.
33. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
34. Set the blower to HIGH.
35. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
36. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
37. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
38. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
39. Allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
41. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 44. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
42. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap.
43. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK/** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
44. Open all windows in the vehicle.
45. Remove the blower motor resistor/power module.
46. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5455
47. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
48. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
49. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
50. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 53. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
51. Remove the drain tube cap/clamp.
52. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
53. Start the engine.
54. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
55. Set the blower to HIGH.
56. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
57. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
58. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
59. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
60. Allow the engine to run for 20 minutes.
61. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
62. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
63. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 67. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
64. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
65. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 72, CS vehicles proceed to Step # 68, LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK**
vehicles proceed to Step # 66.
66. Lower the vehicle.
67. On **LX/WH/WK/XH/XK** vehicles (RS vehicles proceed to next step), install the right silencer
pad.
68. Install the glove box.
69. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to the next step. If equipped with an
A/C filter, remove the air filter door and install the A/C air filter. Replace with a new filter, if
necessary. See the parts table for the appropriate part number filter.
70. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
71. Install the floor mat.
72. Close the hood.
AN/DN/DR/HB/JR/KJ/LH/ND/PL/PT/TJ/WG/WJ Vehicles Procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5456
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
3. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle on a suitable hoist.
4. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), remove the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
5. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
6. On AN/DN/DR/HB/KJ vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), cap off the drain tube using
a suitable cap. When the drain tube is capped off, proceed to Step # 9.
7. On ND vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), plug the cooling coil drain using a piece of
plastic or a shop towel. When the drain tube is plugged, proceed to Step #9.
8. Clamp off the drain tube.
9. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
10. Remove passenger side floor mat.
11. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
12. If applicable, remove the silencer pad from under the instrument panel on the right side to gain
access to the blower motor.
13. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the lower right under panel duct
and blower motor cover.
14. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, and protective clothing.
NOTE:
No occupants should be in the vehicle during material application.
18. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
19. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
20. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner
onto the cooling coil until the required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number
of bottles).
21. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
22. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
23. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
24. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
25. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
26. One at a time, screw each bottle of normal tap water onto the applicator tool.
27. Spray all of the normal tap water onto the cooling coil until each bottle is empty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5457
28. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
29. Connect the negative battery cable.
30. Start the engine.
31. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
32. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
33. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
34. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
35. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
36. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
37. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
38. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
39. Install the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
40. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
41. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
42. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
43. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
44. Shake an 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
45. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle on
the cooling coil being carefully to cover the entire surface of the cooling coil.
46. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
47. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
48. Connect the negative battery cable.
49. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
50. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap.
51. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower the
vehicle.
52. Start the engine.
53. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
54. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
55. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
56. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5458
57. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
58. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
59. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
60. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
61. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
62. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
63. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), install the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
64. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
65. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), install the blower motor cover and lower
right under panel duct.
66. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
67. If applicable, install the silencer pad under the right side of the instrument panel.
68. Install floor mat.
69. Close the hood.
ST Vehicle Procedure
1. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
2. Remove passenger side floor mat.
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
4. Remove the joint duct. Refer to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT,
under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Blower Assembly and Resistor, Joint Duct.
5. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
6. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
7. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
8. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
9. Insert the applicator tool into the opening created by the joint duct removal.
10. Spray the full contents of 2 bottles of cooling coil cleaner onto the evaporator, moving the tool
so that the evaporator is completely covered, until both bottles are empty (16 oz. total).
11. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
12. Fill both of the empty cooling coil cleaner bottles with normal tap water.
13. Screw one bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
14. Insert the applicator tool into the opening of the heater/cooler unit at the evaporator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5459
15. Spray the full contents of water until the bottle is empty.
16. Repeat Step #13 through Step #15 using the second bottle of water. When both bottles of
water are empty, proceed to the next step.
17. Install the joint duct.
18. Disconnect the A/C clutch electrical connector at the A/C compressor.
19. Start the engine.
20. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
21. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
22. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
23. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
24. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
25. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
26. Turn the engine off.
27. Turn the ignition switch ON, do not start the engine, to allow blower motor operation.
28. Fully open all windows.
29. Remove the outer glove box and the inner glove box. Refer to the detailed service information
available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, 23C Body Interior, Instrument Panel
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
30. Shake the 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
31. Insert the applicator tool into the recirculation inlet (behind glove box opening). Spray the full
contents of the bottle in the airstream until the bottle is empty.
32. Start the engine.
33. Set the blower to HIGH.
34. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
35. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
36. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
37. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
38. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
39. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the off position.
41. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
42. Connect the A/C compressor clutch electrical connector at the compressor.
43. Open the right side panel outlet vent.
44. Install inner glove box.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5460
45. Install outer glove box.
46. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
47. Install floor mat.
VA Vehicle Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
2. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
3. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Remove the HVAC filter cover and HVAC filter. Refer to the detailed service information available
in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
6. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
7. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
8. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
9. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (pin 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
10. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
11. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
12. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
13. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
14. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
15. Remove the clamp from the drain tube.
16. Lower the vehicle.
17. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
18. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
19. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
20. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
21. Install the HVAC filter cover (do not install the HVAC filter at this time).
22. Start the engine.
23. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
24. Set the blower to HIGH.
25. Set the A/C switch to NC OFF.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5461
26. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
27. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
28. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
29. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
30. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
31. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
32. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
33. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
34. Open all windows in the vehicle.
35. Remove the HVAC filter cover.
36. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
37. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
38. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
39. Install the HVAC filter. Replace with a new filter, p/n 05103600AA, if necessary.
40. Install the HVAC filter cover.
41. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
42. Remove the drain tube clamp.
43. Lower the vehicle.
44. Start the engine.
45. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
46. Set the blower to HIGH.
47. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
48. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
49. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
50. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
51. With the engine running, allow the blower motor to operate for 20 minutes.
52. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
53. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
54. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When
Hot/Humid > Page 5462
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
55. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
56. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 241496 > Sep > 96 > A/C , Heater - Odors/Defroster Will
Not Clear Glass
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C , Heater - Odors/Defroster Will Not Clear
Glass
NO: 24-14-96
GROUP: Heater & A/C
DATE: Sep. 27, 1996
SUBJECT: A/C Evaporator Odor And/Or Incomplete Defrost In "Recirc" Mode
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon 1995 - 1997 (JA) Stratus/Cirrus/Breeze 1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring
Convertible
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A temporary musty odor may be emitted from the A/C ducts and/or the defroster may not be able to
completely clear all the glass, when the recirculation mode (Recirc) is used for extended periods of
time.
DISCUSSION:
The vehicles listed above offer a separate rotary knob for independent control of the Fresh (outside
air) / "Recirc" (inside air) function. The intent of the independent control of Recirc is:
^ To temporarily allow customers to eliminate dust or outside odors.
^ To get maximum cooldown performance by going into "Recirc" without having to change modes
or temperature settings.
Prior to January 1995, the A/C evaporator had a chromate coating for long term corrosion
protection and a silicate coating to insure that condensate would run off the fins instead of getting
in the airstream and coming out the panel outlets. Due to new regulations, a new non-chromate
coating process was implemented in January 1995.
Under some ambient conditions the new coating may cause the air passing over the evaporator to
develop a temporary musty odor. When operated in the "Recirc mode the odor is more noticeable.
Also, operating for extended periods in "Recirc" with the A/C off may create and intensify the musty
odor.
Running in "Recirc" for long periods of time in very cold weather may cause moisture from snow
tracked into the car and moisture from the occupants breath to condense on the cold glass and in
some cases the defroster may not clear all the glass. Even with the A/C running on mild wet days
and running in "Recirc" some fog may remain on areas of the glass.
NOTE:
CHANGES IN THE 1997 NEON WILL NOT ALLOW THE FRESH/RECIRC DOOR TO STAY IN
RECIRC WHEN THE DEFROST MODE IS SELECTED.
It is important that the instructions given in the owners manual that recommend that the "Recirc"
mode be used for no more than 30 minutes at a time be followed. Encourage customers to operate
in Fresh as the normal condition and go to Recirc only for the temporary conditions given above.
POLICY: Information only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 241496 > Sep > 96 > A/C , Heater - Odors/Defroster Will Not
Clear Glass
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C , Heater - Odors/Defroster Will Not Clear
Glass
NO: 24-14-96
GROUP: Heater & A/C
DATE: Sep. 27, 1996
SUBJECT: A/C Evaporator Odor And/Or Incomplete Defrost In "Recirc" Mode
MODELS:
1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon 1995 - 1997 (JA) Stratus/Cirrus/Breeze 1996 - 1997 (JX) Sebring
Convertible
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A temporary musty odor may be emitted from the A/C ducts and/or the defroster may not be able to
completely clear all the glass, when the recirculation mode (Recirc) is used for extended periods of
time.
DISCUSSION:
The vehicles listed above offer a separate rotary knob for independent control of the Fresh (outside
air) / "Recirc" (inside air) function. The intent of the independent control of Recirc is:
^ To temporarily allow customers to eliminate dust or outside odors.
^ To get maximum cooldown performance by going into "Recirc" without having to change modes
or temperature settings.
Prior to January 1995, the A/C evaporator had a chromate coating for long term corrosion
protection and a silicate coating to insure that condensate would run off the fins instead of getting
in the airstream and coming out the panel outlets. Due to new regulations, a new non-chromate
coating process was implemented in January 1995.
Under some ambient conditions the new coating may cause the air passing over the evaporator to
develop a temporary musty odor. When operated in the "Recirc mode the odor is more noticeable.
Also, operating for extended periods in "Recirc" with the A/C off may create and intensify the musty
odor.
Running in "Recirc" for long periods of time in very cold weather may cause moisture from snow
tracked into the car and moisture from the occupants breath to condense on the cold glass and in
some cases the defroster may not clear all the glass. Even with the A/C running on mild wet days
and running in "Recirc" some fog may remain on areas of the glass.
NOTE:
CHANGES IN THE 1997 NEON WILL NOT ALLOW THE FRESH/RECIRC DOOR TO STAY IN
RECIRC WHEN THE DEFROST MODE IS SELECTED.
It is important that the instructions given in the owners manual that recommend that the "Recirc"
mode be used for no more than 30 minutes at a time be followed. Encourage customers to operate
in Fresh as the normal condition and go to Recirc only for the temporary conditions given above.
POLICY: Information only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5472
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair
This vehicle uses an aluminum plate and fin style evaporator. It is located in the Evaporator/Blower
module.
The unit housing must be removed from the vehicle before beginning with this procedure. Refer to:
"Housing Assembly HVAC : Service and Repair" See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and
Repair
Use this procedure if any or all of the following items require service:
- Evaporator
- Air inlet duct
- Recirculation door
- Evaporator/Blower module case
DISASSEMBLE 1. Remove the clips and screws that hold the Unit Housing to the
Evaporator/Blower Module. Then separate the two units.
Foam Seat Removal
2. Remove the evaporator to dash panel foam seal. 3. Disconnect fin sensing switch from harness.
4. Remove upper to lower case retaining clips and screws.
Case Separation
5. Separate the case halves.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5473
Evaporator Removal
6. Lift the evaporator out of the module.
ASSEMBLE To reassemble, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 241896 > Nov > 96 > Evaporator Drain - Water Leaks
Into Interior
Evaporator Drain Tube: Customer Interest Evaporator Drain - Water Leaks Into Interior
NO: 24-18-96
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Nov. 22, 1996
SUBJECT: Water Leaks Into Passenger Compartment Under I/P By A/C Drain
MODELS: 1996 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Water leaks into passenger compartment from under the right side of the instrument panel.
DIAGNOSIS:
Raise the vehicle on a hoist to allow access to the A/C condensate drain tube. The condensate
drain tube should be pointing down toward the ground. If the tube is pointing elsewhere or if there
are signs of moisture up near the A/C evaporator nipple, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 82300234 RTV Sealant
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the positioning of the A/C condensate drain tube and sealing between the
drain tube and A/C evaporator drain nipple.
1. Remove the drain tube from the NC evaporator nipple. Figure 1
2. Dry any moisture present and apply RTV (PIN 82300234) around the sealing diameter of the
drain tube.
3. Install the drain tube onto the evaporator nipple. Insure the drain tube is pointing down toward
the ground.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-65-03-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Drain Tube: > 241896 > Nov > 96 > Evaporator Drain Water Leaks Into Interior
Evaporator Drain Tube: All Technical Service Bulletins Evaporator Drain - Water Leaks Into Interior
NO: 24-18-96
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Nov. 22, 1996
SUBJECT: Water Leaks Into Passenger Compartment Under I/P By A/C Drain
MODELS: 1996 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Water leaks into passenger compartment from under the right side of the instrument panel.
DIAGNOSIS:
Raise the vehicle on a hoist to allow access to the A/C condensate drain tube. The condensate
drain tube should be pointing down toward the ground. If the tube is pointing elsewhere or if there
are signs of moisture up near the A/C evaporator nipple, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 82300234 RTV Sealant
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the positioning of the A/C condensate drain tube and sealing between the
drain tube and A/C evaporator drain nipple.
1. Remove the drain tube from the NC evaporator nipple. Figure 1
2. Dry any moisture present and apply RTV (PIN 82300234) around the sealing diameter of the
drain tube.
3. Install the drain tube onto the evaporator nipple. Insure the drain tube is pointing down toward
the ground.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-65-03-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Locations
Evaporator Probe Location
The evaporator probe is located in the Evaporator Case unit housing and placed in the evaporator
fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5492
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5493
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5494
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5495
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5496
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5497
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5498
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5499
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5500
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5501
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5502
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5503
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5504
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5505
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5506
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5507
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR PROBE
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the unit housing and placed in the evaporator fins. the probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature rises above freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator temperature
rises above freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a capillary tube. The
tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C unit housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5508
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area and vehicle must be between 16° C (60° F) and 32° C (90° F) when
testing the switch.
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC.
Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there
is no power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
- Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent.
7. If the clutch does not begin to cycle off between 2° C to 7° C (35° F to 45° F), verify that the
evaporator probe is fully installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and reset outlet temperature. If the evaporator
probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <-->
[Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5509
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the
vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Evaporator Probe Location
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator blower module. 3. Note in which of the three pilot
holes the evaporator probe is located. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick and make a new hole. Make the hole 1/4 inch above or below the original
hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into evaporator
probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation
The expansion valve is used to meter refrigerant into the evaporator in accordance with cooling
requirements.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5513
Expansion Valve: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: Expansion valve tests should be performed after compressor tests.
NOTE: Liquid CO2 is required to test the expansion valve. It is available from most welding supply
facilities. CO2 is also available from companies which service and sell fire extinguishers.
WARNING: Review Safety Precautions and Warnings Before proceding.
CAUTION: The work area and vehicle must be 21 ° to 27 °C (70 ° to 85 °F) when testing expansion
valve.
TO TEST THE EXPANSION VALVE:
1. Connect a charging station or manifold gauge set to the refrigerant system service ports.
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
2. Disconnect wire connector at low pressure cutoff switch. Using a jumper wire, jump terminals
inside wire connector boot. 3. Close all doors, windows and vents to the passenger compartment.
4. Set Heater-A/C control to A/C, full heat, floor, RECIRC. and high blower. 5. Start the engine and
hold the idle speed (1000 rpm). After the engine has reached running temperature, allow the
passenger compartment to heat
up. This will create the need for maximum refrigerant flow into the evaporator.
6. If the refrigerant charge is sufficient, discharge (high pressure) gauge should read 965 to 2620
kPa (140 to 380 psi). Suction (low pressure) gauge
should read 103 to 2417 kPa (15 to 35 psi). If system cannot achieve proper pressure readings,
replace the expansion valve. If pressure is correct, proceed with test.
WARNING: Protect skin and eyes from contacting CO2, personal injury can result.
7. If suction side low pressure is within specified range, freeze the expansion valve control head for
30 seconds. Use a super cold substance (liquid
C02). Do not spray refrigerant on the expansion valve for this test. Suction side low pressure
should drop to 34.5 kPa (5 psi) If not, replace expansion valve.
8. Allow expansion valve to thaw. The low pressure gauge reading should stabilize at 103 to 241
kPa (15 to 35 psi). If not, replace expansion valve. 9. When expansion valve test is complete, test
A/C overall performance. Refer to Testing and Inspection/Performance Test. Remove all test
equipment before returning vehicle to use.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5514
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
WARNING: The refrigeration system must be completely empty before proceeding with this
operation.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the boot-type wire connector from the pressure cut-off switch.
Expansion Valve
2. Remove the center bolt of refrigerant line plumbing sealing plate. 3. Carefully pull the refrigerant
line-sealing plate assembly from the expansion valve towards front of vehicle. Do not scratch the
expansion valve
sealing surfaces with pilot tubes.
4. Cover the openings on A/C line-sealing plate assembly to prevent contamination. 5. Remove two
screws securing the expansion valve to the evaporator sealing plate. 6. Carefully remove valve.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove and replace the aluminum gasket on the evaporator sealing plate. 2. Carefully hold the
expansion valve to the evaporator sealing plate so not to scratch the sealing surface. Install two
screws and tighten to 8 to 14
N.m (70 to 130 in. lbs.).
3. Remove and replace the aluminum gasket on the refrigerant line- sealing plate assembly 4.
Carefully hold the refrigerant line-sealing plate assembly to the expansion valve. Install bolt and
tighten to 20 to 26 N.m (170 to 230 in. lbs.). 5. Connect wires to low pressure cut-off switch. 6.
Evacuate and recharge system. 7. After expansion valve is installed, system is charged, and leaks
have been checked, repeat A/C performance check.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Heater Hose: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system. 2. Remove clamp at end of heater hose to be removed.
Heater Hose Quick Connect
3. ON Right Hand Drive (RHD) vehicles, heater hoses at the heater core connection have quick
connects. The quick connect consist of two pieces; a
quick connect and insert. The quick connect is removed by compressing the insert with a pliers,
and pulling the quick connect free of the insert/nipple. Carefully compressed insert pulling the quick
connect from connector nipple. The insert will remain on the connector nipple as the quick connect
is removed.
4. Remove the heater hose clamp from the heater hose at the block and remove hose.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The insert should be removed from the connector nipple and placed inside of the quick
connect before reassembly.
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Locations
High Pressure Relief Valve
The High Pressure Safety Valve is located on the compressor manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5521
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair
WARNING: Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes,
nose and throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting sae requirements to discharge
R-134a system. If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate work area before resuming
service. R-134a service equipment or vehicle A/C system should not be pressure tested or leak
tested with compressed air. Mixtures of air and R-134a can be combustible at elevated pressures.
These mixtures are potentially dangerous and may result in fire or explosion causing injury or
property damage.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system.
High Pressure Relief Valve
2. Rotate the high pressure relief valve counterclockwise and separate relief valve from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures using a new 0-ring seal. Evacuate and charge the
refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation
DISCHARGE LINE
Discharge Line
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber 0-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
LIQUID LINE
Liquid/Suction Line
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the drier. It has no serviceable parts
except the rubber 0-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an
assembly.
SUCTION LINE
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/ drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber 0-rings on all other connections. There are no serviceable parts on the
suction line other than the rubber 0-rings and expansion valve gasket. If the line is found to be
leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5525
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
HANDLING TUBING AND FITTINGS
Kinks in the refrigerant tubing or sharp bends in the refrigerant hose lines will greatly reduce the
capacity of the entire system. High pressures are produced in the system when it is operating.
Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that all connections are pressure tight. Dirt and
moisture can enter the system when it is opened for repair or replacement of lines or components.
The refrigerant oil will absorb moisture readily out of the air. This moisture will convert to acids
within a closed system.
CAUTION: The system must be completely empty before opening any fitting or connection on the
refrigerant system. Open fittings with caution even after system has been emptied. If pressure is
noticed as a fitting is loosened, tighten fitting and evacuate system again.
BENDING FLEX HOSE
A good rule for the flexable hose lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times the
diameter of the hose. Sharper bends will reduce the flow of the refrigerant. The flexible hose lines
should be routed at least 3 inches away from exhaust manifolds. Inspect all flexible hose lines to
make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
CAUTION: The use of correct wrenches when making connections is very important. Improper
wrenches or the improper use of wrenches can damage the fittings.
INTERNAL DAMAGE
The internal parts of the A/C system will remain stable as long as moisture free refrigerant and
refrigerant oil is used. Abnormal amounts of dirt, moisture, or air can upset the chemical stability.
This may cause operational troubles or even serious damage if present in more than very small
quantities.
OPENING SYSTEM
When it is necessary to open the refrigeration system, have everything needed to service the
system ready. The system should not be left open any longer than necessary. Cap or Plug all lines
and fittings as soon as they are opened. This will prevent the entrance of dirt and moisture into the
system. All new lines and components should be capped or sealed until they are ready to be used.
CAUTION: All tools, including the refrigerant dispensing manifold, the manifold gauge set, and test
hoses should be kept dry.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly
Use this procedure if any or all of the following items require service:
- Heater core
- Temperature door
- Mode door
- Heat/Defrost door
- Assembly housing
The unit housing must be removed from the vehicle before beginning with this procedure.
DISASSEMBLE
For Right Hand Drive (RHD) vehicles, the Unit Housing does not separate. It is a one piece unit
and must be replaced as a whole.
Air Distribution Module Separation
1. Remove the clips and screws that hold the Air Distribution Module to the Evaporator/Blower
Module. Then separate the two units. 2. Remove the panel opening foam seal, demister opening
foam seal, and heater core tube foam seals from unit.
Retaining Clip Removal
3. Remove the retaining clips and screws that hold the upper and lower housings together.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly > Page 5530
Case Separation
4. Place the unit in the upside down position. Then separate the two halves of the module.
Heater Core Removal
5. Lift the heater core out of the case.
Temperature Door Removal
6. Press tab in at base of temperature door and release door from lever. Then remove the door.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly > Page 5531
Mode Door Removal
7. Press tab in at base of mode door and release door from lever.
Cam Screw Removal
8. Remove Heat/Defrost door cam screw.
Cam And Lever Removal
9. Lift the cam and mode door lever off of the housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly > Page 5532
Pivot Screw Removal
10. Remove the Heat/Defrost link pivot screw. 11. Lift the Heat/Defrost link and the door as an
assembly. Then separate the link from the door.
ASSEMBLE
To reassemble, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly > Page 5533
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Heater - A/C Housing Removal and Installation
The instrument panel must be removed in order to remove the Unit Housing. Refer to: "Instrument
Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators : Instrument Panel : Service and Repair" See: Instrument
Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster / Carrier/Service and Repair
WARNING: THE R-134a REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE
SERVICING ANY PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
REMOVAL 1. Remove instrument panel from vehicle. Refer to: "Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators : Instrument Panel : Service and
Repair" See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Instrument Cluster /
Carrier/Service and Repair.
2. Drain cooling system and remove heater hoses at the dash panel. Place plugs in the heater core
outlets to prevent coolant spillage during unit
housing removal. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service and Repair"
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
3. Using a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system, if equipped.
Refer to: "Heating and Air Conditioning :
Service and Repair" See: Service and Repair
4. Remove suction line at expansion valve. Place a piece of tape over open refrigerant line to
prevent moisture and/or dirt from entering the line. 5. Remove expansion valve from evaporator.
Place a piece of tape over open evaporator fitting to prevent moisture and/or dirt from entering the
evaporator.
6. Remove rubber drain tube extension from condensation drain tube.
Dash Panel Studs
7. Remove three retaining nuts located in the engine compartment, on the dash panel.
Retaining Screws
8. Remove the right side retaining screw. 9. Remove remaining nut located on dash panel stud.
10. Disconnect the blue five way connector from the plenum. Module wiring harness must be
removed with module. 11. Remove assembly from the vehicle.
For HVAC Unit Housing Disassembly and Assembly, refer to: "Evaporator Core : Service and
Repair" See: Evaporator Core/Service and Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Evaporator Housing Disassembly and Assembly > Page 5534
INSTALLATION For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the right side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: The refrigeration system must be completely recovered before proceeding with this
operation.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect liquid line from filter/drier. 2. Disconnect liquid line on suction line assembly from
filter/drier. 3. Pull filter/drier out of rubber grommet.
INSTALLATION
For installation reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
R134a Capacity ...................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.78 kg (28 oz. or 1.57 lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 5542
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydrofluorocarbon (HFC), ...................................................................................................................
............................................... R-134a liquefied gas
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Total System ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 200 ml 6.75 oz.
Condenser ...........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 30 ml 1.0 oz.
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 59 ml 2.0 oz. Filter-Drier ......................................................
................................................................................................................................................... 30 ml
1.0 oz.
A/C Lines .............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 44 ml 1.5 oz.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 5547
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Synthetic-based, Polyalkylene Glycol ..................................................................................................
.......................................................................... ND-8
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5548
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
It is important to have the correct amount of oil in the A/C system to ensure proper lubrication of the
compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the compressor. Too much oil will reduce the
cooling capacity of the system and consequently result in higher discharge air temperatures.
NOTE: The oil used in the compressor is ND8 PAG R-134a refrigerant oil. Only refrigerant oil of the
same type should be used to service the system. Do not use any other oil. The oil container should
be kept tightly capped until it is ready for use. Tightly cap afterwards to prevent contamination from
dirt and moisture. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with. Special
effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free. Moisture in the oil is very
difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the compressor.
It will not be necessary to check oil level in the compressor or to add oil unless there has been an
oil loss. Oil loss at a leak point will be evident by the presence of a wet, shiny surface around the
leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
The high pressure cut out switch is located in the compressor manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5553
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
HIGH PRESSURE CUT-OFF SWITCH
The High Pressure Cut-Off Switch turns off the compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240
kPa (470 psi).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5554
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: The refrigerant must be removed from the system before removing the high pressure
cut out switch.
REMOVAL
High Pressure Relief Valve
1. Disconnect wiring connector at the switch. 2. Remove internal snap ring. 3. Pull switch out of
manifold.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
The low pressure cut off switch is located on the expansion valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5558
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Low Pressure Cut Off Switch monitors the refrigerant gas pressure on the suction side of the
system.
OPERATION
It turns off voltage to the compressor clutch coil when refrigerant gas pressure drops to levels that
could damage the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5559
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area must not be below 21°C (70°F) to test the compressor clutch circuit.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the cycling clutch switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
low pressure cut off switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5560
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The low pressure cut out switch is a sealed factory calibrated unit. It must be replaced if defective.
WARNING: The refrigeration system must be completely recovered before proceeding with this
operation.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the boot like wire connector at the cut off switch.
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
2. Using a sender unit removal socket, remove the switch from the expansion valve.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Verity the 0-ring condition on the replacement switch.
For installation, reverse the above procedures. Evacuate and charge the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Solid State Relay
The relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5568
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan Control Module -PCM Output
The radiator fan runs when coolant temperature and A/C system pressure demand cooling. The
radiator fan circuit contains a Pulse Width Module (PWM) this is shown on the wiring as the Solid
State Fan Relay.
A 5 volt signal is supplied to the PWM. The PCM provides a pulsed ground for the PWM.
Depending upon the amount of pulse on time, the PWM puts out a proportional voltage to the fan
motor at the lower speed. For instance, if the on time is 30 percent, then the voltage to the fan
motor will be 3.6 volts.
When engine coolant reaches approximately 99°C (210°F) the PCM grounds the PWM relay.
When the PCM grounds the relay it operates at a 30% duty cycle and immediately ramps up to
100% duty cycle. The PCM de-energizes the PWM relay when coolant temperature drops to
approximately 93°C (199°F).
Also, when the air conditioning pressure switch closes, the PCM grounds the PWM. The air
conditioning switch closes at 285 psi ± 10 psi. When air conditioning pressure drops approximately
40 psi, the pressure switch opens and the fan turns off.
The PWM relay is located on the left front inner frame just behind the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor Switch: Testing and Inspection
Heater A/C Blower Switch Test
1. Remove Heater A/C control module.
Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Blower Switch Test. 3. If the switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace Heater A/C Control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7
check the lamps, replace if necessary.
Heater Blower Switch Test
1. Remove heater control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5573
Heater Blower Switch Test
2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Heater Blower Test. 3. If switch fails any part of the continuity test, other then Pin 1 to Pin 7,
replace heater control. If no continuity between Pin 1 to Pin 7 check the
lamps, replace if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5574
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
The switch is not serviced, replace heater A/C control. Refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning/Control Assembly/service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Locations
Evaporator Probe Location
The evaporator probe is located in the Evaporator Case unit housing and placed in the evaporator
fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5580
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5581
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5582
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5583
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5584
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5585
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5586
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5587
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5588
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5589
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5590
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5591
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5592
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5593
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5594
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5595
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR PROBE
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the unit housing and placed in the evaporator fins. the probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature rises above freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator temperature
rises above freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a capillary tube. The
tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C unit housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5596
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area and vehicle must be between 16° C (60° F) and 32° C (90° F) when
testing the switch.
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC.
Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there
is no power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
- Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent.
7. If the clutch does not begin to cycle off between 2° C to 7° C (35° F to 45° F), verify that the
evaporator probe is fully installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and reset outlet temperature. If the evaporator
probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch <--> [Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5597
Evaporator Temperature Sensor/Clutch Cycling Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the unit housing from the
vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Evaporator Probe Location
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator blower module. 3. Note in which of the three pilot
holes the evaporator probe is located. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick and make a new hole. Make the hole 1/4 inch above or below the original
hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into evaporator
probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
The high pressure cut out switch is located in the compressor manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5602
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
HIGH PRESSURE CUT-OFF SWITCH
The High Pressure Cut-Off Switch turns off the compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240
kPa (470 psi).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5603
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: The refrigerant must be removed from the system before removing the high pressure
cut out switch.
REMOVAL
High Pressure Relief Valve
1. Disconnect wiring connector at the switch. 2. Remove internal snap ring. 3. Pull switch out of
manifold.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
The low pressure cut off switch is located on the expansion valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5607
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Low Pressure Cut Off Switch monitors the refrigerant gas pressure on the suction side of the
system.
OPERATION
It turns off voltage to the compressor clutch coil when refrigerant gas pressure drops to levels that
could damage the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5608
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: The work area must not be below 21°C (70°F) to test the compressor clutch circuit.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the cycling clutch switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
low pressure cut off switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 5609
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
The low pressure cut out switch is a sealed factory calibrated unit. It must be replaced if defective.
WARNING: The refrigeration system must be completely recovered before proceeding with this
operation.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the boot like wire connector at the cut off switch.
Low Pressure Cut Off Switch
2. Using a sender unit removal socket, remove the switch from the expansion valve.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Verity the 0-ring condition on the replacement switch.
For installation, reverse the above procedures. Evacuate and charge the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Service Port HVAC: Locations
High Side Service Port
The high side service port is located on the filter drier.
Low Side Service Port Valve (in Suction Line)
The low side service port is located on the suction line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5613
Service Port HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
High Side Service Port
Low Side Service Port Valve (in Suction Line)
1. Remove the valve caps. 2. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, Remove the refrigerant
from A/C system. 3. Using a standard valve core tool, remove the valve core. Be careful to prevent
any dirt/debris from entering the valve core opening or getting on
the replacement valve core.
INSTALLATION
1. When assembling the new valve core into the port, the core should be oiled with clean ND8 PAG
compressor oil.
CAUTION: A valve that is not fully seated can lead to damage to the valve during evacuation and
charge. This can result in system refrigerant discharge while uncoupling the charge adapters.
2. Install valve core into port. 3. Evacuate and charge the A/C system. 4. Install the valve caps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 5620
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA97V080000 > May > 97 > Recall 97V080000: Unexpected Air Bag Deployment
Air Bag: Recalls Recall 97V080000: Unexpected Air Bag Deployment
The electrical circuit design allows the potential for an inadvertent air bag deployment upon vehicle
ignition shut down.
Unexpected air bag deployment can result in occupant injury.
Dealers will replace the air bag electronic control module with a newly designed module. Owner
notification began during July 1997. Owners who take their vehicles to an authorized dealer on an
agreed upon service date and do not receive the free remedy within a reasonable time should
contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403. Also contact the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag: > 08-010-01 > May > 01 > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
Air Bag: All Technical Service Bulletins Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
NUMBER: 08-010-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 25, 2001
SUBJECT: Airbag/Clock Spring Service
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2002 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1988 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1988 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1988 - 1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - 2002 (DN) Durango
2002 (DR) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2002 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2002 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2002 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2002 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1996 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2002 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2002 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2002 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1995 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
Airbag
When servicing any airbag system, it is essential to follow the proper Service Manual and/or
Diagnostic Manual procedures for diagnosing, testing, and replacing of any component. When
diagnosing any airbag squib circuit Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) with a DRBIII(R), the use of the
Airbag Load Tool (Special Tool 8310 and 8443) is required. The Airbag Load Tool, used in
conjunction with the DRBIII(R) are used to isolate and test components and wiring for failure. Only
replace the component or wiring that has failed. This will reduce unnecessary cost to the customer
or DaimlerChrysler.
NOTE:
AIRBAG REPLACEMENT IS NOT REQUIRED EVERY TIME IT IS REMOVED OR WHEN
ANOTHER COMPONENT HAS FAILED. USE OF THE DRBIII(R) AND AIRBAG LOAD TOOL
WILL DETERMINE IF THE AIRBAG HAS FAILED AND REPLACEMENT IS NEEDED.
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag: > 08-010-01 > May > 01 > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service > Page 5634
TECHNICIANS SHOULD RECORD ALL STORED AND ACTIVE AIRBAG SYSTEM FAULT
CODES ON THE REPAIR ORDER.
Clock Springs
Recent analysis of returned clock springs have indicated that prior service may have contributed to
the clock spring's failure.
^ Do not use silicone or any other lubricant spray on or near the clock spring. Lubricants are often
used in the clock spring area of the steering column to eliminate noise. Lubricants may have an
adverse effect on the clock spring.
^ Clock spring centering. Any repair that may disrupt the positioning of the steering wheel with the
front wheels will require that the clock spring be centered. This includes clock spring replacement,
steering column service, HVAC service, steering gear service, and front suspension crossmember
service. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for the clock spring centering procedure.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag: > NHTSA97V080000 > May > 97 > Recall 97V080000: Unexpected
Air Bag Deployment
Air Bag: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 97V080000: Unexpected Air Bag Deployment
The electrical circuit design allows the potential for an inadvertent air bag deployment upon vehicle
ignition shut down.
Unexpected air bag deployment can result in occupant injury.
Dealers will replace the air bag electronic control module with a newly designed module. Owner
notification began during July 1997. Owners who take their vehicles to an authorized dealer on an
agreed upon service date and do not receive the free remedy within a reasonable time should
contact Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403. Also contact the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Bag: > 08-010-01 > May > 01 > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
Air Bag: All Technical Service Bulletins Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
NUMBER: 08-010-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 25, 2001
SUBJECT: Airbag/Clock Spring Service
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2002 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1988 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1988 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1988 - 1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - 2002 (DN) Durango
2002 (DR) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2002 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2002 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2002 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2002 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1996 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2002 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2002 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2002 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1995 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
Airbag
When servicing any airbag system, it is essential to follow the proper Service Manual and/or
Diagnostic Manual procedures for diagnosing, testing, and replacing of any component. When
diagnosing any airbag squib circuit Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) with a DRBIII(R), the use of the
Airbag Load Tool (Special Tool 8310 and 8443) is required. The Airbag Load Tool, used in
conjunction with the DRBIII(R) are used to isolate and test components and wiring for failure. Only
replace the component or wiring that has failed. This will reduce unnecessary cost to the customer
or DaimlerChrysler.
NOTE:
AIRBAG REPLACEMENT IS NOT REQUIRED EVERY TIME IT IS REMOVED OR WHEN
ANOTHER COMPONENT HAS FAILED. USE OF THE DRBIII(R) AND AIRBAG LOAD TOOL
WILL DETERMINE IF THE AIRBAG HAS FAILED AND REPLACEMENT IS NEEDED.
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Bag: > 08-010-01 > May > 01 > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service > Page 5644
TECHNICIANS SHOULD RECORD ALL STORED AND ACTIVE AIRBAG SYSTEM FAULT
CODES ON THE REPAIR ORDER.
Clock Springs
Recent analysis of returned clock springs have indicated that prior service may have contributed to
the clock spring's failure.
^ Do not use silicone or any other lubricant spray on or near the clock spring. Lubricants are often
used in the clock spring area of the steering column to eliminate noise. Lubricants may have an
adverse effect on the clock spring.
^ Clock spring centering. Any repair that may disrupt the positioning of the steering wheel with the
front wheels will require that the clock spring be centered. This includes clock spring replacement,
steering column service, HVAC service, steering gear service, and front suspension crossmember
service. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for the clock spring centering procedure.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Air Bag: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5647
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Bag: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5650
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5651
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5652
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5653
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5654
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5655
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5656
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5657
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5658
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5659
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5660
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5661
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5662
Air Bag: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5663
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5664
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5665
Air Bag: Connector Views
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5666
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5667
Air Bag: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System (Part 1 Of 3)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5668
Airbag System (Part 2 Of 3)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5669
Airbag System (Part 3 Of 3)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5670
Air Bag: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB) to Data Link
connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the lower
instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the latest
version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect the
battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data. 6.
Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if any
diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch on, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection
Air Bag: Service and Repair Maintenance Inspection
1. Check the airbag warning lamp for proper operation as follows:
a. Turn ignition switch to the ON position, the airbag warning lamp should light. If not, test the
system using a scan tool and airbag system
Diagnostic Procedures. Repair as required.
b. The airbag warning lamp lights, but fails to go out after 8 Seconds. Test the system using a scan
tool and airbag system System Diagnostic
Procedures. Repair as required.
c. After correcting active malfunction erase stored diagnostic codes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection > Page 5673
Air Bag: Service and Repair Airbag Module Storage & Handling
Deployed Module
The vehicle interior may contain a very small amount of sodium hydroxide powder, a by-product of
airbag deployment. Sodium hydroxide powder can irritate the skin, eyes, nose and throat. Wear
safety glasses, rubber gloves, and long sleeved clothing when cleaning any of the powder residue
from the vehicle.
If you find that the cleanup is irritating your skin, run cool water over the affected area. Also, if you
experience nasal or throat irritation, exit the vehicle for fresh air until the irritation ceases. If irritation
continues, see a physician.
Undeployed
The airbag module(s) must be stored in its original special container until used for service. At no
time should a source of electricity be permitted near the inflator on the back of an airbag module.
When carrying or handling an undeployed airbag module, the trim side of the airbag should be
pointing away from the body to minimize possibility of injury if accidental deployment occurs. Do
not place undeployed air-bag face down on a solid surface, the airbag will propel into the air if
accidental deployment occurs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection > Page 5674
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Side Airbag Module Replacement
REMOVAL
WARNING: DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE
BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY. ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES
BEFORE REMOVING ANY AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
When removing a deployed module, rubber gloves, eye protection and long sleeved shift should be
worn as there may be deposits on the surface which could irritate the skin and eyes.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove speed control switches or covers
from steering wheel armature and disconnect the wires.
Driver Airbag Module
3. Remove two bolts attaching Driver Airbag Module from the sides of steering wheel. 4. Lift
module and disconnect airbag squib wire connector and horn wire. 5. Remove Driver Airbag
Module. 6. When replacing a deployed driver airbag module, the clockspring must also be
replaced. Refer to Clockspring Removal and Installation for proper
procedure.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
1. Connect the squib wire to the module. Make airbag connection by pressing straight in on the
connector. The connector should be fully seated feel
for positive snap to assure positive connection.
2. Connect the horn wire. 3. Install two bolts and tighten to 10 to 11 N.m (90 to 100 in. lbs.) torque.
4. install non-speed control covers to the steering wheel armature or connect the wire connectors
to the speed control switches and install switches.
Tighten fastener to 2 N.m (20 in. lbs.).
5. Do not connect battery negative cable. Refer to Diagnosis and Testing for Airbag System Test
procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection > Page 5675
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Side Airbag Module Replacement
Non-Deployed Module
REMOVAL
When removing a module for any reason other than DEPLOYMENT. 1. Disconnect and isolate the
battery negative cable.
Instrument Panel
2. Remove instrument panel top cover. 3. Remove instrument panel right trim bezel. 4. Open glove
box and push the sides inward allowing the door bumper to pass and box to open.
Passenger Airbag Module
5. Remove the four trim screws which attach the Passenger Airbag Module to the top instrument
panel. 6. Remove two module attaching nuts from the support structure.
Airbag Module Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection > Page 5676
7. Lift module up until the wire connector is visible and disconnect the 4-way wire connector from
module. Unlock the red locking tab and
compress lock to release the connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures. Ensure that the red locking tab is in the lock
position after installing the connector. Tighten trim screws to 2 N.m (20 in. lbs.) torque. Tighten the
module nuts to 22 to 34 N.m (200 to 300 in. lbs.) torque. Do not connect battery negative cable.
Refer to Diagnosis and Testing for Airbag System Test procedures.
Deployed Module
REMOVAL
When removing a deployed module, rubber gloves, eye protection, and a long-sleeved shirt should
be worn, as there may be deposits on the surface which could irritate the skin and eyes. 1.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Roll/fold airbag towards instrument panel. 3.
Close door over folded airbag and tape door closed. 4. Remove instrument panel top cover. 5.
Remove instrument panel right trim panel. 6. Open glove box and push the sides inward allowing
the door bumper to pass and box to open. 7. Remove the four trim screws which attach the module
to the top instrument panel. 8. Remove two module attaching nuts from the support structure. 9. Lift
module up until the wire connector is visible and disconnect the 4-way wire connector from module.
Unlock the red locking tab and
compress lock to release the connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures. Ensure that the red locking tab is in the lock
position after installing the connector. Tighten trim screws to 2 N.m (20 in lbs.) torque. Tighten the
module nuts to 22 to 34 N.m (200 to 300 in lbs.) torque. Do not connect battery negative cable.
Refer to Diagnosis and Testing for Airbag System Test procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Maintenance Inspection > Page 5677
Air Bag: Service and Repair Service of Deployed Airbag Module
DRIVER AIRBAG
After a Driver Airbag Module has been deployed the following components must be replaced
because they cannot be reused. Other driver airbag system components are replaced if damaged.
Driver Airbag Module
- Clockspring assembly
PASSENGER AIRBAG
After a Passenger Airbag Module has been deployed the following components must be replaced
because they cannot be reused. - Passenger Airbag Module - Right trim panel
The lower instrument panel knee blocker, top cover, and any other components should be replaced
if damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5686
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5687
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5688
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5689
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5690
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5691
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5692
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5693
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5694
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5695
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5696
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5697
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5698
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5699
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page
5700
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5706
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5707
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5708
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5709
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5710
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5711
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5712
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5713
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5714
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5715
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5716
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5717
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5718
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5719
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag
Control Module > Page 5720
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5721
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5722
Connector Pin-Outs Component Index
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5723
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Electrical Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "OFF". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion.
Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5724
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Airbag Control Module Location
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) contains the safing sensor and energy reserve capacitor. The
safing sensor is located inside the ACM. The module is mounted on the tunnel/floor pan between
the gear shift lever and the park brake lever. The safing sensor provides confirmation of a crash,
but does not discriminate severity. The ACM monitors the system to determine the system
readiness. The ACM contains on-board diagnostics, and will illuminate the AIRBAG warning lamp
in the cluster when a fault occurs. The warning equipment is tested for 6 to 8 Seconds every time
the vehicle is started.
Driver And Passenger Airbag Module
WARNING: NEVER DISASSEMBLE THE DRIVER OR PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE, THERE
ARE NO SERVICEABLE PARTS WITH IN THE MODULES.
Driver Airbag
The Driver Airbag Module located on the steering wheel is the most visible part of the system. The
airbag module contains a housing to which the cushion, inflator and cover are attached to.
The driver side inflator assembly is mounted from the back of the module housing. When supplied
with the proper electrical signal the inflator assembly will produce a gas and discharge it directly
into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted to the front of the Driver Airbag Module and forms a
decorative cover in the center of the steering wheel. The Driver Airbag Module is mounted directly
to the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5725
Passengers Airbag
The Passenger Airbag Module is located beneath the decorative cover of the instrument panel,
facing the passenger seat.
The passenger inflator assembly is within the module housing. The module is mounted to the
instrument panel retainer and support structure. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the
inflator will produce a gas and discharge it directly into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted into
the instrument panel over the airbag module and forms a decorative cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5726
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: -
THE ACM CONTAINS A SAFING SENSOR WHICH ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY THE
AIRBAGS. TO AVOID ACCIDENTAL DEPLOYMENT, NEVER CONNECT THE ACM
ELECTRICALLY TO THE SYSTEM WHILE VEHICLE BATTERY IS CONNECTED.
- DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE BEFORE
BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
- ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING ANY
AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
CAUTION: Failure to follow the parking brake service procedures can result in damage to the
parking brake mechanism.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Manual transaxle only, remove shifter knob
fastener and remove shifter knob.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
3. Remove screws attaching rear of center console assembly to console bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5727
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
4. Remove the two screws located in cup holders, attaching front of center console assembly to
console bracket. 5. Raise park brake hand lever assembly as high as it will go for required
clearance to remove center console. 6. Remove center console assembly from vehicle.
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS REQUIRED,
THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE RELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
7. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
8. Grasp park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward. Continue pulling on cable until a
3/16 in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and
sector gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off
park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5728
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
9. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer.
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
10. Remove wiring harness electrical connector for brake warning light from park brake lever.
Park Brake Lever Attachment To Console Bracket
11. Remove the two nuts attaching park brake lever to console bracket. Remove park brake lever
mechanism from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5729
Airbag Control Module
12. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module.
ACM Connector
13. Disconnect ACM 23-PIN connector. 14. Remove Airbag Control Module.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector locking tab is engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED SCREWS ONLY
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
11 to 14 N.m (105 to 125 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: The park brake lever can be in any position when releasing the auto adjuster. To ease
installation of center console, it is advisable to pull park brake lever handle all the way up before
removing lockout pin.
3. Place park brake lever on console bracket. Install and securely tighten the 2 attaching nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5730
Park Brake Cables Properly Installed In Equalizer
Rear Park Brake Cable Installation On Equalizer
4. Install both rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever output cable. 5. Ensure that
park brake cable is correctly installed and aligned with cable track on park brake lever. 6. Pull park
brake lever handle all the way up.
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever Assembly
7. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin and quickly remove it from the park brake lever
mechanism, This will allow the park brake lever
mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5731
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
8. Connect electrical connector for brake warning lamp onto terminal on park brake lever assembly.
9. Cycle park brake lever once to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever its
released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle. They should rotate freely without dragging.
10. Raise park brake lever to its fully engaged position. This is necessary to allow installation of the
center console. 11. Install center console assembly.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5732
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
12. Install the four center console assembly attaching screws. 13. Replace shifter knob and
fastener. 14. Do not connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag - On/Off Switches
NUMBER: 08-025-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 23, 2001
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-037-99, DATED
NOVEMBER 12, 1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN
THE 1999 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-00004). ALL
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS,
PARTS, AND 2001 MODEL YEAR PROCEDURES.
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN DOES NOT APPLY TO DIAMLERCHRYSLER CANADA DEALERS.
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - **2001** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 - **2001** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - **2001** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - **2001** (DN) Durango
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
**2001** (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - **2001** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - **2001** (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
**2001** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5737
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
**2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe**
1997 - 2001** (TJ) Wrangler
1999 - **2001** (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - **2001** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
NOTE:
**SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR PACKAGES (AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL/PT/RS/TJ) REQUIRE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER (ORC) CONFIGURATION USING THE DRB III(R) AS
DETAILED IN EACH VEHICLE SPECIFIC PACKAGE.**
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated) and
a detailed instruction sheet. Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule,
consumers will be authorized for on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria.
Airbag on-off switches must not be installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA
authorization letter. For more information concerning the authorization process and/or the
authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. We encourage you
(dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so and has the
necessary NHTSA authorization.
NOTE:
FOR SOME 2000 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (AB/AN/AN84/DN/JA/NS) **AND SOME 2001
CARRYOVER APPLICATIONS (AB/BR/WJ/XJ)**, A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS
REQUIRED, P/N 05013528AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG
SWITCH KIT. THE NEW INSERT IS ORANGE, AND MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE
CUSTOMER IN PLACE OF THE YELLOW ONE, P/N 05013517AA, THAT WILL COME IN THE
AIRBAG KIT.
**FOR SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (WITH J1850 BUS,
AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL(PT/RS/TJ) A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS REQUIRED, P/N
05016025AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG SWITCH KIT. THE
NEW INSERT MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE CUSTOMER AFTER INSTALLATION.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5738
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5739
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5740
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5741
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5742
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have~
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available in the "Forms Folder" under "TSB/Recall" tab of MDS2 and printed on
your dealership letterhead. keep a copy for your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5743
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag System - ON-OFF Switch
Availibility
NO: 08-17-98 Rev. C
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-17-98 Rev. B DATED
SEPTEMBER 18, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL
MODELS HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS:
**1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan**
1995 - **1999** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
**1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon**
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 -**1999** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue**
1994 - **1999** (BR) Ram Pickup
**1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth**
1998 - **1999** (DN) Durango
**1995 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon**
1995 - **1999** (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **1999** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 -**1999** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - **1999** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/ Voyager
1995 - **1999** (PL) Neon
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
1997 - **1999** (TJ) Wrangler
1997 - **1999** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. Other applicable passenger vehicles will be announced as soon as the switches are
available. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated)
and a detailed instruction sheet.
Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule, consumers will be authorized for
on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria. Airbag on-off switches must not be
installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA authorization letter. For more information
concerning the authorization process and/or the authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
We encourage you (dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so
and has the necessary NHTSA authorization.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5744
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5745
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5746
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5747
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5748
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have.
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available on T.I.L. and printed on your dealership letterhead. Keep a copy for
your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5749
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Technical Service Bulletins Airbag/Clock Spring - Service
NUMBER: 08-010-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 25, 2001
SUBJECT: Airbag/Clock Spring Service
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2002 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1988 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1988 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1988 - 1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Chrysler Maserati
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - 2002 (DN) Durango
2002 (DR) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2002 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2002 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2002 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2002 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2002 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1996 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2002 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2002 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2002 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1995 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
Airbag
When servicing any airbag system, it is essential to follow the proper Service Manual and/or
Diagnostic Manual procedures for diagnosing, testing, and replacing of any component. When
diagnosing any airbag squib circuit Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) with a DRBIII(R), the use of the
Airbag Load Tool (Special Tool 8310 and 8443) is required. The Airbag Load Tool, used in
conjunction with the DRBIII(R) are used to isolate and test components and wiring for failure. Only
replace the component or wiring that has failed. This will reduce unnecessary cost to the customer
or DaimlerChrysler.
NOTE:
AIRBAG REPLACEMENT IS NOT REQUIRED EVERY TIME IT IS REMOVED OR WHEN
ANOTHER COMPONENT HAS FAILED. USE OF THE DRBIII(R) AND AIRBAG LOAD TOOL
WILL DETERMINE IF THE AIRBAG HAS FAILED AND REPLACEMENT IS NEEDED.
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Airbag/Clock Spring - Service > Page 5754
TECHNICIANS SHOULD RECORD ALL STORED AND ACTIVE AIRBAG SYSTEM FAULT
CODES ON THE REPAIR ORDER.
Clock Springs
Recent analysis of returned clock springs have indicated that prior service may have contributed to
the clock spring's failure.
^ Do not use silicone or any other lubricant spray on or near the clock spring. Lubricants are often
used in the clock spring area of the steering column to eliminate noise. Lubricants may have an
adverse effect on the clock spring.
^ Clock spring centering. Any repair that may disrupt the positioning of the steering wheel with the
front wheels will require that the clock spring be centered. This includes clock spring replacement,
steering column service, HVAC service, steering gear service, and front suspension crossmember
service. Refer to the appropriate Service Manual for the clock spring centering procedure.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5755
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5756
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Clockspring The clockspring is mounted to the steering column behind the steering wheel. The
clockspring is used to maintain a continuous electrical circuit between the wiring harness and the: Driver's airbag module
- Speed control switches
- Horn switch
The clockspring consists of a flat, ribbon like, electrically conductive tape which winds and unwinds
with the steering wheel rotation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5757
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Adjustments
If the rotating tape within the clockspring is not positioned properly with the steering wheel and the
front wheels, the clockspring may fail during use. The following procedure MUST BE USED to
center the clockspring if:
- The clockspring is not known to be properly positioned
- The front wheels were moved
- The steering wheel was moved from the half turn (180 °) to the right (clockwise) position.
WARNING: DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE
BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING ANY
AIR BAG COMPONENTS.
1. Remove clockspring, refer to Clockspring Removal. 2. Rotate the clockspring rotor in the
CLOCKWISE DIRECTION to the end of travel. Do not apply excessive torque. 3. From the end of
travel, rotate the rotor two full turns and a half in the counterclockwise direction. The horn wire and
the squib wire should end up
at the bottom. If not, rotate the rotor counter clockwise until the wires are properly orientated, but
not more than half turn (180 °). Engage clockspring locking mechanism.
4. For installation, refer to Clockspring Installation 5. Do not connect battery negative cable. Refer
to Diagnosis and Testing for Airbag System Test procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5758
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE
BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY. ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES
BEFORE REMOVING ANY AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
1. Place the front road wheels in the straight ahead position then:
- Rotate the steering wheel half turn (180 °) to the right (clockwise)
- Lock column with ignition lock cylinder.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Wait two minutes for the reserve capacitor
to discharge before removing non-deployed module. 4. Remove speed control switch mounting
screws, switches and disconnect the wire connectors or remove covers. 5. Remove the Driver
Airbag Module attaching bolts from under the speed control switches or covers. 6. Lift module and
disconnect the airbag and horn wire connectors. 7. Remove the steering wheel, refer to Steering
and Suspension/Steering Wheel removal procedures. 8. Remove upper and lower steering column
shrouds to gain access to clockspring wiring.
9. Disconnect the 2-way and 4-way connectors between the clockspring and the instrument panel
wiring harness at the base of the clockspring.
10. Unlatch and remove clockspring assembly from steering shaft. The clockspring cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if faulty. 11. Rotate clockspring rotor a half turn (180 °) to the left
(counter clockwise). 12. Lock the clockspring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a paper
clip wire through the hole in the rotor at the 10 O' Clock position
and bend to prevent it from falling out.
INSTALLATION
1. Confirm that:
- The steering wheel position is a half turn (180 °) to the right (clockwise)
- The column is locked with the ignition cylinder lock.
- Check that the turn signal stalk is in the neutral position
- When reusing the clockspring, remove locking wire and rotate clockspring rotor one half turn (180
°) to the right (clockwise). Locate the clock-spring on the steering shaft and push down on the rotor
until the clockspring is fully seated on the steering column.
- When installing a new clockspring remove grenade pin and rotate clockspring rotor one half turn
(180 °) to the right (clockwise). Locate clock-spring on the steering shaft and push down on the
rotor until the clockspring is fully seated on the steering wheel.
2. Connect the clockspring to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly routed. Then
check that the connectors, locking tabs are
properly engaged and the halo lamp wire is in position.
3. Install steering column shrouds. Be sure all wires are inside of shrouds. 4. Install steering wheel
ensuring the fiats on hub align with the clockspring. Pull the horn, airbag and speed control leads
through the larger slot.
Ensure leads do not get pinched under the steering wheel.
5. Route speed control wires under and behind the airbag module mounting tabs. 6. Connect the
horn lead wire and the airbag lead wire to the airbag module. 7. Install the airbag module and
tighten bolts to 12 to 14 N.m (105 to 125 in. lbs.) torque. 8. Connect the speed control wires to the
switches and install switches. Tighten screws to 2 N.m (20 in. lbs.) torque. 9. Do not connect the
battery negative cable. Refer to Diagnosis and Testing for Airbag System Test procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The airbag control module (ACM) is an electronic module that monitors the airbag system for
proper operation, stores diagnostic trouble code (DTCs), controls the airbag warning lamp, and
contains the safing sensor and accelerometer that is responsible for airbag deployment. The ACM
is located on the floor pan between the gear shifter and the parking brake assembly. The ACM
provides diagnostic information (DTCs) to the technician through the DRB Ill via the CCD bus.
Some circuits are tested continuously; others are checked only under certain circumstances.
NOTE: The warning lamp is hardwired to the ACM and there are no external impact sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time
Child Seat: Technical Service Bulletins Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time
NUMBER: 23-008-00 Rev. B
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 24, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-08-00 REV. A, DATED
JULY 7, 2000, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS.
SUBJECT: Child Seat Tether Anchors
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1993 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier
1990 - 1994 (BD) Laser/Talon
1994 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1989 - 1992 (B2) Colt/Summit
1992 - 1995 (B3) Colt Vista
1989 (B5) Conquest
1989 - 1995 (B7) Stealth (2000 GTX Dodge/Eagle, Canada)
1992 - 1995 (B8) Colt Vista Wagon/Summit Wagon
1993 - 1994 (B9) Colt/Summit
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango
1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1995 - 1999 JA Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
**2000 (TJ) Wrangler**
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1989 - **2000** (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer
1993 - 1998 (WJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND LABOR OPERATION
NUMBERS NECESSARY TO INSTALL A CHILD SEAT TETHER ANCHOR. DAIMLERCHRYSLER
WILL REIMBURSE YOU FOR THE ANCHORS AND LABOR TO INSTALL THEM. THIS IS BEING
DONE IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION. REFER TO GLOBAL WARRANTY
ADMINISTRATION BULLETIN # D-99-23 FOR COMPLETE REIMBURSEMENT INSTRUCTIONS.
DISCUSSION: User-ready child restraint tether strap anchors will be provided in passenger cars in
the 2000 Model Year, and in light trucks in the 2001 Model Year. Tether straps improve the
performance of child restraints in collisions. Because of the publicity that has accompanied the "Fit
for a Kid" Program, owners of earlier products are expected to approach dealers for the free
provision and installation of the anchor hardware. DaimlerChrysler Corporation is offering child seat
tether anchors for the selected vehicles listed above. Each tether anchor is packaged in a kit
containing all necessary parts and a detailed instruction sheet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 5766
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 5767
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 5768
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 5769
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Child
Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 5770
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5780
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5781
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5782
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5783
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5784
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5785
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5786
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5787
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5788
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5789
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5790
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5791
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5792
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5793
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 > Jul > 97 > Recall Airbag Control Module > Page 5794
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module
Technical Service Bulletin # 731 Date: 970701
Recall - Airbag Control Module
No. 731
July, 1997
To: All Dealers
Subject: Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
Models: ^
1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure a vehicle
occupant. To correct this condition, the airbag control module (ACM) must be replaced.
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Federal law requires you to
complete this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also consider
this requirement to apply to used vehicle inventory, and should perform this recall on vehicles in for
service as determined by using DIAL System Function 70.
Details of this service action are explained in the following sections.
Service Procedure Videotape
No videotape of the service procedure for this recall will be provided.
Dealer Notification & Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this dealer recall notification letter by first class mail. Each dealer
to whom involved vehicles were invoiced (or the current dealer at the same street address) will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The Vehicle List is arranged in Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) sequence. Owners known to Chrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP
All involved vehicles will be entered to DIAL System Functions 53, 70 and VIP at the time of recall
implementation for dealer inquiry as needed.
Parts
Important:
A quantity of parts will be distributed initially and billed to all involved dealers. This quantity will
cover a portion of the total vehicles involved. Additional parts may be ordered as needed to support
customer demand.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5800
Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced (or the current dealer at the
same street address), will receive enough of each ACM Package to service about 25% of those
vehicles. Each package contains one (1) ACM. Refer to the table above for the appropriate
package application:
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for the service with their dealers. A copy
of the owner notification letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner notification is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
recall are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Service Procedure For Neon (PL) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Remove the shifter knob fastener and remove the
shifter knob.
3. Remove the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure
1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5801
4. Remove the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
5. Remove the bolt access covers and the two lower console bracket bolts on each side of the
console bin.
6. Raise the park brake hand lever as high as possible.
7. Remove the center console assembly.
WARNING:
The auto adjusting feature of the park brake lever assembly contains a clock spring loaded to
approximately 20 lbs. DO NOT release the auto adjuster lock out device before installing the cables
into the equalizer. Keep hands out of auto adjuster sector and pawl area. Failure to observe
caution in handling this mechanism could lead to serious injury.
8. Lower the park brake handle.
9. Grasp the park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward until a 3/16" drill bit can be
inserted into the handle and sector gear mechanism (Figure 3). This will remove the tension from
the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5802
10. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer (Figure 4).
11. Disconnect the brake warning light electrical connector from the park brake lever switch.
12. Remove the two park brake lever attaching nuts and remove the park brake lever assembly.
13. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 5):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
14. Remove the remaining three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor,
disconnect the two (2) park brake lever switch wire harness clips from the ACM bracket and then
remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
15. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
16. Loosely install the three (3) ACM attaching nuts.
17. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5803
18. Install the park brake lever assembly.
19. Tighten the four (4) ACM nuts and the remaining park brake lever nut to 115 in-lbs (12.5 N.m).
20. Connect the park brake lever switch electrical connector and attach the wiring clips to the ACM
bracket.
21. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer.
22. Pull the park brake lever handle all the way up.
23. Firmly grasp the park brake lever locking pin (drill bit) and quickly remove it from the
mechanism.
24. Cycle the park brake lever once to position the park brake cables.
25. Make sure that the park brake lever is fully raised and then install the center console assembly.
26. Install the front two (2) center console attaching screws located near the cup holders (Figure 1).
27. Install the two (2) screws at the bottom of the storage bin (Figure 2).
28. Install the two (2) outer lower console bracket bolts on each side of the storage bin and then
install the bolt covers.
29. For Manual Transmission Equipped Vehicles: Install the shifter knob and fastener.
30. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
31. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
32. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Dakota (AN) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area around the center instrument panel support.
3. Remove the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6).
4. Remove the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5804
5. Remove the support bracket.
6. Remove the ground eyelet screw from the left side of the ACM bracket.
7. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 7):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
8. Remove the three (3) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan
transmission tunnel (Figure 8).
9. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
10. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
11. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8
N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5805
12. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
13. Install the ground eyelet screw to the left side of the ACM bracket.
14. Install the center instrument panel support bracket.
15. Install the two (2) left side and one (1) right side support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the
bracket screws to 105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
16. Install the two (2) front center support bracket screws (Figure 6). Tighten the bracket screws to
105 in-lbs (11.8 N.m).
17. Reinstall the floor carpet around the center instrument panel support.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Pull back the floor carpet from the area under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and forward of
the center floor console.
3. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Remove the ABS acceleration sensor from its mounting bracket
and set aside (Figure 9).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5806
4. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 10).
5. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 11):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
6. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out from under the heater-A/C housing floor duct and
remove it from the vehicle.
7. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
8. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
9. Tighten the four (4) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m)
(Figure 10).
10. For vehicles equipped with ABS: Reinstall the ABS acceleration sensor (Figure 9). Tighten the
sensor mounting bolts to 40 in-lbs (4.5 N.m).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5807
11. Reinstall the floor carpet under the heater-A/C floor duct.
12. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
13. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
14. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles:
1. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the transmission shift lever handle by pulling straight up firmly and quickly.
3. Pry up the transmission shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
4. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the
transmission shift indicator bezel from the console.
5. Pry up the transfer case shift indicator bezel with a trim stick (Figure 12).
6. Lift the bezel far enough to remove the lamp socket from the bezel and then remove the transfer
case bezel from the console.
7. Remove the console attaching screws and then remove the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5808
8. Disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 13):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
9. Remove the four (4) screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor transmission
tunnel (Figure 14).
10. Remove the ACM and bracket assembly.
11. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
12. Tighten the four (4) ACM attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7 N.m).
13. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
14. Install the console and secure it with the attaching screws (Figure 12).
15. Install the lamp socket into the transfer case shift bezel and then install the bezel into the
console (Figure 12).
16. Install the lamp socket into the transmission shift indicator bezel and then install the bezel into
the console (Figure 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5809
17. Install the transmission shift lever handle.
18. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
19. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
20. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
Service Procedure For Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles:
1. Remove the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
2. Remove the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
3. With the ignition key in the OFF position, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
WAIT TWO (2) MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
CONTINUING.
Note:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to record all radio settings before disconnecting the
battery and to reset all electronic memory (clock, radio settings, etc.) when you have completed the
service procedure.
4. Remove the instrument panel center bezel and then disconnect the rear window defogger
switch, the power window switches and the lighter (Figure 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5810
5. Remove the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
6. Remove the headlamp switch knob by inserting a paper clip in the hole under the knob and
pushing gently to release the lock clip (Figure 16).
7. Remove the tilt steering handle.
8. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
9. Remove the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful not to break the headlamp switch lock tab when removing the I/P bezel.
10. Remove the two (2) radio mounting screws.
11. Remove the radio and disconnect the wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
12. Remove the radio from the vehicle.
13. Remove the HVAC control module. Only disconnect the vacuum and electrical connectors. Do
not disconnect the cable. Set the control module aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5811
14. Reach through the radio opening and disconnect the ACM wiring connector (Figure 17):
A. Pull the two white lock bars out about 1/8" (3 mm) on each side of the connector.
B. Squeeze the two (2) connector latch tabs between your thumb and forefinger while pulling the
connector out of the module.
15. Remove the three (3) nuts that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor pan transmission
tunnel (Figure 18).
16. Slide the ACM and bracket assembly out through the radio opening.
17. Install the provided ACM and bracket assembly with the arrow on the module pointing forward.
18. Tighten the three (3) ACM to floorpan transmission tunnel attaching screws to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
19. Connect the wiring connector to the ACM. Make sure it is fully seated and the lock bars are
engaged.
20. Connect the HVAC control head electrical and vacuum connectors. Install the HVAC control
module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5812
21. Connect the radio wire connector, coaxial cable and antenna cable.
22. Install the radio into the instrument panel and tighten the two (2) mounting screws.
23. Install the instrument panel bezel (Figure 16).
NOTE:
Be careful when installing the I/P bezel. Do not break the headlamp switch lock tab.
24. Install the headlamp switch knob (Figure 16).
25. Install the upper steering column cover.
26. Install the tilt steering handle.
27. Install the right and left knee blockers (Figure 16).
28. Connect the rear window defogger switch, the power window switches and the lighter and then
install the instrument panel center bezel (Figure 15).
29. Connect the DRB III, turn the ignition switch to the ON position and then exit the vehicle with
the DRB III.
30. Reconnect the negative battery cable and then watch the airbag light in the instrument cluster,
it should light for about 6-8 seconds and then go out.
31. With the DRB III, verify that no system diagnostic codes have been set.
NOTE:
If the airbag warning lamp fails to light or the light stays on, or the DRB displays a diagnostic code,
a system malfunction exists. Diagnose and repair the condition following normal service
procedures.
32. Install the left rear wheel well inner splash shield.
33. Install the left rear wheel and tire assembly.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement / Parts Return
Claims for vehicles which have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall service completions and provide dealer
payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances as shown.
Add the cost of the recall parts package plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
Parts Return
Initially, a small number of ACM and bracket assemblies are required to be returned to the
Warranty Material Return Center. When an adequate number of returned parts have been
accumulated, Parts Return Documents will no longer be generated and parts are to be discarded.
Note:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section for complete recall
claim processing and material return instructions.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service for a known reason, let us know by filling out the
pre-addressed Vehicle Disposition Form portion of the Owner Notification Form or describe the
reason on a postcard and mail to:
Chrysler Corporation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5813
CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan 48326-2757
Following the above procedures will expedite the processing of your claim.
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Zone
Service Office.
Dealer Service Instructions
IMPORTANT
Safety Recall # 731 -- Airbag Control Module
^ Effective immediately, this recall (# 731) cancels and supercedes Recall # 683 -- Airbag Control
Module for 1997 Jeep Wrangler (TJ) vehicles.
^ This service requirement applies only to:
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Belvidere Assembly Plant
("D" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090317)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge and Plymouth Neon (PL) Vehicles Built at the Toluca Assembly Plant
("T" in the 11th VIN Position) Through September 9, 1996 (MDH 090906)
^ 1997 Model Year Dodge Dakota (AN) Vehicles Built Through September 5, 1996 (MDH 090521)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Wrangler (TJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH 090319)
^ 1997 Model Year Jeep Grand Cherokee (ZJ) Vehicles Built Through September 3, 1996 (MDH
090312)
^ 1996 Model Year Dodge Viper GTS Coupe (SR) Vehicles Built Through September 30, 1996
(MDH 093014)
^ The airbags on the above listed vehicles, may inadvertently deploy during a three (3) second
period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position. To correct this condition, the airbag
control module (ACM) must be replaced.
Parts Packages:
^ Each involved dealer, to whom vehicles in the recall were invoiced, will receive enough ACM
Packages to service about 25% of those vehicles.
Owner Letter
SAFETY RECALL TO REPLACE YOUR VEHICLE'S AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
Dear Chrysler Vehicle Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act.
Chrysler Corporation has determined that a defect which relates to motor vehicle safety exists in
some 1997 Plymouth and Dodge Neon; Dodge Dakota; Jeep Grand Cherokee and Wrangler; and
1996 Dodge Viper GTS Coupe vehicles.
The problem is...
The airbags on your vehicle (identified on the enclosed form), may inadvertently deploy during a
three (3) second period after the ignition key has been turned to the off position, which could injure
a vehicle occupant.
What Chrysler and your dealer will do...
Chrysler will repair your (vehicle) free of charge (parts and labor). To do this, your dealer will
replace the airbag control module. The work will take about one hour to complete. However,
additional time may be necessary depending on how dealer appointments are scheduled and
processed.
What you must do to ensure your safety...
^ Simply contact your dealer right away to schedule a service appointment. Ask the dealer to hold
the parts for your vehicle or to order them before your appointment.
^ Bring the enclosed Owner Notification Form with you to your dealer. It explains the required
service to the dealer.
If you need help...
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 731 >
Jul > 97 > Recall - Airbag Control Module > Page 5814
If you have trouble getting your vehicle repaired, please call the Chrysler Customer Center, toll
free, at 1-800-853-1403. A representative will assist you in getting your vehicle repaired. If your
dealer fails or is unable to remedy this defect without charge and within a reasonable time, you
may submit a written complaint to the Administrator, National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration, 400 Seventh Street, S.W., Washington, D.C. 20590, or call the Toll Free Auto
Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. (Washington, D.C. area residents may call 366-0123.)
We're sorry for any inconvenience, but we are sincerely concerned about your safety. Thanks for
your attention to this important matter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5815
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5816
Connector Pin-Outs Component Index
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5817
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Electrical Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "OFF". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion.
Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5818
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Airbag Control Module Location
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) contains the safing sensor and energy reserve capacitor. The
safing sensor is located inside the ACM. The module is mounted on the tunnel/floor pan between
the gear shift lever and the park brake lever. The safing sensor provides confirmation of a crash,
but does not discriminate severity. The ACM monitors the system to determine the system
readiness. The ACM contains on-board diagnostics, and will illuminate the AIRBAG warning lamp
in the cluster when a fault occurs. The warning equipment is tested for 6 to 8 Seconds every time
the vehicle is started.
Driver And Passenger Airbag Module
WARNING: NEVER DISASSEMBLE THE DRIVER OR PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE, THERE
ARE NO SERVICEABLE PARTS WITH IN THE MODULES.
Driver Airbag
The Driver Airbag Module located on the steering wheel is the most visible part of the system. The
airbag module contains a housing to which the cushion, inflator and cover are attached to.
The driver side inflator assembly is mounted from the back of the module housing. When supplied
with the proper electrical signal the inflator assembly will produce a gas and discharge it directly
into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted to the front of the Driver Airbag Module and forms a
decorative cover in the center of the steering wheel. The Driver Airbag Module is mounted directly
to the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5819
Passengers Airbag
The Passenger Airbag Module is located beneath the decorative cover of the instrument panel,
facing the passenger seat.
The passenger inflator assembly is within the module housing. The module is mounted to the
instrument panel retainer and support structure. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the
inflator will produce a gas and discharge it directly into the cushion. A protective cover is fitted into
the instrument panel over the airbag module and forms a decorative cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5820
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: -
THE ACM CONTAINS A SAFING SENSOR WHICH ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY THE
AIRBAGS. TO AVOID ACCIDENTAL DEPLOYMENT, NEVER CONNECT THE ACM
ELECTRICALLY TO THE SYSTEM WHILE VEHICLE BATTERY IS CONNECTED.
- DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE BEFORE
BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
- ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING ANY
AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
CAUTION: Failure to follow the parking brake service procedures can result in damage to the
parking brake mechanism.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Manual transaxle only, remove shifter knob
fastener and remove shifter knob.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
3. Remove screws attaching rear of center console assembly to console bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5821
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
4. Remove the two screws located in cup holders, attaching front of center console assembly to
console bracket. 5. Raise park brake hand lever assembly as high as it will go for required
clearance to remove center console. 6. Remove center console assembly from vehicle.
WARNING: THE AUTO ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER ASSEMBLY
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 20 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTO ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE BEFORE INSTALLING CABLES INTO
THE EQUALIZER. KEEP HANDS OUT OF AUTO ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA.
FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO
SERIOUS INJURY.
WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARK BRAKE HAND LEVER ASSEMBLY OR CABLES IS REQUIRED,
THE AUTO ADJUSTER MUST BE RELOADED AND LOCKED OUT.
7. Lower park brake lever handle.
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
8. Grasp park brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward. Continue pulling on cable until a
3/16 in. drill bit can be inserted into handle and
sector gear of park brake mechanism. This will lock the park brake mechanism and take tension off
park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5822
Locking Pin Installed In Park Brake Mechanism
9. Remove both rear park brake cables from the park brake cable equalizer.
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
10. Remove wiring harness electrical connector for brake warning light from park brake lever.
Park Brake Lever Attachment To Console Bracket
11. Remove the two nuts attaching park brake lever to console bracket. Remove park brake lever
mechanism from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5823
Airbag Control Module
12. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module.
ACM Connector
13. Disconnect ACM 23-PIN connector. 14. Remove Airbag Control Module.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector locking tab is engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED SCREWS ONLY
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
11 to 14 N.m (105 to 125 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: The park brake lever can be in any position when releasing the auto adjuster. To ease
installation of center console, it is advisable to pull park brake lever handle all the way up before
removing lockout pin.
3. Place park brake lever on console bracket. Install and securely tighten the 2 attaching nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5824
Park Brake Cables Properly Installed In Equalizer
Rear Park Brake Cable Installation On Equalizer
4. Install both rear park brake cables into equalizer on park brake lever output cable. 5. Ensure that
park brake cable is correctly installed and aligned with cable track on park brake lever. 6. Pull park
brake lever handle all the way up.
Removing Lockout Pin From Park Brake Lever Assembly
7. Firmly grasp park brake lever locking pin and quickly remove it from the park brake lever
mechanism, This will allow the park brake lever
mechanism to correctly adjust the park brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5825
Brake Warning Lamp Connection To Park Brake Lever
8. Connect electrical connector for brake warning lamp onto terminal on park brake lever assembly.
9. Cycle park brake lever once to position park brake cables. Then return the park brake lever its
released position. Check the rear wheels of the
vehicle. They should rotate freely without dragging.
10. Raise park brake lever to its fully engaged position. This is necessary to allow installation of the
center console. 11. Install center console assembly.
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With/Without Arm Rest
Attaching Screws At Rear Of Center Console With Arm Rest
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5826
Attaching Screws At Front Of Center Console
12. Install the four center console assembly attaching screws. 13. Replace shifter knob and
fastener. 14. Do not connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 5832
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Child Seat Tether
Installation
NUMBER: 23-029-08
GROUP: Body
DATE: October 24, 2008
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-08-00 REV. B, DATED
NOVEMBER 24, 2000, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
DEALERS PLEASE NOTE, THIS IS REIMBURSABLE REGARDLESS OF VEHICLE AGE OR
MILEAGE.
SUBJECT: Child Seat Tether Anchor Installation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes procedures to install Child Seat Tether Anchors based on
Customer Request.
NOTE:
Dealers are encouraged to honor any customers request for the installation of the Child Seat
Tether Anchors and Dealer reimbursement will be made by Chrysler regardless of vehicle age or
mileage. See the Warranty Policy and Procedure Manual and or Warranty Bulletin D-08-33 for
reimbursement detail.
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1993 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shawdow/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier
1990 - 1994 (BD) Laser/Talon
1994 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1989 - 1992 (B2) Colt/Summit
1992 - 1995 (B3) Colt Vista
1989 (B5) Conquest
1989 - 1995 (B7) Stealth (2000 GTX Dodge/Eagle, Canada)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5838
1992 - 1995 (B8) Colt Vista Wagon/Summit Wagon
1993 - 1994 (B9) Colt/Summit
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango
1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
2000 (TJ) Wrangler
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1989 - 2000 (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION: User-ready child restraint tether strap anchors will be provided in passenger cars in
the 2000 Model Year, and in light trucks in the 2001 Model Year and later. Tether straps improve
the performance of child restraints in collisions. Because of the publicity that has accompanied the
"Fit for a Kid" Program, owners of earlier products are expected to approach dealers for the free
provision and installation of the anchor hardware.
Chrysler is offering child seat tether anchors for the selected vehicles listed above. Each tether
anchor is packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts and a detailed instruction sheet.
NOTE:
This bulletin is provided to identify the parts and labor operation numbers necessary to install a
Child Seat Tether Anchor. Each dealer is encouraged to install these kits based on customer
request and Chrysler will reimburse any Chrysler / Dodge / or Jeep dealer installing these kits
regardless of vehicle age or mileage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5839
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5840
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction, Reimbursable regardless of mileage or age.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5841
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5842
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5843
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5844
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Technical Service Bulletins Child Seat Tether Anchor - Labor/Parts
Identification
NUMBER: 23-35-99 Rev. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: Oct. 1, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-35-99 DATED
SEPTEMBER 3, 1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE CHANGES IN SOME TIME
ALLOWANCES.
SUBJECT: Child Seat Tether Anchors
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN DOES NOT APPLY TO DAIMLERCHRYSLER CANADA DEALERS.
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1993 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier
1990 - 1994 (BD) Laser/Talon
1994 - 2000 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1989 - 1992 (B2) Colt/Summit
1992 - 1995 (B3) Colt Vista
1989 (B5) Conquest
1989 - 1995 (B7) Stealth (2000 GTX Dodge/Eagle, Canada)
1992 - 1995 (B8) Colt Vista Wagon/Summit Wagon
1993 - 1994 (B9) Colt/Summit
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango
1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1995 - 1999 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1989 - 2000 (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND LABOR OPERATION
NUMBERS NECESSARY TO INSTALL A CHILD SEAT TETHER ANCHOR. DAIMLERCHRYSLER
WILL REIMBURSE YOU FOR THE ANCHORS AND LABOR TO INSTALL THEM. THIS IS BEING
DONE IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION. REFER TO GLOBAL WARRANTY
ADMINISTRATION BULLETIN # D-99-23 FOR COMPLETE REIMBURSEMENT INSTRUCTIONS.
DISCUSSION
User-ready child restraint tether strap anchors will be provided in passenger cars in the 2000 Model
Year, and in light truck in the 2001 Model Year. Tether straps improve the performance of child
restraints in collisions. Because of the publicity that has accompanied the "Fit for a kid" Program,
owners of earlier products are expected to approach dealers for the free provision and installation
of the anchor hardware. DaimlerChrysler Corporation is offering child seat tether anchors for the
selected vehicles listed above. Each tether anchor is packaged in a kit containing all necessary
parts and a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5845
detailed instruction sheet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5846
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5847
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5848
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Failure Code: CG - Customer Satisfaction
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5849
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Technical Service Bulletins Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part
Numbers & Labor Time
NUMBER: 23-008-00 Rev. B
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 24, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-08-00 REV. A, DATED
JULY 7, 2000, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS.
SUBJECT: Child Seat Tether Anchors
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1993 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier
1990 - 1994 (BD) Laser/Talon
1994 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1989 - 1992 (B2) Colt/Summit
1992 - 1995 (B3) Colt Vista
1989 (B5) Conquest
1989 - 1995 (B7) Stealth (2000 GTX Dodge/Eagle, Canada)
1992 - 1995 (B8) Colt Vista Wagon/Summit Wagon
1993 - 1994 (B9) Colt/Summit
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango
1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1995 - 1999 JA Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
**2000 (TJ) Wrangler**
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1989 - **2000** (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer
1993 - 1998 (WJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND LABOR OPERATION
NUMBERS NECESSARY TO INSTALL A CHILD SEAT TETHER ANCHOR. DAIMLERCHRYSLER
WILL REIMBURSE YOU FOR THE ANCHORS AND LABOR TO INSTALL THEM. THIS IS BEING
DONE IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION. REFER TO GLOBAL WARRANTY
ADMINISTRATION BULLETIN # D-99-23 FOR COMPLETE REIMBURSEMENT INSTRUCTIONS.
DISCUSSION: User-ready child restraint tether strap anchors will be provided in passenger cars in
the 2000 Model Year, and in light trucks in the 2001 Model Year. Tether straps improve the
performance of child restraints in collisions. Because of the publicity that has accompanied the "Fit
for a Kid" Program, owners of earlier products are expected to approach dealers for the free
provision and installation of the anchor hardware. DaimlerChrysler Corporation is offering child seat
tether anchors for the selected vehicles listed above. Each tether anchor is packaged in a kit
containing all necessary parts and a detailed instruction sheet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5850
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5851
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5852
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5853
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Tether Installation > Page 5854
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
Seat Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
NUMBER: 08-010-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr.25, 2003
SUBJECT: Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
MODELS:
2001 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon (Front Passenger Seat Belt Only)
1994 (BR) Ram Pickup
1996-2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango (Front Passenger Seat Belt Only)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - 2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
DISCUSSION:
Any time the seat belt cinch bar (Fig. 1) is loose, missing or damaged it is no longer necessary to
replace the seat belt assembly. Cinch bar repair kits are now available for the vehicles listed. If any
component of the seat belt assembly has been damaged due to collision, the entire assembly must
be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service > Page 5859
NOTE:
THE CINCH BAR, CINCH BAR COVER OR ANY OTHER COMPONENT OF THE SEAT BELT
ASSEMBLY MUST NEVER BE PAINTED.
NOTE:
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS ARE INCLUDED WITH EACH KIT.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SELECT THE COLOR CLOSEST TO THE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY COLOR.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The fasten seat belt indicator is used with the warning chime to indicate to the operator to fasten
the seat belt. There is a switch located in the drivers side B-pillar that is normally OPEN with the
seat belt buckled.
If the seat belt is not buckled the switch CLOSES and a ground path is completed from the G10
circuit to the Z1 circuit. This will illuminate the lamp in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition switch is moved to the START position the lamp will illuminate. Logic internal to
the instrument cluster determines the length of time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag - On/Off Switches
NUMBER: 08-025-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 23, 2001
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-037-99, DATED
NOVEMBER 12, 1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN
THE 1999 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-00004). ALL
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS,
PARTS, AND 2001 MODEL YEAR PROCEDURES.
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN DOES NOT APPLY TO DIAMLERCHRYSLER CANADA DEALERS.
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - **2001** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 - **2001** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - **2001** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - **2001** (DN) Durango
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
**2001** (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - **2001** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - **2001** (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
**2001** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5868
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
**2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe**
1997 - 2001** (TJ) Wrangler
1999 - **2001** (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - **2001** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
NOTE:
**SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR PACKAGES (AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL/PT/RS/TJ) REQUIRE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER (ORC) CONFIGURATION USING THE DRB III(R) AS
DETAILED IN EACH VEHICLE SPECIFIC PACKAGE.**
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated) and
a detailed instruction sheet. Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule,
consumers will be authorized for on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria.
Airbag on-off switches must not be installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA
authorization letter. For more information concerning the authorization process and/or the
authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. We encourage you
(dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so and has the
necessary NHTSA authorization.
NOTE:
FOR SOME 2000 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (AB/AN/AN84/DN/JA/NS) **AND SOME 2001
CARRYOVER APPLICATIONS (AB/BR/WJ/XJ)**, A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS
REQUIRED, P/N 05013528AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG
SWITCH KIT. THE NEW INSERT IS ORANGE, AND MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE
CUSTOMER IN PLACE OF THE YELLOW ONE, P/N 05013517AA, THAT WILL COME IN THE
AIRBAG KIT.
**FOR SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (WITH J1850 BUS,
AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL(PT/RS/TJ) A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS REQUIRED, P/N
05016025AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG SWITCH KIT. THE
NEW INSERT MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE CUSTOMER AFTER INSTALLATION.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5869
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5870
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5871
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5872
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5873
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have~
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available in the "Forms Folder" under "TSB/Recall" tab of MDS2 and printed on
your dealership letterhead. keep a copy for your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5874
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag System - ON-OFF Switch
Availibility
NO: 08-17-98 Rev. C
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-17-98 Rev. B DATED
SEPTEMBER 18, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL
MODELS HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS:
**1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan**
1995 - **1999** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
**1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon**
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 -**1999** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue**
1994 - **1999** (BR) Ram Pickup
**1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth**
1998 - **1999** (DN) Durango
**1995 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon**
1995 - **1999** (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **1999** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 -**1999** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - **1999** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/ Voyager
1995 - **1999** (PL) Neon
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
1997 - **1999** (TJ) Wrangler
1997 - **1999** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. Other applicable passenger vehicles will be announced as soon as the switches are
available. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated)
and a detailed instruction sheet.
Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule, consumers will be authorized for
on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria. Airbag on-off switches must not be
installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA authorization letter. For more information
concerning the authorization process and/or the authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
We encourage you (dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so
and has the necessary NHTSA authorization.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5875
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5876
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5877
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5878
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5879
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have.
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available on T.I.L. and printed on your dealership letterhead. Keep a copy for
your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation Switch
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 5880
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The airbag control module (ACM) is an electronic module that monitors the airbag system for
proper operation, stores diagnostic trouble code (DTCs), controls the airbag warning lamp, and
contains the safing sensor and accelerometer that is responsible for airbag deployment. The ACM
is located on the floor pan between the gear shifter and the parking brake assembly. The ACM
provides diagnostic information (DTCs) to the technician through the DRB Ill via the CCD bus.
Some circuits are tested continuously; others are checked only under certain circumstances.
NOTE: The warning lamp is hardwired to the ACM and there are no external impact sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Antenna: Testing and Inspection
Bench Test For Antenna Malfunction
It is also possible to check short or open circuits with an ohmmeter or continuity light once the
antenna has been removed from the vehicle.
Antenna Bench Test Points
1. Continuity should he present between the tip of the mast and radio lead. 2. No continuity should
be observed or a very high resistance of several megohms between the ground shell of the
connector and radio end pin. 3. Continuity should be observed between the ground shell of the
connector and the mounting bracket. Wiggle cable over its entire length to
reveal intermittent short or open circuits during step 1, 2 and 3.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5888
Antenna: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Antenna Mast Removal - Typical
Antenna Mast Removal-Export
1. Remove antenna mast by unscrewing mast from antenna body. 2. Locate the antenna lead
disconnect in the instrument panel wire harness above the right kick panel. Disconnect the antenna
cable from cable lead.
Antenna Mounting
3. Unfasten push pins from the rear of the plastic inner fender shield and move shield to gain
access to mounting screws. 4. Remove mounting screw and remove antenna base and cable
assembly from under the fender.
INSTALLATION
1. Align antenna adapter tongue with grove in the fender hole and push adapter into fender.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5889
2. From under the fender, push the antenna base and cable assembly through the adapter in the
fender. Tighten mounting screw to 7 N.m (75 in. lbs.). 3. Seat the grommet in the side panel and
connect the cable to the instrument panel harness connector. 4. Install the plastic inner fender
shield. 5. Connect the antenna cable to the cable lead.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5896
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Programming Connector > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Programming Connector: Locations
Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a GREEN wire with a RED BULLET CONNECTOR.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: > 08-39-97 > Nov > 97 > RKE Transmitter - Premature Battery
Failure
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Customer Interest RKE Transmitter - Premature Battery Failure
NO: 08-39-97
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 28, 1997
SUBJECT: Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Batteries Discharge Prematurely
MODELS:
1997 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1997 - 1998 (AN) Dakota/Dakota Cab & Chassis
1998 (BRIBE)Ram Truck
1998 (DN) Durango
1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/Vision
1997 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1997 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO AUGUST 15, 1997 (MDH 0815XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter batteries discharge in approximately 6 weeks.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the vehicle was built prior to MDH
0815XX, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04686366 Transmitter, RKE- NS, PL & PR
AR 04759136AB Transmitter, RKE- LH
AR 56007049 Transmitter, RKE- AB & 1997 AN
AR 56008761 Transmitter 1, RKE- ZJ & DN
AR 56008762 Transmitter 2, RKE- ZJ
AR 56021903AA Transmitter, RKE- BR/BE & 1998 AN
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the RKE transmitter(s).
1. Replace RKE transmitter(s) that have discharged batteries.
2. Program the RKE transmitter(s) to the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-28-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: > 08-39-97 > Nov > 97 > RKE Transmitter - Premature
Battery Failure
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: All Technical Service Bulletins RKE Transmitter - Premature
Battery Failure
NO: 08-39-97
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 28, 1997
SUBJECT: Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Batteries Discharge Prematurely
MODELS:
1997 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1997 - 1998 (AN) Dakota/Dakota Cab & Chassis
1998 (BRIBE)Ram Truck
1998 (DN) Durango
1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/Vision
1997 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1997 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO AUGUST 15, 1997 (MDH 0815XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter batteries discharge in approximately 6 weeks.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the vehicle was built prior to MDH
0815XX, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04686366 Transmitter, RKE- NS, PL & PR
AR 04759136AB Transmitter, RKE- LH
AR 56007049 Transmitter, RKE- AB & 1997 AN
AR 56008761 Transmitter 1, RKE- ZJ & DN
AR 56008762 Transmitter 2, RKE- ZJ
AR 56021903AA Transmitter, RKE- BR/BE & 1998 AN
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the RKE transmitter(s).
1. Replace RKE transmitter(s) that have discharged batteries.
2. Program the RKE transmitter(s) to the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-28-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-23-99 Date: 990709
Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations
NUMBER: 08-23-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Jul. 9, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-16-98, DATED APRIL 17,
1998, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1998
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO.81-699-99003). ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF THE 2000
MODEL YEAR VEHICLES.
SUBJECT: Installation of Radio Transmitting Equipment
MODELS: 1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan 1989 - **2000** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon 1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram
Pickup/Ramcharger 1989 - 1993 (AG) Daytona 1989 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron
Convertible 1989 - **2000** (AN) Dakota 1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth
Avenue 1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier 1994 - **2000** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup 1998 - **2000**
(DN) Durango 1992 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market) 1995 - **2000** (FJ)
Sebring/Avenger/Talon 1996 - **2000** (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1995 **2000** (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1993 - **2000** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1989 - 1992 (MJ) Comanche 1996 - **2000** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1995 **2000** (PL) Neon 1992 - **2000** (SR) Viper/Viper GTS 1997 - **2000** (TJ) Wrangler 1999 **2000** (WJ) Grand Cherokee 1989 - **2000** (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer 1989 - 1995 (YJ)
Wrangler 1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market) 1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand
Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION: Included is a copy of DaimlerChrysler's Radio Communication Equipment
Installation Recommendations. It is being provided with this Technical Service Bulletin to assist in
properly installing communication equipment in DaimlerChrysler vehicles. This information should
be given to any owner inquiring about installing radio-transmitting equipment.
Installation Recommendations
DaimlerChrysler
Radio Communication Equipment Installation Recommendations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5918
The following is excerpted from the owners manual of new DaimlerChrysler products:
"INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this vehicle's electronic system to provide
immunity to radio frequency signals. Mobile two-way radio and telephone equipment must be
installed properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly to the battery and fused as close to the
battery as possible. The negative power connection should be made to body sheet metal adjacent
to the negative battery connection. This connection should not be fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the roof or the rear area of the vehicle. Care
should be used in mounting antennas with magnet bases. Magnets may affect the accuracy or
operation of the compass on vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and routed away from the vehicle wiring when
possible. Use only fully shielded coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to ensure a low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than normal may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications
equipment and the vehicle's electronic systems. A Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) is available for
detailed assistance."
The owner's first line of contact regarding vehicle problems is the dealer. The literature supplied
with each vehicle lists the steps to be taken in the event the dealer is unable to resolve the
problem. To assist in properly installing communications equipment in DaimlerChrysler vehicles,
the following information is provided. Always use good construction practices (see The ARRL
Handbook or other standard reference works).
The information contained in this guide has been prepared for use by persons installing two-way
radio equipment (transmitters and receivers) in vehicles. It has been prepared in accordance with
current engineering principles and generally accepted practices, using the best information
available at the time of publication. It is not possible to cover all of the possible installations of
two-way radio equipment in this guide. Accordingly, DaimlerChrysler Corporation cannot be held
responsible for incidental or consequent damages arising out of the use of the information
contained herein. The responsibility for installations and modifications is the sole responsibility of
the customer.
The installation recommendations presented here are intended to supplement the radio
manufacturer's instructions. Test the entire installation for anomalies, especially drivetrain and
brake control before extensive driving.
1. CONTROLS Mount the transceiver to a solid surface. If you use screws through the floor pan,
put body sealer over the underbody projections. (Stamped acorn nuts, filled with sealer are
available at most body shops for this purpose.) This will keep moisture out of the carpet and
insulation, and will forestall rust in this area. Watch out for wire harnesses routed under carpet and
behind instrument panel.
If you mount the radio under the instrument panel, be sure that there is no interference with proper
operation of the foot controls. Mount the control head or front panel (especially the microphone
cable) so that it is clear of the steering wheel and column controls and passenger airbag. If the unit
is heavy, extra bracing may be needed for stability. Newer vehicles have more structure and
energy absorbing materials in the knee blocker (the lower part of the Instrument Panel).
For one-piece transceivers, if ignition switch control is desired, it is good practice to use a power
relay to avoid overloading the ignition switch, and to maintain the advantages of direct battery feed.
Try the installation out before you start drilling holes.
2. POWER WIRING To reduce the hazard of working on the vehicle, disconnect the battery
NEGATIVE before beginning work. Note that some components may lose short-term memory (e.g.:
radio presets) after a protracted time without battery power.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5919
For low or medium power transmitters (up to 55W FM or 110W SSB or CW), the power outlet or
cigar lighter feed may be used. Use a 1/4" jumper terminal at the socket or splice (solder and heat
shrink or tape). For higher power transmitters, including amplifiers, connect the power (battery +)
lead at the battery or at the power distribution center or at the positive jump-start post, if the vehicle
has one. An appropriate terminal should be used. If the terminal is exposed to the weather, solder
and apply a commercial protectant (wheel bearing grease is an acceptable alternative.) to retard
corrosion. This lead should be fused as close to the battery as practical to protect the wiring (and
the vehicle)! If the power connection is underhood, use a weatherproof fuse holder. Motorola
Communications Division supplies a weatherproof holder, part number 09-84277B01 for 5AG
cartridge fuses that is part of their standard installation kit. Packard Electric Division of Delphi
Automotive Systems makes an insulator, part number 12033769, terminal number 12020156 with
cover 12033731 for standard SAE plastic fuses.
Vinyl-insulated wire, typically supplied with transceivers is not entirely suitable for the higher
underhood temperatures in modern vehicles. Route underhood wiring away from all hot areas.
Body sheet metal, away from the exhaust, radiator, A/C liquid line and engine is usually the coolest
location.
DO NOT FUSE THE GROUND LEAD. If the ground-side fuse were to open, the entire supply
current would be conducted by an alternate current return path, which could cause the feedline to
overheat, with possible resulting damage.
For low or medium power installations, connect the ground (battery -) to body sheet near the power
feed point. If you use a screw through the floor, put body sealer over the underbody projection.
(Stamped acorn nuts, filled with sealer are available at most body shops for this purpose.) For high
power installations, connect the ground (battery -) lead at the battery connection to the body. This
is usually a 6 or 8 AWG black wire from the battery negative terminal to a screw at the wheelhouse
or radiator support. If a separate sheet metal ground is used, clean the paint off a one inch or so
diameter area of body panel where the ground lead is to be connected (usually the case with
commercial trunk mount radios). An awl is the best tool to use to pierce a starting hole for a #12 or
5mm, minimum plated ground screw. A ring terminal with lockwasher serrations of the proper size
for the screw or a separate serrated (not a split or SAE) lockwasher should be used between the
terminal and the screw head. As above, some grease or protectant should be used if the
connection is in an unprotected area.
If the power cable must pass through the dash panel, try to find an existing hole with a grommet
that is unused. If none is available, pull the carpet back from under the dash panel in the passenger
footwell in the cabin. Locate a place where there are no other components on either side, as high
up as possible. An awl is the best tool to use to punch a small hole through to the engine
compartment. If the position is good, enlarge the hole by driving the awl in up to the shank. If this is
not large enough to easily pass the cable, enlarge it by using a larger tapered punch. This will
leave an extruded hole with no sharp edges. Install the cable and seal the hole with silicone RTV or
commercial body sealer on both sides. Seal any extra holes that you may have made. Dress the
underhood wiring so that it is sate from all hazards, which include the following: exhaust manifold,
steering shaft, throttle linkage, fans, etc. Tie wrap as required.
3. CABLING Route control cables under the floor mats, inside the corner where the floor pan meets
the rocker panel for best protection. Remove the sill plates and tuck the cable under the floor mats
or carpet and padding. For most left hand drive vehicles, use the right side for best separation to
the main body harness (usually on the left side).
Route the cable along the extreme outboard edge of the floor pan, under the side trim, if possible.
4. REMOTE TRANSCEIVER For trunk mount installations in passenger cars, you may need to
remove the rear seat cushion and seat back to get the cable into the trunk. The seat cushion is
usually clipped at the front, lower edge by its own frame: push down and back, then lift. Note the
front and rear clipping points for ease of reinstallation. The seat back is usually clipped to the rear
compartment inner panel: pull out at the bottom and slide up to remove. Again, note the clipping
points for ease of reinstallation. There is usually a vapor/sound barrier behind the seat back, which
must be pierced to pass the cable.
Open the trunk and pick a spot where the cable is safe from chafing on any sharp sheet metal. Tie
wrap or tape in place at this location. Repair the barrier sheet if necessary. Replace the seat back
and cushion, taking care that the cable is not pinched by the seat cushion when there is someone
sitting in the seat. On some vehicles, there may be a channel for wiring at this location.
For remote control radios, a sheet of 1/2 in. plywood one or two inches larger than the radio, is a
good method to mount the transceiver to the shelf. It provides a good mounting surface, some
shock and vibration isolation, and it keeps moisture away from the radio. Mounting on the floor of
the trunk is not recommended. To conserve trunk space, in some vehicles, the radio may be
mounted to the rear compartment panel. Locate as far as possible from any vehicle electronic
modules located in the rear of the vehicle.
In any case, provide good air circulation; a 50 watt RF output FM transmitter will dissipate about 22
watts (@70% efficiency). Do not pile things on top of the unit.
5. TRANSMISSION LINE The transmission line (coaxial cable) should be treated in the same way
as the control and power cables. Route flat along body sheet metal wherever possible to avoid
sharp edges and pinches. If it is necessary to cross over wiring, cross at right angles. In some
cases, additional shielding between the transmission line and the vehicle wiring may be helpful. It is
important to maintain the maximum spacing from the vehicle harnesses, especially if the antenna is
not a good match. Use the best cable available (98-99% braid coverage or braid/foil) especially at
UHF and above. Mechanical pressure on the cable can cause degradation or even short circuits.
Do not rely on the obsolete military "RG" designations as an indicator of quality.
Cut off, do not coil excess transmission line (This forms a choke balun.) and terminate in the
correct connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5920
The use of N, BNC or C connectors is recommended over "UHF" (PL-259/S0-239) connectors. A
small amount of silicone dielectric grease (not the white heat sink compound) in the connector
(after soldering) will minimize condensation problems. Cut the line as short as practical, to minimize
losses.
6. ANTENNA LOCATION Antenna location is the most important consideration in any mobile
installation. For VHF and UHF antennas the recommended place on almost all vehicles is in the
center of the roof. The center of the deck lid is an acceptable alternate. Glass-mounted antennas
should be mounted at the very top edge of the clear portion of the glass away from the heater grid.
Vehicles with printed-on-glass antennas may be damaged by through-glass installations.
For HF antennas, refer to the manufacturer's instructions and follow them closely, unless you are
an accomplished antenna experimenter. HF antennas should be mounted to body or frame steel
for a good counterpoise as well as structural strength. Aluminum bumpers are heavily anodized for
corrosion protection, and the coating (aluminum oxide) is very hard as well as nonconductive. A
small grinder with a coarse stone will break through the anodized coating for electrical connection.
7. ANTENNA INSTALLATION Permanently installed antennas are preferable over magnetic, glass
or body-lip mounts for anything other than for low power or temporary installations. Most of these
alternate antennas will reflect some power back at the feedpoint. Much of this will be radiated from
the feedline inside the passenger compartment, and may be picked up by the vehicle wiring.
For deck lid installations, the deck lid must be bonded to the body, across the hinges, with short,
wide tinned braid straps. They must connect to clean sheet metal at both ends. For AM/SSB and
even some FM installations, the hood must be bonded to the body. In some cases the doors may
need to be bonded, as well.
Glass-mount antennas will not work or will only work very poorly in vehicles with metallized glass
(Electrically-heated windshields or some solar reflective glass). Non-metallic bodies (e.g., Viper)
require a half-wavelength antenna or a ground plane with radius approximately equal to the length
of a quarter-wave antenna. Copper is the best choice, but aluminum or even steel may be used.
Install on the inside of the body panel with a good adhesive or tape and provide a good RF
connection to the coax shield at the feedpoint. Screen, mesh or thin sheet stock may be used.
Shape is not critical, but some directional characteristics may be noted if it is not round. Try to stay
one-quarter wavelength away from edges, including sunroof openings. Consider the sunroof
mechanism for interference to the base and to the feedline.
For VHF and UHF, a good quality "NMO" (New Motorola) base or other mount with feedline (center
conductor and shield) soldered to base is recommended. This will allow the maximum flexibility in
antenna selection and is the best choice for electrical and mechanical considerations. Use the
proper hole saw (3/4 in. for NMO) or have it done professionally if you are not comfortable with
power tools. Hole plugs are available, for use at sale or trade-in, if you expect to remove the
antenna base.
To install the antenna base in the hole, remove the one or two-door trim pieces at the pillar where
the cable is to be routed and ease the headliner away from the roof. Insert a piece of flat steel or
plastic banding (1/2 in. to 3/4 in. wide) and guide to the desired corner. Pull the banding through,
leaving 6 in., which can be taped, to the transmission line (easier without the connector, but
possible even with a PL-259). Continue pulling until the antenna base is one inch or less from the
hole, then seat the base and screw on the outside ring, 0-ring down. A little silicone grease helps
maintain a good seal for the life of the vehicle. Tighten with an open-end wrench, and apply a small
amount of silicone grease to the contact and insulator surface of the base. This will help exclude
water, but must be renewed periodically. Tip: if you remove your antenna to go through the car
wash, there are caps available to exclude water during the process.
In most vehicles, RG-58-sized cable will fit between the pillar trim and body sheet metal. If
necessary, the technique used on the roof can also be used to snake the cable down the inside the
pillar.
Install the connector very carefully. There are good instructions in The ARRL Handbook. Use a
clean, hot, high-wattage iron and work quickly, to prevent damage to the cable dielectric. If you are
a beginner or are not comfortable with this kind of detail work, ask for help. It is extremely
important.
Electrical/Electronic Systems Compatibility Department CIMS 481-47-20 DaimlerChrysler
Corporation 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, MI 48326-2757
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Citizens Band Radio (CB) > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-23-99 Date: 990709
Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations
NUMBER: 08-23-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Jul. 9, 1999
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-16-98, DATED APRIL 17,
1998, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN THE 1998
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO.81-699-99003). ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE THE ADDITION OF THE 2000
MODEL YEAR VEHICLES.
SUBJECT: Installation of Radio Transmitting Equipment
MODELS: 1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan 1989 - **2000** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon 1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram
Pickup/Ramcharger 1989 - 1993 (AG) Daytona 1989 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/LeBaron
Convertible 1989 - **2000** (AN) Dakota 1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth
Avenue 1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier 1994 - **2000** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup 1998 - **2000**
(DN) Durango 1992 - 1995 (ES) Chrysler Voyager (European Market) 1995 - **2000** (FJ)
Sebring/Avenger/Talon 1996 - **2000** (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1995 **2000** (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1993 - **2000** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New
Yorker 1989 - 1992 (MJ) Comanche 1996 - **2000** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1995 **2000** (PL) Neon 1992 - **2000** (SR) Viper/Viper GTS 1997 - **2000** (TJ) Wrangler 1999 **2000** (WJ) Grand Cherokee 1989 - **2000** (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer 1989 - 1995 (YJ)
Wrangler 1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market) 1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand
Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION: Included is a copy of DaimlerChrysler's Radio Communication Equipment
Installation Recommendations. It is being provided with this Technical Service Bulletin to assist in
properly installing communication equipment in DaimlerChrysler vehicles. This information should
be given to any owner inquiring about installing radio-transmitting equipment.
Installation Recommendations
DaimlerChrysler
Radio Communication Equipment Installation Recommendations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Citizens Band Radio (CB) > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5925
The following is excerpted from the owners manual of new DaimlerChrysler products:
"INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this vehicle's electronic system to provide
immunity to radio frequency signals. Mobile two-way radio and telephone equipment must be
installed properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly to the battery and fused as close to the
battery as possible. The negative power connection should be made to body sheet metal adjacent
to the negative battery connection. This connection should not be fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the roof or the rear area of the vehicle. Care
should be used in mounting antennas with magnet bases. Magnets may affect the accuracy or
operation of the compass on vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and routed away from the vehicle wiring when
possible. Use only fully shielded coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to ensure a low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than normal may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications
equipment and the vehicle's electronic systems. A Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) is available for
detailed assistance."
The owner's first line of contact regarding vehicle problems is the dealer. The literature supplied
with each vehicle lists the steps to be taken in the event the dealer is unable to resolve the
problem. To assist in properly installing communications equipment in DaimlerChrysler vehicles,
the following information is provided. Always use good construction practices (see The ARRL
Handbook or other standard reference works).
The information contained in this guide has been prepared for use by persons installing two-way
radio equipment (transmitters and receivers) in vehicles. It has been prepared in accordance with
current engineering principles and generally accepted practices, using the best information
available at the time of publication. It is not possible to cover all of the possible installations of
two-way radio equipment in this guide. Accordingly, DaimlerChrysler Corporation cannot be held
responsible for incidental or consequent damages arising out of the use of the information
contained herein. The responsibility for installations and modifications is the sole responsibility of
the customer.
The installation recommendations presented here are intended to supplement the radio
manufacturer's instructions. Test the entire installation for anomalies, especially drivetrain and
brake control before extensive driving.
1. CONTROLS Mount the transceiver to a solid surface. If you use screws through the floor pan,
put body sealer over the underbody projections. (Stamped acorn nuts, filled with sealer are
available at most body shops for this purpose.) This will keep moisture out of the carpet and
insulation, and will forestall rust in this area. Watch out for wire harnesses routed under carpet and
behind instrument panel.
If you mount the radio under the instrument panel, be sure that there is no interference with proper
operation of the foot controls. Mount the control head or front panel (especially the microphone
cable) so that it is clear of the steering wheel and column controls and passenger airbag. If the unit
is heavy, extra bracing may be needed for stability. Newer vehicles have more structure and
energy absorbing materials in the knee blocker (the lower part of the Instrument Panel).
For one-piece transceivers, if ignition switch control is desired, it is good practice to use a power
relay to avoid overloading the ignition switch, and to maintain the advantages of direct battery feed.
Try the installation out before you start drilling holes.
2. POWER WIRING To reduce the hazard of working on the vehicle, disconnect the battery
NEGATIVE before beginning work. Note that some components may lose short-term memory (e.g.:
radio presets) after a protracted time without battery power.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Citizens Band Radio (CB) > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5926
For low or medium power transmitters (up to 55W FM or 110W SSB or CW), the power outlet or
cigar lighter feed may be used. Use a 1/4" jumper terminal at the socket or splice (solder and heat
shrink or tape). For higher power transmitters, including amplifiers, connect the power (battery +)
lead at the battery or at the power distribution center or at the positive jump-start post, if the vehicle
has one. An appropriate terminal should be used. If the terminal is exposed to the weather, solder
and apply a commercial protectant (wheel bearing grease is an acceptable alternative.) to retard
corrosion. This lead should be fused as close to the battery as practical to protect the wiring (and
the vehicle)! If the power connection is underhood, use a weatherproof fuse holder. Motorola
Communications Division supplies a weatherproof holder, part number 09-84277B01 for 5AG
cartridge fuses that is part of their standard installation kit. Packard Electric Division of Delphi
Automotive Systems makes an insulator, part number 12033769, terminal number 12020156 with
cover 12033731 for standard SAE plastic fuses.
Vinyl-insulated wire, typically supplied with transceivers is not entirely suitable for the higher
underhood temperatures in modern vehicles. Route underhood wiring away from all hot areas.
Body sheet metal, away from the exhaust, radiator, A/C liquid line and engine is usually the coolest
location.
DO NOT FUSE THE GROUND LEAD. If the ground-side fuse were to open, the entire supply
current would be conducted by an alternate current return path, which could cause the feedline to
overheat, with possible resulting damage.
For low or medium power installations, connect the ground (battery -) to body sheet near the power
feed point. If you use a screw through the floor, put body sealer over the underbody projection.
(Stamped acorn nuts, filled with sealer are available at most body shops for this purpose.) For high
power installations, connect the ground (battery -) lead at the battery connection to the body. This
is usually a 6 or 8 AWG black wire from the battery negative terminal to a screw at the wheelhouse
or radiator support. If a separate sheet metal ground is used, clean the paint off a one inch or so
diameter area of body panel where the ground lead is to be connected (usually the case with
commercial trunk mount radios). An awl is the best tool to use to pierce a starting hole for a #12 or
5mm, minimum plated ground screw. A ring terminal with lockwasher serrations of the proper size
for the screw or a separate serrated (not a split or SAE) lockwasher should be used between the
terminal and the screw head. As above, some grease or protectant should be used if the
connection is in an unprotected area.
If the power cable must pass through the dash panel, try to find an existing hole with a grommet
that is unused. If none is available, pull the carpet back from under the dash panel in the passenger
footwell in the cabin. Locate a place where there are no other components on either side, as high
up as possible. An awl is the best tool to use to punch a small hole through to the engine
compartment. If the position is good, enlarge the hole by driving the awl in up to the shank. If this is
not large enough to easily pass the cable, enlarge it by using a larger tapered punch. This will
leave an extruded hole with no sharp edges. Install the cable and seal the hole with silicone RTV or
commercial body sealer on both sides. Seal any extra holes that you may have made. Dress the
underhood wiring so that it is sate from all hazards, which include the following: exhaust manifold,
steering shaft, throttle linkage, fans, etc. Tie wrap as required.
3. CABLING Route control cables under the floor mats, inside the corner where the floor pan meets
the rocker panel for best protection. Remove the sill plates and tuck the cable under the floor mats
or carpet and padding. For most left hand drive vehicles, use the right side for best separation to
the main body harness (usually on the left side).
Route the cable along the extreme outboard edge of the floor pan, under the side trim, if possible.
4. REMOTE TRANSCEIVER For trunk mount installations in passenger cars, you may need to
remove the rear seat cushion and seat back to get the cable into the trunk. The seat cushion is
usually clipped at the front, lower edge by its own frame: push down and back, then lift. Note the
front and rear clipping points for ease of reinstallation. The seat back is usually clipped to the rear
compartment inner panel: pull out at the bottom and slide up to remove. Again, note the clipping
points for ease of reinstallation. There is usually a vapor/sound barrier behind the seat back, which
must be pierced to pass the cable.
Open the trunk and pick a spot where the cable is safe from chafing on any sharp sheet metal. Tie
wrap or tape in place at this location. Repair the barrier sheet if necessary. Replace the seat back
and cushion, taking care that the cable is not pinched by the seat cushion when there is someone
sitting in the seat. On some vehicles, there may be a channel for wiring at this location.
For remote control radios, a sheet of 1/2 in. plywood one or two inches larger than the radio, is a
good method to mount the transceiver to the shelf. It provides a good mounting surface, some
shock and vibration isolation, and it keeps moisture away from the radio. Mounting on the floor of
the trunk is not recommended. To conserve trunk space, in some vehicles, the radio may be
mounted to the rear compartment panel. Locate as far as possible from any vehicle electronic
modules located in the rear of the vehicle.
In any case, provide good air circulation; a 50 watt RF output FM transmitter will dissipate about 22
watts (@70% efficiency). Do not pile things on top of the unit.
5. TRANSMISSION LINE The transmission line (coaxial cable) should be treated in the same way
as the control and power cables. Route flat along body sheet metal wherever possible to avoid
sharp edges and pinches. If it is necessary to cross over wiring, cross at right angles. In some
cases, additional shielding between the transmission line and the vehicle wiring may be helpful. It is
important to maintain the maximum spacing from the vehicle harnesses, especially if the antenna is
not a good match. Use the best cable available (98-99% braid coverage or braid/foil) especially at
UHF and above. Mechanical pressure on the cable can cause degradation or even short circuits.
Do not rely on the obsolete military "RG" designations as an indicator of quality.
Cut off, do not coil excess transmission line (This forms a choke balun.) and terminate in the
correct connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Citizens Band Radio (CB) > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Communication Equipment - Recommendations > Page 5927
The use of N, BNC or C connectors is recommended over "UHF" (PL-259/S0-239) connectors. A
small amount of silicone dielectric grease (not the white heat sink compound) in the connector
(after soldering) will minimize condensation problems. Cut the line as short as practical, to minimize
losses.
6. ANTENNA LOCATION Antenna location is the most important consideration in any mobile
installation. For VHF and UHF antennas the recommended place on almost all vehicles is in the
center of the roof. The center of the deck lid is an acceptable alternate. Glass-mounted antennas
should be mounted at the very top edge of the clear portion of the glass away from the heater grid.
Vehicles with printed-on-glass antennas may be damaged by through-glass installations.
For HF antennas, refer to the manufacturer's instructions and follow them closely, unless you are
an accomplished antenna experimenter. HF antennas should be mounted to body or frame steel
for a good counterpoise as well as structural strength. Aluminum bumpers are heavily anodized for
corrosion protection, and the coating (aluminum oxide) is very hard as well as nonconductive. A
small grinder with a coarse stone will break through the anodized coating for electrical connection.
7. ANTENNA INSTALLATION Permanently installed antennas are preferable over magnetic, glass
or body-lip mounts for anything other than for low power or temporary installations. Most of these
alternate antennas will reflect some power back at the feedpoint. Much of this will be radiated from
the feedline inside the passenger compartment, and may be picked up by the vehicle wiring.
For deck lid installations, the deck lid must be bonded to the body, across the hinges, with short,
wide tinned braid straps. They must connect to clean sheet metal at both ends. For AM/SSB and
even some FM installations, the hood must be bonded to the body. In some cases the doors may
need to be bonded, as well.
Glass-mount antennas will not work or will only work very poorly in vehicles with metallized glass
(Electrically-heated windshields or some solar reflective glass). Non-metallic bodies (e.g., Viper)
require a half-wavelength antenna or a ground plane with radius approximately equal to the length
of a quarter-wave antenna. Copper is the best choice, but aluminum or even steel may be used.
Install on the inside of the body panel with a good adhesive or tape and provide a good RF
connection to the coax shield at the feedpoint. Screen, mesh or thin sheet stock may be used.
Shape is not critical, but some directional characteristics may be noted if it is not round. Try to stay
one-quarter wavelength away from edges, including sunroof openings. Consider the sunroof
mechanism for interference to the base and to the feedline.
For VHF and UHF, a good quality "NMO" (New Motorola) base or other mount with feedline (center
conductor and shield) soldered to base is recommended. This will allow the maximum flexibility in
antenna selection and is the best choice for electrical and mechanical considerations. Use the
proper hole saw (3/4 in. for NMO) or have it done professionally if you are not comfortable with
power tools. Hole plugs are available, for use at sale or trade-in, if you expect to remove the
antenna base.
To install the antenna base in the hole, remove the one or two-door trim pieces at the pillar where
the cable is to be routed and ease the headliner away from the roof. Insert a piece of flat steel or
plastic banding (1/2 in. to 3/4 in. wide) and guide to the desired corner. Pull the banding through,
leaving 6 in., which can be taped, to the transmission line (easier without the connector, but
possible even with a PL-259). Continue pulling until the antenna base is one inch or less from the
hole, then seat the base and screw on the outside ring, 0-ring down. A little silicone grease helps
maintain a good seal for the life of the vehicle. Tighten with an open-end wrench, and apply a small
amount of silicone grease to the contact and insulator surface of the base. This will help exclude
water, but must be renewed periodically. Tip: if you remove your antenna to go through the car
wash, there are caps available to exclude water during the process.
In most vehicles, RG-58-sized cable will fit between the pillar trim and body sheet metal. If
necessary, the technique used on the roof can also be used to snake the cable down the inside the
pillar.
Install the connector very carefully. There are good instructions in The ARRL Handbook. Use a
clean, hot, high-wattage iron and work quickly, to prevent damage to the cable dielectric. If you are
a beginner or are not comfortable with this kind of detail work, ask for help. It is extremely
important.
Electrical/Electronic Systems Compatibility Department CIMS 481-47-20 DaimlerChrysler
Corporation 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, MI 48326-2757
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > CD Player - CD Compatibility
Compact Disc Player (CD): Technical Service Bulletins CD Player - CD Compatibility
BULLETIN NUMBER: 08-11-00
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: March 24, 2000
SUBJECT: Recordable Compact Discs Used in Automotive CD players
MODELS: 1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon 1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota 1994 - 2000 (BR/BE) Ram
Truck 1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango 1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon 1995 - 1999 (JA)
Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M 1996 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon 1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GT 1997 - 2000 (TJ) Wrangler 1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - 2000 (XJ) Cherokee 1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
DISCUSSION: Some recordable compact disc media, such as CD-R and CD-RW, may not comply
with the standard CD format used in automotive CD players. When these CD's are used,
customers may encounter error messages, skipping, or delaminating of the labels, which can
cause an eject failure. It is important to question whether these kinds of CD media are being used.
When customers encounter these symptoms, check the system with a known playable CD. Explain
that the media may not be compatible with some automotive CD players. Replacing or exchanging
the CD player will not address these issues.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Speaker: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Circuit X53 feeds the speaker in the left front door. Circuit X55 is the return from the speaker to the
radio. On the premium system the X53 and X55 circuits are connected in with the instrument panel
speaker.
Circuit X54 feeds the speaker in the right front door. Circuit X56 is the return from the speaker to
the radio. On the premium system the X54 and X56 circuits are connected in with the instrument
panel speaker.
Circuit X51 feeds the left rear speaker. Circuit X57 is the return from the speaker to the radio.
Circuit X52 feeds the right rear speaker. Circuit X5S is the return from the speaker to the radio.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5936
Speaker: Testing and Inspection
- Circuit M1 also powers the vanity lamps, glove box lamp, time delay relay, dome lamps,
underhood lamp, cargo lamp, and power mirrors.
- If the radio does not operate, check for blown fuses in circuits A1 and X12.
- Circuits A3 and F3.3 feed the L7 circuit.
- If the radio illumination lamps do not operate, check for blown fuses in circuits E2, F33, and A3.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5937
Speaker: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Speaker
REMOVAL
Instrument Panel Speakers
1. Remove instrument panel top cover and cluster bezel. 2. Remove speaker retaining screws. 3.
Remove speaker and disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION For installation reverse the above procedures.
Front Door Speaker
REMOVAL 1. Remove door trim panel.
Front Door Speaker
2. Remove three speaker retaining screws. 3. Remove speaker assembly and disconnect wire
connector.
INSTALLATION For installation reverse the above procedures.
Rear Shelf Speaker
REMOVAL 1. Remove rear seat and seat back. Remove seat cushion, seat back and seat belt
anchor bolts. 2. Pry out the seat belt trim bezel along the rearward edge. 3. Partially remove the
shelf trim panel slipping it down to the seat back position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5938
Rear Shelf Speakers
4. Remove four speaker retaining screws. 5. Remove speaker and disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION For installation reverse the above procedures. Position speakers so that the wire connectors are
pointing to the drivers side of car. Tighten the seat belt anchor bolts to the proper torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 5944
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Rear
Bumper Fascia - Production Modifications
Bumper: Technical Service Bulletins Rear Bumper Fascia - Production Modifications
NO: 23-29-97
GROUP: Body
DATE: May 16, 1997
SUBJECT: Tape Across Rear Fascia Fasteners Shows In Opening
MODELS: 1997 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT AFTER MAY 9, 1997 (MDH 05-09-XX) AT THE
TOLUCA ASSEMBLY PLANT. TOLUCA ASSEMBLY IS DESIGNATED BY A "T" IN THE 11TH
POSITION OF THE VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER.
DISCUSSION:
Beginning on May 9, 1997 (MDH 05-09-XX) Toluca Assembly will begin installing a strip of black
tape under the fasteners of painted rear fascias to address an assembly process issue
(Illustration). The tape will not be applied to fascias molded in color or vehicles built at the Belvidere
Assembly Plant. The tape will be applied securely and is intended to last the lifetime of the vehicle.
There will be no replacement service tape, if the tape should come loose it should be removed
completely and discarded.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR HANDLE
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Close door glass. 3. Disconnect lock and latch rods
from door latch.
Fig. 6
4. Remove nut attaching door handle retainer to outer door panel (Fig. 6). 5. Remove retainer from
back of door handle. 6. Remove door handle from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position door handle into door and install retainer at back of handle. 2. Install nut attaching door
handle retainer to outer door panel. 3. Connect lock and latch rods to door latch. 4. Install door trim
panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Interior - Door Trim Panel Service Procedure Revisions
Front Door Panel: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Door Trim Panel Service Procedure
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-06-97I
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: June, 1997
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997 Neon Service Manual - Publication Number 81-370-7025
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the door trim panel service procedures
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Interior - Door Trim Panel Service Procedure Revisions > Page 5961
23-20
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Interior - Door Trim Panel Service Procedure Revisions > Page 5962
23-21
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Interior - Door Trim Panel Service Procedure Revisions > Page 5963
23-22
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door - 2 Door Model
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Front Door - 2 Door Model
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-06-97.
Removal
1. Lower door glass.
2. Remove screw attaching pull cup to door trim panel.
3. Pull inside latch release handle to access attaching screw and remove.
4. Remove window regulator crank, if equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door - 2 Door Model > Page 5966
5. Disengage all hidden push-in fasteners attaching trim panel to door. Ensure that each push-in
fastener is disengaged using the removal tool. 6. Tilt trim panel outward to clear locator pins on
backside of trim panel. 7. Lift trim panel to disengage from retainer channel on inner belt
weatherstrip. 8. Disengage clip holding door latch linkage to back of inside door handle. 9.
Separate latch rod from handle.
10. Disengage wire connector from power door lock switch, mirror switch, and power window
switch, if equipped. 11. Separate trim panel from vehicle.
Installation
1. Replace any damaged or missing push-in fasteners with original equipment push-in fasteners. 2.
Place trim panel near door. 3. Engage wire connectors to power lock switch, mirror switch, and
power window switch, if equipped. 4. Insert latch rod into inside release handle. 5. Engage clip
holding door latch linkage to back of inside door handle. 6. Engage trim panel into retainer channel
at top of door and push down to seat. 7. Locate door trim panel to inner door panel by aligning
locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door panel. Gently shift
panel forward or rearward if necessary.
8. Engage hidden push-in fasteners holding trim panel to door from around perimeter of trim panel.
9. With the window in the down position, orientate the window regulator crank handle appropriately.
Install the right handle at the 10 o'clock position
and the left handle at the 2 o'clock position, if equipped.
10. Install screw holding trim panel to door behind inside door handle. 11. Install screw inside pull
cup holding door trim panel to bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door - 2 Door Model > Page 5967
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Front Door - 4 Door Model
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-06-97.
Removal
1. Lower door glass.
2. Remove screw attaching pull cup to door trim panel. 3. Pull inside latch release handle to access
attaching screw and remove.
4. Remove window regulator crank, if equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door - 2 Door Model > Page 5968
5. Disengage all push-in fasteners attaching trim to door panel. Ensure that each push-in fastener
is disengaged using the removal tool. 6. Tilt trim panel outward to clear locator pins on backside of
trim panel. 7. Lift trim panel to disengage from retainer channel on inner belt weatherstrip at the top
of the door. 8. Disengage clip holding door latch linkage to back of inside door handle. 9. Separate
latch rod from handle.
10. Disengage wire connector from power door lock switch, mirror switch, and power window
switch, if equipped. 11. Separate trim panel from door.
Installation
1. Replace any damaged or missing push-in fasteners with original equipment push-in fasteners. 2.
Place trim panel near door. 3. Engage wire connector into power door lock switch, mirror switch,
and power window switch, if equipped. 4. Insert latch rod into inside latch release. 5. Engage trim
panel into retainer channel at top of door and push down to seat. 6. Locate door trim panel to inner
door panel by aligning locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door panel.
7. Engage push-in fasteners to hold trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 8. With the
window in the down position, orientate the window regulator crank handle appropriately. Install the
right handle at the 10 o'clock position
and the left handle at the 2 o'clock position, if equipped.
9. Install screw holding trim panel to door from behind inside latch release handle.
10. Install screw inside pull cup holding door trim panel to bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Exterior Handle
> System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR HANDLE
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Close door glass. 3. Disengage clips attaching linkage rods to door
handle.
Fig. 4
4. Remove nuts attaching outside handle to door (Fig. 4). 5. Remove outside handle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position door outside handle in opening. 2. Tighten attaching nuts. 3. Connect linkage rods to
latch. 4. Connect lock and latch rods to door handle. 5. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Release Lever
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emergency Trunk Release - Availability
Trunk / Liftgate Release Lever: Technical Service Bulletins Emergency Trunk Release - Availability
NUMBER: 23-02-00
GROUP: Body
DATE: Feb. 4, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-20-99 REV. A DATED
AUGUST 13, 1999 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS
INFORMATION.
SUBJECT: Internal Emergency Trunk Release
MODELS: 1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus 1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible **1993 2000 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New Yorker/Vision/300M** 1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO INSTALL AN INTERNAL EMERGENCY TRUNK RELEASE. RELEASE INSTALLATION
EXPENSE IS SHARED BY DAIMLERCHRYSLER AND THE CUSTOMER. DAIMLERCHRYSLER
WILL REIMBURSE YOU FOR THE LABOR ONLY. THE CUSTOMER IS RESPONSIBLE FOR
THE PART EXPENSE. REFER TO WARRANTY BULLETIN D-99-20 FOR CLAIMING THE
LABOR EXPENSE.
DISCUSSION: DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering internal emergency trunk releases for
the selected vehicles listed above. Other applicable passenger vehicles will be announced as soon
as the parts are available. The trunk releases are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts
and a detailed instruction sheet.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05016812AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 1995 - 2000 JA
**1 05016813AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 1993 - 1997 LH**
1 05016810AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 1998 - 2000 LH
1 05016809AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 2000 PL W/Remote Entry
1 05016811AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 1994 - 1999 PL,
2000 PL W/Manual Entry
1 05016814AA Kit, Emergency Trunk Release, 1996 - 2000 JX
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction Announcement
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No.
23-41-25-95 .........................................................................................................................................
.............................. 1.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-47-97 Date: 970926
Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps
NO: 23-47-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: Sept. 26, 1997
SUBJECT: Creak/Rattle From Front Foot Well
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Creak/rattle from driver or passenger front foot well. The creak/rattle is more pronounced over
bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
Drive the vehicle over a bumpy road and listen for a creak/rattle in the foot well area. If creak/rattle
is heard proceed with the repair procedure on the side that the noise is heard. If the side the
creak/rattle is coming from cannot be determined by sound, torque each crossmember bolt to 163
Nm (120 ft lbs). If the bolt was at 163 Nm (120 ft.lbs), the torque is acceptable and no further action
is needed on that side. If the torque was not at 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs), proceed to the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 05011650AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Right)
AR(1) 05011651AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Left)
Each kit will include one of the following components:
Cage Nut, Crossmember Bolt, Crossmember Mastic Patch Drain Plug Access Hole Template
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
13-30-01-90 0.6 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves drilling an access hole to replace the crossmember bolt and cage nut, then
sealing the access hole.
1. Raise vehicle to gain access to the crossmember bolt.
2. Remove the crossmember bolt.
3. Lower the vehicle and open the door.
4. Slide the seat to the full rearward position. Remove the floor mat if so equipped.
5. Remove the scuff plate and kick panel.
6. Pull the carpet and pad away to access the floor.
7. Prop the clutch and brake pedal to make room for drilling (drivers side only).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps > Page
5987
8. Insert the template, mark and center punch the floor pan (Figure 1).
9. Using a drill and 70 mm (2-3/4") Dia hole saw, drill in the floor to access the cage nut.
10. Pry up on the cage surrounding the nut and slide the nut out.
11. Insert the new nut and bend the cage back into position to secure the nut.
12. Raise the vehicle and install the new bolt, torque to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
13. Lower the vehicle and vacuum all drill shavings.
14. Install the drain hole plug into the hole in the floor. Use a heat gun to seal the plug to the floor.
15. Center the mastic patch over the drain hole plug and install (Figure 2). To install, remove
backing paper and apply firm even pressure across the entire patch to seal.
16. Position pad and carpet into proper location.
17. Remove prop holding brake and clutch pedal if applied.
18. Install the scuff plate and kick panel.
19. Install floor mat and reposition seat.
20. Repeat procedure for other side if needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on
Bumps
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-47-97 Date: 970926
Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on Bumps
NO: 23-47-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: Sept. 26, 1997
SUBJECT: Creak/Rattle From Front Foot Well
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Creak/rattle from driver or passenger front foot well. The creak/rattle is more pronounced over
bumps.
DIAGNOSIS:
Drive the vehicle over a bumpy road and listen for a creak/rattle in the foot well area. If creak/rattle
is heard proceed with the repair procedure on the side that the noise is heard. If the side the
creak/rattle is coming from cannot be determined by sound, torque each crossmember bolt to 163
Nm (120 ft lbs). If the bolt was at 163 Nm (120 ft.lbs), the torque is acceptable and no further action
is needed on that side. If the torque was not at 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs), proceed to the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR(1) 05011650AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Right)
AR(1) 05011651AA Crossmember Bolt/Nut Repair Kit (Left)
Each kit will include one of the following components:
Cage Nut, Crossmember Bolt, Crossmember Mastic Patch Drain Plug Access Hole Template
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
13-30-01-90 0.6 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves drilling an access hole to replace the crossmember bolt and cage nut, then
sealing the access hole.
1. Raise vehicle to gain access to the crossmember bolt.
2. Remove the crossmember bolt.
3. Lower the vehicle and open the door.
4. Slide the seat to the full rearward position. Remove the floor mat if so equipped.
5. Remove the scuff plate and kick panel.
6. Pull the carpet and pad away to access the floor.
7. Prop the clutch and brake pedal to make room for drilling (drivers side only).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cross-Member: > 23-47-97 > Sep > 97 > Front Foot Well - Creak/Rattle on
Bumps > Page 5993
8. Insert the template, mark and center punch the floor pan (Figure 1).
9. Using a drill and 70 mm (2-3/4") Dia hole saw, drill in the floor to access the cage nut.
10. Pry up on the cage surrounding the nut and slide the nut out.
11. Insert the new nut and bend the cage back into position to secure the nut.
12. Raise the vehicle and install the new bolt, torque to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
13. Lower the vehicle and vacuum all drill shavings.
14. Install the drain hole plug into the hole in the floor. Use a heat gun to seal the plug to the floor.
15. Center the mastic patch over the drain hole plug and install (Figure 2). To install, remove
backing paper and apply firm even pressure across the entire patch to seal.
16. Position pad and carpet into proper location.
17. Remove prop holding brake and clutch pedal if applied.
18. Install the scuff plate and kick panel.
19. Install floor mat and reposition seat.
20. Repeat procedure for other side if needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5994
Cross-Member: Specifications
Attaching Bolts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................ 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Console: > 232497 > May > 97 > Center Console Latch - Broken
Console: Customer Interest Center Console Latch - Broken
NO: 23-24-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: May 23, 1997
SUBJECT: Broken Center Console Latch
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Center console latch broken.
DISCUSSION:
If the center console latch (P/N 04775112AB) is broken, only the latch should be replaced without
replacing the console lid. Illustration
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04775112AB Latch, Center Console
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the center console latch.
1. Lift the center console lid.
2. Remove the two screws holding the latch to the lid and remove latch.
3. Install the new center console latch (P/N 04775112AB) and torque the two screws to 1.7 Nm (15
in.-lbs.)
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-41-40-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Console: > 232497 > May > 97 > Center Console Latch - Broken
Console: All Technical Service Bulletins Center Console Latch - Broken
NO: 23-24-97
GROUP: Body
EFFECTIVE DATE: May 23, 1997
SUBJECT: Broken Center Console Latch
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Center console latch broken.
DISCUSSION:
If the center console latch (P/N 04775112AB) is broken, only the latch should be replaced without
replacing the console lid. Illustration
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04775112AB Latch, Center Console
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the center console latch.
1. Lift the center console lid.
2. Remove the two screws holding the latch to the lid and remove latch.
3. Install the new center console latch (P/N 04775112AB) and torque the two screws to 1.7 Nm (15
in.-lbs.)
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-41-40-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6009
Console: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the MTX shifter knob only. 2. Remove the attaching screws from each side of the cup
holder.
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
a. Non-armrest console. Remove the two screws from the rear of the console. b. Armrest console.
Remove the four screws in the console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever up all the way 4. Lift the console at the rear and guide it out from
under the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 6015
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable and isolate it or remove fuse 12 prior to removing the switch,
or the wires may short to ground. 2. Remove the screws along the bottom of glove box door. 3.
Open the glove box and push the glove box sides inward allowing the door bumpers to clear and
box to tip forward. 4. Pull the glove box door/bin rearward and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 6025
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Programming Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Programming Connector: Locations
Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a GREEN wire with a RED BULLET CONNECTOR.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery: > 08-39-97 > Nov > 97 > RKE Transmitter - Premature Battery Failure
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: Customer Interest RKE Transmitter - Premature Battery Failure
NO: 08-39-97
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 28, 1997
SUBJECT: Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Batteries Discharge Prematurely
MODELS:
1997 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1997 - 1998 (AN) Dakota/Dakota Cab & Chassis
1998 (BRIBE)Ram Truck
1998 (DN) Durango
1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/Vision
1997 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1997 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO AUGUST 15, 1997 (MDH 0815XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter batteries discharge in approximately 6 weeks.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the vehicle was built prior to MDH
0815XX, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04686366 Transmitter, RKE- NS, PL & PR
AR 04759136AB Transmitter, RKE- LH
AR 56007049 Transmitter, RKE- AB & 1997 AN
AR 56008761 Transmitter 1, RKE- ZJ & DN
AR 56008762 Transmitter 2, RKE- ZJ
AR 56021903AA Transmitter, RKE- BR/BE & 1998 AN
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the RKE transmitter(s).
1. Replace RKE transmitter(s) that have discharged batteries.
2. Program the RKE transmitter(s) to the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-28-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Keyless Entry
Transmitter Battery > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter Battery: > 08-39-97 > Nov > 97 > RKE Transmitter - Premature Battery Failure
Keyless Entry Transmitter Battery: All Technical Service Bulletins RKE Transmitter - Premature
Battery Failure
NO: 08-39-97
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 28, 1997
SUBJECT: Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Batteries Discharge Prematurely
MODELS:
1997 - 1998 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1997 - 1998 (AN) Dakota/Dakota Cab & Chassis
1998 (BRIBE)Ram Truck
1998 (DN) Durango
1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/Vision
1997 - 1998 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 1998 (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
1997 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO AUGUST 15, 1997 (MDH 0815XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter batteries discharge in approximately 6 weeks.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the vehicle was built prior to MDH
0815XX, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR 04686366 Transmitter, RKE- NS, PL & PR
AR 04759136AB Transmitter, RKE- LH
AR 56007049 Transmitter, RKE- AB & 1997 AN
AR 56008761 Transmitter 1, RKE- ZJ & DN
AR 56008762 Transmitter 2, RKE- ZJ
AR 56021903AA Transmitter, RKE- BR/BE & 1998 AN
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves replacing the RKE transmitter(s).
1. Replace RKE transmitter(s) that have discharged batteries.
2. Program the RKE transmitter(s) to the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-28-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Power Door Lock Actuator: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Make certain battery is in normal condition before circuits are tested.
To determine which motor is faulty, check each individual door for electrical lock and unlock or
disconnect the motor connectors one at a time, while operating the door lock switch. In the event
that none of the motors work, the problem maybe caused by a shorted motor, or a bad switch.
Disconnecting the defective motor will allow the others to work.
Door Latch Assembly
To test an individual door lock motor, disconnect the electrical connector from the motor. To lock
the door, connect a 12 Volt power source to the positive pin of the lock motor and a ground wire to
the other pin To unlock the door reverse the wire connections at the motor pin terminals. If these
results are NOT obtained, replace the door latch assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6047
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Door Latch Assembly
2. Disconnect all door linkages at the latch/lock assembly. 3. Disconnect motor wire connector. 4.
Remove latch/lock assembly attaching screws and remove assembly.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Left Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the door lock switch is moved to the LOCK position,
voltage is supplied on the P35 circuit to the bus bar located inside the right door switch, lock side.
Battery voltage is passed through the switch to the P33 circuit to the door motors. Grounding is
provided through the P34 circuit for all door motors back to the right door switch. The ground is
passed through the bus bar internal to the switch, UNLOCK side, to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit
connects to the left front switch to a bus bar, internal to the switch, and then to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit connects to its grounding point.
Left Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position, voltage is
supplied on the P36 circuit to the right door switch, unlock side. The battery voltage is passed
through the switch internal bus bar to the P34 circuit.
The P34 circuit then connects to the door motors on the unlock side. Grounding for the UNLOCK
function is provided by the P33 circuit.
The P33 circuit connects back to the right door switch, LOCK side, and passes through the internal
bus bar to the P35 circuit. The P35 circuit connects back to the left door switch, and passes
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to it's grounding point.
Right Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the switch is moved to the LOCK position, voltage is
supplied to the P33 circuit, and then to the door lock motors. The ground path is provided on the
P34 circuit back to the right door switch. The ground is passed through the switch internal bus bar
to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit connects to the left door switch and through to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit then connects to the grounding point at the left center instrument panel support.
Right Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position voltage
is supplied to the P34 circuit from the switch to the door UNLOCK side of the motors. The
grounding path is through the LOCK side of the motors, circuit P33, back to the switch. The ground
continues through the internal bus bar of the switch on circuit P35 to the left door switch. At the left
door switch, the ground passes through that switches internal bus bar to the Z8 grounding point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 6051
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Door Lock Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the Door Lock Switch
Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct in the Lock and Unlock switch positions. If these
results are not obtained, replace the switch.
Wiring The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through
the body harness to switch. 1. Remove left side switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate
multiple terminal block on wiring harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a
ground terminal. Touch other test light lead to Red Wire terminal.
a. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional. b. If test light
does not come on, check fuse 3 in the fuse block or for a open circuit.
4. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 6052
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove front door trim. 2. Disconnect wire connector. 3. Remove attaching screws. 4. Remove
the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Power Mirror Motor: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove switch mounting screws from back side of trim panel and
remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire connector.
Mirror Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6057
Power Fold Away Mirror Test
4. Using two jumper wires, one connected to a 12 volt source, and 2 the other connected to a good
body ground. Refer to the Mirror Test for
appropriate mirror response. RHD vehicle with Power Fold Away Mirror, refer to Power Fold Away
Mirror Switch Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6058
Power Fold Away Mirrors Wiring Schematic
5. If test results are not obtained as shown, check for open or shorted circuit, or replace mirror
assembly as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Power Mirror Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power mirror switch has a right and left position. Moving the switch to either of these positions
changes the voltage path internal to the switch (i.e.. changes polarity at the motors).
When the switch is moved to the left position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P93 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a left door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P95 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door minor RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
When the switch is moved to the right position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P92 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a right door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P94 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door mirror RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6062
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Mirror Switch Test
Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position. 2. Disconnect wiring harness at switch
connector. 3. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown
in the Mirror Switch Test and RHD Power Fold Away Mirror
Switch Test.
4. If test results are not obtained as shown, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6063
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove switch mounting screws from back side of trim panel and
remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-25-00 > Jun > 00 > Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
Paint: Customer Interest Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
NUMBER: 23-25-00
GROUP: Body
DATE: Jun. 30, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-05-98, DATED JANUARY
30, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS.
SUBJECT: Paint Fogging/Whitening
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves removal of a fogging or staining condition from any painted
surface where moisture may be trapped under the clear coat.
MODELS:
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - **2000** (PL) Neon
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
1997 - **2001** (BR) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Painted surfaces of the vehicle that are covered for extended periods of
time with front end covers (Bras), transit films or magnetic signs may appear to have a white
"milky" spot ** on dark colors, or a fogging, coffee colored spot lighter colors**.
NOTE:
WHEN USING A FRONT END COVER OR MAGNETIC SIGN, FOLLOW THE
MANUFACTURER'S PRECAUTIONS.
DIAGNOSIS: **Wash the affected area(s) with mild soap and water. Spot clean any area(s) to
remove any difficult dirt, tar, bugs, etc. If paint fogging/whitening exist, run your hand over the
surface, if no surface condition exists perform the following Repair Procedure**.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
**Heat Gun**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. **Place a heat gun approximately 100 to 150 mm (4 to 6 inches) from the effected area. A target
surface temperature of 80° to 95° C. (180° to 200 °F.) is preferred.
NOTE:
DO NOT APPLY HEAT ABOVE 95° C. (200°F.) TO ANY PLASTIC PARTS.
2. Heat the effected area for approximately 2 to 4 minutes. The amount of time is dependent upon
the size and shape of the affected area and the severity of the condition.
NOTE:
CIRCULATE THE HEAT GUN AROUND THE EFFECTED AREA. DO NOT ALLOW HEAT TO BE
DIRECTED AT ONE AREA FOR TOO LONG, PAINT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR.
3. If this Repair Procedure does not correct the condition, color-coat paint repair will be required.
NOTE:
IF PAINT "FOGGING" DAMAGE WAS CAUSED BY A FRONT END COVER OR A MAGNETIC
SIGN, THE OWNER SHOULD BE CAUTIONED AGAINST USING THAT PRODUCT, OR A
SIMILAR PRODUCT THAT MAY CREATE THE PAINT "FOGGING".**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-25-00 > Jun > 00 > Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening > Page 6073
Labor Operation No: 23-60-02-90 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 23-25-00 > Jun > 00 > Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
NUMBER: 23-25-00
GROUP: Body
DATE: Jun. 30, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-05-98, DATED JANUARY
30, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS.
SUBJECT: Paint Fogging/Whitening
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves removal of a fogging or staining condition from any painted
surface where moisture may be trapped under the clear coat.
MODELS:
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - **2000** (PL) Neon
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
1997 - **2001** (BR) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Painted surfaces of the vehicle that are covered for extended periods of
time with front end covers (Bras), transit films or magnetic signs may appear to have a white
"milky" spot ** on dark colors, or a fogging, coffee colored spot lighter colors**.
NOTE:
WHEN USING A FRONT END COVER OR MAGNETIC SIGN, FOLLOW THE
MANUFACTURER'S PRECAUTIONS.
DIAGNOSIS: **Wash the affected area(s) with mild soap and water. Spot clean any area(s) to
remove any difficult dirt, tar, bugs, etc. If paint fogging/whitening exist, run your hand over the
surface, if no surface condition exists perform the following Repair Procedure**.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
**Heat Gun**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. **Place a heat gun approximately 100 to 150 mm (4 to 6 inches) from the effected area. A target
surface temperature of 80° to 95° C. (180° to 200 °F.) is preferred.
NOTE:
DO NOT APPLY HEAT ABOVE 95° C. (200°F.) TO ANY PLASTIC PARTS.
2. Heat the effected area for approximately 2 to 4 minutes. The amount of time is dependent upon
the size and shape of the affected area and the severity of the condition.
NOTE:
CIRCULATE THE HEAT GUN AROUND THE EFFECTED AREA. DO NOT ALLOW HEAT TO BE
DIRECTED AT ONE AREA FOR TOO LONG, PAINT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR.
3. If this Repair Procedure does not correct the condition, color-coat paint repair will be required.
NOTE:
IF PAINT "FOGGING" DAMAGE WAS CAUSED BY A FRONT END COVER OR A MAGNETIC
SIGN, THE OWNER SHOULD BE CAUTIONED AGAINST USING THAT PRODUCT, OR A
SIMILAR PRODUCT THAT MAY CREATE THE PAINT "FOGGING".**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 23-25-00 > Jun > 00 > Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening >
Page 6079
Labor Operation No: 23-60-02-90 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 236996 > Nov > 96 > Paint - Fallout Damage Repair
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Fallout Damage Repair
NO: 23-69-96
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 22, 1996
SUBJECT: Repair Of Fallout Damaged Paint
MODELS:
1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon 1997 (AN) Dakota 1997 (BR) Ram Pickup 1997 (FJ)
Sebring/Avenger/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New
Yorker/Vision 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper
GTS 1997 (TJ) Wrangler 1997 (XJ) Cherokee 1997 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market)
1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THE MOPAR FALLOUT REMOVAL KIT CAN BE USED ON ANY CURRENT OR PAST MODEL
YEAR CHRYSLER VEHICLE.
DISCUSSION:
Mopar Parts has released a new product, Mopar Fallout Removal Kit (p/n 04882417) for correcting
paint damage due to industrial fallout, rail dust, over-spray and volcanic ash.
The Mopar Fallout Removal Kit does not use a compounding process or acid wash and is the
current Chrysler preferred method for correcting fallout damage. This product uses a clay polymer
material and a liquid that are safer and better than other fallout removal methods. The Mopar
Fallout Removal Kit is easier to use and less expensive than other methods.
Some vehicles that would have been repainted in the past have been saved from that time
consuming and expensive process with the Mopar Fallout Removal Kit.
NOTE:
WHEN ALL OF THE FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID HAS BEEN USED, DISCARD THE CLAY
POLYMER MATERIAL. CONTINUED USE OF THE CLAY POLYMER AFTER ALL OF THE
FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID HAS BEEN USED CAN CAUSE MINOR SCRATCHING OF THE
PAINT FINISH. THE AMOUNT OF FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID PROVIDED IN THE KIT WAS
ESTABLISHED BY DETERMINING THE AMOUNT OF FALLOUT THE CLAY POLYMER COULD
ABSORB BEFORE IT BECAME OVER SATURATED WITH FALLOUT AND WOULD CAUSE
DAMAGE TO THE PAINT FINISH.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 236996 > Nov > 96 > Paint - Fallout Damage Repair
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Fallout Damage Repair
NO: 23-69-96
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 22, 1996
SUBJECT: Repair Of Fallout Damaged Paint
MODELS:
1997 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon 1997 (AN) Dakota 1997 (BR) Ram Pickup 1997 (FJ)
Sebring/Avenger/Talon 1997 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market) 1997 (JA)
Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze 1997 (JX) Sebring Convertible 1997 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/New
Yorker/Vision 1997 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager 1997 (PL) Neon 1997 (SR) Viper/Viper
GTS 1997 (TJ) Wrangler 1997 (XJ) Cherokee 1997 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Market)
1997 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THE MOPAR FALLOUT REMOVAL KIT CAN BE USED ON ANY CURRENT OR PAST MODEL
YEAR CHRYSLER VEHICLE.
DISCUSSION:
Mopar Parts has released a new product, Mopar Fallout Removal Kit (p/n 04882417) for correcting
paint damage due to industrial fallout, rail dust, over-spray and volcanic ash.
The Mopar Fallout Removal Kit does not use a compounding process or acid wash and is the
current Chrysler preferred method for correcting fallout damage. This product uses a clay polymer
material and a liquid that are safer and better than other fallout removal methods. The Mopar
Fallout Removal Kit is easier to use and less expensive than other methods.
Some vehicles that would have been repainted in the past have been saved from that time
consuming and expensive process with the Mopar Fallout Removal Kit.
NOTE:
WHEN ALL OF THE FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID HAS BEEN USED, DISCARD THE CLAY
POLYMER MATERIAL. CONTINUED USE OF THE CLAY POLYMER AFTER ALL OF THE
FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID HAS BEEN USED CAN CAUSE MINOR SCRATCHING OF THE
PAINT FINISH. THE AMOUNT OF FALLOUT REPAIR LIQUID PROVIDED IN THE KIT WAS
ESTABLISHED BY DETERMINING THE AMOUNT OF FALLOUT THE CLAY POLYMER COULD
ABSORB BEFORE IT BECAME OVER SATURATED WITH FALLOUT AND WOULD CAUSE
DAMAGE TO THE PAINT FINISH.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 6089
Paint: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-25-00 Date: 000630
Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
NUMBER: 23-25-00
GROUP: Body
DATE: Jun. 30, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-05-98, DATED JANUARY
30, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS.
SUBJECT: Paint Fogging/Whitening
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves removal of a fogging or staining condition from any painted
surface where moisture may be trapped under the clear coat.
MODELS:
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - **2000** (PL) Neon
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
1997 - **2001** (BR) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Painted surfaces of the vehicle that are covered for extended periods of
time with front end covers (Bras), transit films or magnetic signs may appear to have a white
"milky" spot ** on dark colors, or a fogging, coffee colored spot lighter colors**.
NOTE:
WHEN USING A FRONT END COVER OR MAGNETIC SIGN, FOLLOW THE
MANUFACTURER'S PRECAUTIONS.
DIAGNOSIS: **Wash the affected area(s) with mild soap and water. Spot clean any area(s) to
remove any difficult dirt, tar, bugs, etc. If paint fogging/whitening exist, run your hand over the
surface, if no surface condition exists perform the following Repair Procedure**.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
**Heat Gun**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. **Place a heat gun approximately 100 to 150 mm (4 to 6 inches) from the effected area. A target
surface temperature of 80° to 95° C. (180° to 200 °F.) is preferred.
NOTE:
DO NOT APPLY HEAT ABOVE 95° C. (200°F.) TO ANY PLASTIC PARTS.
2. Heat the effected area for approximately 2 to 4 minutes. The amount of time is dependent upon
the size and shape of the affected area and the severity of the condition.
NOTE:
CIRCULATE THE HEAT GUN AROUND THE EFFECTED AREA. DO NOT ALLOW HEAT TO BE
DIRECTED AT ONE AREA FOR TOO LONG, PAINT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR.
3. If this Repair Procedure does not correct the condition, color-coat paint repair will be required.
NOTE:
IF PAINT "FOGGING" DAMAGE WAS CAUSED BY A FRONT END COVER OR A MAGNETIC
SIGN, THE OWNER SHOULD BE CAUTIONED AGAINST USING THAT PRODUCT, OR A
SIMILAR PRODUCT THAT MAY CREATE THE PAINT "FOGGING".**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 6090
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-60-02-90 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-25-00 Date: 000630
Paint - Surface Fogging or Whitening
NUMBER: 23-25-00
GROUP: Body
DATE: Jun. 30, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-05-98, DATED JANUARY
30, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS.
SUBJECT: Paint Fogging/Whitening
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves removal of a fogging or staining condition from any painted
surface where moisture may be trapped under the clear coat.
MODELS:
1996 - **2000** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - **2000** (PL) Neon
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
1997 - **2001** (BR) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Painted surfaces of the vehicle that are covered for extended periods of
time with front end covers (Bras), transit films or magnetic signs may appear to have a white
"milky" spot ** on dark colors, or a fogging, coffee colored spot lighter colors**.
NOTE:
WHEN USING A FRONT END COVER OR MAGNETIC SIGN, FOLLOW THE
MANUFACTURER'S PRECAUTIONS.
DIAGNOSIS: **Wash the affected area(s) with mild soap and water. Spot clean any area(s) to
remove any difficult dirt, tar, bugs, etc. If paint fogging/whitening exist, run your hand over the
surface, if no surface condition exists perform the following Repair Procedure**.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
**Heat Gun**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. **Place a heat gun approximately 100 to 150 mm (4 to 6 inches) from the effected area. A target
surface temperature of 80° to 95° C. (180° to 200 °F.) is preferred.
NOTE:
DO NOT APPLY HEAT ABOVE 95° C. (200°F.) TO ANY PLASTIC PARTS.
2. Heat the effected area for approximately 2 to 4 minutes. The amount of time is dependent upon
the size and shape of the affected area and the severity of the condition.
NOTE:
CIRCULATE THE HEAT GUN AROUND THE EFFECTED AREA. DO NOT ALLOW HEAT TO BE
DIRECTED AT ONE AREA FOR TOO LONG, PAINT DAMAGE MAY OCCUR.
3. If this Repair Procedure does not correct the condition, color-coat paint repair will be required.
NOTE:
IF PAINT "FOGGING" DAMAGE WAS CAUSED BY A FRONT END COVER OR A MAGNETIC
SIGN, THE OWNER SHOULD BE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 6091
CAUTIONED AGAINST USING THAT PRODUCT, OR A SIMILAR PRODUCT THAT MAY
CREATE THE PAINT "FOGGING".**
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-60-02-90 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the right trim panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from RKE module.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove screws holding RKE module to instrument panel assembly. 4. Remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Replacement > Page 6097
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Program Remote Keyless Entry Module
1. Retrieve the programming line from the upper edge of the passenger side cowl trim panel. The
RKE Programming Line is a green wire with a red
bullet connector.
2. Using a jumper wire, ground the RKE programming line. 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON
position. 4. Press any button on the transmitter to set code. The locks will cycle to confirm
programming. If there is a second transmitter it must be set at this
time. Press any button on the second transmitter and wait for the locks to cycle to confirm
programming.
5. Disconnect the programming line from ground. This returns the system to its normal operation
mode. 6. Replace all removed components. Return programming line to its original position. Check
for system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 > Sunroof Shade - Rattles
In Full Open Position
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-98 Date: 981009
Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position
NO: 23-46-98
GROUP: Body
DATE: Oct. 9, 1998
SUBJECT: Sunroof Sun Shade Rattles In Full Open Position
MODELS:
1997-1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION
The sunroof sun shade rattles in the full open position due to the roof deadner pad not fully bonding
to the roof and/or the track foam/sponge bumpers are coming loose from the track.
DIAGNOSIS:
Open the sun shade to the full open position. Drive the vehicle and listen for a rattle coming from
the sun shade/roof area. If the rattle is heard perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR (1) 4546820 Deadner Pad, Roof Panel
AR (1) 05027248AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Right
AR (1) 05027249AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Left
NOTE:
THE SUNROOF REAR TRACK BUMPERS MUST BE REPLACED AS A SET.
POLICY:
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-10-30-93 1.0 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 2 Door Vehicles
23-10-30-94 1.1 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 4 Door Vehicles
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves reapplying or replacing the existing deadner pad and/or replacing the rear
track pad bumpers as needed.
1. Remove the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication
No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 23-19.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 > Sunroof Shade - Rattles
In Full Open Position > Page 6108
2. With the headlining removed the deadner pad will be visible (Figure 1). Inspect the large
deadner pad and the two C-pillar pads. If the deadner pad is completely disengaged, from the roof
it must be replaced, proceed to Step 3. If the deadner pad is loose or partially detached it can be
reattached following the procedure beginning with Step 4 (Figure 1).
3. Position the new deadner pad as shown in (Figure 1).
4. Use a six inch roller to pressurize and apply the deadner pad. A constant uniform force should
be used to apply the pressure across the complete surface of the deadner pad.
5. Use the six inch roller to firmly seat the C-pillar pads.
6. Inspect the rear track bumpers, if they are loose or missing they must be replaced.
7. Remove the loose bumper or locate the bumper that has fallen off and discard.
8. Clean the surface with isopropyl alcohol and let dry.
9. Remove the backing paper from the new bumper and apply to the same location that the old
bumper was removed from (Figure 1). Repeat the procedure for the other side.
10. Install the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 23-20. Insure that the door weatherstrips are properly seated around the
headlining.
11. Verity proper operation of the sunroof and confirm that rattle has been eliminated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail
Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
NO: 23-48-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: Sep. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Water Drips From Roof Rail Weatherstrip Channel Into Vehicle
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-97, DATED AUG. 29,
1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE PART NUMBERS HAVE BEEN
REVISED AND ARE MARKED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Water drips from roof rail weatherstrip and retainer channel into vehicle with the door/window open.
DISCUSSION:
A new anti-drip roof rail retainer channel is available for Sedan and Coupe models. The left and
right side roof rail retainer channels must be replaced as a set on 1997 and earlier models due to
appearance differences from the existing roof rail retainer channels.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04724516AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
1 04724517AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
**1 04724514AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan**
**1 04724515AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan **
1 04546838 Applique, "B" Pillar, Right
1 04546839 Applique, "B" Pillar, Left
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of both roof rail retainer channels and B pillar appliques.
1. Open door(s).
2. Using trim stick disengage the top and bottom push in fasteners from "B" pillar applique. Gently
pull outward on the applique to remove from the vehicle.
NOTE:
THE APPLIQUE IS ATTACHED TO THE VEHICLE WITH TWO SIDED TAPE BETWEEN THE
PUSH IN FASTENERS, INSURE ALL OF THE OLD TWO SIDED TAPE IS REMOVED FROM THE
VEHICLE SURFACE BEFORE INSTALLATION OF NEW PART.
3. Remove the weatherstrip from the retainer channel.
4. Remove the retainer channel from the body side aperture.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail
Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle > Page 6114
5. Install the new retainer channel, by inserting the push pin(s). Install the remaining screws and
torque to 4.9 Nm (44 in. lbs), Figure 1 - Two Door, Figure 2 - Four Door.
6. Install the weatherstrip into the retainer channel.
7. Remove the backing paper from the "B" pillar two sided tape. Place the "B" pillar applique up to
the vehicle and push in the two fasteners. Beginning at the top of the "B" pillar, use firm pressure to
completely seat the applique.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
23-02-15-92 2 Door 0.9 Hrs.
23-02-15-93 4 Door 1.1 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Sun Shade: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97
> Customer Interest for Sun Shade: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 > Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-98 Date: 981009
Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position
NO: 23-46-98
GROUP: Body
DATE: Oct. 9, 1998
SUBJECT: Sunroof Sun Shade Rattles In Full Open Position
MODELS:
1997-1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION
The sunroof sun shade rattles in the full open position due to the roof deadner pad not fully bonding
to the roof and/or the track foam/sponge bumpers are coming loose from the track.
DIAGNOSIS:
Open the sun shade to the full open position. Drive the vehicle and listen for a rattle coming from
the sun shade/roof area. If the rattle is heard perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR (1) 4546820 Deadner Pad, Roof Panel
AR (1) 05027248AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Right
AR (1) 05027249AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Left
NOTE:
THE SUNROOF REAR TRACK BUMPERS MUST BE REPLACED AS A SET.
POLICY:
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-10-30-93 1.0 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 2 Door Vehicles
23-10-30-94 1.1 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 4 Door Vehicles
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves reapplying or replacing the existing deadner pad and/or replacing the rear
track pad bumpers as needed.
1. Remove the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication
No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 23-19.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Sun Shade: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97
> Customer Interest for Sun Shade: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 > Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position > Page 6124
2. With the headlining removed the deadner pad will be visible (Figure 1). Inspect the large
deadner pad and the two C-pillar pads. If the deadner pad is completely disengaged, from the roof
it must be replaced, proceed to Step 3. If the deadner pad is loose or partially detached it can be
reattached following the procedure beginning with Step 4 (Figure 1).
3. Position the new deadner pad as shown in (Figure 1).
4. Use a six inch roller to pressurize and apply the deadner pad. A constant uniform force should
be used to apply the pressure across the complete surface of the deadner pad.
5. Use the six inch roller to firmly seat the C-pillar pads.
6. Inspect the rear track bumpers, if they are loose or missing they must be replaced.
7. Remove the loose bumper or locate the bumper that has fallen off and discard.
8. Clean the surface with isopropyl alcohol and let dry.
9. Remove the backing paper from the new bumper and apply to the same location that the old
bumper was removed from (Figure 1). Repeat the procedure for the other side.
10. Install the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 23-20. Insure that the door weatherstrips are properly seated around the
headlining.
11. Verity proper operation of the sunroof and confirm that rattle has been eliminated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 >
Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-98 Date: 981009
Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position
NO: 23-46-98
GROUP: Body
DATE: Oct. 9, 1998
SUBJECT: Sunroof Sun Shade Rattles In Full Open Position
MODELS:
1997-1998 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION
The sunroof sun shade rattles in the full open position due to the roof deadner pad not fully bonding
to the roof and/or the track foam/sponge bumpers are coming loose from the track.
DIAGNOSIS:
Open the sun shade to the full open position. Drive the vehicle and listen for a rattle coming from
the sun shade/roof area. If the rattle is heard perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
AR (1) 4546820 Deadner Pad, Roof Panel
AR (1) 05027248AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Right
AR (1) 05027249AA Bumper, Sunroof Rear Track Pad - Left
NOTE:
THE SUNROOF REAR TRACK BUMPERS MUST BE REPLACED AS A SET.
POLICY:
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-10-30-93 1.0 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 2 Door Vehicles
23-10-30-94 1.1 Hrs.
Sunshade, Sunroof - Repair - 4 Door Vehicles
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves reapplying or replacing the existing deadner pad and/or replacing the rear
track pad bumpers as needed.
1. Remove the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication
No. 81-270-8025) beginning on page 23-19.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 23-46-98 > Oct > 98 >
Sunroof Shade - Rattles In Full Open Position > Page 6130
2. With the headlining removed the deadner pad will be visible (Figure 1). Inspect the large
deadner pad and the two C-pillar pads. If the deadner pad is completely disengaged, from the roof
it must be replaced, proceed to Step 3. If the deadner pad is loose or partially detached it can be
reattached following the procedure beginning with Step 4 (Figure 1).
3. Position the new deadner pad as shown in (Figure 1).
4. Use a six inch roller to pressurize and apply the deadner pad. A constant uniform force should
be used to apply the pressure across the complete surface of the deadner pad.
5. Use the six inch roller to firmly seat the C-pillar pads.
6. Inspect the rear track bumpers, if they are loose or missing they must be replaced.
7. Remove the loose bumper or locate the bumper that has fallen off and discard.
8. Clean the surface with isopropyl alcohol and let dry.
9. Remove the backing paper from the new bumper and apply to the same location that the old
bumper was removed from (Figure 1). Repeat the procedure for the other side.
10. Install the headlining following the procedure in the 1998 Neon Service Manual (Publication No.
81-270-8025) on page 23-20. Insure that the door weatherstrips are properly seated around the
headlining.
11. Verity proper operation of the sunroof and confirm that rattle has been eliminated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Motor:
> 23-49-99 > Nov > 99 > Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When Opening Or Closing
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Customer Interest Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When Opening Or
Closing
NUMBER: 23-49-99
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 12, 1999
SUBJECT: Sunroof Makes A Ratcheting Type Noise When Opening Or Closing
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the motor bracket drive tube locator.
MODELS: 1996 - 1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The sunroof makes a ratcheting type noise while opening or closing. The
noise is most noticeable at the full open or full closed position. The noise is caused by an oversized
drive tube locator allowing the motor gear to override the drive tubes.
DIAGNOSIS: While opening and closing the sunroof listen for the ratcheting noise, if the noise is
heard perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05016539AA Locator, Motor Bracket Drive Tube
4 04856501 Tie Strap
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Remove the sunroof module following the procedure in the 1999 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-9125) page 23-14.
2. Ensure that the sunroof module is in the full closed position and remove the sunroof motor from
the sunroof module assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Motor:
> 23-49-99 > Nov > 99 > Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When Opening Or Closing > Page 6139
3. With a 3 mm (.012 in.) drill bit remove the rivet holding the locator to the motor bracket (Figure
1).
4. Place the new locator over the drive tubes and secure with the rivet provided with the new
locator. Make sure that the spring insert is in place under the bracket (Figure 2).
5. Install the motor. Ensure that the motor is positioned in the same place it was removed from.
NOTE:
WHEN INSTALLING THE SUNROOF MODULE INSURE THAT THE DRAIN TUBE CLAMPS ARE
INSTALLED IN THE POSITION THEY WERE REMOVED FROM DURING DISASSEMBLY. USE
A TIE STRAP OR EQUIVALENT TO SECURE THE DRIVE TUBES IN THE SAME LOCATIONS
THE CLAMPS WERE REMOVED FROM DURING DISASSEMBLY.
6. Install the sunroof module following the procedure in the 1999 Neon Service Manual (Publication
No. 81-270-9125) page 23-14.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-30-64-92 1.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor: > 23-49-99 > Nov > 99 > Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When Opening Or Closing
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When
Opening Or Closing
NUMBER: 23-49-99
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 12, 1999
SUBJECT: Sunroof Makes A Ratcheting Type Noise When Opening Or Closing
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the motor bracket drive tube locator.
MODELS: 1996 - 1999 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The sunroof makes a ratcheting type noise while opening or closing. The
noise is most noticeable at the full open or full closed position. The noise is caused by an oversized
drive tube locator allowing the motor gear to override the drive tubes.
DIAGNOSIS: While opening and closing the sunroof listen for the ratcheting noise, if the noise is
heard perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
05016539AA Locator, Motor Bracket Drive Tube
4 04856501 Tie Strap
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Remove the sunroof module following the procedure in the 1999 Neon Service Manual
(Publication No. 81-270-9125) page 23-14.
2. Ensure that the sunroof module is in the full closed position and remove the sunroof motor from
the sunroof module assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor: > 23-49-99 > Nov > 99 > Sunroof - Ratcheting Noise When Opening Or Closing > Page 6145
3. With a 3 mm (.012 in.) drill bit remove the rivet holding the locator to the motor bracket (Figure
1).
4. Place the new locator over the drive tubes and secure with the rivet provided with the new
locator. Make sure that the spring insert is in place under the bracket (Figure 2).
5. Install the motor. Ensure that the motor is positioned in the same place it was removed from.
NOTE:
WHEN INSTALLING THE SUNROOF MODULE INSURE THAT THE DRAIN TUBE CLAMPS ARE
INSTALLED IN THE POSITION THEY WERE REMOVED FROM DURING DISASSEMBLY. USE
A TIE STRAP OR EQUIVALENT TO SECURE THE DRIVE TUBES IN THE SAME LOCATIONS
THE CLAMPS WERE REMOVED FROM DURING DISASSEMBLY.
6. Install the sunroof module following the procedure in the 1999 Neon Service Manual (Publication
No. 81-270-9125) page 23-14.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 23-30-64-92 1.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time
Child Seat: Technical Service Bulletins Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time
NUMBER: 23-008-00 Rev. B
GROUP: Body
DATE: Nov. 24, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-08-00 REV. A, DATED
JULY 7, 2000, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND PARTS.
SUBJECT: Child Seat Tether Anchors
MODELS: 1989 - 1995
(AA) Spirit/Acclaim/LeBaron Sedan
1989 - 2000 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1993 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1989 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1988 - 1992 (BB) Monaco/Premier
1990 - 1994 (BD) Laser/Talon
1994 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1989 - 1992 (B2) Colt/Summit
1992 - 1995 (B3) Colt Vista
1989 (B5) Conquest
1989 - 1995 (B7) Stealth (2000 GTX Dodge/Eagle, Canada)
1992 - 1995 (B8) Colt Vista Wagon/Summit Wagon
1993 - 1994 (B9) Colt/Summit
1998 - 2000 (DN) Durango
1995 - 1999 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1995 - 1999 JA Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
1993 - 1999 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2000 (PL) Neon
1997 - 1999 (PR) Prowler
1996 - 1999 (SR) Viper/Viper GTS
**2000 (TJ) Wrangler**
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1989 - **2000** (XJ) Cherokee/Wagoneer
1993 - 1998 (WJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND LABOR OPERATION
NUMBERS NECESSARY TO INSTALL A CHILD SEAT TETHER ANCHOR. DAIMLERCHRYSLER
WILL REIMBURSE YOU FOR THE ANCHORS AND LABOR TO INSTALL THEM. THIS IS BEING
DONE IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION. REFER TO GLOBAL WARRANTY
ADMINISTRATION BULLETIN # D-99-23 FOR COMPLETE REIMBURSEMENT INSTRUCTIONS.
DISCUSSION: User-ready child restraint tether strap anchors will be provided in passenger cars in
the 2000 Model Year, and in light trucks in the 2001 Model Year. Tether straps improve the
performance of child restraints in collisions. Because of the publicity that has accompanied the "Fit
for a Kid" Program, owners of earlier products are expected to approach dealers for the free
provision and installation of the anchor hardware. DaimlerChrysler Corporation is offering child seat
tether anchors for the selected vehicles listed above. Each tether anchor is packaged in a kit
containing all necessary parts and a detailed instruction sheet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 6151
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 6152
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 6153
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Customer Satisfaction
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 6154
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Child Seat - Tether Anchor Part Numbers & Labor Time > Page 6155
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Left Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the door lock switch is moved to the LOCK position,
voltage is supplied on the P35 circuit to the bus bar located inside the right door switch, lock side.
Battery voltage is passed through the switch to the P33 circuit to the door motors. Grounding is
provided through the P34 circuit for all door motors back to the right door switch. The ground is
passed through the bus bar internal to the switch, UNLOCK side, to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit
connects to the left front switch to a bus bar, internal to the switch, and then to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit connects to its grounding point.
Left Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position, voltage is
supplied on the P36 circuit to the right door switch, unlock side. The battery voltage is passed
through the switch internal bus bar to the P34 circuit.
The P34 circuit then connects to the door motors on the unlock side. Grounding for the UNLOCK
function is provided by the P33 circuit.
The P33 circuit connects back to the right door switch, LOCK side, and passes through the internal
bus bar to the P35 circuit. The P35 circuit connects back to the left door switch, and passes
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to it's grounding point.
Right Door Switch Operation (Lock) When the switch is moved to the LOCK position, voltage is
supplied to the P33 circuit, and then to the door lock motors. The ground path is provided on the
P34 circuit back to the right door switch. The ground is passed through the switch internal bus bar
to the P36 circuit. The P36 circuit connects to the left door switch and through to the Z8 circuit. The
Z8 circuit then connects to the grounding point at the left center instrument panel support.
Right Door Switch Operation (Unlock) When the switch is moved to the UNLOCK position voltage
is supplied to the P34 circuit from the switch to the door UNLOCK side of the motors. The
grounding path is through the LOCK side of the motors, circuit P33, back to the switch. The ground
continues through the internal bus bar of the switch on circuit P35 to the left door switch. At the left
door switch, the ground passes through that switches internal bus bar to the Z8 grounding point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6160
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Door Lock Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting location. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the Door Lock Switch
Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct in the Lock and Unlock switch positions. If these
results are not obtained, replace the switch.
Wiring The following wiring test sequence determines whether or not voltage is continuous through
the body harness to switch. 1. Remove left side switch from door trim panel. 2. Carefully separate
multiple terminal block on wiring harness from switch body. 3. Connect one lead of test light to a
ground terminal. Touch other test light lead to Red Wire terminal.
a. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional. b. If test light
does not come on, check fuse 3 in the fuse block or for a open circuit.
4. If test light comes on, the wiring circuit between the battery and switch is functional.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6161
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove front door trim. 2. Disconnect wire connector. 3. Remove attaching screws. 4. Remove
the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Mirror Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The power mirror switch has a right and left position. Moving the switch to either of these positions
changes the voltage path internal to the switch (i.e.. changes polarity at the motors).
When the switch is moved to the left position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P93 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a left door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P95 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door minor RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
When the switch is moved to the right position and mirror movement UP is selected, voltage is
supplied through the P92 circuit and the ground path is through circuit P90. When the DOWN
movement is selected the power and ground are reversed.
If a right door mirror movement LEFT is selected voltage is supplied through the P94 circuit and the
ground is passed through circuit P91. When the left door mirror RIGHT movement is selected the
power and ground are reversed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6165
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Mirror Switch Test
Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position. 2. Disconnect wiring harness at switch
connector. 3. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown
in the Mirror Switch Test and RHD Power Fold Away Mirror
Switch Test.
4. If test results are not obtained as shown, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6166
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove switch mounting screws from back side of trim panel and
remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Air Dam > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Competition Package Front Fascia - Information
Air Dam: Technical Service Bulletins Competition Package Front Fascia - Information
NO: 23-22-98
GROUP: Body
DATE: Jun. 12, 1998
SUBJECT:
Competition Package (Sales Code ACR) Front Fascia Information
MODELS:
1995 - 1998 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT WITH THE COMPETITION PACKAGE (SALES
CODE ACR) ONLY.
DISCUSSION:
Neon's built with the corn petition package (sales code ACR) are built with the same front fascia as
a Sport, Expresso and RT models. The sport model front fascia includes holes for fog lamps.
However on the competition package the fog lamps are not installed to allow for additional air flow
during racing.
If a replacement is necessary to a front fascia on a vehicle equipped with the competition package,
it is important that the correct fascia with the fog lamp openings be installed.
If a customer requests that fog lamps be added at their expense, they should be advised that if the
vehicle is modified from original equipment it may then be illegal for some competition situations.
The addition of fog lamps is not a warrantable issue.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Weatherstrip: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
NO: 23-48-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: Sep. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Water Drips From Roof Rail Weatherstrip Channel Into Vehicle
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-97, DATED AUG. 29,
1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE PART NUMBERS HAVE BEEN
REVISED AND ARE MARKED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Water drips from roof rail weatherstrip and retainer channel into vehicle with the door/window open.
DISCUSSION:
A new anti-drip roof rail retainer channel is available for Sedan and Coupe models. The left and
right side roof rail retainer channels must be replaced as a set on 1997 and earlier models due to
appearance differences from the existing roof rail retainer channels.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04724516AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
1 04724517AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
**1 04724514AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan**
**1 04724515AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan **
1 04546838 Applique, "B" Pillar, Right
1 04546839 Applique, "B" Pillar, Left
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of both roof rail retainer channels and B pillar appliques.
1. Open door(s).
2. Using trim stick disengage the top and bottom push in fasteners from "B" pillar applique. Gently
pull outward on the applique to remove from the vehicle.
NOTE:
THE APPLIQUE IS ATTACHED TO THE VEHICLE WITH TWO SIDED TAPE BETWEEN THE
PUSH IN FASTENERS, INSURE ALL OF THE OLD TWO SIDED TAPE IS REMOVED FROM THE
VEHICLE SURFACE BEFORE INSTALLATION OF NEW PART.
3. Remove the weatherstrip from the retainer channel.
4. Remove the retainer channel from the body side aperture.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Weatherstrip: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle > Page
6180
5. Install the new retainer channel, by inserting the push pin(s). Install the remaining screws and
torque to 4.9 Nm (44 in. lbs), Figure 1 - Two Door, Figure 2 - Four Door.
6. Install the weatherstrip into the retainer channel.
7. Remove the backing paper from the "B" pillar two sided tape. Place the "B" pillar applique up to
the vehicle and push in the two fasteners. Beginning at the top of the "B" pillar, use firm pressure to
completely seat the applique.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
23-02-15-92 2 Door 0.9 Hrs.
23-02-15-93 4 Door 1.1 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle
NO: 23-48-97 Rev. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: Sep. 19, 1997
SUBJECT: Water Drips From Roof Rail Weatherstrip Channel Into Vehicle
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-48-97, DATED AUG. 29,
1997 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THE PART NUMBERS HAVE BEEN
REVISED AND ARE MARKED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Water drips from roof rail weatherstrip and retainer channel into vehicle with the door/window open.
DISCUSSION:
A new anti-drip roof rail retainer channel is available for Sedan and Coupe models. The left and
right side roof rail retainer channels must be replaced as a set on 1997 and earlier models due to
appearance differences from the existing roof rail retainer channels.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04724516AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
1 04724517AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left Front Pillar to Roof Glass Weather Strip, Coupe
**1 04724514AA Retainer Channel Assy., Right A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan**
**1 04724515AA Retainer Channel Assy., Left A to C Pillar Door Glass, Sedan **
1 04546838 Applique, "B" Pillar, Right
1 04546839 Applique, "B" Pillar, Left
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of both roof rail retainer channels and B pillar appliques.
1. Open door(s).
2. Using trim stick disengage the top and bottom push in fasteners from "B" pillar applique. Gently
pull outward on the applique to remove from the vehicle.
NOTE:
THE APPLIQUE IS ATTACHED TO THE VEHICLE WITH TWO SIDED TAPE BETWEEN THE
PUSH IN FASTENERS, INSURE ALL OF THE OLD TWO SIDED TAPE IS REMOVED FROM THE
VEHICLE SURFACE BEFORE INSTALLATION OF NEW PART.
3. Remove the weatherstrip from the retainer channel.
4. Remove the retainer channel from the body side aperture.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 23-48-97A > Sep > 97 > Roof Rail Weatherstrip - Water Leaks into Vehicle >
Page 6186
5. Install the new retainer channel, by inserting the push pin(s). Install the remaining screws and
torque to 4.9 Nm (44 in. lbs), Figure 1 - Two Door, Figure 2 - Four Door.
6. Install the weatherstrip into the retainer channel.
7. Remove the backing paper from the "B" pillar two sided tape. Place the "B" pillar applique up to
the vehicle and push in the two fasteners. Beginning at the top of the "B" pillar, use firm pressure to
completely seat the applique.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
23-02-15-92 2 Door 0.9 Hrs.
23-02-15-93 4 Door 1.1 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Diagrams
Speed Control Servo Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6191
Cruise Control Servo: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The servo unit consists of a solenoid valve body, and a vacuum chamber. The PCM controls the
solenoid valve body. The solenoid valve body controls the application and release of vacuum to the
diaphragm of the vacuum servo. The servo unit cannot be repaired and is serviced only as a
complete assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6192
Cruise Control Servo: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn ignition switch to the ON position without starting engine. Activate speed control ON switch.
Fig. 4 Servo Harness Connector
2. Disconnect the four-way electrical connector and the vacuum harness at the servo. 3. Connect a
jumper wire from Pin 3 of the servo to Pin 3 of the wire connector. 4. Ground Pins 2 and 4 in the
servo. Do not connect pin 1. 5. Connect a hand held vacuum pump to the vacuum nipple and apply
10 - 15 inches of vacuum. 6. If servo pulls cables, replace servo. 7. Ground Pin 1 on servo. 8.
Check that the throttle cable pulls in and holds as long as the vacuum pump is connected. After
one minute, check if cable is still holding. If cable
does not hold replace the servo.
9. Disconnect jumper from pin 3. Cable should return to rest position. If not, replace servo.
10. Connect 4 way electrical connector and vacuum harness to servo.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6193
Cruise Control Servo: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from servo. 2. Disconnect vacuum hoses from servo. 3. Remove
2 nuts retaining cable to servo. 4. Remove hair pin holding cable to servo.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hairpin to cable at servo. 2. Install 2 nuts at cable to servo and servo bracket, tighten to 7
N.m (60 in.lbs.). 3. Connect electrical connector to servo. 4. Connect vacuum hose to servo
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The speed control servo cable is connected between the speed control vacuum servo diaphragm
and the throttle body control linkage. This cable causes the throttle control linkage to open or close
the throttle valve in response to movement of the vacuum servo diaphragm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6197
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Service and Repair
Throttle Control Shield
Throttle Cable Attachment To Throttle Body-Manual Transmission
Throttle Cable Attachment To Throttle Body-Automatic Transmission
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6198
Disconnecting Throttle Cable - Typical
REMOVAL
1. Remove throttle control shield. 2. Remove throttle clasp from the throttle body lever. 3. Remove
speed control cable from throttle lever by sliding clasp out hole used for throttle cable. 4. Compress
the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket. 5. Disconnect electrical connector
from servo. 6. Disconnect vacuum hose from servo 7. Remove 2 nuts retaining bracket to servo. 8.
Remove push nuts holding cable housing to servo. 9. Remove retaining clip holding cable to servo.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retaining clip to cable at servo. 2. Slide cable bell housing over servo mounting studs. 3.
Install servo mounting studs into bracket. 4. Install 2 nuts at cable to servo and servo bracket,
tighten to 7 N.m (60 in. lbs.). 5. Connect electrical connector to servo. 6. Connect vacuum hose to
servo 7. Slide cable into throttle cable bracket and engage retaining tabs. 8. Rotate the throttle
lever forward to the wide open position and install speed control cable clasp. 9. Rotate the throttle
lever forward to the wide open position and install throttle cable clasp.
10. Install throttle control shield. Tighten bolt to 5.6N.m (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
There are two separate switch pods that operate the speed control system. The
steering-wheel/mounted switches use multiplexed circuits to provide inputs to the PCM for ON,
OFF RESUME/ACCELERATE, SET/COAST and CANCEL modes. Refer to the owner's manual for
more information on speed control switch functions and setting procedures.
When speed control is selected by depressing the ON switch, the PCM allows a set speed to be
stored in RAM for speed control. To store a set speed, depress the COAST/SET switch while the
vehicle is moving at a speed between 30 and 85 mph. In order for the speed control to engage, the
brakes cannot be applied, nor can the gear selector be indicating the transmission is in Park or
Neutral.
The speed control can be disengaged manually by: Stepping on the brake pedal
- Depressing the OFF switch
- Depressing the CANCEL switch.
The speed control can be disengaged also by any of the following conditions: An indication of Park or Neutral
- The VSS signal increases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the co-efficient of friction
between the road surface and tires is extremely low)
- An rpm increase without a VSS signal increase (indicates that the clutch has been disengaged)
- Excessive engine rpm (indicates that the transmission may be in a low gear)
- The VSS signal decreases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the vehicle may have
decelerated at an extremely high rate)
- If the actual speed is not within 20 mph of the set speed
The previous disengagement conditions are programmed for added safety.
Once the speed control has been disengaged, depressing the RES/ACCEL switch restores the
vehicle to the target speed that was stored in the PCM's RAM.
NOTE: Depressing the OFF switch will erase the set speed stored in the PCM's RAM.
If, while the speed control is engaged, the driver wishes to increase vehicle speed, the PCM is
programmed for an acceleration feature. With the RES/ ACCEL switch held closed, the vehicle
accelerates slowly to the desired speed. The new target speed is stored in the RAM when the
RES/ACCEL switch is released. The PCM also has a "tap-up" feature in which vehicle speed
increases at a rate of approximately 2 mph for each momentary switch activation of the
RES/ACCEL switch.
The PCM also provides a means to decelerate without disengaging speed control. To decelerate
from an existing recorded target speed, depress and hold the SET/COAST switch until the desired
speed is reached. Then release the switch. The ON and OFF switches operates two components:
the PCM's ON/OFF input, and the battery voltage to the brake switch, which powers the speed
control servo.
The individual switches cannot be repaired. If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 6202
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection
The speed control switches mounted on the steering wheel contain five switches and four resistors.
The PCM sends 5 Volts through pin 41 to the speed control switches. The input on pin 41 is
responsible for identifying the following: Resume/Accelerate, Set/ Coast, On, Off and Cancel. This
is accomplished by multiplexing. Multiplexing allows the PCM to identify more than one signal from
a single wire. To accomplish this, the speed control switch uses resistors that cause different
voltage signals at pin 41.
The 5-Volt signal at pin 41 has no path to ground when no buttons are depressed, allowing the
PCM to recognize the open circuit. When the ON, OFF switch contacts are closed, the 5 Volt signal
is pulled through a 15400 ohm resistor to ground providing a voltage of 4.14 to 4.73 Volts at pin 41.
Once the PCM recognizes the ON signal, the PCM provides a battery voltage signal to the speed
control servo through pin 5 of the 80-way connector.
When the SET/COAST switch is depressed, a momentary contact closes a path to ground through
a 2,940 ohm resistor. This causes a voltage of approximately 1.99 to 3.20 Volts at pin 41, indicating
that the SET/COAST switch has been depressed. When the RES/ACCEL switch is depressed, a
momentary contact closes to ground through a 6,650 ohm resistor. The 5-volt signal then passes
through a higher resistance than that of the SET/COAST switch, causing the voltage to be
approximately 3.30 to 4.14 Volts. When the OFF switch is depressed, the contacts close directly to
ground, causing the 5-Volt signal to drop to 0 Volts. When the CANCEL is pressed the contact
closes to ground through a 920 ohm resister, causing voltage at pin 41 of 0.61 to 1.94 Volts.
Ohmmeter Check Of Switch
Speed Control Switch
1. Remove the ON, OFF speed control switch assembly and disconnect the two-way connector. 2.
Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the other Pin. The meter
should read no continuity. Press the OFF button,
the ohmmeter should read 0 to 0.5 ohms. Press the ON button, the ohmmeter should read 15,245
to 15,555 ohms. If the resistance does not fall within these values replace switch.
3. Remove the RESUME/SET/CANCEL speed control switch assembly and disconnect the
two-way connector. 4. Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the
other Pin. The meter should read no continuity Press the SET button,
the ohmmeter should read 2,910 to 2,970 ohms. Press the RESUME button, the ohmmeter should
read 6,580 to 6,720 ohms. Press the CANCEL button, the ohmmeter should read 900 to 920 ohms.
If the resistance values do not fall within these specification replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The reservoir contains a one-way check valve to trap engine vacuum in the reservoir. When engine
vacuum drops, as in climbing a grade while driving, the reservoir supplies the vacuum needed to
maintain proper speed control operation. The vacuum reservoir cannot be repaired and must be
replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 6206
Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove bolt on top of vacuum reservoir. 3. Remove vacuum
hoses. 4. Remove vacuum reservoir.
INSTALLATION
1. Install vacuum reservoir, install push pin and tighten screw to 5 N.m (44 in. lbs.). 2. Install
vacuum hoses. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
There are two separate switch pods that operate the speed control system. The
steering-wheel/mounted switches use multiplexed circuits to provide inputs to the PCM for ON,
OFF RESUME/ACCELERATE, SET/COAST and CANCEL modes. Refer to the owner's manual for
more information on speed control switch functions and setting procedures.
When speed control is selected by depressing the ON switch, the PCM allows a set speed to be
stored in RAM for speed control. To store a set speed, depress the COAST/SET switch while the
vehicle is moving at a speed between 30 and 85 mph. In order for the speed control to engage, the
brakes cannot be applied, nor can the gear selector be indicating the transmission is in Park or
Neutral.
The speed control can be disengaged manually by: Stepping on the brake pedal
- Depressing the OFF switch
- Depressing the CANCEL switch.
The speed control can be disengaged also by any of the following conditions: An indication of Park or Neutral
- The VSS signal increases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the co-efficient of friction
between the road surface and tires is extremely low)
- An rpm increase without a VSS signal increase (indicates that the clutch has been disengaged)
- Excessive engine rpm (indicates that the transmission may be in a low gear)
- The VSS signal decreases at a rate of 10 mph per second (indicates that the vehicle may have
decelerated at an extremely high rate)
- If the actual speed is not within 20 mph of the set speed
The previous disengagement conditions are programmed for added safety.
Once the speed control has been disengaged, depressing the RES/ACCEL switch restores the
vehicle to the target speed that was stored in the PCM's RAM.
NOTE: Depressing the OFF switch will erase the set speed stored in the PCM's RAM.
If, while the speed control is engaged, the driver wishes to increase vehicle speed, the PCM is
programmed for an acceleration feature. With the RES/ ACCEL switch held closed, the vehicle
accelerates slowly to the desired speed. The new target speed is stored in the RAM when the
RES/ACCEL switch is released. The PCM also has a "tap-up" feature in which vehicle speed
increases at a rate of approximately 2 mph for each momentary switch activation of the
RES/ACCEL switch.
The PCM also provides a means to decelerate without disengaging speed control. To decelerate
from an existing recorded target speed, depress and hold the SET/COAST switch until the desired
speed is reached. Then release the switch. The ON and OFF switches operates two components:
the PCM's ON/OFF input, and the battery voltage to the brake switch, which powers the speed
control servo.
The individual switches cannot be repaired. If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6211
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection
The speed control switches mounted on the steering wheel contain five switches and four resistors.
The PCM sends 5 Volts through pin 41 to the speed control switches. The input on pin 41 is
responsible for identifying the following: Resume/Accelerate, Set/ Coast, On, Off and Cancel. This
is accomplished by multiplexing. Multiplexing allows the PCM to identify more than one signal from
a single wire. To accomplish this, the speed control switch uses resistors that cause different
voltage signals at pin 41.
The 5-Volt signal at pin 41 has no path to ground when no buttons are depressed, allowing the
PCM to recognize the open circuit. When the ON, OFF switch contacts are closed, the 5 Volt signal
is pulled through a 15400 ohm resistor to ground providing a voltage of 4.14 to 4.73 Volts at pin 41.
Once the PCM recognizes the ON signal, the PCM provides a battery voltage signal to the speed
control servo through pin 5 of the 80-way connector.
When the SET/COAST switch is depressed, a momentary contact closes a path to ground through
a 2,940 ohm resistor. This causes a voltage of approximately 1.99 to 3.20 Volts at pin 41, indicating
that the SET/COAST switch has been depressed. When the RES/ACCEL switch is depressed, a
momentary contact closes to ground through a 6,650 ohm resistor. The 5-volt signal then passes
through a higher resistance than that of the SET/COAST switch, causing the voltage to be
approximately 3.30 to 4.14 Volts. When the OFF switch is depressed, the contacts close directly to
ground, causing the 5-Volt signal to drop to 0 Volts. When the CANCEL is pressed the contact
closes to ground through a 920 ohm resister, causing voltage at pin 41 of 0.61 to 1.94 Volts.
Ohmmeter Check Of Switch
Speed Control Switch
1. Remove the ON, OFF speed control switch assembly and disconnect the two-way connector. 2.
Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the other Pin. The meter
should read no continuity. Press the OFF button,
the ohmmeter should read 0 to 0.5 ohms. Press the ON button, the ohmmeter should read 15,245
to 15,555 ohms. If the resistance does not fall within these values replace switch.
3. Remove the RESUME/SET/CANCEL speed control switch assembly and disconnect the
two-way connector. 4. Using an ohmmeter, touch one lead to one Pin and the second lead to the
other Pin. The meter should read no continuity Press the SET button,
the ohmmeter should read 2,910 to 2,970 ohms. Press the RESUME button, the ohmmeter should
read 6,580 to 6,720 ohms. Press the CANCEL button, the ohmmeter should read 900 to 920 ohms.
If the resistance values do not fall within these specification replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) AMBER WARNING LAMP
The ABS system uses an Amber ABS Warning Lamp, located in the instrument cluster. The
purpose of the warning lamp is discussed in detail below.
When Detection Occurs The ABS warning lamp will turn on when the Controller Antilock Brake
(CAB) detects a condition which results in a shutdown of ABS function. The ABS Warning Lamp is
normally on until the CAB completes its self tests and turns the lamp off (approximately 4-5
seconds after the ignition switch is turned on). When the ABS warning lamp is on, only the ABS
function of the brake system if affected. The standard brake system and the ability to stop the car
will not be affected when only the ABS warning lamp is on.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp on Chime
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation Headlamp on Chime
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The headlamp ON chime is used to indicate to the operator that the headlamps or parking lamps
are ON when the drivers door is OPEN. If the lamps are ON and the drivers door is opened, a
ground path is completed from the G26 circuit at the cluster, through the headlamp switch, to the
G16 circuit and ending at the door ajar switch. The door ajar switch is case grounded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Headlamp on Chime > Page 6220
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation Key-In Chime
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The key-in chime is used to indicate to the operator that the key is in the ignition with the drivers
door OPEN. If the key is in the ignition and the drivers door is OPEN, a ground path is completed
from the G26 circuit at the cluster, through the CLOSED key-in switch, to the G16 circuit and
terminating at the door ajar switch which is case grounded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions
Brake Warning Indicator: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS
Revisions
NUMBER: 26-12-97F
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1997
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1997-1998 Teves Mark IV, Teves Mark 20 ABS Diagnostic Manual - Publication Number 81-699-97012
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revisions to the ABS warning light procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions > Page 6225
244
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Teves Mark IV/Teves Mark 20 ABS Revisions > Page 6226
245
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > General Information
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation General Information
Master Cylinder Fluid Level Sensor
GENERAL INFORMATION
The red Brake warning lamp is located in the instrument panel cluster and is used to indicate a low
brake fluid condition or that the parking brake is applied. In addition, the brake warning lamp is
turned on as a bulb check by the ignition switch when the ignition switch is placed in the crank
position. Problems with this system will generally be of the type where the warning lamp fails to
turn on when it should, or remains on when it should not. The warning lamp bulb is supplied a 12
volt ignition feed anytime the ignition switch is on. The bulb is then illuminated by completing the
ground circuit either through the park brake switch, the fluid level sensor in the master cylinder
reservoir, or the ignition switch in the crank position.
PURPOSE
The Brake Fluid Level sensor is located in the brake fluid reservoir of the master cylinder assembly.
The purpose of the sensor is to provide the driver with an early warning that the brake fluid level in
the master cylinder reservoir has dropped to below normal. This may indicate an abnormal loss of
brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir resulting from a leak in the hydraulic system. As the
fluid drops below the minimum level, the fluid level sensor closes the brake warning light circuit.
This will turn on the red brake warning light. At this time, master cylinder fluid reservoir should be
checked and filled to the full mark with DOT 3 brake fluid.
NOTE: If brake fluid level has dropped in master cylinder fluid reservoir, the entire brake hydraulic
system should he checked for evidence of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 6229
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation ABS Warning Lamp Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The ABS warning lamp is an output from the Controller Anti Lock Brake (CAB) and the Antilock
Brake System (ABS) relay box. It is used to alert the operator of a problem in the ABS system. The
G19 circuit from the CAB and the ABS system relay is used to detect a problem. If a problem is
detected, the CAB grounds the G19 circuit and illuminates the lamp in the instrument cluster.
Circuit G19 is also an output of the CAB to the ABS system relay contact side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 6230
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Warning Lamp Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Brake Warning Indicator lamp is used to alert the operator of a problem with the vehicles
braking system. The lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is turned to START position to
perform a self check.
There are two switches used in this system and they are wired in parallel form. A parking brake
switch located on the parking brake mechanism will illuminate the lamp if the normally OPEN
switch is CLOSED. This switch is case grounded.
The other switch used is the brake warning lamp switch. This switch is normally OPEN. When the
brake system pressure is below a predetermined level the switch CLOSES and completes a path to
ground from the G9 circuit at the cluster, through the switch, to the left headlamp ground.
If the vehicle is built for use in Canada the parking brake switch is used for the Daytime Running
Lamp Module (DRL).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection Brake System Warning Lamp Test
The brake warning lamp illuminates when the parking brake is applied with ignition switch turned to
the ON position. The same lamp will also illuminate if one of the two service brake systems fail the
when brake pedal is applied.
To test the system:
- As the ignition switch is turned to the start position the lamp should light.
- Turn ignition switch to the ON position and apply the parking brake. The lamp should light.
If lamp fails to light inspect for:
- A burned out lamp
- Loose, corroded or damaged socket
- A damaged circuit board
- A broken or disconnected wire at the switch
- Defective switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test > Page 6233
Brake Warning Lamp Functional Check
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake System Warning Lamp Test > Page 6234
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 5 Amp fuse in cavity 11 of the fuse block.
- Check the 4 Amp fuse in cavity 12 of the fuse block.
- Check the Ignition Off Draw fuse in the PDC.
- Check for a good ground at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Charge Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Charge Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Charge Indicator lamp is used to alert the operator that the charging system voltage has fallen
below the normal operating range. This circuit is controlled by the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM). When the PCM determines a problem, it grounds the G12 circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Function
Circuit Identification
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Wire Code Identification
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6242
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
Connector Identification
Connectors shown in the diagrams are identified using the international standard arrows for male
and female terminals. A connector identifier is placed next to the arrows to indicate the connector
number.
For viewing connector pin-outs, with two or more terminals, refer to Connector Pin-Outs Index,
which identifies the connector by number and provides terminal numbering, circuit identification,
wire colors, and functions.
All connectors are viewed from the terminal end unless otherwise specified. To find the connector
location in the vehicle, refer to Connector Locations Index, which uses the connector identification
number from the wiring diagrams to provide a figure number reference.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6243
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6244
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the junction block, and are used to protect such items
as: power door lock motors, power windows, and various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6245
Symbol Identification
Various symbols are used throughout the Diagrams. These symbols can be identified by referring
to the Symbol Identification chart.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location group to indicate a point at which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6246
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
How to Read Wiring Diagrams
Wire Color Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire and color. The color is shown as a two-letter code, which can be identified by
referring to the Wire Color Code chart. If the wire has a tracer and it is a standard color, an asterisk
will follow the main wire color. If the tracer is non-standard, the main wire color will have a slash (/)
after it, followed by the tracer color.
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6247
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6248
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6249
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Fusible Link Replacement
On PL vehicles there is a fusible link placed between the output terminal of the generator and the
engine starter motor terminal. A service part is available if this fusible link requires replacement.
This service part has the eyelet that attaches to the starter motor. If the fusible link requires
replacement this indicates a problem in the charging/starting system that needs to be corrected.
Replacement of the fusible link is the same as repairing a wire. Refer to the wiring repair
information for soldering information.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6250
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6251
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6252
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6253
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6254
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Harness Connector Inspection
When an intermittent or open circuit is suspected it is important to check for a spread terminal. To
accomplish this remove the suspect female terminal from its connector.
Check the female terminal for drag when mated with the appropriate male terminal. If the terminal
is spread (no or little drag felt) replace the terminal using the procedures covered.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6255
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6256
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6257
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
Horns/Cigar Lighter
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6258
Cigarette Lighter: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The cigar lighter is powered by a 40 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
There is also a 15 Amp fuse located in cavity 1 of the fuse block dedicated for the cigar lighter.
When the operator presses the lighter, contacts inside of the lighter element CLOSE and voltage
flows through the heating element to ground.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6259
Cigarette Lighter: Testing and Inspection
- Check the 40 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
- Check the 15 Amp fuse located in the fuse block.
- Check for a good ground at the instrument panel left center support.
- Check the cigar lighter element.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6260
Cigarette Lighter: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cigar lighter element. 2. Reach underneath the instrument panel through the bottom
access hole and disconnect the cigar lighter receptacle wiring connectors. 3. Unscrew the cigar
lighter receptacle shell from the receptacle and remove from the base instrument panel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Clock: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The electronic digital clock is in the radio. The clock and radio each use the display panel built into
the radio. A digital readout indicates the time in hours and minutes whenever the ignition switch is
in the ON or ACC position.
When the ignition switch is in the OFF position, or when the radio frequency is being displayed,
time keeping is accurately maintained.
The procedure for setting the clock varies slightly with each radio. The correct procedure is
described in the individual radio operating instructions. Refer to the Owner's Manual supplied with
the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 6269
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door/Trunk Ajar Indicator/Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Door/Trunk Ajar Indicator/Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The trunk lamp snaps into the rear shelf panel reinforcement under/below the package shelf. 1.
Remove the socket assembly by reaching up above the sheet metal. Push the snap inward and
downward and remove the assembly 2. Remove the lamp from socket and pull the socket from the
lens. Replace as necessary
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper
Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper
Operation > Page 6281
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps Improper Operation > Page 6287
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Fuel Gauge: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The fuel level gauge is connected to the fuel pump module on the G4 circuit. The fuel pump
module contains the fuel pump and a variable resistor for the gauge. Grounding for the fuel pump
module is provided on the Z2 circuit and terminates at the left rear wheel house.
The logic driven gauge moves in response to the measured resistance of the fuel tank sending unit.
The fuel level sensor contains a variable resistor. As the position of the float and on the level
sensor changes, the resistor changes the current flow through the fuel gauge circuit. A change in
current flow alters the magnetic field in the fuel gauge which changes the pointer position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6291
Fuel Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Fuel Gauge
1. Disconnect the fuel gauge sending unit. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. The fuel
gauge should be at its lowest position. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 3. Ground fuel gauge sending
unit connector Pin 3. Turn ignition switch to the ON position. The fuel gauge should be at its
highest position. Turn
ignition switch OFF then ON, after a sending unit signal change to disable the cluster electronic
gauge dampening mechanism. a. If OK, check the fuel gauge sending unit connector for proper
connection. b. If not OK, connect the sending unit. Remove the cluster and check for an open or
short in the sending unit wiring. The sending unit will be less
than 1080 Ohms and greater than 50 Ohms depending upon fuel level. If the - sending unit wiring
is open or a short circuit, repair as necessary
c. If the sending unit wiring is OK, replace the gauge assembly If the condition persists, replace the
cluster printed circuit board.
Cluster Wire Harness Connector
Powertrain Control Module Pin Location
Fuel Gauge Incorrectly Indicates Empty
The fuel system uses both the instrument cluster and the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to
monitor the fuel level sending unit. If the PCM fuel monitoring circuits senses an open circuit, the
increased circuit resistance will causes a false fuel gauge empty reading. Check for continuity
between cluster wire harness connector Pin J2-10 and Pin 23 of the PCM. If there is no continuity,
repair as necessary If there is continuity, refer to Fuel Gauge test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > General Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > General Description > Page 6296
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6299
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6300
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6301
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6302
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6303
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Disarming
Air Bag Disarming
WARNING: Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable before beginning any airbag
system component removal or installation procedure. This will disable the airbag system. Failure to
disconnect battery could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury. Allow
system capacitor to discharge for 2 minutes before removing any airbag components
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Air Bag Disarming > Page 6309
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Air Bag Arming
Air Bag Arming
1. Verify that the negative battery cable is disconnected and isolated. 2. Connect scan tool (DRB)
to Data Link connector, located at right side of the steering column and at the lower edge of the
lower instrument panel. 3. Turn the ignition key to ON position. Exit vehicle with scan tool. Use the
latest version of the proper cartridge. 4. After checking that no one is inside the vehicle, connect
the battery negative terminal. 5. Using the scan tool, read and record active diagnostic code data.
6. Read and record any stored diagnostic codes. 7. Refer to the airbag system Diagnostic Test if
any diagnostic codes are found in Step 5 or Step 6. 8. Erase stored diagnostic codes if there are no
active diagnostic codes. If problems remain, diagnostic codes will not erase. Refer to the airbag
system Diagnostic Test. If the airbag warning lamp either fails to light with the ignition switch ON, or
the light goes on and stays on, there is a system malfunction. Refer to the airbag system
Diagnostic Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Instrument
Panel Circuit Board > Component Information > Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Circuit Board: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cluster.
Cluster Assembly
2. Remove the attaching screws and rear cover. The bottom screws attaching lens to housing can
be accessed without removing foam pad.
Printed Circuit Board
3. Disconnect the odometer connector and remove eight attaching screws that attach the printed
circuit board and housing. 4. Carefully remove printed circuit board from the cluster.
INSTALLATION
- For installation reverse the above procedures. Carefully place board on the cluster and ensure
that the odometer connector is placed through the board. Gently press board on cluster with a
slight rocking motion to ensure pins on gauges line up.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The low fuel lamp is used to indicate to the operator that the fuel level is below a predetermined
level. This lamp is logic driven by the instrument cluster.
When the instrument cluster determines a low fuel condition based on an input from the fuel tank
gauge level sending unit (circuit G4) it illuminates the lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6316
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The low fuel warning lamp receives its signal from the fuel gauge drive circuit. Due to production
variations, the point where the lamp illuminates, may vary from 1/16 to 3/16 mark on the fuel
gauge. There is a built in time delay before the lamp illuminates. This prevents the lamp from going
on and off under various road conditions.
1. Verify that the fuel gauge is operating properly 2. Check the low fuel warning lamp assembly. 3.
If the lamp still does not function under a low fuel condition replace the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The Service Engine Soon lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is in the ON position and prior
to starting the vehicle. The lamp will turn off after the vehicle is started.
If while the vehicle is running a problem is detected in the engine control system the lamp is
illuminated. This is accomplished by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) grounding the G3
circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Odometer: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The speedometer and odometer receive their information on the G7 circuit from the Vehicle Speed
Sensor (VSS) on vehicles equipped with the manual or 3-spd automatic transmission. On vehicles
equipped with the 41TE transmission the G7 circuit connects from the Transmission Control
Module (TCM) to the instrument duster. This circuit also provides a signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
Logic internal to the cluster steps the odometer at a high rate to indicate the proper mileage
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6323
Odometer: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the instrument panel top cover and cluster bezel.
Odometer
2. Remove the four screws attaching cluster to instrument panel. 3. Remove the cluster. 4. Remove
the screws attaching PC board cover to cluster. 5. Disconnect the odometer connector from the
printed circuit board. 6. Remove the screws attaching lens, dial and gauge assembly to the
housing. The bottom screws attaching lens to the housing can be accessed
without removing the foam pad.
7. Remove the lens, dial and gauge assembly from housing. 8. Remove the two screws holding the
odometer to dial and gauge assembly When setting the dial/gauge and/or cluster assembly down, it
must be
face up or the gauge operation will be damaged.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures. Carefully place the dial and gauge assembly on
the cluster and ensure that the odometer connector is placed through the board. Install with a slight
rocking motion to ensure the pins on gauges line up.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The low oil pressure lamp is used to indicate to the operator that the engine oil pressure has
dropped below a predetermined pressure. Power for the lamp is provided on the G5 circuit which
also powers the other warning lamps.
When the oil pressure is low the normally OPEN oil pressure switch CLOSES completing a path to
ground on circuit G6. The oil pressure switch is case grounded to the engine block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test
CAUTION: Disconnect the battery negative cable before servicing the instrument panel or
components. When power is required for test purposes, connect battery cable for test only.
Disconnect the battery negative cable afier test and before continuing service procedures.
The low oil pressure warning lamp will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a
safe oil pressure level.
Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine. If the wire
at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper wire,
ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check the
warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket in
the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Low Oil Pressure Warning Lamp Test > Page 6329
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection Low Oil Warning Circuit
The low fuel warning lamp receives its-signal from the fuel gauge drive circuit. Due to production
variations, the point where the lamp illuminates, may vary from 1/16 to 3/16 mark on the fuel
gauge. There is a built in time delay before the lamp illuminates. This prevents the lamp from going
on and off under various road conditions.
1. Verify that the fuel gauge is operating properly 2. Check the low fuel warning lamp assembly. 3.
If the lamp still does not function under a low fuel condition replace the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The fasten seat belt indicator is used with the warning chime to indicate to the operator to fasten
the seat belt. There is a switch located in the drivers side B-pillar that is normally OPEN with the
seat belt buckled.
If the seat belt is not buckled the switch CLOSES and a ground path is completed from the G10
circuit to the Z1 circuit. This will illuminate the lamp in the instrument cluster.
When the ignition switch is moved to the START position the lamp will illuminate. Logic internal to
the instrument cluster determines the length of time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov
> 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov
> 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 6342
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: >
083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: >
083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 6348
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation General Description
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
OPERATION
The fuel gauge sending unit is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The sending unit
consists of a float, an arm, and two variable resistors (tracks). These two tracks are used to send
two different electrical signals. One is used for fuel gauge operation and the other is for OBD II
emission requirements.
Track 1 fuel gauge operation: As the fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This
decreases the sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read full.
As the fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This increases the sending unit
resistance, causing the fuel gauge on the instrument panel to read empty
Track 2-OBD II emission requirements: A variable voltage signal is sent to the PCM to indicate fuel
level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent a false setting of misfire and fuel system monitor
trouble codes if the fuel level in the tank is less than 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > General Description > Page 6353
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Related Trouble Codes and Set Conditions
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too High
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes above a calculated value.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
systems monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Open sensor signal circuit
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
Name of Code:
Fuel Level Sending Unit Volts Too Low
When Monitored:
Ignition on.
Set Condition:
The fuel level sensor signal circuit voltage at the PCM goes below 0.10 volts.
Theory of Operation:
The voltage at the fuel level sending unit sends a variable voltage to the powertrain control module
to indicate fuel level. The purpose of this feature is to prevent false setting of misfire and fuel
system monitor codes when the vehicle is operating at low fuel levels.
Possible Causes:
- Sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Fuel level sending unit failure
- Loss of fuel ignition switch output voltage
- Instrument cluster printed circuit board failure
- Powertrain control module failure
- Connector wires
- Connector terminals
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Operation Check
When a problem occurs with a cluster gauge check for a defective sending unit or wiring. Do this
before disassembling the cluster.
1. Sending units and wiring can be checked by grounding the connector leads at the sending unit in
the vehicle. 2. With the ignition in the ON position, a grounded input will cause the fuel or
temperature gauge to read at or above maximum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6356
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Voltage Check
Fig. 1 Fuel Guage Test Terminal
1. Remove the fuel gauge electrical harness. 2. Connect 12 volt test light to the fuel gauge and
ground terminal. 3. Turn ignition to On position and proceed as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6357
a. If test light illuminates and pointer of gauge does not swing, replace fuel gauge. b. If test light
illuminates and pointer of gauge swings, replace fuel gauge unit. c. If test light does not light and
pointer of gauge does not swing, check the electrical harness for kinks chaffing and broken wires.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Sending Unit Operation Check > Page 6358
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection Sending Unit Resistance Check
Fig. 10 Level Sensor Diagnosis
This procedure tests the resistance of the level sensor itself. It does not test the level sensor circuit.
The level sensor is a variable resistor. Its resistance changes with the amount of fuel in the tank.
The float arm attached to the sensor moves as the fuel level changes. To test the level sensor,
connect an ohmmeter across the sensor signal and sensor ground terminals of the fuel pump
module connector. Move the float lever to the positions shown in the resistance chart. Record the
resistance at each point. Replace the level sensor if the resistance is not within specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6359
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Fig. 21 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
NOTE: Remove fuel pump module prior to beginning this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector.
Fig. 22 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge.
Fig. 23 Wire Terminal Locking Finger
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6360
Fig. 24 Removing Wires From Connector
4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector.
Fig. 25 Loosening Level Sensor
5. Insert a screwdriver between the fuel pump module and the top of the level sensor housing.
Fig. 26 Level Sensor Removal/Installation
6. Push level sensor down slightly.
- Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in place.
7. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
8. Install locking wedge on connector. 9. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector.
10. Install fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The PRNDL lamp receives power on the E2 circuit from the 4 Amp fuse located in the fuse block in
cavity 12. The fuse receives power from the headlamp switch. Circuit E2 also powers the ash
receiver lamp.
When the headlamp switch is moved to the PARK or ON position, current flows through the fuse to
the PRNDL lamp. The ground for the lamp is supplied on the Z3 circuit, and terminates at the
instrument panel left center support. This circuit is also spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, the
ignition switch lamp, and the glove box lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Speedometer Head: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The speedometer and odometer receive their information on the G7 circuit from the Vehicle Speed
Sensor (VSS) on manual and 3-spd automatic transmission applications. On vehicles equipped
with the 41TE transmission circuit G7 connects from the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to the
instrument cluster. The G7 circuit also provides a signal to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
Logic internal to the instrument cluster adjusts the position of the gauge pointer to the correct
vehicle speed using the signal on the G7 circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6367
Speedometer Head: Testing and Inspection
The vehicle is equipped with a electronically driven speedometer and odometer assemblies. A
signal is sent from a transmission-mounted vehicle speed sensor to the speedometer circuitry
through the wiring harness.
Diagnosis of the vehicle speed sensor and circuit, the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus,
and/or the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) should be performed with a DRB scan tool. For
diagnosis of the speedometer, refer to Powertrain Management / Computers and Control Systems /
Vehicle Speed Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tachometer: > 08-04-98 > Jan > 98 > Tachometer - Fluctuates and/or
Bounces
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-04-98 Date: 980130
Tachometer - Fluctuates and/or Bounces
NO: 08-04-98
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Tachometer Fluctuates And/Or Bounces
MODELS: 1997-1998 (PL) Neon
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A TACHOMETER, BUILT PRIOR TO
DECEMBER 12, 1997 (MDH 1212XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Tachometer fluctuates and/or bounces as much as 300 to 1000 RPM
while driving at a steady speed/RPM.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB Ill) with
the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Using an
ohmmeter, check the resistance between the PCM case and the battery ground. If the resistance is
less than 1 ohm, refer to the appropriate Powertrain Diagnostic Manual for further tachometer
diagnostics. If the resistance is more than 1 ohm, perform the Repair Procedure.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
08-19-01-98 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves tightening the four screws holding the case of the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) to ensure complete grounding. If the ground is incomplete, the signal to the tachometer is
momentarily interrupted.
1. Disconnect the negative and positive cables from the battery.
2. Remove the washer bottle neck.
3. Squeeze the tabs on the Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling up to remove the PDC
from the mounting bracket. Lay the PDC aside to gain access to the PCM bracket screws.
4. Remove the three screws attaching the PCM to the body.
5. Lift the PCM up and disconnect the two 40-way connectors.
6. Remove the PCM.
7. Turn the PCM over to the back side. Torque the four screws (at each corner) to 6.8 Nm (60 in.
lbs.) using a manual torque wrench.
8. Attach the two 40-way connectors to the PCM.
9. Install the PCM. Torque the mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.).
10. Install the PDC by pushing it down into the brackets.
11. Install the washer bottle neck.
12. Connect the positive and negative battery cables.
13. Using an ohmmeter, check the resistance between the PCM case and the battery ground. If the
resistance is less than 1 ohm, the repair is complete.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tachometer: > 08-04-98 > Jan > 98 > Tachometer - Fluctuates and/or
Bounces > Page 6376
14. If the resistance is above 1 ohm, remove the PCM and perform the following steps:
A. Remove one PCM corner screw at a time, then insert back into the hole, and torque to 6.8 Nm
(60 in. lbs.). This will work the screw through the paint creating a better ground.
B. Repeat for remaining three screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tachometer: > 08-04-98 > Jan > 98 > Tachometer Fluctuates and/or Bounces
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-04-98 Date: 980130
Tachometer - Fluctuates and/or Bounces
NO: 08-04-98
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Jan. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Tachometer Fluctuates And/Or Bounces
MODELS: 1997-1998 (PL) Neon
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A TACHOMETER, BUILT PRIOR TO
DECEMBER 12, 1997 (MDH 1212XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Tachometer fluctuates and/or bounces as much as 300 to 1000 RPM
while driving at a steady speed/RPM.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS) or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB Ill) with
the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Using an
ohmmeter, check the resistance between the PCM case and the battery ground. If the resistance is
less than 1 ohm, refer to the appropriate Powertrain Diagnostic Manual for further tachometer
diagnostics. If the resistance is more than 1 ohm, perform the Repair Procedure.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
08-19-01-98 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: XX - Service Adjustment
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves tightening the four screws holding the case of the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) to ensure complete grounding. If the ground is incomplete, the signal to the tachometer is
momentarily interrupted.
1. Disconnect the negative and positive cables from the battery.
2. Remove the washer bottle neck.
3. Squeeze the tabs on the Power Distribution Center (PDC) while pulling up to remove the PDC
from the mounting bracket. Lay the PDC aside to gain access to the PCM bracket screws.
4. Remove the three screws attaching the PCM to the body.
5. Lift the PCM up and disconnect the two 40-way connectors.
6. Remove the PCM.
7. Turn the PCM over to the back side. Torque the four screws (at each corner) to 6.8 Nm (60 in.
lbs.) using a manual torque wrench.
8. Attach the two 40-way connectors to the PCM.
9. Install the PCM. Torque the mounting screws to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.).
10. Install the PDC by pushing it down into the brackets.
11. Install the washer bottle neck.
12. Connect the positive and negative battery cables.
13. Using an ohmmeter, check the resistance between the PCM case and the battery ground. If the
resistance is less than 1 ohm, the repair is complete.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tachometer: > 08-04-98 > Jan > 98 > Tachometer Fluctuates and/or Bounces > Page 6382
14. If the resistance is above 1 ohm, remove the PCM and perform the following steps:
A. Remove one PCM corner screw at a time, then insert back into the hole, and torque to 6.8 Nm
(60 in. lbs.). This will work the screw through the paint creating a better ground.
B. Repeat for remaining three screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6383
Tachometer: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The tachometer is connected to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on the G21 circuit. It uses
solid state circuity to decode the ignition pulses received from the PCM to adjust the gauge pointer
to the proper position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6384
Tachometer: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the cluster.
Cluster Wire Harness Connector
2. Check for battery voltage at Pin J1-6 of the cluster wire harness connector. 3. With the ignition
switch in the ON position, check for battery voltage at Pin J1-5 connector. 4. Check Pin J1-8 of the
connector for continuity to ground. 5. Check for tachometer signal from the Powertrain Control
Module by connecting an AC DIGITAL VOLTMETER to Pin J1-7 of the connector and
ground. A reading of at least 1.0 Volt should be present with the engine running. a. If the voltage is
NOT within specification, go to Step 6. b. If the voltage is within specification go to Step 7.
Powertrain Control Module Pin Location
6. If there is less than 1.0 Volt at Pin J1-7 of the connector, check for continuity between Pin J1-7
and Pin 73 of the Powertrain Control Module
connector. Also, check the connector at the Powertrain Control Module for damaged pins or
terminal push outs.
7. If the voltage is less than 1.0 Volt at Pin J1-7 of the connector and there is continuity between
Pin J1-7 and Pin 73 of the PCM connector, replace
the Powertrain Control Module.
8. If all tests performed test good, replace the dial and gauge assembly 9. If the tachometer
continues to be inoperative, replace the print circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The temperature gauge is connected to the engine coolant temperature sensor on the G20 circuit.
The engine coolant temperature sensor for the gauge is a combination unit. One side of the unit is
used for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and the other side for the cluster. The sending unit
is case grounded to the engine.
The logic driven gauge moves in response to the measured resistance of the engine coolant
temperature sending unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6388
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
1. Disconnect the coolant temperature sensor. 2. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge
should be at its lowest position. Turn ignition switch OFF 3. Ground temperature gauge sending
unit connector Pin 3. Turn ignition switch ON. The temperature gauge should be at its highest
position. After
the seat belt lamp goes out, the cluster should chime for about Eight Seconds. a. If OK, check
temperature sending unit connector for proper connection. If connections are OK, replace the
sending unit. b. If not OK, and the high temperature chime sounds but the gauge shows cold,
replace the gauge assembly If gauge is still not working, replace
the printed circuit board.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Floor Console With Transmission Range Indicator
1. Raise the floor console. 2. Remove the attaching screw from each of the two forward cup
holders of the floor console. Remove the screws at the rear of the console or inside
of the armrest console bin.
3. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up. 4. Lift the floor console at the rear high enough to
gain access to the lamp and socket. 5. Remove the indicator lamp socket from bezel to replace the
lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Specifications
Backup Lamp Switch: Specifications
Mounting ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6397
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 6400
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
NOTE: The back-up lamp switch is located on the top left front side of the transaxle case.
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist. 2. From bottom side of vehicle, remove wiring connector from switch. 3.
Unscrew switch from transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. To install, reverse removal procedure. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Confirm back-up lamps are functioning properly following installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Light Bulb > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Backup Light Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release trunk latch and open trunk lid. 2. Separate trunk lining from rear closure panel to gain
access to back of tail lamp.
Tail And Stop Lamp Bulb
3. Rotate and remove bulb socket from tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel. 4. Pull
bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Rotate and install bulb socket into tail lamp through openings in rear
closure panel. 3. Install trunk lining to rear closure panel. 4. Close and secure trunk lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Brake Light Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release trunk latch and open trunk lid. 2. Separate trunk lining from rear closure panel to gain
access to back of tail lamp.
Tail And Stop Lamp Bulb
3. Rotate and remove bulb socket from tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel. 4. Pull
bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Rotate and install bulb socket into tail lamp through openings in rear
closure panel. 3. Install trunk lining to rear closure panel. 4. Close and secure trunk lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service Precautions
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Switch Operation
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Switch Operation
The stop lamp switch controls operation of the vehicles stop lamps. Also, if the vehicle is equipped
with speed control, the stop lamp switch will deactivate speed control when the brake pedal is
depressed. The stop lamp switch controls operation of the right and left tail, stop and turn signal
lamp and Center High Mounted Stop Lamp CHMSL, by supplying battery current to these lamps.
The stop lamp switch controls the lamp operation by opening and closing the electrical circuit to the
stop lamps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Switch Operation > Page 6413
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Vehicles equipped with the speed control option use a dual function stop lamp switch. The switch is
mounted in the same location as the conventional stop lamp switch, on the brake pedal mounting
bracket under the instrument panel. The PCM monitors the state of the dual function stop lamp
switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6414
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 21 Stop Lamp Switch
1. Remove the stop lamp switch, refer to Lighting and Horns/Brake Light Switch/Stop Switch
Removal/Installation. Disconnect connector from stop
lamp switch. Using an ohmmeter, switch continuity may be checked as follows:
2. With switch plunger released, there should be continuity between Pin 5 and Pin 6. 3. With switch
plunger depressed, there should be continuity:
- Between Pin 1 and Pin 2.
- Between Pin 3 and Pin 4.
4. If the above results are not obtained, the stop lamp switch is defective or out of adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6415
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
PROCEDURE
1. Remove stop lamp switch from its bracket by rotating it approximately 30° in a counter-clockwise
direction. 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch. 3. Hold stop lamp switch
firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of the stop lamp switch until
it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
4. Install the stop lamp switch into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake
pedal as far down as possible. Then while keeping
the brake pedal depressed, install the stop lamp switch into the bracket by aligning index key on
switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When switch is fully installed in the
square hole of the bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock the switch into the
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
5. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 6. Gently pull back on brake
pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger to ratchet backward to the
correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6416
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
REMOVE
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal while rotating stop lamp switch in a counter-clockwise
direction approximately 30°. 2. Pull the switch rearward and remove from its mounting bracket. 3.
Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch.
INSTALL
NOTE: Prior to installing stop lamp switch into bracket, the plunger must be moved to its fully
extended position using procedure in step Step 1.
1. Hold stop lamp switch firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of
the stop lamp switch until it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 3. Mount the stop lamp switch
into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake pedal as far down as possible.
Then install switch in
bracket by aligning index key on switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When
switch is fully installed in bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock switch into
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If too much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
4. Gently pull back on brake pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger
to ratchet backward to the correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear
Cargo Lamp
Cargo Lamp: Service and Repair Rear Cargo Lamp
REMOVAL
1. Insert a trim stick or small flat blade between the lamp lens and rear shelf reinforcement panel.
2. Pry the lamp lens downward. 3. Disengage wire connectors. 4. Separate lamp from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the removal procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear
Cargo Lamp > Page 6421
Cargo Lamp: Service and Repair Rear Cargo Lamp Bulb
The trunk lamp snaps into the rear shelf panel reinforcement under/below the package shelf.
REMOVAL 1. Insert a trim stick or small flat blade between the lamp lens and rear shelf
reinforcement panel. 2. Pry the lamp lens downward. 3. Pull bulb from socket
INSTALLATION 1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Position the lamp in the rear shelf reinforcement panel
and snap into place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center High Mounted Stop Lamp <--> [Center Mounted Brake Lamp] >
Center Mounted Brake Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and Repair
Center Mounted Brake Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release trunk latch and open trunk lid.
CHMSL Bulb
2. Remove bulb socket from center high mounted stop lamp. 3. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Glove Box Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The glove box lamp receives power on the M1 circuit from the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power
Distribution Center (PDC). A switch, wired in series after the lamp, CLOSES when the glove box
door is opened, and completes a path to ground on the Z3 circuit.
The Z3 circuit is spliced in with the ash receiver lamp, PRNDL lamp, and the time delay relay. The
Z3 circuit terminates at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6430
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair
Glove Box Switch/Lamp
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable and isolate it or remove fuse 12 prior to removing the switch,
or wires may short to ground. 2. Open the glove box and push the glove box sides inward allowing
the door bumpers to clear and the box to tip forward. 3. Reach inside the opening and squeeze the
lamp/switch retainers until they are disengage. 4. Pull the switch/lamp rearward and remove it.
Replace the lamp. To replace the switch disconnect wire and replace the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable and isolate it or remove fuse 12 prior to removing the switch,
or wires may short to ground. 2. Open the glove box and push the glove box sides inward allowing
the door bumpers to clear and the box to tip forward. 3. Reach inside the opening and squeeze the
lamp/switch retainers until they are disengage. 4. Pull the switch/lamp rearward and remove it.
Replace the lamp. To replace the switch disconnect wire and replace the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
DRL Module
The Daytime Running Lamp module is attached to a support brace on the underside of the
instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6438
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION - CANADA
On vehicles built for sale in Canada, the head- lamps operate, at reduced intensity, when the
ignition switch is in the RUN position and the parking brake switch is OPEN.
In the Power Distribution Center (PDC), a bus bar connected to battery voltage feeds circuit A1. In
the RUN position, the ignition switch connects circuit A1 to circuit A21. A 30 Amp fuse in the PDC,
protects circuits A1 and A21.
Circuit A21 connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. The bus bar in the fuse block feeds circuit G5
through a 5 Amp fuse in cavity 11. Circuit G5 is powered only when the ignition switch is in the
RUN position.
Circuit G9 connects to the DRL module. The G9 circuit splices to the brake warning switch, park
brake switch and instrument cluster brake warning bulb.
Circuit L20 from the headlamp and dimmer switch supplies battery voltage to the DRL module at all
times. Circuit A3 from the PDC feeds circuit L20. A 40 Amp fuse in the PDC protects the A3 circuit.
From the DRL module, circuit L4 powers the LOW beams of the left and right headlamps. The DRL
controls the power to circuit L4. Circuit L4 connects to cavity 10 of the DRL module.
Circuit L3 feeds the high beams of the headlamps. When the operator flashes the headlamps with
the stalk of the multi-function switch, the DRL senses voltage on circuit L3. When it senses voltage
on circuit L3, the DRL module stops supplying power to the low beams on circuit L4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6439
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
- If the park brake switch is CLOSED, the DRL will not turn on the headlamps. The DRL senses if
the park brake switch is CLOSED on circuit G9.
- Circuit Z1 provides ground for the headlamps.
- Circuit L20 of the headlamp switch connector has a jumper that feeds the DRL module.
- Check for a blown fuse in circuits A1 or G5.
- The headlamp switch has a 24 Amp circuit breaker that feeds circuit L20.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection Relay, Lighting > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Description and Operation
Halo Lamp/Time Delay Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time delay relay is used to allow a time-ON function for the ignition switch halo lamp. Power for
the relay is received on the M1 circuit from the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC). This is the Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse and HOT at all times.
When a door is OPENED, or the headlamp switch is moved to the dome lamp position, a ground
path is provided for the relay on the M23 circuit. This energizes the relay, CLOSING the contacts.
When the relay contacts are CLOSED, power is provided through the relay to the M50 circuit.
The M50 circuit supplies current to the ignition switch lamp in the steering column. Ground for the
lamp is provided on the Z3 circuit. This circuit splices with the glove box lamp, the ash receiver
lamp, and the PRNDL lamp. The Z3 circuit terminates at the instrument panel left center support.
Circuit M23 is also spliced with the Remote Key-less Entry (RKE) module and the time out relay
located in the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Dome Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Insert a trim stick between the headliner and dome lamp lens. 2. Carefully pry downward on the
four corners of the lamp lens. 3. Separate lamp lens from lamp. 4. Grasp bulb and pull from lamp
socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Position bulb in socket and snap into place. 2. Position lens on lamp and snap into place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 6455
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 6461
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove fog lamp from behind fascia. 2. Disengage wire connector from fog lamp bulb base.
Fog Lamp Bulb
3. Remove bulb from lamp.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the glass of halogen bulbs with fingers or other possibly oily surface,
reduced bulb life will result.
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Relay Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires, connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of the switch to
battery voltage.
Fog Lamp Switch Test
Fog Lamp Switch Circuit
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in for fog lamp switch circuit. 4. Push
the fog lamp switch button. The test lamp and the LED indicator on the front of the switch should
illuminate. 5. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Front Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch and disconnect the connector at the center stack.
Front Fog Lamp Switch Circuit Diagram
2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin L7 to battery voltage, and connect Pin Z03 to ground. 3.
Push the fog lamp switch button. The LED indicator on the front of the switch should illuminate.
Check Pin L35 with a test lamp for battery
voltage.
4. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Rear Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of
the switch to battery voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Page 6472
Rear Fog Lamp Switch Test
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in. 4. Push the fog lamp switch
button. The test lamp should illuminate, and the LED indicator on the front of the switch. 5. If either
the LED, or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the wire connector in the center stack, EUX left side and RHD right side. 2. Remove
the floor console and disconnect the two clips attaching the wire harness from the underside of the
floor console. 3. Remove the switch bezel from the floor console.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 6475
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 6476
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Rear Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove the assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation
Hazard Warning Flasher: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Hazard Flashers Circuit L9 from the Power Distribution Center (PDC) supplies battery voltage for
the hazard flashers. A 10 Amp fuse in the PDC protects circuit L9.
Circuit L9 connects to the multi-function switch. With the hazard flashers ON, the multi-function
switch connects circuits L9 and L55.
Circuit L55 feeds the combination flashing unit. Circuit Z2 provides ground for the flashing unit.
From the flashing unit, circuit L32 connects to the multi-function switch. With the hazard flashers
ON, the multi-function switch connects circuit L32 to circuits L60, L61, L62, and L63.
Circuit L6O supplies voltage to the right front turn signal/hazard lamp. The L6O circuit splices to the
instrument cluster to power the right indicator lamp.
Circuit L61 supplies voltage to the left front turn signal/hazard lamp. The L61 circuit splices to the
instrument cluster to power the left indicator lamp.
Circuit L62 supplies voltage to the right rear turn signal/hazard flasher/stop lamp.
Circuit L63 supplies voltage to the left rear turn signal/hazard/flasher/stop lamp.
Ground Circuit Circuit Z3 provides ground for the instrument cluster indicator lamps. The
termination point for circuit Z3 is the instrument panel left center support.
Circuit Z1 provides ground for all the turn signal/hazard lamps, although the it has different
grounding points for each circuit. Circuit Z2 provides the ground path for the combination flashing
unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Circuit Operation > Page 6482
Hazard Warning Flasher: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Combination Flasher The turn signal flasher and the hazard warning flasher are combined into one
unit called a combination flasher (combo-flasher). The combo-flasher controls the flashing of the
hazard warning system and the turn signal system. An inoperative bulb or incomplete turn signal
circuit will cause the flasher rate to double.
Combo-Flasher
The combo-flasher is located on the fuse block. The combo-flasher is black in color for ease of
identification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6483
Hazard Warning Flasher: Testing and Inspection
- For the left front turn signal/hazard flasher lamp the Z1 circuit grounding point is the left side of
the radiator closure panel.
- For the right front turn signal/hazard flasher lamp the Z1 circuit grounding point is in the right
fender side shield.
- For the left rear turn signal/hazard flasher/stop lamp the Z1 circuit grounding point is in the left
rear wheel well.
- For the right rear turn signal/hazard flasher/ stop lamp the Z1 circuit grounding point is in the right
rear wheel well.
- Circuit Z1 also supplies ground for the headlamps, parking lamps, rear license plate lamp,
back-up lamps and side marker lamps.
- The grounding point for circuit Z2 is the instrument panel right center support. Circuit Z2 supplies
ground for the combination flashing unit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6487
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Disengage wire connector from headlamp bulb connector.
3. Remove retaining ring holding bulb to back of headlamp module.
Headlamp Bulb
4. Pull bulb from back of headlamp module.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not touch the glass of halogen bulbs with fingers or other possibly oily surface,
reduced bulb life will result.
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. From behind bumper fascia, remove bolt holding
outboard end of module to fender. 3. Loosen bolts holding inboard end of module to radiator
closure panel. 4. Remove bolt holding grille to headlamp module.
Headlamp Module
5. Remove bolts holding top of module to upper cross member. 6. Disengage wire connector from
headlamp and parking lamp sockets. 7. Separate headlamp module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
In OFF or Parking Lamp Position Circuit A3 originates in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and
supplies battery voltage for the headlamp switch. A 40 Amp fuse protects the A3 circuit. The
headlamp switch has an internal 24 Amp circuit breaker that connects circuit A3 to either the L2 or
L20 circuits, depending on switch position.
In the OFF and PARK positions the headlamp switch feeds the L20 circuit that connects to the
multi-function switch. Circuit L20 powers the high beam circuit when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function switch. when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the stalk, the multi-function switch connects the L20 circuit to the L3 circuit. The L3
circuit feeds the high beam of the headlamps.
In ON Position When the headlamp switch is in the ON position, it connects the A3 circuit from the
PDC to circuit L2. Circuit L2 connects to the multi-function switch and feeds the L4 circuit (for low
beam operation). The L4 circuit connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. Circuits L43 and L44
connect to the bus bar in fuse block and power the low beam headlamps. Circuit L43 supplies
voltage to the left headlamp. Circuit L44 supplies voltage to the right headlamp. Both the L43 and
L44 circuits have separate 10 Amp fuses located in fuse block. Fuse 17 protects circuit L43, and
fuse 18 protects circuit L44.
When the operator selects high beam operation with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function
switch, circuit L2 connects to the L3 circuit, Circuit L3 powers high beam operation.
On vehicles equipped with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) the L4 circuit is spliced to the RKE
module. The RKE module uses this circuit to flash the headlamps when the operator has activated
the PANIC mode with the key fob.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Leveling Switch
1. Remove the headlamp leveling switch from the instrument panel and disconnect the wire
harness connector from the switch. 2. If the L.E.D. is not illuminated, using a voltmeter, connect B+
lead to Pin 4 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the negative lead to Pin 3.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low beam position and ensure the instrument panel dimmer
switch is on day light driving position. If voltage is present, replace switch. If no voltage, connect
the ground lead to a good ground, if voltage, repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary, and if no
voltage.
3. Using a voltmeter, connect B+ lead to Pin 2 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the
negative lead to Pin 3. Turn ON the headlamp switch to
the low beam position. If battery voltage, go to Step 5. If not OK, go to Step 4.
4. Connect the ground lead to a good ground, if no voltage, refer to Wiring Diagrams and test
circuit back to headlamp switch. If battery voltage,
repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary
5. Turn headlamps OFF. Connect the wire harness connector to the headlamp leveling switch.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low. beam
position. Check voltage at Pin 5, while rotating the headlamp leveling switch knob through the four
positions. The voltage reading should change as the switch is rotated to each position. If the
voltage does not vary replace switch. If OK, test the headlamp leveling motors and/or circuit to the
motors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch > Page 6500
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Switch Test
Headlamp Switch Test
1. Remove the headlamp switch. 2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals
of the switch as shown in the Headlamp Switch Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly
Headlamp Leveling Switch
2. Disengage the headlamp leveling switch bezel from instrument panel . 3. Pull the switch and
bezel rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export > Page 6503
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlight Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the steering column cover and liner.
Headlamp Switch
2. Remove the three screws securing headlamp switch mounting plate to the instrument panel. 3.
Pull the headlamp switch and mounting plate rearward from the instrument panel opening. 4.
Disconnect both the nine way and the ground wiring connectors from the switch. 5. Remove the
switch knob by depressing the release button on the bottom on the switch and pulling out knob
from switch. 6. Snap headlamp switch bezel out of mounting plate to gain access to the mounting
plate retaining nut. 7. Remove the headlamp switch, mounting plate retaining nut and separate
switch from mounting plate.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The High Beam Indicator Lamp is used to indicate to the operator that the high beam headlamps
are ON. Power is supplied to the cluster on the L3 circuit for vehicles without Daytime Running
Lamps (DRL), or the G34 circuit for vehicles with DRL. Ground is provided on the Z3 circuit.
On vehicle equipped without DRL circuit L3 connects from the headlamp dimmer switch to the
instrument cluster. On vehicles with DRL circuit G34 connects from the DRL module to the
instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 6512
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6513
Horn Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6514
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6515
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay. 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity between ground and circuit 65 of horn
relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay. b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and refer to Horn
Test.
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
5. Check relay for 70 to 75 Ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6516
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Power Distribution Center cover and locate the horn relay.
Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
Horn Switch
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module. When
the Driver Airbag is pressed the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is carried
to the horn relay and the horn sounds. 1. The horn switch grounds to the airbag housing. 2. If horn
does not sound check for corrosion:
- Horn wire
- Horn switch ground connected to airbag metal housing
- Airbag to steering wheel
- Ensure horn wire is properly connected and insulator is in place on wire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6520
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center.
Power Distribution Center
2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power
distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch, should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4.
Test continuity at horn switch remove the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat
Belts/Air Bag Control Module/Replacement/Driver
Airbag Module.
Test Horn Switch Driver Airbag Module
5. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity. If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6521
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
The Horn Switch is part of the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/Air Bag
Control Module/Replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Interior Lighting Relay: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time out relay is located in the fuse block and is used to control the ground path for various
interior lamps. It will also turn the lamps OFF after a specified period of time, and works with the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system for illuminated entry.
Circuit M2 connects to the relay and supplied a ground path through the door ajar switches.
Circuit M1 is used to supply battery voltage to the relay. This circuit is produced by a 10 Amp fuse
located in cavity 13 of the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
Circuit M32 is connected from the relay to the various interior lamps and RKE module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Key Cylinder Lamp > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Key Cylinder Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time delay relay is used to allow a time-ON function for the ignition switch halo lamp. Power for
the relay is received on the M1 circuit from the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC). This is the Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse and HOT at all times.
When a door is OPENED, or the headlamp switch is moved to the dome lamp position, a ground
path is provided for the relay on the M23 circuit. This energizes the relay, CLOSING the contacts.
When the relay contacts are CLOSED, power is provided through the relay to the M50 circuit.
The M50 circuit supplies current to the ignition switch lamp in the steering column. Ground for the
lamp is provided on the Z3 circuit. This circuit splices with the glove box lamp, the ash receiver
lamp, and the PRNDL lamp. The Z3 circuit terminates at the instrument panel left center support.
Circuit M23 is also spliced with the Remote Key-less Entry (RKE) module and the time out relay
located in the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Key Cylinder Lamp > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6528
Key Cylinder Lamp: Service and Repair
Ignition Key Lamp
REMOVAL
1. Remove the steering column cover. 2. Disconnect the lamp hood from the base panel. 3.
Remove the lamp socket from hood and replace the lamp.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > License Plate Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
License Plate Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
License Plate Lamp
1. Remove screws holding license plate lamp to rear bumper. 2. Separate lamp from bumper. 3.
Remove bulb socket from lamp. 4. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Description and Operation
Map Light: Description and Operation
MAP/Reading Lamps
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The map/reading lamps are powered by the M1 circuit from the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
This circuit is the Ignition-Off Draw circuit and protected by a 10 Amp fuse. The M1 circuit is spliced
and provides power for the visor/vanity lamps, radio, power mirrors, dome lamp, time delay relay,
and other interior lamps.
Ground for the lamps is provided from two sources. One is the Z3 circuit which is spliced in with the
glove box lamp and terminates at the instrument panel left center support. The second ground is
provided on circuit M23. This circuit is spliced in with the time out relay so the lamps will turn ON
when any door is OPENED.
On vehicles equipped with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) the M23 circuit, which is the ground circuit
when a door is OPENED, is connected to the RKE module. The module will provide a ground path
for the lamps with a valid signal from the transmitter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Marker Lamp Bulb > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Marker Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Reach behind front bumper fascia forward of front wheel. 2. Remove socket from side marker
lamp.
Front Side Marker
3. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Light Bulb > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Parking Light Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove screws holding park and turn signal lamp to
headlamp module. 3. Separate lamp from module. 4. Remove bulb socket from back of lamp.
Park And Turn Signal Lamp Bulb
5. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Battery Discharge Protection
Relay, Lighting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Battery Discharge Protection Relay: Description and Operation
Halo Lamp/Time Delay Relay
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time delay relay is used to allow a time-ON function for the ignition switch halo lamp. Power for
the relay is received on the M1 circuit from the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC). This is the Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse and HOT at all times.
When a door is OPENED, or the headlamp switch is moved to the dome lamp position, a ground
path is provided for the relay on the M23 circuit. This energizes the relay, CLOSING the contacts.
When the relay contacts are CLOSED, power is provided through the relay to the M50 circuit.
The M50 circuit supplies current to the ignition switch lamp in the steering column. Ground for the
lamp is provided on the Z3 circuit. This circuit splices with the glove box lamp, the ash receiver
lamp, and the PRNDL lamp. The Z3 circuit terminates at the instrument panel left center support.
Circuit M23 is also spliced with the Remote Key-less Entry (RKE) module and the time out relay
located in the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
DRL Module
The Daytime Running Lamp module is attached to a support brace on the underside of the
instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 6551
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION - CANADA
On vehicles built for sale in Canada, the head- lamps operate, at reduced intensity, when the
ignition switch is in the RUN position and the parking brake switch is OPEN.
In the Power Distribution Center (PDC), a bus bar connected to battery voltage feeds circuit A1. In
the RUN position, the ignition switch connects circuit A1 to circuit A21. A 30 Amp fuse in the PDC,
protects circuits A1 and A21.
Circuit A21 connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. The bus bar in the fuse block feeds circuit G5
through a 5 Amp fuse in cavity 11. Circuit G5 is powered only when the ignition switch is in the
RUN position.
Circuit G9 connects to the DRL module. The G9 circuit splices to the brake warning switch, park
brake switch and instrument cluster brake warning bulb.
Circuit L20 from the headlamp and dimmer switch supplies battery voltage to the DRL module at all
times. Circuit A3 from the PDC feeds circuit L20. A 40 Amp fuse in the PDC protects the A3 circuit.
From the DRL module, circuit L4 powers the LOW beams of the left and right headlamps. The DRL
controls the power to circuit L4. Circuit L4 connects to cavity 10 of the DRL module.
Circuit L3 feeds the high beams of the headlamps. When the operator flashes the headlamps with
the stalk of the multi-function switch, the DRL senses voltage on circuit L3. When it senses voltage
on circuit L3, the DRL module stops supplying power to the low beams on circuit L4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 6552
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
- If the park brake switch is CLOSED, the DRL will not turn on the headlamps. The DRL senses if
the park brake switch is CLOSED on circuit G9.
- Circuit Z1 provides ground for the headlamps.
- Circuit L20 of the headlamp switch connector has a jumper that feeds the DRL module.
- Check for a blown fuse in circuits A1 or G5.
- The headlamp switch has a 24 Amp circuit breaker that feeds circuit L20.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Relay Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Headlamp Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. From behind bumper fascia, remove bolt holding
outboard end of module to fender. 3. Loosen bolts holding inboard end of module to radiator
closure panel. 4. Remove bolt holding grille to headlamp module.
Headlamp Module
5. Remove bolts holding top of module to upper cross member. 6. Disengage wire connector from
headlamp and parking lamp sockets. 7. Separate headlamp module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Power Distribution Center (Top)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6563
Auto Shutdown Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6564
Horn Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (Bottom)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6565
Power Distribution Center (Top)
NOTE: To view sheets referred in these diagrams, see Diagram Information and
Instructions/Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6566
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay. 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity between ground and circuit 65 of horn
relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay. b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and refer to Horn
Test.
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
5. Check relay for 70 to 75 Ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6567
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Power Distribution Center cover and locate the horn relay.
Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Interior Lighting Relay: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The time out relay is located in the fuse block and is used to control the ground path for various
interior lamps. It will also turn the lamps OFF after a specified period of time, and works with the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system for illuminated entry.
Circuit M2 connects to the relay and supplied a ground path through the door ajar switches.
Circuit M1 is used to supply battery voltage to the relay. This circuit is produced by a 10 Amp fuse
located in cavity 13 of the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
Circuit M32 is connected from the relay to the various interior lamps and RKE module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Backup Lamp Switch: Specifications
Mounting ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6575
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
The park/neutral starting switch is the center terminal of the three terminal switch. It provides
ground for the starter solenoid circuit through the selector lever in PARK and NEUTRAL positions
only.
1. To test switch, remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between center pin of
switch and transaxle case. Continuity should
exist only when transaxle is in PARK or NEUTRAL.
2. Check gearshift cable adjustment before replacing a switch that tests bad.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
REMOVAL
Unscrew switch from transaxle case allowing fluid to drain into a container. Move selector lever to
PARK, then to NEUTRAL position, and inspect to see the switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Screw the switch with a new seal into transaxle case and tighten to 33 Nm (24 ft. lbs.). Retest
switch with the test lamp. 2. Add fluid to transaxle to bring up to proper level. 3. The back-up lamp
switch circuit is through the two outside terminals of the three terminal switch. 4. To test switch,
remove wiring connector from switch and test for continuity between the two outside pins. 5.
Continuity should exist only with transaxle in REVERSE position. 6. No continuity should exist from
either pin to the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Automatic Transmission > Page 6578
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
NOTE: The back-up lamp switch is located on the top left front side of the transaxle case.
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist. 2. From bottom side of vehicle, remove wiring connector from switch. 3.
Unscrew switch from transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. To install, reverse removal procedure. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Confirm back-up lamps are functioning properly following installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service Precautions
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Switch Operation
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Switch Operation
The stop lamp switch controls operation of the vehicles stop lamps. Also, if the vehicle is equipped
with speed control, the stop lamp switch will deactivate speed control when the brake pedal is
depressed. The stop lamp switch controls operation of the right and left tail, stop and turn signal
lamp and Center High Mounted Stop Lamp CHMSL, by supplying battery current to these lamps.
The stop lamp switch controls the lamp operation by opening and closing the electrical circuit to the
stop lamps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Switch Operation > Page 6584
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation System Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Vehicles equipped with the speed control option use a dual function stop lamp switch. The switch is
mounted in the same location as the conventional stop lamp switch, on the brake pedal mounting
bracket under the instrument panel. The PCM monitors the state of the dual function stop lamp
switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6585
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 21 Stop Lamp Switch
1. Remove the stop lamp switch, refer to Lighting and Horns/Brake Light Switch/Stop Switch
Removal/Installation. Disconnect connector from stop
lamp switch. Using an ohmmeter, switch continuity may be checked as follows:
2. With switch plunger released, there should be continuity between Pin 5 and Pin 6. 3. With switch
plunger depressed, there should be continuity:
- Between Pin 1 and Pin 2.
- Between Pin 3 and Pin 4.
4. If the above results are not obtained, the stop lamp switch is defective or out of adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6586
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
PROCEDURE
1. Remove stop lamp switch from its bracket by rotating it approximately 30° in a counter-clockwise
direction. 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch. 3. Hold stop lamp switch
firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of the stop lamp switch until
it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
4. Install the stop lamp switch into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake
pedal as far down as possible. Then while keeping
the brake pedal depressed, install the stop lamp switch into the bracket by aligning index key on
switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When switch is fully installed in the
square hole of the bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock the switch into the
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If to much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
5. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 6. Gently pull back on brake
pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger to ratchet backward to the
correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6587
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stop Light Switch Location In Vehicle
REMOVE
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal while rotating stop lamp switch in a counter-clockwise
direction approximately 30°. 2. Pull the switch rearward and remove from its mounting bracket. 3.
Disconnect wiring harness connector from stop lamp switch.
INSTALL
NOTE: Prior to installing stop lamp switch into bracket, the plunger must be moved to its fully
extended position using procedure in step Step 1.
1. Hold stop lamp switch firmly in one hand. Then using other hand, pull outward on the plunger of
the stop lamp switch until it has ratcheted out to
its fully extended position.
2. Connect the wiring harness connector to the stop lamp switch. 3. Mount the stop lamp switch
into the bracket using the following procedure. Depress the brake pedal as far down as possible.
Then install switch in
bracket by aligning index key on switch with slot at top of square hole in mounting bracket. When
switch is fully installed in bracket, rotate switch clockwise approximately 30° to lock switch into
bracket.
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when pulling back on brake pedal to adjust the stop lamp
switch. If too much force is used, damage to the stop lamp switch or striker can result.
4. Gently pull back on brake pedal until the pedal stops moving. This will cause the switch plunger
to ratchet backward to the correct position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6591
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps Improper Operation
Door Switch: Customer Interest Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior Lamps Improper Operation > Page 6600
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation
Door Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior Lamps - Improper Operation
NO: 08-36-96
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 1, 1996
SUBJECT: Interior Lights Operate Improperly After Door Adjustment
MODELS: 1995 - 1997 (PL) Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The interior lights operate improperly after a door has been adjusted.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the lights are inoperative with the doors open:
^ Begin with the left front door, open the door, the dome lamp should be on. If the dome lamp is not
on, proceed to the Repair Procedure. If the dome lamp is on, repeat the check for the other doors.
If the lights are on with all doors closed:
^ Begin with the left door, remove the door jam switch and disconnect the wiring connector. If the
light goes off perform the Repair Procedure. If the light remains on, repeat procedure for the other
doors.
If all door jam switches allow the dome lamp to come on with the door open and go off with the
door closed, they are operating properly and this bulletin will not correct the interior lights
inoperative condition, reference the appropriate model year service manual group 8 for further
diagnostics.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04609106 Door Jam Switch
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves the replacement of the door jam switch with an improved part.
1. Open the door with the inoperative door jam switch, Figure 1 shows the location of the drivers
side door jam switch on 4 door models.
2. Remove the screw holding the switch to the vehicle.
3. Pull the switch from the vehicle and disconnect the wiring. Discard the old switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Door Switch: > 083696 > Nov > 96 > Interior
Lamps - Improper Operation > Page 6606
4. Attach the wiring to the new door jam switch.
5. Insert the switch into the vehicle.
6. Install the screw and torque to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.)
7. Verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-80-88-93 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires, connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of the switch to
battery voltage.
Fog Lamp Switch Test
Fog Lamp Switch Circuit
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in for fog lamp switch circuit. 4. Push
the fog lamp switch button. The test lamp and the LED indicator on the front of the switch should
illuminate. 5. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Front Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch and disconnect the connector at the center stack.
Front Fog Lamp Switch Circuit Diagram
2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin L7 to battery voltage, and connect Pin Z03 to ground. 3.
Push the fog lamp switch button. The LED indicator on the front of the switch should illuminate.
Check Pin L35 with a test lamp for battery
voltage.
4. If either the LED or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Rear Export 1. Remove the fog lamp switch. 2. Using two jumper wires connect Pin 2 and Pin 4 of
the switch to battery voltage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6610
Rear Fog Lamp Switch Test
3. Using a test lamp, connect the test lamp to Pin 3 as shown in. 4. Push the fog lamp switch
button. The test lamp should illuminate, and the LED indicator on the front of the switch. 5. If either
the LED, or the test lamp fails to illuminate, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Front Fog Lamp Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the wire connector in the center stack, EUX left side and RHD right side. 2. Remove
the floor console and disconnect the two clips attaching the wire harness from the underside of the
floor console. 3. Remove the switch bezel from the floor console.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 6613
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Fog Lamp Switch Export > Page 6614
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Rear Window Defogger and/or Fog Lamp Switch
Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly.
Rear Window Defogger And Rear Fog Lamp Switch
2. Reach in and disengage the left bezel latch and remove the assembly. 3. Pull the bezel and
switch(s) rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector(s). 4. Remove the switch
from the bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable and isolate it or remove fuse 12 prior to removing the switch,
or wires may short to ground. 2. Open the glove box and push the glove box sides inward allowing
the door bumpers to clear and the box to tip forward. 3. Reach inside the opening and squeeze the
lamp/switch retainers until they are disengage. 4. Pull the switch/lamp rearward and remove it.
Replace the lamp. To replace the switch disconnect wire and replace the switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6621
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
In OFF or Parking Lamp Position Circuit A3 originates in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and
supplies battery voltage for the headlamp switch. A 40 Amp fuse protects the A3 circuit. The
headlamp switch has an internal 24 Amp circuit breaker that connects circuit A3 to either the L2 or
L20 circuits, depending on switch position.
In the OFF and PARK positions the headlamp switch feeds the L20 circuit that connects to the
multi-function switch. Circuit L20 powers the high beam circuit when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function switch. when the operator flashes the
headlamps with the stalk, the multi-function switch connects the L20 circuit to the L3 circuit. The L3
circuit feeds the high beam of the headlamps.
In ON Position When the headlamp switch is in the ON position, it connects the A3 circuit from the
PDC to circuit L2. Circuit L2 connects to the multi-function switch and feeds the L4 circuit (for low
beam operation). The L4 circuit connects to a bus bar in the fuse block. Circuits L43 and L44
connect to the bus bar in fuse block and power the low beam headlamps. Circuit L43 supplies
voltage to the left headlamp. Circuit L44 supplies voltage to the right headlamp. Both the L43 and
L44 circuits have separate 10 Amp fuses located in fuse block. Fuse 17 protects circuit L43, and
fuse 18 protects circuit L44.
When the operator selects high beam operation with the turn signal stalk of the multi-function
switch, circuit L2 connects to the L3 circuit, Circuit L3 powers high beam operation.
On vehicles equipped with Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) the L4 circuit is spliced to the RKE
module. The RKE module uses this circuit to flash the headlamps when the operator has activated
the PANIC mode with the key fob.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Leveling Switch
1. Remove the headlamp leveling switch from the instrument panel and disconnect the wire
harness connector from the switch. 2. If the L.E.D. is not illuminated, using a voltmeter, connect B+
lead to Pin 4 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the negative lead to Pin 3.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low beam position and ensure the instrument panel dimmer
switch is on day light driving position. If voltage is present, replace switch. If no voltage, connect
the ground lead to a good ground, if voltage, repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary, and if no
voltage.
3. Using a voltmeter, connect B+ lead to Pin 2 of the Wire harness connector. Connect the
negative lead to Pin 3. Turn ON the headlamp switch to
the low beam position. If battery voltage, go to Step 5. If not OK, go to Step 4.
4. Connect the ground lead to a good ground, if no voltage, refer to Wiring Diagrams and test
circuit back to headlamp switch. If battery voltage,
repair Pin 3 ground circuit as necessary
5. Turn headlamps OFF. Connect the wire harness connector to the headlamp leveling switch.
Turn ON the headlamp switch to the low. beam
position. Check voltage at Pin 5, while rotating the headlamp leveling switch knob through the four
positions. The voltage reading should change as the switch is rotated to each position. If the
voltage does not vary replace switch. If OK, test the headlamp leveling motors and/or circuit to the
motors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Headlamp Leveling Switch > Page 6627
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection Headlamp Switch Test
Headlamp Switch Test
1. Remove the headlamp switch. 2. Use a ohmmeter, and check continuity between the terminals
of the switch as shown in the Headlamp Switch Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlamp Leveling Switch Export
REMOVAL
1. Remove the top cover and cluster bezel assembly
Headlamp Leveling Switch
2. Disengage the headlamp leveling switch bezel from instrument panel . 3. Pull the switch and
bezel rearward from the opening and disconnect the wire connector.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Headlamp Leveling Switch Export > Page 6630
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Headlight Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the steering column cover and liner.
Headlamp Switch
2. Remove the three screws securing headlamp switch mounting plate to the instrument panel. 3.
Pull the headlamp switch and mounting plate rearward from the instrument panel opening. 4.
Disconnect both the nine way and the ground wiring connectors from the switch. 5. Remove the
switch knob by depressing the release button on the bottom on the switch and pulling out knob
from switch. 6. Snap headlamp switch bezel out of mounting plate to gain access to the mounting
plate retaining nut. 7. Remove the headlamp switch, mounting plate retaining nut and separate
switch from mounting plate.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
Horn Switch
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module. When
the Driver Airbag is pressed the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is carried
to the horn relay and the horn sounds. 1. The horn switch grounds to the airbag housing. 2. If horn
does not sound check for corrosion:
- Horn wire
- Horn switch ground connected to airbag metal housing
- Airbag to steering wheel
- Ensure horn wire is properly connected and insulator is in place on wire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6634
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center.
Power Distribution Center
2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power
distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch, should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4.
Test continuity at horn switch remove the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat
Belts/Air Bag Control Module/Replacement/Driver
Airbag Module.
Test Horn Switch Driver Airbag Module
5. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity. If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6635
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
The Horn Switch is part of the Driver Airbag Module. Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts/Air Bag
Control Module/Replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Tail Light Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Tail Light Bulb: Service and Repair
Tail, Stop, Back-Up and Turn Signal Lamp Bulb
REMOVAL
1. Release trunk latch and open trunk lid. 2. Separate trunk lining from rear closure panel to gain
access to back of tail lamp.
Tail And Stop Lamp Bulb
3. Rotate and remove bulb socket from tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel. 4. Pull
bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Rotate and install bulb socket into tail lamp through openings in rear
closure panel. 3. Install trunk lining to rear closure panel. 4. Close and secure trunk lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation
Trunk Lamp: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The trunk lamp uses a case-grounded switch located on the trunk latch. The switch is normally
OPEN. When the deck lid is opened, the switch CLOSES, completing a path to ground on circuit
M4. The M1 circuit provides power to the lamp, and is HOT at all times.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 6643
Trunk Lamp: Testing and Inspection
- Check the 10 Amp fuse located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) for the trunk lamp,
underhood lamp, visor/vanity lamps, dome lamp, time delay relay, and the glove box lamp.
- Check for a good ground at the instrument panel left center support.
- Check the door switches for a good ground.
- Check the 4 Amp fuse in the fuse block, cavity 12.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 6644
Trunk Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The trunk lamp snaps into the rear shelf panel reinforcement under/below the package shelf. 1.
Remove the socket assembly by reaching up above the sheet metal. Push the snap inward and
downward and remove the assembly 2. Remove the lamp from socket and pull the socket from the
lens. Replace as necessary
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
The multi-function switch contains electrical circuitry for turn signal, hazard warning, headlamp
beam select, headlamp optical horn. This integrated switch assembly is mounted to the left hand
side of the steering column. Should any function of the switch fail, the entire switch assembly must
be replaced.
Turn Signal And Hazard Switch Continuity
Beam Select Switch Continuity
To test the switch, first disconnect the negative battery cable, then remove the upper and lower
column shrouds to gain access to the switch connector. Remove switch connector. Using an
ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 6649
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering column shrouds.
Multi-Function Switch
3. Remove multi-function switch mounting screws.
INSTALLATION
For installation, reverse the above procedures.
- Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten steering column cover retaining screws to 2 N.m (17 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Turn Signal Flasher: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Combination Flasher The turn signal flasher and the hazard warning flasher are combined into one
unit called a combination flasher (combo-flasher). The combo-flasher controls the flashing of the
hazard warning system and the turn signal system. An inoperative bulb or incomplete turn signal
circuit will cause the flasher rate to double.
Combo-Flasher
The combo-flasher is located on the fuse block. The combo-flasher is black in color for ease of
identification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Turn Signal Indicator: Description and Operation
Right and Left Turn Signal Indicators CIRCUIT OPERATION
These lamps are used to indicate to the operator which turn signal is ON. Power for the lamps
comes from the turn signal switch. The L60 circuit is for the right turn indicator, and the L61 circuit
is used for the left turn signal indicator. Ground for the circuits is provided on the Z3 circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park and Turn Signal Lamp Bulb
Turn Signal Bulb: Service and Repair Park and Turn Signal Lamp Bulb
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove screws holding park and turn signal lamp to
headlamp module. 3. Separate lamp from module. 4. Remove bulb socket from back of lamp.
Park And Turn Signal Lamp Bulb
5. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
- Reverse the preceding operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Park and Turn Signal Lamp Bulb > Page 6661
Turn Signal Bulb: Service and Repair Tail, Stop, Turn Signal and Back-Up Lamp Bulb
REMOVAL
1. Release trunk latch and open trunk lid. 2. Separate trunk lining from rear closure panel to gain
access to back of tail lamp.
Tail And Stop Lamp Bulb
3. Rotate and remove bulb socket from tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel. 4. Pull
bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Rotate and install bulb socket into tail lamp through openings in rear
closure panel. 3. Install trunk lining to rear closure panel. 4. Close and secure trunk lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Underhood Lamp > Underhood Light Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Underhood Light Bulb: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the underhood lamp. 2. Rotate the bulb
counter-clockwise. Remove it from the lamp socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the replacement bulb in the lamp base socket and rotate it clockwise. 2. Connect the wire
harness connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vanity Lamp: Description and Operation
Visor/Vanity Lamps
CIRCUIT OPERATION
The visor/vanity lamps are case-grounded, and are operated by a switch internal to the assembly
Power for the lamps is on the M1 circuit from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). When the
operator opens the cover, the switch CLOSES, completing a path to ground illuminating the lamp.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 6669
Vanity Lamp: Service and Repair
The visor vanity lamp is incorporated in the visor assembly. Replace the visor if the lamp has failed.
REMOVAL 1. Lower visor. 2. Insert a small flat bladed tool between the lamp lens and lamp. 3.
Carefully pry lens outward. 4. Remove bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION 1. Position bulb in socket and snap into place. 2. Position lens on lamp and snap
into place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Window Defogger <--> [Heated Glass Element] > Heated Glass
Element Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The rear window defogger switch is a control switch and timer relay integrated into a single panel
mounted assembly. Actuating the switch energizes the circuit which allows current to flow through
the grid lines. Upon initial actuation for approximately eight to ten minutes, or until either the switch
or ignition is turned off. An indicating lamp illuminates a lens inlaid in the control switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Window Defogger <--> [Heated Glass Element] > Heated Glass
Element Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6675
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in- vehicle or bench tested. In vehicle testing is
accomplished in the following manner:
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Rear Window Defogger Switch-Export
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 3 and Pin 4.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 8 in fuse block and the 30 Amp maxi fuse in the
Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check wiring
circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch/relay module.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come on and remain on for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
6. To bench test relay:
a. Using a jumper wire connect a 12 volt batter supply, apply voltage to Pin 3 and 4. Ground Pin 2.
b. Follow the above procedures except Step 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The rear window defogger switch is a control switch and timer relay integrated into a single panel
mounted assembly. Actuating the switch energizes the circuit which allows current to flow through
the grid lines. Upon initial actuation for approximately eight to ten minutes, or until either the switch
or ignition is turned off. An indicating lamp illuminates a lens inlaid in the control switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6680
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in- vehicle or bench tested. In vehicle testing is
accomplished in the following manner:
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Rear Window Defogger Switch-Export
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 3 and Pin 4.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 8 in fuse block and the 30 Amp maxi fuse in the
Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check wiring
circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch/relay module.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come on and remain on for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
6. To bench test relay:
a. Using a jumper wire connect a 12 volt batter supply, apply voltage to Pin 3 and 4. Ground Pin 2.
b. Follow the above procedures except Step 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Master Window Switch (Left Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q21 circuit. The Q21 circuit connects from the switch to the left front window motor.
Grounding is provided on circuit Q11 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q11 is
the feed and circuit Q21 is the ground.
Master Window Switch (Right Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q26 circuit. The Q26 circuit connects from the master switch to the right window switch. A
BUS bar internal to the right switch passes the voltage through the switch to circuit Q22. Circuit
Q22 connects from the switch to the right window motor. Grounding is provided on circuit Q12 from
the motor back to the right switch.
The ground is passed through the switch on a BUS bar to circuit Q16. Circuit Q16 then goes to the
master switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit attaches to
its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuits Q12
and Q16 are the feeds and circuits Q22 and Q26 are the grounds.
Right Window Switch Operation When the window switch is moved to the window DOWN position,
voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch to the Q22 circuit.
The Q22 circuit connects from the switch to the right front window motor. Grounding is provided on
circuit Q12 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Q16
circuit. The Q16 circuit connects from the right switch to the master switch. Ground is passed
through the master switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q12 is
the feed and circuit Q22 is the ground.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 40 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
- Check the 30 Amp circuit breaker located behind the fuse block.
- Check the ground at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 6686
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch Test
Driver Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Passenger Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting, refer to the Window Switch Removal and Installation
procedures. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the test procedure, Driver Side or Passenger Side
Window Switch Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct. If the results are not obtained,
replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6687
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Switch Removal
1. Using a flat tool, insert tool in the slot on the bottom of the switch bezel. 2. Pry the bezel from the
door trim panel. 3. Disconnect wire connector from switch. 4. Remove switch by releasing the tabs
from bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Power Window Motor: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Connect positive (+) lead from a test battery to either of the two
motor terminals. 3. Connect negative (-) lead from test battery to remaining motor terminal. 4. The
motor should now rotate in one direction to either move window up or down.
a. If window happens to already be in full UP position and motor is connected so as to move it in
UP direction no movement will be observed. b. Likewise, motor connected to move window in
DOWN direction no movement will be observed if window is already in full DOWN position. c.
Reverse battery leads in Step 2 and Step 3 and window should now move. If window does not
move, remove motor. See for motor removal
from vehicle.
5. If window moved completely up or down, the test leads should be reversed one more time to
complete a full window travel inspection. 6. If window does not move, check to make sure that it is
free. 7. It is necessary that the window be free to slide up and down in the glass channels. If the
window is not free to move up and down, the window lift
motor will not be able to move the glass.
8. To determine if the glass is free, disconnect the regulator from the glass lift plate. Remove the
two attaching nuts, and slide the window up and
down by hand. This check can not be made on a four door vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 6692
Power Window Motor: Service and Repair
2 DOOR WINDOW MOTOR
WARNING: DO NOT HAVE ANY HANDS OR FINGERS IN SECTOR GEAR AREA WHERE THEY
CAN BE PINCHED BY SMALL MOVEMENTS OF REGULATOR LINKAGE.
REMOVAL 1. Move the window to the full-up position, if possible. 2. Remove door trim panel and
window regulator.
WARNING: FAILURE TO CLAMP THE SECTOR GEAR TO THE MOUNTING PLATE WHEN
REMOVING THE MOTOR CAN RESULT IN INJURY.
3. Secure the sector gear and mounting plate with a C clamp or similar clamping tool. This will
prevent a sudden and forceful movement of the
regulator when the motor is removed.
2 Door Motor Removal
4. Remove three mounting screws that hold motor gearbox to regulator. 5. Remove motor from
regulator.
INSTALLATION 1. Install new motor on regulator by positioning motor gearbox so that it engages
regulator sector teeth. 2. A slight rotational or rocking movement may be necessary to bring three
motor gearbox screw holes into proper position. 3. Install three gearbox screws and one tie down
bracket screw, if applicable. Tighten to 5.6 to 8 N.m (50 to 70 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Install regulator,
using the switch, test operation of motor.
4 DOOR WINDOW MOTOR
REMOVAL 1. Move the window so it is not in the full up or down position, if possible. 2. Remove
door trim panel. 3. Disconnect wiring connector from motor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 6693
4 Door Motor Removal
4. Remove the three nuts attaching the window regulator motor/housing to the door inner panel.
This will allow the motor/housing to be moved to the
lower door inner panel opening since the cables will flex.
5. Turn the motor/housing to gain access to the three nuts attaching the motor to the housing. 6.
Remove the three nuts attaching the motor to the housing. 7. Remove the motor from the housing.
Be careful not to pull the cable drum from the housing, as the motor shaft will tend to pull the drum
with it.
INSTALLATION For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT OPERATION
Master Window Switch (Left Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q21 circuit. The Q21 circuit connects from the switch to the left front window motor.
Grounding is provided on circuit Q11 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed
through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q11 is
the feed and circuit Q21 is the ground.
Master Window Switch (Right Window Operation) When the window switch is moved to the window
DOWN position, voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch
to the Q26 circuit. The Q26 circuit connects from the master switch to the right window switch. A
BUS bar internal to the right switch passes the voltage through the switch to circuit Q22. Circuit
Q22 connects from the switch to the right window motor. Grounding is provided on circuit Q12 from
the motor back to the right switch.
The ground is passed through the switch on a BUS bar to circuit Q16. Circuit Q16 then goes to the
master switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit attaches to
its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuits Q12
and Q16 are the feeds and circuits Q22 and Q26 are the grounds.
Right Window Switch Operation When the window switch is moved to the window DOWN position,
voltage is supplied on the F21 circuit through the CLOSED contacts in the switch to the Q22 circuit.
The Q22 circuit connects from the switch to the right front window motor. Grounding is provided on
circuit Q12 from the motor back to the switch. The ground is passed through the switch to the Q16
circuit. The Q16 circuit connects from the right switch to the master switch. Ground is passed
through the master switch to the Z8 circuit. The Z8 circuit goes to its grounding point.
When window UP operation is selected, the power and ground circuits are reversed. Circuit Q12 is
the feed and circuit Q22 is the ground.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Helpful Information
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Helpful Information
- Check the 40 Amp fuse located in the PDC.
- Check the 30 Amp circuit breaker located behind the fuse block.
- Check the ground at the instrument panel left center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Helpful Information > Page 6699
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch Test
Driver Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Passenger Side Window Switch Continuity Test
Remove the switch from its mounting, refer to the Window Switch Removal and Installation
procedures. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the test procedure, Driver Side or Passenger Side
Window Switch Continuity Test to determine if continuity is correct. If the results are not obtained,
replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 6700
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Switch Removal
1. Using a flat tool, insert tool in the slot on the bottom of the switch bezel. 2. Pry the bezel from the
door trim panel. 3. Disconnect wire connector from switch. 4. Remove switch by releasing the tabs
from bezel.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Window Seal: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-97 Date: 970822
Door Glass - Scratches
NO: 23-46-97
GROUP: Body
DATE: Aug. 22, 1997
SUBJECT: Door Glass Scratched
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Door glass is scratched, inner and outer belt stabilizer contacts glass.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Window Seal: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6709
Inspect the door glass, if scratch runs up the glass in line with the stabilizer location (Figure 1 & 2),
perform the repair procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No: 23-30-10-96
0.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves the replacement of the scratched glass and inner and outer belt stabilizer
assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Window Seal: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6710
1. Open the door and remove the door trim panel and partial water shield to access glass
fasteners.
2. Remove the inner and outer belt weatherstrip.
3. Remove the innerbelt stabilizer (figure 3).
4. Lower the door glass 3/4 way to access glass fasteners.
5. Remove the nuts holding the regulator channel to the door glass.
6. Mark (for installation) and remove the bolts holding the rear guide plate to the glass.
7. Separate the rear guide plate from the glass.
8. Lift the door glass upward and out of opening at the top of the door.
9. Remove the front guide plate from door glass.
10. Remove the outer belt stabilizer(s). If the door being repaired is the front door on the Sedan,
there will be one outer belt stabilizer per door. The rear doors on the Sedan and the doors on the
Coupe will have two outer belt stabilizers per door (Figure 1).
11. Install the new outer belt stabilizers using the screw and washer removed from the existing
outer belt stabilizers and torque to 4.7 Nm (42 in lbs).
12. Loosely install the new window inner belt stabilizer.
13. Install the front guide plate to door glass.
14. Carefully lower the door glass through opening in top of door.
15. Position the front guide plate onto the front glass run.
16. Install the nuts holding the regulator lift channel to the door glass.
17. Use marks made in step 6 to position the rear guide plate onto door glass and install bolts.
18. Roll door glass up, adjust and tighten inner door glass stabilizer. Install inner and outer belt
weatherstrips.
19. Tighten window inner and outer door belt weatherstrips.
20. Install door trim panel and water shield.
21. Adjust the door glass as needed following the procedure provided in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) page 23-47.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Window Glass: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-97 Date: 970822
Door Glass - Scratches
NO: 23-46-97
GROUP: Body
DATE: Aug. 22, 1997
SUBJECT: Door Glass Scratched
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Door glass is scratched, inner and outer belt stabilizer contacts glass.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Window Glass: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches >
Page 6716
Inspect the door glass, if scratch runs up the glass in line with the stabilizer location (Figure 1 & 2),
perform the repair procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No: 23-30-10-96
0.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves the replacement of the scratched glass and inner and outer belt stabilizer
assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Window Glass: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches >
Page 6717
1. Open the door and remove the door trim panel and partial water shield to access glass
fasteners.
2. Remove the inner and outer belt weatherstrip.
3. Remove the innerbelt stabilizer (figure 3).
4. Lower the door glass 3/4 way to access glass fasteners.
5. Remove the nuts holding the regulator channel to the door glass.
6. Mark (for installation) and remove the bolts holding the rear guide plate to the glass.
7. Separate the rear guide plate from the glass.
8. Lift the door glass upward and out of opening at the top of the door.
9. Remove the front guide plate from door glass.
10. Remove the outer belt stabilizer(s). If the door being repaired is the front door on the Sedan,
there will be one outer belt stabilizer per door. The rear doors on the Sedan and the doors on the
Coupe will have two outer belt stabilizers per door (Figure 1).
11. Install the new outer belt stabilizers using the screw and washer removed from the existing
outer belt stabilizers and torque to 4.7 Nm (42 in lbs).
12. Loosely install the new window inner belt stabilizer.
13. Install the front guide plate to door glass.
14. Carefully lower the door glass through opening in top of door.
15. Position the front guide plate onto the front glass run.
16. Install the nuts holding the regulator lift channel to the door glass.
17. Use marks made in step 6 to position the rear guide plate onto door glass and install bolts.
18. Roll door glass up, adjust and tighten inner door glass stabilizer. Install inner and outer belt
weatherstrips.
19. Tighten window inner and outer door belt weatherstrips.
20. Install door trim panel and water shield.
21. Adjust the door glass as needed following the procedure provided in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) page 23-47.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-97 Date: 970822
Door Glass - Scratches
NO: 23-46-97
GROUP: Body
DATE: Aug. 22, 1997
SUBJECT: Door Glass Scratched
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Door glass is scratched, inner and outer belt stabilizer contacts glass.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6726
Inspect the door glass, if scratch runs up the glass in line with the stabilizer location (Figure 1 & 2),
perform the repair procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No: 23-30-10-96
0.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves the replacement of the scratched glass and inner and outer belt stabilizer
assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6727
1. Open the door and remove the door trim panel and partial water shield to access glass
fasteners.
2. Remove the inner and outer belt weatherstrip.
3. Remove the innerbelt stabilizer (figure 3).
4. Lower the door glass 3/4 way to access glass fasteners.
5. Remove the nuts holding the regulator channel to the door glass.
6. Mark (for installation) and remove the bolts holding the rear guide plate to the glass.
7. Separate the rear guide plate from the glass.
8. Lift the door glass upward and out of opening at the top of the door.
9. Remove the front guide plate from door glass.
10. Remove the outer belt stabilizer(s). If the door being repaired is the front door on the Sedan,
there will be one outer belt stabilizer per door. The rear doors on the Sedan and the doors on the
Coupe will have two outer belt stabilizers per door (Figure 1).
11. Install the new outer belt stabilizers using the screw and washer removed from the existing
outer belt stabilizers and torque to 4.7 Nm (42 in lbs).
12. Loosely install the new window inner belt stabilizer.
13. Install the front guide plate to door glass.
14. Carefully lower the door glass through opening in top of door.
15. Position the front guide plate onto the front glass run.
16. Install the nuts holding the regulator lift channel to the door glass.
17. Use marks made in step 6 to position the rear guide plate onto door glass and install bolts.
18. Roll door glass up, adjust and tighten inner door glass stabilizer. Install inner and outer belt
weatherstrips.
19. Tighten window inner and outer door belt weatherstrips.
20. Install door trim panel and water shield.
21. Adjust the door glass as needed following the procedure provided in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) page 23-47.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Customer Interest for Window Seal: >
23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-46-97 Date: 970822
Door Glass - Scratches
NO: 23-46-97
GROUP: Body
DATE: Aug. 22, 1997
SUBJECT: Door Glass Scratched
MODELS: 1995-1997 (PL)
Neon
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Door glass is scratched, inner and outer belt stabilizer contacts glass.
DIAGNOSIS:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Customer Interest for Window Seal: >
23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6737
Inspect the door glass, if scratch runs up the glass in line with the stabilizer location (Figure 1 & 2),
perform the repair procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No: 23-30-10-96
0.7 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Repair Procedure
This bulletin involves the replacement of the scratched glass and inner and outer belt stabilizer
assemblies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Customer Interest for Window Seal: >
23-46-97 > Aug > 97 > Door Glass - Scratches > Page 6738
1. Open the door and remove the door trim panel and partial water shield to access glass
fasteners.
2. Remove the inner and outer belt weatherstrip.
3. Remove the innerbelt stabilizer (figure 3).
4. Lower the door glass 3/4 way to access glass fasteners.
5. Remove the nuts holding the regulator channel to the door glass.
6. Mark (for installation) and remove the bolts holding the rear guide plate to the glass.
7. Separate the rear guide plate from the glass.
8. Lift the door glass upward and out of opening at the top of the door.
9. Remove the front guide plate from door glass.
10. Remove the outer belt stabilizer(s). If the door being repaired is the front door on the Sedan,
there will be one outer belt stabilizer per door. The rear doors on the Sedan and the doors on the
Coupe will have two outer belt stabilizers per door (Figure 1).
11. Install the new outer belt stabilizers using the screw and washer removed from the existing
outer belt stabilizers and torque to 4.7 Nm (42 in lbs).
12. Loosely install the new window inner belt stabilizer.
13. Install the front guide plate to door glass.
14. Carefully lower the door glass through opening in top of door.
15. Position the front guide plate onto the front glass run.
16. Install the nuts holding the regulator lift channel to the door glass.
17. Use marks made in step 6 to position the rear guide plate onto door glass and install bolts.
18. Roll door glass up, adjust and tighten inner door glass stabilizer. Install inner and outer belt
weatherstrips.
19. Tighten window inner and outer door belt weatherstrips.
20. Install door trim panel and water shield.
21. Adjust the door glass as needed following the procedure provided in the 1997 Neon Service
Manual (Publication No. 81-270-7025) page 23-47.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > Page 6739
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Upper Shroud Removal
1. Remove three screws holding steering column shroud and remove upper half of shroud. 2.
Remove mounting screw on switch and remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch Test
To test the switch, first disconnect the switch wires from the body wiring in the steering column.
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch, as indicated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6745
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Upper Shroud Removal
1. Remove three screws holding steering column shroud and remove upper half of shroud. 2.
Remove mounting screw on switch and remove switch. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
switch.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Disconnect the wire connector from the reservoir pump. 3. Disconnect
the washer hose at the pump and drain the reservoir.
Washer Pump
4. Gently pry pump away from reservoir and out of grommet. Care must be taken not to puncture
reservoir. 5. Remover rubber grommet from reservoir and throw away.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Filler Neck Removal
1. Remove filler neck. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist.
Reservoir Removal
3. Disconnect the wire connector from the reservoir pump. 4. Disconnect the washer hose at the
pump and drain the reservoir. 5. Remove fastener from reservoir. 6. Remove the reservoir through
fender opening.
INSTALLATION
- For installation, reverse the above procedures. Tighten the reservoir screw to 2.2 to 3.3 N.m (20
to 29 in.lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Windshield Washer Nozzle
Fig.8 Windshield Washer Pattern - Typical
This model is equipped with two hood mounted washer nozzles. Each nozzle emits two streams
into the wiper pattern. If the nozzle performance is unsatisfactory they can be adjusted. To adjust
insert a pin into the nozzle ball and move to proper pattern. The right and left nozzles are identical.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6755
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect washer fluid hose at the nozzle.
Windshield Washer Nozzle
2. Using a needle nose pliers, squeeze together the locking tabs on the nozzle. 3. Remove nozzle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place the nozzle in position and push downward till locking tabs are securely snapped into
position. 2. Connect the washer hose and ensure that the hose is not kinked.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments
Wiper Arm: Adjustments
1. Cycle the wiper motor into the PARK position. 2. Lift the wiper blade off the windshield and
release it.
Arm Adjustment
3. The wiper blade heel should be parked within 5 mm of the park line. The park line is mark on the
windshield. 4. In the event that the wiper blade tip excessively strikes the cowl screen due to long
term normal wear, reposition the wiper blade heel slightly
above the park line. Make sure that the wipers are in the PARK position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Page
6759
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Place the wiper arm/blades in the PARK position and turn ignition OFF 2. Remove arm cap and
wiper arm nut. 3. Remove the arm from the pivot using a rocking motion. 4. Clean metal splinters
OFF the pivot shafts.
INSTALLATION
- For installation reverse above procedures. Before installation activate wiper system to ensure the
wiper module is in the PARK position. Position wiper arms so that the heel of the blade(s) is on the
park line on the windshield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Blade: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak
Windshield
Wiper Blade: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak Windshield
NUMBER: 23-014-06
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 8, 2006
SUBJECT: Windshield Wiper Blade/Element Maintenance
MODELS: All
All All Chrysler Group Vehicles
DISCUSSION:
Windshield wiper blades/elements are frequently replaced unnecessarily. Because of the
environmental conditions vehicles can be operated in, a film can build up on both the windshield
and the windshield wiper elements that will cause poor cleaning/streaking of the windshield, and in
some instances, a chattering condition as the wipers blades travel across the windshield.
Replacement of the wiper blades/elements is normally NOT required to correct streaking issues. A
simple NORMAL MAINTENANCE cleaning of the wiper blades/elements and windshield is all that
is required.
If the wipe pattern appears to be streaky or if there is chatter and no damage to the wiper
blades/elements is obvious, the following steps should be performed:
1. Use a soft cloth or sponge & squeegee and MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent (p/n
04318067AB, 16 Oz. bottle or p/n 04318068AB, 32 Oz. bottle), MOPAR Glass Cleaner (p/n
04897623AB, 16 Oz. bottle) or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water, to wash the windshield.
2. Raise the wiper blades off the glass and clean the wiper blade elements (rubber insert) with
MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water and a soft cloth,
paper towel or sponge.
3. Return the wiper blades to their normal operating position and function the washer system. If the
wiper blades/elements are not streaking the windshield or chattering, replacing the blade
assembly(ies) is not necessary. If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, repeat step 2 several times.
If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, replace the wiper blades/elements.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Blade: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or
Streak Windshield
Wiper Blade: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak Windshield
NUMBER: 23-014-06
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 8, 2006
SUBJECT: Windshield Wiper Blade/Element Maintenance
MODELS: All
All All Chrysler Group Vehicles
DISCUSSION:
Windshield wiper blades/elements are frequently replaced unnecessarily. Because of the
environmental conditions vehicles can be operated in, a film can build up on both the windshield
and the windshield wiper elements that will cause poor cleaning/streaking of the windshield, and in
some instances, a chattering condition as the wipers blades travel across the windshield.
Replacement of the wiper blades/elements is normally NOT required to correct streaking issues. A
simple NORMAL MAINTENANCE cleaning of the wiper blades/elements and windshield is all that
is required.
If the wipe pattern appears to be streaky or if there is chatter and no damage to the wiper
blades/elements is obvious, the following steps should be performed:
1. Use a soft cloth or sponge & squeegee and MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent (p/n
04318067AB, 16 Oz. bottle or p/n 04318068AB, 32 Oz. bottle), MOPAR Glass Cleaner (p/n
04897623AB, 16 Oz. bottle) or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water, to wash the windshield.
2. Raise the wiper blades off the glass and clean the wiper blade elements (rubber insert) with
MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water and a soft cloth,
paper towel or sponge.
3. Return the wiper blades to their normal operating position and function the washer system. If the
wiper blades/elements are not streaking the windshield or chattering, replacing the blade
assembly(ies) is not necessary. If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, repeat step 2 several times.
If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, replace the wiper blades/elements.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6773
Wiper Blade: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Wiper blades, exposed to the weather for a long period of time, tend to lose their wiping
effectiveness. Periodic cleaning of the wiper blade is suggested to remove the accumulation of salt
and road film. The wiper blades, arms, and windshield should be cleaned with a sponge or cloth
and a mild detergent or nonabrasive cleaner. If the blades continue to streak or smear, they should
be replaced. The right and left wipers are different blade lengths. The driver side length is 525 mm
and the passenger side length is 450 mm. The blades should not be interchanged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6774
Wiper Blade: Testing and Inspection
Cleaning and Inspection Wiper blades exposed to the weather for a long period of time tend to lose
their wiping effectiveness. Periodic cleaning of the wiper blade is recommended to remove the
accumulation of salt and road grime. The wiper blades, arms and windshield should be cleaned
with a sponge or cloth and a mild detergent or nonabrasive cleaner: If the wiper blades continue to
streak or smear, they should be replaced. The wiper blade should run smoothly across the
windshield in both directions. The wiper blade should slightly roll over center when the blade
reverses direction. A wiper blade insert that has lost flexibility or a wiper arm that has lost spring
tension, will cause the blade to skip or chatter across the windshield. If the wiper blades are new
and the wiper arm spring tension is OK and a chattering sound is emitted from the wiper(s), the
wiper blade is not rolling over center. If this condition exists, refer to the Wiper Arm Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Cleaning and Inspection
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Cleaning and Inspection
Wiper blades exposed to the weather for a long period of time tend to lose their wiping
effectiveness. Periodic cleaning of the wiper blade is recommended to remove the accumulation of
salt and road grime. The wiper blades, arms and windshield should be cleaned with a sponge or
cloth and a mild detergent or nonabrasive cleaner: If the wiper blades continue to streak or smear,
they should be replaced. The wiper blade should run smoothly across the windshield in both
directions. The wiper blade should slightly roll over center when the blade reverses direction. A
wiper blade insert that has lost flexibility or a wiper arm that has lost spring tension, will cause the
blade to skip or chatter across the windshield. If the wiper blades are new and the wiper arm spring
tension is OK and a chattering sound is emitted from the wiper(s), the wiper blade is not rolling over
center. If this condition exists, refer to the Wiper Arm Alignment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Cleaning and Inspection > Page 6777
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade
REMOVAL
1. Lift wiper arm to over center position.
Wiper Blade And Element
Remove Blade From Arm
2. Remove blade assembly from arm by pushing release tab under arm tip and slide blade away
from arm tip. 3. Gently place wiper arm tip on glass surface.
INSTALLATION
- For installation reverse above procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Cleaning and Inspection > Page 6778
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade Element
REMOVAL
1. Lift wiper arm to raise blade off glass.
Wiper Blade And Element
Remove Blade From Arm
2. Remove blade assembly from arm by pushing release tab under arm tip and slide blade away
from arm tip. Gently place wiper arm tip on glass
surface.
Windshield Wiper Blade Element
3. Remove wiping element from blade assembly. Pull stopper, of the rubber element, out of the end
claw together with vertebra (metal rails).
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Cleaning and Inspection > Page 6779
- For installation reverse the above procedures. Check that the element and vertebra are through
all claws and the final claw is locked in the stopper.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Wiper Motor Diagnosis Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6784
Wiper Motor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR-BAGS, SEE AIR BAGS AND SEAT BELTS/AIR
BAG
Whenever a wiper motor malfunction occurs, verify that the wire harness is properly connected
start normal diagnosis and repair procedures. Refer to Wiper Motor Test.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 6785
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Wiper Motor And Linkage Module
1. Remove wiper arms and blades. 2. Remove the rear hood seal with the cowl top plastic screen.
3. Disconnect motor wire connector at front plenum wall. 4. Remove wiper module mounting
screws and remove module.
INSTALLATION
- For installation reverse the above procedures. Tighten the mounting screws to 7 to 9 N.m (60 to
80 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Wiper Motor And Linkage Module
1. Remove wiper module. 2. Disconnect wiper arm linkage, by insert screw driver between ball cap
and linkage, then twist the screwdriver and lift straight up on linkage.
INSTALLATION
- For installation reverse the above procedures. Using pliers or hand press the ball cap straight on
to the ball stud.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-122 2.0L DOHC VIN Y SFI (1997))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch Test
To test the switch, first disconnect the switch wires from the body wiring in the steering column.
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch, as indicated.